As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on December 5, 2016

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

 

FORM 20-F

 

¨ REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
OR
x ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended September 30, 2016
OR
¨ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
OR
¨ SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF  1934

 

Commission File Number 001-35892

GW PHARMACEUTICALS PLC

(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

 

England and Wales

(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

 

Sovereign House, Vision Park

Chivers Way, Histon

Cambridge, CB24 9BZ

United Kingdom

(Address of principal executive offices)

Justin D. Gover, Chief Executive Officer

Sovereign House, Vision Park

Chivers Way, Histon

Cambridge, CB24 9BZ

United Kingdom

Telephone No. (44) 1223 266800

E-Mail: investors@gwpharm.com

Facsimile: (44) 1223 235667

(Name, Telephone, E-mail and/or Facsimile number and Address of Company Contact Person)

 

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act.

 

Title of each class   Name of each exchange on which registered

American Depositary Shares, each representing 12

Ordinary Shares, par value £0.001 per share

  The NASDAQ Global Market

 

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None

 

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act: None

 

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual report: 302,093,139 ordinary shares, par value £0.001 per share.

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes   x     No   ¨

 

If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Yes  ¨  No  x

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes  x  No  ¨

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes   x     No   ¨

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer. See definition of “accelerated filer and large accelerated filer” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one): 

 

Large accelerated filer  x Accelerated filer  ¨ Non-accelerated filer  ¨

 

Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:

 

U.S. GAAP ¨

 

International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board  x

 

Other ¨

 

If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow.

 

Item 17 ¨ Item 18 ¨

 

If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). Yes  ¨ No  x

 

 

 

   

TABLE OF CONTENTS (TO BE UPDATED)

 

      Page
       
GENERAL INFORMATION 1
PRESENTATION OF FINANCIAL AND OTHER DATA 1
INFORMATION REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS 1
NOTE REGARDING EXPANDED ACCESS STUDIES 3
PART I      
Item 1   Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisers 4
Item 2   Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable 4
Item 3   Key Information 4
  A.   Selected Financial Data 4
  B.   Capitalization and Indebtedness 6
  C.   Reasons for the Offer and Use of Proceeds 6
  D.   Risk Factors 7
Item 4   Information  on the Company 29
  A.   History and Development of the Company 29
  B.   Business 29
  C.   Organizational Structure 68
  D.   Property, Plant and Equipment 68
Item 4A.   Unresolved Staff Comments 69
Item 5.   Operating and Financial Review and Prospects 69
  A.   Operating Results 69
  B.   Liquidity and Capital Resources 86
  C.   Research and Development, Patents and Licenses, etc. 88
  D.   Trend information 88
  E.   Off Balance Sheet Arrangements 90
  F.   Tabular Disclosure of Contractual Obligations 91
  G.   Safe Harbor 91
Item 6   Directors, Senior Management and Employees 91
  A.   Directors and Senior Management 91
  B.   Compensation 94
  C.   Board Practices 107
  D.   Employees 109
  E.   Share Ownership 109
Item 7   Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions 109
  A.   Major Shareholders 109
  B.   Related Party Transactions 111
  C.   Interests of Experts and Counsel 111
Item 8   Financial Information 111
  A.   Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information 111
  B.   Significant Changes 111
Item 9   The Offer and Listing 112
  A.   Offer and Listing Details 112
  B.   Plan of Distribution 113
  C.   Markets 113
  D.   Selling Shareholders 113
  E.   Dilution 113
  F.   Expenses of the Issue 113
Item 10   Additional Information 113
  A.   Share Capital 113
  B.   Memorandum and Articles of Association 113

 

 

 

  

        Page
         
  C.   Material Contracts 113
  D.   Exchange Controls 114
  E.   Taxation 114
  F.   Dividends and Paying Agents 121
  G.   Statement by Experts 121
  H.   Documents on Display 121
  I.   Subsidiary Information 121
Item 11   Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk 121
Item 12   Description of Securities Other than Equity Securities 122
  A.   Debt Securities 122
  B.   Warrants and Rights 122
  C.   Other Securities 122
  D.   American Depositary Shares 122
PART II      
Item 13.   Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies 123
Item 14.   Material Modifications To The Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds 123
Item 15.   Controls and Procedures 123
  A.   Disclosure Controls and Procedures 123
  B.   Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting 123
  C.   Attestation Report of the Registered Public Accounting Firm 124
  D.   Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting 125
Item 16A.   Audit Committee Financial Expert 125
Item 16B.   Code of Ethics 126
Item 16C.   Principal Accountant Fees and Services 126
Item 16D.   Exemptions From the Listing Standards For Audit Committees 126
Item 16E.   Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers 126
Item 16F.   Change in the Registrant’s Certifying Accountant 126
Item 16G.   Corporate Governance 127
Item 16H.   Mine Safety Disclosure 127
PART III      
Item 17   Financial Statements 128
Item 18   Financial Statements 128
Item 19   Exhibits 128

 

 

 

   

GENERAL INFORMATION

 

In this annual report on Form 20-F (“Annual Report”), “GW Pharma,” the “Group,” the “Company,” “we,” “us” and “our” refer to GW Pharmaceuticals plc and its consolidated subsidiaries, except where the context otherwise requires.

 

Epidiolex ® and Sativex ® are registered trademarks of GW Pharmaceuticals plc.

 

PRESENTATION OF FINANCIAL AND OTHER DATA

 

The consolidated financial statement data as at September 30, 2016 and 2015 and for the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014 have been derived from our consolidated financial statements, as presented elsewhere in this Annual Report, which have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards, or IFRS, as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board, or IASB, and as adopted by the European Union and audited in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). The consolidated financial statement data as at September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012 and for the years ended September 30, 2013 and 2012 have been derived from our consolidated financial statements, which are not presented herein, which have also been prepared in accordance with IFRS as issued by the IASB, and as adopted by the European Union and audited in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).There are no differences applicable to us between IFRS as issued by the IASB and IFRS-EU and PCAOB for any of the periods presented herein.

 

All references in this Annual Report to "$" are to U.S. dollars, all references to "£" are to pounds sterling and all references to "€" are to Euros. Solely for the convenience of the reader, unless otherwise indicated, all pounds sterling amounts as at and for the year ended September 30, 2016 have been translated into U.S. dollars at the rate at September 30, 2016, the last business day of our year ended September 30, 2016, of £0.7744 to $1.00 and unless otherwise indicated, all pounds sterling amounts as at and for the year ended September 30, 2015 have been translated into U.S. dollars at the rate at September 30, 2015, the last business day of our year ended September 30, 2015, of £0.6611 to $1.00. These translations should not be considered representations that any such amounts have been, could have been or could be converted into U.S. dollars at that or any other exchange rate as at that or any other date.

 

INFORMATION REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

 

This Annual Report contains forward-looking statements that are based on our current expectations, assumptions, estimates and projections about us and our industry. All statements other than statements of historical fact in this Annual Report are forward-looking statements.

 

These forward-looking statements are subject to known and unknown risks, uncertainties, assumptions and other factors that could cause our actual results of operations, financial condition, liquidity, performance, prospects, opportunities, achievements or industry results, as well as those of the markets we serve or intend to serve, to differ materially from those expressed in, or suggested by, these forward-looking statements. These forward-looking statements are based on assumptions regarding our present and future business strategies and the environment in which we expect to operate in the future. Important factors that could cause those differences include, but are not limited to:

 

the inherent uncertainty of product development;

 

  manufacturing and commercialization;

 

our ability to submit and maintain INDs and NDAs with the FDA, including our planned submission of our NDA for Epidiolex at the end of the first half of 2017;

 

  our ability to successfully design, commence and complete clinical trials;

 

  patents, including, but not limited to, oppositions and legal challenges;

 

  government regulation and approval, including, but not limited to, the expected timing of potential regulatory approval dates for Epidiolex;

 

  future revenue being lower than expected;

 

  the level of pricing and reimbursement for our products and product candidates, if approved;

 

  increasing competitive pressures in our industry;

 

  general economic conditions or conditions affecting demand for the products offered by us in the markets in which we operate, both domestically and internationally, being less favorable than expected;

 

  1  

 

  

  currency fluctuations and hedging risks;

 

  worldwide economic and business conditions and conditions in the industry in which we operate;

 

  our relationships with our customers and suppliers;

 

  increased competition from other companies in the industry in which we operate;

 

  changing technology;

 

  claims for personal injury or death arising from the use of products and product candidates produced by us;

 

  the occurrence of accidents or other interruptions to our production processes;

 

  changes in our business strategy or development plans, and our expected level of capital expenses;

 

  our ability to attract and retain qualified personnel, including with respect to our preparation for potential commercialization of Epidiolex;

 

  regulatory, environmental, legislative and judicial developments;

 

  our intention not to pay dividends; and

 

  factors that are not known to us at this time.

 

Additional factors that could cause actual results, financial condition, liquidity, performance, prospects, opportunities, achievements or industry results to differ materially include, but are not limited to, those discussed under “Risk Factors” or elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 20-F. Additional risks that we may currently deem immaterial or that are not presently known to us could also cause the forward-looking events discussed in this Annual Report on Form 20-F not to occur. The words “believe,” “may,” “will,” “estimate,” “continue,” “anticipate,” “intend,” “expect” and similar words are intended to identify estimates and forward-looking statements. Estimates and forward-looking statements speak only at the date they were made, and we undertake no obligation to update or to review any estimate and/or forward-looking statement because of new information, future events or other factors. Estimates and forward-looking statements involve risks and uncertainties and are not guarantees of future performance. Our future results may differ materially from those expressed in these estimates and forward-looking statements. In light of the risks and uncertainties described above, the estimates and forward-looking statements discussed in this Annual Report on Form 20-F might not occur and our future results and our performance may differ materially from those expressed in these forward-looking statements due to, inclusive of, but not limited to, the factors mentioned above. Because of these uncertainties, you should not make any investment decision based on these estimates and forward-looking statements.

 

  2  

 

  

NOTE REGARDING EXPANDED ACCESS STUDIES

 

The expanded access studies we are currently supporting are uncontrolled, carried out by individual physician investigators independent from us, and not always conducted in strict compliance with Good Clinical Practices, all of which can lead to an observed treatment effect that may differ from one seen in placebo-controlled trials. Data from these studies provide only anecdotal evidence of efficacy for regulatory review, although they may provide supportive safety information for regulatory review. These studies contain no control or comparator group for reference and are not designed to be aggregated or reported as study results. Moreover, data from such small numbers of patients may be highly variable. Such information, including the statistical principles that the independent investigators have chosen to apply to the data, may not reliably predict results achieved after systematic evaluation of the efficacy in company-sponsored clinical trials or evaluated via other statistical principles that may be applied in these trials. Reliance on such information may lead to Phase 2 and/or Phase 3 clinical trials that are not adequately designed to demonstrate efficacy and could delay or prevent our ability to seek approval of Epidiolex. Physicians conducting these studies may use Epidiolex in a manner inconsistent with GW’s protocols, including in children with conditions different from those being studied in GW-sponsored trials. Any adverse events or reactions experienced by subjects in the expanded access program may be attributed to Epidiolex and may limit our ability to obtain regulatory approval with labeling that we consider desirable, or at all.

 

  3  

 

   

PART I

 

Item 1 Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisers.

 

Not Applicable.

 

Item 2 Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable.

 

Not Applicable.

 

Item 3 Key Information.

 

A. Selected Financial Data.

 

The following table summarizes our consolidated financial data as at the dates and for the periods indicated. The consolidated financial statement data as at September 30, 2016 and 2015 and for the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014 have been derived from our consolidated financial statements, as presented elsewhere in this Annual Report, which have been prepared in accordance with IFRS, as issued by the IASB, and as adopted by the European Union and audited in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). The consolidated financial statement data as at September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012, and for the years ended September 30, 2013 and 2012 has been derived, after certain reclassifications to conform to the current presentation, from our consolidated financial statements, which are not presented herein, which have also been prepared in accordance with IFRS as issued by the IASB, and as adopted by the European Union and audited in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). There are no differences applicable to us between IFRS as issued by the IASB and IFRS-EU and PCAOB for any of the periods presented herein.

 

Our consolidated financial statements are prepared and presented in pounds sterling, our presentation currency. Solely for the convenience of the reader our consolidated financial statements as at and for the year ended September 30, 2016 have been translated into U.S. dollars at $1.00 = £0.7744 based on the certified foreign exchange rates published by Federal Reserve Bank of New York on September 30, 2016. Such convenience translation should not be construed as a representation that the pound sterling amounts have been or could be converted into U.S. dollars at this or at any other rate of exchange, or at all.

 

Our historical results are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be expected in the future. The following selected consolidated financial data should be read in conjunction with our audited consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this Annual Report and the related notes and Item 5, “Operating and Financial Review and Prospects” below.

 

    Year Ended September 30,  
    2016     2016 (1)     2015 (1)     2014 (1)     2013 (1)(2)     2012 (1)(2)  
    $     £     £     £     £     £  
    (in thousands, except per share data)  
Income Statement Data:                                                
Revenue     13,320       10,315       28,540       30,045       27,295       33,120  
Cost of sales     (3,511 )     (2,719 )     (2,618 )     (2,060 )     (1,276 )     (839 )
Research and development expenditure     (128,889 )     (99,815 )     (76,785 )     (43,475 )     (32,697 )     (27,578 )
Sales, general and administrative expenses     (25,747 )     (19,939 )     (12,569 )     (7,337 )     (3,555 )     (3,620 )
Net foreign exchange gains/(losses)     32,993       25,551       6,202       3,188       (237 )     (40 )
Operating (loss)/profit     (111,834 )     (86,607 )     (57,230 )     (19,639 )     (10,470 )     1,043  
Interest expense     (223 )     (173 )     (75 )     (61 )     (64 )     (1 )
Other income     785       608       244       130       178       200  
(Loss)/profit before tax     (111,272 )     (86,172 )     (57,061 )     (19,570 )     (10,356 )     1,242  
Tax benefit     29,073       22,515       12,498       4,911       5,807       1,248  
(Loss)/profit for the year     (82,199 )     (63,657 )     (44,563 )     (14,659 )     (4,549 )     2,490  
(Loss)/earnings per share                                                
Basic     (0.30 )     (0.24 )     (0.18 )     (0.07 )     (0.03 )     0.02  
Diluted     (0.30 )     (0.24 )     (0.18 )     (0.07 )     (0.03 )     0.02  
Weighted average number of shares                                                
Basic     270.4       270.4       246.4       210.4       151.5       133.0  
Diluted     277.5       277.5       254.2       219.9       158.2       137.5  

  

  4  

 

  

    As at September 30,  
    2016     2016 (1)     2015 (1)     2014 (1)(3)     2013 (1)     2012 (1)  
    $     £     £     £     £     £  
    (in thousands)  
Balance Sheet Data:                                                
Non-current assets     62,832       48,659       34,606       17,126       11,581       7,642  
Current assets                                                
Inventories     5,485       4,248       4,756       4,777       4,661       3,537  
Trade and other receivables     33,416       25,878       15,514       7,108       4,633       2,408  
Cash and cash equivalents     483,445       374,392       234,872       164,491       38,069       29,335  
Total current assets     522,346       404,518       255,142       176,376       47,363       35,280  
Total assets     585,178       453,177       289,748       193,502       58,944       42,922  
Current liabilities                                                
Trade and other payables     (40,249 )     (31,170 )     (24,022 )     (12,376 )     (9,440 )     (9,114 )
Current tax liabilities     (1,140 )     (883 )     (366 )     -       -       -  
Obligations under finance leases     (272 )     (211 )     (111 )     (126 )     (100       -  
Deferred revenue     (3,468 )     (2,686 )     (3,269 )     (4,827 )     (3,181 )     (2,449 )
Non-current liabilities                                                
Trade and other payables     (12,168 )     (9,423 )     (8,445 )     (7,927 )     -       -  
Obligations under finance leases     (6,403 )     (4,959 )     (1,540 )     (1,781 )     (1,905 )     -  
Deferred revenue     (6,915 )     (5,355 )     (6,725 )     (7,881 )     (8,916 )     (10,127 )
Share capital     390       302       261       237       178       133  
Share premium     718,568       556,477       349,275       220,551       84,005       65,947  
Net assets/Total equity     514,563       398,490       245,270       158,584       35,402       21,232  

 

    Year Ended September 30,  
    2016     2016 (1)     2015 (1)     2014 (1)     2013 (1)     2012 (1)  
    $     £     £     £     £     £  
    (in thousands)  
Cash Flow Data:                                                
Net cash (outflow)/inflow from operating activities     (109,234 )     (84,594 )     (46,471 )     (12,626 )     (7,468 )     1,801  
Net cash outflow from investing activities     (11,307 )     (8,756 )     (17,791 )     (7,095 )     (2,076 )     (1,060 )
Net cash inflow from financing activities     267,045       206,807       128,419       144,267       18,253       73  

 

 

 

(1) The selected historical consolidated financial data as at September 30, 2016 and 2015 and for the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015, and 2014 have been derived from our consolidated financial statements, as presented elsewhere in this Annual Report, which have been prepared in accordance with IFRS as issued by the IASB and as adopted by the European Union, and audited in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). The consolidated financial statement data as at September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012, and for the years ended September 30, 2013 and 2012 have been derived, after certain reclassifications to conform to the current presentation, from our consolidated financial statements, which are not presented herein, which have also been prepared in accordance with IFRS as issued by the IASB, and as adopted by the European Union.

 

  5  

 

  

(2) The selected historical consolidated financial data as at September 30, 2013 and 2012 and for the years then ended, reflects a reclassification to report foreign exchange gains and losses, primarily from balance sheet revaluation, previously reported within “Management and administrative expenses” in a new income statement line item, titled “Net foreign exchange gains/(losses).” Such reclassification had no impact on operating profit, profit before tax or profit for the year.

 

(3) The selected historical consolidated financial data as at September 30, 2014 and for the year then ended, reflects a reclassification to report the deferred tax asset, previously reported within “Current assets”, to “Non-current assets.” Such reclassification had no impact on operating loss, loss before tax or loss for the year.

 

Exchange rate information

 

The table below shows the period end, average, high and low exchange rates of U.S. dollars per pound sterling for the periods shown. Average rates are computed by using the noon buying rate of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York for the U.S. dollar on the last business day of each month during the relevant year indicated or each business day during the relevant month indicated. The rates set forth below are provided solely for your convenience and may differ from the actual rates used in the preparation of our consolidated financial statements included in this Annual Report.

 

    Noon Buying Rate  
    Period End     Average (1)     High     Low  
Year ended September 30:                                
2011     1.5624       1.6064       1.6691       1.5358  
2012     1.6132       1.5768       1.6263       1.5301  
2013     1.6179       1.5609       1.6275       1.4837  
2014     1.6220       1.6570       1.7165       1.5904  
2015     1.5116       1.5447       1.6216       1.4648  
2016     1.3015       1.4228       1.5475       1.2874  
Month:                                
May 2016     1.4530       1.4524       1.4694       1.4369  
June 2016     1.3242       1.4197       1.4800       1.3217  
July 2016     1.3270       1.3134       1.3332       1.2921  
August 2016     1.3129       1.3101       1.3335       1.2874  
September 2016     1.3015       1.3140       1.3429       1.2959  
October 2016     1.2212       1.2330       1.2840       1.2155  
November 2016 (through November 25, 2016)     1.2462       1.2426       1.2546       1.2218  

 

 

 

(1) The average of the noon buying rate for pounds sterling on the last day of each full month during the relevant year or each business day during the relevant month indicated.

 

B. Capitalization and Indebtedness.

 

Not Applicable.

 

C. Reasons for the Offer and Use of Proceeds.

 

Not Applicable.

 

  6  

 

  

D. Risk Factors.

 

Our business has significant risks. You should carefully consider the following risk factors and all other information contained in this Annual Report, including our consolidated financial statements and the related notes. The risks and uncertainties described below are those significant risk factors, currently known and specific to us that we believe are relevant to our business, results of operations and financial condition. Additional risks and uncertainties not currently known to us or that we now deem immaterial may also impair our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Risks Related to Our Business

 

We are dependent on the success of our product candidates, none of which may receive regulatory approval or be successfully commercialized .

 

Our success will depend on our ability to successfully commercialize our product pipeline, including commercialization of Epidiolex and our other cannabinoid product candidates. We are evaluating Epidiolex for the treatment of Dravet syndrome, LGS and TSC in the United States and have initiated Phase 3 trials for these indications. Nevertheless, Epidiolex may never receive U.S. regulatory approval for the treatment of any of these indications. Even if completed Phase 3 clinical trials and/or Phase 3 clinical trials conducted for U.S. approval show positive results, there can be no assurance that the FDA will approve Epidiolex or any other product candidate for any given indication for several potential reasons, including failure to follow Good Clinical Practice, or GCP, negative assessment of risk to benefit, unacceptable risk of abuse or diversion, insufficient product quality control and standardization, non-GMP compliant manufacturing facilities and in the absence of a protocol agreed through the FDA’s Special Protocol Assessment process, refusal by FDA to accept our clinical trial design/or failure to agree on appropriate clinical endpoints.

 

Our ability to successfully commercialize Epidiolex, if approved, Sativex and our other product candidates will depend on, among other things, our ability to:

 

successfully complete pre-clinical studies and clinical trials, including human factors testing requirements and the assessment of abuse potential;

 

  demonstrate to the FDA and similar foreign regulatory authorities that efficacy of Epidiolex, Sativex or any other product candidates in clinical trials, can be attributed to the investigative product and not exclusively to its interaction with concomitant medications;

 

  receive regulatory approvals from the FDA and similar foreign regulatory authorities;

 

  produce, through a validated process, in manufacturing facilities inspected and approved by regulatory authorities, including the FDA, sufficiently large quantities of the product candidate, and the related Botanical Drug Substances, or BDSs, to permit successful commercialization;

 

  build and maintain strong sales, distribution and marketing capabilities sufficient to launch commercial sales of our product candidates, or otherwise establish collaborations with third parties for the commercialization of our product candidates;

 

  obtain reimbursement from payers such as government health care programs and insurance companies and other private payers, as well as achieve commercially attractive levels of pricing;

 

  secure acceptance of our product candidates from physicians, health care payers, patients and the medical community;

 

  create positive publicity surrounding our product candidates;

 

manage our spending as costs and expenses increase due to clinical trials and commercialization; and

 

obtain and enforce sufficient intellectual property for our product candidates.

 

Our failure or delay with respect to any of the factors above could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

  

  7  

 

  

Our product candidates, if approved, may be unable to achieve the expected market acceptance and, consequently, limit our ability to generate revenue from new products .

 

Even when product development is successful and regulatory approval has been obtained, our ability to generate significant revenue depends on the acceptance of our products by physicians and patients. We cannot assure you that Epidiolex or our other product candidates will achieve the expected market acceptance and revenue if and when they obtain the requisite regulatory approvals. The market acceptance of any product depends on a number of factors, including the indication statement and warnings approved by regulatory authorities in the product label, continued demonstration of efficacy and safety in commercial use, physicians’ willingness to prescribe the product, reimbursement from third-party payers such as government health care systems and insurance companies, the price of the product, the nature of any post-approval risk management plans mandated by regulatory authorities, competition, and marketing and distribution support. Any factors preventing or limiting the market acceptance of our products could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

In respect of our product candidates targeting rare indications, orphan drug exclusivity may afford limited protection, and if another party obtains orphan drug exclusivity for the drugs and indications we are targeting, we may be precluded from commercializing our product candidates in those indications during that period of exclusivity .

 

The first New Drug Application, or NDA, applicant with an Orphan Drug Designation for a particular active moiety to treat a specific disease or condition that receives FDA approval is entitled to a seven-year exclusive marketing period in the United States for that product, for that indication. There is no assurance that we will successfully obtain Orphan Drug Designation for future rare indications or orphan exclusivity upon approval of any of our product candidates that have already obtained Orphan Drug Designation. Even if we do obtain orphan exclusivity for any product candidate, the exclusive marketing rights may be lost if the FDA later determines that the request for designation was materially defective or if the manufacturer is unable to assure sufficient quantity of the drug. Moreover, a drug product with an active moiety that is a different cannabinoid from that in our drug candidate or, under limited circumstances, the same drug product, may be approved by the FDA for the same indication during the period of marketing exclusivity. The limited circumstances include a showing that the second drug is clinically superior to the drug with marketing exclusivity through a demonstration of superior safety or efficacy or that it makes a major contribution to patient care. In addition, if a competitor obtains approval and marketing exclusivity for a drug product with an active moiety that is the same as that in a product candidate we are pursuing for the same indication, approval of our product candidate would be blocked during the period of marketing exclusivity unless we could demonstrate that our product candidate is clinically superior to the approved product. In addition, if a competitor obtains approval and marketing exclusivity for a drug product with an active moiety that is the same as that in a product candidate we are pursuing for a different orphan indication, this may negatively impact the market opportunity for our product candidate. There have been legal challenges to aspects of the FDA’s regulations and policies concerning the exclusivity provisions of the Orphan Drug Act, and future challenges could lead to changes that affect the protections afforded our products in ways that are difficult to predict. In a recent successful legal challenge, a court invalidated the FDA’s denial of orphan exclusivity to a drug on the grounds that the drug was not proven to be clinically superior to a previously approved product containing the same ingredient for the same orphan use. In response to the decision, the FDA released a policy statement stating that the court’s decision is limited just to the facts of that particular case and that the FDA will continue to require the sponsor of a designated drug that is the “same” as a previously approved drug to demonstrate that its drug is clinically superior to that drug upon approval in order to be eligible for orphan drug exclusivity, or in some cases, to even be eligible for marketing approval. In the future, there is the potential for additional legal challenges to the FDA’s orphan drug regulations and policies, and it is uncertain how such challenges might affect our business.

 

In the European Union, if a marketing authorization is granted for a medicinal product that is designated an orphan drug, that product is entitled to ten years of marketing exclusivity. During the period of marketing exclusivity, no similar medicinal product may be granted a marketing authorization for the orphan indication. There is no assurance that we will successfully obtain Orphan Drug Designation for future rare indications or orphan exclusivity upon approval of any of our product candidates that have already obtained designation. Even if we obtain orphan exclusivity for any product candidate, the exclusivity period can be reduced to six years if at the end of the fifth year it is established that the orphan designation criteria are no longer met or if it is demonstrated that the orphan drug is sufficiently profitable that market exclusivity is no longer justified. Further, a similar medicinal product may be granted a marketing authorization for the same indication notwithstanding our marketing exclusivity if we are unable to supply sufficient quantities of our product, or if the second product is safer, more effective or otherwise clinically superior to our orphan drug. In addition, if a competitor such as Insys Therapeutics Inc. obtains marketing authorization and orphan exclusivity for a product that is similar to a product candidate we are pursuing for the same indication, approval of our product candidate would be blocked during the period of orphan marketing exclusivity unless we could demonstrate that our product candidate is safer, more effective or otherwise clinically superior to the approved product.

 

We have to date commercialized only one product, Sativex .

 

Our only approved product, Sativex is currently being commercialized for spasticity due to multiple sclerosis, or MS, outside the United States. Even if we obtain regulatory approval for a product other than Sativex, our future success will still depend in part on the continued successful commercialization of Sativex. Although Sativex is currently approved in 30 countries outside of the United States for MS spasticity, and is sold in 16 of those countries, it may never be successfully commercialized in all of these jurisdictions. The commercial success of Sativex for MS spasticity depends on a number of factors beyond our control, including the willingness of physicians to prescribe Sativex to patients, payers’ willingness and ability to pay for the drug, the level of pricing achieved, patients’ response to Sativex, the ability of our marketing partners to generate sales and, given that we generate revenue from the supply of Sativex to our partners at a fixed percentage of partners’ net sales and that any increase in our manufacturing costs will adversely affect our margins and our financial condition, our ability to manufacture Sativex on a cost effective and efficient basis. Accordingly, we cannot assure you that we will succeed in generating revenue growth through the commercialization of Sativex for MS spasticity. If we are not successful in the continued commercialization of Sativex for MS spasticity, our business, results of operations and financial condition may be harmed.

 

  8  

 

  

We expect to face intense competition, often from companies with greater resources and experience than we have .

 

The pharmaceutical industry is highly competitive and subject to rapid change. The industry continues to expand and evolve as an increasing number of competitors and potential competitors enter the market. Many of these competitors and potential competitors have substantially greater financial, technological, managerial and research and development resources and experience than we have. Some of these competitors and potential competitors have more experience than we have in the development of pharmaceutical products, including validation procedures and regulatory matters. In addition, Sativex competes with, and our product candidates, if successfully developed, will compete with, product offerings from large and well-established companies that have greater marketing and sales experience and capabilities than we or our collaboration partners have. In particular, Insys Therapeutics, Inc. has publicly stated its intention to develop cannabidiol (CBD) in Dravet syndrome, LGS, Infantile Spasms, glioma and potentially other indications. Zogenix, Inc. is developing low dose fenfluramine in Dravet syndrome and has commenced an open-label study with this product in LGS, and other companies with greater resources than us may announce similar plans in the future. In addition, there are non-FDA approved CBD preparations being made available from companies in the medical marijuana industry, which may be competitive to Epidiolex. If we are unable to compete successfully, our commercial opportunities will be reduced and our business, results of operations and financial conditions may be materially harmed.

 

Product shipment delays could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition .

 

The shipment, import and export of Epidiolex, Sativex and our other product candidates require import and export licenses. In the United States, the FDA, U.S. Customs and Border Protection, and the Drug Enforcement Administration, or DEA, and in the United Kingdom, the Home Office, and in other countries, similar regulatory authorities regulate the import and export of pharmaceutical products that contain controlled substances, including Sativex, Epidiolex and our other product candidates. Specifically, the import and export process requires the issuance of import and export licenses by the relevant controlled substance authority in both the importing and exporting country. We may not be granted, or if granted, maintain, such licenses from the authorities in certain countries. Even if we obtain the relevant licenses, shipments of Sativex, Epidiolex and our product candidates may be held up in transit, which could cause significant delays and may lead to product batches being stored outside required temperature ranges. Inappropriate storage may damage the product shipment resulting in a partial or total loss of revenue from one or more shipment of Sativex, Epidiolex or our other product candidates. A partial or total loss of revenue from one or more shipments of Sativex, Epidiolex or our other product candidates could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

If the price for Sativex or any future approved products decreases or if governmental and other third-party payers do not provide adequate coverage and reimbursement levels, our revenue and prospects for profitability will suffer .

 

Reimbursement systems in international markets vary significantly by country and by region, and reimbursement approvals generally must be obtained on a country-by-country basis. Where we have chosen to collaborate with a third party on product candidate development and commercialization, our partner may elect to reduce the price of our products in order to increase the likelihood of obtaining reimbursement approvals. In many countries, products cannot be commercially launched until reimbursement is approved and the negotiation process in some countries can exceed 12 months. In addition, pricing and reimbursement decisions in certain countries can be affected by decisions taken in other countries, which can lead to mandatory price reductions and/or additional reimbursement restrictions across a number of other countries, which may thereby adversely affect our sales and profitability. In the event that countries impose prices that are not sufficient to allow us or our partners to generate a profit, our partners may refuse to launch the product in such countries or withdraw the product from the market, which would adversely affect sales and profitability. For example, whereas the All Wales Medicines Strategy Group has recommended Sativex for use in MS spasticity in Wales, the National Institute for Clinical Excellence published MS treatment guidelines which did not recommend Sativex for use in England. While this example refers to the commercialization of Sativex, the same or similar events, such as price decreases, government mandated rebates or unfavorable reimbursement decisions, could affect the pricing and reimbursement of Epidiolex and our other product candidates and could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

  9  

 

  

Problems in our manufacturing process, failure to comply with manufacturing regulations or unexpected increases in our manufacturing costs could harm our business, results of operations and financial condition .

 

We are responsible for the manufacture and supply of Sativex to our collaboration partners and for the manufacture and supply of Sativex, Epidiolex and other product candidates for use in clinical trials. The manufacturing of Sativex and our product candidates necessitates compliance with Good Manufacturing Practice, or GMP, and other regulatory requirements in jurisdictions internationally. Our ability to successfully manufacture Sativex, Epidiolex and other product candidates involves cultivation of botanical raw material from specific cannabinoid plants, extraction and purification processes, manufacture of finished products and labeling and packaging, which includes product information, tamper evidence and anti-counterfeit features, under tightly controlled processes and procedures. For Sativex and certain of our product candidates, production also requires the cultivation of cannabinoid plants under highly controlled and standardized conditions. In addition, we must ensure chemical consistency among our batches, including clinical batches and, if approved, marketing batches. Demonstrating such consistency may require typical manufacturing controls as well as clinical data. We must also ensure that our batches conform to complex release specifications. For each step in the manufacturing process for Sativex, we are currently reliant on single manufacturing facilities and no back-up facilities are yet in place. We have a second site at which we can grow the specific cannabinoid plants which produce the CBD used in Epidiolex, but we are currently reliant on a single manufacturing facility, and no back-up facilities are yet in place, for the later steps in the Epidiolex production process. Because Sativex is a complex mixture manufactured from plant materials, and because the release specifications may not be identical in all countries, certain batches may fail release testing and not be able to be commercialized. A number of our product candidates (excluding Epidiolex) also consist of a complex mixture manufactured from plant materials, and are therefore subject to a similar risk. If we are unable to manufacture Sativex, Epidiolex or other product candidates in accordance with regulatory specifications, including good manufacturing practices or if there are disruptions in our manufacturing process due to damage, loss or otherwise, or failure to pass regulatory inspections of our manufacturing facilities, we may not be able to meet current demand or supply sufficient product for use in clinical trials, and this may also harm our ability to commercialize Sativex, Epidiolex and our product candidates on a timely or cost-competitive basis, if at all. We are in the process of expanding and upgrading parts of our growing and manufacturing facilities and are working with a number of contract manufacturing partners in order to be able to submit an NDA for Epidiolex which includes a sufficient number of growing and manufacturing sites that would provide sufficient quantities to meet initial demand, and to meet FDA’s stringent requirements for demonstrating equivalence of the scaled up manufacturing process, a program which requires significant time and resources and which may not be successful. We are planning a significant expansion of our growing facilities over the next few years in order to meet potential peak demand for Epidiolex, including working with several new contractors and adopting new methods in order to handle and process bulk quantities of botanical raw material. We are planning to increase the scale in which we manufacture Epidiolex over the next few years in order to meet potential peak demand for Epidiolex, including working with several new contractors and, potentially, adopting new processes. These activities may be unsuccessful, may lead to delays, interruptions to supply, or may prove to be more costly than anticipated. We may fail to expand our growing and manufacturing capability in time to meet market demand for our products and product candidates. Any problems in our growing or manufacturing process could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

In addition, before we can begin commercial manufacture of any product candidates for sale in the United States, we must obtain FDA regulatory approval for the product, which requires a successful FDA inspection of our manufacturing facilities and those of our contract manufacturing partners, processes and quality systems in addition to other product-related approvals. Further, pharmaceutical manufacturing facilities are continuously subject to inspection by the FDA and foreign regulatory authorities, before and after product approval. Due to the complexity of the processes used to manufacture our product candidates, we may be unable to initially or continue to pass federal, state or international regulatory inspections in a cost effective manner. If we are unable to comply with manufacturing regulations, we may be subject to fines, unanticipated compliance expenses, recall or seizure of any approved products, total or partial suspension of production and/or enforcement actions, including injunctions, and criminal or civil prosecution. These possible sanctions would adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Further, the processes we use for cultivation of botanical raw material and the production of product candidates for use in clinical trials may be different to the processes we use to produce commercial product and/or may not be capable of producing sufficient quantities of product for commercial purposes. We may therefore need to undertake additional manufacturing process development and scale-up activities before we can commercialize a product. This may include the conduct of bioequivalence studies to demonstrate that product produced by the process used to manufacture on a commercial scale is the same as the material used in clinical trials. If we cannot demonstrate that our commercial scale product is the same as material used in our clinical trials, we may not be permitted to sell that product, which could have an impact on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Product recalls or inventory losses caused by unforeseen events, cold chain interruption and testing difficulties may adversely affect our operating results and financial condition.

 

Sativex and our product candidates are manufactured and distributed using technically complex processes requiring specialized facilities, highly specific raw materials and other production constraints. The complexity of these processes, as well as strict company and government standards for the manufacture of our products, subjects us to production risks. For example, during the manufacturing process we have from time to time experienced defects in components which have caused vial sealing faults, resulting in vial leakage, pump dispenser faults which have resulted in under-filling of vials and misalignment of labels and tamper evident seals, as well as receipt of faulty electronic dose counters from our supplier. While product batches released for use in clinical trials or for commercialization undergo sample testing, some defects may only be identified following product release. In addition, process deviations or unanticipated effects of approved process changes may result in these intermediate products not complying with stability requirements or specifications. Some of our products must be stored and transported at temperatures within a certain range, which is known as “strict cold chain” storage and transportation. If these environmental conditions deviate, our products’ remaining shelf-lives could be impaired or their efficacy and safety could become adversely affected, making them no longer suitable for use. The occurrence or suspected occurrence of production and distribution difficulties can lead to lost inventories, and in some cases product recalls, with consequential reputational damage and the risk of product liability. The investigation and remediation of any identified problems can cause production delays, substantial expense, lost sales and delays of new product launches.

 

  10  

 

  

Sativex and our product candidates contain controlled substances, the use of which may generate public controversy.

 

Since Sativex, Epidiolex and our other product candidates contain controlled substances, their regulatory approval may generate public controversy. Political and social pressures and adverse publicity could lead to delays in approval of, and increased expenses for, Sativex and our product candidates. These pressures could also limit or restrict the introduction and marketing of Sativex and our product candidates. Adverse publicity from cannabis misuse or adverse side effects from cannabis or other cannabinoid products may adversely affect the commercial success or market penetration achievable by Sativex and our product candidates. The nature of our business attracts a high level of public and media interest, and in the event of any resultant adverse publicity, our reputation may be harmed.

 

  Business interruptions could delay us in the process of developing our product candidates and could disrupt our product sales.

 

Loss of our manufacturing facilities, our growing plants, stored inventory or laboratory facilities through fire, theft or other causes, or loss of our botanical raw material due to pathogenic infection or other causes, could have an adverse effect on our ability to meet demand for Sativex, to continue product development activities and to conduct our business. Failure to supply our partners with commercial product may lead to adverse consequences, including the right of partners to take over responsibility for product supply. We currently have insurance coverage to compensate us for such business interruptions; however, such coverage may prove insufficient to fully compensate us for the damage to our business resulting from any significant property or casualty loss to our inventory or facilities.

 

We have significant and increasing liquidity needs and may require additional funding .

 

Our operations have consumed substantial amounts of cash since inception. For the year ended September 30, 2015, we reported a net operating cash outflow of £46.5 million and a net cash outflow from investing activities of £17.8 million. For the year ended September 30, 2016, we reported a net operating cash outflow of £84.6 million and a net cash outflow from investing activities of £8.8 million.

 

Looking forward, for the year ended September 30, 2017 we expect an operating cash outflow in the range of £77-93 million ($100-120 million) and we expect a cash outflow of £23 million ($30 million) from investing activities as we invest in further scale up of our growing and manufacturing capacity. We expect research and development spend to continue at current levels as, although spend on Phase 3 clinical trials is expected to reduce, we will be investing $30-40 million dollars into pre-launch inventory build, all of which will be expensed via the research and development line in 2017. Sales, general and administrative expenses for 2016 is likely to increase by approximately 30%, mainly in the 2nd half of the year, once our NDA is filed and we are on track towards approval.

 

 Research and development, management and administrative expenses and cash used for operations will continue to be significant and may increase substantially in future connection with new research and development initiatives, continued product commercialization efforts and as we prepare for the potential commercial launch of Epidiolex and continue to grow as a U.S. public company. We may need to raise additional capital to fund our operations, continue to conduct clinical trials to support potential regulatory approval of marketing applications, and to fund commercialization of our products.

 

The amount and timing of our future funding requirements will depend on many factors, including, but not limited to:

 

  the timing of FDA approval, if any, and approvals in international markets of our product candidates, if at all;

 

  the timing and amount of revenue from sales of Sativex, or revenue from grants or other sources;

 

  the rate of progress and cost of our clinical trials and other product development programs;

 

  costs of establishing or outsourcing sales, marketing and distribution capabilities;

 

  costs and timing of completion of expanded in-house manufacturing facilities as well as any outsourced growing and commercial manufacturing supply arrangements for our product candidates;

 

  costs of filing, prosecuting, defending and enforcing any patent claims and other intellectual property rights associated with our product candidates;

 

  costs of operating as a U.S. public company;

 

  the effect of competing technological and market developments;

 

personnel, facilities and equipment requirements; and

 

the terms and timing of any additional collaborative, licensing, co-promotion or other arrangements that we may establish.

 

While we expect to fund our future capital requirements from a number of sources including cash flow from operations, the proceeds from further public offerings, the proceeds from the exercise of share options, we cannot assure you that any of these funding sources will be available to us on favorable terms, or at all. Further, even if we can raise funds from all of the above sources, the amounts raised may not be sufficient to meet our future capital requirements.

 

  11  

 

  

  We may identify a material weakness in our internal control over financial reporting for future fiscal years. If we do not remediate material weaknesses or are unable to implement and maintain effective internal control over financial reporting in the future, the accuracy and timeliness of our financial reporting may be adversely affected.

 

We may discover future deficiencies in our internal controls over financial reporting, including those identified through testing conducted by us or subsequent testing by our independent registered public accounting firm. If we are unable to achieve effective internal control over financial reporting, or if our independent registered public accounting firm determines we continue to have a material weakness in our internal control over financial reporting, we could lose investor confidence in the accuracy and completeness of our financial reports and the market price of our ordinary shares and ADSs could decline.

 

We are exposed to risks related to currency exchange rates.

 

We conduct a significant portion of our operations outside the United Kingdom. Because our financial statements are presented in pounds sterling, changes in currency exchange rates have had and could have a significant effect on our operating results. Exchange rate fluctuations between local currencies and the pound sterling create risk in several ways, including the following: weakening of the pound sterling may increase the pound sterling cost of overseas research and development expenses and the cost of sourced product components outside the United Kingdom; strengthening of the pound sterling may decrease the value of our revenues denominated in other currencies; the exchange rates on non-sterling transactions and cash deposits can distort our financial results; and commercial Sativex pricing and profit margins are affected by currency fluctuations.

 

If product liability lawsuits are successfully brought against us, we will incur substantial liabilities and may be required to limit the commercialization of Sativex and our product candidates.

 

Although we have never had any product liability claims or lawsuits brought against us, we face potential product liability exposure related to the testing of our product candidates in human clinical trials, and we currently face exposure to claims in jurisdictions where we market and distribute Sativex. We may face exposure to claims by an even greater number of persons if we begin marketing and distributing our products commercially in the United States and elsewhere. Now, and in the future, an individual may bring a liability claim against us alleging that Sativex or one of our product candidates caused an injury. While we continue to take what we believe are appropriate precautions, we may be unable to avoid significant liability if any product liability lawsuit is brought against us. Although we have purchased insurance to cover product liability lawsuits, if we cannot successfully defend ourselves against product liability claims, or if such insurance coverage is inadequate, we will incur substantial liabilities. Regardless of merit or eventual outcome, liability claims may result in:

 

decreased demand for Sativex and our other product candidates, if such product candidates are approved;

 

injury to our reputation;

 

withdrawal of clinical trial participants;

 

costs of related litigation;

 

  substantial monetary awards to patients and others;

 

  increased cost of liability insurance;

 

  loss of revenue; and

 

  the inability to successfully commercialize our products.

 

Counterfeit versions of our products could harm our business.

 

Counterfeiting activities and the presence of counterfeit products in a number of markets and over the Internet continue to be a challenge for maintaining a safe drug supply for the pharmaceutical industry. Counterfeit products are frequently unsafe or ineffective, and can be life-threatening. To distributors and users, counterfeit products may be visually indistinguishable from the authentic version. Reports of adverse reactions to counterfeit drugs along with increased levels of counterfeiting could be mistakenly attributed to the authentic product, affect patient confidence in the authentic product and harm the business of companies such as ours. If our products were to be the subject of counterfeits, we could incur substantial reputational and financial harm.

 

We have recently grown our business and will need to further increase the size and complexity of our organization in the future, and we may experience difficulties in managing our growth and executing our growth strategy.

 

Our management and personnel, systems and facilities currently in place may not be adequate to support our business plan and future growth. With the initiation of Phase 3 clinical trials for Epidiolex and the decision to promote and market in the United States the product candidates for with we receive marketing approval from FDA, we have increased our number of full-time employees from 194 on September 30, 2013 to 496 as of September 30, 2016, primarily because we are conducting all of our Phase 2 and 3 clinical trials of Epidiolex and our other product candidates ourselves and establishing a commercial organization and our commercial infrastructure. As a result of these activities the complexity of our business operations has substantially increased. We will need to further expand our scientific, sales and marketing, managerial, compliance, operational, financial and other resources to support our planned research, development and commercialization activities.

 

  12  

 

  

Our need to effectively manage our operations, growth and various projects requires that we:

 

continue to improve our operational, financial, management and regulatory compliance controls and reporting systems and procedures;

 

attract and retain sufficient numbers of talented employees;

 

manage our commercialization activities effectively and in a cost-effective manner;

 

manage our clinical trials effectively;

 

manage our internal manufacturing operations effectively and in a cost effective manner;

 

manage our development efforts effectively while carrying out our contractual obligations to contractors and other third parties; and

 

continue to improve our facilities.

 

In addition, historically, we have utilized and continue to utilize the services of part-time outside consultants and contractors to perform a number of tasks for us, including tasks related to compliance programs, clinical trial management, regulatory affairs, formulation development and other drug development functions. Our growth strategy may also entail expanding our use of consultants and contractors to implement these and other tasks going forward. Because we rely on consultants and contractors for certain functions of our business, we will need to be able to effectively manage these consultants and contractors to ensure that they successfully carry out their contractual obligations and meet expected deadlines. There can be no assurance that we will be able to manage our existing consultants and contractors or find other competent outside expertise, as needed, on economically reasonable terms, or at all. If we are not able to effectively expand our organization by hiring new employees and expanding our use of consultants and contractors, we may be unable to successfully implement the tasks necessary to effectively execute on our planned research, development and commercialization activities and, accordingly, may not achieve our research, development and commercialization goals.

 

We depend upon our key personnel and our ability to attract and retain employees.

 

Our future growth and success depend on our ability to recruit, retain, manage and motivate our employees. The inability to hire or retain experienced management personnel could adversely affect our ability to execute our business plan and harm our operating results. Because of the specialized scientific and managerial nature of our business, we rely heavily on our ability to attract and retain qualified scientific, technical and managerial personnel. The competition for qualified personnel in the pharmaceutical field is intense. Due to this intense competition, we may be unable to continue to attract and retain qualified personnel necessary for the development of our business or to recruit suitable replacement personnel.

 

Our employees may engage in misconduct or other improper activities, including noncompliance with regulatory standards and requirements.

 

We are exposed to the risk of employee fraud or other misconduct. Misconduct by employees could include intentional failures to comply with FDA regulations, provide accurate information to the FDA, comply with applicable manufacturing standards, comply with other federal and state laws and regulations, report information or data accurately or disclose unauthorized activities to us. Employee misconduct could also involve the improper use of information, including information obtained in the course of clinical trials, or illegal misappropriation of drug product, which could result in government investigations and serious harm to our reputation. We have adopted a Code of Business Conduct and Ethics, but it is not always possible to identify and deter employee misconduct, and the precautions we take to detect and prevent this activity may not be effective in controlling unknown or unmanaged risks or losses or in protecting us from governmental investigations or other actions or lawsuits stemming from a failure to be in compliance with such laws or regulations. If any such actions are instituted against us, and we are not successful in defending ourselves or asserting our rights, those actions could have a significant impact on our business, including the imposition of significant fines or other sanctions.

 

If we are unable to use net operating loss carry-forwards and certain built-in losses to reduce future tax payments, or benefit from favorable tax legislation, our business, results of operations and financial condition may be adversely affected.

 

As a U.K. resident trading company, we are predominantly subject to U.K. corporate taxation. At September 30, 2016, we had cumulative carry-forward tax losses of £102.8 million, available to offset against future profits. The majority of these tax loss attributes have not been recognized on our balance sheet at September 30, 2016. Additionally, as we carry out extensive research and development activities in the U.K., we benefit from the U.K. research and development tax credit regime for small and medium sized companies, whereby our principal research subsidiary, GW Research Ltd, is able to surrender a portion of available losses that arise from research and development activity for a refundable credit of up to approximately 33.4% of the eligible research and development expenditure. We may also benefit in the future from the UK’s “patent box” regime, which would allow certain profits attributable to revenue from patented products to be taxed at a lower rate than other profits that over time will be reduced to 10%. When taken in combination with our available carry-forward tax losses and the enhanced relief available on our research and development expenditure, we expect that this may result in a long-term low rate of corporation tax. If, however, we are unable to generate sufficient future taxable profits, or for any reason to utilize our carry-forward losses, or there are unexpected adverse changes to the U.K. research and development tax credit regime or “patent box” regime, or we are unable to qualify for such advantageous tax legislation, our business, results of operations and financial condition may be adversely affected.

 

  13  

 

  

We are subject to the U.K. Bribery Act, the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act and other anti-corruption laws, as well as export control laws, customs laws, sanctions laws and other laws governing our operations. If we fail to comply with these laws, we could be subject to civil or criminal penalties, other remedial measures, and legal expenses, which could adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Our operations are subject to anti-corruption laws, including the U.K. Bribery Act 2010, or Bribery Act, the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act, or FCPA, and other anti-corruption laws that apply in countries where we do business. The Bribery Act, FCPA and these other laws generally prohibit us and our employees and intermediaries from bribing, being bribed or making other prohibited payments to government officials or other persons to obtain or retain business or gain some other business advantage. We and our commercial partners operate in a number of jurisdictions that pose a high risk of potential Bribery Act or FCPA violations, and we participate in collaborations and relationships with third parties whose actions could potentially subject us to liability under the Bribery Act, FCPA or local anti-corruption laws. In addition, we cannot predict the nature, scope or effect of future regulatory requirements to which our international operations might be subject or the manner in which existing laws might be administered or interpreted

 

We are also subject to other laws and regulations governing our international operations, including regulations administered by the governments of the United Kingdom and the United States, and authorities in the European Union, including applicable export control regulations, economic sanctions on countries and persons, customs requirements and currency exchange regulations, collectively referred to as the Trade Control laws.

 

However, there is no assurance that we will be completely effective in ensuring our compliance with all applicable anti-corruption laws, including the Bribery Act, the FCPA or other legal requirements, including Trade Control laws. If we are not in compliance with the Bribery Act, the FCPA and other anti-corruption laws or Trade Control laws, we may be subject to criminal and civil penalties, disgorgement and other sanctions and remedial measures, and legal expenses, which could have an adverse impact on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity. Likewise, any investigation of any potential violations of the Bribery Act, the FCPA, other anti-corruption laws or Trade Control laws by the United Kingdom, the United States or other authorities could also have an adverse impact on our reputation, our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Our proprietary information, or that of our customers, suppliers and business partners, may be lost or we may suffer security breaches.

 

In the ordinary course of our business, we collect and store sensitive data, including intellectual property, clinical trial data, our proprietary business information and that of our customers, suppliers and business partners, and personally identifiable information of our customers, clinical trial subjects and employees, in our data centers and on our networks. The secure processing, maintenance and transmission of this information is critical to our operations. Despite our security measures, our information technology and infrastructure may be vulnerable to attacks by hackers or breached due to employee error, malfeasance or other disruptions. Although to our knowledge we have not experienced any such material security breach to date, any such breach could compromise our networks and the information stored there could be accessed, publicly disclosed, lost or stolen. Any such access, disclosure or other loss of information could result in legal claims or proceedings, liability under laws that protect the privacy of personal information, regulatory penalties, disrupt our operations, damage our reputation, and cause a loss of confidence in our products and our ability to conduct clinical trials, which could adversely affect our business and reputation and lead to delays in gaining regulatory approvals for Epidiolex. Although we maintain business interruption insurance coverage, our insurance might not cover all losses from any future breaches of our systems.

 

Failure of our information technology systems could significantly disrupt the operation of our business.

 

Our business increasingly depends on the use of information technologies, which means that certain key areas such as research and development, production and sales are to a large extent dependent on our information systems or those of third party providers. Our ability to execute our business plan and to comply with regulators requirements with respect to data control and data integrity, depends, in part, on the continued and uninterrupted performance of our information technology systems, or IT systems and the IT systems supplied by third-party service providers. These systems are vulnerable to damage from a variety of sources, including telecommunications or network failures, malicious human acts and natural disasters. Moreover, despite network security and backup measures, some of our servers are potentially vulnerable to physical or electronic break-ins, computer viruses and similar disruptive problems. Despite the precautionary measures we and our third-party service providers have taken to prevent unanticipated problems that could affect our IT systems, sustained or repeated system failures or problems arising during the upgrade of any of our IT systems that interrupt our ability to generate and maintain data, and in particular to operate our proprietary technology platform, could adversely affect our ability to operate our business.

 

  14  

 

  

Legislative or regulatory reform of the health care system in the United States and foreign jurisdictions may affect our ability to profitably sell our products, if approved.

 

Our ability to commercialize our future products successfully, alone or with collaborators, will depend in part on the extent to which coverage and reimbursement for the products will be available from government and health administration authorities, private health insurers and other third-party payers. The continuing efforts of the U.S. and foreign governments, insurance companies, managed care organizations and other payers of health care services to contain or reduce health care costs may adversely affect our ability to set prices for our products which we believe are fair, and our ability to generate revenues and achieve and maintain profitability.

 

Specifically, in both the United States and some foreign jurisdictions, there have been a number of legislative and regulatory proposals to change the health care system in ways that could affect our ability to sell our products profitably. For example, the Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act, as amended by the Health Care and Education Reconciliation Act, or collectively the ACA, enacted in the United States in March 2010, substantially changes the way healthcare is financed by both governmental and private insurers. Proposals have been made to repeal or modify the ACA, but it is not clear at this point whether such proposals will be adopted.

 

We expect additional federal and state proposals and health care reforms to continue to be proposed by legislators, which could limit the prices that can be charged for the products we develop and may limit our commercial opportunity.

 

The continuing efforts of government and other third-party payers to contain or reduce the costs of health care through various means may limit our commercial opportunity. It will be time consuming and expensive for us to go through the process of seeking coverage and reimbursement from Medicare and private payers. Our products may not be considered cost effective, and government and third-party private health insurance coverage and reimbursement may not be available to patients for any of our future products or sufficient to allow us to sell our products on a competitive and profitable basis. Our results of operations could be adversely affected by ACA, changes to the ACA, and by other health care reforms that may be enacted or adopted in the future. In addition, increasing emphasis on managed care in the United States will continue to put pressure on the pricing of pharmaceutical products. Cost control initiatives could decrease the price that we or any potential collaborators could receive for any of our future products and could adversely affect our ability to generate revenue in the U.S. market and maintain profitability.

 

In some foreign countries, including major markets in the European Union, the pricing of prescription pharmaceuticals is subject to governmental control. In these countries, pricing negotiations with governmental authorities can take six to 12 months or longer after the receipt of regulatory approval for a product. To obtain reimbursement or pricing approval in some countries, we may be required to conduct a pharmacoeconomic study that compares the cost-effectiveness of our product candidates to other available therapies. Such pharmacoeconomic studies can be costly and the results uncertain. Our business could be harmed if reimbursement of our products is unavailable or limited in scope or amount or if pricing is set at unsatisfactory levels.

 

We may acquire other companies which could divert our management’s attention, result in additional dilution to our shareholders and otherwise disrupt our operations and harm our operating results.

 

We may in the future seek to acquire businesses, products or technologies that we believe could complement or expand our product offerings, enhance our technical capabilities or otherwise offer growth opportunities. The pursuit of potential acquisitions may divert the attention of management and cause us to incur various expenses in identifying, investigating and pursuing suitable acquisitions, whether or not they are consummated. If we acquire additional businesses, we may not be able to integrate the acquired personnel, operations and technologies successfully, or effectively manage the combined business following the acquisition. We also may not achieve the anticipated benefits from the acquired business due to a number of factors, including:

 

  incurrence of acquisition-related costs;

 

  diversion of management’s attention from other business concerns;

 

  unanticipated costs or liabilities associated with the acquisition;

 

  harm to our existing business relationships with collaboration partners as a result of the acquisition;

 

  harm to our brand and reputation;

 

  the potential loss of key employees;

 

  use of resources that are needed in other parts of our business; and

 

  use of substantial portions of our available cash to consummate the acquisition.

 

In the future, if our acquisitions do not yield expected returns, we may be required to take charges to our operating results arising from the impairment assessment process. Acquisitions may also result in dilutive issuances of equity securities or the incurrence of debt, which could adversely affect our operating results. In addition, if an acquired business fails to meet our expectations, our business, results of operations and financial condition may be adversely affected.

 

  15  

 

  

The United Kingdom’s vote in favor of withdrawing from the European Union and the result of the recent U.S. presidential election could lead to increased market volatility which could adversely impact the market price of our ADSs and make it more difficult for us to do business in Europe or have other adverse effects on our business.

 

On June 23, 2016, the electorate in the United Kingdom voted in favor of leaving the European Union (commonly referred to as “Brexit”). The withdrawal of the United Kingdom from the European Union will take effect either on the effective date of the withdrawal agreement or, in the absence of agreement, two years after the United Kingdom provides a notice of withdrawal pursuant to the EU Treaty. No announcement has been made by the U.K. government as to when it intends to deliver any notice of withdrawal. There are many ways in which our business could be affected by this event, only some of which we can identify at this time. It appears likely that this withdrawal will involve a process of lengthy negotiations between the United Kingdom and European Union member states to determine the future terms of the United Kingdom’s relationship with the European Union. This could lead to a period of considerable uncertainty particularly in relation to United Kingdom financial and banking markets as well as on the regulatory process in Europe. As a result of this uncertainty, financial markets could experience significant volatility which could adversely affect the market price of our ADSs. We may also face new regulatory costs and challenges that could have a material adverse effect on our operations. Depending on the terms of Brexit, the United Kingdom could lose the benefits of global trade agreements negotiated by the European Union on behalf of its members, which may result in increased trade barriers which could make our doing business in Europe more difficult. In addition, currency exchange rates in the pound sterling and the euro with respect to each other and the U.S. dollar have already been adversely affected by Brexit. Should this foreign exchange volatility continue it could cause volatility in our quarterly financial results.

 

On November 8, 2016, Mr. Donald J. Trump was elected the next president of the United States. As a candidate, President-Elect Trump proposed changes to existing trade policies and agreements, proposed reforming the FDA, repealing the Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act and changing the manner in which drug prices are negotiated by Medicare. Changes in U.S. social, political, regulatory and economic conditions in the U.S. or in laws and policies governing foreign trade, importation, manufacturing, development, registration and approval, commercialization and reimbursement of our products in the U.S. could adversely affect our business.

 

Risks Related to Development and Regulatory Approval of Sativex and Our Product Candidates

 

Clinical trials for our product candidates are expensive, time-consuming, uncertain and susceptible to change, delay or termination.

 

Clinical trials are expensive, time consuming and difficult to design and implement. Even if the results of our clinical trials are favorable, the clinical trials for a number of our product candidates are expected to continue for several years and may take significantly longer to complete. In addition, we, the FDA or other regulatory authorities, including state and local authorities, or an Institutional Review Board, or IRB, with respect to a trial at its institution, may suspend, delay or terminate our clinical trials at any time, require us to conduct additional clinical trials, require a particular clinical trial to continue for a longer duration than originally planned, require a change to our development plans such that we conduct clinical trials for a product candidate in a different order, e.g., in a step-wise fashion rather than running two trials of the same product candidate in parallel, or the DEA could suspend or terminate the registrations and quota allotments we require in order to procure and handle controlled substances, for various reasons, including:

 

  lack of effectiveness of any product candidate during clinical trials;

 

  discovery of serious or unexpected toxicities or side effects experienced by trial participants or other safety issues, such as drug: drug interactions, including those which cause confounding changes to the levels of other concomitant medications. In this regard it should be noted that the data from the expanded access studies with Epidiolex we are currently supporting, as presented by Devinsky et al. at the Annual Meeting of the American Epilepsy Society held in December 2015, indicates that clobazam co-therapy is associated with a higher rate of treatment response (median reduction in convulsive seizures (CBD with v. without clobazam) at week 12 of treatment. However, this effect is not seen in patients with Dravet syndrome or LGS. We have initiated a Company-sponsored double-blinded, placebo controlled Phase 2 trial to investigate this drug:drug interaction in a controlled and scientific manner;

 

  slower than expected rates of subject recruitment and enrollment rates in clinical trials;

 

  difficulty in retaining subjects who have initiated a clinical trial but may withdraw at any time due to adverse side effects from the therapy, insufficient efficacy, fatigue with the clinical trial process or for any other reason;

 

  delays or inability in manufacturing or obtaining sufficient quantities of materials for use in clinical trials due to regulatory and manufacturing constraints;

 

  inadequacy of or changes in our manufacturing process or product formulation;

 

  delays in obtaining regulatory authorization to commence a trial, including “clinical holds” or delays requiring suspension or termination of a trial by a regulatory agency, such as the FDA, before or after a trial is commenced;

 

  DEA-related recordkeeping, reporting or security violations at a clinical site, leading the DEA or state authorities to suspend or revoke the site’s controlled substance license and causing a delay or termination of planned or ongoing trials;

 

  changes in applicable regulatory policies and regulation, including changes to requirements imposed on the extent, nature or timing of studies;

 

  delays or failure in reaching agreement on acceptable terms in clinical trial contracts or protocols with prospective clinical trial sites;

 

  16  

 

  

  uncertainty regarding proper dosing;

 

  delay or failure to supply product for use in clinical trials which conforms to regulatory specification;

 

  unfavorable results from ongoing pre-clinical studies and clinical trials;

 

  failure of our contract research organizations, or CROs, or other third-party contractors to comply with all contractual requirements or to perform their services in a timely or acceptable manner;

 

  failure by us, our employees, our CROs or their employees to comply with all applicable FDA or other regulatory requirements relating to the conduct of clinical trials or the handling, storage, security and recordkeeping for controlled substances;

 

  scheduling conflicts with participating clinicians and clinical institutions;

 

failure to design appropriate clinical trial protocols;

  

regulatory concerns with cannabinoid products generally and the potential for abuse;

 

insufficient data to support regulatory approval;

 

inability or unwillingness of medical investigators to follow our clinical protocols; or

 

difficulty in maintaining contact with patients during or after treatment, which may result in incomplete data.

 

Any of the foregoing could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Any failure by us to comply with existing regulations could harm our reputation and operating results.

 

We are subject to extensive regulation by U.S. federal and state and foreign governments in each of the markets where we currently sell Sativex or in markets where we have product candidates progressing through the approval process. We must adhere to all regulatory requirements including the FDA’s Good Laboratory Practice, current Good Manufacturing Practice, or GMP, and Good Clinical Practice requirements. If we or our suppliers fail to comply with applicable regulations, including FDA pre-or post-approval GMP requirements, then the FDA or other foreign regulatory authorities could sanction us. Even if a drug is FDA-approved, regulatory authorities may impose significant restrictions on a product’s indicated uses or marketing or impose ongoing requirements for potentially costly post-marketing trials.

 

If any of our product candidates is approved in the United States, it will be subject to ongoing regulatory requirements for labeling, packaging, storage, distribution, import, export, advertising, promotion, sampling, recordkeeping and submission of safety and other post-market information, including both federal and state requirements in the United States. In addition, manufacturers and manufacturers’ facilities are required to comply with extensive FDA requirements, including ensuring that quality control and manufacturing procedures conform to GMP. As such, we and our contract manufacturers (in the event contract manufacturers are appointed in the future) are subject to continual review and periodic inspections to assess compliance with GMP. Accordingly, we and others with whom we work must continue to expend time, money and effort in all areas of regulatory compliance, including manufacturing, production, quality control and quality assurance. We will also be required to report certain adverse reactions and production problems, if any, to the FDA, and to comply with requirements concerning advertising and promotion for our products. Promotional communications with respect to prescription drugs are subject to a variety of legal and regulatory restrictions and must be consistent with the information in the product’s approved label.

 

If a regulatory agency discovers previously unknown problems with a product, such as adverse events of unanticipated severity or frequency, or problems with the facility where the product is manufactured, or disagrees with the promotion, marketing or labeling of the product, it may impose restrictions on that product or us, including requiring withdrawal of the product from the market. If we fail to comply with applicable regulatory requirements, a regulatory agency or enforcement authority may:

 

  issue warning letters;

 

  impose civil or criminal penalties;

 

  suspend regulatory approval;

 

  suspend any of our ongoing clinical trials;

 

  refuse to approve pending applications or supplements to approved applications submitted by us;

 

  17  

 

  

  impose restrictions on our operations, including by requiring us to enter in to a Corporate Integrity Agreement or closing our contract manufacturers’ facilities, if any; or

 

  seize or detain products or require a product recall.

 

Any government investigation of alleged violations of law could require us to expend significant time and resources in response, and could generate negative publicity. Any failure to comply with ongoing regulatory requirements may significantly and adversely affect our ability to commercialize and generate revenue from Sativex and our product candidates. If regulatory sanctions are applied or if regulatory approval is withdrawn, the value of our business and our operating results will be adversely affected. Additionally, if we are unable to generate revenue from sales of Sativex, our potential for achieving profitability will be diminished and the capital necessary to fund our operations will be increased.

 

Any action against us for violation of these laws, even if we successfully defend against it, could cause us to incur significant legal expenses, divert our management’s attention from the operation of our business and damage our reputation. We expend significant resources on compliance efforts and such expenses are unpredictable and might adversely affect our results. Changing laws, regulations and standards might also create uncertainty, higher expenses and increase insurance costs. As a result, we intend to invest all reasonably necessary resources to comply with evolving standards, and this investment might result in increased management and administrative expenses and a diversion of management time and attention from revenue-generating activities to compliance activities.

 

Information obtained from expanded access studies may not reliably predict the efficacy of our product candidates in company-sponsored clinical trials and may lead to adverse events that could limit approval.

 

The expanded access studies we are currently supporting are uncontrolled, carried out by individual investigators and not typically conducted in strict compliance with GCPs, all of which can lead to a treatment effect which may differ from that in placebo-controlled trials. These studies provide only anecdotal evidence of efficacy for regulatory review. These studies contain no control or comparator group for reference and these patient data are not designed to be aggregated or reported as study results. Moreover, data from such small numbers of patients may be highly variable. Information obtained from these studies, including the statistical principles that we and the independent investigators have chosen to apply to the data, may not reliably predict data collected via systematic evaluation of the efficacy in company-sponsored clinical trials or evaluated via other statistical principles that may be applied in those trials. Reliance on such information to design our clinical trials may lead to Phase 2 and 3 trials that are not adequately designed to demonstrate efficacy and could delay or prevent our ability to seek approval of Epidiolex.

 

Expanded access programs provide supportive safety information for regulatory review. Physicians conducting these studies may use Epidiolex in a manner inconsistent with the protocol, including in children with conditions beyond those being studied in GW-sponsored trials. Any adverse events or reactions experienced by subjects in the expanded access program may be attributed to Epidiolex and may limit our ability to obtain regulatory approval with labeling that we consider desirable, or at all.

 

There is a high rate of failure for drug candidates proceeding through clinical trials.

 

Generally, there is a high rate of failure for drug candidates proceeding through clinical trials. We may suffer significant setbacks in our clinical trials similar to the experience of a number of other companies in the pharmaceutical and biotechnology industries, even after receiving promising results in earlier trials. Further, even if we view the results of a clinical trial to be positive, the FDA or other regulatory authorities may disagree with our interpretation of the data. In the event that we obtain negative results from clinical trials for Epidiolex or our other product candidates, or the FDA places a clinical hold on our trials due to potential Chemistry, Manufacturing and Controls issues or other hurdles or does not approve our NDA for our product candidates, we may not be able to generate sufficient revenue or obtain financing to continue our operations, our ability to execute on our current business plan will be materially impaired, our reputation in the industry and in the investment community would likely be significantly damaged and the price of our ADSs would likely decrease significantly. In addition, our inability to properly design, commence and complete clinical trials may negatively impact the timing and results of our clinical trials and ability to seek approvals for our drug candidates.

 

The anticipated development of a Risk Evaluation and Mitigation Strategy (REMS) for our product candidates could cause delays in the approval process and would add additional layers of regulatory requirements that could impact our ability to commercialize our product candidates in the United States and reduce their market potential.

 

As a condition of approval of an NDA, the FDA may require a Risk Evaluation and Mitigation Strategies (REMS) to ensure that the benefits of the drug outweigh the potential risks. REMS elements can include medication guides, communication plans for health care professionals, and elements to assure safe use, or ETASU. ETASU can include, but are not limited to, special training or certification for prescribing or dispensing, dispensing only under certain circumstances, special monitoring and the use of patient registries. Moreover, product approval may require substantial post-approval testing and surveillance to monitor the drug’s safety or efficacy. We may be required to adopt a REMS for our product candidates to ensure that the benefits outweigh the risks of abuse, misuse, diversion and other potential safety concerns. Even if abuse, misuse and diversion are not as high as for other cannabinoid products, there can be no assurance that the FDA will approve a manageable REMS for our product candidates, which could create material and significant limits on our ability to successfully commercialize our product candidates in the United States. Delays in the REMS approval process could result in delays in the NDA approval process. In addition, as part of the REMS, the FDA could require significant restrictions, such as restrictions on the prescription, distribution and patient use of the product, which could significantly impact our ability to effectively commercialize our product candidates, and dramatically reduce their market potential thereby adversely impacting our business, financial condition and results of operations. Even if initial REMS are not highly restrictive, if, after launch, our product candidates were to be subject to significant abuse/non-medical use or diversion from licit channels, this could lead to negative regulatory consequences, including a more restrictive REMS.

 

  18  

 

  

If we are found in violation of federal or state “fraud and abuse” laws, we may be required to pay a penalty and/or be suspended from participation in federal or state health care programs, which may adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

After we obtain regulatory approval for our products in the United States, if any, we will be subject to various federal and state health care “fraud and abuse” laws, including anti-kickback laws, false claims laws and other laws intended to reduce fraud and abuse in federal and state health care programs, which could affect us particularly upon successful commercialization of our products in the United States. The Medicare and Medicaid Patient Protection Act of 1987, or federal Anti-Kickback Statute, makes it illegal for any person, including a prescription drug manufacturer (or a party acting on its behalf), to knowingly and willfully solicit, receive, offer or pay any remuneration that is intended to induce the referral of business, including the purchase, order or prescription of a particular drug for which payment may be made under a federal health care program, such as Medicare or Medicaid. Under federal government regulations, some arrangements, known as safe harbors, are deemed not to violate the federal Anti-Kickback Statute. Although we seek to structure our business arrangements in compliance with all applicable requirements, these laws are broadly written, and it is often difficult to determine precisely how the law will be applied in specific circumstances. Accordingly, it is possible that our practices may be challenged under the federal Anti-Kickback Statute. False claims laws prohibit anyone from knowingly and willfully presenting or causing to be presented for payment to third-party payers, including government payers, claims for reimbursed drugs or services that are false or fraudulent, claims for items or services that were not provided as claimed, or claims for medically unnecessary items or services. Cases have been brought under false claims laws alleging that off-label promotion of pharmaceutical products or the provision of kickbacks has resulted in the submission of false claims to governmental health care programs. Under the Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996, we are prohibited from knowingly and willfully executing a scheme to defraud any health care benefit program, including private payers, or knowingly and willfully falsifying, concealing or covering up a material fact or making any materially false, fictitious or fraudulent statement in connection with the delivery of or payment for health care benefits, items or services. Violations of fraud and abuse laws may be punishable by criminal and/or civil sanctions, including fines and/or exclusion or suspension from federal and state health care programs such as Medicare and Medicaid and debarment from contracting with the U.S. government. In addition, private individuals have the ability to bring actions on behalf of the government under the federal False Claims Act as well as under the false claims laws of several states.

 

Many states have adopted laws similar to the federal anti-kickback statute, some of which apply to the referral of patients for health care services reimbursed by any source, not just governmental payers. In addition, California and a few other states have passed laws that require pharmaceutical companies to comply with the April 2003 Office of Inspector General Compliance Program Guidance for Pharmaceutical Manufacturers and/or the Pharmaceutical Research and Manufacturers of America Code on Interactions with Healthcare Professionals. In addition, several states impose other marketing restrictions or require pharmaceutical companies to make marketing or price disclosures to the state. There are ambiguities as to what is required to comply with these state requirements and if we fail to comply with an applicable state law requirement we could be subject to penalties.

 

Neither the government nor the courts have provided definitive guidance on the application of fraud and abuse laws to our business. Law enforcement authorities are increasingly focused on enforcing these laws, and it is possible that some of our practices may be challenged under these laws. While we believe we have structured our business arrangements to comply with these laws, it is possible that the government could allege violations of, or convict us of violating, these laws. If we are found in violation of one of these laws, we could be required to pay a penalty and could be suspended or excluded from participation in federal or state health care programs, and our business, results of operations and financial condition may be adversely affected.

 

Our ability to research, develop and commercialize Sativex and our product candidates is dependent on our ability to maintain licenses relating to the cultivation, possession and supply of controlled substances.

 

Our research and manufacturing facilities are located exclusively in the United Kingdom. In the United Kingdom, licenses to cultivate, possess and supply cannabis for medical research are granted by the Home Office on an annual basis. Although the Home Office has renewed our licenses each year since 1998, it may not do so in the future, in which case we may not be in a position to carry on our research and development program in the United Kingdom. In addition, we are required to maintain our existing commercial licenses to cultivate, produce and supply cannabis. However, if the Home Office were not prepared to renew such licenses, we would be unable to manufacture and distribute our products on a commercial basis in the United Kingdom or beyond. In order to carry out research in countries other than the United Kingdom, similar licenses to those outlined above are required to be issued by the relevant authority in each country. In addition, we will be required to obtain licenses to export from the United Kingdom and to import into the recipient country. To date, we have obtained necessary import and export licenses to over 30 countries. Although we have an established track record of successfully obtaining such licenses as required, this may change in the future.

 

In the United States, the DEA regulates the cultivation, possession and supply of cannabis for medical research and/or commercial development, including the requirement of annual registrations to manufacture or distribute pharmaceutical products derived from cannabis extracts. We do not currently conduct manufacturing or repackaging/relabeling of any product candidates in the United States. In the event that we sought to do so in the future, a decision to manufacture, or supply cannabis extracts for medical research or commercial development in the United States would require that we and/or our contract manufacturers maintain such registrations, and be subject to other regulatory requirements such as manufacturing quotas, and if the DEA failed to issue or renew such registrations, we would be unable to manufacture and distribute any product in the United States on a commercial basis.

 

  19  

 

  

Serious adverse events or other safety risks could require us to abandon development and preclude, delay or limit approval of our product candidates, or limit the scope of any approved label or market acceptance.

 

If Sativex or any of our product candidates, prior to or after any approval for commercial sale, cause serious or unexpected side effects, or are associated with other safety risks such as misuse, abuse or diversion, a number of potentially significant negative consequences could result, including:

 

regulatory authorities may interrupt, delay or halt clinical trials;

 

  regulatory authorities may deny regulatory approval of our product candidates;

 

  regulatory authorities may require certain labeling statements, such as warnings or contraindications or limitations on the indications for use, and/or impose restrictions on distribution in the form of a Risk Evaluation and Mitigation Strategy, or REMS, in connection with approval, if any;

 

  regulatory authorities may withdraw their approval, require more onerous labeling statements or impose a more restrictive REMS of any product that is approved;

 

  we may be required to change the way the product is administered or conduct additional clinical trials;

 

  our relationships with our collaboration partners may suffer;

 

  we could be sued and held liable for harm caused to patients; or

 

  our reputation may suffer. The reputational risk is heightened with respect to those of our product candidates that are being developed for pediatric indications.

 

We may voluntarily suspend or terminate our clinical trials if at any time we believe that they present an unacceptable risk to participants or if preliminary data demonstrate that our product candidates are unlikely to receive regulatory approval or unlikely to be successfully commercialized. To date, we have only voluntarily suspended clinical trials when recruitment of the target patients has proven to be too difficult or, temporarily, to properly investigate suspected adverse events. In addition, regulatory agencies, IRBs or data safety monitoring boards may at any time recommend the temporary or permanent discontinuation of our clinical trials or request that we cease using investigators in the clinical trials if they believe that the clinical trials are not being conducted in accordance with applicable regulatory requirements, or that they present an unacceptable safety risk to participants. Although we have never been asked by a regulatory agency, IRB or data safety monitoring board to temporarily or permanently discontinue a clinical trial, if we elect or are forced to suspend or terminate a clinical trial of any of our product candidates, the commercial prospects for that product will be harmed and our ability to generate product revenue from that product may be delayed or eliminated. Furthermore, any of these events may result in labeling statements such as warnings or contraindications. In addition, such events or labeling could prevent us or our partners from achieving or maintaining market acceptance of the affected product and could substantially increase the costs of commercializing our product candidates and impair our ability to generate revenue from the commercialization of these products either by us or by our collaboration partners.

 

If third parties claim that intellectual property used by us infringes upon their intellectual property, our operating profits could be adversely affected.

 

There is a substantial amount of litigation, both within and outside the United States, involving patent and other intellectual property rights in the pharmaceutical industry. We may, from time to time, be notified of claims that we are infringing upon patents, trademarks, copyrights or other intellectual property rights owned by third parties, and we cannot provide assurances that other companies will not, in the future, pursue such infringement claims against us or any third-party proprietary technologies we have licensed. If we were found to infringe upon a patent or other intellectual property right, or if we failed to obtain or renew a license under a patent or other intellectual property right from a third party, or if a third party that we were licensing technologies from was found to infringe upon a patent or other intellectual property rights of another third party, we may be required to pay damages, including triple damages if the infringement is found to be willful, suspend the manufacture of certain products or reengineer or rebrand our products, if feasible, or we may be unable to enter certain new product markets. Any such claims could also be expensive and time consuming to defend and divert management’s attention and resources. Our competitive position could suffer as a result. In addition, if we have declined to enter into a valid non-disclosure or assignment agreement for any reason, we may not own the invention or our intellectual property, and our products may not be adequately protected. Although we have reviewed certain third-party patents and patent filings that we believe may be relevant to Sativex, Epidiolex and our other product candidates, we have not conducted full freedom-to-operate searches or analyses, and we may not be aware of patents or pending or future patent applications that, if issued, would block us from commercializing Sativex, Epidiolex or our other product candidates. Thus, we cannot guarantee that Sativex, Epidiolex or our other product candidates, or our commercialization thereof, does not and will not infringe any third party’s intellectual property.

 

  20  

 

   

Risks Related to Our Reliance Upon Third Parties

 

We depend substantially on the commercial expertise of our collaboration partners for Sativex .

 

Although we intend to commercialize Epidiolex using our own sales and marketing operation in the United States and potentially elsewhere, we rely on the expertise and commercial skills of our collaboration partners to sell Sativex. We have entered into agreements for the commercialization of Sativex with Almirall S.A., or Almirall, in Europe (excluding the United Kingdom) and Mexico; Otsuka Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd., Otsuka, in the United States; Novartis Pharma AG, or Novartis, in Australia and New Zealand, Asia (excluding Japan, China and Hong Kong), the Middle East (excluding Israel) and Africa; Bayer HealthCare AG in the United Kingdom and Canada; Ipsen Biopharm Ltd, or Ipsen, in Latin America (excluding Mexico and the Islands of the Caribbean); and Neopharm Group in Israel. Our ability to successfully market and sell Sativex in each of these markets depends entirely on the expertise and commercial skills of our collaboration partners. Our partners have the right, under certain circumstances, to terminate their agreements with us, and three of our partners, Almirall, Otsuka and Novartis, have the right to terminate their agreements with us without cause. In November 2016 we entered into a mutual termination agreement with Novartis, pursuant to which rights in Sativex in Australia and New Zealand, Asia (excluding Japan, China and Hong Kong), the Middle East (excluding Israel) and Africa will be returned to GW over an agreed transition period, and we are in the process of appointing new distributors in the countries in the Novartis territories where Sativex is approved. No other partner has given notice of termination of their agreement with us to date, but given the fact that not one of three Phase 3 cancer pain trials for Sativex showed a statistically significant difference for Sativex compared with placebo, we cannot be certain that not one of these remaining partners will not terminate their agreement with us. Further, a failure by our partners to successfully market Sativex, or the termination of agreements with our partners, may have an adverse effect on our business at least in the near term period following such termination.

 

We have relied on Otsuka for funding of our Sativex research and development programs in the United States and if Otsuka were to terminate its agreement with us we would have to fund any future development of Sativex in the United States ourselves, and come to an agreement with Otsuka on jointly-owned intellectual property resulting from our pre-clinical research collaboration.

 

Under the terms of our agreement with Otsuka with respect to Sativex in the United States, Otsuka funds all pre-clinical and clinical trials for the development of Sativex in the treatment of cancer pain as well as potential additional indications. There is however no assurance that Otsuka will agree to fund future development activities. As outlined above, Otsuka has the right to terminate their agreement with us without cause. In light of the results of the Phase 3 cancer pain trials for Sativex discussed above, we cannot be certain that Otsuka will not terminate this agreement. If Otsuka were to terminate this agreement, we would be required to find alternative funding for our clinical program for any future development of Sativex in the United States.

 

In addition, under the terms of the research collaboration agreement we entered with Otsuka in 2007 all intellectual property rights (including both patents and non-manufacturing related know-how) that was conceived by either Otsuka or us during the course of the collaboration is to be jointly owned by Otsuka and us unless Otsuka elects to cease funding the prosecution and maintenance costs for these rights. As at September 30, 2016 we had 6 patent families which consist of 79 jointly owned patent applications and 87 granted patents relating to our collaboration with Otsuka. Because Otsuka exercises some control over this jointly owned intellectual property, we may need to seek Otsuka’s consent to out-license and/or enforce some of this collaboration intellectual property in the future.

 

Our existing collaboration arrangements and any that we may enter into in the future may not be successful, which could adversely affect our ability to develop and commercialize Sativex and our product candidates.

 

We are a party to, and may seek additional, collaboration arrangements with pharmaceutical or biotechnology companies for the development or commercialization of Sativex and our product candidates. We may, with respect to our product candidates, enter into new arrangements on a selective basis depending on the merits of retaining commercialization rights for ourselves as compared to entering into selective collaboration arrangements with leading pharmaceutical or biotechnology companies for each product candidate, both in the United States and internationally. To the extent that we decide to enter into collaboration agreements, we will face significant competition in seeking appropriate collaborators. Moreover, collaboration arrangements are complex and time consuming to negotiate, document and implement. We may not be successful in our efforts to establish, implement and maintain collaborations or other alternative arrangements if we choose to enter into such arrangements and, as noted above, our selected partners may be given, and may exercise, a right to terminate their agreement with us without cause. The terms of any collaboration or other arrangements that we may establish may not be favorable to us.

 

Any existing or future collaboration that we enter into may not be successful. The success of our collaboration arrangements will depend heavily on the efforts and activities of our collaborators. Collaborators generally have significant discretion in determining the efforts and resources that they will apply to these collaborations. For example, and as explained above, the mutual termination of the Sativex distribution and license agreement with Novartis follows the prior amendment agreement with Novartis which permitted Novartis not to make a determination about launching Sativex in any country in its territory until final data was available for the Phase 3 clinical trials for Sativex in cancer pain.

 

Disagreements between parties to a collaboration arrangement regarding development, intellectual property, regulatory or commercialization matters, can lead to delays in the development process or commercialization of the applicable product candidate and, in some cases, termination of the collaboration arrangement. These disagreements can be difficult to resolve if neither of the parties has final decision making authority.

 

Collaborations with pharmaceutical or biotechnology companies and other third parties often are terminated or allowed to expire by the other party. Any such termination or expiration would adversely affect us financially and could harm our business reputation.

 

  21  

 

  

We depend on a limited number of suppliers for materials and components required to manufacture Sativex and our other product candidates. The loss of these suppliers, or their failure to supply us on a timely basis, could cause delays in our current and future capacity and adversely affect our business.

 

We depend on a limited number of suppliers for the materials and components required to manufacture Sativex and our other product candidates. For example, we rely on single-source suppliers to supply various components of Sativex, including the glass vial and pump actuator, and we rely on a single contractor for commercial supply of botanical raw material for Sativex. Although we are actively working on expanding the number of suppliers and facilities for Epidiolex production, at present we have two independent contractors who supply botanical raw material for Epidiolex but are otherwise dependent on single-source suppliers and facilities for producing Epidiolex. As a result, we may not be able to obtain sufficient quantities of critical materials and components in the future. A delay or interruption by our suppliers may also harm our business, results of operations and financial condition. In addition, the lead time needed to establish a relationship with a new supplier can be lengthy, and we may experience delays in meeting demand in the event we must switch to a new supplier. The time and effort to qualify for and, in some cases, obtain regulatory approval for a new supplier could result in additional costs, diversion of resources or reduced manufacturing yields, any of which would negatively impact our operating results. Our dependence on single-source suppliers exposes us to numerous risks, including the following: our suppliers may cease or reduce production or deliveries, raise prices or renegotiate terms; our suppliers may become insolvent or cease trading; we may be unable to locate a suitable replacement supplier on acceptable terms or on a timely basis, or at all; and delays caused by supply issues may harm our reputation, frustrate our customers and cause them to turn to our competitors for future needs.

 

A significant portion of our cash and cash equivalents are held at a small number of banks.

 

A significant portion of our cash and cash equivalents is presently held at a small number of banks. Although our board has adopted a treasury policy requiring us to limit the amount of cash held by each banking group taking into account their credit ratings, we are subject to credit risk if any of these banks are unable to repay the balance in the applicable account or deliver our securities or if any bank should become bankrupt or otherwise insolvent. Any of the above events could have a material and adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Risks Related to Our Intellectual Property

 

We may not be able to adequately protect Sativex, our product candidates or our proprietary technology in the marketplace .

 

Our success will depend, in part, on our ability to obtain patents, protect our trade secrets and operate without infringing on the proprietary rights of others. We rely upon a combination of patents, trade secret protection (i.e., know how), and confidentiality agreements to protect the intellectual property of Sativex and our product candidates. The strengths of patents in the pharmaceutical field involve complex legal and scientific questions and can be uncertain. Where appropriate, we seek patent protection for certain aspects of our products and technology. Filing, prosecuting and defending patents throughout the world would be prohibitively expensive, so our policy is to patent commercially potential technology in jurisdictions with significant commercial opportunities. However, patent protection may not be available for some of the products or technology we are developing. If we must spend significant time and money protecting, defending or enforcing our patents, designing around patents held by others or licensing, potentially for large fees, patents or other proprietary rights held by others, our business, results of operations and financial condition may be harmed. We may not develop additional proprietary products that are patentable.

 

The patent positions of pharmaceutical products are complex and uncertain. The scope and extent of patent protection for Sativex and our product candidates are particularly uncertain. To date, our principal product candidates, including Sativex and Epidiolex, have been based on specific formulations of certain previously known cannabinoids found in nature in the cannabis sativa plant. While we have sought patent protection directed to, among other things, composition of matter for our specific formulations, their methods of use, and methods of manufacture, we do not have and will not be able to obtain composition of matter protection on these previously known cannabinoids per se. We anticipate that the products we develop in the future will continue to include or be based on the same or other naturally occurring compounds, as well as synthetic compounds we may discover. Although we have sought and expect to continue to seek patent protection for our product candidates, their methods of use, and methods of manufacture, any or all of them may not be subject to effective patent protection. Publication of information related to Sativex and our product candidates by us or others may prevent us from obtaining or enforcing patents relating to these products and product candidates. Furthermore, others may independently develop similar products, may duplicate our products, or may design around our patent rights. In addition, any of our issued patents may be opposed and/or declared invalid or unenforceable. Indeed, a number of our recently issued European patents, including our European patent claiming the use of CBD in the treatment of partial seizures, have received notices of opposition, which may result in claims in these patents being narrowed or cancelled such that the scope of the opposed patent may not be as broad, or the opposed patent may be revoked in its entirety. In the case of our European patent claiming the use of CBD in the treatment of partial seizures, the granted claims were upheld at first instance, but this decision may be appealed. If we fail to adequately protect our intellectual property, we may face competition from companies who attempt to create a generic product to compete with Sativex or Epidiolex. We may also face competition from companies who develop a substantially similar product to Sativex, Epidiolex or one of our other product candidates that is not covered by any of our patents.

 

Many companies have encountered significant problems in protecting, defending and enforcing intellectual property rights in foreign jurisdictions. The legal systems of certain countries, particularly certain developing countries, do not favor the enforcement of patents and other intellectual property rights, particularly those relating to pharmaceuticals, which could make it difficult for us to stop the infringement of our patents or marketing of competing products in violation of our proprietary rights generally. Proceedings to enforce our patent rights in foreign jurisdictions could result in substantial cost and divert our efforts and attention from other aspects of our business.

 

  22  

 

  

Risks Related to Controlled Substances

 

Controlled substance legislation differs between countries and legislation in certain countries may restrict or limit our ability to sell Sativex and our product candidates .

 

Most countries are parties to the Single Convention on Narcotic Drugs 1961, which governs international trade and domestic control of narcotic substances, including cannabis extracts. Countries may interpret and implement their treaty obligations in a way that creates a legal obstacle to our obtaining regulatory approval for Sativex, Epidiolex and our other products in those countries. These countries may not be willing or able to amend or otherwise modify their laws and regulations to permit Sativex, Epidiolex or our other products to be marketed, or achieving such amendments to the laws and regulations may take a prolonged period of time. For example, we are currently unable to file a regulatory application in Mexico or Japan due to a national law which the regulators consider prevents the approval of a cannabis-based medicine. In the case of countries with similar obstacles, we would be unable to market Sativex, Epidiolex and our product candidates in countries in the near future or perhaps at all if the laws and regulations in those countries do not change.

 

The product candidates we are developing will be subject to U.S. controlled substance laws and regulations and failure to comply with these laws and regulations, or the cost of compliance with these laws and regulations, may adversely affect the results of our business operations, both during clinical development and post approval, and our financial condition .

 

The product candidates we are developing contain controlled substances as defined in the federal Controlled Substances Act of 1970, or CSA. Controlled substances that are pharmaceutical products are subject to a high degree of regulation under the CSA, which establishes, among other things, certain registration, manufacturing quotas, security, recordkeeping, reporting, import, export and other requirements administered by the DEA. The DEA classifies controlled substances into five schedules: Schedule I, II, III, IV or V substances. Schedule I substances by definition have a high potential for abuse, no currently “accepted medical use” in the United States, lack accepted safety for use under medical supervision, and may not be prescribed, marketed or sold in the United States. Pharmaceutical products approved for use in the United States which contain a controlled substance are listed as Schedule II, III, IV or V, with Schedule II substances considered to present the highest potential for abuse or dependence and Schedule V substances the lowest relative risk of abuse among such substances. Schedule I and II drugs are subject to the strictest controls under the CSA, including manufacturing and procurement quotas, security requirements and criteria for importation. In addition, dispensing of Schedule II drugs is further restricted. For example, they may not be refilled without a new prescription.

 

While cannabis is a Schedule I controlled substance, products approved for medical use in the United States that contain cannabis or cannabis extracts should be placed in Schedules II-V, since approval by the FDA satisfies the “accepted medical use” requirement. If and when any of our product candidates receive FDA approval, the DEA will make a scheduling determination and place the product in a schedule other than Schedule I in order for it to be prescribed to patients in the United States. If approved by the FDA, we expect the finished dosage form of Epidiolex to be controlled in Schedule III or IV. Consequently, the manufacture, importation, exportation, domestic distribution, storage, sale and legitimate use will be subject to specific and potentially significant levels of regulation by the DEA. On November 25, 2015 the President of the United States signed a new law that (i) amends the CSA to require the DEA to issue an interim final scheduling rule within ninety days following FDA approval and the Secretary of Health and Human Services recommending that the Attorney General control the drug in Schedule II, III, IV or V, and (ii) amends the FDCA to ensure that companies do not lose exclusivity on newly approved drugs because of the DEA drug scheduling process. Insys Therapeutics Inc., a competitor who is developing products for the treatment of Dravet Syndrome and LGS (among other indications) which are based on CBD produced by a synthetic process, has already petitioned DEA to reschedule its synthetic CBD. Any DEA rescheduling action on the Insys petition might be limited to CBD produced by a synthetic process and thereby not apply to our product. If Insys succeeds with its petition before its product is approved by FDA, it will avoid the 90-day post-FDA approval rescheduling delay. Furthermore, if the FDA, DEA, or any foreign regulatory authority determines that Sativex or Epidiolex may have potential for abuse, it may require us to generate more clinical or other data than we currently anticipate to establish whether or to what extent the substance has an abuse potential, which could increase the cost and/or delay the launch of that product.

 

DEA registration and inspection of facilities.   Facilities conducting research, manufacturing, distributing, importing or exporting, or dispensing controlled substances must be registered (licensed) to perform these activities and have the security, control, recordkeeping, reporting and inventory mechanisms required by the DEA to prevent drug loss and diversion. All these facilities must renew their registrations annually, except dispensing facilities, which must renew every three years. The DEA conducts periodic inspections of certain registered establishments that handle controlled substances. Obtaining the necessary registrations may result in delay of the importation, manufacturing or distribution of Sativex and/or Epidiolex. Furthermore, failure to maintain compliance with the CSA, particularly non-compliance resulting in loss or diversion, can result in regulatory action that could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. The DEA may seek civil penalties, refuse to renew necessary registrations, or initiate proceedings to restrict, suspend or revoke those registrations. In certain circumstances, violations could lead to criminal proceedings.

 

State-controlled substances laws.   Individual states have also established controlled substance laws and regulations. Though state-controlled substances laws often mirror federal law, because the states are separate jurisdictions, they may separately schedule our product candidates as well. While some states automatically schedule a drug based on federal action, other states schedule drugs through rulemaking or a legislative action. State scheduling may delay commercial sale of any product for which we obtain federal regulatory approval and adverse scheduling could have a material adverse effect on the commercial attractiveness of such product. We or our partners must also obtain separate state registrations, permits or licenses in order to be able to obtain, handle, and distribute controlled substances for clinical trials or commercial sale, and failure to meet applicable regulatory requirements could lead to enforcement and sanctions by the states in addition to those from the DEA or otherwise arising under federal law.

 

  23  

 

  

Clinical trials.   Because Sativex and Epidiolex contain cannabis extracts, which are Schedule I substances, to conduct clinical trials with Sativex and Epidiolex in the United States prior to approval, each of our research sites must submit a research protocol to the DEA and obtain and maintain a DEA researcher registration that will allow those sites to handle and dispense Sativex and/or Epidiolex (as applicable) and to obtain the product from our importer. If the DEA delays or denies the grant of a research registration to one or more research sites, the clinical trial could be significantly delayed, and we could lose clinical trial sites. The importer for the clinical trials must also obtain a Schedule I importer registration and an import permit for each import. We do not currently conduct any manufacturing or repackaging/relabeling of either Sativex or its active ingredients (i.e., the cannabis extract) or Epidiolex or its active ingredient (purified CBD) in the United States. Sativex and Epidiolex are both imported in fully-finished, packaged and labeled dosage forms.

 

Importation.   If one of our product candidates is approved and classified as a Schedule II or III substance, an importer can import for commercial purposes if it obtains an importer registration and files an application for an import permit for each import. The DEA provides annual assessments/estimates to the International Narcotics Control Board which guides the DEA in the amounts of controlled substances that the DEA authorizes to be imported. The failure to identify an importer or obtain the necessary import authority, including specific quantities, could affect product availability and have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. In addition, an application for a Schedule II importer registration must be published in the Federal Register, and there is a waiting period for third party comments to be submitted. It is always possible a competitor could take this opportunity to make adverse comments that delay the grant of an importer registration.

 

If one of our product candidates is approved and classified as a Schedule II controlled substance, federal law may prohibit the import of the substance for commercial purposes. If a product is listed as a Schedule II substance, we will not be allowed to import that drug for commercial purposes unless the DEA determines that domestic supplies are inadequate or there is inadequate domestic competition among domestic manufacturers for the substance as defined by the DEA. It is always possible the DEA could find that the active substance in a product, even if it is a plant derived substance, could be manufactured in the US. Moreover, Schedule I controlled substances, including BDSs, have never been registered with the DEA for importation commercial purposes, only for scientific and research needs. Therefore, if neither Sativex nor its BDSs, nor Epidiolex or its purified BDS could be imported, that product would have to be wholly manufactured in the United States, and we would need to secure a manufacturer that would be required to obtain and maintain a separate DEA registration for that activity.

 

Manufacture in the United States.   If, because of a Schedule II classification or voluntarily, we were to conduct manufacturing or repackaging/relabeling in the United States, our contract manufacturers would be subject to the DEA’s annual manufacturing and procurement quota requirements. Additionally, regardless of the scheduling of Sativex and Epidiolex, cannabis and the BDSs comprising the active ingredient in the final dosage form are currently Schedule I controlled substances and would be subject to such quotas as these substances could remain listed on Schedule I. The annual quota allocated to us or our contract manufacturers for the active ingredients in our products may not be sufficient to complete clinical trials or meet commercial demand. Consequently, any delay or refusal by the DEA in establishing our, or our contract manufacturers’, procurement and/or production quota for controlled substances could delay or stop our clinical trials or product launches, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial position and operations.

 

Distribution in the United States.   If any of our product candidates is scheduled as Schedule II or III, we would also need to identify wholesale distributors with the appropriate DEA and state registrations and authority to distribute the product to pharmacies and other health care providers. We would need to identify distributors to distribute the product to pharmacies; these distributors would need to obtain Schedule II or III distribution registrations. The failure to obtain, or delay in obtaining, or the loss any of those registrations could result in increased costs to us. If any of our product candidates is a Schedule II drug, pharmacies would have to maintain enhanced security with alarms and monitoring systems and they must adhere to recordkeeping and inventory requirements. This may discourage some pharmacies from carrying either or both of these products. Furthermore, state and federal enforcement actions, regulatory requirements, and legislation intended to reduce prescription drug abuse, such as the requirement that physicians consult a state prescription drug monitoring program may make physicians less willing to prescribe, and pharmacies to dispense, Schedule II products.

 

The approval and use of medical and recreational marijuana in various U.S. states may impact our business.

 

There is a substantial amount of change occurring in various states of the United States regarding the use of medical and recreational marijuana. While marijuana is a Schedule I substance as defined under federal law, and its possession and use is not permitted according to federal law, a number of individual states have enacted state laws to enable possession and use of marijuana for medical purposes, and in some states for recreational purposes also. Our business is quite distinct from that of crude herbal marijuana, however, our prospects may be impacted by developments of these laws at the state level in the United States.

 

Risks Related to Ownership of our American Depositary Shares (ADSs)

 

The liquidity of our ADSs may have an adverse effect on share price .

 

As at September 30, 2016, we had 302,093,139 ordinary shares outstanding. Of these ordinary shares, 226,162,356 were held as ADSs and 75,930,783 were held as ordinary shares outside the ADS facility. In connection with our May 2013 initial public offering, or IPO, of ADSs on the NASDAQ Global Market, we issued 3,678,000 ADSs. In January 2014 we issued an additional 2,807,275 ADSs in a public offering on the NASDAQ Global Market. In June 2014 we issued an additional 1,455,000 ADSs and certain selling shareholders sold an additional 500,000 ADSs in a public offering on the NASDAQ Global Market. In May 2015 we issued an additional 1,840,000 ADSs in a public offering on the NASDAQ Global Market. In July 2016 we issued an additional 3,220,000 ADSs in a public offering on the NASDAQ Global Market. There is a risk that there may not be sufficient liquidity in the market to accommodate significant increases in selling activity or the sale of a large block of our securities. Our ADSs have historically had limited trading volume, which may also result in volatility.

 

  24  

 

  

Additionally, as at September 30, 2016 our ADSs were traded on NASDAQ and our ordinary shares are traded on AIM. On August 16, 2016, London Stock Exchange plc agreed that we could cancel the admission of our ordinary shares to trading on AIM without needing to seek the consent of shareholders. On October 19, 2016 we published a circular to our shareholders notifying them of our intention to cancel the admission of our ordinary shares to trading on AIM on December 5, 2016, and on December 5, 2016 the admission of the Company’s ordinary shares to trading on AIM was cancelled. The last day of dealing in the Company’s ordinary shares on AIM was December 2, 2016. We cannot predict the effect that such cancellation will have on the market price of the ADSs (if any) and it may have an adverse effect on the market price of the ADSs.

 

The market price of our ADSs may be volatile.

 

Many factors may have a material adverse effect on the market price of the ADSs, including, but not limited to:

 

the loss of any of our key scientific or management personnel;

 

  announcements of the failure to obtain regulatory approvals or receipt of a complete response letter from the FDA;

 

  announcements of restricted label indications or patient populations, or changes or delays in regulatory review processes;

 

  announcements of therapeutic innovations or new products by us or our competitors;

 

  adverse actions taken by regulatory agencies with respect to our clinical trials, manufacturing supply chain or sales and marketing activities;

 

  changes or developments in laws or regulations applicable to Sativex, Epidiolex and our product candidates;

 

  any adverse changes to our relationship with licensors, manufacturers or suppliers;

 

  the failure of our testing and clinical trials;

 

  the failure to retain our existing, or obtain new, collaboration partners;

 

  announcements concerning our competitors or the pharmaceutical industry in general;

 

  the achievement of expected product sales and profitability;

 

  the failure to obtain reimbursements for our products or price reductions;

 

  manufacture, supply or distribution shortages;

 

  actual or anticipated fluctuations in our operating results;

 

  our cash position;

 

  changes in financial estimates or recommendations by securities analysts;

 

  potential acquisitions;

 

  the trading volume of ADSs on NASDAQ;

 

  sales of our ADSs or ordinary shares by us, our executive officers and directors or our shareholders in the future;

 

  the impact on the financial markets or otherwise of the expected withdrawal of the United Kingdom from the European Union;

 

  general economic and market conditions and overall fluctuations in the United States equity markets; and

 

  changes in accounting principles.

 

  25  

 

  

In addition, the stock market in general, and NASDAQ in particular, have experienced extreme price and volume fluctuations that have often been unrelated or disproportionate to the operating performance of individual companies. Broad market and industry factors may negatively affect the market price of our ADSs, regardless of our actual operating performance.

 

In the past, following periods of volatility in the market price of a company’s securities, securities class-action litigation often has been instituted against that company. In January 2016, a shareholder-initiated class action lawsuit was filed against us. While this lawsuit has been dismissed, similar litigation if initiated against us in the future, could cause us to incur substantial costs to defend such claims and divert management’s attention and resources, which could seriously harm our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects.

 

Our largest shareholder owns a significant percentage of the share capital and voting rights of GW.

 

As of September 30, 2016, Capital Research and Management Company held approximately 15.01% of our issued share capital, accounting for approximately 15.01% of the voting rights of the Company. To the extent Capital Research and Management Company continues to hold a large percentage of our share capital and voting rights, it will remain in a position to exert greater influence in the appointment of the directors and officers of GW and in other corporate actions that require shareholders’ approval.

 

Substantial future sales of our ADSs in the public market, or the perception that these sales could occur, could cause the price of the ADSs to decline.

 

Sales of our ADSs in the public market, or the perception that these sales could occur, could cause the market price of the ADSs to decline. The ordinary shares held by our directors, including our officers, are available for sale in the form of ADSs and are not subject to contractual and legal restrictions on resale. If any of our large shareholders or members of our management team seek to sell substantial amounts of our ADSs, particularly if these sales are in a rapid or disorderly manner, or other investors perceive that these sales could occur, the market price of our ADSs could decrease significantly.

 

As a foreign private issuer, we are not subject to certain NASDAQ Global Market corporate governance rules applicable to U.S. listed companies and are subject to reporting obligations that are different and less frequent than those of a U.S. listed company. As a result, investors in our securities may not have the same protections afforded to shareholders of companies that are not foreign private issuers.

 

We rely on a provision in NASDAQ’s Global Market Listed Company Manual that allows us to follow English corporate law and the Companies Act 2006 with regard to certain aspects of corporate governance. This allows us to follow certain corporate governance practices that differ in significant respects from the corporate governance requirements applicable to U.S. companies listed on the NASDAQ Global Market.

 

For example, we are exempt from NASDAQ Global Market regulations that require a U.S. listed company to:

 

  have a majority of the board of directors consist of independent directors;

 

  require non-management directors to meet on a regular basis without management present;

 

  promptly disclose any waivers of the code for directors or executive officers that should address certain specified items;

 

  have an independent nominating committee;

 

  have a compensation committee charter specifying the items enumerated in NASDAQ Stock Market, Marketplace Rule 5605(d)(1) and a review and assessment of the adequacy of that charter on an annual basis;

 

  solicit proxies and provide proxy statements for all shareholder meetings; and

 

  seek shareholder approval for the implementation of certain equity compensation plans and issuances of ordinary shares.

 

As a foreign private issuer, we are permitted to, and we will continue to, follow home country practice in lieu of the above requirements.

 

Because we qualify and report as a foreign private issuer under the Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), we are exempt from certain provisions of the Exchange Act that are applicable to U.S. public companies, including (i) the sections of the Exchange Act regulating the solicitation of proxies, consents or authorizations in respect of a security registered under the Exchange Act, (ii) the sections of the Exchange Act requiring insiders to file public reports of their stock ownership and trading activities and liability for insiders who profit from trades made in a short period of time, and (iii) the rules under the Exchange Act requiring the filing with the Securities and Exchange Commission of quarterly reports on Form 10-Q containing unaudited financial and other specified information, or current reports on Form 8-K, upon the occurrence of specified significant events. We intend to continue to furnish quarterly reports to the Securities and Exchange Commission on Form 6-K for so long as we are subject to the reporting requirements of Section 13(g) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act, although the information we furnish may not be the same as the information that is required in quarterly reports on Form 10-Q for U.S. domestic issuers. In addition, while U.S. domestic issuers that are large accelerated filers are required to file their annual reports on Form 10-K within 60 days after the end of each fiscal year foreign private issuers are not required to file their annual report on Form 20-F until 120 days after the end of each fiscal year. Foreign private issuers are also exempt from Regulation Fair Disclosure, aimed at preventing issuers from making selective disclosures of material information. Although we intend to make quarterly financial reports available to our shareholders in a timely manner, investors in our securities may not have the same protections afforded to shareholders of companies that are not foreign private issuers.

 

  26  

 

  

Because we are listed on the NASDAQ Global Market, our Audit Committee is required to comply with the provisions of Section 301 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, or the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, and Rule 10A-3 of the Exchange Act, both of which are also applicable to NASDAQ Global Market-listed U.S. companies. Because we are a foreign private issuer, however, our Audit Committee is not subject to additional NASDAQ Global Market requirements applicable to U.S. listed companies, including an affirmative determination that all members of the Audit Committee are “independent,” using more stringent criteria than those applicable to us as a foreign private issuer.

 

We may lose our foreign private issuer status in the future, which could result in significant additional costs and expenses.

 

We are a “foreign private issuer,” as such term is defined in Rule 405 under the Securities Act of 1933 as amended (the “Securities Act”), and therefore we are not required to comply with all the periodic disclosure and current reporting requirements of the Exchange Act and related rules and regulations. Under Rule 405, the determination of foreign private issuer status is made annually on the last business day of an issuer’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter and, accordingly, the next determination will be made with respect to us on March 31, 2017.

 

In the future, we would lose our foreign private issuer status if a majority of our ordinary shares (including those represented by ADSs) are owned by U.S. shareholders and a majority of our shareholders, directors or management are U.S. citizens or residents and we fail to meet additional requirements necessary to avoid loss of foreign private issuer status. The regulatory and compliance costs to us under applicable U.S. securities laws as a U.S. domestic issuer may be significantly higher than our current regulatory and compliance costs. If we are not a foreign private issuer, we will be required to file periodic reports and registration statements on U.S. domestic issuer forms with the SEC, which are more detailed and extensive than the forms available to a foreign private issuer. For example, the annual report on Form 10-K requires domestic issuers to disclose executive compensation information on an individual basis with specific disclosure regarding the domestic compensation philosophy, objectives, annual total compensation (base salary, bonus, equity compensation) and potential payments in connection with change in control, retirement, death or disability, while the annual report on Form 20-F permits foreign private issuers to disclose compensation information on an aggregate basis. We will also have to report our results under U.S. Generally Accepted Accounting Principles, rather than under International Financial Reporting Standards, as a domestic registrant. We will have to restate our previously-reported financial statements under U.S. Generally Accepted Accounting Principles. We will also have to mandatorily comply with U.S. federal proxy requirements, and our officers, directors and principal shareholders will become subject to the short-swing profit disclosure and recovery provisions of Section 16 of the Exchange Act. We may also be required to modify certain of our policies to comply with corporate governance practices required for U.S. domestic issuers. Such conversion and modifications will involve additional costs. In addition, we may lose our ability to rely upon exemptions from certain corporate governance requirements of the NASDAQ Global Market that are available to foreign private issuers.

 

We incur significant increased costs as a result of operating as a company whose ADSs are publicly traded in the United States, and our management is required to devote substantial time to new compliance initiatives.

 

As a company whose ADSs commenced trading in the United States in May 2013, we incur significant legal, accounting, insurance and other expenses that we did not previously incur. In addition, the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act and related rules implemented by the SEC and NASDAQ Global Market have imposed various requirements on public companies including requiring establishment and maintenance of effective disclosure and financial controls. We are required to comply with Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, which involves considerable management time and expenses. Our management and other personnel need to devote a substantial amount of time to these compliance initiatives. Moreover, these rules and regulations increase our legal and financial compliance costs, relative to companies that are listed solely in the United Kingdom, and make some activities more time-consuming and costly. We estimate that our annual compliance expenses will be approximately £1.5 million in each of the next two fiscal years. These rules and regulations have also made it more difficult and more expensive for us to obtain director and officer liability insurance, and we may be required to incur substantial costs to maintain the same or similar coverage. These laws and regulations could also make it more difficult and expensive for us to attract and retain qualified persons to serve on our board of directors, our board committees or as our executive officers. Furthermore, if we are unable to satisfy our obligations as a public company, we could be subject to delisting of the ADSs, fines, sanctions and other regulatory action and potentially civil litigation.

 

U.S. investors may have difficulty enforcing civil liabilities against our Company, our directors or members of senior management and the experts named in this Annual Report on Form 20-F.

 

Except for Justin Gover, Julian Gangolli, and Cabot Brown, our directors and the experts named in this Annual Report on Form 20-F are non-residents of the United States, and all or a substantial portion of the assets of such persons are located outside the United States. As a result, it may not be possible to serve process on such persons or us in the United States or to enforce judgments obtained in U.S. courts against them or us based on civil liability provisions of the securities laws of the United States. Mayer Brown International LLP, our English solicitors, advised us that there is doubt as to whether English courts would enforce certain civil liabilities under U.S. securities laws in original actions or judgments of U.S. courts based upon these civil liability provisions. In addition, awards of punitive damages in actions brought in the United States or elsewhere may be unenforceable in the United Kingdom. An award for monetary damages under the U.S. securities laws would be considered punitive if it does not seek to compensate the claimant for loss or damage suffered and is intended to punish the defendant. The enforceability of any judgment in the United Kingdom will depend on the particular facts of the case as well as the laws and treaties in effect at the time. The United States and the United Kingdom do not currently have a treaty providing for recognition and enforcement of judgments (other than arbitration awards) in civil and commercial matters.

 

  27  

 

  

The rights of our shareholders may differ from the rights typically offered to shareholders of a U.S. corporation.

 

We are incorporated under English law. The rights of holders of ordinary shares, and therefore certain of the rights of holders of ADSs, are governed by English law, including the provisions of the Companies Act 2006, and by our Articles. These rights differ in certain respects from the rights of shareholders in typical U.S. corporations. See “Description of Share Capital — Differences in Corporate Law” in our Registration Statement on Form F-3 (File No. 333-195747), filed with the SEC on May 7, 2014 and which is incorporated by reference into this document for a description of the principal differences between the provisions of the Companies Act 2006 applicable to us and, for example, the Delaware General Corporation Law relating to shareholders’ rights and protections.

 

We may be classified as a passive foreign investment company, or a PFIC, in any taxable year and U.S. holders of our ordinary shares could be subject to adverse U.S. federal income tax consequences.

 

The rules governing passive foreign investment companies, or PFICs, can have adverse effects for U.S. federal income tax purposes. The tests for determining PFIC status for a taxable year depend upon the relative values of certain categories of assets and the relative amounts of certain kinds of income. The determination of whether we are a PFIC depends on the particular facts and circumstances (such as the valuation of our assets, including goodwill and other intangible assets) and may also be affected by the application of the PFIC rules, which are subject to differing interpretations. Based on our estimated gross income, the average value of our assets, including goodwill and the nature of our active business, we do not believe that we were classified as a PFIC for U.S. federal income tax purposes for our taxable year ended September 30, 2016.

 

If we are a PFIC, U.S. holders of our ordinary shares would be subject to adverse U.S. federal income tax consequences, such as ineligibility for any preferred tax rates on capital gains or on actual or deemed dividends, interest charges on certain taxes treated as deferred, and additional reporting requirements under U.S. federal income tax laws and regulations. A U.S. holder of our ordinary shares may be able to mitigate some of the adverse U.S. federal income tax consequences described above with respect to owning the ordinary shares if we are classified as a PFIC, provided that such U.S. investor is eligible to make, and validly makes, a “mark-to-market” election. In certain circumstances a U.S. Holder can make a “qualified electing fund” election to mitigate some of the adverse tax consequences described with respect to an ownership interest in a PFIC by including in income its share of the PFIC’s income on a current basis. However, we do not currently intend to prepare or provide the information that would enable a U.S. Holder to make a qualified electing fund election.

 

Investors should consult their own tax advisors regarding all aspects of the application of the PFIC rules to our ordinary shares. For more information related to classification as a PFIC, see “Taxation — U.S. Federal Income Taxation — Passive Foreign Investment Company.”

 

  28  

 

  

Item 4 Information on the Company.

 

A. History and Development of the Company

 

GW Pharmaceuticals plc was founded in 1998 and is a public limited company incorporated under the laws of England and Wales. Our ordinary shares were admitted to trading on the Alternative Investment Market, or AIM, a market operated by London Stock Exchange plc, under the symbol GWP on June 28, 2001. The admission of our ordinary shares to trading on AIM was cancelled with effect from 7.00am on December 5, 2016. On May 1, 2013, we completed our initial public offering of American Depositary Shares, or ADSs, on the NASDAQ Global Market. Our ADSs are traded under the symbol GWPH.

 

Our registered and principal executive offices are located at Sovereign House, Vision Park, Chivers Way, Histon, Cambridge, CB24 9BZ, United Kingdom, our general telephone number is (44) 1223 266-800 and our internet address is http://www.gwpharm.com. Our website and the information contained on or accessible through our website are not part of this document. Our agent for service of process in the United States is CT Corporation, 111 Eighth Avenue, 13th Floor, New York, NY 10011.

 

B. Business

 

Overview

 

We are a biopharmaceutical company focused on discovering, developing and commercializing novel therapeutics from our proprietary cannabinoid product platform in a broad range of disease areas. In our 18 years of operations, we have established a world leading position in the development of plant-derived cannabinoid therapeutics through our proven drug discovery and development processes, our intellectual property portfolio and our regulatory and manufacturing expertise. Our lead cannabinoid product candidate is Epidiolex, a liquid formulation of pure plant-derived cannabidiol, or CBD, for which we retain global commercial rights, and which is in development for a number of rare childhood-onset epilepsy disorders. We received Orphan Drug Designation from the U.S. Food and Drug Administration, or FDA, for Epidiolex for the treatment of Dravet syndrome, Lennox-Gastaut syndrome, or LGS, Tuberous Sclerosis Complex, or TSC, and Infantile Spasms, or IS, each of which are severe infantile-onset, drug-resistant epilepsy syndromes. Additionally, we have received Fast Track Designation from the FDA and Orphan Designation from the European Medicines Agency, or EMA, for Epidiolex for the treatment of Dravet syndrome. In March 2016, we reported positive results from the first pivotal Phase 3 trial of Epidiolex in Dravet syndrome. In June 2016, we reported positive results from the first pivotal Phase 3 trial of Epidiolex in LGS. In July 2016, we held a positive pre-NDA meeting with the FDA to discuss pre-clinical and clinical aspects of the proposed New Drug Application, or NDA, for Epidiolex. In November, we held a positive CMC pre-NDA meeting. We expect to submit a NDA to the FDA at the end of the first half of 2017 for Epidiolex in both Dravet syndrome and LGS. We are also building an experienced commercial team in the United States in preparation for the potential future launch of Epidiolex.

 

We have a deep pipeline of additional cannabinoid product candidates with an increasing focus on orphan pediatric neurologic conditions. Our pipeline includes cannabidivarin, or CBDV, which is in Phase 2 development in the field of epilepsy and is also being researched within the field of autism spectrum disorders, or ASD. In addition, we have received Orphan Drug Designation and Fast Track Designation from the FDA for intravenous CBD for the treatment of Neonatal Hypoxic Ischemic Encepholapthy, or NHIE, which entered Phase 1 development in the fourth quarter of 2016.

 

  29  

 

   

Our Product and Product Candidates

 

GW Product Pipeline Summary

 

Epilepsy and Pediatric Neurology

 

Product/Product

Candidates

  Indication   Partner(s)   Status   Expected Next Steps
Epidiolex (CBD)  

Childhood-onset epilepsy

 

Initial targets: Dravet syndrome and LGS Follow-up target: TSC

  We retain global rights.   Positive results in Phase 3 trials in Dravet syndrome and LGS.  Pre-NDA meetings held with FDA. NDA submission preparation underway for Dravet syndrome and LGS.  

NDA submission expected at the end of the first half of 2017. Data from second Phase 3 Dravet syndrome trial expected in 2017.

 

            Phase 3 trial in TSC underway.   Data from Phase 3 TSC trial expected the first half of 2018.
   

 IS

 

       Two-part Phase 3 trial in IS commenced in Q4 2016.    
GWP42006 (CBDV)  

Epilepsy

 

ASD

 

 

We retain global rights

 

 

Phase 2 trial ongoing in adults with focal seizures.

 

Phase 2 trials planned within field of ASD. FDA orphan designation in Rett syndrome.

 

Phase 2 data expected mid 2017.

 

Phase 2 trials within field of ASD expected to commence the third quarter of 2017.

 

Intravenous GWP42003   Neonatal Hypoxic-Ischemic Encephalopathy   We retain global rights   Pre-clinical. FDA orphan and fast track designation.  Phase 1 trial commenced in the fourth quarter of 2016.   Phase 1 data expected in 2017.

 

Other Orphan Product Candidates

 

Product/Product
Candidates
  Indication   Partner(s)   Status   Expected Next Steps
Combination of GWP42002 and GWP42003   Glioma   We retain global rights   Phase 2a trial complete. FDA orphan designation.   Phase 2a data expected in Q1 2017

 

Other Pipeline Product Candidates

 

Product/Product

Candidates

  Indication   Partner(s)   Status   Expected Next Steps
GWP42003   Schizophrenia   We retain global rights   Positive Phase 2 proof-of-concept.   Data under review for next steps.
Sativex (nabiximols)  

MS spasticity

 

Cerebral Palsy spasticity

 

Otsuka, Almirall, Novartis, Bayer, Neopharm and Ipsen. 

 

Approved in 30 countries (excluding the United States) 

 

Phase 2 trial complete

 

 

 

Phase 2 data expected Q1 2017.

 

Epidiolex® for Orphan Childhood-onset Epilepsy

 

Our lead cannabinoid product candidate is Epidiolex, a liquid formulation of pure plant-derived CBD, which is in development for the treatment of a number of rare childhood-onset epilepsy disorders. Several features of the pharmacology of certain cannabinoids suggest that they may be candidates for investigation as anti-epileptic drugs, or AEDs. We have been conducting pre-clinical research of CBD in epilepsy since 2007, primarily in collaboration with the University of Reading in the United Kingdom. This research has shown that CBD has significant anti-epileptiform and anticonvulsant activity using a variety of in vitro and in vivo models and that it has the ability to treat seizures in acute animal models of epilepsy with significantly fewer side effects than existing AEDs.

 

  30  

 

  

Many cases of epilepsy are able to be classified and have clearly defined natural histories providing important information on the likelihood of seizure control and chance of remission. Some of the rarer electroclinical syndromes have very poor responses to treatment and negligible remission rates such as Ohtahara in neonates, Dravet syndrome in infants, LGS in young children and progressive myoclonic epilepsies in adolescence. An electroclinical syndrome is a complex of clinical features, signs and symptoms that together define a distinctive, recognizable clinical disorder,

 

Our strategy for the development of Epidiolex within the field of childhood-onset epilepsy is to initially concentrate formal development efforts on four orphan indications: Dravet Syndrome, LGS, TSC and IS. We have to date received Orphan Drug Designation from the FDA for Epidiolex for the treatment of Dravet syndrome, LGS, TSC and IS. Additionally, we have received Fast Track Designation from the FDA and Orphan Designation from the EMA for Epidiolex for the treatment of Dravet syndrome. We expect to further expand the potential market opportunity of Epidiolex by targeting additional orphan seizure disorders.

 

Epilepsy Market Overview

 

Epilepsy afflicts between 1.3 million to 2.8 million adults and children in the United States according to the Epilepsy Foundation. The Epilepsy Foundation believes its most accurate estimate is 2.2 million people, or 7.1 for every 1,000 people. According to Kwan and Brodie in the February 2000 edition of the New England Journal of Medicine, 36 percent of patients with epilepsy were pharmacoresistant. Of the patients in the study, 47 percent became seizure-free during treatment with their first AED, 13 percent became seizure-free during treatment with a second AED as a monotherapy, and 4 percent became seizure-free with a third AED or treatment with multiple AEDs. The remaining 36 percent of patients were classified by the authors as having pharmacoresistant epilepsy. Furthermore it is recognized that some of those that do find relief often suffer side effects severe enough with their current medication that an alternative or adjunct treatment is often sought. The costs of uncontrolled epilepsy are significant, with direct and indirect costs associated with epilepsy totaling more than $15 billion per year. It is estimated that 50,000 epilepsy related deaths occur each year, more than breast cancer deaths annually.

 

According to Russ et al. in the February 2012 edition of Pediatrics, there are 466,000 childhood epilepsy patients in the United States and 765,000 patients in Europe, of which 30 percent, or about 140,000 patients in the United States and about 230,000 in Europe, are deemed medically intractable or pharmacoresistant.

 

Dravet Syndrome

 

Dravet syndrome is a severe infantile-onset, genetic, drug-resistant epilepsy syndrome with a distinctive but complex electroclinical presentation. Onset of Dravet syndrome occurs during the first year of life with clonic seizures (jerking) and tonic-clonic (convulsive) seizures in previously healthy and developmentally normal infants. Symptoms peak at about five months of age, and the latest onset beginning by 15 months of age. Other seizures develop between one and four years of age such as prolonged focal dyscognitive seizures and brief absence seizures, and duration of these seizures decreases during this period, but their frequency increases. Prognosis is poor and approximately 14 percent of children die during a seizure, because of infection due, for example, to prolonged periods of physical inactivity, the presence of advanced neurodegenerative disease or a compromised level of consciousness requiring a feeding tube, or suddenly due to uncertain causes, often because of the relentless neurological decline or from Sudden Unexpected Death in Epilepsy. Patients develop intellectual disability and life-long ongoing seizures. Intellectual impairment varies from severe in 50 percent of patients, to moderate and mild intellectual disability each accounting for 25 percent of cases. Patients may rarely return to normal intellect.

 

According to Forsgren L. et al. in the 2004 edition of Epilepsy in Children, the incidence of epilepsy in the first year of life is 1.5 per 1,000 people, or, by our estimate, 6,450 new epilepsies per year worldwide. According to Dravet et al. in the 2012 edition of Epileptic Syndromes in Infancy, Childhood and Adolescence, up to 5 percent of epilepsies diagnosed in the first year of life are Dravet syndrome, equating to 320 new cases per year in the United States with a mortality rate that studies have shown may be as high as 15 percent in the first 20 years of life. By our estimate, there are approximately 5,440 patients with Dravet syndrome in the United States under the age of 20 years. Applying the same assumptions in Europe, we believe there are an estimated 6,710 Dravet syndrome patients in the European Union under the age of 20 years.

 

A large percentage of cases of Dravet syndrome have a family history for epilepsy or convulsions. Heterozygous de novo mutations of the alpha 1 (α-1) subunit of the SCN1A gene, which encodes a voltage-gated sodium channel, are the major cause of Dravet syndrome and are found in approximately 75 percent – 80 percent of patients and more than 500 SCN1A mutations have been reported to be associated with this disorder. There are currently no FDA-approved treatments specifically indicated for Dravet syndrome. The standard of care usually involves a combination of the following anticonvulsants: clobazam, clonazepam, leviteracetam, topirimate, valproic acid, ethosuximide or zonisamide. Stiripentol is approved in Europe for the treatment of Dravet syndrome in conjunction with clobazam and valproate. In the United States, stiripentol was granted an Orphan Drug Designation for the treatment of Dravet syndrome in 2008; however, the drug is not FDA approved. Potent sodium channel blockers used to treat epilepsy actually increase seizure frequency in patients with Dravet syndrome. The most common are phenytoin, carbamazepine, lamotrigine and rufinamide. Management of this disease may also include a ketogenic diet, and physical and communication therapy. In addition to anti-convulsive drugs, many patients with Dravet syndrome are treated with anti-psychotic drugs, stimulants and drugs to treat insomnia.

 

Dravet Syndrome Phase 3 Clinical Program

 

We held a pre-Investigational New Drug, or IND, meeting with the FDA in February 2014 to discuss the investigational plan for Epidiolex in Dravet syndrome, following which we opened a commercial IND in May 2014. In October 2014, we commenced a Phase 2/3 trial designed as a two-part randomized double-blind, placebo-controlled parallel group dose escalation, safety, tolerability, pharmacokinetic and efficacy trial of single and multiple doses of Epidiolex to treat Dravet syndrome in children who are being treated with other AEDs. Part One was completed in February 2015, and included pharmacokinetic and dose-finding data elements in a total of 34 patients over a 3 week treatment period.

 

  31  

 

  

Following a review of the Part One data by an independent panel, Part Two (Phase 3) of the trial commenced in March 2015, and was a placebo-controlled safety and efficacy evaluation of Epidiolex (at a dose of 20mg/kg per day) over a 3-month treatment period.

 

This Phase 3 trial randomized 120 patients into two arms, Epidiolex 20mg/kg/day (n=61) and placebo (n=59). Epidiolex or placebo was added to current AED treatment regimens. On average, patients were taking approximately three AEDs, having previously tried and failed an average of more than four other AEDs. The average age of trial participants was ten years and 30 percent of patients were younger than six years of age. The median baseline convulsive seizure frequency per month was 13.

 

The primary efficacy endpoint was a comparison between Epidiolex and placebo measuring the percentage change in the monthly frequency of convulsive seizures during the 14-week treatment period compared with the 4-week baseline observation period. In this trial, patients taking Epidiolex achieved a median reduction in monthly convulsive seizures of 39 percent compared with a reduction on placebo of 13 percent, which was highly statistically significant (p=0.012). A series of sensitivity analyses of the primary endpoint confirmed the robustness of this result. The difference between Epidiolex and placebo emerged during the first month of treatment and was sustained during the entire treatment period. Results from secondary efficacy endpoints reinforced the overall effectiveness observed with Epidiolex.

 

Additional secondary efficacy endpoint data from this Phase 3 pivotal trial in Dravet syndrome were presented in a poster at the 70 th Annual Meeting of the American Epilepsy Society in December 2016 which included the following:

 

In the 12-week maintenance period (not including the dose escalation period), Epidiolex treatment effect increased further, achieving a median reduction in monthly convulsive seizures of 41 percent compared with a reduction on placebo of 16 percent, which was highly statistically significant (p=0.0052). Three CBD patients achieved total seizure freedom during the entire treatment period, with one additional CBD patient achieving convulsive seizure freedom during the entire maintenance period. No placebo patients experienced seizure freedom.
Caregivers of patients on Epidiolex were significantly more likely to report an improvement in overall condition on the Caregiver Global Impression of Change (CGIC) (p=0.0155).
During the treatment period, patients taking Epidiolex achieved a median reduction in monthly total seizures of 29 percent compared with a reduction of 9 percent in patients receiving placebo, which was statistically significant (p=0.0335). When looking at the 12-week maintenance period, Epidiolex treatment effect increased further, achieving a median reduction in monthly convulsive seizures of 37 percent compared with a reduction on placebo of 10 percent, which was statistically significant (p=0.0234).
A consistent separation between Epidiolex and placebo across all response rates. At the 50 percent seizure reduction threshold, the separation between Epidiolex and placebo approached statistical significance (p=0.0784).

 

Epidiolex was generally well tolerated in this trial. The most common adverse events (occurring in greater than 10 percent of Epidiolex-treated patients) were: somnolence, diarrhea, decreased appetite, fatigue, pyrexia, vomiting, lethargy, upper respiratory tract infection and convulsion. Of those patients on Epidiolex that reported an adverse event, 84 percent reported it to be mild or moderate. Ten patients on Epidiolex experienced a serious adverse event compared with three patients on placebo. There was no difference in episodes of status epilepticus between Epidiolex and placebo. Eight patients on Epidiolex discontinued treatment due to adverse events compared with one patient on placebo. Increases in ALT or AST (levels >3× ULN) occurred in 12 patients on Epidiolex and 1 placebo patient; all patients were on concomitant Valproic Acid. There is a set of accepted criteria for identifying whether these transient elevations of liver enzymes are a signal for serious toxicity. These criteria are known as Hy’s law. No patients met these criteria for drug-induced liver injury. All elevations resolved to lower than 3x ULN.

 

We are working with the investigators in this trial on a manuscript for peer-review publication. We expect this paper will be published in the first half of 2017.

 

In addition to this first Phase 3 trial, we are conducting a second Phase 3 trial of Epidiolex in Dravet syndrome which is expected to recruit 180 patients. This placebo-controlled trial differs from the first Phase 3 trial in that it includes two Epidiolex dose arms, at 20mg/kg per day and at 10 mg/kg per day. We continue to work to enroll this trial and expect to report results from the trial in 2017. Each of these trials will be the largest known controlled trials in Dravet syndrome.

 

Lennox-Gastaut Syndrome

 

LGS is a type of epilepsy with multiple types of seizures, particularly tonic (stiffening) and atonic (drop) seizures. According to Trevathan et al. in the December 1997 edition of Epilepsia, the estimated prevalence of LGS is between 3 percent and 4 percent of childhood epilepsy with the cause of the disorder unknown in 1 out of 4 children. LGS affects between 14,500 – 18,500 children under the age of 18 years in the United States and over 30,000 children and adults in the United States. Eighty percent of children with LGS continue to experience seizures, psychiatric, and behavioral deficits in adulthood. Seizures due to LGS are hard to control and they generally require life-long treatment as LGS usually persists into the adult years. Historically patients with LGS have had few effective treatment options. Intellectual and behavioral problems associated with LGS are common and add to the complexity of this syndrome and the difficulties in managing life with LGS.

 

Drug resistance is one of the main features of LGS. Generally, treatment often requires broad spectrum AEDs and/or polypharmacy. Treatment will also depend on the seizure type as some treatments that are effective for one type of seizure may worsen another. The FDA approved treatments for LGS are: Onfi (clobazam); Banzel (rufinamide); Lamictal (lamotrigine); Topamax (topirimate); and Felbatol (felbamate). These medicines are often used as adjunctive therapy with existing medications. When used with other particular AEDs, the FDA approved treatments for LGS show a level of efficacy, however, many also have severe undesirable side effects. Furthermore, several of these medicines are based on the same mechanism of action as traditional AEDs. As patients with LGS generally need to take several treatments to gain any change to their seizure frequency, we believe that there is a need for further pharmacological treatments, particularly those with a different mechanism of action, to give prescribers more options in treating this rare, pharmacoresistant syndrome.

 

  32  

 

  

LGS Phase 3 Clinical Program

 

In April 2015, we commenced a Phase 3, randomized, double-blind placebo-controlled trial to evaluate the safety and efficacy of Epidiolex for the treatment of LGS in patients who are being treated with other AEDs. Patients aged two to 55 years with a confirmed diagnosis of drug-resistant LGS currently uncontrolled on one or more concomitant AEDs were eligible to participate in this trial. The trial randomized 171 patients into two arms, where Epidiolex 20mg/kg/day (n=86) or placebo (n=85) was added to current AED treatment. On average, patients were taking approximately 3 AEDs, having previously tried and failed an average of 6 other AEDs. The average age of trial participants was 15 years (34 percent were 18 years of age or older). The median baseline drop seizure frequency per month was 74.

 

The primary efficacy endpoint of this trial was a comparison between Epidiolex and placebo in the percentage change in the monthly frequency of drop seizures during the 14 week treatment period (2 week dose escalation period followed by 12 weeks of maintenance) compared to the 4 week baseline period before randomization. Drop seizures were defined as atonic, tonic and tonic-clonic seizures involving the entire body, trunk or head that led or could have led to a fall, injury, slumping in a chair or hitting the patient’s head on a surface. During the treatment period, patients taking Epidiolex achieved a median reduction in monthly drop seizures of 44 percent compared with a reduction of 22 percent in patients receiving placebo, and the difference between treatments was statistically significant (p=0.0135). A series of sensitivity analyses of the primary endpoint confirmed the robustness of this result. The difference between Epidiolex and placebo emerged during the first month of treatment and was sustained during the entire treatment period. The results from secondary efficacy endpoints reinforced the overall effectiveness observed with Epidiolex.

 

Additional secondary efficacy endpoint data from this Phase 3 pivotal trial in LGS were presented in a poster at the 70 th Annual Meeting of the American Epilepsy Society in December 2016 which included the following:

 

In the 12-week maintenance period (not including the dose escalation period), Epidiolex treatment effect increased further, achieving a median reduction in monthly drop seizures of 49 percent compared with a reduction on placebo of 20 percent, which was highly statistically significant (p=0.0096).
No patients in either treatment group were drop seizure free during the treatment period. Three patients on Epidiolex were drop seizure free during the entire maintenance period, compared with no placebo patients.
Caregivers of patients on Epidiolex were significantly more likely to report an improvement in overall condition on the S/Caregiver Global Impression of Change scale (p=0.0008).
During the treatment period, patients taking Epidiolex achieved a median reduction in monthly total seizures of 41 percent compared with a reduction of 14 percent in patients receiving placebo, which was statistically significant (p=0.0005). When looking at the 12-week maintenance period, Epidiolex treatment effect increased further, achieving a median reduction in monthly total seizures of 45 percent compared with a reduction on placebo of 15 percent, which was highly statistically significant (p=0.0004).
Median non-drop seizure frequency reduced by 49 percent in the CBD group, compared with 23 percent in the placebo group during the treatment period, which was statistically significant (p=0.0044).
A consistent separation between Epidiolex and placebo across all drop seizure response rates. At the 50 percent seizure reduction threshold, there was a statistically-significant separation between Epidiolex and placebo (p=0.0043).

 

Epidiolex was generally well tolerated in this trial. Overall, 86 percent of all Epidiolex patients experienced an adverse event compared with 69 percent of patients on placebo. The most common adverse events (occurring in greater than 10 percent of Epidiolex-treated patients) were: diarrhea, somnolence, decreased appetite, pyrexia, and vomiting. Of those patients on Epidiolex who reported an adverse event, 78 percent reported it to be mild or moderate. Nine patients on Epidiolex experienced a treatment-related serious adverse event compared with one patient on placebo. There was no difference in episodes of status epilepticus between Epidiolex and placebo. Twelve patients on Epidiolex discontinued treatment due to adverse events compared with one patient on placebo. Increases in ALT or AST (levels >3× ULN) occurred in 19 patients on Epidiolex and 1 placebo patient; 15 of the patients were on concomitant Valproic Acid. There is a set of accepted criteria for identifying whether these transient elevations of liver enzymes are a signal for serious toxicity. These criteria are known as Hy’s law. No patients met these criteria for drug-induced liver injury. All elevations resolved to below 3x ULN. There was one death in the Epidiolex group, which was deemed unrelated to treatment. Of the patients who completed this trial, 100 percent have opted to continue into an open-label extension trial.

 

In addition to this first Phase 3 trial of Epidiolex in LGS, in June 2015 we commenced a second Phase 3, randomized, double-blind placebo-controlled trial to evaluate the safety and efficacy of Epidiolex for the treatment of LGS in patients who are being treated with other AEDs. Patients aged 2-55 years with a confirmed diagnosis of drug-resistant LGS currently uncontrolled on one or more concomitant AEDs were eligible to participate in this trial. The trial randomized 225 patients into three arms, where Epidiolex 20mg/kg/day (n=76), Epidiolex 10mg/kg/day (n=73) or placebo (n=76) was added to current AED treatment. On average, patients were taking approximately 3 AEDs, having previously tried and discontinued an average of 7 other AEDs. The average age of trial participants was 16 years (30 percent were 18 years or older). The median drop seizure frequency over the 4 week baseline period was 85.

 

  33  

 

  

The primary efficacy endpoint of this trial was a comparison between Epidiolex and placebo in the percentage change in the monthly frequency of drop seizures during the 14 week treatment period (two week dose escalation period followed by 12 weeks of maintenance) compared to the 4 week baseline period before randomization. Drop seizures were defined as atonic, tonic or tonic-clonic seizures involving the entire body, trunk or head that led or could have led to a fall, injury, slumping in a chair or hitting the patient's head on a surface. During the treatment period, patients taking Epidiolex 20mg/kg/day achieved a median reduction in monthly drop seizures of 42 percent compared with a reduction of 17 percent in patients taking placebo (p=0.0047), and patients taking Epidiolex 10mg/kg/day achieved a median reduction in monthly drop seizures of 37 percent compared with a reduction of 17 percent in patients taking placebo (p=0.0016). A series of sensitivity analyses of the primary endpoint for both dose groups confirmed the robustness of these results. In both dose groups, the difference between Epidiolex and placebo emerged during the first month of treatment and was sustained during the entire treatment period. Results from secondary efficacy endpoints in both dose groups reinforced the overall effectiveness observed with Epidiolex.

 

Epidiolex was generally well tolerated in this trial. One patient on 10mg/kg Epidiolex discontinued treatment due to an adverse event compared with six patients on 20mg/kg and one patient on placebo. Of the 84 percent of 10mg/kg patients who experienced an adverse event, 89 percent of them deemed it to be mild or moderate. Of the 94 percent of 20mg/kg patients who experienced an adverse event, 88 percent of them reported it to be mild or moderate. 72 percent of patients on placebo experienced an adverse event. The most common adverse events (occurring in greater than 10 percent of Epidiolex-treated patients) in the 10mg/kg group were: somnolence, decreased appetite, upper respiratory infection, diarrhea, and status epilepticus. None of the cases of status epilepticus in the 10mg/kg group was deemed treatment-related. The most common adverse events (occurring in greater than 10 percent of Epidiolex-treated patients) in the 20mg/kg group were: somnolence, decreased appetite, diarrhea, upper respiratory infection, pyrexia, vomiting, and nasopharyngitis. Thirteen patients on Epidiolex 10mg/kg experienced a serious adverse event (two of which were deemed treatment-related) compared with thirteen patients on 20mg/kg (five of which were deemed treatment-related) and eight patients on placebo (none of which were deemed treatment-related). There were no deaths in this trial. Of the patients who completed this trial, 99 percent have opted to continue into an open-label extension trial.

 

The detailed analysis of the data from this trial is on-going and we expect data from this trial to be submitted for presentation at a medical meeting in the first half of 2017.

 

Drug:Drug Interactions

 

Drug:drug interactions, or DDIs, in epilepsy are commonplace and clinicians routinely monitor blood levels of concomitant AEDs. We now have extensive real world experience of Epidiolex, with approximately 1,000 patients currently on treatment.

 

At our pre-NDA meeting, we reached agreement with FDA on the scope of our DDI studies. A number of these studies have now been completed and to date the only DDI identified is an interaction with clobazam, which results in increases in the first metabolite, n-desmethylclobazam, and not in raised levels of clobazam itself. There are patients within both the EAP and the GW sponsored Phase 3 studies who achieved meaningful seizure reductions, even becoming seizure free, who are not on concomitant clobazam.

 

Regulatory Submissions for Dravet syndrome and LGS

 

Following the success of the first Dravet syndrome Phase 3 trial, we requested a pre-NDA meeting with the FDA to discuss a proposed Dravet syndrome NDA. This meeting took place in July 2016 and included some discussion of the LGS trial data. As a result of this meeting, we believe the guidance received was both positive and supportive of our proposed filing strategy to submit a single NDA that includes Phase 3 data from one Dravet trial and two LGS trials. Subject to satisfactory review, we now anticipate simultaneous approval of both indications and do not expect to wait for results from the second trial in Dravet syndrome prior to this submission.

 

In November 2016, we held a CMC pre-NDA meeting. At this meeting, agreement was reached on key questions related to the CMC content of our planned NDA submission.

 

We are on track to submit the NDA to the FDA at the end of the first half of 2017.

 

In Europe, we expect to hold pre-submission meetings with the EMA in the first quarter of 2017 and are making plans to submit a marketing authorization application in Europe in the second half of 2017.

 

Tuberous Sclerosis Complex (TSC)

 

TSC is a genetic disorder that causes non-malignant tumors to form in many different organs, primarily in the brain, eyes, heart, kidney, skin and lungs. The brain and skin are the most affected organs. TSC results from a mutation in tumor suppression genes TSC1 or TSC2. According to the Tuberous Sclerosis Alliance, TSC is estimated to affect approximately 50,000 patients in the United States. The most common symptom of TSC is epilepsy, which occurs in 75 – 90 percent of patients, about 70 percent of whom experience seizure onset in their first year of life. Approximately 60 percent of these TSC patients (or approximately 25,000 of patients in the United States) have treatment-resistant seizures. The seizures of TSC are typically focal in onset, meaning that they are localized to one hemisphere of the brain. There are significant co-morbidities associated with TSC including cognitive impairment in 50 percent, autism spectrum disorders in up to 40 percent and neurobehavioral disorders in over 60 percent of individuals with TSC.

 

A number of patients with TSC have been treated with Epidiolex in the expanded access program (as explained in detail below). At the 69 th Annual Meeting of the American Epilepsy Society in December 2015, safety and efficacy data on 10 patients diagnosed with TSC from the physician-led open-label Epidiolex expanded access program were presented by Massachusetts General Hospital for Children (Geffrey et al 2015). The percent of patients who reported a 50 percent or greater reduction in seizures were 50 percent, 50 percent, 40 percent, 60 percent and 66 percent at 2, 3, 6, 9, and 12 months of treatment with Epidiolex, respectively. Side effects were seen in five patients (50 percent) and most were resolved with AED or CBD dose adjustments.

 

TSC Phase 3 Clinical Program

 

In April 2016, we commenced a Phase 3 trial of Epidiolex in patients with TSC. This dose-ranging trial is a 16-week comparison of Epidiolex versus placebo in a total of approximately 200 patients, aged one to 65 years, to assess the safety and efficacy of Epidiolex as an adjunctive anti-epileptic treatment. The primary measure of this trial is the percentage change from baseline in seizure frequency during the treatment period. Primary endpoint seizures include focal motor seizures with or without impairment of consciousness or awareness and generalized convulsive seizures. We expect to report data from this trial in the first half of 2018.

 

  34  

 

  

Infantile Spasms (IS)

 

According to the National Institute of Neurological Disorders and Stroke, an infantile spasm is a specific type of seizure seen in an epilepsy syndrome of infancy and childhood known as West syndrome. West syndrome is characterized by infantile spasms, developmental regression, and a specific pattern on electroencephalography, or EEG, testing called hypsarrhythmia (chaotic brain waves). The onset of infantile spasms is usually in the first year of life, typically between 4 to 8 months of age. The seizures primarily consist of a sudden bending forward of the body with stiffening of the arms and legs; some children arch their backs as they extend their arms and legs. Spasms tend to occur upon awakening or after feeding, and often occur in clusters of up to 100 spasms at a time. Infants may have dozens of clusters and several hundred spasms per day. Many underlying disorders, such as birth injury, metabolic disorders, and genetic disorders can give rise to spasms, making it important to identify the underlying cause. In some children, no cause can be found.

 

According to data published on Medscape, the condition constitutes 2 percent of childhood epilepsies and 25 percent of epilepsies with onset in the first year of life. There are approximately 2,000 to 4,000 new cases in the United States each year. Cognitive and developmental delay is severe in 70 percent of patients, often with psychiatric problems such as autistic features or hyperactivity. IS usually stops by five years of age, but may be replaced by other seizure types. It has been found that 50 percent to 70 percent of patients develop other seizure types and that 18 to 50 percent will develop LGS or some other form of symptomatic generalized epilepsy. The long-term prognosis is poor and includes increased mortality and severe neurodevelopmental impairment.

 

The FDA approved treatments for IS are ACTH (Acthar Gel) and vigabitrin (Sabril). These treatment options are successful in 20 percent to 80 percent of patients. Both of these medicines have significant adverse events, including boxed warnings limiting their long-term use.

 

On December 7, 2015, at the Annual Meeting of the American Epilepsy Society, safety and efficacy data on 9 patients suffering from epileptic spasms from the Epidiolex expanded access program were presented by Massachusetts General Hospital for Children (Abati et al.). Epilepsy spasms often remain refractory to standard AEDs. According to this poster, Epidiolex exerted its effects in a short time course, with a response rate of 67 percent after two weeks and 78 percent after one month. Three of nine patients became spasm-free after two weeks of Epidiolex treatment. By parent report, patients also showed cognitive gains including improvements in alertness, verbal capacity/communication, and cognitive availability.

 

IS Phase 3 Clinical Program

 

We commenced a two-part Phase 3 trial of Epidiolex in patients with IS in the fourth quarter of 2016. The first part of the trial will recruit 10 patients and is expected to complete in the first half of 2017. Subject to review by an independent panel, the second pivotal phase of the trial is expected to commence shortly after this review.

 

Cannabinoid Rationale for Treating Epilepsy

 

Several features of the pharmacology of certain cannabinoids suggest that they may be candidates for investigation as AEDs. A series of validated laboratory experiments have shown that certain cannabinoids can modulate neurotransmission, can reduce neuro-inflammation and can affect oxidative stress. These cannabinoids may simultaneously modulate a number of endogenous systems to attenuate and/or prevent epileptic neuronal hyperexcitability. These include ion channel control, inflammation, modulation of oxidative stress and inhibition of gene expression of epilepsy-associated genes.

 

Several different ion channels influence epileptogenesis (the process by which a normal brain develops epilepsy) including both ligand-gated and voltage-gated ion channels. It is the former to which a proportion of the actions of plant cannabinoids can be attributed, for example through agonism and antagonism of G-protein coupled receptors, including orphan receptors as well as modulation of transient receptor potential (TRP) channels (differentially activated, repressed and desensitized by different plant cannabinoids). Additionally it is now recognized that there is a role for inflammation in epilepsy. Some cannabinoids possess anti-inflammatory properties including inhibition of pro-inflammatory cytokine release and modulation of glial cell/neuronal interactions. Furthermore cannabinoids modulate oxidative stress and production of toxic nitric oxide. Research shows that other than THC, most plant cannabinoids have little or no affinity for the cannabinoid receptors, and therefore do not share the unwanted psychoactivity that goes along with stimulation of the CB1 receptor in particular.

 

Finally, certain cannabinoids may possess disease modifying potential through regulation of epilepsy-related genes, as well as up-regulation of endogenous anti-convulsant neuropeptides and/or compensatory systems.

 

Based on recent findings in The Journal of Pharmacology and Experimental Therapeutics, CBD is likely to be acting via more than one mechanism of action with the effect of reducing neuronal hyperexcitability. Neuronal hyperexcitability occurs when the nerve keeps firing and can lead to seizures. There are several mechanisms that aim to stop nerves firing once they have stimulated the post-synaptic nerve. Among these mechanisms is the movement of positively charged ions, e.g. sodium and calcium, across the cell membrane in a process called re-polarization. If these mechanisms are faulty, then the continued firing means ‘hyperexcitability’. Importantly, the anti-seizure effects of CBD are not dependent on cannabinoid receptors, nor on sodium channels.

 

CBD Pharmacology in Epilepsy

 

The epilepsy-relevant pharmacology of CBD can be summarized as follows: inhibition of neutrophil and microglial migration, anti-inflammatory effects in conventional animal models; inhibition of adenosine uptake and indirect agonism of the neuroprotective and anti-inflammatory A2a receptor; other neuroprotective effects (TNF inhibition and anti-oxidant activity); antipsychotic activity; agonism at the orphan receptor GPR55; desensitizer of TRP channels; anticonvulsant activity in all laboratory models tested; ion channel modulation; reduction of acetylcholine turnover at neuro-muscular junctions; and perturbation of the negative effects of THC (opposes euphoric, cognitive and psychotropic effects) via one or more of the above mechanisms.

 

  35  

 

  

There is a significant effort to identify the mechanisms of action that underpin the clinical effectiveness of Epidiolex (and other cannabinoids) in epilepsy, including investigation of the effects of cannabinoids on epilepsy associated gene expression. CBD has negligible binding at the CB1 receptor, and so shares neither the pharmacology of CB1 agonists such as THC nor that of CB1 inverse agonists such as Rimonabant. CBD’s mechanism for treating seizures is not fully understood but is believed to involve a combination of beneficial effects stacking upon one another (polypharmacology).

 

Preclinical models suggest a broad role for CBD in generalized and partial seizures, and clinical reports of benefit extend into other congenital seizure disorders.

 

Our CBD Pre-Clinical Research in Pediatric Epilepsy

 

We have conducted pre-clinical research of CBD in epilepsy for several years and have reported significant anti-epileptiform and anticonvulsant activity using a variety of in vitro and in vivo models. This research has shown the ability of CBD to treat seizures in acute models of epilepsy with significantly fewer side effects than existing AEDs. Our cannabinoid research compounds were screened in electrically discharging hippocampal brain slices caused by the omission of Mg2+ ions from, or addition of the K+ channel blocker, 4-aminopyridine (4-AP) to the bathing solution. In these models, 100μM of CBD decreased epileptiform amplitude and duration as well as burst frequency; importantly, this compound exerted no effect upon the propagation of epileptiform activity.

 

Subsequently, the anti-convulsant actions of 1, 10 and 100 mg/kg of CBD were examined in three different in vivo seizure rodent models. In the Pentylenetetrazol (PTZ) induced acute, generalized seizures model, 100 mg/kg of CBD significantly decreased mortality rate and the incidence of tonic-clonic seizures. In the acute pilocarpine model of temporal lobe seizures all doses of CBD significantly reduced the percentage of animals experiencing the most severe seizures. In this model of partial seizures, 10 and 100 mg/kg of CBD significantly decreased the percentage of animals dying as a result of seizures and all doses of CBD also decreased the percentage of animals experiencing the most severe tonic-clonic seizures.

 

During 2013, we received increasing interest among U.S. pediatric epilepsy specialists and patient organizations in the potential role of CBD in treating intractable childhood epilepsy, in particular Dravet syndrome. This interest led to a medical conference organized by the New York University School of Medicine on October 4, 2013 titled: “Cannabidiols: Potential Use in Epilepsy and Other Neurological Disorders.” Epilepsy specialists at the meeting viewed CBD as attractive for the treatment of these disorders for a variety of reasons, including:

 

Case reports of its efficacy in severe, refractory patients consistently provide encouraging signals; and

 

  CBD’s “natural” profile and safety data generated to date suggest that it could be an attractive treatment option without the unwanted side effects of other AEDs.

 

In addition, specialists at this conference concluded the following:

 

  Only a pharmaceutical formulation of CBD which could meet FDA requirements for standardization and quality control would be appropriate for administering to children; and

 

  Placebo-controlled trials should be performed as a matter of urgency in order to provide robust evidence of the safety and efficacy of CBD.

 

Epidiolex Expanded Access INDs

 

In parallel with our commercial clinical trial programs, the FDA has been receiving and approving INDs from independent investigators in the United States to allow treatment with Epidiolex in children and young adults with a range of epilepsy syndromes. To date, the FDA has granted 20 intermediate expanded access INDs to independent physician investigators in the United States to treat a total of 474 children and young adults suffering from intractable epilepsy with Epidiolex. In addition, the FDA has granted further INDs to treat 637 additional patients under expanded access programs supported by seven U.S. states and for which we are supplying Epidiolex. The FDA may authorize expanded access programs to facilitate access to investigational drugs for treatment use for patients with a serious or immediately life-threatening disease or condition who lack therapeutic alternatives. The patients in these INDs suffer not only from Dravet syndrome, LGS, TSC and IS but also from other pediatric epilepsy syndromes. The FDA has also authorized to physicians 15 individual emergency INDs and three individual patient non-emergency INDs.

 

The Lancet Neurology Data

 

On December 23, 2015, Epidiolex data from the physician-led expanded access program in treatment-resistant epilepsy were published by the treating physicians in The Lancet Neurology (Devinsky et al., Cannabidiol in Patients with Treatment Resistant Epilepsy: an open-label interventional trial, Lancet Neurology December 23, 2015). This paper provides a more expansive description of data previously presented at the American Academy of Neurology Annual Meeting in April 2015. Data in the paper are from 11 independent epilepsy centers in the United States; 162 patients who had at least 12 weeks of follow-up after the first dose of cannabidiol were included in the safety and tolerability analysis, and 137 patients were included in the efficacy analysis. Of these 162 patients, there were 33 patients with Dravet syndrome and 31 patients with LGS. The published paper reported that Epidiolex reduced seizure frequency across multiple drug-resistant epilepsy syndromes and seizure types and was generally well tolerated. In the paper the authors note that the administration of Epidiolex as an add-on treatment led to a clinically meaningful reduction in seizure frequency in many patients and had an adequate safety profile in this patient population with highly treatment-resistant epilepsies. The safety and tolerability profile of Epidiolex was favorable with only 3 percent of patients terminating therapy due to an adverse event. Highlights from the publication of particular relevance to GW’s pivotal trial programs in Dravet syndrome and LGS include:

 

  36  

 

  

  Dravet syndrome:  The median reduction in monthly motor (i.e., convulsive) seizures was 49.8 percent (n=32). 50 percent of Dravet syndrome patients had a 50 percent or greater reduction in monthly motor seizures. During the last 4 weeks of therapy, 13 percent (n=4) were free of motor seizures; these patients were also free of all other seizure types. In Dravet syndrome patients who experienced them at baseline, there was a median 69.2 percent reduction in monthly tonic seizures (n=6), 46.7 percent reduction in monthly tonic-clonic seizures (n=29), and 83.3 percent reduction in non-motor focal seizures (n=10).

 

  LGS:  A median 68.8 percent reduction in average monthly atonic seizures was observed (n=14). During the last 4 weeks of therapy, 21 percent (n=3) were free of atonic seizures and 3 percent (n=1) were totally seizure free. In LGS patients who experienced motor and tonic seizures at baseline, there were median 36.8 percent (n=30) and 44 percent (n=21) reductions, respectively.

 

  Clobazam co-therapy was associated with a higher rate of treatment response (median reduction in convulsive seizures): 56.4 percent v. 35.0 percent at week 12; this may reflect elevations in the N-desmethyl clobazam metabolite. This apparent effect of clobazam co-therapy was not seen in Dravet syndrome or LGS groups — at week 12, 53 percent of Dravet/LGS patients on Clobazam were 50 percent responders compared with 54 percent not taking Clobazam (odds ratio 0.97 (95 percent Confidence Interval — 0.35 – 2.65)).

 

  Adverse events occurred in 79 percent of all patients treated with cannabidiol (n=162). Adverse events reported in greater than 10 percent of patients were somnolence (25 percent), decreased appetite (19 percent), diarrhea (19 percent), fatigue (13 percent) and convulsion (11 percent). Most adverse events were mild or moderate and transient. Five patients (3 percent) discontinued treatment due to an adverse event.

 

  Serious adverse events were reported in 48 patients (30 percent), including one death, regarded as unrelated to CBD. Serious adverse events which were deemed possibly related to CBD occurred in 20 patients.

 

The authors noted that without a control group, the results regarding efficacy and safety should be interpreted cautiously.

 

2015 American Epilepsy Data

 

In addition to the data published in The Lancet Neurology, seven abstracts related to the physician-led expanded access program for Epidiolex in treatment-resistant epilepsy were presented at the 69 th Annual Meeting of the American Epilepsy Society including data from the physician-led Epidiolex expanded access program. On December 7, 2015, at the Annual Meeting of the American Epilepsy Society, physician reports of clinical effect and safety data was presented on 261 children and young adults with treatment-resistant epilepsy who had been treated with Epidiolex for a period of at least 12 weeks (Devinsky et al.). This data is from 16 clinical sites in the United States and was generated under the expanded access program. In addition, physician reports of safety data were presented on 313 patients (261 patients with 12 weeks treatment effect data plus an additional 52 patients still in their first 12 weeks of treatment or who withdrew from treatment).

 

The patients included in the Epidiolex program had Dravet syndrome (17 percent of the total) and LGS (15 percent of the total), as well as 14 other types of severe epilepsy, such as TSC, Aicardi syndrome and Doose syndrome. Many of these other types of epilepsy are severe and rare, and several patients with these epilepsies have major congenital structural brain abnormalities.

 

The 261 patients were predominately children with an average age of 11.8 years. In all cases, Epidiolex was added to current AED treatment regimes. On average, patients were taking approximately three other AEDs. At baseline, the median number of convulsive seizures per month was 31.

 

Clinical Effect Data — All Patients

 

Data was presented on all 261 patients who had at least 12 weeks treatment. Treatment was open label. Of these 261 patients, 135 patients had also reached 36 weeks treatment at the time of data analysis. Information collected on all seizures (convulsive and non-convulsive) was reported for each patient. The following data was presented showing the median change in seizure frequency compared to a 4-week baseline period.

 

    Week 4     Week 8     Week 12     Week 16     Week 24     Week 36  
Median change in seizure frequency     -33.5 %     -42.5 %     -45.1 %     -49.5 %     -45.9 %     -44.1 %

 

At the end of 12 weeks, 47 percent of all patients experienced a ≥50 percent reduction in seizures and 9 percent of all patients were seizure-free.

 

At the end of 12 weeks, the median overall reduction in convulsive seizure frequency was 48.8 percent.

 

Clinical Effect Data — Dravet syndrome patients only

 

Data was presented on 44 patients with Dravet syndrome who had at least 12 weeks treatment data. Of these 44 patients, 25 patients had also reached 36 weeks treatment at the time of data analysis. Information collected on all seizures (convulsive and non-convulsive) was reported for each patient. The following data was presented showing the median change in seizure frequency compared to a 4-week baseline period.

 

    Week 4     Week 8     Week 12     Week 16     Week 24     Week 36  
Median change in seizure frequency     -36.8 %     -56.4 %     -62.7 %     -56.2 %     -55.4 %     -50.6 %

 

  37  

 

  

At the end of 12 weeks, 13 percent of Dravet syndrome patients were seizure-free.

 

Of the 44 patients with Dravet syndrome, 42 patients had convulsive seizures at baseline. At the end of 12 weeks, the median reduction in convulsive seizures in these patients was 52.3 percent.

 

Clinical Effect Data — Patients without Dravet syndrome

 

Data was made available on all 217 patients with diagnoses other than Dravet syndrome who had at least 12 weeks treatment. Of these 217 patients, 110 patients had also reached 36 weeks treatment at the time of data analysis. Information collected on all seizures (convulsive and non-convulsive) was reported for each patient. The following data was presented showing the median change in seizure frequency compared to a 4-week baseline period.

 

    Week 4     Week 8     Week 12     Week 16     Week 24     Week 36  
Median change in seizure frequency     -33.3 %     -41.2 %     -41.4 %     -47.0 %     -45.5 %     -44.1 %

 

Clinical Effect Data — LGS patients only

 

Data was presented on 40 patients with LGS who had at least 12 weeks treatment data. Of these patients, 14 had atonic seizures at baseline. In these patients, there was a 71.1 percent median reduction in the number of atonic seizures at the end of 12 weeks.

 

Safety Data

 

Safety data was made available on 313 patients (261 patients with 12 weeks treatment effect data plus 52 additional patients for whom 12 week treatment effect data is not yet available or who withdrew from treatment) and represents approximately 180 patient-years of exposure to Epidiolex. The most common adverse events (occurring in 10% or more of patients and resulting from all causes) were somnolence (23 percent), diarrhea (23 percent), fatigue (17 percent), decreased appetite (17 percent), convulsions (17 percent) and vomiting (10 percent). Adverse events led to discontinuation in four percent of patients. Most adverse events were mild or moderate and transient. 14 patients (4 percent) reported an adverse event leading to discontinuation. There were 36 (12 percent) withdrawals from treatment due to lack of clinical effect. Serious adverse events were reported in 106 patients. Of these, serious adverse events in 16 (5 percent) patients were deemed possibly related to treatment, including altered liver enzymes (4 patients), status epilepticus/convulsion (4), diarrhea (4), decreased weight (3), thrombocytopenia (1). Serious adverse events reported under the expanded access program include seven deaths. We are also aware of the death of one patient that received Epidiolex on a compassionate use basis in the United Kingdom. All eight of these deaths have been investigated and were all deemed unrelated to Epidiolex by the independent investigators.

 

Since the time that this data was collected in September 2015, a further 300 patients have been exposed to Epidiolex in the expanded access program. Over 700 patients have participated in comparative clinical studies, including patients with Dravet Syndrome, LGS or Tuberous Sclerosis. There have been five more deaths reported under the expanded access program. We are also aware of the death of two additional patients who received Epidiolex on a compassionate use basis in the United Kingdom. Outside of these programs, there was one patient death during our recently completed Phase 3 trial of Epidiolex in LGS, and seven patient deaths during the open label extension trial for patients who have completed their treatment under our completed or ongoing Phase 3 trials of Epidiolex in Dravet syndrome and LGS. All fifteen of these deaths have been investigated and all of them have been deemed unrelated to treatment with Epidiolex by the independent investigators

 

Note Regarding Expanded Access Studies

 

The expanded access studies we are currently supporting are uncontrolled, carried out by individual physician investigators independent from us, and not always conducted in strict compliance with Good Clinical Practices, all of which can lead to an observed treatment effect that may differ from one seen in placebo-controlled trials. Data from these studies provide only anecdotal evidence of efficacy for regulatory review, although they may provide supportive safety information for regulatory review. The patients treated under these expanded access INDs contain no control or comparator group for reference and these patient data are not designed to be aggregated or reported as study results. Moreover, data from such small numbers of patients may be highly variable. Information obtained from these INDs, including the statistical principles that the independent investigators have chosen to apply to the data, may not reliably predict data collected via systematic evaluation of efficacy in our sponsored clinical trials, or evaluated via other statistical principles that may be applied in these trials. We can offer no assurances that the observations reported by the treating physicians under these expanded access INDs are due solely to Epidiolex and not as a result of other factors, such as a beneficial or synergistic drug-drug interaction, as postulated above. Further, due to the non-normal distribution of the data collected from the small sample size, we have chosen to use median data in its analysis. However, other statistical principles may be more appropriate to the analysis of the clinical data generated from our placebo controlled trials of Epidiolex for the treatment of Dravet syndrome, LGS, TSC and IS.

 

We believe the data we have received to date under these expanded access INDs support the continued investigation of Epidiolex as a potential treatment for epilepsy, including for Dravet syndrome, LGS, TSC and IS.

 

  38  

 

  

Emergency INDs

 

The FDA has also granted to physicians 12 individual emergency INDs. An emergency IND is an IND for the use of an investigational new drug or biological product for clinical treatment of a patient in an emergency situation. In order to be granted an emergency IND the following five conditions must all be met: (1) the patient or patients to be treated have a serious or immediately life-threatening disease or condition, and there is no comparable or satisfactory alternative therapy to diagnose, monitor, or treat the disease or condition; (2) FDA must determine that the patient cannot obtain the drug under another IND or protocol; (3) the potential benefits to the patient justify the potential risks of the treatment and the risks from this investigational treatment are not unreasonable in the context of the disease or condition treated with this investigational product; (4) providing the investigational drug for the requested use will not interfere with the initiation, conduct, or completion of clinical investigations that could support marketing approval of the expanded access use or otherwise compromise the potential development of the expanded access use; and (5) the physician must determine that the probable risk to the person from the investigational drug is not greater than the probable risk from the disease or condition. In these cases, we have responded to, and the FDA has approved, emergency treatment requests from physicians for children hospitalized as a result of severe and potentially life-threatening seizures. In a poster at the American Epilepsy Society annual meeting in December 2014, Lopez C. et al. presented information on a four year old patient with super refractory status epilepticus due to febrile infection related epilepsy syndrome, or FIRES, treated with Epidiolex under an emergency IND concluding that CBD was very well tolerated and associated with a significant improvement in clinical and electrographic seizure burden. We believe eight of the children treated under emergency INDs remain on Epidiolex treatment. Two children treated under emergency INDs died while receiving treatment with Epidiolex and two withdrew due to lack of efficacy; both deaths were deemed unrelated to Epidiolex by the independent investigators.

 

Collaborations with State Governments in Australia

 

In October 2015, we announced that we had signed a Memorandum of Understanding, or MOU, with the Government of New South Wales, or NSW, in Australia to advance a research program for Epidiolex and CBDV in children with severe, drug resistant childhood epilepsy. With respect to Epidiolex, the MOU will facilitate (i) a compassionate access program for Epidiolex, (ii) provision for NSW to host additional Phase 3 clinical trials of Epidiolex and (iii) a Phase 4 clinical trial of Epidiolex (to follow completion of the Phase 3 trials). The first patients received treatment under the compassionate access program for Epidiolex in Q3 2016.

 

In June 2016, we signed an MOU with the Queensland Government in Australia to advance research into the use of cannabinoid-based pharmaceutical products for the treatment of patients in Queensland with serious illness, including childhood epilepsy. The MOU will facilitate (i) establishing a centre to undertake clinician led observational studies using cannabinoid-based investigational medicinal products across a range of childhood developmental disorders, (ii) an expanded access treatment protocol using Epidiolex for a small number of patients with severe drug-resistant epilepsy and (iii) an observational study for a small number of patients with severe drug-resistant epilepsy using Epidiolex and other cannabinoids.

 

Epidiolex Manufacturing

 

We are currently manufacturing Epidiolex through utilization of in-house and external third party facilities for various steps in the production process. We expect to satisfy near-term requirements for Epidiolex from these current facilities but we are also in an ongoing process of scaling-up various parts of the production process both in-house and with external third parties.

 

We are actively scaling our growing and manufacturing of Epidiolex to meet anticipated commercial demand, if approved. From our extensive experience in growing CBD botanical raw material, we are able to utilize a range of growing methods to generate significant quantities of CBD botanical raw material derived from our proprietary CBD plant chemotypes. In 2015, our production of CBD botanical raw materials increased by a factor of approximately 20 times compared with the previous year and increased significantly again in 2016. The combined inventory created by growing operations over the last 2 years equates to approximately 200 tonnes of CBD raw materials for Epidiolex and when purified and formulated, results in approximately 1.6 million 100mg/ml bottles of Epidiolex. With expectations of significant demand for Epidiolex upon potential approval, we plan to continue expansion of our Epidiolex plant growing capacity well beyond our exit 2016 levels and to this end GW recently signed an agreement with a new third party that enables GW to treble its growing capacity from 2017 onwards. The finished product, Epidiolex, is a liquid formulation of pure CBD and there are several processing steps beyond growing to ensure that the product is pure, meets the required FDA specification, and can be manufactured at scale to current Good Manufacturing Practice Regulations. Each step has already been scaled and a further increase in scale of the processes is anticipated during 2016 and into 2017. We believe we are on track to be ready for FDA pre-approval inspection anticipated in the second half of 2017.

 

Epidiolex Commercialization

 

We are planning to commercialize Epidiolex in the United States and elsewhere using our own sales and marketing organization. In June 2015, we appointed Julian Gangolli to the newly created position of President, North America and he has been appointed to our Board of Directors. Mr. Gangolli is leading our commercial organization in the United States. We have also recruited a number of U.S. medical affairs, clinical trials and commercial staff, many of whom have strong epilepsy knowledge and experience. We expect this organization to expand over the next 12 months. The creation of the medical affairs team has allowed us to open scientific and consultative communications with key stakeholders, such as the patient and physician communities in the United States. Our commercial staff have begun actively developing our commercial strategy for the United States.

 

Our U.S. commercial organization is based in our office at Carlsbad, CA. With the successful results from the first Dravet syndrome and two LGS Phase 3 trials, we are now accelerating plans for our potential U.S. commercialization of Epidiolex. We expect to implement a “high efficiency” commercial deployment model expected to include a dedicated sales force of approximately 50 to 60 sales professionals targeting approximately 4,000 – 5,000 U.S. physicians. This commercial organization will be defined by a “high-touch” patient, payor and physician communication, education and distribution model.

 

We believe that the U.S. physician awareness and enthusiasm for a new therapeutic alternative for the treatment of pediatric epilepsies is high, and that, if approved, Epidiolex would represent a new class of anti-convulsant with a potentially differentiated side-effect profile and mechanism of action.

 

  39  

 

  

We will commercialize our CBD-containing products for the treatment of epilepsy under a different name than Epidiolex in the United States. We will commercialize these products, and any of our other products, in the United States under the name Greenwich Biosciences and have changed the name of our U.S. subsidiary responsible for commercializing these products in the United States from GW Pharmaceuticals Inc. to Greenwich Biosciences Inc.

 

Epidiolex Intellectual Property

 

In addition to orphan exclusivity, we have been seeking to protect Epidiolex through our patent portfolio. We have a portfolio of intellectual property relating to the use of CBD in epilepsy. This portfolio includes twelve distinct patent families which are either granted or filed. The latest expiry date of these families runs to July 2036. This portfolio includes patent families with claims directed to the use of CBD in the treatment of epilepsy seizure subtypes, particular childhood epilepsy syndromes, and formulations. To date, this has resulted in 2 patents granted by the USPTO and numerous patent applications being prosecuted at the USPTO. We anticipate filing additional patent applications claiming the use of Epidiolex in 2017 as new data is generated, and expect more of our pending patent applications to be granted by USPTO during 2017. Should the NDA for Epidiolex be approved we expect a number of these granted patent to be listed in the Approved Drug Products with Therapeutic Equivalence Evaluations, or Orange Book. In addition other patent families provide protection for epilepsy related inventions such as extraction techniques, CBD extracts and highly purified CBD.

 

GWP42006 (CBDV) in Epilepsy and Autism Spectrum Disorders (ASD)

 

In addition to Epidiolex, our product candidates also include GWP42006, which features CBDV as the primary cannabinoid. CBDV is similar in chemical structure to CBD and has also shown anti-epileptic properties across a range of in vitro and in vivo models of epilepsy. In a paper published in the September 2012 issue of The British Journal of Pharmacology by scientists with whom we collaborate at the University of Reading, United Kingdom, GWP42006 was reported to have the potential to prevent more seizures, with few of the side effects caused by many existing AEDs, such as uncontrollable shaking. In the study, GWP42006 strongly suppressed seizures in six different experimental models commonly used in epilepsy treatment. GWP42006 was also found to provide additional efficacy when combined with drugs currently used to control epilepsy. Genetic biomarkers for response have been identified.

 

We have also evaluated GWP42006 in both general and syndromic pre-clinical models of ASD yielding promising signals on cognitive and social endpoints as well as repetitive behavior. These animal models include both genetically determined abnormalities of neurobehavioral, and chemically-induced models, and include Rett syndrome and Fragile X among others.

 

We have completed a Phase 1 trial of GWP42006 in 66 healthy subjects. In this trial, GWP42006 was well tolerated even at the highest tested dose. There were no serious or severe adverse events reported, nor any withdrawals due to adverse events.

 

We are pursuing multiple development programs for GWP42006 both within adult and childhood epilepsy and in childhood behavioral disorders:

 

In epilepsy, we are recruiting a Phase 2 trial of GWP42006. This is a double-blind, randomized, placebo-controlled two-part trial to investigate the pharmacokinetics, followed by efficacy and safety of GWP42006 as add-on therapy in patients with inadequately controlled focal seizures. The first part of this trial has completed enrollment of 32 patients and the dose-ranging pharmacokinetic and safety data has been reviewed by an independent panel. We have commenced the efficacy part of the trial and expect to recruit an additional 100 patients. Data from this part of the trial is expected in mid 2017.

 

  As described above, in October 2015, we announced that we had signed a MOU with the NSW Government in Australia to advance a research program for Epidiolex and CBDV in children with severe, drug resistant childhood epilepsy. The MOU will facilitate a world first, Phase 2 clinical trial in children for GWP42006.

 

  We are conducting pre-clinical research into CBDV within the field of ASD. Many of the pediatric intractable epilepsy conditions within the Epidiolex expanded access program share considerable overlap with ASD and these conditions often fall within the orphan disease space. Initial clinical observations from treating physicians suggest a potential role for cannabinoids in addressing problems associated with ASD such as deficits in cognition, behavior and communication. Phase 2 placebo-controlled trials are expected to commence in the third quarter of 2017. We have to date received Orphan Drug Designation from the FDA for CBDV for the treatment of Rett syndrome.

 

CBDV Intellectual Property Portfolio

 

We have a portfolio of intellectual property relating to CBDV for use in various indications including epilepsy and autism spectrum disorder. This portfolio includes patent families which are either granted or filed, protecting the use of this product candidate. The latest expiry date of these families runs to April 2036. These patent families include claims to use of CBDV alone or in combination with standard anti-epileptic drugs in the treatment of seizures, the use of CBDV in the treatment of autism spectrum disorders and associated conditions. Other families which provide protection for the use of CBDV in other therapeutic areas such as neuropathic pain, Alzheimer’s disease and Duchenne’s disease, CBDV compositions and CBDV extracts. We anticipate additional patent applications being filed as new data is generated.

 

Other Orphan Product Candidates

 

Neonatal Hypoxic-Ischemic Encephalopathy (NHIE)

 

NHIE is acute or sub-acute brain injury due to asphyxia caused during birth resulting from deprivation of oxygen during birth, referred to as hypoxia, as a result of a sentinel event such as ruptured placenta, parental shock and even increased heart rate. Hypoxic damage can occur to most of the infant’s organs, but brain damage is the most serious and least likely to heal, resulting in encephalopathy. This can later manifest itself as either mental retardation (including developmental delay and/or intellectual disability) or physical disabilities such as spasticity, blindness and deafness. Indeed, spastic diplegia and the other forms of cerebral palsy almost always feature asphyxiation during the birth process as a contributing factor. The exact timing and underlying causes of these outcomes remains unknown but it is widely recognized that interventions need to be administered within six hours of hypoxic insult.

 

  40  

 

  

Market Overview

 

According to Kurinczuk et al. in the 2010 edition of Early Human Development, the incidence of NHIE is 1.5 to 2.8 per 1,000 births in the United States, or, by our estimate, 6,500 to 12,000 cases per year. Of these, 35 percent are expected to die in early life and 30 percent of cases will result in permanent disability. There are currently no FDA-approved medicines specifically indicated for NHIE. The only FDA-approved treatment is the Olympic Cool-Cap System and treatment guidelines in many European countries also support use of whole body hypothermia. Clinical trials have shown the Cool-Cap to reduce the occurrence of disability due to NHIE but not death, while whole body hypothermia had a more marginal effect on disability but is able to reduce mortality. This treatment is only available in specialized neonatal intensive care units and must be started within 6 hours of birth. Even if a patient is put into induced hypothermia there is still a significant rate of morbidity and mortality, with a meta-analysis of the available data revealing a 27 percent death rate. Among the patients who survive NHIE, 28 percent suffer from major neurodevelopment issues and 26 percent develop cerebral palsy. There are academic initiatives looking to develop treatments in this area. In addition, one intervention being investigated by the pharmaceutical industry is an IV infusion of 2-Iminobiotin. Neurophyxia B.V. attained Orphan Drug Designation for this treatment in both Europe and the United States and is conducting a Phase 2 trial.

 

Cannabinoid Rationale for Treating NHIE

 

The pathophysiology of NHIE includes processes such as apoptosis, oxidative stress, inflammation and excitotoxicity, and may involve not only the brain, but also other organs. Some cannabinoids are able to influence all of these processes, but unlike other therapeutic compounds under development, can combine these neuroprotective strategies within a single molecule. Firstly, cannabinoids can act on nuclear receptors that control neuronal homeostasis and survival. Secondly, not only do cannabinoids have important free radical scavenging actions, but they may also upregulate and activate endogenous antioxidant defenses. Thirdly, cannabinoids influence the immune network and modulate phenomena associated with infection or inflammation, via inhibition of macrophage and neutrophil migration, natural killer cell proliferation, and by their ability to inhibit harmful cytokine production. It has been widely reported that endocannabinoids are able to protect the glial cell, an effect that may be independent of CB receptors. Finally, the endocannabinoid system, or ECS, has been shown to be neuroprotective in animal models — the levels of endogenous cannabinoids become enhanced in the brains of newborn rats after acute injury, acting as a protective response, and it has been proposed that one additional mechanism by which plant cannabinoids work is by preventing the enzymatic degradation of endocannabinoids, thus enhancing endogenous defense mechanisms. Recent research into the neuroprotection that has been shown by cannabinoids in animal models of neonatal hypoxia has also suggested a role for the 5HT1A receptor, since some of the beneficial effects can be blocked by 5HT1A receptor antagonists.

 

CBD as the Primary Cannabinoid Product Candidate in NHIE

 

In addition to its other properties, the possible neuroprotective effects of CBD have been examined. These neuroprotective effects are thought to be based mainly on the potent anti-inflammatory and anti-oxidant properties of CBD, although other actions of CBD that might also account for CBD-induced neuroprotection including: inhibition of calcium transport across membranes; inhibition of anandamide uptake and enzymatic hydrolysis; inhibition of iNOS protein expression and NF-|gkB activation; and inhibition of adenosine uptake. In a similar fashion to endocannabinoids, adenosine is thought to be part of a natural neuroprotective system, because adenosine levels rise in response to hypoxic insult in the brain and increasing extracellular adenosine acts as a neuroprotectant. It has been demonstrated that CBD enhances adenosine signaling through the inhibition of adenosine re-uptake and therefore indirectly activates the adenosine A2A receptor. Previously, it was demonstrated that CBD reduces brain damage after ischemic injury in adult animals. In a newborn piglet model of NHIE, CBD improved brain activity as measured by an EEG and reduced the numbers of seizures by half, while histological analysis of brain tissues showed that neuron degeneration was reduced. Neurological exams showed improved neurobehavioral performance up to three days after insult. There were also significant beneficial extra cerebral effects and the dose of dopamine needed by the animals to maintain blood pressure was less than half of what was required in vehicle-treated animals.

 

Our NHIE Research

 

In a paper by Castillo et al., published in Neurobiology of Disease in 2010, reporting results from our pre-clinical collaboration, CBD protected newborn mice forebrain slices from oxygen and glucose deprivation. We have further demonstrated that CBD was neuroprotective even when administered 18 hours after the hypoxic insult. A study from our pre-clinical collaboration with Lafuente, published in Paediatric Research in 2011, showed that administration of CBD to newborn piglets at doses much lower than those reported in the literature appears to protect brain cells, preserve brain activity, prevent seizures and improve neurobehavioral performance. These neuroprotective effects were not only free from side effects in the piglets but also associated with some cardiac, hemodynamic and ventilatory benefits unlike other promising compounds with neuroprotective activity. This data supports the view of CBD as a possible therapy for asphyxiated newborns. In a paper by Pazos et al. published in Neuropharmacology in 2012, post hypoxic-ischemic administration of CBD to newborn rats was shown to reduce the volume of brain damage, restore neurobehavioral function long term and reserve myelinization. In a second paper by Pazos et al., published in Neurpharmacology in 2013, reporting results from our pre-clinical collaboration, post hypoxic-ischemic administration of CBD was shown, in a piglet model, to reduce necrotic and apoptotic cell death, recover brain activity, restore neurobehavioral function in the short term and enhance hypothermia protection.

 

  41  

 

  

Our NHIE clinical program

 

We held a pre-IND meeting with the FDA to discuss the development program for an intravenous CBD formulation (GWP42003) in the treatment of NHIE. In April 2015, we received Orphan Drug Designation from the FDA for CBD for the treatment of NHIE and in July 2015 we received fast track designation. In July 2015 we received Orphan Drug Designation from the EMA for CBD for the treatment of perinatal asphyxia, an alternate term that describes the same condition. We commenced a Phase 1 trial of GWP42003 in healthy volunteers in the fourth quarter of 2016.

 

Glioma

 

Beyond epilepsy-related orphan diseases, we are evaluating a combination product containing GWP42002:GWP42003 (THC:CBD) in the treatment of recurrent glioblastoma multiforme, or GBM, a particularly aggressive brain tumor. We have received Orphan Drug Designation from the FDA for GWP 42002:GWP42003 combination for the treatment of GBM.

 

Market Overview

 

Glioma describes any tumor that arises from the glial tissue of the brain. Glioblastoma is a particularly aggressive tumor that forms from abnormal growth of glial tissue. According to the New England Journal of Medicine, GBM accounts for approximately 46 percent of the 22,500 new cases of brain cancer diagnosed in the United States each year. Treatment options are limited and expected survival is a little over one year. GBM is considered a rare disease by the FDA and the EMA.

 

Our Research

 

In pre-clinical models, we have shown cannabinoids to be orally active in the treatment of gliomas and, in addition, have shown tumor response to be positively associated with tissue levels of cannabinoids. We have identified the putative mechanism of action for our cannabinoid product candidates, where autophagy and programmed cell death are stimulated via inhibition of the akt/mTORC1 axis. We have shown in in vivo studies that cannabinoids have a synergistic effect with temozolomide, the standard chemotherapeutic agent used in the treatment of glioma.

 

A recent study carried out in collaboration with us by specialists at St. George’s University of London, was the first to show a dramatic effect on brain tumors when combining cannabinoids with irradiation. This research, published in Molecular Cancer Therapeutics, showed that tumor growth in mouse brain was significantly slowed when a combination of THC and CBD was used with irradiation and tumor inhibition was higher than observed with irradiation alone.

 

In light of this promising pre-clinical research, in 2014, we commenced an early proof of concept Phase 1b/2a clinical trial in 20 patients with recurrent GBM evaluating GWP42002:GWP42003 in combination with temozolomide, the current standard of care. This trial is a two-part study with an open-label phase to assess safety and tolerability followed by a double-blind, randomized, placebo-controlled phase with patients randomized to receive active or placebo. The first phase, an open-label safety evaluation of GWP42002:GWP42003 comprising two cohorts of three patients each completing two cycles (months) of treatment is complete. Safety data from these initial patient cohorts has been assessed by the independent safety monitoring board and their approval was given to proceed into the Phase 2a placebo-controlled phase of this trial.

 

We have now completed the placebo-controlled Phase 2a part of this trial, having enrolled 20 patients. Top-line data is expected in the first quarter of 2017. The primary outcome measure is 12 month progression free survival.

 

The principal cannabinoids we have studied in pre-clinical models of glioma are GWP42002 and GWP42003 in various ratios, and this first trial employs Sativex, which contains an equal ratio of GWP42002 and GWP42003, to establish a proof of principle. It is anticipated that subsequent development may focus on a product candidate with a different ratio of GWP42002 and GWP42003.

 

Other Pipeline Product Candidates

 

Schizophrenia

 

Market Overview

 

Schizophrenia is a chronic disease that manifests through disturbances of perception, thought, cognition, emotion, motivation and motor activity. Over a lifetime, about 1 percent of the population will develop schizophrenia. All anti-psychotic treatments for schizophrenia rely primarily upon their antagonistic action at the dopamine D2 receptor for their antipsychotic effect. They produce a wide range of adverse events, and are often poorly tolerated by patients resulting in poor compliance with treatment. Current antipsychotics also have little or no effect upon the “negative” symptoms (blunted mood and lack of pleasure, motivation and movement) of schizophrenia or the associated cognitive deficit. Furthermore, the “positive” symptoms (such as hallucinations, delusions and thought disorder) of at least one-third of patients fail to respond adequately to current treatments.

 

Our Research

 

GWP42003 has shown notable anti-psychotic effects in accepted pre-clinical models of schizophrenia and importantly has also demonstrated the ability to reduce the characteristic movement disorders induced by currently available anti-psychotic agents. In September 2015, we announced positive top line results from an exploratory Phase 2 placebo-controlled clinical trial of CBD in 88 patients with schizophrenia who had previously failed to respond adequately to first line anti-psychotic medications. Over a series of exploratory endpoints, CBD was consistently superior to placebo, with the most notable differences being in the PANSS positive sub-scale (p=0.018), the Clinical Global Impression of Severity (p=0.04) and Clinical Global Impression of Improvement (p=0.02). The proportion of responders (improvement in PANSS Total score greater than 20 percent) on CBD was higher than that of participants on placebo and the Scale for Assessment of Negative Symptoms showed a trend in favor of CBD which reached statistical significance for patients taking CBD together with one of the leading first line anti-psychotic medications. The safety profile of CBD was reassuring, with no serious adverse events and an overall frequency of adverse events very similar to placebo.

 

  42  

 

  

We believe that the signals of efficacy demonstrated in this trial, together with a notably reassuring safety profile, provide us with the prospect of new and distinct cannabinoid neuropsychiatric product pipeline opportunity as the mechanism of CBD does not appear to rely on the dopamine D2 receptor augmentation of standard antipsychotics. We are now analyzing the data to fully understand the appropriate next steps regarding product development in schizophrenia with future research likely focused on pediatric orphan neuropsychiatric indications. Additionally, our pre-clinical research findings suggest that a range of other psychiatric conditions may be promising targets for cannabinoid therapeutics.

 

Sativex for Cerebral Palsy in Children

 

We are currently conducting a Phase 2 clinical trial of Sativex to assess the efficacy, safety and tolerability of Sativex as an adjunctive treatment to existing anti-spasticity medications in children aged 8 to 18 years with spasticity due to cerebral palsy or traumatic central nervous system injury who have not responded adequately to existing anti-spasticity medications. This trial is a randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled trial followed by a 24-week open label extension phase and is now complete, having enrolled 70 patients. We expect to report data from this trial in the first quarter of 2017

 

Pre-clinical developments

 

In addition to our extensive in-house research organization, we have established a global network of leading scientists in the cannabinoid field. Our proprietary cannabinoid product platform allows us to discover, develop and commercialize additional novel first-in-class cannabinoid products across a broad range of therapeutic areas. Some of the more advanced programs include:

 

  The use of CBD and other cannabinoid candidates in Duchenne muscular dystrophy (DMD), the most common inherited lethal childhood orphan disease in the world, where new discoveries lead researchers to conclude that muscle cells respond positively to CBD by increasing metabolic output and improving mitochondrial function.

 

  In Glioma, cannabinoids induce glioma stem-like cell differentiation and inhibit gliomagenesis and research suggests that a combination of cannabinoids with other anticancer agents can eliminate GICs (Glioma Initiating Cells) which can cause recurrence of tumors after surgery. These findings are significant as GICs are resistant to most anticancer therapies and therefore reduce the apparent effectiveness of conventional brain cancer therapies.

 

  In various other cancers including ovarian and pancreatic cancer, pre-clinical research has shown that cannabinoids can act in concert with current cancer treatments such as chemotherapy and radiotherapy to enhance therapeutic response in animal models.

 

  The use of the cannabinoid CBG in the treatment of chemotherapy-induced cachexia where pre-clinical data supports a multi-modal action that includes a protective effect on overall loss of muscle mass, stimulation of feeding, and a normalized metabolic profile.

 

Our Commercialized Product: Sativex® for MS Spasticity

 

Sativex is an oromucosal spray of a formulated extract of the cannabis sativa plant that contains the principal cannabinoids THC and CBD as well as specific minor cannabinoids and other non-cannabinoid components. We developed Sativex to be administered as an oral spray, whereby the active ingredients are absorbed in the lining of the mouth, either under the tongue or inside the cheek. The product has been granted the U.S. Adopted Name, or USAN, of nabiximols.

 

Our licensing partners are commercializing Sativex for MS spasticity in 16 countries outside the United States. We have also received regulatory approval in an additional 14 countries, and we anticipate commercial launches in several of these countries in the next 12 months. Regulatory filings are ongoing in a number of additional countries, principally in the Middle East and Latin America where we expect approvals over the next 12 months.

 

MS Spasticity Indication in the United States

 

We previously opened an IND with the FDA for the MS spasticity indication and this has now been withdrawn.

 

Our Strategic Partnerships

 

To support the development and commercialization of Sativex, we have entered into license and development agreements with the following major pharmaceutical companies: Otsuka in the United States; Almirall S.A., or Almirall, in Europe (excluding the United Kingdom) and Mexico; Novartis Pharma AG, or Novartis, in Australia and New Zealand, Asia (excluding Japan, China and Hong Kong), the Middle East (excluding Israel) and Africa; Bayer HealthCare AG, or Bayer, in the United Kingdom and Canada; Ipsen Biopharm Ltd, or Ipsen, in Latin America (excluding Mexico and the Islands of the Caribbean); and Neopharm Group, or Neopharm, in Israel. These agreements provide our collaborators with the sole right to commercialize Sativex in exclusive territories for all indications. In November 2016 we entered into a mutual termination agreement with Novartis, pursuant to which rights in Sativex in Australia and New Zealand, Asia (excluding Japan, China and Hong Kong), the Middle East (excluding Israel) and Africa will be returned to GW over an agreed transition period, and we are in the process of appointing new distributors in the countries in the Novartis territories where Sativex is approved. From our incorporation through September 30, 2016, these agreements have yielded cash of £67.9 million in upfront fees and milestone payments. We are entitled to receive additional lump sum payments upon the achievement of certain regulatory and commercial milestones in the future, but are not relying on any of these milestones being achieved. Upon commercialization, we are also entitled to receive revenue from the supply of products as well as royalties on product sales. In addition, under the terms of our agreement with Otsuka, all pre-clinical and clinical costs associated with the development of Sativex in the United States are fully funded by Otsuka.

 

Following the failure of the Sativex cancer pain trials, GW Pharma and Otsuka expect to meet to discuss whether there are any next steps for Sativex in the United States within the scope of this partnership.

 

With the exception of Sativex, we retain global commercial rights to all of our other product pipeline candidates.

 

  43  

 

  

Our Proprietary Cannabinoid Product Platform

 

The cannabis plant is the unique source of more than 70 structurally-related, plant-derived cannabinoids. Although one cannabinoid, THC, is known to cause psychoactive effects associated with the use of illicit herbal cannabis, none of the other cannabinoids are known to share this property. In recent decades, there have been major scientific advances that have led to the discovery of new plant-derived cannabinoids and a cannabinoid receptor system in the human body, or endocannabinoid system. We are at the forefront of this new area of science, and we believe that our proprietary cannabinoid product platform uniquely positions us to discover and develop cannabinoids as new therapeutics. We are currently evaluating the potential for cannabinoids in the treatment of central nervous system, or CNS, disorders, including epilepsy, multiple sclerosis and schizophrenia, cancer and cancer pain, type-2 diabetes, and neurodegenerative disease.

 

Our proprietary cannabinoid product platform consists of our:

 

continually evolving library of internally generated novel cannabis plant types that produce selected cannabinoids, or chemotypes. We can reproduce the selected chemotypes through propagation of plant cuttings, or clones, in order to ensure that all subsequent plant material is genetically uniform. We can also generate seeds of selected chemotypes for large scale production;

 

  in-house extraction, processing methodologies and analytical techniques, which yield well-characterized and standardized chemotype extracts;

 

  discovery of novel cannabinoid pharmacology through conducting in vitro and in vivo pharmacologic evaluation studies in validated disease models to determine the most promising potential therapeutic areas for each extract;

 

  in-house formulation and manufacturing capabilities, supplemented by third party contractors;

 

  global in-house development and regulatory expertise; and

 

  intellectual property portfolio, which includes 67 patent families with issued and/or pending claims directed to plants, plant extracts, extraction technology, pharmaceutical formulations, drug delivery and the therapeutic uses of cannabinoids, as well as plant variety rights, know-how and trade secrets.

 

We believe that the successful development and regulatory approval of Sativex for MS spasticity provide important validation of our proprietary cannabinoid product platform.

 

The prospect for cannabinoid therapeutics to be approved through the FDA approval pathway has been the subject of statements from the White House, Congress, the Drug Enforcement Administration, or DEA, and the FDA. The White House Office of National Drug Control Policy states on its “Facts and Answers to the Frequently Asked Questions about Marijuana” on the White House website that the FDA has recognized and approved the medicinal use of isolated components of the marijuana plant and related synthetic compounds, and it specifically references Sativex as a product that is currently in late-stage clinical trials with the FDA. In its June 2012 report entitled “Reducing the U.S. Demand for Illegal Drugs,” the U.S. Senate Caucus on International Narcotics Control expresses the view that the development of marijuana-based therapeutics through an approved FDA process is the best route to explore and references Sativex as a promising product currently in the final phase of the FDA’s trials for approved use in the United States. In that report, the Senate Caucus urged the FDA to complete a careful review of Sativex in a timely manner. In its May 2014 report entitled “The Dangers and Consequences of Marijuana Abuse,” the DEA expresses support for ongoing research into potential medicinal uses of marijuana’s active ingredients, and specifically references Sativex and Epidiolex. A presentation in March 2015 by Douglas C. Throckmorton, Deputy Director for Regulatory Programs, Center for Drug Evaluation and Review, FDA, referenced Epidiolex and Sativex as examples of drugs in clinical testing, and concluded that drug development, grounded in rigorous scientific research is essential to determining the appropriate uses of marijuana in the treatment of human disease, and that the FDA is committed to making this process as efficient as possible and looking for ways to speed the availability of new drugs from marijuana for the American public. Further, in his statement before the Subcommittee on Crime and Terrorism, Committee on the Judiciary, U.S. Senate on “Researching the Potential Medical Benefits and Risks of Marijuana” on July 13, 2016, Douglas C. Throckmorton, Deputy Director for Regulatory Programs, Center for Drug Evaluation and Research, FDA, described how development programs for drugs derived from marijuana are eligible for certain FDA expedited review and development programs under appropriate circumstances, and some are being used to aid the development of drugs derived from marijuana, giving the examples of FDA’s grant of Fast Track designation to Sativex for the treatment of pain in patients with advanced cancer, who experience inadequate analgesia during optimized chronic opioid therapy, and Epidiolex, in the treatment of Dravet syndrome. He concluded that there is considerable public interest in developing new therapies from marijuana and its constituents, and FDA will continue to play its role in ensuring that any such new therapies are safe, effective, and manufactured to a high quality, applying the drug development paradigm that continues to provide new medicines that meet these standards for patients.

 

  44  

 

  

Our Strengths

 

We believe that we offer the following key distinguishing characteristics:

 

  A late stage product, Epidiolex, in pediatric epilepsy for which we have generated positive Phase 3 data .  We have reported positive Phase 3 data for Epidiolex in both Dravet syndrome and LGS. Each of these conditions is a severe, infantile-onset, genetic, drug-resistant epilepsy syndrome for which we have secured Orphan Drug Designation from the FDA. We expect to submit an NDA to the FDA at the end of the first half of 2017.

 

  Additional indications for Epidiolex to expand epilepsy market opportunity .  We believe that there is potential for the development of Epidiolex in additional rare childhood-onset epilepsy indications. Physician reported data on patients receiving Epidiolex under physician-led INDs includes promising signals of clinical effect in patients with conditions other than Dravet syndrome and LGS. One of these additional indications is TSC, and we commenced Phase 3 development in this indication in April 2016. Another is IS, and we commenced clinical development in the IS indication in the fourth quarter of 2016, and there are additional potential target indications under consideration for future development.

 

  We retain global commercial rights to Epidiolex and believe it has significant market potential .  We are building a U.S. commercial organization led by Julian Gangolli as President, North America, who joined us in June 2015 having previously held the same position at Allergan. We have also recruited U.S. medical affairs, clinical trials and commercial staff, many of whom have strong epilepsy knowledge and experience. There is a significant unmet need within the field of epilepsy and we believe that U.S. physician awareness and enthusiasm for Epidiolex is high.

  

  Commercialized product validates development and regulatory pathway .  We believe that the successful development and regulatory approval of Sativex in MS spasticity outside the United States provides important validation of our proprietary cannabinoid product platform. On this basis, we believe that we can develop a portfolio of additional cannabinoid therapeutics.

  

  Additional pipeline programs within epilepsy, autism, and pediatric neurology .  We are in Phase 2 clinical development for an additional product candidate, GWP42006 (CBDV), in adult epilepsy patients. GWP42006 has also shown promising pre-clinical data within the field of ASDs and we expect to commence Phase 2 development in this therapeutic area in the third quarter of 2017. We have received Orphan Drug Designation from the FDA for CBDV for the treatment of Rett syndrome. In addition, we have received Orphan Drug Designation from the FDA for CBD in the treatment of NHIE and commenced Phase 1 development of an intravenous CBD formulation in the treatment of NHIE in the fourth quarter of 2016.

  

  A pipeline of additional cannabinoid orphan and non-orphan drug opportunities for which we retain global commercial rights .  We have completed a Phase 1b/2a trial of another product, our combination GWP42002:GWP42003, to treat GBM and expect to report top-line data in the first quarter of 2017. We have successfully completed a Phase 2 trial in schizophrenia for our product candidate, GWP42003.

 

  Opportunity for first-in-class treatments across a large number of therapeutic targets .  We are at the forefront of the commercialization of cannabinoid therapeutics using our proprietary product platform to identify, validate and develop innovative first-in-class therapeutics that are designed to meet significant unmet medical needs.

 

  Strong competitive position in a highly specialized and regulated field .  We believe that we are uniquely positioned to benefit from the significant potential within the field of cannabinoid therapeutics in which we have developed a successful track record and expertise, as well as an intellectual property portfolio, during our 18 years of operations.

 

  In-house manufacturing capabilities and expertise in controlled substances .  We operate under Good Manufacturing Practice commercial manufacturing licenses in the United Kingdom, which give us the capability to supply our products to global markets. We have successfully exported cannabinoid commercial or research materials to over 30 countries and have substantial expertise in relevant international and national regulations in relation to the research, distribution and commercialization of cannabinoid therapeutics.

 

  Highly experienced management team and network of leading scientists .  Several members of our leadership team have been in place for over ten years. We have a fully integrated in-house research and development organization, regulatory capabilities and commercial manufacturing expertise. We closely collaborate with a broad network of leading scientists in the cannabinoid field.

 

Our Business Strategy

 

Our goal is to capitalize on our leading position in the field of plant-derived cannabinoid therapeutics by pursuing the following strategies:

 

  Secure regulatory approval and launch using our own commercial organization our lead product candidate Epidiolex in Dravet syndrome and LGS in the United States and around the world .  We have reported positive Phase 3 data in Dravet syndrome and LGS, held pre-NDA meetings with FDA regarding our filing approach and expect to submit a NDA to the FDA at the end of the first half of 2017. We also expect to submit a regulatory application in Europe in the second half of 2017, and also have future plans to submit applications elsewhere around the world. We are building U.S. and European commercial organizations in preparation for potential launch of Epidiolex.

 

  Expand the market opportunity for Epidiolex within the field of epilepsy .  We have commenced Phase 3 clinical development of Epidiolex for TSC and clinical development of Epidiolex for IS in the fourth quarter of 2016. We are evaluating additional indications for Epidiolex within the field of epilepsy.

 

  45  

 

  

  Develop additional product candidates within the field of epilepsy and pediatric neurology .  We have a second product candidate, GWP42006, for which a Phase 2 clinical trial in epilepsy is underway with data expected mid 2017. We expect to commence Phase 2 development of GWP42006 in the field of ASD in the third quarter of 2017. We also commenced a Phase 1 clinical trial in 2016 for an intravenous CBD formulation in the treatment of NHIE. In addition, following positive proof-of-concept data in a Phase 2 schizophrenia trial, we expect to conduct further research within the field of psychiatric disease in children. We retain global commercial rights to these programs.

 

  Leverage our proprietary cannabinoid product platform to discover, develop and commercialize additional novel first-in-class cannabinoid products .  We believe our established platform, including our in-house development expertise, allows us to achieve candidate selection and proof-of-concept in an efficient manner.

 

  Further strengthen our competitive position .  We will continue to develop our extensive international network of the most prominent scientists in the cannabinoid field and secure additional intellectual property rights.

 

Our Proprietary Cannabinoid Product Platform

 

We believe we have established a world-leading position in cannabinoid therapeutics through our proven proprietary cannabinoid product platform. Our platform consists of a continually evolving library of internally generated novel cannabis plant types that produce selected cannabinoids, discovery of novel cannabinoid pharmacology through our network of world leading scientists, an intellectual property portfolio, in-house formulation, processing and manufacturing capabilities, and development and regulatory expertise. We further believe that we are in a unique position to develop and manufacture plant-derived cannabinoid formulations worldwide at sufficient quality, uniformity, scale and sophistication for the purposes of pharmaceutical development and to meet international regulatory requirements.

 

  46  

 

   

Cannabinoid Science Overview

 

Although one cannabinoid, THC, is known to cause psychoactive effects associated with the use of illicit herbal cannabis, none of the other cannabinoids are known to share these properties. In recent decades, there have been major scientific advances that have led to the discovery of new plant-derived cannabinoids and the endocannabinoid system. We are at the forefront of this new area of science and our research into a large number of these cannabinoids suggests that each has distinct pharmacological effects and potential therapeutic applications.

 

Our research to date has focused on the following plant-based cannabinoids:

 

CBD (Cannabidiol) CBN (Cannabinol)
CBDV (Cannabidivarin) CBNV (Cannabinovarin)
CBDA (Cannabidiol—Acid) D8-THC (Delta-8 Tetrahydrocannabinol)
CBDVA (Cannabidivarin—Acid) THC (Delta-9 Tetrahydrocannabinol)
CBC (Cannabichromene) THCA (Tetrahydrocannabinol—Acid)
CBG (Cannabigerol) THCV (Tetrahydrocannabivarin)
CBGA (Cannabigerol—Acid) THCVA (Tetrahydrocannabivarin—Acid)
CBGV (Cannabigerovarin)  

 

Initial academic research in the field of cannabinoid science focused almost exclusively on THC. It has been widely published in scientific literature that THC has pain suppression, anti-spasmodic, anti-tremor, anti-inflammatory, appetite stimulant and anti-nausea properties. Our research and development, however, has focused primarily on exploring cannabinoids other than THC and identifying potential therapeutic applications of these other cannabinoids. We have focused particularly on CBD, which has shown in pre-clinical testing conducted by us and supported by publications in scientific literature to have anti-inflammatory, anti-convulsant, anti-psychotic, anti-oxidant, neuroprotective and immunomodulatory effects. In addition, we believe CBD is not intoxicating as evidenced by its distinct pharmacology from THC as well as evidence from clinical trials. In particular, the intoxicating effects of THC result from its activity as a partial agonist at the CB1 receptor; CBD does not have this same pharmacologic activity. There is a significant body of scientific literature on the properties of CBD, which consistently describes CBD as a cannabinoid without psychotropic effects. Furthermore, according to publications in scientific literature, in particular pre-clinical research published by Zuardi, et al. in the Journal of Psychopharmacology 1982 and clinical research published by Karniol, et al. in the European Journal of Pharmacology 1974, research suggests that the presence of CBD may mitigate some of the side-effects of THC. We have also identified important pharmacological effects of other cannabinoids, such as the anti-convulsant effects of CBDV, anti-diabetic effects of THCV, anti-nausea effects of CBDA and anti-cancer effects of CBG.

 

There are at least two types of cannabinoid receptors, CB1 and CB2, in the human endocannabinoid system. CB1 receptors are considered to be among the most widely expressed G protein-coupled receptors in the brain and are particularly abundant in areas of the brain concerned with movement and postural control, pain and sensory perception, memory, cognition, emotion, and autonomic and endocrine function. CB1 receptors are also found in peripheral tissues including peripheral nerves and non-neuronal tissues such as muscle, liver tissues and fat. CB2 receptors are expressed primarily in tissues in the immune system and are believed to mediate the immunological effects of cannabinoids. In addition, research suggests the endocannabinoid system interacts with other important neurotransmitter and neuromodulatory systems in the human body, including TRP channels, adenosine uptake and serotonin receptors. We believe that the far-reaching and diverse pharmacology of the numerous cannabinoids provides significant potential for development of cannabinoid therapeutics across many indications and disease areas.

 

Our Product Development Approach

 

Our approach to early product development of novel cannabinoids consists of the following stages:

 

Cannabinoid Chemotype Development. Our research activities commence with the generation of novel and proprietary cannabinoid plant types that produce selected cannabinoids. Our plant geneticists breed unique and protected “chemotypes,” or plants characterized by their chemical content, such that we can precisely control the cannabinoid composition of a plant. We employ traditional methods of plant breeding, with no use of genetic modification. We select chemotypes on the basis of their cannabinoid profile, appropriate levels of concentration and botanical characteristics that enable commercial viability. We seek protection for chemotypes in the form of plant variety rights, which protect the plants and the material obtained therefrom in Europe.

 

  47  

 

  

Extract Preparation. After we generate the unique and protected chemotypes, we develop and characterize preparations from an extract of the chemotype. In addition to preparing whole plant extracts, we also modify the extract preparations by adding or removing certain components or purifying preparations to produce a purified cannabinoid. Each of these steps may give rise to patentable opportunities.

 

Pharmacologic Evaluation. We then conduct in vitro and in vivo pharmacologic evaluation studies in validated disease models, testing the potential activity, safety and routes of drug metabolism of each cannabinoid preparation as well as combinations of preparations. These studies seek to identify the pharmacology of cannabinoid preparations and allow us to determine the potential therapeutic area in which they might have promise. We then conduct additional pharmacology, toxicology and pre-clinical development on promising preparations.

 

We conduct most of our pharmacologic evaluations in collaboration with cannabinoid scientists at academic institutions around the world. We enter into research collaboration agreements and other arrangements that enable us to benefit from the expertise of external scientists while retaining intellectual property rights that emerge from the study of our research materials.

 

Product Composition and Formulation Development. In parallel with the later stages of pharmacological evaluation, we identify optimum extraction and processing methods for the most promising preparations and then develop clinical formulations from the plant extract and analytical methodologies to further study the formulations. We are able to develop formulations of potential product candidates that focus on one or more cannabinoids as key active constituents as well as formulations that focus on a single cannabinoid. Each of these steps may give rise to patentable opportunities.

 

With respect to complex extracts, our formulation approach is exemplified by Sativex, the first approved cannabinoid therapeutic based on whole plant extracts from the cannabis plant. The main active ingredients of Sativex, THC and CBD, are extracted from two protected chemotypes. In addition to THC and CBD, Sativex contains additional cannabinoid and non-cannabinoid plant components. In order to achieve a fully standardized formulation of these complex extracts, we employ a range of advanced analytical technologies to demonstrate batch-to-batch uniformity. We standardize the formulation across the extracts as a whole, not simply by reference to their key active components.

 

With respect to pure cannabinoid formulations, our approach is exemplified by Epidiolex. The active ingredient, CBD, is extracted from proprietary CBD containing chemotypes and then undergoes various processing steps to generate the isolated pure compound.

 

Clinical development. Selected cannabinoid product candidates progress into clinical development. We have an in-house clinical operations team that has the proven capability to execute Phase 1, 2 and 3 trials rapidly and cost-effectively. Since our inception, we have undertaken an extensive program of clinical trials in over 4,000 patients, including over 40 Phase 2 and Phase 3 trials and have undertaken post-market safety studies involving over 1,000 patients.

 

Cannabinoid Product Production Process

 

There are three principal steps in the manufacturing process for Sativex and our cannabinoid product candidates—production of botanical raw material, or BRM, botanical drug substance, or BDS, and botanical drug product, or BDP, in each instance as defined by FDA Guidance for Industry—Botanical Drug Products. We hold inventories of BRM and BDS, both of which have extended shelf lives that enable us to manufacture BDP on demand. We have in-house facilities that can perform all steps in the production process.

 

BRM Production. Each of our product candidates is derived from one or more selected chemotypes. For products such as Sativex that comprise complex extracts, we reproduce the chemotype solely through propagation of plant cuttings, or clones, in order to ensure that all subsequent plant material is genetically uniform. The plants are then grown under highly controlled conditions in indoor glasshouses, in which all key features of the growing climate and growing process are standardized. Plant material is grown throughout the year and batches are harvested each week. Following harvest, plant material is dried and milled under standardized conditions. For pure cannabinoid product candidates, such as Epidiolex, selected chemotypes can be grown in a range of conditions to produce plant material that meets the necessary specifications for further processing. The BRM for Sativex and our other pipeline product candidates are sourced from either our own in-house growing operations or from growing sub-contractors.

 

  48  

 

  

BDS Production. BRM from each chemotype is processed and controlled separately to yield a well-characterized and standardized extract as our BDS for a particular product or product candidate. Conversion from BRM to BDS involves several processing steps as well as employment of extraction technologies. A proprietary liquid carbon dioxide extraction method is employed for Sativex production. For Epidiolex, the BDS undergoes subsequent processing steps to yield pure CBD.

 

BDP Production. BDP is the finished product manufactured from one or more BDSs at our in-house manufacturing facility. We manufacture Sativex and our other product candidates through a controlled series of processes resulting in a reproducible finished product manufactured to GMP standards. We are able to manufacture spray products (such as Sativex), liquids (such as Epidiolex) and capsules.

 

Advantages of Our Approach

 

We believe that our focus on the development of therapeutics from plant-derived cannabinoids offers the following important advantages:

 

Our approach offers advantages over development programs that focus on synthetic single-target potent molecules. There is an increasing recognition within the pharmaceutical industry that the aetiology of complex disease is multifactorial and that improved treatments will involve multiple or poly-pharmacology. We believe that the development of plant extract formulations containing one or more principal cannabinoids offers a multi-target profile designed to address many of the causative factors of complex diseases.

 

  Our approach is optimally suited to targeting the endocannabinoid system. This system has been shown to be altered by, and to contribute to, several chronic conditions, especially involving the CNS. The inherent complexity of this system and the ability of one part of the system to compensate for abnormalities elsewhere in the system make the “single-target” approach to therapeutics unlikely to be successful.

 

  Our platform enables us to evaluate the therapeutic potential of single cannabinoids as well as combinations of cannabinoids. As demonstrated with Sativex, this approach offers the prospect of developing a product that enhances the efficacy and safety features of one cannabinoid with complementary features of another cannabinoid while remaining defined as a single new medicinal entity by regulatory authorities.

 

  Our research has generated pre-clinical evidence in a number of disease areas where cannabinoids contained within plant extract formulations may offer superior therapeutic promise compared with the corresponding pure cannabinoids.

 

  The chemical complexity of our plant-based formulations provides additional hurdles for potential generic competitors who will be required to demonstrate essential similarity.

 

  49  

 

  

Sativex Collaboration Agreements

 

We have entered into six separate collaboration agreements for Sativex with major pharmaceutical companies. Each agreement provides the respective partner with exclusive rights in a defined geographic territory to commercialize Sativex in all indications, while we retain the exclusive right to manufacture and supply Sativex to such partner on commercial supply terms for the duration of the commercial life of the product. These agreements typically carry a 15 year initial term, with automatic renewal periods. Our partners have the right, under certain circumstances, to terminate their agreements with us, and three of our partners, Almirall, Otsuka and Novartis, have the right to terminate their agreements with us without cause. In November 2016 we entered into a mutual termination agreement with Novartis, pursuant to which rights in Sativex in Australia and New Zealand, Asia (excluding Japan, China and Hong Kong), the Middle East (excluding Israel) and Africa will be returned to GW over an agreed transition period.

 

Each of our remaining collaboration agreements for Sativex incorporates different supply and royalty terms. With the exception of the Novartis agreement, described below, each of our supply agreements requires us to supply fully labeled Sativex vials at a price that is expressed as a percentage of a partner’s in-market net sales revenue. In some cases, part of this revenue is structured as a combination of product supply price plus a royalty, although both types of revenue are accounted for similarly. Sativex supply revenue is invoiced when product inventory is delivered to or collected by the marketing partner. Royalties will be received in arrears based upon quarterly in- market net sales declarations from partners.

 

The price charged for Sativex in the market is controlled by our marketing partners. However, our contracts do not anticipate us being obligated to supply Sativex at a loss. In such event, if the in-market supply price would cause us to supply Sativex at a loss we would have the right to renegotiate supply terms to prevent this. For example, following the price reduction in Germany in March 2013, the resultant supply price would have led to us providing Sativex to our partner, Almirall, at a loss. We completed an amendment to the supply terms with Almirall in 2014, and this amendment provides for us to generate a margin on supply of product for countries in which a price reduction would otherwise have led to us supplying product at a loss.

 

Please see Note 3 to our audited consolidated financial statements included as part of this Annual Report for a breakdown of our revenue by geographic location.

 

Sativex in the United States

 

In 2007, we entered into a Sativex U.S. license agreement with Otsuka, the Japanese pharmaceutical company.

 

Under the terms of the Sativex U.S. license agreement, we granted Otsuka an exclusive license to develop and market Sativex in the United States. We are responsible for the manufacture and supply of Sativex to Otsuka. Both companies jointly oversee all U.S. clinical development and regulatory activities for the first cancer pain indication. We will be the holder of the IND until the filing of an NDA, which will be in Otsuka’s name. Otsuka will assume development and regulatory responsibility for the second and any subsequent indications. Otsuka will bear the costs of all U.S. development activities for Sativex in the treatment of cancer pain, additional indications and future formulations.

 

  50  

 

  

The financial terms of this agreement include total milestone payments and license fees to us of up to $272.0 million, of which approximately $18.0 million relates to license fees, $54.0 million are linked to regulatory milestones, such as initiation of Phase 3 trials, submission of an NDA to the FDA and other regulatory approvals, and $200.0 million are linked to various commercial milestones, as well as revenue from the supply of products and royalties on product sales. Our combined supply price and royalty to Otsuka equates to a percentage in the mid-twenties of Otsuka’s in-market net sales revenue. Otsuka paid us the license fee of $18.0 million upfront and has since paid an additional milestone payment of $4.0 million upon commencing the first Phase 3 clinical trial in cancer pain.

 

Sativex in Latin America, Asia, the Middle East and Africa

 

Novartis Pharma AG. In 2011, we entered into an exclusive agreement with Novartis to commercialize Sativex in Australia and New Zealand, Asia (excluding Japan, China and Hong Kong), the Middle East (excluding Israel) and Africa.

 

Under the terms of this agreement, Novartis had exclusive commercialization rights to Sativex in the above-mentioned territories and will act as the marketing authorization holder for Sativex. We will be responsible for the manufacture and supply of Sativex to Novartis.

 

The financial terms of the agreement included an upfront fee of $5.0 million from Novartis.

 

In November 2016 we entered into a mutual termination agreement with Novartis, pursuant to which rights in Sativex in these territories. As this agreement has now been terminated we will not receive any further lump sum or other payments from Novartis. However, we are in the process of identifying and appointing third parties to distribute Sativex on GW’s behalf in the countries within the former Novartis territories in which Sativex is approved is likely to be approved in the near future.

 

Ipsen Biopharm Ltd. In 2014, we entered into an exclusive agreement with Ipsen. Under the terms of this agreement, Ipsen will promote and distribute Sativex in Latin America (excluding Mexico and the Islands of the Caribbean).

 

Neopharm Group. Under an agreement signed in 2010, Neopharm, an Israeli pharmaceutical company, holds exclusive commercial rights to Sativex in Israel. The financial terms of this agreement did not include a license fee and we are not entitled to any milestone payments. We will receive revenue from the supply of products to Neopharm, expected to equate to a percentage equal to forty to fifty of Neopharm’s in-market net sales revenue.

 

Under the terms of this agreement, Neopharm acts as market authorization holder in the territory. We are responsible for commercial product supply to Neopharm for which we generate sales revenue.

 

Sativex in the European Union

 

Almirall S.A. In 2005, we entered into an exclusive agreement with Almirall, an international pharmaceutical company with headquarters in Spain and 2015 total revenue of €769.0 million, to commercialize Sativex in the European Union (excluding the United Kingdom) and E.U. accession countries, as well as Switzerland, Norway and Turkey. In 2012, this agreement was amended to add Mexico to the licensed territory. In countries where Almirall has no direct presence at the time of product launch, we will jointly agree on the appointment of distribution partners. In such countries, we may elect to distribute the product ourselves.

 

  51  

 

  

Under the agreement, we are the marketing authorization holder for Sativex in all countries in the territory except where local regulations require a locally registered entity to assume this responsibility. In addition, we are responsible for commercial product supply to Almirall. The financial terms of the agreement included an upfront fee of £12.0 million. In addition, milestone payments are payable to us upon the successful completion of certain development activities, as well as on regulatory approvals and the achievement of specified sales targets. Since its initial execution in 2005, the agreement has been the subject of various amendments, two of which included the provision of new milestone payments. Since 2005, in total, we have received £20.8 million of milestone payments from Almirall. We have the potential to receive a further £17.0 million in future milestone payments in the event that the relevant milestones are achieved. Of such £17.0 million in potential future milestone payments, £4.0 million are linked to regulatory and clinical milestones and £13.0 million are linked to commercial milestones. We also receive revenue from the supply of Sativex, currently equating to a percentage in the low to mid-twenties of Almirall’s in-market net sales revenue, a percentage which is subject to a floor price. This percentage would increase to the mid-thirties if Sativex is approved for cancer pain in Europe.

 

Bayer HealthCare AG. In 2003, we entered into an agreement with Bayer whereby we granted Bayer an exclusive license to market Sativex in the United Kingdom. This agreement was amended later in 2003 to include Canada.

 

Under the agreement, we are the marketing authorization holder for Sativex in the United Kingdom and Canada. In addition, we are responsible for commercial product supply to Bayer.

 

The financial terms of the agreement included an upfront fee of £5.0 million. In addition, milestone payments are payable on the successful completion of certain development activities, as well as on regulatory approvals and the achievement of specified sales targets. Since its initial execution in 2003, the agreement has been the subject of various amendments, one of which included the provision of new milestone payments. In total, we have received £19.8 million in milestone payments from Bayer. We have the potential to receive a further £9.0 million in milestone payments in the event that the relevant milestones are achieved, all of which are related to future regulatory approvals. We also receive revenue from supply of Sativex, equating to a percentage in the mid-thirties to forty of Bayer’s in-market net sales revenue.

 

Intellectual Property and Technology Licenses

 

Our success depends in significant part on our ability to protect the proprietary nature of Sativex, Epidiolex, our other product candidates, technology and know-how, to operate without infringing on the proprietary rights of others, and to defend challenges and oppositions from others and prevent others from infringing on our proprietary rights. We have sought, and plan to continue to seek, patent protection in the United States and other countries for our proprietary technologies. Our intellectual property portfolio at September 30, 2016, includes 67 patent families with issued and/or pending claims directed to plants, plant extracts, extraction technology, pharmaceutical formulations, drug delivery and the therapeutic uses of cannabinoids, as well as plant variety rights, know-how and trade secrets. From these families, as of September 30, 2016, we own 242 pending patent applications worldwide. Within the United States, we already have 35 issued patents with a further 35 pending patent applications under active prosecution. There are an additional 478 issued patents outside of the United States. Our policy is to seek patent protection for the technology, inventions and improvements that we consider important to the development of our business, but only in those cases where we believe that the costs of obtaining patent protection is justified by the commercial potential of the technology, and typically only in those jurisdictions that we believe present significant commercial opportunities.

 

We also rely on trademarks, trade secrets, know-how and continuing innovation to develop and maintain our competitive position.

 

Our strategy is to seek and obtain patents related to Sativex across all major pharmaceutical markets around the world. In the United States, our patents and/or pending applications (if they were to issue) relating to Sativex would expire on various dates between 2021 and 2026, excluding possible patent term extensions. We have at least seven different patent families containing one or more pending and/or issued patents directed to the Sativex formulation, the extracts from which Sativex is composed, the extraction technique used to produce the extracts and the therapeutic use of Sativex.

 

Under the 2007 research collaboration agreement with Otsuka, which expired in June 2013, all intellectual property (including both patents and non-manufacturing related know-how) that was conceived by either Otsuka or us during the course of the collaboration is jointly owned by Otsuka and us, and is referred to as “collaboration IP.” Since no product/product candidate(s) were licensed by Otsuka at the end of the collaboration, we have an exclusive sub-licensable royalty-bearing license to use collaboration IP both outside and within the fields of CNS and oncology.

 

Under the collaboration agreement, we are responsible for the filing, prosecution, maintenance and defense of any patents filed on the jointly owned collaboration IP, and Otsuka is responsible for all out-of-pocket expenses associated therewith. In the event Otsuka no longer wishes to reimburse us for our out-of-pocket costs associated with any of the jointly owned patents, Otsuka is required to assign its rights to the patents in question back to us. Otsuka has the first right to bring and control any action for infringement of any joint patent rights in the research field, and we have the right to join such action at our own expense. In the event Otsuka fails to bring such an action, we have the right to bring and control any such action at our own expense. Neither party shall have the right to settle any infringement litigation regarding the joint patent rights inside the research field without the prior written consent of the other party.

 

  52  

 

  

We have a portfolio of intellectual property relating to the use of CBD in epilepsy. This portfolio includes twelve distinct patent families which are either granted or filed. The latest expiry date of these families runs to July 2036. Two of these patent families are collaboration IP derived from the now expired Otsuka research collaboration, and to which we have an exclusive sub-licensable royalty-bearing license. This portfolio includes patent families with claims directed to the use of CBD in the treatment of epilepsy seizure subtypes, particular childhood epilepsy syndromes and formulations. To date we have been successful in defending our granted CBD patents against oppositions and like challenges, with our European patent claiming the use of CBD in the treatment of partial seizures being upheld by the EPO at first instance. We have 2 patents granted by the USPTO and numerous patent applications being prosecuted at the USPTO. We anticipate filing additional patent applications claiming the use of Epidiolex in 2017 as new data is generated, and expect more of our pending patent applications to be granted by USPTO during 2017. Should the NDA for Epidiolex be approved we expect a number of these granted patent to be listed in the Approved Drug Products with Therapeutic Equivalence Evaluations, or Orange Book. In addition other patent families provide protection for epilepsy related inventions such as extraction techniques, CBD extracts and highly purified CBD.

 

We have a portfolio of intellectual property relating to CBD in schizophrenia. This portfolio includes two distinct patent families which are either granted or filed, protecting the use of this product candidate. One of these patent families is collaboration IP derived from the now expired Otsuka research collaboration, and to which we have an exclusive sub-licensable royalty-bearing license. The latest expiry date of these families runs to September 2035. These patent families include claims to use of CBD alone or in combination with other cannabinoids / anti-psychotics in the treatment of schizophrenia as well as other families which provide protection for compositions, extraction techniques, CBD extracts and highly purified CBD. We anticipate additional patent applications being filed as new data is generated.

 

We have a portfolio of intellectual property relating to CBDV for use in various indications including epilepsy and autism spectrum disorder. This portfolio includes patent families which are either granted or filed, protecting the use of this product candidate. One of these patent families is collaboration IP derived from the now expired Otsuka research collaboration, and to which we have an exclusive sub-licensable royalty-bearing license. The latest expiry date of these families runs to April 2036. These patent families include claims to use of CBDV alone or in combination with standard anti-epileptic drugs in the treatment of seizures, the use of CBDV in the treatment of autism spectrum disorders and associated conditions. Other families which provide protection for the use of CBDV in other therapeutic areas such as neuropathic pain, Alzheimer’s disease and Duchenne’s disease, CBDV compositions and CBDV extracts. We anticipate additional patent applications being filed as new data is generated.

 

We have a portfolio of intellectual property relating to CBD and THC for use in the treatment of glioma. This portfolio includes six distinct patent families which are either granted or filed, protecting the use of these product candidates in glioma. One of these patent families is collaboration IP derived from the now expired Otsuka research collaboration, and to which we have an exclusive sub-licensable royalty-bearing license. The latest expiry date of these families runs to June 2034. These patent families include claims to use of THC and CBD in various ratios either alone or in combination with chemotherapeutic drugs or radiotherapy in the treatment of glioma.

 

The term of individual patents depends upon the countries in which they are obtained. In most countries in which we have filed, the patent term is 20 years from the earliest date of filing a non-provisional patent application. In the United States, a patent’s term may be lengthened by patent term adjustment, which compensates a patentee for administrative delays by the U.S. Patent and Trademark Office, or PTO, in granting a patent, or may be shortened if a patent is terminally disclaimed over another patent.

 

The term of a patent that covers an FDA-approved drug may also be eligible for extension, which permits term restoration as compensation for the term lost during the FDA regulatory review process. The Drug Price Competition and Patent Term Restoration Act of 1984, or the Hatch-Waxman Act, permits an extension of up to five years beyond the expiration of the patent. The length of the patent term extension is related to the length of time the drug is under regulatory review. Extensions cannot extend the remaining term of a patent beyond 14 years from the date of product approval and only one patent applicable to an approved drug may be extended. Similar provisions to extend the term of a patent that covers an approved drug are available in Europe and other non-U.S. jurisdictions; indeed Supplementary Protection Certificates have been applied for such that the European formulation patent for Sativex will be extended to 2025 in Europe. In the future, if and when our pharmaceutical product candidates receive FDA approval, we may apply for extensions on patents covering those products.

 

  53  

 

  

To protect our rights to any of our issued patents and proprietary information, we may need to litigate against infringing third parties, avail ourselves of the courts or participate in hearings to determine the scope and validity of those patents or other proprietary rights.

 

We also rely on trade secret protection for our confidential and proprietary information, and it is our policy to require our employees, consultants, outside scientific collaborators, sponsored researchers and other advisors to execute confidentiality agreements upon the commencement of employment or consulting relationships with us.

 

From time to time, in the normal course of our operations, we will be a party to litigation and other dispute matters and claims relating to intellectual property. Litigation can be expensive and disruptive to normal business operations. Moreover, the results of complex legal proceedings are difficult to predict and our view of these matters may change in the future as the litigation and events related thereto unfold. An unfavorable outcome to any legal matter, if material, could have a materially adverse effect on our operations or our financial position, liquidity or results of operations.

 

In June 2016 our wholly-owned subsidiary GW Pharma Limited settled a claim of trademark infringement by G&W Laboratories for the use of the GW PHARMACEUTICALS name and logo in the US.

 

Manufacturing

 

We are responsible for the manufacture and supply of our products for commercial and clinical trial purposes. We operate under GMP manufacturing licenses issued by the Medicines and Healthcare products Regulatory Agency, or MHRA, in the United Kingdom and our facilities have been audited by the MHRA on several occasions. We have personnel with extensive experience in production of botanical raw material, pharmaceutical production, quality control, quality assurance and supply chain.

 

For commercial Sativex production, the BRM is currently contracted to an external third party, although our staff is at the contract site to monitor activity and production quality on a weekly basis. All other steps in the commercial production process for Sativex are performed in-house. We routinely hold significant inventories of Sativex BRM and BDS, both of which have extended shelf lives that enable us to manufacture finished product on demand. We believe that these inventories are currently sufficient to enable us to continue to meet anticipated commercial demand for Sativex in the event of an interruption in our supply of BRM.

 

We are in the process of expanding and upgrading parts of our manufacturing facilities in order to meet future demand and FDA requirements. We are constructing a new BDS production facility at our current site where we expect to install new BDS processing equipment. Construction work for this new facility commenced in September 2013 and was completed in May 2016. Longer term, depending on volume requirements, we anticipate the need to construct a new BDP facility.

 

For Epidiolex production, the BRM is currently contracted to the same external third party used for Sativex production plus an additional third party. We plan to continue expansion of our Epidiolex plant growing capacity well beyond our exit 2016 levels and to this end GW recently signed an agreement with a new third party that enables GW to treble its growing capacity from 2017 onwards. We will also work with several new third party contractors and adopt new methods in order to handle and process bulk quantities of BRM. All other steps in the production process for Epidiolex are currently performed in-house and we are working with a number of third party contractors in the scale-up of various steps in the process in order to be in a position to manufacture commercial quantities.

 

  54  

 

  

We have successfully exported cannabinoid commercial or research materials to over 30 countries and have the necessary in-house expertise to manage the import/export process worldwide. We have substantial expertise in, and experience with, relevant international and national regulations in relation to the research, distribution and commercialization of cannabinoid therapeutics. We have formed relationships with relevant international and national agencies in order to enable licensing of research sites, establishing appropriate product distribution channels and securing licensed storage, obtaining import/export licenses, and facilitating amendments to relevant legislation if required prior to commercialization.

 

Competition

  

The biotechnology and pharmaceutical industries are characterized by rapidly advancing technologies, intense competition and a strong emphasis on proprietary products. While we believe that our scientific knowledge, technology and development experience provide us with competitive advantages, we face potential competition from many different sources, including major pharmaceutical, specialty pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies, academic institutions, governmental agencies and public and private research institutions. Any product candidates that we successfully develop and commercialize will compete with existing therapies and new therapies that may become available in the future.

 

A synthetic THC (dronabinol) oral capsule has been approved and distributed in the United States for anorexia associated with weight loss in patients with AIDS. Dronabinol and nabilone (a synthetic molecule similar to THC) capsules have been approved and distributed in the United States for the treatment of nausea and vomiting associated with cancer chemotherapy in patients who have failed to respond adequately to conventional antiemetic treatments. We are also aware of exploratory research into the effects of THC formulations in other areas.

 

We are aware of discovery research within the pharmaceutical industry into synthetic agonists and antagonists of CB1 and CB2 receptors. We are also aware of companies that supply synthetic cannabinoids and cannabis extracts to researchers for pre-clinical and clinical investigation. We are also aware of various companies that cultivate cannabis plants with a view to supplying herbal cannabis or non-pharmaceutical cannabis-based formulations to patients. These activities have not been approved by the FDA.

 

In both MS spasticity and cancer pain, Sativex aims to treat patients who do not respond adequately to standard care. In MS spasticity, such treatments include baclofen and tizanidine, and in cancer pain such treatments include morphine and other opioids. In cancer pain, the principal focus of ongoing clinical research by our potential competitors is in the development of alternative formulations of opioids.

 

With respect to CBD, a number of non-approved and non-standardized “artisanal” CBD preparations derived from crude herbal cannabis have been made available in limited quantities by producers of “medical marijuana” in the United States. In addition, certain pharmaceutical companies that currently manufacture synthetic THC are likely to have the capability to manufacture synthetic CBD and may already be doing so. Insys Therapeutics, Inc. has publicly stated its intention to develop CBD in Dravet syndrome, LGS, glioma and potentially other orphan indications. Zogenix, Inc. is developing low dose fenfluramine in Dravet syndrome. Zynerba Pharmaceuticals, Inc. is developing a topical formulation of CBD.

 

We have never endorsed or supported the idea of distributing or legalizing crude herbal cannabis, or preparations derived from crude herbal cannabis, for medical use and do not believe prescription cannabinoids are the same, and therefore competitive, with crude herbal cannabis. We have consistently maintained that only a cannabinoid medication, one that is standardized in composition, formulation and dose, administered by means of an appropriate delivery system, and tested in properly controlled pre-clinical and clinical studies, can meet the standards of regulatory authorities around the world, including those of the FDA. We have also repeatedly stressed that these regulatory processes provide important protections for patients, and we believe that any cannabinoid medication must be subjected to, and satisfy, such rigorous scrutiny.

 

  55  

 

  

The prospect for cannabinoid therapeutics to be approved through the FDA approval pathway has been the subject of statements from the White House, Congress and the Drug Enforcement Administration, or DEA. The White House Office of National Drug Control Policy states on its “Facts and Answers to the Frequently Asked Questions about Marijuana” on the White House website that the FDA has recognized and approved the medicinal use of isolated components of the marijuana plant and related synthetic compounds, and it specifically references Sativex as a product that is currently in late-stage clinical trials with the FDA. In its June 2012 report titled “Reducing the U.S. Demand for Illegal Drugs,” the U.S. Senate Caucus on International Narcotics Control expresses the view that the development of marijuana-based therapeutics through an approved FDA process is the best route to explore and references Sativex as a promising product currently in the final phase of the FDA’s trials for approved use in the United States. In that report, the Senate Caucus urged the FDA to complete a careful review of Sativex in a timely manner. In its May 2014 report titled “The Dangers and Consequences of Marijuana Abuse,” the DEA expresses support for ongoing research into potential medicinal uses of marijuana’s active ingredients, and specifically references Sativex and Epidiolex.

 

Government Regulation and Product Approval

 

FDA Approval Process

 

In the United States, pharmaceutical products are subject to extensive regulation by the FDA. The Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act, or the FDC Act, and other federal and state statutes and regulations, govern, among other things, the research, development, testing, manufacture, storage, recordkeeping, approval, labeling, promotion and marketing, distribution, post-approval monitoring and reporting, sampling, and import and export of pharmaceutical products. Failure to comply with applicable U.S. requirements may subject a company to a variety of administrative or judicial sanctions, such as imposition of clinical holds, FDA refusal to approve pending NDAs, warning letters, product recalls, product seizures, total or partial suspension of production or distribution, injunctions, fines, refusals of government contracts, restitution, disgorgement, civil penalties and criminal prosecution.

 

Pharmaceutical product development in the United States typically involves pre-clinical laboratory and animal tests and the submission to the FDA of an IND, which must become effective before clinical testing may commence. For commercial approval, the sponsor must submit adequate tests by all methods reasonably applicable to show that the drug is safe for use under the conditions prescribed, recommended or suggested in the proposed labeling. The sponsor must also submit substantial evidence, generally consisting of adequate, well-controlled clinical trials to establish that the drug will have the effect it purports or is represented to have under the conditions of use prescribed, recommended or suggested in the proposed labeling. In certain cases, FDA may determine that a drug is effective based on one clinical study plus confirmatory evidence. Satisfaction of FDA pre-market approval requirements typically takes many years and the actual time required may vary substantially based upon the type, complexity and novelty of the product or disease.

 

Pre-clinical tests include laboratory evaluation of product chemistry, formulation and toxicity, as well as animal trials to assess the characteristics and potential safety and efficacy of the product. The conduct of the pre-clinical tests must comply with federal regulations and requirements, including the FDA’s good laboratory practices regulations and the U.S. Department of Agriculture’s (USDA’s) regulations implementing the Animal Welfare Act. The results of pre- clinical testing are submitted to the FDA as part of an IND along with other information, including information about product chemistry, manufacturing and controls, and a proposed clinical trial protocol. Long term pre-clinical tests, such as animal tests of reproductive toxicity and carcinogenicity, may continue after the IND is submitted.

 

A 30-day waiting period after the submission of each IND is required prior to the commencement of clinical testing in humans. If the FDA has not imposed a clinical hold on the IND or otherwise commented or questioned the IND within this 30-day period, the clinical trial proposed in the IND may begin.

 

Clinical trials involve the administration of the investigational new drug to healthy volunteers or patients under the supervision of a qualified investigator. Clinical trials must be conducted: (i) in compliance with federal regulations, (ii) in compliance with Good Clinical Practice, or GCP, an international standard meant to protect the rights and health of patients and to define the roles of clinical trial sponsors, administrators and monitors, and (iii) under protocols detailing the objectives of the trial, the parameters to be used in monitoring safety and the effectiveness criteria to be evaluated. Each protocol involving testing on U.S. patients and subsequent protocol amendments must be submitted to the FDA as part of the IND.

 

The FDA may order the temporary, or permanent, discontinuation of a clinical trial at any time or impose other sanctions if it believes that the clinical trial either is not being conducted in accordance with FDA requirements or presents an unacceptable risk to the clinical trial patients. The trial protocol and informed consent information for patients in clinical trials must also be submitted to an institutional review board, or IRB, for approval. An IRB may also require the clinical trial at the site to be halted, either temporarily or permanently, for failure to comply with the IRB’s requirements or may impose other conditions.

 

  56  

 

  

 Clinical trials to support NDAs for marketing approval are typically conducted in three sequential phases, but the phases may overlap. In Phase 1, the initial introduction of the drug into healthy human subjects or patients, the drug is tested to assess metabolism, pharmacokinetics, pharmacological actions, side effects associated with increasing doses and, if possible, early evidence on effectiveness. Phase 2 usually involves trials in a limited patient population to determine the effectiveness of the drug for a particular indication, dosage tolerance and optimum dosage, and to identify common adverse effects and safety risks. If a compound demonstrates evidence of effectiveness and an acceptable safety profile in Phase 2 evaluations, Phase 3 trials are undertaken to obtain the additional information about clinical efficacy and safety in a larger number of patients, typically at geographically dispersed clinical trial sites, to permit the FDA to evaluate the overall benefit-risk relationship of the drug and to provide adequate information for the labeling of the drug. In most cases, the FDA requires two adequate and well-controlled Phase 3 clinical trials to demonstrate the efficacy of the drug. FDA may, however, determine that a drug is effective based on one clinical study plus confirmatory evidence. Only a small percentage of investigational drugs complete all three phases and obtain marketing approval. In some cases, FDA may require post-market studies, known as Phase 4 studies, to be conducted as a condition of approval in order to gather additional information on the drug’s effect in various populations and any side effects associated with long-term use. Depending on the risks posed by the drugs, other post-market requirements may be imposed.

 

After completion of the required clinical testing, an NDA is prepared and submitted to the FDA. FDA approval of the NDA is required before marketing of the product may begin in the United States. The NDA must include the results of all pre-clinical, clinical, and other testing and a compilation of data relating to the product’s pharmacology, chemistry, manufacture, and controls. The cost of preparing and submitting an NDA is substantial. Under federal law, the submission of most NDAs is additionally subject to a substantial application user fee, for Fiscal Year 2017 $2,038,100, and the manufacturer and/or sponsor under an approved NDA are also subject to annual product and establishment user fees, for Fiscal Year 2017 $97,750 per product and $512,200 per establishment.

 

The FDA has 60 days from its receipt of an NDA to determine whether the application will be accepted for filing based on the agency’s threshold determination that it is sufficiently complete to permit substantive review. Once the submission is accepted for filing, the FDA begins an in-depth review. Under the statute and implementing regulations, FDA has 180 days (the initial review cycle) from the date of filing to issue either an approval letter or a complete response letter, unless the review period is adjusted by mutual agreement between FDA and the applicant or as a result of the applicant submitting a major amendment. In practice, the performance goals established pursuant to the Prescription Drug User Fee Act have effectively extended the initial review cycle beyond 180 days. FDA’s current performance goals call for FDA to complete review of 90 percent of standard (non-priority) NDAs within 10 months of receipt and within six months for priority NDAs, but two additional months are added to standard and priority NDAs for a new molecular entity (NME).

 

The FDA may also refer applications for novel drug products, or drug products that present difficult questions of safety or efficacy, to an advisory committee, which is typically a panel that includes clinicians and other experts, for review, evaluation and a recommendation as to whether the application should be approved. The FDA is not bound by the recommendation of an advisory committee, but it generally follows such recommendations. Before approving an NDA, the FDA will typically inspect one or more clinical sites to assure compliance with GCP. Additionally, the FDA will inspect the facility or the facilities at which the drug is manufactured. The FDA will not approve the product unless compliance with current good manufacturing practices, or GMP, is satisfactory and the NDA contains data that provide substantial evidence that the drug is safe and effective in the indication studied.

 

After the FDA evaluates the NDA and the manufacturing facilities, it issues either an approval letter or a complete response letter. A complete response letter generally outlines the deficiencies in the submission and may require substantial additional testing, or information, in order for the FDA to reconsider the application. If, or when, those deficiencies have been addressed to the FDA’s satisfaction in a resubmission of the NDA, the FDA will issue an approval letter. The FDA has committed to reviewing 90 per cent of resubmissions within two or six months depending on the type of information included.

 

  57  

 

  

An approval letter authorizes commercial marketing of the drug with specific prescribing information for specific indications. As a condition of NDA approval, the FDA may require a risk evaluation and mitigation strategy, or REMS, to help ensure that the benefits of the drug outweigh the potential risks. REMS can include medication guides, communication plans for health care professionals, and elements to assure safe use, or ETASU. ETASU can include, but are not limited to, special training or certification for prescribing or dispensing, dispensing only under certain circumstances, special monitoring, and the use of patient registries. The requirement for a REMS can materially affect the potential market and profitability of the drug. Moreover, product approval may require substantial post-approval testing and surveillance to monitor the drug’s safety or efficacy. Once granted, product approvals may be withdrawn if compliance with regulatory standards is not maintained or problems are identified following initial marketing.

 

Disclosure of Clinical Trial Information

 

Sponsors of clinical trials of certain FDA-regulated products, including prescription drugs, are required to register and disclose certain clinical trial information on a public website maintained by the U.S. National Institutes of Health. Information related to the product, patient population, phase of investigation, study sites and investigator, and other aspects of the clinical trial is made public as part of the registration. Under a new rule, effective January 18, 2017, sponsors are also obligated to disclose the results of these trials after completion (prior to the new rule, disclosure of results was only required if the product or new indication was approved by the FDA). Disclosure of the results of these trials can be delayed for up to two years if the sponsor is seeking approval of the product or a new indication. Competitors may use this publicly available information to gain knowledge regarding the design and progress of our development programs.

 

Fast Track Designation and Accelerated Approval

 

FDA is required to facilitate the development, and expedite the review, of drugs that are intended for the treatment of a serious or life-threatening disease or condition for which there is no effective treatment and which demonstrate the potential to address unmet medical needs for the condition. Under the Fast Track Program, the sponsor of a new drug candidate may request that FDA designate the drug candidate for a specific indication as a Fast Track drug concurrent with, or after, the filing of the IND for the drug candidate. FDA must determine if the drug candidate qualifies for Fast Track designation within 60 days of receipt of the sponsor’s request.

 

Under the FDA’s accelerated approval regulations, FDA may approve a drug for a serious or life-threatening illness that provides meaningful therapeutic benefit to patients over existing treatments based upon a surrogate endpoint that is reasonably likely to predict clinical benefit, or on a clinical endpoint that can be measured earlier than irreversible morbidity or mortality, that is reasonably likely to predict an effect on irreversible morbidity or mortality or other clinical benefit, taking into account the severity, rarity or prevalence of the condition and the availability or lack of alternative treatments.

 

In clinical trials, a surrogate endpoint is a measurement of laboratory or clinical signs of a disease or condition that substitutes for a direct measurement of how a patient feels, functions or survives. Surrogate endpoints can often be measured more easily or more rapidly than clinical endpoints. A drug candidate approved on this basis is subject to rigorous post-marketing compliance requirements, including the completion of Phase 4 or post- approval clinical trials to confirm the effect on the clinical endpoint. Failure to conduct required post-approval studies, or confirm a clinical benefit during post-marketing studies, will allow FDA to withdraw the drug from the market on an expedited basis. Unless otherwise informed by the FDA, for an accelerated approval product an applicant must submit to the FDA for consideration during the preapproval review period copies of all promotional materials, including promotional labeling as well as advertisements, intended for dissemination or publication within 120 days following marketing approval. After 120 days following marketing approval, unless otherwise informed by the FDA, the applicant must submit promotional materials at least 30 days prior to the intended time of initial dissemination of the labeling or initial publication of the advertisement

 

In addition to other benefits such as the ability to use surrogate endpoints and engage in more frequent interactions with FDA, FDA may initiate review of sections of a Fast Track drug’s NDA before the application is complete. This rolling review is available if the applicant provides, and FDA approves, a schedule for the submission of the remaining information and the applicant pays applicable user fees. However, FDA’s time period goal for reviewing an application does not begin until the last section of the NDA is submitted. Additionally, the Fast Track designation may be withdrawn by FDA if FDA believes that the designation is no longer supported by data emerging in the clinical trial process.

 

  58  

 

   

The Hatch-Waxman Act

 

Orange Book Listing

 

In seeking approval for a drug through an NDA, applicants are required to list with the FDA each patent whose claims cover the applicant’s product. Upon approval of a drug, each of the patents listed in the application for the drug is then published in the FDA’s Approved Drug Products with Therapeutic Equivalence Evaluations, commonly known as the Orange Book. Drugs listed in the Orange Book can, in turn, be cited by potential generic competitors in support of approval of an abbreviated new drug application, or ANDA. An ANDA provides for marketing of a drug product that has the same active ingredients in the same strengths and dosage form as the listed drug and has been shown through bioequivalence testing to be therapeutically equivalent to the listed drug. Other than the requirement for bioequivalence testing, ANDA applicants are not required to conduct, or submit results of, pre-clinical or clinical tests to prove the safety or effectiveness of their drug product. Drugs approved in this way are commonly referred to as “generic equivalents” to the listed drug, and can often be substituted by pharmacists under prescriptions written for the original listed drug.

 

The ANDA applicant is required to certify to the FDA concerning any patents listed for the approved product in the FDA’s Orange Book. Specifically, the applicant must certify that: (i) the required patent information has not been filed; (ii) the listed patent has expired; (iii) the listed patent has not expired, but will expire on a particular date and approval is sought after patent expiration; or (iv) the listed patent is invalid or will not be infringed by the new product. The ANDA applicant may also elect to submit a section viii statement, certifying that its proposed ANDA label does not contain (or carves out) any language regarding the patented method-of- use, rather than certify to a listed method-of-use patent.

 

If the applicant does not challenge the listed patents, the ANDA application will not be approved until all the listed patents claiming the referenced product have expired.

 

A certification that the new product will not infringe the already approved product’s listed patents, or that such patents are invalid, is called a Paragraph IV certification. If the ANDA applicant has provided a Paragraph IV certification to the FDA, the applicant must also send notice of the Paragraph IV certification to the NDA and patent holders once the ANDA has been accepted for filing by the FDA. The NDA and patent holders may then initiate a patent infringement lawsuit in response to the notice of the Paragraph IV certification. The filing of a patent infringement lawsuit within 45 days of the receipt of a Paragraph IV certification automatically prevents the FDA from approving the ANDA until the earlier of 30 months, expiration of the patent, settlement of the lawsuit, or a decision in the infringement case that is favorable to the ANDA applicant.

 

The ANDA application also will not be approved until any applicable non- patent exclusivity listed in the Orange Book for the referenced product has expired.

 

Exclusivity

 

Upon NDA approval of a new chemical entity or NCE, which is a drug that contains no active moiety that has been approved by the FDA in any other NDA, that drug receives five years of marketing exclusivity during which time the FDA cannot receive any ANDA or 505(b)(2) application seeking approval of a drug that references a version of the NCE drug. Certain changes to a drug, such as the addition of a new indication to the package insert, are associated with a three-year period of exclusivity during which the FDA cannot approve an ANDA or 505(b)(2) application that includes the change.

 

An ANDA or 505(b)(2) application may be submitted one year before NCE exclusivity expires if a Paragraph IV certification is filed. If there is no listed patent in the Orange Book, there may not be a Paragraph IV certification and thus no ANDA or 505(b)(2) application may be filed before the expiration of the exclusivity period.

 

For a botanical drug, FDA may determine that the active moiety is one or more of the principal components or the complex mixture as a whole. This determination would affect the utility of any 5-year exclusivity as well as the ability of any potential generic competitor to demonstrate that it is the same drug as the original botanical drug.

 

Five-year and three-year exclusivities do not preclude FDA approval of a 505(b)(1) application for a duplicate version of the drug during the period of exclusivity, provided that the 505(b)(1) conducts or obtains a right of reference to all of the preclinical studies and adequate and well controlled clinical trials necessary to demonstrate safety and effectiveness.

 

  59  

 

  

Patent Term Extension

 

After NDA approval, owners of relevant drug patents may apply for up to a five-year patent extension. The allowable patent term extension is calculated as half of the drug’s testing phase—the time between IND submission and NDA submission—and all of the review phase—the time between NDA submission and approval up to a maximum of five years. The time can be shortened if FDA determines that the applicant did not pursue approval with due diligence. The total patent term after the extension may not exceed 14 years.

 

For patents that might expire during the application phase, the patent owner may request an interim patent extension. An interim patent extension increases the patent term by one year and may be renewed up to four times. For each interim patent extension granted, the post-approval patent extension is reduced by one year. The director of the PTO must determine that approval of the drug covered by the patent for which a patent extension is being sought is likely. Interim patent extensions are not available for a drug for which an NDA has not been submitted.

 

Advertising and Promotion

 

Once an NDA is approved, a product will be subject to certain post-approval requirements. For instance, FDA closely regulates the post-approval marketing and promotion of drugs, including standards and regulations for direct-to-consumer advertising, off-label promotion, industry- sponsored scientific and educational activities and promotional activities involving the internet.

 

Drugs may be marketed only for the approved indications and in accordance with the provisions of the approved labeling. Changes to some of the conditions established in an approved application, including changes in indications, labeling, or manufacturing processes or facilities, require submission and FDA approval of a new NDA or NDA supplement before the change can be implemented. An NDA supplement for a new indication typically requires clinical data similar to that in the original application, and the FDA uses the same procedures and actions in reviewing NDA supplements as it does in reviewing NDAs.

 

Adverse Event Reporting and GMP Compliance

 

Adverse event reporting and submission of periodic reports is required following FDA approval of an NDA. The FDA also may require post-marketing testing, known as Phase 4 testing, REMS and surveillance to monitor the effects of an approved product, or the FDA may place conditions on an approval that could restrict the distribution or use of the product. In addition, quality-control, drug manufacture, packaging, and labeling procedures must continue to conform to GMP, after approval. Drug manufacturers and certain of their subcontractors are required to register their establishments with FDA and certain state agencies. Registration with the FDA subjects entities to periodic unannounced inspections by the FDA, during which the agency inspects manufacturing facilities to assess compliance with GMP. Accordingly, manufacturers must continue to expend time, money and effort in the areas of production and quality control to maintain compliance with GMP. Regulatory authorities may withdraw product approvals or request product recalls if a company fails to comply with regulatory standards, if it encounters problems following initial marketing or if previously unrecognized problems are subsequently discovered.

 

Pediatric Exclusivity and Pediatric Use

 

The Best Pharmaceuticals for Children Act, or BPCA, provides NDA holders a six-month extension of any exclusivity—patent or non-patent—for a drug if certain conditions are met. Conditions for exclusivity include a determination by the FDA that information relating to the use of a new drug in the pediatric population may produce health benefits in that population; a written request by the FDA for pediatric studies; and agreement by the applicant to perform the requested studies and the submission to the FDA, and the acceptance by the FDA, of the reports of the requested studies within the statutory timeframe. Applications under the BPCA are treated as priority applications.

 

In addition, under the Pediatric Research Equity Act, or PREA, NDAs or supplements to NDAs must contain data to assess the safety and effectiveness of the drug for the claimed indications in all relevant pediatric subpopulations and to support dosing and administration for each pediatric subpopulation for which the drug is safe and effective, unless the sponsor has received a deferral or waiver from the FDA. Unless otherwise required by regulation, PREA does not apply to any drug for an indication for which orphan designation has been granted. The sponsor or FDA may request a deferral of pediatric studies for some or all of the pediatric subpopulations. A deferral may be granted for several reasons, including a finding that the drug is ready for approval for use in adults before pediatric studies are complete or that additional safety or effectiveness data need to be collected before the pediatric studies begin. Under PREA, the FDA must send a non-compliance letter requesting a response with 45 days to any sponsor that fails to submit the required assessment, keep a deferral current or fails to submit a request for approval of a pediatric formulation.

 

  60  

 

   

Orphan Drugs

 

Under the Orphan Drug Act, the FDA may grant orphan drug designation to drugs intended to treat a rare disease or condition—generally a disease or condition that affects fewer than 200,000 individuals in the U.S (or affects more than 200,000 in the U.S. and for which there is no reasonable expectation that the cost of developing and making available in the U.S. a drug for such disease or condition will recovered from sales in the U.S. of such drug). Orphan drug designation must be requested before submitting an NDA. After the FDA grants orphan drug designation, the generic identity of the drug and its potential orphan use are disclosed publicly by the FDA. Orphan drug designation does not convey any advantage in, or shorten the duration of, the regulatory review and approval process. The first NDA applicant to receive FDA approval for a particular active ingredient to treat a particular disease with FDA orphan drug designation is entitled to a seven-year exclusive marketing period in the U.S. for that product, for that indication. During the seven-year exclusivity period, the FDA may not approve any other applications to market the same drug for the same disease, except in limited circumstances, such as a showing of clinical superiority to the product with orphan drug exclusivity. Orphan drug exclusivity does not prevent the FDA from approving a different drug for the same disease or condition, or the same drug for a different disease or condition. Among the other benefits of orphan drug designation are tax credits for certain research and a waiver of the NDA application user fee.

 

Special Protocol Assessment

 

A company may reach an agreement with the FDA under the Special Protocol Assessment, or SPA, process as to the required design and size of clinical trials intended to form the primary basis of an efficacy claim. According to its performance goals, the FDA is supposed to evaluate the protocol within 45 days of the request to assess whether the proposed trial is adequate, and that evaluation may result in discussions and a request for additional information. An SPA request must be made before the proposed trial begins, and all open issues must be resolved before the trial begins. If a written agreement is reached, it will be documented and made part of the administrative record. Under the FDC Act and FDA guidance implementing the statutory requirement, an SPA is generally binding upon the FDA except in limited circumstances, such as if the FDA identifies a substantial scientific issue essential to determining safety or efficacy after the study begins, public health concerns emerge that were unrecognized at the time of the protocol assessment, the sponsor and FDA agree to the change in writing, or if the study sponsor fails to follow the protocol that was agreed upon with the FDA.

 

Controlled Substances

 

The federal Controlled Substances Act of 1970, or CSA, and its implementing regulations establish a “closed system” of regulations for controlled substances. The CSA imposes registration, security, recordkeeping and reporting, storage, manufacturing, distribution, importation and other requirements under the oversight of the U.S. Drug Enforcement Administration, or DEA. The DEA is the federal agency responsible for regulating controlled substances, and requires those individuals or entities that manufacture, import, export, distribute, research, or dispense controlled substances to comply with the regulatory requirements in order to prevent the diversion of controlled substances to illicit channels of commerce.

 

The DEA categorizes controlled substances into one of five schedules—Schedule I, II, III, IV or V—with varying qualifications for listing in each schedule. Schedule I substances by definition have a high potential for abuse, have no currently accepted medical use in treatment in the United States and lack accepted safety for use under medical supervision. They may be used only in federally approved research programs and may not be marketed or sold for dispensing to patients in the United States. Pharmaceutical products having a currently accepted medical use that are otherwise approved for marketing may be listed as Schedule II, III, IV or V substances, with Schedule II substances presenting the highest potential for abuse and physical or psychological dependence, and Schedule V substances presenting the lowest relative potential for abuse and dependence. The regulatory requirements are more restrictive for Schedule II substances than Schedule III substances. For example, all Schedule II drug prescriptions must be signed by a physician, physically presented to a pharmacist in most situations and cannot be refilled.

 

  61  

 

  

Following NDA approval of a drug containing a Schedule I controlled substance, that substance must be rescheduled as a Schedule II, III, IV or V substance before it can be marketed. On November 17, 2015, H.R. 639, Improving Regulatory Transparency for New Medical Therapies Act, passed through both houses of Congress and on November 25, 2015 the Bill was signed into law. The new law removes uncertainty associated with timing of the DEA rescheduling process after NDA approval. Specifically, it requires DEA to issue an “interim final rule,” pursuant to which a manufacturer may market its product no later than 90 days after the later of: (1) the date on which DEA receives from FDA the scientific and medical evaluation and scheduling recommendation; or (2) the date on which DEA receives from FDA notification that FDA has approved the drug. The new law also preserves the period of orphan marketing exclusivity for the full seven years such that this period only begins with the approval of the NDA or DEA scheduling, whichever is later. This contrasts with the previous situation whereby the orphan “clock” began to tick upon FDA approval, even though the product could not be marketed until DEA scheduling was complete.

 

Facilities that manufacture, distribute, import or export any controlled substance must register annually with the DEA. The DEA registration is specific to the particular location, activity(ies) and controlled substance schedule(s). For example, separate registrations are required for importation and manufacturing activities, and each registration authorizes which schedules of controlled substances the registrant may handle. However, certain coincident activities are permitted without obtaining a separate DEA registration, such as distribution of controlled substances by the manufacturer that produces them.

 

The DEA inspects all manufacturing facilities to review security, recordkeeping, reporting and handling prior to issuing a controlled substance registration. The specific security requirements vary by the type of business activity and the schedule and quantity of controlled substances handled. The most stringent requirements apply to manufacturers of Schedule I and Schedule II substances. Required security measures commonly include background checks on employees and physical control of controlled substances through storage in approved vaults, safes and cages, and through use of alarm systems and surveillance cameras. An application for a manufacturing registration as a bulk manufacturer (not a dosage form manufacturer or a repacker/relabeler) for a Schedule I or II substance must be published in the Federal Register, and is open for 60 days to permit interested persons to submit comments, objections or requests for a hearing. A copy of the notice of the Federal Register publication is simultaneously forwarded by DEA to all those registered, or applicants for registration, as bulk manufacturers of that substance. Once registered, manufacturing facilities must maintain records documenting the manufacture, receipt and distribution of all controlled substances. Manufacturers must submit periodic reports to the DEA of the distribution of Schedule I and II controlled substances, Schedule III narcotic substances, and other designated substances. Registrants must also report any controlled substance thefts or significant losses, and must obtain authorization to destroy or dispose of controlled substances. As with applications for registration as a bulk manufacturer, an application for an importer registration for a Schedule I or II substance must also be published in the Federal Register, which remains open for 30 days for comments. Imports of Schedule I and II controlled substances for commercial purposes are generally restricted to substances not already available from domestic supplier or where there is not adequate competition among domestic suppliers. In addition to an importer or exporter registration, importers and exporters must obtain a permit for every import or export of a Schedule I and II substance or Schedule III, IV and V narcotic, and submit import or export declarations for Schedule III, IV and V non-narcotics. In some cases, Schedule III non-narcotic substances may be subject to the import/export permit requirement, if necessary to ensure that the United States complies with its obligations under international drug control treaties.

 

For drugs manufactured in the United States, the DEA establishes annually an aggregate quota for the amount of substances within Schedules I and II that may be manufactured or produced in the United States based on the DEA’s estimate of the quantity needed to meet legitimate medical, scientific, research and industrial needs. This limited aggregate amount of cannabis that the DEA allows to be produced in the United States each year is allocated among individual companies, which, in turn, must annually apply to the DEA for individual manufacturing and procurement quotas. The quotas apply equally to the manufacturing of the active pharmaceutical ingredient and production of dosage forms. The DEA may adjust aggregate production quotas a few times per year, and individual manufacturing or procurement quotas from time to time during the year, although the DEA has substantial discretion in whether or not to make such adjustments for individual companies.

 

  62  

 

  

The states also maintain separate controlled substance laws and regulations, including licensing, recordkeeping, security, distribution, and dispensing requirements. State Authorities, including Boards of Pharmacy, regulate use of controlled substances in each state. Failure to maintain compliance with applicable requirements, particularly as manifested in the loss or diversion of controlled substances, can result in enforcement action that could have a material adverse effect on our business, operations and financial condition. The DEA may seek civil penalties, refuse to renew necessary registrations, or initiate proceedings to revoke those registrations. In certain circumstances, violations could lead to criminal prosecution.

 

Europe/Rest of World Government Regulation

 

In addition to regulations in the United States, we are and will be subject, either directly or through our distribution partners, to a variety of regulations in other jurisdictions governing, among other things, clinical trials and any commercial sales and distribution of our products, if approved.

 

Whether or not we obtain FDA approval for a product, we must obtain the requisite approvals from regulatory authorities in non-U.S. countries prior to the commencement of clinical trials or marketing of the product in those countries.

 

In the E.U., medicinal products are subject to extensive pre- and post-marketing regulation by regulatory authorities at both the EU and national levels. Additional rules also apply at the national level to the manufacture, import, export, storage, distribution and sale of controlled substances. In many E.U. member states the regulatory authority responsible for medicinal products is also responsible for controlled substances. Responsibility is, however, split in some member states, such as the UK. Generally, any company manufacturing or distributing a medicinal product containing a controlled substance in the E.U. will need to hold a controlled substances licence from the competent national authority and will be subject to specific record-keeping and security obligations. Separate import or export certificates are required for each shipment into or out of the member state.

 

Clinical Trials and Marketing Approval

 

Certain countries outside of the United States have a process that requires the submission of a clinical trial application much like an IND prior to the commencement of human clinical trials. In Europe, for example, a clinical trial application, or CTA, must be submitted to the competent national health authority and to independent ethics committees in each country in which a company intends to conduct clinical trials. Once the CTA is approved in accordance with a country’s requirements and a company has received favorable ethics committee approval, clinical trial development may proceed in that country.

 

The requirements and process governing the conduct of clinical trials, product licensing, pricing and reimbursement vary from country to country, even though there is already some degree of legal harmonization in the European Union member states resulting from the national implementation of underlying E.U. legislation. In all cases, the clinical trials must be conducted in accordance with the International Conference on Harmonization, or ICH, guidelines on Good Clinical Practices, or GCP and other applicable regulatory requirements.

 

To obtain regulatory approval of an investigational drug under E.U. regulatory systems, we must submit a marketing authorization application. This application is similar to the NDA in the United States, with the exception of, among other things, country-specific document requirements. All application procedures require an application in the common technical document, or CTD, format, which includes the submission of detailed information about the manufacturing and quality of the product, and non-clinical and clinical trial information. Drugs can be authorized in the European Union by using (i) the centralized authorization procedure, (ii) the mutual recognition procedure, (iii) the decentralized procedure or (iv) national authorization procedures. The initial Sativex approvals were a consequence of an application under the De-Centralized Procedure, or DCP, to the E.U. member states of the United Kingdom and Spain.

 

The European Commission created the centralized procedure for the approval of human drugs to facilitate marketing authorizations that are valid throughout the European Union and, by extension (after national implementing decisions) in Iceland, Liechtenstein and Norway, which, together with the E.U. member states, comprise the European Economic Area, or EEA. Applicants file marketing authorization applications with the EMA, where they are reviewed by a relevant scientific committee, in most cases the Committee for Medicinal Products for Human Use, or CHMP. The EMA forwards CHMP opinions to the European Commission, which uses them as the basis for deciding whether to grant a marketing authorization.. This procedure results in a single marketing authorization granted by the European Commission that is valid across the European Union, as well as in Iceland, Liechtenstein and Norway. The centralized procedure is compulsory for human drugs that are: (i) derived from biotechnology processes, such as genetic engineering, (ii) contain a new active substance indicated for the treatment of certain diseases, such as HIV/AIDS, cancer, diabetes, neurodegenerative diseases, autoimmune and other immune dysfunctions and viral diseases, (iii) officially designated “orphan drugs” (drugs used for rare human diseases) and (iv) advanced-therapy medicines, such as gene- therapy, somatic cell-therapy or tissue-engineered medicines. The centralized procedure may at the voluntary request of the applicant also be used for human drugs which do not fall within the above mentioned categories if the CHMP agrees that the human drug (a) contains a new active substance not yet approved on 20 November 2005); (b) constitutes a significant therapeutic, scientific or technical innovation or (c) authorization under the centralized procedure is in the interests of patients at the E.U. level.

 

  63  

 

  

Under the centralized procedure in the European Union, the maximum timeframe for the evaluation of a marketing authorization application by the EMA is 210 days (excluding clock stops, when additional written or oral information is to be provided by the applicant in response to questions asked by the CHMP), with adoption of the actual marketing authorization by the European Commission thereafter. Accelerated evaluation might be granted by the CHMP in exceptional cases, when a medicinal product is expected to be of a major public health interest from the point of view of therapeutic innovation, defined by three cumulative criteria: the seriousness of the disease to be treated; the absence of an appropriate alternative therapeutic approach, and anticipation of exceptional high therapeutic benefit. In this circumstance, EMA ensures that the evaluation for the opinion of the CHMP is completed within 150 days and the opinion issued thereafter.

 

For those medicinal products for which the centralized procedure is not available, the applicant must submit marketing authorization applications to the national medicines regulators through one of three procedures: (i) the mutual recognition procedure (which must be used if the product has already been authorized in at least one other E.U. member state, and in which the E.U. member states are required to grant an authorization recognizing the existing authorization in the other E.U. member state, unless they identify a serious risk to public health), (ii) the decentralized procedure (in which applications are submitted simultaneously in two or more E.U. member states ) or (iii) national authorization procedures (which results in a marketing authorization in a single E.U. member state).

 

Mutual Recognition Procedure

 

The mutual recognition procedure, or MRP, for the approval of human drugs is an alternative approach to facilitate individual national marketing authorizations within the European Union. Basically, the MRP may be applied for all human drugs for which the centralized procedure is not obligatory. The MRP is applicable to the majority of conventional medicinal products, must be used if the product has already been authorized in at least one or more member states. Since the first approvals for Sativex were national approvals in the United Kingdom and Spain (following a DCP), the only route open to us for additional marketing authorizations in the European Union was the MRP.

 

The characteristic of the MRP is that the procedure builds on an already‒existing marketing authorization in a member state of the E.U. that is used as a reference in order to obtain marketing authorizations in other E.U. member states. In the MRP, a marketing authorization for a drug already exists in one or more member states of the E.U. and subsequently marketing authorization applications are made in other European Union member states by referring to the initial marketing authorization. The member state in which the marketing authorization was first granted will then act as the reference member state. The member states where the marketing authorization is subsequently applied for act as concerned member states. The concerned member states are required to grant an authorization recognizing the existing authorization in the reference member state, unless they identify a serious risk to public health.

 

 The MRP is based on the principle of the mutual recognition by European Union member states of their respective national marketing authorizations. Based on a marketing authorization in the reference member state, the applicant may apply for marketing authorizations in other member states. In such case, the reference member state shall update its existing assessment report about the drug in 90 days. After the assessment is completed, copies of the report are sent to all member states, together with the approved summary of product characteristics, labeling and package leaflet. The concerned member states then have 90 days to recognize the decision of the reference member state and the summary of product characteristics, labeling and package leaflet. National marketing authorizations shall be granted within 30 days after acknowledgement of the agreement.

 

Should any Member State refuse to recognize the marketing authorization by the reference member state, on the grounds of potential serious risk to public health, the issue will be referred to a coordination group. Within a timeframe of 60 days, member states shall, within the coordination group, make all efforts to reach a consensus. If this fails, the procedure is submitted to an EMA scientific committee for arbitration. The opinion of this EMA Committee is then forwarded to the Commission, for the start of the decision making process. As in the centralized procedure, this process entails consulting various European Commission Directorates General and the Standing Committee on Human Medicinal Products. Since the initial approvals of Sativex in the United Kingdom and Spain, there have been three “waves” of additional approvals under three separate MRPs. Each of these procedures have been completed without any referral, and therefore without any delay.

 

Data Exclusivity

 

In the E.U., marketing authorization applications for generic medicinal products do not need to include the results of pre-clinical and clinical trials, but instead can refer to the data included in the marketing authorization of a reference product for which regulatory data exclusivity has expired. If a marketing authorization is granted for a medicinal product containing a new active substance, that product benefits from eight years of data exclusivity, during which generic marketing authorization applications referring to the data of that product may not be accepted by the regulatory authorities, and a further two years of market exclusivity, during which such generic products may not be placed on the market. The two-year period may be extended to three years if during the first eight years a new therapeutic indication with significant clinical benefit over existing therapies is approved.

 

  64  

 

   

Orphan Medicinal Products

 

The EMA’s Committee for Orphan Medicinal Products, or COMP, may recommend orphan medicinal product designation to promote the development of products that are intended for the diagnosis, prevention or treatment of life-threatening or chronically debilitating conditions affecting not more than 5 in 10,000 persons in the E.U. Additionally, designation is granted for products intended for the diagnosis, prevention or treatment of a life-threatening, seriously debilitating or serious and chronic condition and when, without incentives, it is unlikely that sales of the product in the E.U. would be sufficient to justify the necessary investment in developing the medicinal product. The COMP may only recommend orphan medicinal product designation when the product in question offers a significant clinical benefit over existing approved products for the relevant indication. Following a positive opinion by the COMP, the European Commission adopts a decision granting orphan status. The COMP will reassess orphan status in parallel with EMA review of a marketing authorization application and orphan status may be withdrawn at that stage if it no longer fulfills the orphan criteria (for instance because in the meantime a new product was approved for the indication and no convincing data are available to demonstrate a significant benefit over that product). Orphan medicinal product designation entitles a party to financial incentives such as reduction of fees or fee waivers and 10 years of market exclusivity is granted following marketing authorization. During this period, the competent authorities may not accept or approve any similar medicinal product, unless it offers a significant clinical benefit. This period may be reduced to 6 years if the orphan medicinal product designation criteria are no longer met, including where it is shown that the product is sufficiently profitable not to justify maintenance of market exclusivity.

 

Pediatric Development

 

In the E.U., companies developing a new medicinal product must agree a Paediatric Investigation Plan (“PIP”) with the EMA and must conduct paediatric clinical trials in accordance with that PIP unless a waiver applies, for example because the relevant disease or condition occurs only in adults. The marketing authorization application for the product must include the results of paediatric clinical trials conducted in accordance with the PIP, unless a waiver applies, or a deferral has been granted, in which case the paediatric clinical trials must be completed at a later date. Products that are granted a marketing authorization on the basis of the paediatric clinical trials conducted in accordance with the PIP are eligible for a six-month extension of the protection under a supplementary protection certificate (if any is in effect at the time of approval). This paediatric reward is subject to specific conditions and is not automatically available when data in compliance with the PIP are developed and submitted.

 

If we fail to comply with applicable foreign regulatory requirements, we may be subject to, among other things, fines, suspension of clinical trials, suspension or withdrawal of regulatory approvals, product recalls, seizure of products, operating restrictions and criminal prosecution.

 

In addition, most countries are parties to the Single Convention on Narcotic Drugs 1961, which governs international trade and domestic control of narcotic substances, including cannabis extracts. Countries may interpret and implement their treaty obligations in a way that creates a legal obstacle to our obtaining marketing approval for Sativex and our other products in those countries. These countries may not be willing or able to amend or otherwise modify their laws and regulations to permit Sativex or our other products to be marketed, or achieving such amendments to the laws and regulations may take a prolonged period of time. In that case, we would be unable to market our products in those countries in the near future or perhaps at all.

 

  65  

 

   

Reimbursement

 

Sales of pharmaceutical products in the United States will depend, in part, on the extent to which the costs of the products will be covered by third-party payers, such as government health programs, commercial insurance and managed health care organizations. These third-party payers are increasingly challenging the prices charged for medical products and services. Additionally, the containment of health care costs has become a priority of federal and state governments, and the prices of drugs have been a focus in this effort. The United States government, state legislatures and foreign governments have shown significant interest in implementing cost-containment programs, including price controls, restrictions on reimbursement and requirements for substitution of generic products. Adoption of price controls and cost-containment measures, and adoption of more restrictive policies in jurisdictions with existing controls and measures, could further limit our net revenue and results. If these third-party payers do not consider our products to be cost-effective compared to other available therapies, they may not cover our products after approval as a benefit under their plans or, if they do, the level of payment may not be sufficient to allow us to sell our products on a profitable basis.

 

The Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement, and Modernization Act of 2003, or the MMA, imposed new requirements for the distribution and pricing of prescription drugs for Medicare beneficiaries and included a major expansion of the prescription drug benefit under Medicare Part D. Under Part D, Medicare beneficiaries may enroll in prescription drug plans offered by private entities which provide coverage of outpatient prescription drugs. Part D is available through both stand-alone prescription drug benefit plans and prescription drug coverage as a supplement to Medicare Advantage plans. Unlike Medicare Parts A and B, Part D coverage is not standardized. Part D prescription drug plan sponsors are not required to pay for all covered Part D drugs, and each drug plan can develop its own drug formulary that identifies which drugs it will cover and at what tier or level. However, Part D prescription drug formularies must include drugs within each therapeutic category and class of covered Part D drugs, though not necessarily all the drugs in each category or class. Any formulary used by a Part D prescription drug plan must be developed and reviewed by a pharmacy and therapeutic committee. Government payment for some of the costs of prescription drugs may increase demand for products for which we receive marketing approval. However, any negotiated prices for our products covered by a Part D prescription drug plan will likely be lower than the prices we might otherwise obtain. Moreover, while the MMA applies only to drug benefits for Medicare beneficiaries, private payers often follow Medicare coverage policy and payment limitations in setting their own payment rates. Any reduction in payment that results from the MMA may result in a similar reduction in payments from non-governmental payers.

 

On February 17, 2009, President Obama signed into law The American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009. This law provides funding for the federal government to compare the effectiveness of different treatments for the same illness. This research is overseen by the Department of Health and Human Services, the Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality and the National Institutes for Health, and periodic reports on the status of the research and related expenditures must be made to Congress. Although the results of the comparative effectiveness studies are not intended to mandate coverage policies for public or private payers, it is not clear how such a result could be avoided and what if any effect the research will have on the sales of our product candidates, if any such product or the condition that it is intended to treat is the subject of a study. It is also possible that comparative effectiveness research demonstrating benefits in a competitor’s product could adversely affect the sales of our product candidates. Decreases in third-party reimbursement for our product candidates or a decision by a third-party payer to not cover our product candidates could reduce physician usage of the product candidate and have a material adverse effect on our sales, results of operations and financial condition.

 

The Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act, as amended by the Health Care and Education Affordability Reconciliation Act of 2010 (collectively, the ACA) enacted in March 2010, is expected to have a significant impact on the health care industry. The ACA is expected to expand coverage for the uninsured while at the same time contain overall health care costs. With regard to pharmaceutical products, among other things, the ACA is expected to expand and increase industry rebates for drugs covered under Medicaid programs and made changes to the coverage requirements under the Medicare D program. We cannot predict the impact of the ACA on pharmaceutical companies as many of the ACA reforms require the promulgation of detailed regulations implementing the statutory provisions which has not yet been completed. In addition, although the United States Supreme Court has upheld the constitutionality of most of the ACA, some states have stated their intentions to not implement certain sections of the ACA and some members of Congress are still working to repeal the ACA. These challenges add to the uncertainty of the changes enacted as part of ACA. In addition, the current legal challenges to the ACA, as well as Congressional efforts to repeal the ACA, add to the uncertainty of the legislative changes enacted as part of the ACA.

 

  66  

 

  

In addition, in some foreign countries, the proposed pricing for a drug must be approved before it may be lawfully marketed. The requirements governing drug pricing vary widely from country to country. For example, some E.U. jurisdictions operate positive and negative list systems under which products may only be marketed once a reimbursement price has been agreed. To obtain reimbursement or pricing approval, some of these countries may require the completion of clinical trials that compare the cost-effectiveness of a particular product candidate to currently available therapies. Other member states allow companies to fix their own prices for medicines but monitor and control company profits. Such differences in national pricing regimes may create price differntials between E.U. member states. There can be no assurance that any country that has price controls or reimbursement limitations for pharmaceutical products will allow favorable reimbursement and pricing arrangements for any of our products. Historically, products launched in the European Union do not follow price structures of the United States. In the E.U., the downward pressure on healthcare costs in general, particularly prescription medicines, has become intense. As a result, barriers to entry of new products are becoming increasingly high and patients are unlikely to use a drug product that is not reimbursed by their government.

  

Other Health Care Laws and Compliance Requirements

 

In the United States, our activities are potentially subject to regulation by various federal, state and local authorities in addition to the FDA, including the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services (formerly the Health Care Financing Administration), or CMS, other divisions of the U.S. Department of Health and Human Services (e.g., the Office of Inspector General), the U.S. Department of Justice and individual U.S. Attorney offices within the Department of Justice, and state and local governments. For example, sales, marketing and scientific/educational grant programs must comply with the anti-fraud and abuse provisions of the Social Security Act, the False Claims Act, the privacy provisions of the Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act, or HIPAA, and similar state laws, each as amended. Pricing and rebate programs must comply with the Medicaid rebate requirements of the Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1990 and the Veterans Health Care Act of 1992, or VHCA, each as amended. If products are made available to authorized users of the Federal Supply Schedule, additional laws and requirements apply. Under the VHCA, drug companies are required to offer certain drugs at a reduced price to a number of federal agencies including the U.S. Department of Veteran Affairs and U.S. Department of Defense, the Public Health Service and certain private Public Health Service‒designated entities in order to participate in other federal funding programs including Medicare and Medicaid. In addition discounted prices must be offered for certain U.S. Department of Defense purchases for its TRICARE program via a rebate system. Participation under the VHCA requires submission of pricing data and calculation of discounts and rebates pursuant to complex statutory formulas, as well as the entry into government procurement contracts governed by the Federal Acquisition Regulations.

 

In order to distribute products commercially, we must comply with state laws that require the registration of manufacturers and wholesale distributors of pharmaceutical products in a state, including, in certain states, manufacturers and distributors who ship products into the state, even if such manufacturers or distributors have no place of business within the state. Several states have enacted legislation requiring pharmaceutical companies to establish marketing compliance programs, file periodic reports with the state, make periodic public disclosures on sales and marketing, activities or register their sales representatives. Other legislation has been enacted in certain states prohibiting certain other sales and marketing practices. All of our activities are potentially subject to federal and state consumer protection and unfair competition laws.

 

  67  

 

   

Expanded Access to Investigational Drugs

 

An investigational drug may be eligible for clinical use outside the context of a manufacturer-sponsored clinical trial of the drug. “Expanded access” refers to the use of an investigational drug where the primary purpose is to diagnose, monitor, or treat a patient’s disease or condition rather than to collect information about the safety or effectiveness of a drug. Expanded access INDs are typically sponsored by individual physicians to treat patients who fall into one of three FDA-recognized categories of expanded access: expanded access for individual patients, including for emergency use; expanded access for intermediate-size patient populations; and expanded access for large patient populations under a treatment IND or treatment protocol. For all types of expanded access, FDA must determine prior to authorizing expanded access that: (1) the patient or patients to be treated have a serious or life threatening disease or condition and there is no comparable or satisfactory alternative therapy; (2) the potential patient benefit justifies the potential risks of use and that the potential risks are not unreasonable in the context of the disease or condition to be treated; and (3) granting the expanded access will not interfere with the initiation, conduct, or completion of clinical studies in support of the drug’s approval. In addition, the sponsor of an expanded access IND must submit IND safety reports and, in the cases of protocols continuing for one year or longer, annual reports to the FDA. Expanded access programs are not intended to yield information relevant to evaluating a drug’s effectiveness for regulatory purposes.

 

Legal Proceedings and Related Matters

 

From time to time, we may be party to litigation that arises in the ordinary course of our business. We do not have any pending litigation that, separately or in the aggregate, would, in the opinion of management, have a material adverse effect on our results of operations, financial condition or cash flows.

 

C. Organizational Structure

 

The following is a list of our subsidiaries:

 

Name of undertaking   Country of
registration
  Activity   %
holding
 
GW Pharma Limited   England and Wales   Research and Development     100  
GW Research Limited   England and Wales   Research and Development     100  
Greenwich Biosciences Inc.   United States   Pharmaceutical development services     100  
GWP Trustee Company Limited   England and Wales   Employee Share Ownership     100  
Cannabinoid Research Institute Limited   England and Wales   Dormant     100  
Guernsey Pharmaceuticals Limited   Guernsey   Dormant     100  
G-Pharm Limited   England and Wales   Dormant     100  

 

D. Property, Plant and Equipment

 

Type   Location   Size (sq ft)     Expiry
Executive office   Andover, United Kingdom     3,113     April 2020
Executive office   London, United Kingdom     2,680     September 2020
Executive office   Cambridge, United Kingdom     12,120     May 2021
Executive office   Carlsbad, United States     4,911     January 2019
Executive office   Durham, United States     782     October 2016
Executive office   Southern United Kingdom     17,222     December 2025
Research and manufacturing   Southern United Kingdom     64,620     January 2019
Research and manufacturing   Southern United Kingdom     15,222     November 2027
Research and manufacturing   Southern United Kingdom     3,261     September 2029
Research and manufacturing   Southern United Kingdom     20,172     May 2036
Research and manufacturing   Southern United Kingdom     7,050     December 2019
Growing facility   Eastern United Kingdom     1,960,000     August 2021
Growing facility   Southern United Kingdom     163,350     January 2017
Growing facility   Northern United Kingdom     914,760     December 2016
Growing facility   Tenerife, Spain     11,679     December 2016
Growing facility   Eastern United Kingdom     815,022     February 2020

 

All of our property is leased. On November 9, 2016, we signed a six-year lease for 21,895 square feet in Carlsbad, California to meet our future US commercialization requirements. We believe that our office, research and manufacturing facilities are sufficient to meet our current needs. We are not aware of any environmental issues that may affect our utilization of our property.

 

  68  

 

  

Further details of our Property, Plant and Equipment are given in Note 14 to our consolidated financial statements set out on page F-22.

 

Item 4A. Unresolved Staff Comments.

 

There are no written comments from the staff of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission which remain unresolved before the end of the fiscal year to which the annual report relates.

 

Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects.

 

The following discussion of our financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with “Selected Financial Data,” and our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this Annual Report. We present our consolidated financial statements in pounds sterling and in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards, or IFRS, as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board, or IASB, and as adopted by the European Union, or E.U.

 

The statements in this discussion regarding industry outlook, our expectations regarding our future performance, liquidity and capital resources and other non-historical statements are forward-looking statements. These forward-looking statements are subject to numerous risks and uncertainties, including, but not limited to, the risks and uncertainties described in “Risk Factors” and “Forward-Looking Statements” in this Annual Report. Our actual results may differ materially from those contained in or implied by any forward-looking statements.

 

Solely for the convenience of the reader, unless otherwise indicated, all pound sterling amounts as at and for the year ended September 30, 2016 have been translated into U.S. dollars at the rate at September 30, 2016, of £0.7744 to $1.00 and unless otherwise indicated, all pounds sterling amounts as at and for the year ended September 30, 2015 have been translated into U.S. dollars at the rate at September 30, 2015, the last business day of our year ended September 30, 2015, of £0.6611 to $1.00. These translations should not be considered representations that any such amounts have been, could have been or could be converted into U.S. dollars at that or any other exchange rate as at that or any other date.

 

A. Operating Results.

 

Important Financial and Operating Terms and Concepts

 

Revenue

 

We generate revenue from product sales, license fees, collaboration fees, technical access fees, development and approval milestone fees, research and development fees and royalties. Agreements with our commercial partners generally include a non-refundable upfront fee (attributed to separately identifiable components including license fees, collaboration fees and technical access fees), milestone payments, the receipt of which is dependent upon the achievement of certain clinical, regulatory or commercial milestones, royalties on product sales of licensed products if and when such product sales occur and revenue from the supply of products. For these agreements, total arrangement consideration is attributed to separately identifiable components on a reliable basis that reasonably reflects the selling prices that might be achieved in stand-alone transactions. The allocated consideration is recognized as revenue in accordance with our accounting policies for each revenue stream.

 

Product sales

 

We recognize revenue from the sale of products when we have transferred the significant risks and rewards of ownership of the goods to the buyer, when we no longer have effective control over the goods sold, when the amount of revenue and costs associated with the transaction can be measured reliably, and when it is probable that we will receive future economic benefits associated with the transaction. Product sales have no rights of return.

 

We maintain a rebate provision for expected reimbursements to our commercial partners in circumstances in which actual net revenue per vial differs from expected net revenue per vial as a consequence of, as an example, ongoing pricing negotiations with local health authorities. The amount of our rebate provision is based on, among other things, monthly unit sales and in-market sales data received from commercial partners, and represents management’s best estimate of the rebate expected to be required to settle the present obligation at the end of the reporting period. Provisions for rebates are established in the same period that the related sales are recorded.

 

  69  

 

   

Licensing fees

 

Licensing fees are upfront payments received under our product out-licensing agreements from our commercial partners for the right to commercialize products. Such fees are generally received upfront, are non-refundable and are deferred and recognized over the period of the expected license term.

 

Collaboration fees

 

Collaboration fees are amounts received from our commercial partners for our participation in joint development activities. Such fees are generally received upfront, are non-refundable and are deferred and recognized as services are rendered based on the percentage of completion method.

 

Technical access fees

 

Technical access fees represent amounts charged to licensing partners to provide access to, and allow them to commercially exploit, data that we possess or that can be expected to result from our research programs that are in progress. Non-refundable technical access fees that involve the delivery of data that we possess and that permit our licensing partners to use the data freely and where we have no remaining obligations to perform are recognized as revenue upon delivery of the data. Non-refundable technical access fees relating to data where the research program is ongoing are recognized based on the percentage of completion method.

 

Development and approval milestone fees

 

Development and approval milestones represent amounts received from our commercial partners, the receipt of which is dependent upon the achievement of certain clinical, regulatory or commercial milestones. We recognize development and approval milestone fees as revenue based on the percentage of completion method on the assumption that all stages will be completed successfully, but with cumulative revenue recognized limited to non-refundable amounts already received or reasonably certain to be received.

 

Research and development fees

 

Research and development fees represent amounts chargeable to our development partners relating to the conduct of our joint research plans. Revenue from development partner-funded contract research and development agreements is recognized as research and development services are rendered. Where services are in-progress at period end, we recognize revenue proportionately, in line with the percentage of completion of the service. Where such in-progress services include the conduct of clinical trials, we recognize revenue in line with the stage of completion of each trial so that revenue is recognized in line with the expenditures.

 

Royalties

 

Royalty revenue arises from our contractual entitlement to receive a fixed percentage of our commercial partner’s in-market net product sales revenue. Royalty revenue is recognized on an accrual basis in accordance with the substance of the relevant agreement provided that it is probable that the economic benefits will flow to us and the amount of revenue can be measured reliably.

 

Costs of sales

 

Costs of sales principally includes the cost of materials, direct labor, depreciation of manufacturing assets and overhead associated with our manufacturing facilities.

 

  70  

 

   

Research and development expenditure

 

Expenses on research and development activities are recognized as an expense in the period in which the expense is incurred.

 

An internally generated intangible asset arising from our development activities is recognized only when an asset is created that can be identified, it is probable that the asset created will generate future economic benefits and the development cost of the asset can be measured reliably.

 

We have determined that regulatory approval is the earliest point at which the probable threshold for the creation of an internally generated intangible asset can be achieved. All research and development expenditure incurred prior to achieving regulatory approval is therefore expensed as incurred.

 

GW-funded research and development expenditure

 

GW-funded research and development expenditure consists of costs associated with our research activities. These costs include costs of conducting our pre-clinical studies or clinical trials, payroll costs associated with employing our team of research and development staff, share-based payment expenses, property costs associated with leasing laboratory and office space to accommodate our research teams, costs of growing botanical raw material, costs of consumables used in the conduct of our in-house research programs, payments for research work conducted by sub-contractors and sponsorship of work by our network of academic collaborative research scientists, costs associated with safety studies and costs associated with the development of further Epidiolex, Sativex or our other pipeline product data.

 

Development partner-funded research and development expenditure

 

Development partner-funded research and development expenditure represent costs incurred by us in conducting the joint research plans under our collaborations. These costs include (i) costs incurred under our Phase 3 cancer pain program and other Sativex related U.S. market development activities that are chargeable to Otsuka under the terms of the 2007 Sativex U.S. development license and (ii) costs that we incur in providing support to the regulatory and research activities of our other Sativex development partners, which are recoverable under the terms of our agreements.

 

Sales, general and administrative expenses

 

Sales, general and administrative expenses consist primarily of salaries and benefits related to our executive, finance, commercial, business development and support functions. Other sales, general and administrative expenses include costs associated with managing our commercial activities and the costs of compliance with the day-to-day requirements of being a listed public company in the United States, including insurance, general administration overhead, legal and professional fees, audit fees and fees for taxation services.

 

We expect that sales, general and administrative expenses will increase in the future as we expand our operating activities and start to build our commercial team in preparation for commercialization of Epidiolex.

 

Net foreign exchange gains/losses

 

Net foreign exchange gains/losses consist primarily of gains or losses recorded on our foreign currency cash and cash equivalents translated to Pounds Sterling at the balance sheet date.

 

Interest expense and other income

 

Interest expense consists primarily of interest expense incurred on three finance leases. One lease was settled in the year ended September 30, 2015, and the remaining leases will expire in 2027 and 2031, respectively. One of these leases commenced in the year ended September 30, 2016.

 

Other income consists primarily of interest earned by investing our cash reserves in short-term interest-bearing deposit accounts and an ‘above the line’ credit associated with the United Kingdom large company R&D tax credit scheme.

 

  71  

 

   

Taxation

 

As a U.K. resident trading company, we are predominantly subject to U.K. corporate taxation. Our tax recognized represents the sum of the tax currently payable or recoverable, and deferred tax. Deferred tax liabilities are generally recognized for all taxable temporary differences and deferred tax assets are recognized only to the extent that it is probable that taxable profits will be available against which deductible temporary differences can be utilized.

 

As a company that carries out extensive research and development activities, we benefit from the U.K. research and development tax credit regime for small and medium sized companies, whereby our principal research subsidiary company, GW Research Limited, is able to surrender a portion of trading losses that arise from its research and development activities for a refundable credit of up to 33.35% of eligible research and development expenditures. Qualifying expenditures largely comprise employment costs for research staff, consumables and certain internal overhead costs incurred as part of research projects. Subcontracted research expenditures are eligible for a cash rebate of up to 21.68%. The majority of our pipeline research, clinical trials management and the Epidiolex and Sativex chemistry and manufacturing controls development activities, all of which are being carried out by GW Research Limited, are eligible for inclusion within these tax credit claims.

 

The Sativex Phase 3 cancer pain clinical trials program, which is fully funded by Otsuka, and certain other Sativex safety studies are being carried out by GW Pharma Limited, our principal commercial trading subsidiary. As GW Pharma Limited is currently profitable, it is currently unable to surrender losses to seek a research and development tax credit.

 

We may also benefit from the U.K.’s “patent box” regime in the future. This would allow certain profits attributable to revenues from patented products to be taxed at a lower rate than other revenue that over time will be reduced to 10%. As we have many different patents covering our products, we expect that future upfront fees, milestone fees, product revenues and royalties could be taxed at this favorably low tax rate. When taken in combination with the enhanced relief available on our research and development expenditure, this could result in a long-term low rate of corporation tax. As such, we consider that the U.K. is a favorable location for us to continue to conduct our business for the long-term.

 

Our U.S. subsidiary, Greenwich Biosciences Inc. (formerly GW Pharmaceuticals Inc.), is currently profitable and incurs a U.S. tax liability on taxable profits earned in the United States.

 

Critical Judgments in Applying our Accounting Policies

 

In the application of our accounting policies, we are required to make judgments, estimates and assumptions about the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. The estimates and associated assumptions are based on historical experience and other factors that are considered to be relevant. Actual results may differ from these estimates.

 

Our estimates and assumptions are reviewed on an ongoing basis. Revisions to accounting estimates are recognized in the period in which the estimate is revised if the revision affects only that period or in the period of the revisions and future periods if the revision affects both current and future periods.

 

The following are our critical judgments, except those involving estimation uncertainty, that we have made in the process of applying our accounting policies and that have the most significant effect on the amounts recognized in our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this Annual Report.

 

Recognition of clinical trials expenses and liabilities

 

We recognize expenses incurred in carrying out clinical trials during the course of conduct of each clinical trial in line with the state of completion of each trial. This involves the calculation of clinical trial accruals at each period end to account for incurred expenses. This requires estimation of the expected full cost to complete the trial as well as the current stage of trial completion.

 

  72  

 

  

Clinical trials usually take place over extended time periods and typically involve a set-up phase, a recruitment phase and a completion phase which ends upon the receipt of a final report containing full statistical analysis of trial results. Accruals are prepared separately for each in-process clinical trial and take into consideration the stage of completion of each trial including the number of patients that have entered the trial, the number of patients that have completed treatment and whether we have received the final report. In all cases, the full cost of each trial is expensed by the time we have received the final report.

 

Revenue recognition

 

We recognize revenue from product sales, license fees, collaboration fees, technical access fees, development and approval milestone fees, research and development fees and royalties. Agreements with our commercial partners generally include a non-refundable upfront fee (attributed to separately identifiable components including license fees, collaboration fees and technical access fees), milestone payments (the receipt of which is dependent upon the achievement of certain clinical, regulatory or commercial milestones), and royalties on product sales of licensed products if and when such product sales occur and revenue from the supply of products to our commercial partners. For these agreements, we are required to apply judgment in the allocation of total agreement consideration to the separately identifiable components on a reliable basis that reasonably reflects the selling prices that might be expected to be achieved in stand-alone transactions.

 

Product revenue received is based on a contractually agreed percentage of our commercial partner’s in-market net sales revenue. The commercial partner’s in-market net sales revenue is the price per vial charged to end customers, less set defined deductible overheads incurred in distributing the product. In developing estimates, we use monthly unit sales and in-market sales data received from commercial partners during the course of the year. For certain markets, where negotiations are ongoing with local reimbursement authorities, an estimated in-market sales price is used, which requires the application of judgement in assessing whether an estimated in-market sales price is reliably measurable. In our assessment, we consider, inter alia, identical products sold in similar markets and whether the agreed prices for those identical products support the estimated in-market sales price. In the event that we consider there to be significant uncertainty with regards to the in-market sales price to be charged by the commercial partner as a result of, as an example, ongoing pricing negotiations with local health authorities, such that it is not possible to reliably measure the amount of revenue that will flow to us, we would not recognize revenue until that uncertainty has been resolved.

 

We apply the percentage of completion revenue recognition method to certain classes of revenue. The application of this approach requires our judgment with regards to the total costs incurred and total estimated costs expected to be incurred over the length of the agreement.

 

Key Sources of Estimation Uncertainty

 

The key assumptions concerning the future, and other key sources of estimation uncertainty at the balance sheet date, that have a significant risk of causing a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within the next year are discussed below.  

 

  73  

 

   

Deferred taxation

 

Our policy is to recognize deferred tax assets only to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profits, feasible tax-planning strategies and deferred tax liabilities will be available against which the deferred tax assets can be utilized. At September 30, 2016, we have accumulated tax losses of £102.8 million and other deductible temporary differences of £33.9 million, which are available to offset against future profits. If the value of these losses and other deductible temporary differences were recognized within the Group’s balance sheet at September 30, 2016, the Group would be carrying a deferred tax asset of £23.2 million compared to £18.9 million at September 30, 2015. Due to cumulative losses in recent years and uncertainties with respect to achieving certain future milestones, our ability to rely on estimated future taxable profits for purposes of recognizing deferred tax assets is limited to short term profit projections of Greenwich Biosciences Inc. (formerly GW Pharmaceuticals Inc.), our U.S. subsidiary. We recognized a deferred tax asset of £3.9 million on our balance sheet at September 30, 2016, compared to £0.4 million at September 30, 2015.

 

Research and Development Tax Credit

 

The Group's research and development tax credit claim is complex and requires management to interpret and apply UK research and development tax legislation to the Group's specific circumstances and requires the use of certain assumptions in estimating the portion of current year research costs that are eligible for the claim.

 

Segments

 

We operate through three reportable segments, Commercial, Sativex Research and Development and Pipeline Research and Development.

 

Commercial. The Commercial segment distributes and sells the Group’s commercial products. Currently Sativex is promoted through strategic collaborations with major pharmaceutical companies for the currently approved indication of spasticity due to MS. The commercial segment will include revenues from the direct marketing of other future approved commercial products. The Group has licensing agreements for the commercialization of Sativex with Almirall S.A. in Europe (excluding the United Kingdom) and Mexico, Otsuka Pharmaceutical Co. Ltd. (“Otsuka”) in the U.S., Bayer HealthCare AG in the United Kingdom and Canada, Neopharm Group in Israel and Ipsen Biopharm Ltd. in Latin America (excluding Mexico and the Islands of the Caribbean). Commercial segment revenues include product sales, royalties, license, collaboration, and technical access fees, and development and approval milestone fees.

 

Sativex Research and Development. The Sativex Research and Development (“Sativex R&D”) segment seeks to maximize the potential of Sativex through the development of new indications. The focus during the period for this segment was the Phase 3 clinical development program of Sativex for use in the treatment of cancer pain. Sativex R&D segment revenues consist of research and development fees charged to Sativex licensees.

 

  74  

 

  

Pipeline Research and Development. The Pipeline Research and Development (“Pipeline R&D”) segment seeks to develop cannabinoid medications other than Sativex across a range of therapeutic areas using our proprietary cannabinoid technology platform. The Group’s product pipeline includes Epidiolex®, in development as a treatment for Dravet syndrome, Lennox-Gastaut syndrome, Tuberous Sclerosis and Infantile Spasms, as well as other product candidates in Phase 1 and 2 clinical development for glioma, adult epilepsy and schizophrenia. Pipeline R&D segment revenues consist of research and development fees charged to Otsuka under the terms of our pipeline research collaboration agreement.

 

Results of Operations

 

Comparison of Years Ended September 30, 2016 and 2015

 

The following table summarizes the results of our operations for the years ended September 30, 2016 and 2015, together with the changes to those items.

 

    Year Ended September 30,     Change
2016 vs. 2015
 
    2016     2016     2015     Increase/(Decrease)  
    $     £     £     £     %  
    (in thousands, except for percentages)  
Revenue     13,320       10,315       28,540       (18,225 )     (64 )%
Cost of sales     (3,511 )     (2,719 )     (2,618 )     (101 )     4 %
Research and development expenditure     (128,889 )     (99,815 )     (76,785 )     (23,030 )     30 %
Sales, general and administrative expenses     (25,747 )     (19,939 )     (12,569 )     (7,370 )     59 %
Net foreign exchange gains     32,993       25,551       6,202       19,349       312 %
Operating loss     (111,834 )     (86,607 )     (57,230 )     (29,377 )     51 %
Interest expense     (223 )     (173 )     (75 )     (98 )     131 %
Other income     785       608       244       364       149 %
Loss before tax     (111,272 )     (86,172 )     (57,061 )     (29,111 )     51 %
Tax benefit     29,073       22,515       12,498       10,017       80 %
Loss for the year     (82,199 )     (63,657 )     (44,563 )     (19,094 )     43 %

 

Revenue

 

The following table summarizes our revenue for the years ended September 30, 2016 and 2015, together with the changes to those items.

 

    Year Ended September 30,     Change
2016 vs. 2015
 
    2016     2016     2015     Increase/
(Decrease)
 
    $     £     £     £     %  
    (in thousands, except for percentages)  
Product sales     6,725       5,208       4,255       953       22 %
Research and development fees     4,955       3,837       22,810       (18,973 )     (83 )%
License, collaboration and technical access fees     1,513       1,172       1,287       (115 )     (9 )%
Development and approval milestone fees     127       98       188       (90 )     (48 )%
Total revenue     13,320       10,315       28,540       (18,225 )     (64 )%

 

  75  

 

 

Total revenue for the year ended September 30, 2016 was £10.3 million, compared to £28.5 million for the year ended September 30, 2015. The decrease of £18.2 million comprises:

 

£19.0 million decrease in research and development fees reflecting the impact of the conclusion of the Group's partner funded Sativex Phase 3 cancer pain clinical trials.

 

£1.0 million increase in Sativex product sales revenues to £5.2 million due to increased shipments. In-market sales volumes sold by GW’s commercial partners for the year ended September 30, 2016 were 14% higher than the year ended September 30, 2015. Sales volumes to partners increased by 9% over the same period.

 

£0.1 million decrease in licence, collaboration and technical access fees to £1.2 million for the year ended September 30, 2016 compared to £1.3 million for the year ended September 30, 2015. This decrease is due to the recognition period of certain signature fees having come to an end in the prior year.

 

£0.1 million decrease in development and approval milestones as a result of having earned one milestone from our parter Ipsen for the year ended September 30, 2016, compared to the receipt of two milestones for the year ended September 30, 2015.

 

Cost of sales

 

Cost of sales for the year ended September 30, 2016 of £2.7 million represents an increase of £0.1 million compared to the £2.6 million recorded in the year ended September 30, 2015. This increase primarily reflects the growth in the volume of Sativex inventory shipped to commercial partners in the year ended September 30, 2016.

 

Research and development expenditure

 

The following table summarizes our research and development expenditure for the years ended September 30, 2016 and 2015, together with the changes to those items.

 

    Year Ended September 30,    

Change

2016 vs.

2015

 
    2016     2016     2015    

Increase/

(Decrease)

 
    $     £     £     £     %  
    (in thousands, except for percentages)  
GW-funded research and development     123,935       95,978       53,975       42,003       78 %
Development partner-funded research and development     4,954       3,837       22,810       (18,973 )     (83 )%
Total research and development expenditure     128,889       99,815       76,785       23,030       30 %

 

Total research and development expenditure for the year ended September 30, 2016 of £99.8 million increased by £23.0 million compared to the £76.8 million incurred in the year ended September 30, 2015.

 

  76  

 

 

GW-funded research and development expenditure increased by £42.0 million to £96.0 million for the year ended September 30, 2016 from £54.0 million for the year ended September 30, 2015. The increase is due to:

 

£17.1 million increase in epilepsy and other GW funded clinical program costs - reflecting the costs associated with GW's continuing Dravet and Lennox-Gastaut syndrome Epidiolex studies, setting up new Phase 3 studies, costs of our other pipeline studies and costs of providing regulatory support and Epidiolex to an increasing number of patients under FDA-authorized expanded access INDs.

 

£16.0 million increase in research and development staff and employment-related expenses linked to increased global headcount combined with the transition of the Group's clinical headcount from partner funded Sativex trials to the GW funded pipeline activities and Epidiolex development program.

 

£6.5 million increase in other overheads associated with running clinical trials such as depreciation of R&D assets, consumables and other property-related overheads. This increase has been impacted by the Group's refocussing of assets on GW funded activities from partner funded projects.

 

£2.4 million increase in costs of growing an increased volume of high CBD plant material for the Epidiolex development program.

 

We track all research and development expenditures against detailed budgets but do not seek to allocate and monitor all research and development costs by individual project. As noted in the segmental analysis below, we do analyze GW-funded research and development into Sativex related expenditures and pipeline related expenditures. External third-party costs of running clinical trials totaling £28.1 million for the year ended September 30, 2016 and £13.4 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 were tracked by individual project while the remaining £67.9 million for the year ended September 30, 2016 and £40.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 consisting largely of internal overhead costs were not allocated to individual projects. We believe that our existing liquidity is sufficient to complete our currently ongoing GW-funded research and development projects.

 

Development partner-funded research and development projects are funded in advance by our development partners, which involves the receipt of advanced funds every three months, sufficient to cover projected expenditure for the next three months. For further information on the risks our research and development program face, see “Risk Factors—Risks Related to Development and Regulatory Approval of Sativex and Our Product Candidates.”

 

Development partner-funded research and development expenditure was made up of two principal elements, as follows:

 

    Year Ended September 30,    

Change

2016 vs. 2015

 
    2016     2016     2015    

Increase/

(Decrease)

 
    $     £     £     £     %  
    (in thousands, except for percentages)  
Sativex U.S. development program     4,519       3,500       22,275       (18,775 )     (84 )%
                                         
Otsuka research collaboration expenses     435       337       535       (198 )     (37 )%
                                         
Total development partner-funded research and development     4,954       3,837       22,810       (18,973 )     (83 )%

 

Sativex U.S. development expenses decreased by £18.8 million, or 84%, to £3.5 million during the year ended September 30, 2016 as compared to £22.3 million for the year ended September 30, 2015. This reflects decreased expenditure following the completion of the three Sativex Phase 3 cancer pain trials.

 

Otsuka research collaboration expenses decreased by £0.2 million, or 37%, to £0.3 million during the year ended September 30, 2016 as compared to £0.5 million for the year ended September 30, 2015. The decrease reflects the fact that the Otsuka research collaboration term ended on June 30, 2013 and the remaining revenue relates to income recognized to offset the depreciation expense of property, plant and equipment purchased under the collaboration agreement, which are now all fully depreciated.

 

  77  

 

 

Sales, general and administrative expenses

 

Sales, general and administrative expenses for the year ended September 30, 2016 of £19.9 million increased by £7.3 million compared to the £12.6 million incurred in the year ended September 30, 2015. This net increase is due to:

 

£6.3 million increase in employee-related expenses, comprising a £5.1 million increase in payroll costs driven by increased headcount and a £1.2 million increase in the charge in respect of the provision for payroll taxes on unrealized staff share option gains.

 

£0.9 million increase in property and travel costs, primarily to the U.S. by staff involved in the establishment of U.S. based operations.

 

£0.5 million increase in accountancy, audit and investor relation costs arising from GW's U.S. listing and Sarbanes-Oxley compliance.

 

A £0.4 million decrease in respect of pre-launch commercialization costs in the U.S. These costs follow discrete commercialization projects.

 

Net foreign exchange gains

 

Net foreign exchange gains increased by £19.4 million, or 312%, to £25.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2016 compared to £6.2 million for the year ended September 30, 2015. This represents foreign exchange gains, due to unrealized gains on our U.S. dollar denominated cash deposits at the closing balance sheet exchange rate.

 

Interest expense

 

Interest expense of £0.2 million for the year ended September 30, 2016 increased by £0.1 million, or 131%, compared to the £0.1 million recorded for the year ended September 30, 2015. This increase reflects an increase in interest paid on leases for manufacturing facilities.

 

Other income

 

Other income increased by £0.4 million, or 149%, to £0.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2016 compared to £0.2 million for the year ended September 30, 2015. The increase reflects the increase in the Group’s cash and cash equivalents balance and additional tax credit recognized in the UK.

 

Tax

 

Our tax benefit increased by £10.0 million, or 80%, to £22.5 million for the year ended September 30, 2016 compared to £12.5 million for the year ended September 30, 2015. This benefit consists of:

 

Accrual for an expected research and development tax credit claim of £21.2 million in respect of the year ended September 30, 2016 for GW Research Limited. We expect to submit this claim in the quarter ending March 31, 2017 and this claim is subject to agreement by HMRC.

 

Recognition of an additional £0.7 million of research and development tax credit in respect of the year ended September 30, 2015 for GW Research Limited.

 

Recognition of U.S. tax credits of £0.8 million in respect of the years ended September 30, 2015 and September 30, 2016 for the Group’s U.S. subsidiary, Greenwich Biosciences Inc. (formerly GW Pharmaceuticals Inc.) following the submission of an orphan drug tax credit claim.

 

Research and development tax credits recognized vary depending on our available tax losses, the eligibility of our research and development expenditure and the level of certainty relating to the recoverability of the claim.

 

Segmental review

 

Commercial segment

 

The following table summarizes the results of our operations for our Commercial segment for the years ended September 30, 2016 and 2015, together with the changes to those items.

 

  78  

 

 

    Year Ended September 30,    

Change

2016 vs. 2015

 
    2016     2016     2015    

Increase/

Decrease

 
    $     £     £     £     %  
    (in thousands, except for percentages)  
Product sales     6,725       5,208       4,255       953       22 %
License, collaboration and technical access fees     1,513       1,172       1,287       (115 )     (9 )%
Development and approval milestone fees     127       98       188       (90 )     (48 )%
Total revenue     8,365       6,478       5,730       748       13 %
Cost of sales     (3,511 )     (2,719 )     (2,618 )     (101 )     4 %
Segmental result     4,854       3,759       3,112       647       21 %

 

We classify all revenue from Sativex collaboration partners, with the exception of research and development fees, as Commercial segment revenue. The principal variances in these revenue streams are summarized in the table above. An explanation of the principal movements in the revenue streams is provided in the revenue section above.

 

Cost of sales for the year ended September 30, 2016 of £2.7 million represents an increase of £0.1 million compared to the £2.6 million recorded in the year ended September 30, 2015. This increase reflects the growth in the volume of Sativex vials shipped to commercial partners in the year ended September 30, 2016.

 

Sativex Research and Development segment

 

The following table summarizes the results of our operations for our Sativex R&D segment for the years ended September 30, 2016 and 2015, together with the changes to those items.

 

    Year Ended September 30,    

Change

2016 vs.

2015

 
    2016     2016     2015    

Increase/

(Decrease)

 
    $     £     £     £     %  
    (in thousands, except for percentages)  
Research and development fees     4,519       3,500       22,275       (18,775 )     (84 )%
Research and development expenditure:                                        
GW-funded research and development     (807 )     (625 )     (4,123 )     3,498       (85 )%
Development partner-funded research and development     (4,519 )     (3,500 )     (22,275 )     18,775       (84 )%
Total research and development expenditure     (5,326 )     (4,125 )     (26,398 )     22,273       (84 )%
Segmental result     (807 )     (625 )     (4,123 )     3,498       (85 )%

 

Total research and development expenditure related to Sativex of £4.1 million for the year ended September 30, 2016 decreased by £22.3 million, or 84%, compared with the £26.4 million recorded for the year ended September 30, 2015. This decrease reflects the conclusion and close out of the Sativex Phase 3 cancer pain clinical trials.

 

  79  

 

 

As all of the development partner-funded research and development expenditure is reimbursed to us under the terms of our license agreements, the net result for this segment equals the GW-funded research and development expenditure on Sativex related projects.

 

Pipeline Research and Development segment

 

The following table summarizes the results of our operations for our Pipeline R&D segment for the years ended September 30, 2016 and 2015, together with the changes to those items.

 

   

Year Ended

September 30,

   

Change

2016 vs.

2015

 
    2016     2016     2015    

Increase/

(Decrease)

 
    $     £     £     £     %  
    (in thousands, except for percentages)  
Research and development fees     435       337       535       (198 )     (37 )%
Research and development expenditure                                        
GW-funded research and development     (117,809 )     (91,234 )     (48,327 )     (42,907 )     89 %
Development partner-funded research and development     (435 )     (337 )     (535 )     198       (37 )%
Total research and development expenditure     (118,244 )     (91,571 )     (48,862 )     (42,709 )     87 %
Segmental result     (117,809 )     (91,234 )     (48,327 )     (42,907 )     89 %

 

GW-funded pipeline research and development expenditure increased by £42.7 million, or 87%, to £91.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2016 as compared to £48.9 million for the year ended September 30, 2015. This reflects the impact of carrying out GW-funded clinical trials and research and development, including the costs associated with GW’s ongoing Phase 3 Dravet syndrome and Tuberous Sclerosis studies, plus the costs of the completed Phase 3 Dravet and Lennox-Gastaut syndrome Epidiolex studies, preclinical and scale up work associated with our epilepsy program. Additionally, we have various pipeline activities including cannabidivarin, or CBDV, which is in Phase 2 development in the field of epilepsy and is also being researched within the field of autism spectrum disorders, or ASD.

 

Pipeline research and development fees are equal to the development partner-funded research and development expenditure incurred by us in conducting our joint pipeline research program and recharged to Otsuka under the terms of our 2007 research collaboration agreement. The 20% year-on-year decrease in pipeline research and development fees reflects the ending, effective June 30, 2013, of our pre-clinical research collaboration with Otsuka in the field of CNS disorders and unwinding of remaining revenue associated with this collaboration. GW has a worldwide license to all data and product candidates generated under the collaboration.

 

As the development partner-funded research and development expenditure was fully offset by the associated research and development fees, the segmental result equals the GW-funded pipeline research and development expenditure.

 

Comparison of Years Ended September 30, 2015 and 2014

 

The following table summarizes the results of our operations for the years ended September 30, 2015 and 2014, together with the changes to those items.

 

    Year Ended September 30,    

Change

2015 vs. 2014

 
    2015     2015     2014     Increase/(Decrease)  
    $     £     £     £     %  
    (in thousands, except for percentages)  
Revenue     43,172       28,540       30,045       (1,505 )     (5 )%
Cost of sales     (3,960 )     (2,618 )     (2,060 )     (558 )     27 %
Research and development expenditure     (116,153 )     (76,785 )     (43,475 )     (33,310 )     (77 )%
Sales, general and administrative expenses     (19,013 )     (12,569 )     (7,337 )     (5,232 )     (71 )%
Net foreign exchange gains     9,382       6,202       3,188       3,014       95 %
Operating loss     (86,572 )     (57,230 )     (19,639 )     (37,591 )     (191 )%
Interest expense     (113 )     (75 )     (61 )     (14 )     (23 )%
Other income     369       244       130       114       88 %
Loss before tax     (86,316 )     (57,061 )     (19,570 )     (37,491 )     (192 )%
Tax benefit     18,906       12,498       4,911       7,587       154 %
Loss for the year     (67,410 )     (44,563 )     (14,659 )     (29,904 )     (204 )%

 

  80  

 

 

Revenue

 

The following table summarizes our revenue for the years ended September 30, 2015 and 2014, together with the changes to those items.

 

    Year Ended September 30,    

Change

2015 vs. 2014

 
    2015     2015     2014    

Increase/

(Decrease)

 
    $     £     £     £     %  
    (in thousands, except for percentages)  
Product sales     6,437       4,255       4,382       (127 )     (3 )%
Research and development fees     34,504       22,810       24,285       (1,475 )     (6 )%
License, collaboration and technical access fees     1,947       1,287       1,378       (91 )     (7 )%
Development and approval milestone fees     284       188       -       188       -  
Total revenue     43,172       28,540       30,045       (1,505 )     (5 )%

 

  81  

 

 

Total revenue decreased by 5% to £28.5 million for the year ended September 30, 2015, compared to £30.0 million for the year ended September 30, 2014. This decrease was driven by a variety of factors, as explained below.

 

Sativex product sales revenue decreased by £0.1 million, or 3%, to £4.3 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 compared to £4.4 million for the year ended September 30, 2014. This decrease was primarily due to inclusion in the year ended September 30, 2015 of a £0.2 million rebate provision for amounts expected to be paid to Almirall following the decision of the Italian Medicines Agency to impose a maximum budget for Sativex sales in Italy for 2013 and 2014.

 

Research and development fees decreased by £1.5 million, or 6%, to £22.8 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 compared to £24.3 million for the year ended September 30, 2014. This decrease was due to decreased research and development costs, linked to the Otsuka-funded Phase 3 cancer pain clinical program.

 

License, collaboration and technical access fees decreased by £0.1 million, or 7%, to £1.3 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 compared to £1.4 million for the year ended September 30, 2014. This decrease was due to the completion of the recognition of a Novartis cancer pain technical access fee during 2015.

 

Development and approval milestone fees increased by £0.2 million, to £0.2 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 compared to £nil  for the year ended September 30, 2014. Development and approval milestone fees consist of milestone payments due to us from Sativex partners under the terms of our agreements. Development and approval milestone payments of £0.2 million during the year ended September 30, 2015 resulted from two milestone payments received from Ipsen upon submission of regulatory dossiers in two South American territories for Sativex. We had no such payment during the year ended September 30, 2014.

 

Cost of sales

 

Cost of sales increased by £0.5 million, or 27%, to £2.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 compared to £2.1 million for the year ended September 30, 2014. This increase was due to a 22% increase in the volume of Sativex vials shipped to partners during the year ended September 30, 2015 compared to the year ended September 30, 2014. Costs of sales per unit shipped remained consistent across periods.

 

Research and development expenditure

 

The following table summarizes our research and development expenditure for the years ended September 30, 2015 and 2014, together with the changes to those items.

 

    Year Ended September 30,    

Change

2015 vs.

2014

 
    2015     2015     2014    

Increase/

(Decrease)

 
    $     £     £     £     %  
    (in thousands, except for percentages)  
GW-funded research and development     81,649       53,975       19,190       34,785       181 %
Development partner-funded research and development     34,504       22,810       24,285       (1,475 )     (6 )%
Total research and development expenditure     116,153       76,785       43,475       33,310       77 %

 

Total research and development expenditure increased by £33.3 million, or 77%, to £76.8 million for the year ended September 30, 2015, from £43.5 million for year ended September 30, 2014. As shown in the table above, research and development expenditure consists of two elements, GW-funded research and development expenditure and development partner-funded research and development expenditure.

 

  82  

 

 

The £34.8 million increase in GW-funded research and development expenditure was due principally to:

 

£17.5 million increase in epilepsy and other GW-funded clinical program costs reflecting the costs associated with GW's ongoing Phase 3 Dravet and Lennox-Gastaut syndrome Epidiolex studies, costs of our other pipeline studies and costs of providing regulatory support and Epidiolex under FDA-authorized expanded access INDs.

 

£9.2 million increase in staff and employment-related expenses as a result of increased headcount as the Group expands its team in the UK and the U.S. to enable execution of the epilepsy development program.

 

£4.1 million increase in costs of growing an increased volume of high CBD plant material for the Epidiolex development program.

 

£4.0 million increase in other property-related overheads and depreciation of R&D assets.

 

We track all research and development expenditures against detailed budgets but do not seek to allocate and monitor all research and development costs by individual project. As noted in the segmental analysis below, we do analyze GW-funded research and development into Sativex related expenditures and pipeline related expenditures. External third-party costs of running clinical trials totaling £13.4 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 and £2.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2014 were tracked by individual project while the remaining £40.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 and £16.5 million for the year ended September 30, 2014 consisting largely of internal overhead costs were not allocated to individual projects. We believe that our existing liquidity is sufficient to complete our currently ongoing GW-funded research and development projects.

 

Development partner-funded research and development projects are funded in advance by our development partners, which involves the receipt of advanced funds every three months, sufficient to cover projected expenditure for the next three months. For further information on the risks our research and development program face, see “Risk Factors—Risks Related to Development and Regulatory Approval of Sativex and Our Product Candidates.”

 

Development partner-funded research and development expenditure was made up of two principal elements, as follows:

 

    Year Ended September 30,    

Change

2015 vs. 2014

 
    2015     2015     2014    

Increase/

(Decrease)

 
    $     £     £     £     %  
    (in thousands, except for percentages)  
Sativex U.S. development program     33,695       22,275       23,618       (1,343 )     (6 )%
                                         
Otsuka research collaboration expenses     809       535       667       (132 )     (20 )%
                                         
Total development partner-funded research and development     34,504       22,810       24,285       (1,475 )     (6 )%

 

Sativex U.S. development expenses decreased by £1.3 million, or 6%, to £22.3 million during the year ended September 30, 2015 as compared to £23.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2014. This reflects decreased expenditure following the completion of the three Sativex Phase 3 cancer pain trials.

 

Otsuka research collaboration expenses decreased by £0.2 million, or 20%, to £0.5 million during the year ended September 30, 2015 as compared to £0.7 million for the year ended September 30, 2014. The decrease reflects the fact that the Otsuka research collaboration term ended on June 30, 2013 and the remaining revenue relates to income recognized to offset the depreciation expense of property, plant and equipment purchased under the collaboration agreement, which will shortly all be fully depreciated. Most of the pre-clinical programs that Otsuka was funding are now proceeding into Phase 1/2 clinical trials as part of the GW-funded clinical programs.

 

  83  

 

 

Sales, general and administrative expenses (formerly management and administrative expenses)

 

Sales, general and administrative expenses (formerly Management and administrative expenses) increased by £5.3 million, or 71%, to £12.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 compared to £7.3 million for the year ended September 30, 2014. The increase reflects a £4.4 million increase in respect of pre-launch commercialization costs in the U.S., £0.8 million increase in respect of property and travel costs, primarily to the U.S. by staff involved in the establishment of U.S. based operations, £0.7 million increase in respect of increased accountancy, audit and investor relation costs arising from GW's U.S. listing and Sarbanes-Oxley compliance, £0.6 million decrease in respect of employee-related expenses, comprising a £2.0 million decrease in the charge in respect of the provision for payroll taxes on unrealized staff share option gains; and offset by a £1.4 million increase in payroll costs driven by increased headcount.

 

Net foreign exchange gains

 

Net foreign exchange gains increased by £3.0 million, or 95%, to £6.2 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 compared to £3.2 million for the year ended September 30, 2014. This represents foreign exchange gains, due to unrealized gains on our U.S.-dollar denominated cash deposits at the closing balance sheet exchange rate.

 

Interest expense

 

Interest expense of £0.1 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 was consistent with the £0.1 million recorded for the year ended September 30, 2014.

 

Other income

 

Other income increased by £0.1 million, or 88%, to £0.2 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 compared to £0.1 million for the year ended September 30, 2014. The increase reflects the increase in interest earned on the Group’s cash and cash equivalents balance.

 

Tax

 

Our tax benefit increased by £7.6 million, or 154%, to £12.5 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 compared to £4.9 million for the year ended September 30, 2014. This benefit consists of:

 

Accrual for an expected research and development tax credit claim of £12.6 million in respect of the year ended September 30, 2015 for GW Research Limited. We expect to submit this claim in the quarter ending March 31, 2016 and this claim is subject to agreement by HMRC.

 

Recognition of an additional £0.2 million of research and development tax credit in respect of the year ended September 30, 2014 for GW Research Limited.

 

Recognition of U.S. current tax expense of £0.3 million in respect of the year ended September 30, 2015 for the Group’s U.S. subsidiary, Greenwich Biosciences Inc. (formerly GW Pharmaceuticals Inc.).

 

Research and development tax credits recognized vary depending on our available tax losses, the eligibility of our research and development expenditure and the level of certainty relating to the recoverability of the claim.

 

Segmental review

 

Commercial segment

 

The following table summarizes the results of our operations for our Commercial segment for the years ended September 30, 2015 and 2014, together with the changes to those items.

 

  84  

 

 

    Year Ended September 30,    

Change

2015 vs. 2014

 
    2015     2015     2014    

Increase/

Decrease

 
    $     £     £     £     %  
    (in thousands, except for percentages)  
Product sales     6,437       4,255       4,382       (127 )     (3 )%
License, collaboration and technical access fees     1,947       1,287       1,378       (91 )     (7 )%
Development and approval milestone fees     284       188       -       188       -  
Total revenue     8,668       5,730       5,760       (30 )     (1 )%
Cost of sales     (3,960 )     (2,618 )     (2,060 )     (558 )     (27 )%
Research and development credit     -       -       847       (847 )     (100 )%
Segmental result     4,708       3,112       4,547       (1,435 )     (32 )%

 

We classify all revenue from Sativex collaboration partners, with the exception of research and development fees, as Commercial segment revenue. The principal variances in these revenue streams are summarized in the table above. An explanation of the principal movements in the revenue streams is provided in the revenue section above.

 

Cost of sales increased by £0.5 million, or 27%, to £2.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 compared to £2.1 million for the year ended September 30, 2014 driven by a 22% year‒on‒year increase in the volume of Sativex vials shipped to partners as previously discussed.

 

For the Commercial segment, the research and development credit represents the movement in the provision against inventories manufactured prior to the regulatory approval of Sativex (such inventories were capitalized as an asset but provided for, with the charge recognized in the research and development expenditure line, until there was a high probability of regulatory approval). When we determined that there was a high probability of regulatory approval of Sativex, the provision was revised to adjust the carrying value of Sativex inventories to the expected net realizable value, which may not exceed original cost. The provision for inventories release of £nil for the year ended September 30, 2015 was lower than the release of £0.8 million for the year ended September 30, 2014. The higher provision release in the year ended September 30, 2014 was due to us having reassessed and increased our estimated future sales of Sativex, resulting in release of provision.

 

Sativex Research and Development segment

 

The following table summarizes the results of our operations for our Sativex R&D segment for the years ended September 30, 2015 and 2014, together with the changes to those items.

 

    Year Ended September 30,    

Change

2015 vs.

2014

 
    2015     2015     2014    

Increase/

(Decrease)

 
    $     £     £     £     %  
    (in thousands, except for percentages)  
Research and development fees     33,695       22,275       23,618       (1,343 )     (6 )%
Research and development expenditure:                                        
GW-funded research and development     (6,237 )     (4,123 )     (2,826 )     (1,297 )     (46 )%
Development partner-funded research and development     (33,695 )     (22,275 )     (23,618 )     1,343       6 %
Total research and development expenditure     (39,932 )     (26,398 )     (26,444 )     46       0 %
Segmental result     (6,237 )     (4,123 )     (2,826 )     (1,297 )     46 %

 

Total research and development expenditure related to Sativex of £26.4 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 was consistent with the £26.4 million recorded for the year ended September 30, 2014. This movement consisted of a £1.3 million decrease due to the conclusion of the three Phase 3 cancer pain clinical trials offset by a £1.3 million increase in Phase 1 trials, pre-clinical, regulatory and abuse liability planning activities that are being carried out to support the cancer pain development program and are funded by Otsuka under the terms of the Sativex license and development agreement.

 

As all of the development partner-funded research and development expenditure is reimbursed to us under the terms of our license agreements, the net result for this segment equals the GW-funded research and development expenditure on Sativex related projects.

 

  85  

 

 

Pipeline Research and Development segment

 

The following table summarizes the results of our operations for our Pipeline R&D segment for the years ended September 30, 2015 and 2014, together with the changes to those items.

 

   

Year Ended

September 30,

   

Change

2015 vs.

2014

 
    2015     2015     2014    

Increase/

(Decrease)

 
    $     £     £     £     %  
    (in thousands, except for percentages)  
Research and development fees     809       535       667       (132 )     (20 )%
Research and development expenditure                                        
GW-funded research and development     (73,105 )     (48,327 )     (16,436 )     (31,891 )     (194 )%
Development partner-funded research and development     (809 )     (535 )     (667 )     132       20 %
Total research and development expenditure     (73,914 )     (48,862 )     (17,103 )     (31,759 )     (186 )%
Segmental result     (73,105 )     (48,327 )     (16,436 )     (31,891 )     (194 )%

 

GW-funded pipeline research and development expenditure increased by £31.9 million, or 194%, to £48.3 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 as compared to £16.4 million for the year ended September 30, 2014. This reflects the impact of carrying out GW-funded clinical trials and research and development, including the costs associated with GW’s ongoing Phase 3 Dravet and Lennox-Gastaut syndrome Epidiolex studies, preclinical and scale up work associated with our epilepsy program. Additionally, we have completed a Phase 2 clinical trial with GWP42003 and have ongoing Phase 2 trials in glioma with a THC:CBD product candidate, and in diabetes with GWP42004.

 

Pipeline research and development fees are equal to the development partner-funded research and development expenditure incurred by us in conducting our joint pipeline research program and recharged to Otsuka under the terms of our 2007 research collaboration agreement. The 20% year-on-year decrease in pipeline research and development fees reflects the ending, effective June 30, 2013, of our pre-clinical research collaboration with Otsuka in the field of CNS disorders and unwinding of remaining revenue associated with this collaboration. GW has a worldwide license to all data and product candidates generated under the collaboration.

 

As the development partner-funded research and development expenditure was fully offset by the associated research and development fees, the segmental result equals the GW-funded pipeline research and development expenditure.

 

B. Liquidity and Capital Resources.

 

In recent years, we have largely funded our operations and growth from issuances of equity securities, research and development fees and tax credits and milestone payments from our development partners. We have also funded our operations and growth with cash flows from operating activities, including Sativex revenue credits and interest income. Our cash flows may fluctuate, are difficult to forecast and will depend on many factors, including:

 

  86  

 

 

the timing of achievement of future Epidiolex regulatory approvals and commercial launches in the United States and Europe;

 

the extent to which we seek to retain development rights to our pipeline of new product candidates or whether we seek to out-license them to a partner who will fund future research and development expenditure in return for a right to share in future commercial revenue;

 

the extent of success in our early pre-clinical and clinical stage research programs which will determine the amount of funding required to further the development of our product candidates;

 

the terms and timing of new strategic collaborations;

 

the number and characteristics of the product candidates that we seek to develop;

 

the outcome, timing and cost of regulatory approvals of Epidiolex and our other product candidates;

 

the costs involved in constructing larger, FDA-compliant manufacturing facilities for Epidiolex and our other product candidates;

 

the costs involved in filing and prosecuting patent applications and enforcing and defending potential patent claims;

 

the costs of hiring additional skilled employees to support our continued growth; and

 

the rate of growth of our Sativex revenue, which relies upon the marketing efforts of our commercial partners and factors such as the timing of further national approvals, the price levels achieved by our partners in each country, and the availability of reimbursement in countries in which the product is able to be marketed.

 

We believe that, our cash and cash equivalents as at September 30, 2016 of £374.4 million, coupled with cash flows from operating activities will be sufficient to fund our operations, including currently anticipated research and development activities and planned capital expenditures, for the foreseeable future, including for at least the next 12 months.

 

Cash Flows

 

The following table summarizes the results of our cash flows for the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014.

 

    Year Ended September 30,  
    2016     2016     2015     2014  
    $     £     £     £  
    (in thousands)  
Net cash outflow from operating activities     (109,234 )     (84,594 )     (46,471 )     (12,626 )
Net cash outflow from investing activities     (11,307 )     (8,756 )     (17,791 )     (7,095 )
Net cash inflow from financing activities     267,045       206,807       128,419       144,267  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of the year     483,445       374,392       234,872       164,491  

 

Operating activities

 

Net cash outflow from operating activities for the year ended September 30, 2016 of £84.6 million was £38.1 million higher than the £46.5 million outflow from operating activities for the year ended September 30, 2015, principally reflecting the increase in investment in Epidiolex and other pipeline research and development activities offset by additional tax benefit.

 

Net cash flow from operating activities increased by £33.9 million to a £46.5 million outflow for the year ended September 30, 2015 compared to a £12.6 million outflow for the year ended September 30, 2014. This increase was primarily driven by a £34.8 million increase in GW-funded research and development expenditure.

 

  87  

 

 

Investing activities

 

The net cash outflow from investing activities decreased by £9.0 million to £8.8 million for the year ended September 30, 2016 from £17.8 million for the year ended September 30, 2015, reflecting a decrease in capital expenditure of £9.2 million during the year ended September 30, 2016 due to the conclusion of a significant phase of construction of our new manufacturing facilities.

 

The net cash outflow from investing activities increased by £10.7 million to £17.8 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 from £7.1 million for the year ended September 30, 2014, reflecting an increase in capital expenditure of £10.7 million during the year ended September 30, 2015 as we accelerated our investment in expanding and upgrading our cannabinoid extraction and Epidiolex manufacturing and growing facilities.

 

Financing activities

 

Net cash flow from financing activities increased by £78.4 million to a £206.8 million inflow in the year ended September 30, 2016 compared to a £128.4 million inflow for the year ended September 30, 2015 due to a £79.1 million increase in net new equity funding inflows, a £0.6 million reduction in proceeds from the exercise of employee share options, a £0.2 million increase in fit out funding repayments and a £0.1 million decrease in finance lease repayments.

 

Net cash inflow from financing activities decreased by £15.9 million to £128.4 million for the year ended September 30, 2015 from £144.3 million for the year ended September 30, 2014 primarily as a result of a decrease of £7.8 million in the receipt of fit-out funding receipts, a decrease of £5.3 million in the receipt of warrant exercise proceeds, a decrease of £3.8 million in proceeds from the exercise of employee share options offset by a £1.2 million increase in new equity funding, net of expenses.

 

C. Research and Development, Patents and Licenses, etc.

 

Full details of our research and development activities and expenditures are given in the Business section and Operating and Financial Review and Prospects sections of this Annual Report above.

 

 D. Trend information

 

The following charts illustrate the key financial trends in our business:

 

 

  88  

 

 

Our revenues consist of R&D fees, product sales revenues, royalties, licence collaboration and technical access fees and development and approval milestone fees.

 

For the year ended September 30, 2016, we recorded revenues of £5.2 million for Sativex product sales, an increase of £0.9 million from the £4.3 million recorded for the year ended September 30, 2015. This increase was due primarily to an increase in the volume of shipments to partners of 9%.

 

In the year to September 30, 2016 we have seen a decline in our research and development fee income, as the level of rechargeable activity associated with our recently completed cancer pain trials programme has significantly reduced during the course of the year. We consider our licence, collaboration and technical access fees and our product sales revenues to be recurring revenues. The milestone revenues recognized in each of the financial years above tend to be individual items linked to specific development milestones achieved in a particular financial year.

 

In 2012 we received substantial development and approval milestones from our Sativex licensees. In 2013, we received only one £250,000 development and approval milestone. In 2014, we received no development and approval milestones. In 2015, we received two €125,000 development and approval milestones linked to regulatory filings by Ipsen, our commercial partner in Latin America. In 2016, we received one €125,000 development and approval milestone linked to a regulatory submission filing by Ipsen in Venezuela.

 

The Sativex In-market vial sales volumes graph above illustrates the trend in in-market commercial sales volumes of Sativex by our commercial marketing partners Bayer in UK/Canada, Almirall in Europe and Neopharm in Israel. In-market sales volumes grew by 14% from 2015 to 2016.

 

In 2012 commercial sales to private patients started in Sweden and in 2013 commercial sales by Almirall commenced in Norway, Austria, Italy, Poland and by Neopharm in Israel. In 2014, Almirall launched Sativex in Switzerland and Finland. 2015 and 2016 saw volume growth driven primarily by increased prescribing in Germany and Italy, as well as launch in Belgium.

 

 

As illustrated in the Total Group Expenditure graph above, our R&D expenditures have shown a consistent growth trend over the last five financial years from £27.6 million in 2012 to £99.8 million in 2016. The growth during 2016 of £23.0 million from the £76.8 million of research and development incurred in 2015 demonstrates the execution of our epilepsy Phase 3 clinical research with Epidiolex as well as progress with a number of other pipeline product candidates. In addition, SG&A expenditure has increased from £12.6 million in 2015 to £19.9 million in 2016, reflecting the increased activity in respect of pre-launch commercialization in the U.S.

 

In the last five years, a significant proportion of the partner-funded R&D expenditure has been driven by our US Phase 3 cancer pain clinical trials programme, which included three pivotal Phase 3 cancer pain trials plus a series of supporting Phase 1 clinical trials and regulatory activities. All of this clinical activity was funded by our development partner Otsuka. These activities came to an end during 2016, explaining the significant decrease in partner funded R&D.

 

In 2012 and 2013, Otsuka also funded a significant amount of pre-clinical activity as part of our six-year pre-clinical research collaboration. This pre-clinical collaboration ended on 30 June 2013. GW now has a worldwide licence to all data and product candidates generated under this collaboration.

 

From 2012 to 2016 GW-funded R&D increased from £8.1 million in 2012 to £96.0 million in 2016. In 2014 GW-funded R&D increased significantly to £19.2 million, reflecting our investment in the development of Epidiolex, cannabidivarin (“CBDV”) and other pipeline candidates. In 2015 GW-funded R&D increased further to £54.0 million, as we initiated five Phase 3 clinical trials in several forms of refractory childhood epilepsy, including Dravet syndrome and Lennox-Gastaut syndrome. In 2016 GW-funded R&D increased to £96.4 million as we completed three Phase 3 clinical trials, and continued to invest in our wider epilepsy program to support the forthcoming NDA filing in the United States. In addition we commenced a Phase 3 clinical trial in Tuberous Sclerosis Complex as well as continuing to progress multiple active Phase 1/2 clinical trials in other disease areas such as epilepsy partial seizures and Glioma.

 

  89  

 

 

The Total Group Cash graph above illustrates the trend in our financial year-end closing cash position for each of the last five years.

 

In 2012 we recorded a positive net operating cash inflow each financial year, largely as a result of the substantial milestone receipts from our Sativex development partners. Since 2013, having taken the decision to invest in the development of Epidiolex to treat a number of refractory forms of childhood onset epilepsy we have consistently recorded operating cash outflows, offset by the proceeds of a series of fundraisings, each of which have been conducted following the achievement of key product development milestones. Our aim has been to ensure that the Group remains well funded with sufficient working capital to successfully execute our Epidiolex and other pipeline product development plans. These equity fundraisings, together with proceeds from share options and warrants, have generated net financing cash inflows as follows:

 

£18.1 million of net new funds from issue of equity as part of our NASDAQ initial public offering in May 2013
£136.6 million in 2014
£128.7 million in 2015
£207.2 million in 2016

 

As a result of this series of successful equity fundraisings the Group has made excellent progress with the execution of our Epidiolex development strategy and with £374.4 million of cash reserves held at September 30, 2016 the Group has the funds necessary to execute our plans to file an NDA with FDA, to scale up our growing and manufacturing facilities and to expand our commercial team in preparation for Epidiolex commercialisation.

 

E. Off Balance Sheet Arrangements.

 

We do not have any off-balance sheet arrangements.

 

  90  

 

 

F. Tabular Disclosure of Contractual Obligations.

 

The following table summarizes our contractual obligations as at September 30, 2016.

 

    Payments Due by Period  
    Total    

Less than

1 year

    1 - 3 years     3 - 5 years    

More than

5 years

 
    £     £     £     £     £  
    (in thousands)  
Operating lease obligations (1)     13,038       2,723       4,816       3,301       2,198  
Finance lease obligations (2)     9,306       571       1,112       1,112       6,511  
Purchase obligations (3)     5,130       5,130       -       -       -  
Borrowings (4)     14,399       1,448       1,930       1,930       9,091  
Growing operations (5)     45,670       6,755       18,069       18,598       2,248  
Total contractual obligations     87,543       16,627       25,927       24,941       20,048  

 

 

(1) We enter into operating leases in the normal course of business. Most lease arrangements provide us with the option to renew the leases on defined terms. The future operating lease obligations would change if we exercise our renewal options or if we were to enter into additional new operating leases. See Note 25 to our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this Annual Report.

 

(2) We enter into finance leases when beneficial to the Group. See Note 19 to our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this Annual Report.

 

(3) Purchase obligations include signed orders for capital equipment, which have been committed but not yet received at the balance sheet date totaling £5.1 million. This includes £4.0 million of capital equipment relating to the commercial growing agreement in (5).

 

(4) We enter into borrowings when beneficial to the Group. See Note 18 to our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this Annual Report.

 

(5) During the year ended September 30, 2016, the Group signed a commercial growing agreement with an external supplier to produce plant material for use in the Epidiolex development programmes and commercial release. This agreement is expected to commence during the second quarter of the year ended September 30, 2017 and includes multiple fee-elements designed to incentivise cost efficient, reliable production volumes. As part of the accounting treatment for this agreement a component operating lease has been identified under the requirements of IFRIC 4 Determining Whether an Arrangement Contains a Lease. Rental payments commence during the second quarter of the year ended 30 September 2017 and continue over a five-year non-cancellable period. Future minimum lease payments associated with this operating lease are included in the table shown above and (1).

 

G. Safe Harbor.

 

See the section titled “Information Regarding Forward-Looking Statements” at the beginning of this Annual Report.

 

Item 6 Directors, Senior Management and Employees.

 

A. Directors and Senior Management.

 

The following table sets forth the names, ages and positions of our executive officers and non-employee directors:

 

Name

 

Age

 

Position

Executive Officers        
Dr. Geoffrey Guy (3)   62   Chairman of the Board of Directors and member of Board of Directors
Justin Gover   45   Chief Executive Officer and member of Board of Directors
Dr. Stephen Wright   64   Chief Medical Officer and member of Board of Directors
Adam George   46   Chief Financial Officer and member of Board of Directors
Chris Tovey   51   Chief Operating Officer and member of Board of Directors
Julian Gangolli   58   President, North America and member of Board of Directors
Non-Employee Directors        
James Noble (1)(2)(3)(4)   57   Deputy Chairman
Cabot Brown (1)(2)(3)(4)   55   Non-Executive Director
Thomas Lynch (1)(2)(4)   60   Non-Executive Director

 

 

(1) Member of the Audit Committee.

 

(2) Member of the Remuneration Committee.

 

(3) Member of the Nomination Committee.

 

(4) An “independent director” as such term is defined in Rule 10A-3 under the Exchange Act.

 

  91  

 

 

Executive Officers

 

Dr. Geoffrey Guy is our founder and has served as Chairman since 1998. Dr. Guy has over 30 years of experience in medical research and global drug development, previously as Chairman and Chief Executive of Ethical Holdings plc, a NASDAQ-quoted drug delivery company (now Amarin Corporation plc, or Amarin), which he founded in 1985 and led to its NASDAQ listing in 1993. He also founded Phytopharm plc in 1989, of which he was Chairman until 1997. Dr. Guy has been the physician in charge of over 300 clinical studies including first dose in man, pharmacokinetics, pharmacodynamics, dose-ranging, controlled clinical trials and large scale multi-centred studies and clinical surveys. He is also an author on numerous scientific publications and has contributed to six books. Dr. Guy was appointed as Visiting Professor in the School of Science and Medicine at the University of Buckingham in July 2011. He also received the “Deloitte Director of the Year Award in Pharmaceuticals and Healthcare” in 2011. Dr. Guy was appointed Visiting Professor at Westminster University, and awarded Honorary DSc at Reading University in 2016. Dr. Guy holds a BSc in pharmacology from the University of London, an MBBS at St Bartholomew’s Hospital, an MRCS Eng. and LRCP London, an LMSSA Society of Apothecaries and a Diploma of Pharmaceutical Medicine from the Royal Colleges of Physicians.

 

Justin Gover has been Chief Executive Officer of GW Pharmaceuticals since January 1999, shortly after the Company was founded. In this time, Mr. Gover has been the lead executive responsible for the running of the company’s operations, leading equity financings and business development activities. He raised initial rounds of private capital, following which led the company’s initial public offering on the AIM stock exchange in London in 2001, and more recently led GW’s initial public offering on Nasdaq in 2013. In total, he has led equity financing rounds which have raised approx. $900m. In 2015, Mr. Gover relocated to the U.S. to open the company’s U.S. headquarters in California. Prior to joining GW, Mr. Gover was Head of Corporate Affairs at Ethical Holdings plc, a UK-based Nasdaq listed company, where he was responsible for the company’s strategic corporate activities, including mergers and acquisitions, strategic investments, equity financings and investor relations. Mr. Gover holds an M.B.A. from the INSEAD business school in France.

 

Dr. Stephen Wright has served as our Research and Development Director and Chief Medical Officer since January 2004 and as a Director since March 2005. Dr. Wright, now GW’s Chief Medical Officer, will retire and step down from his position on 1 May 2017. Dr. Wright has more than 25 years of experience in medicines development. He joined GW from Ipsen, where he was Senior Vice President of Clinical Research & Development and a member of the UK Board of Directors. Prior to this, he was Venture Head of Neuroscience at Abbott Laboratories, based in the US, and was also formerly Associate Medical Director at Glaxo in the UK. In each of these roles he has been closely associated with at least eight successful NDAs for new drug products, both small molecules, peptides and botanicals.

 

Adam George joined GW in 2007 and was Group Financial Controller until June 1, 2012, at which time he joined the Board as Chief Financial Officer. Mr. George also acts as Company Secretary, a role he has held since he first joined the Company. Prior to joining GW, Mr. George occupied several senior finance roles within both listed and privately owned high growth businesses. From 2004 to 2007, Mr. George was Finance Director of Believe It Group Limited (now 4Com plc), a telecommunications service provider, having been Group Financial Controller from 2001 to 2004.

 

Chris Tovey has served as our Chief Operating Officer since October 2012. Prior to joining our Company, Mr. Tovey was at UCB Pharmaceuticals from 2006 to 2012. In his last role there, Mr. Tovey was the Vice President of Global Marketing Operations where he was responsible for worldwide marketing activities on a portfolio of UCB products including Keppra® (Anti-epileptic) generating over €2.0 billion in annual sales. Previous experience and roles at UCB included a number of multi-country product launches including Vimpat® (Anti-epileptic), Managing Director Greece and Cyprus, and leader of all UCB activities on the orphan narcotic medication Xyrem®, used in the treatment of narcolepsy. Mr. Tovey previously spent 18 years at GlaxoSmithKline plc in senior commercial roles in both the European and UK organisations. These roles included Director Commercial Strategy Distribution Europe, Director European Vaccine Therapy, Director Commercial Development UK, Director Vaccines Business Unit UK and Business Unit Manager Oncology UK While at GSK, Mr. Tovey worked across a wide range of therapeutic areas including neurology, infectious diseases, oncology, diabetes, respiratory, gastroenterology and immunology.

 

  92  

 

 

Julian Gangolli has served as our President, North America since his appointment in June 2015. Mr. Gangolli has more than two decades of senior management experience with large pharmaceutical, specialty pharmaceutical, and start-up biotechnology companies. Since July 2016, Mr. Gangolli has served on the board and Audit Committee of Revance Therapeutics, Inc. Prior to joining GW, Mr. Gangolli was, from 2004 until April 2015, President of the North American Pharmaceutical division of Allergan Inc., with responsibility for a 1,400-person integrated commercial operation with sales exceeding $3.8 billion in 2014. As a Corporate Vice President and member of the Executive Committee, Allergan’s most senior leadership team overseeing worldwide operations, Mr. Gangolli was an integral part of the executive management team that transformed Allergan into one of the leading specialty pharmaceutical companies in the US. Prior to Allergan, Mr. Gangolli was Vice President, Sales and Marketing at VIVUS, Inc. where he established from inception a fully functioning commercial operation. Prior to VIVUS, Mr. Gangolli held roles at Syntex Pharmaceuticals, Inc. and Ortho-Cilag Pharmaceuticals Ltd. in the United Kingdom. Mr. Gangolli was raised in the UK and received a BSc (Honours) in Applied Chemistry from Kingston University in England.

 

Non-Employee Directors

 

James Noble has served as a non-executive Director since January 2007. Mr. Noble has extensive experience in the biotech industry and currently serves as Chief Executive Officer of Adaptimmune Therapeutics plc, a NASDAQ-listed company (ADAP) involved in T cell therapeutics. Mr. Noble was previously Chief Executive Officer of Avidex Limited, a private biotech company and, until March 2014, was Chief Executive Officer of Immunocore Limited. Mr. Noble qualified as a chartered accountant with PriceWaterhouse in 1983 and then spent seven years at investment bank Kleinwort Benson Limited, where he became a Director in 1990. He then joined British Biotech plc as Chief Financial Officer and secured the company’s IPO on NASDAQ and London in 1992. From 1997 to 2001, he held numerous non-executive Director positions, including at PowderJect Pharmaceuticals plc, Oxford GlycoSciences plc, MediGene AG, and Advanced Medical Solutions plc. Mr. Noble graduated from the University of Oxford in 1980.

 

Cabot Brown joined the GW Board in February 2013. Mr. Brown is the Founder and Chief Executive Officer of Carabiner LLC, a strategic and financial advisory firm based in San Francisco that specializes in healthcare and education. Previously, Mr. Brown served as a Managing Director and Head of the Healthcare Group at GCA Savvian, an international financial advisory firm, from 2011 to 2012. Before joining GCA Savvian, Mr. Brown worked for 10 years at Seven Hills Group, an investment banking group he co-founded where he also directed the firm’s healthcare activities. He also was Managing Director of Brown, McMillan & Co, an investment firm he co-founded that sponsored buy-outs and venture capital investments. From 1987 until 1995, Mr. Brown worked at Volpe, Welty & Company, a boutique investment bank where he co-founded and ran the healthcare practice and served as a member of its Executive Committee. Mr. Brown holds an MBA from Harvard Business School with high distinction as a George F Baker Scholar and an AB cum laude in Government from Harvard College.

 

Thomas Lynch has served as a non-executive Director since 2010. Mr. Lynch currently serves as Chairman and non-executive Director of Evofem Biosciences Inc., executive Director of Profectus Biosciences, Inc. and Chairman of the Ireland East Healthcare Group. Mr. Lynch serves on the board of a number of other privately held biotechnology companies. Mr. Lynch previously served as Chairman of Icon plc, having served on its board for 22 years. Mr. Lynch has also worked in a variety of capacities in Amarin Corporation plc, Elan Corporation plc and Warner Chilcott plc from 2001 to 2010. Mr. Lynch was a member of the Board of IDA Ireland (an Irish government investment agency).

 

  93  

 

 

B. Compensation.

 

The following discussion provides the amount of compensation paid, and benefits in‒kind granted, by us and our subsidiaries to our directors for services in all capacities to us and our subsidiaries for the year ended September 30, 2016, as well as the amount contributed by us or our subsidiaries into money purchase plans for the year ended September 30, 2016 to provide pension, retirement or similar benefits to, our directors and members of the executive management board.

 

Directors and Executive Management Board Compensation

 

Directors Compensation

 

For the year ended September 30, 2016, the table below sets forth the compensation paid to our directors, and, in the case of Messrs. Guy, Gover, Wright and George, reflects the compensation paid for their services as our executives.

 

Year Ended September 30, 2016 Directors Compensation (1)

 

Name   Salary/Fees    

Annual

Bonus

   

Benefit

Excluding

Pension (2)

   

Pension

Benefit (3)

    Total  
    £     £     £     £     £  
Dr. Geoffrey Guy                                        
Executive Director
Chairman
    353,860       167,342       28,475       54,416       604,093  
Justin Gover (4)                                        
Executive Director
Chief Executive Officer
    311,921       146,720       32,854       52,993       544,488  
Adam George                                        
Executive Director
Chief Financial Officer
    197,276       93,293       17,699       30,337       338,605  
Dr. Stephen Wright                                        
Executive Director
Chief Medical Officer
    242,370       114,618       20,180       39,830       416,998  
Chris Tovey                                        
Executive Director
Chief Operating Officer
    214,179       101,287       17,817       35,198       368,481  
Julian Gangolli                                        
Executive Director
President, North America
    274,997       72,658       1,159       1,664       350,478  
James Noble                                        
Non-Executive Director
Deputy Chairman
    63,500       -       -       -       63,500  
Cabot Brown                                        
Non-Executive Director     51,294       -       -       -       51,294  
Thomas Lynch (5)                                        
Non-Executive Director     -       -       -       -       -  

 

 

(1) For the year ended September 30, 2016, the compensation of Dr. Geoffrey Guy, Adam George, Dr. Stephen Wright, Chris Tovey, and James Noble are set and paid in pounds sterling (£). Compensation of James Noble and Cabot Brown are set in US dollars ($) and paid in pounds sterling. Compensation of Justin Gover and Julian Gangolli are set and paid in US dollars ($).

 

(2) For our Executive Directors, these amounts represent the value of the personal benefits granted to our senior management for the year ended September 30, 2016, which include car allowance and medical and life insurance.

 

  94  

 

 

(3) These amounts represent our contribution into money purchase plans.

 

(4) The Remuneration Committee has agreed to indemnify the incremental US tax suffered by Mr. Gover that he is likely to suffer in respect of the gain on exercising options arising from the September 2013 LTIP award. Further details are provided in Note 27 to our consolidated financial statements.

 

(5) Mr. Lynch has waived his right to receive fees for his service as a Non-Executive Director.

 

Executive Management Compensation

 

The compensation for each member of our executive management board is comprised of the following elements: base salary, annual bonus, personal benefits and long-term incentives. The total amount of compensation paid and benefits in kind granted to the members of our executive management board, whether or not a director, for the year ended September 30, 2016 was £2.7 million.

 

Bonus Plans

 

The discussion set forth below describes each bonus plan pursuant to which compensation was paid to our directors and members of our executive management board for our last full year.

 

Executive Directors are eligible for an annual bonus at the discretion of the Remuneration Committee. Bonus awards are reviewed at the end of each calendar year and any such awards are determined by the performance of the individual and the Group as a whole based upon the achievement of strategic objectives set at the beginning of the year. The awards are normally limited to a maximum of 50% of basic salary, however in exceptional circumstances the annual maximum may increase up to 150% of base salary.

 

Outstanding Equity Awards, Grants and Option Exercise

 

During the year ended September 30, 2016 3,063,893 options to purchase ordinary shares were awarded to the directors under our Long Term Incentive Plan.

 

Name of Director   Type of Plan   Granted     Nominal value     Exercise price     Date of exercise   Date of expiry
Dr. Geoffrey W. Guy   LTIP     182,171       0.1 p     257.0 p   February 15, 2019   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     25,914       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2017   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     25,914       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2018   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     345,517       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2019   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     25,914       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2019   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     25,913       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2020   February 15, 2026
Justin Gover   LTIP     213,245       0.1 p     257.0 p   February 15, 2019   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     30,334       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2017   August 15, 2017
    LTIP     30,334       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2018   August 15, 2018
    LTIP     404,455       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2019   August 15, 2019
    LTIP     30,334       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2019   August 15, 2019
    LTIP     30,334       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2020   August 15, 2020
Adam George   LTIP     67,707       0.1 p     257.0 p   February 15, 2019   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     9,631       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2017   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     9,631       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2018   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     128,417       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2019   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     9,631       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2019   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     9,632       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2020   February 15, 2026
Dr. Stephen Wright   LTIP     83,183       0.1 p     257.0 p   February 15, 2019   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     11,833       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2017   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     11,833       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2018   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     157,771       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2019   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     11,833       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2019   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     11,832       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2020   February 15, 2026
Chris Tovey   LTIP     73,508       0.1 p     257.0 p   February 15, 2019   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     10,456       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2017   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     10,456       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2018   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     139,420       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2019   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     10,457       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2019   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     10,457       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2020   February 15, 2026
Julian Gangolli   LTIP     192,755       0.1 p     257.0 p   February 15, 2019   February 15, 2026
    LTIP     27,419       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2017   August 15, 2017
    LTIP     27,419       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2018   August 15, 2018
    LTIP     365,591       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2019   August 15, 2019
    LTIP     27,419       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2019   August 15, 2019
    LTIP     27,420       0.1 p     0.1 p   February 15, 2020   August 15, 2020
James Noble   LTIP     68,122       0.1 p     383.0 p   December 29, 2018   December 29, 2025
    LTIP     14,479       0.1 p     0.1 p   December 29, 2018   December 29, 2025
Cabot Brown   LTIP     68,122       0.1 p     383.0 p   December 29, 2018   June 29, 2019
    LTIP     14,479       0.1 p     0.1 p   December 29, 2018   June 29, 2019
Thomas Lynch   LTIP     68,122       0.1 p     383.0 p   December 29, 2018   December 29, 2025
    LTIP     14,479       0.1 p     0.1 p   December 29, 2018   December 29, 2025

 

  95  

 

 

As of September 30, 2016, directors held options to purchase 6,528,449 ordinary shares. During the year ended September 30, 2016, directors exercised and sold options over 1,729,792 ordinary shares.

 

We periodically grant share options to employees, directors and consultants to enable them to share in our successes and to reinforce a corporate culture that aligns employee interests with that of our shareholders.

 

Options issued under our Long Term Incentive Plan generally have an exercise price of £0.001 per share and a three-year vesting period (although this could be shorter) and expire ten years from the date of grant (save in relation to options granted to a participant subject to the federal income tax laws of the United States, which may only be exercised for a short period following vesting). Generally, these options are also subject to a number of different performance conditions. If the relevant performance conditions are not achieved by the vesting date, the options lapse. In addition, generally, an option holder must remain an employee, director or consultant throughout the relevant vesting period, or the options will lapse. Options issued under the other share option schemes were all issued with an exercise price equal to the closing market price on the day prior to grant, a three-year vesting period and an expiration ten years from date of grant. The only condition linked to these awards was continued employment throughout the vesting period.

 

Pension, Retirement and Similar Benefits

 

For the year ended September 30, 2016, we and our subsidiaries contributed a total of £0.2 million into money purchase plans to provide pension, retirement or similar benefits to our directors and members of the executive management board. The Group does not operate any pension plans directly.

 

Employment Agreements

 

Dr. Geoffrey Guy

 

On March 14, 2013, GW Research Limited entered into a service agreement with Dr. Guy, our Chairman and Founder. Dr. Guy’s service agreement provides that his service will continue until either party provides no less than 12 months’ written notice. Upon notice of termination, GW Research Limited may require Dr. Guy not to attend work for all or any part of the period of notice, during which time he will continue to receive his salary and other contractual entitlements. GW Research Limited may terminate Dr. Guy’s employment with immediate effect at any time by notice in writing for certain circumstances as described in his service agreement, including bankruptcy, criminal convictions, gross misconduct or serious or repeated breaches of obligations of his service.

 

Dr. Guy’s service agreement provides for a base salary of £341,794 per annum (to be reviewed annually), a car allowance of £24,960 per annum, plus a monthly pension contribution of 17.5% of salary, permanent health insurance coverage, life assurance coverage and private health insurance, and a bonus on such terms and of such amount as approved from time to time by the Remuneration Committee in its sole discretion. Dr. Guy’s service agreement provides that for 12 months following termination of his employment with GW Research Limited, he will not entice, induce or encourage any customer or employee to end their relationship with GW Research Limited or any other member of the Group, solicit or accept business from customers or engage in competitive acts more fully described in his service agreement.

 

  96  

 

 

Justin Gover

 

On February 26, 2013, GW Research Limited entered into a service agreement with Mr. Gover, our Chief Executive Officer. Mr. Gover’s service agreement provides that his service will continue until either party provides no less than 12 months’ written notice. Upon notice of termination, GW Research Limited may require Mr. Gover not to attend work for all or any part of the period of notice, during which time he will continue to receive his salary and other contractual entitlements. GW Research Limited may terminate Mr. Gover’s employment with immediate effect at any time by notice in writing for certain circumstances as described in his service agreement, including bankruptcy, criminal convictions, gross misconduct or serious or repeated breaches of obligations of his service.

 

Mr. Gover’s service agreement provides for a base salary of £281,061 per annum (to be reviewed annually), plus a monthly pension contribution of 17.5% of salary, car allowance of £15,600 per annum, permanent health insurance coverage, life assurance coverage and private health insurance, and a bonus on such terms and of such amount as approved from time to time by the Remuneration Committee in its sole discretion.

 

Mr. Gover’s service agreement provides that, for 12 months following termination of his employment with GW Research Limited, he will not entice, induce or encourage any customer or employee to end their relationship with GW Research Limited or any other member of the Group, solicit or accept business from customers or engage in competitive acts more fully described in his service agreement.

 

On July 21, 2015, (i) this service agreement was novated to GW Pharmaceuticals plc by GW Research Limited and at the same time Mr. Gover’s commitment to GW Pharmaceutical plc was reduced to no more than 30 days per annum, to be worked outside the United States, and his base salary was reduced pro rata to £33,079 ($51,482) per annum (to be reviewed annually) and his entitlement to a car allowance and private health insurance from GW Pharmaceuticals plc were removed, and (ii) Greenwich Biosciences Inc. (formerly GW Pharmaceuticals Inc.), entered into a service agreement with Mr. Gover, which provides that his service will continue until either party provides no less than 12 months’ written notice. Upon notice of termination, Greenwich Biosciences Inc. may require Mr. Gover not to attend work for all or any part of the period of notice, during which time he will continue to receive his salary and other contractual entitlements. GW Research Limited may terminate Mr. Gover’s employment with immediate effect at any time by notice in writing for certain circumstances as described in his service agreement, including bankruptcy, criminal convictions, gross misconduct or serious or repeated breaches of obligations of his service.

 

Mr. Gover’s service agreement with Greenwich Biosciences Inc. provides for a base salary of $446,177 per annum less the amount to be paid to Mr. Gover by GW Pharmaceuticals plc in the UK in respect of his role as its Chief Executive Officer (initially $51,482 per annum), plus a monthly pension contribution of 17.5% of salary once Greenwich Biosciences Inc. has established its 401(k) Plan, car allowance of $24,279 per annum, permanent health insurance coverage, life assurance coverage and private health insurance, and a bonus on such terms and of such amount as approved from time to time by the Remuneration Committee in its sole discretion.

 

Dr. Stephen Wright

 

On January 18, 2013, GW Research Limited entered into a service agreement with Dr. Stephen Wright, our Chief Medical Officer. The service agreement provides that his service will continue until either party provides no less than 12 months written notice. Upon notice of termination, GW Research Limited may require Dr. Wright not to attend work for all or any part of the period of notice, during which time he will continue to receive his salary and other contractual entitlements. GW Research Limited may terminate Dr. Wright’s employment with immediate effect at any time by notice in writing for certain circumstances as described in his service agreement, including bankruptcy, criminal convictions, gross misconduct or serious or repeated breaches of obligations of his service.

 

Dr. Wright’s service agreement provides for a base salary of £234,106 per annum (to be reviewed annually), plus a monthly pension contribution of 17.5% of salary, a car allowance of £15,600 per annum, life assurance coverage, the cost of membership for Dr. Wright, his spouse and children in a private patients medical plan, access to a permanent health insurance plan, and a bonus on such terms and of such amount as approved from time to time by the Remuneration Committee in its sole discretion.

 

  97  

 

 

Dr. Wright’s service agreement provides that for 12 months following termination of his employment with GW Research Limited, he will not entice, induce or encourage any customer or employee to end their relationship with GW Research Limited or any other member of the Group, solicit or accept business from customers or engage in competitive acts more fully described in his service agreement.

 

On 9 August 2016 we announced that Dr. Stephen Wright will step down from his position as Chief Medical Officer and a member of the Board of Directors on 1 May 2017. Dr. Wright will remain in post full-time until May 2017 and will thereafter stay on as a part time employee of the Company throughout the NDA process for Epidiolex, in which he will continue to take a leading and active role.

 

Adam George

 

On June 1, 2012, GW Pharma Limited entered into a service agreement with Mr. George, our Chief Financial Officer. The service agreement provides for a base salary of £190,550 per annum (to be reviewed annually), plus a monthly pension contribution of 17.5% of salary, a car allowance of £15,600 per annum, life assurance coverage, the cost of membership for Mr. George, his spouse and children in a private patients medical plan, access to a permanent health insurance plan, and a discretionary bonus on such terms and of such amount as decided from time to time by the Remuneration Committee in its sole discretion.

 

Mr. George’s service agreement provides that, his service will continue until either party provides no less than 12 months’ written notice. Upon notice of termination, GW Pharma Limited may require Mr. George not to attend work for all or any part of the period of notice, during which time he will continue to receive his salary and other contractual entitlements. GW Pharma Limited may terminate Mr. George’s employment with immediate effect at any time by notice in writing for certain circumstances as described in his service agreement, including bankruptcy, criminal convictions, gross misconduct or serious or repeated breaches of obligations of his service.

 

Mr. George’s service agreement provides that for a period of 12 months following termination of his employment with GW Pharma Limited, he will not entice, induce or encourage any customer or employee to end their relationship with GW Pharma Limited or any member of the Group, solicit or accept business from customers or engage in competitive acts more fully described in his service agreement.

 

Chris Tovey

 

On July 11, 2012, GW Pharma Limited entered into a service agreement with Mr. Tovey, our Chief Operating Officer. The service agreement provides for a base salary of £206,876 per annum (to be reviewed annually), plus a monthly pension contribution of 17.5% of salary, a car allowance of £15,600 per annum, life assurance coverage, the cost of membership for Mr. Tovey, his spouse and children in a private patients medical plan, access to a permanent health insurance plan, and a discretionary bonus on such terms and of such amount as decided from time to time by the Remuneration Committee in its sole discretion.

 

Mr. Tovey’s service agreement provides that his service will continue until either party provides no less than 12 months’ written notice. Upon notice of termination, GW Pharma Limited may require Mr. Tovey not to attend work for all or any part of the period of notice, during which time he will continue to receive his salary and other contractual entitlements. GW Pharma Limited may terminate Mr. Tovey’s employment with immediate effect at any time by notice in writing for certain circumstances as described in his employment agreement, including bankruptcy, criminal convictions, gross misconduct, or serious or repeated breaches of obligations to his service.

 

Mr. Tovey’s service agreement provides that for a period of 12 months following termination of his employment with GW Pharma Limited, he will not entice, induce or encourage any customer or employee to end their relationship with GW Pharma Limited or any other member of the Group, solicit or accept business from customers or engage in competitive acts more fully described in his service agreement.

 

Julian Gangolli

 

On May 6, 2015, Greenwich Biosciences Inc. (formerly GW Pharmaceuticals Inc.) entered into a service agreement with Mr. Gangolli, our President, North America. Mr. Gangolli’s service agreement provides that his service will continue until either party provides no less than one month’s written notice. Upon notice of termination, Greenwich Biosciences Inc. may pay Mr. Gangolli his salary in lieu of giving a month’s written notice.

 

  98  

 

 

Mr. Gangolli’s service agreement with Greenwich Biosciences Inc. provides for a base salary of $400,000 per annum (to be reviewed annually), less any amounts paid under his service agreement with GW Pharmaceuticals plc (described below), a bonus on such terms and of such amount as approved from time to time by the Remuneration Committee in its sole discretion, plus life assurance coverage, matching contributions to a 401(k) plan and private health insurance once Greenwich Biosciences Inc. has established these benefit programs.

 

On July 21, 2015, GW Pharmaceuticals plc entered into a service agreement with Mr. Gangolli for Mr. Gangolli to provide GW Pharmaceuticals plc with no fewer than 12 days of work per annum, to be worked outside the United States. The Service Agreement provides for a base salary of $1,550 per day (to be reviewed annually).

 

Mr. Gangolli’s service agreement with GW Pharmaceuticals plc provides that his service will continue until either party provides no less than 6 months’ written notice. Upon notice of termination, GW Pharmaceuticals plc may require Mr. Gangolli not to attend work for all or any part of the period of notice. GW Pharmaceuticals plc may terminate Mr. Gangolli’s employment with immediate effect at any time by notice in writing for certain circumstances as described in his service agreement, including bankruptcy, criminal convictions, gross misconduct serious or repeated breaches of obligations of his service.

 

Mr. Gangolli’s service agreement with GW Pharmaceuticals plc provides that, for 12 months following termination of his employment with GW Pharmaceuticals plc, he will not entice, induce or encourage any customer or employee to end their relationship with GW Pharmaceuticals plc or any other member of the Group, solicit or accept business from customers or engage in competitive acts more fully described in his service agreement.

 

James Noble

 

On January 19, 2007, GW Pharmaceuticals plc appointed Mr. Noble Deputy Chairman and Non-Executive Director with effect from January 26, 2007. On February 1, 2016, GW Pharmaceuticals plc entered into an appointment letter with Mr. Noble, which continues for no specific duration. The appointment letter provides for Director’s fees of £63,000 per annum, plus reimbursement for all reasonable out-of-pocket expenses incurred on GW Pharmaceutical plc business and director’s and officer’s liability insurance, subject to the provisions governing such insurance and on such terms as our board of directors may from time to time decide. Mr. Noble’s agreement provides that he is not entitled to participate in any pension scheme and is not eligible for any other employee benefits. Mr. Noble is eligible to participate in the Company’s Long Term Incentive Plan under its rules.

 

Mr. Noble’s appointment letter provides that his appointment will continue until either party provides no less than three months’ written notice and that he should be prepared to spend at least 12 days per year on company business. Mr. Noble’s appointment may be automatically terminated if he is removed from office by a resolution of the shareholders, is not re-elected to office, vacates his office, commits any act that would justify summary termination of an employment contract, or is unable to perform his duties under his appointment for six months consecutively or in aggregate in any period of one year. Mr. Noble’s appointment letter provides that GW Pharmaceuticals plc may, during any period of notice, ask Mr. Noble not to attend any board or general meetings or to perform any other services on its behalf. The appointment letter includes a non-compete clause, to take effect on termination, for 12 months following termination of his office.

 

Cabot Brown

 

We originally appointed Mr. Brown as a Non-Executive Director on February 19, 2013. Mr. Brown serves as a member of the Audit Committee, the Remuneration Committee and Nominations Committee.

 

On January 1, 2016, GW Pharmaceuticals plc entered into an appointment letter with Mr. Brown, which continues for no specific duration. The appointment letter provides for Director’s fees of $70,000 plus reimbursement for all reasonable out‒of‒pocket expenses incurred on GW Pharmaceuticals plc’s business and director’s and officer’s liability insurance, subject to the provisions governing such insurance and on such terms as our board of directors may from time to time decide. Mr. Brown’s appointment letter provides that he is not entitled to participate in any pension and will not be eligible for other employee benefits. Mr. Brown is eligible to participate in the Company’s Long Term Incentive Plan under its rules.

 

  99  

 

 

Mr. Brown’s appointment letter also provides that his appointment will continue until either party provides no less than three months’ written notice and that he should be prepared to spend at least 12 days per year attending board and general meetings of GW Pharmaceuticals plc. Mr. Brown’s appointment may be automatically terminated if he is removed from office as a director of GW Pharmaceuticals plc by a resolution of the shareholders, is not re-elected to office, vacates his office, commits any act that would justify summary termination of an employment contract or if he is unable to perform his duties under his appointment for six months consecutively or in aggregate in any period of one year. Mr. Brown’s appointment letter provides that GW Pharmaceuticals plc may, during any period of notice, ask Mr. Brown not to attend any board or general meetings or to perform any other services on its behalf. The appointment letter includes a non-compete clause, to take effect on termination, for one year.

 

Thomas Lynch

 

On July 22, 2010, GW Pharmaceuticals plc appointed Mr. Lynch a Non-Executive Director. On February 26, 2013, Mr. Lynch entered into an updated appointment letter with GW Pharmaceuticals plc, which continues for no specific duration. Mr. Lynch has waived his right to receive fees for this role. Mr. Lynch’s agreement provides for reimbursement for all reasonable out-of-pocket expenses incurred on GW Pharmaceutical plc business and director’s and officer’s liability insurance, subject to the provisions governing such insurance and on such terms as our Board of Directors may from time to time decide. Mr. Lynch’s agreement provides that he is not entitled to participate in any pension or any other employee benefits. Mr. Lynch is eligible to participate in the Company’s Long Term Incentive Plan under its rules.

 

Mr. Lynch’s appointment letter provides that his appointment will continue until either party provides no less than three months’ written notice and that he should be prepared to spend at least 12 days per year on company business. Mr. Lynch’s appointment may be automatically terminated if he is removed from office by a resolution of the shareholders, is not re-elected to office, vacates his office, commits any act that would justify summary termination of an employment contract or if he is unable to perform his duties under his appointment for six months consecutively or in aggregate in any period of one year.

 

Mr. Lynch’s appointment letter provides that GW Pharmaceuticals plc may, during any period of notice, ask Mr. Lynch not to attend any board or general meetings or to perform any other services on its behalf. The agreement includes a non-compete clause, to take effect on termination, for 12 months following termination of his office.

 

Equity Compensation Plans

 

GW Pharmaceuticals plc Long-Term Incentive Plan

 

Our board of directors adopted and our shareholders approved the GW Pharmaceuticals plc Long-Term Incentive Plan, or the Long-Term Incentive Plan, on March 18, 2008, and it has subsequently been amended in accordance with its terms.. The Long-Term Incentive Plan permits the grant of awards over our ordinary shares to be granted to our employees, directors and consultants, referred to in this annual report as Awards, all summarized below.

 

Types of Award. Under the Long-Term Incentive Plan, the Remuneration Committee may grant Matching Awards (which are granted in connection with invitations to participants to acquire Investment Shares, see the following paragraph) or Performance Awards (awards other than Matching Awards). Awards are in the form of either an option to purchase our ordinary shares, referred to in this Annual Report as an Option or a conditional right to acquire a number of our ordinary shares for no payment upon vesting, referred to in this Annual Report as a Conditional Award. Awards may be granted only within the six weeks beginning with the dealing date after the date on which we announce our results for any period or at any other time that the Committee determines that the circumstances justify the grant. The Remuneration Committee may determine that any Conditional Award or Option may be settled in cash rather than ordinary shares unless it would be unlawful to do so or if it would cause adverse tax or social security contribution consequences for the participant or us or our affiliates.

 

  100  

 

 

Matching Awards and Investment Shares. The Remuneration Committee may invite any eligible employee to participate in the Long-Term Incentive Plan by purchasing ordinary shares, which are referred to as Investment Shares in this Annual Report. The invitation will specify the maximum amount of Investment Shares which can be purchased, the procedure for purchasing the Investment Shares, the maximum number of ordinary shares which may be received as a Matching Award and other terms of the Award. A “Return Date” will also be specified which is the date by which the invitation to participate must be accepted. As soon as practicable after the Return Date, we procure the acquisition of the Investment Shares and the participant is granted a Matching Award. The participant will have full rights with respect to the Investment Shares. Any ordinary shares subject to a Matching Award with respect to Investment Shares will be transferred to the participant when the Matching Award vests.

 

Vesting of Awards. Awards generally vest on the later of the date on which the Remuneration Committee determines whether any applicable performance conditions or other vesting condition have been met or the third anniversary of the grant date (or such other date as the Remuneration Committee may determine prior to the grant of the applicable Award, which may be before the third anniversary of the grant date). In addition, a Matching Award will lapse on the date on which the participant does any act in breach of the terms relating to Investment Shares or loses his entitlement to, transfers, charges or otherwise disposes of the Investment Shares to which the Matching Award relates and the lapse shall be pro rata to the number of the affected Investment Shares. Options, once vested, will generally remain exercisable until the tenth anniversary of the grant date (subject to earlier lapse in accordance with the rules), however Options granted to a participant who is subject to the federal income tax laws of the United States may only be exercised for a short period following vesting.

 

If a participant ceases to be a director or employee of, or a consultant to, us or our affiliates before the normal vesting date of an Award by reason of (i) death, (ii) retirement with the agreement of the Remuneration Committee (in the case of our executive directors or senior management) or the employer or company to whom the participant provides services (in the case of other participants), (iii) ill health, injury or disability, (iv) redundancy, (v) his office, employment or consultancy contract is with a company that ceases to be one of our affiliates or relating to a business or part of a business which is transferred to an unrelated third party or (vi) for any other reason that the Remuneration Committee determines, then the Award will vest on the normal vesting date unless the Remuneration Committee decides that the Award will vest on the date of cessation (and an Option could generally be exercised for six months thereafter). If a participant ceases to be a director, employee or consultant in other circumstances, the Award will lapse immediately upon cessation of service. Special rules apply to determine the number of ordinary shares that will vest in any specified circumstances, including application of any performance conditions.

 

Limits on Ordinary Shares and Awards. No Award may be made under the Long-Term Incentive Plan in any calendar year if, at the time of the proposed grant date, it would cause the number of our ordinary shares allocated on or after June 28, 2001 and in the period of ten calendar years ending with that calendar year under the Long-Term Incentive Plan, any other employee share plan operated by us or any other share incentive arrangement operated by us for the benefit of directors or consultants to any participating company to exceed ten percent of our ordinary share capital in issue at that time. Ordinary shares are generally considered to be allocated if they are subject to outstanding options to acquire unissued shares or treasury shares, if they are issued or transferred from treasury otherwise than pursuant to an option or other right to acquire the ordinary shares, or, in certain circumstances, if they are issued or may be issued to any trustees to satisfy the grant of an option or other contractual right. Existing shares other than treasury shares that are transferred or over which options or other contractual rights are granted are not treated as allocated. Special rules apply to the determination of whether shares are allocated in the case of awards that expire or are settled in cash or where institutional investor guidelines cease to require the shares to be counted as allocated. In addition, the aggregate number of shares in relation to which Awards may be made pursuant to the Long-Term Incentive Plan after March 14, 2013 shall not exceed 15 million.

 

As approved at our Annual General Meeting on February 5, 2015, the maximum total market value of our ordinary shares over which Award may be granted to any director, employee or consultant during any year is 600% of such person’s base salary or fees. These Awards can now include restricted stock options which have service but no other performance conditions. The expected value of an Award shall be calculated as at the date of grant in accordance with generally accepted methodologies based on Black Scholes or binomial stochastic models.

 

  101  

 

 

Takeovers and Corporate Events. If a person or group obtains control of us pursuant to a general offer to acquire our ordinary shares or has obtained control of us and then makes such an offer or such an offer becomes unconditional in all respects, then the Remuneration Committee will notify all participants and all Awards will vest on the date determined by the Remuneration Committee (but no later than the date of the change in control or offer becoming unconditional) and any Option can be exercised within one month after such early vesting date. Special vesting rules apply in the context of a winding up of us or in the event of a demerger, special dividends or other events which, in the opinion of the Remuneration Committee would affect the market price of our ordinary shares to a material extent. In exceptional circumstances, the Remuneration Committee, with the consent of an acquiring company if applicable, may decide before the change of control that an Award will not vest under the special vesting provisions but shall instead be surrendered in consideration for the grant of a new award which the Remuneration Committee determines is equivalent in value to the Award that it replaces. Absent such exceptional circumstances, the Remuneration Committee’s intention is that all Awards will vest. Special rules apply to determine the numbers of ordinary shares that will vest in any specified circumstances, including application of any performance conditions.

 

Adjustment of Awards. In the event that there is any variation in our share capital or any demerger, special dividend or other similar event which affects the market price of our ordinary shares to a material extent, the Remuneration Committee may make such adjustments as it considers appropriate, taking into account where relevant, any adjustment to the related holding of Investment Shares. Any such adjustments may be made to one or more of the number of ordinary shares subject to an Award, the option price or the number of ordinary shares that may be transferred pursuant to a vested Award which has not yet been settled. Limitations apply to the extent that any such adjustments may reduce the price at which ordinary shares may be purchased pursuant to the exercise of an Option.

 

Transferability. No award under the Long-Term Incentive Plan may be transferred, assigned, charged or otherwise disposed of (except on death to the recipient’s personal representatives) and will lapse immediately upon an attempt to do so. In addition, an award under the Long-Term Incentive Plan will lapse immediately if the recipient of an Award is declared bankrupt.

 

Amendment and Termination. The Long-Term Incentive Plan will expire ten years after the date that it was approved by our shareholders and no awards may be granted thereunder after the expiration date. The Committee may, at any time, alter the Long-Term Incentive Plan or the terms of any Award; provided, however, that no alteration to the benefit of a participant or potential participants will be made to the provisions relating to the individual limits on participation, the overall limits on the issue of ordinary shares or transfer of treasury shares, the overall limit on the number of ordinary shares which may be subject to Awards or the foregoing restrictions without approval of our ordinary shareholders. Minor alterations to benefit the administration of the Long-Term Incentive Plan, to take into account changes in law or obtain or maintain favorable tax treatment, exchange control or regulatory treatment for participants or us and our affiliates or alterations to performance conditions are not subject to shareholder approval. Alterations to the disadvantage of participants (other than changes to performance conditions) may not be made unless all participants have the opportunity to approve the change and the change is approved by a majority of the participants. Although performance conditions can generally be altered by the Committee, we have undertaken to consult with our major shareholders prior to altering any performance conditions existing as of January 18, 2008.

 

GW Pharmaceuticals All Employee Share Scheme

 

GW Pharma Limited (formerly GW Pharmaceuticals Ltd) adopted the GW Pharmaceuticals All Employee Share Scheme, or the Share Scheme, on August 16, 2000 and it was approved by the U.K.’s Inland Revenue on August 25, 2000 as what is now known as an approved share incentive plan. The Share Scheme provides for the grant of awards of our ordinary shares, which may be Free Shares, Matching Shares or Partnership Shares, or, collectively, Share Scheme Awards, all summarized below, in a tax advantageous manner. Dividends payable in relation to Share Scheme Awards may be reinvested as Dividend Shares subject to the scheme. Shares awarded are held by the trustees of the scheme, or the Trustees, in a specially established trust on behalf of the participants. The scheme originally operated over ordinary shares in GW Pharma Limited, but following our acquisition of GW Pharma Limited the scheme was amended so that it operated over our ordinary shares.

 

Eligibility. Generally, employees of GW Pharma or certain of its subsidiaries are eligible to receive Share Scheme Awards under the Plan. In order to satisfy certain U.K. tax rules, certain participants, referred to in this Annual Report as Qualifying Employees, must be invited to participate in the Share Scheme if they are otherwise eligible.

 

  102  

 

 

Generally, all Qualifying Employees who are required to be invited (or who have been invited) to participate in a Share Scheme Award under the Share Scheme will participate on the same terms. We may, however, make awards of Free Shares to Qualifying Employees which vary by reference to their remuneration, length of service or hours worked or by reference to their performance.

 

Free Shares. The Trustees, with the prior consent of GW Pharma Limited., may award Free Shares. The number of Free Shares to be awarded to each Qualifying Employee will be determined by GW Pharma Limited. and the initial market value of any such Share Scheme Award in any tax year will not exceed £3,000. The number of Free Shares granted to a Qualifying Employee on any date may be determined by reference to performance allowances. If such performance allowances are used, they will apply to all Qualifying Employees. The Share Scheme sets forth methodologies for determining how to calculate the number of Free Shares that are awarded to a Qualifying Employee by reference to performance allowances. With respect to the grant of Free Shares, a holding period is specified through which a participant who has been granted Free Shares must be bound by the terms of a Free Share agreement. The length of the holding period will not be less than three nor more than five years beginning on the award date and will be the same for all participants who receive a grant at the same time.

 

Partnership Shares. GW Pharma Limited. may invite every Qualifying Employee to enter into an agreement with respect to the grant of Partnership Shares. Partnership Shares are subject to the terms and conditions of the Share Scheme and are not subject to any forfeiture provisions. Participants are required to have amounts deducted from their compensation to pay for Partnership Shares, such amounts referred to in this Annual Report as Partnership Share Money; provided, however, that the maximum amount of Partnership Share Money for any month cannot exceed £125 or such lower figure that may be specified and the total Partnership Share Money for any period during which contributions are accumulated to purchase Partnership Shares such period referred to in this Annual Report as the Accumulation Period, cannot exceed 10% of the payments of salary made to the participant over the Accumulation Period. There may also be a minimum amount of Partnership Share Money for any month (applied uniformly to all participants), which minimum cannot exceed £10. Any Partnership Share Money that is deducted in excess of the limitations, less applicable taxes, will be paid to the participant as soon as practicable.

 

If there is an Accumulation Period, the maximum number of Partnership Shares that may be acquired for that Accumulation Period will be determined by reference to the lower of the value of our shares at the beginning of the Accumulation Period or the value of ordinary shares on the acquisition date. Any excess Partnership Share Money remaining after purchase of the ordinary shares may, with the agreement of the participant, be carried over to the next Accumulation Period or in other cases be paid to the participant less applicable taxes. The number of Partnership Shares that may be purchased as of any date may be reduced if the applications to purchase exceed the permitted limits.

 

An employee may withdraw from purchasing Partnership Shares at any time. Unless otherwise specified by the employee, the withdrawal will take effect 30 days after we receive the notice. In the event of a withdrawal, any Partnership Purchase Money held on behalf of the withdrawing employee, less applicable taxes, will be returned to the employee as soon as practicable.

 

If approval of the Share Scheme is withdrawn or if the Share Scheme is terminated, all Partnership Share Money, less applicable taxes, will be repaid to employees as soon as practicable.

 

Matching Shares. Matching Shares are granted on the basis set forth in the Partnership Agreement relating to the grant of Partnership Shares. No payment is made by the participants in relation to Matching Shares. Generally, Matching Shares are awarded to all participants on the same basis. In no event will the ratio of Matching Shares to Partnership Shares exceed 2:1.

 

Dividend Shares. If any dividends are paid in relation to ordinary shares held pursuant to the Share Scheme for participants, GW Pharma Limited may specify that some or all of those dividends shall be applied to purchase Dividend Shares or they may give the participants the choice between such dividends being applied to purchase Dividend Shares or being paid in cash. Special rules apply to reinvestment of dividends. Dividend Shares are subject to a three year holding period.

 

  103  

 

 

Limits on Shares and Awards. No ordinary shares will be issued under the Share Scheme if the issue would result in the aggregate number of our ordinary shares which have been allocated under the Share Scheme, any other employees’ share plan adopted by us or any other share incentive arrangements for employees, directors, officers and consultants of our affiliates during the period of ten years ending on the date of the issue to exceed 10% of our ordinary shares then in issue. “Allocated” for these purposes means the grant of options or other rights to acquire ordinary shares which may be satisfied by the issue of new shares, or, where no such rights are granted, the issue of ordinary shares. Rights which have lapsed are no longer taken into account.

 

Amendment. GW Pharma Limited. may, with the Trustees’ written consent, amend the Share Scheme, provided that no amendment which may increase the limits described in the preceding paragraph may be made without the approval of our shareholders. In addition, no amendment may be made which would adversely prejudice to a material extent the rights attached to any ordinary shares awarded, and certain amendments would require the approval of the UK tax authorities.

 

Reconstructions and Rights Issues. The Share Scheme sets forth special rules that apply in the case of reconstructions and rights issues.

 

GW Pharmaceuticals Unapproved Share Option Scheme 2001

 

Our shareholders approved and adopted the GW Pharmaceuticals Unapproved Share Option Scheme 2001, or the Executive Option Scheme, on May 31, 2001. In the United Kingdom, generally, an “unapproved” share option scheme means that it does not qualify for certain tax breaks since it has not been “approved” by the U.K. tax authority, although these terms are now less common for new share schemes, as the approval system has been replaced by a self-certification system for tax advantaged schemes. It was typical for U.K. companies to have both “approved” and “unapproved” share options schemes due, in part, to the individual participation limits found in “approved” schemes. Under the Executive Option Scheme, Options were granted to our employees, such employees referred to in this Annual Report as eligible employees. The scheme terminated on May 31, 2011, and no further options will be granted under the scheme. Termination of the scheme did not affect the rights of existing participants.

 

Options granted under the Executive Option Scheme may be designated as “EMI Options” which are intended to qualify for advantageous tax treatment as enterprise management incentives under applicable UK tax law. Generally, EMI Options are subject to the same terms and conditions as those that apply to Options. Other terms and conditions may also apply to EMI Options, particularly where the Committee determines that such alternative treatment is appropriate to obtain, protect or maximize beneficial tax or national insurance treatment of the participant, us or our affiliates.

 

Exercise of Options. Options generally may not be exercised prior to the third anniversary of the grant, however all outstanding options are currently exercisable. If applicable, any performance targets and other conditions on exercise must also be satisfied. Vesting provisions and performance targets may be waived only to the extent provided in the grant terms or, in the case of a performance target, an event occurs which makes the condition more onerous to achieve.

 

Generally, Options must be exercised while the participant is an eligible employee. In the event, however, that a participant ceases to be an eligible employee as the result of injury, illness or disability, redundancy or retirement on or after attaining his normal retirement age (age 60 or such other date on which he is required to retire pursuant to his employment contract) or at the specific request of his employer, the Option may be exercised during the period of six months (or such longer period as the Committee may specify) commencing on the date he ceases to be an eligible employee. If a participant dies while he is an eligible employee or during the extended exercise period described in the preceding sentence, the participant’s personal representatives may exercise the Option for 12 months after the participant’s death. In all other cases, the Remuneration Committee may permit post-cessation exercise during such period from the date of cessation as they may notify to the participant. All Options lapse upon the tenth anniversary of the date of grant although the Committee has discretion to extend this date by up to 12 months.

 

  104  

 

 

Takeovers and Corporate Events. If any person obtaining control of us (as determined in accordance with specified U.K. tax law) as the result of making an offer to acquire all of our issued share capital that is either unconditional or which is made on a condition which, if satisfied will cause the person making the offer to have control of us or a general offer to acquire all of our ordinary shares, any such offer referred to in this document as a Takeover Offer, Options may be exercised within the relevant period after the time the person has obtained control and any conditions subject to which the Takeover Offer have been satisfied. Options may also be exercisable for the relevant period in the event of certain court sanctioned restructurings or amalgamations of us or if another company becomes bound or entitled to acquire our ordinary shares pursuant to certain provisions of U.K. corporate law. If the Remuneration Committee determines that it is likely that we will come under the control of another company such that our ordinary shares will cease to satisfy specified conditions of U.K. tax law, the Remuneration Committee may permit exercise of the Options prior to the change of control.

 

In the event of a Takeover Offer or court sanctioned restructuring or amalgamation, the participant may, by agreement with the other company, release Options in consideration for the grant of a new option with respect to the acquiring company’s shares and subject to certain other terms and conditions. The Remuneration Committee may also permit exercise of the Options within a relevant period following the date on which we pass a resolution for voluntary winding up or certain other transactions involving a change in control of us.

 

With respect to any event, the “relevant period” is generally the period of three months or such different period not less than 30 days and not more than six months that the Remuneration Committee may determine in connection with a relevant particular event which may allow Options to be exercised. Options not exercised by the end of that period will lapse.

 

Adjustment of Awards. In the event that there is any variation in our share capital the Remuneration Committee may make adjustments as it considers fair and reasonable to preserve the participant’s position to the number of ordinary shares subject to an Option and/or the acquisition price and/or the aggregate maximum number of ordinary shares. Limitations apply to the extent to which any such adjustments may reduce the price at which ordinary shares may be purchased pursuant to the exercise of an Option.

 

Transferability. No Option under the Executive Option Scheme may be transferred, assigned, charged or otherwise disposed of (except on death to the recipient’s personal representatives) and will lapse immediately upon an attempt to do so. In addition, an award under the Executive Option Scheme will lapse immediately if the recipient of an Award is declared bankrupt or if there is a compulsory winding up of us.

 

Amendment. The Committee may, at any time, alter the Executive Option Scheme.

 

GW Pharmaceuticals Approved Share Option Scheme 2001

 

Our shareholders approved and adopted the GW Pharmaceuticals Approved Share Option Scheme 2001, or the “Company Option Scheme”, on May 31, 2001 and it was approved by the U.K.’s Inland Revenue on July 3, 2001. Under the Company Option Scheme, Options were granted to our employees who were not ineligible to participate in the Company Option Scheme under applicable U.K. tax law and who, in the case of a director, is required to work not less than 25 hours per week, such individuals referred to in this Annual Report as Option Scheme eligible employees. The scheme terminated on May 31, 2011, and no further options will be granted under the scheme. Termination of the scheme did not affect the rights of existing participants.

 

Exercise of Options. Options generally may not be exercised prior to the third anniversary of the grant. All outstanding options, however, are currently exercisable. If applicable, any performance targets and other conditions on exercise must also be satisfied. Vesting provisions and performance targets may be waived only to the extent provided in the grant terms or, in the case of a performance target, an event occurs which makes the condition more onerous to achieve.

 

Generally, Options must be exercised while the participant is an Option Scheme eligible employee. In the event, however, that a participant ceases to be an Option Scheme eligible employee as the result of injury, illness or disability, redundancy or retirement on or after attaining his normal retirement age (age 60 or such other date on which he is required to retire pursuant to his employment contract) or at the specific request of his employer, the Option may be exercised during the period commencing on the date he ceases to be an Option Scheme eligible employee and ending on the later of six months thereafter or three years and six months after the date of grant. If a participant dies while he is an Option Scheme eligible employee or during the extended exercise period described in the preceding sentence, the participant’s personal representatives may exercise the Option for 12 months after the participant’s death (unless the participant would have been precluded from exercising the option during that period under applicable U.K. tax law). In all other cases, the Remuneration Committee may permit post-cessation exercise for up to six months from the date of cessation or, if later three years and six months after the date of grant. All Options lapse upon the tenth anniversary of the date of grant.

 

  105  

 

 

Takeovers and Corporate Events. If any person obtains control of us (as determined in accordance with specified U.K. tax law) as a result of making a Takeover Offer, any Options may be exercised within the relevant period after the time the person has obtained control and any conditions subject to which the Takeover Offer have been satisfied. Options may also be exercisable for the relevant period in the event of certain court sanctioned restructurings or amalgamations of us or if another company becomes bound or entitled to acquire our ordinary shares pursuant to certain provisions of U.K. corporate law. If the Remuneration Committee determines that it is likely that we will come under the control of another company such that our ordinary shares will cease to satisfy the conditions of applicable U.K. tax law, the Remuneration Committee may permit exercise of the Options prior to the change of control.

 

In the event of a Takeover Offer or court sanctioned restructuring or amalgamation, the participant may, by agreement with the other company, release Options in consideration for the grant of a new option with respect to the acquiring company’s shares and subject to certain other terms and conditions, in such a manner as to preserve the tax advantages applicable to the Options.

 

The Remuneration Committee may also permit exercise of the Options within a relevant period following the date on which we pass a resolution for voluntary winding up or certain other transactions involving a change in control of us.

 

With respect to any event, the “relevant period” is generally the period of three months or such different period not less than 30 days and not more than six months that the Remuneration Committee may determine in connection with a relevant particular event which may allow Options to be exercised. Options not exercised by the end of that period will lapse.

 

Adjustment of Awards. In the event that there is any variation in our share capital the Remuneration Committee may make adjustments as it considers fair and reasonable to preserve the participant’s position to the number of ordinary shares subject to an Option and/or the acquisition price and/or the aggregate maximum number of ordinary shares. Limitations apply to the extent to which any such adjustments may reduce the price at which ordinary shares may be purchased pursuant to the exercise of an Option and no adjustment will take effect until it has been approved by the United Kingdom tax authorities in accordance with applicable U.K. tax law.

 

Transferability. No Option under the Company Option Scheme may be transferred, assigned, charged or otherwise disposed of (except on death to the recipient’s personal representatives) and will lapse immediately upon an attempt to do so. In addition, an award under the Company Option Scheme will lapse immediately if the recipient of an award is declared bankrupt or if there is a compulsory winding up of us.

 

Amendment. The Remuneration Committee may, at any time, alter the Company Option Scheme provided that no alterations shall be effective unless approved by the U.K. tax authorities in accordance with applicable U.K. tax law.

 

Options granted to non-employees

 

Our consultants and non-executive directors, who are not employees of companies in the Group, are not eligible to participate in our equity compensation plans described above. Certain of these consultants and non-executive directors have been granted options to acquire our shares pursuant to separate option agreements. These options are generally on comparable terms to options granted under the Executive Option Scheme.

 

  106  

 

 

Limitations on Liability and Indemnification Matters

 

To the extent permitted by the Companies Act 2006, we shall indemnify our directors against any liability. We maintain directors and officers insurance to insure such persons against certain liabilities.

 

Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to directors, officers or persons controlling us under the foregoing provisions, we have been advised that in the opinion of the SEC, such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and therefore is unenforceable.

 

C. Board Practices.

 

Board Composition

 

Our business affairs are managed under the direction of our board of directors, which is currently composed of eight members. As a foreign private issuer, we have elected to follow home country practices in lieu of NASDAQ Global Market requirement that a majority of our board qualify as independent directors. Three of our directors qualify as independent directors under Rule 5605(a)(2) of the NASDAQ Stock Market, Marketplace Rules.

 

Terms of Directors and Executive Officers

 

Our executive officers are selected by and serve at the discretion of our board of directors. A director may be removed by an ordinary resolution passed by a majority of our shareholders.

 

Committees of the Board of Directors and Corporate Governance

 

We have established an Audit Committee, a Remuneration Committee and a Nominations Committee. Each of these committees has the responsibilities described below. Our board of directors may also establish other committees from time to time to assist in the discharge of its responsibilities.

 

Audit Committee

 

Our Audit Committee is comprised of our three non-executive directors, Mr. James Noble, Mr. Cabot Brown and Mr. Thomas Lynch, and each of these members satisfies the independence requirements of Rule 5605(a)(2) of the NASDAQ Stock Market, Marketplace Rules and the independence requirements of Rule 10A-3(b)(1) under the Exchange Act. Mr. Noble serves as chair of the Audit Committee. Our board of directors has determined that Mr. Noble is a financial expert as contemplated by applicable SEC rules. Our Audit Committee oversees the monitoring of our internal control over financial reporting, our accounting and financial reporting processes and the audits of the financial statements of our company. Our Audit Committee is responsible for, among other things:

 

selecting our independent auditors, approving their reappointment or removal and pre-approving all auditing and non-auditing services permitted to be performed by our independent auditors;
reviewing all related‒party transactions on an ongoing basis;
discussing the annual audited financial statements with management and our independent auditors;
annually reviewing and reassessing the adequacy of our Audit Committee charter;
meeting separately and periodically with management and our independent auditors;
reporting regularly to our full board of directors; and
such other matters that are specifically delegated to our Audit Committee by our board of directors from time to time.

 

  107  

 

 

Remuneration Committee

 

Our Remuneration Committee is comprised of our three non-executive directors, Mr. James Noble, Mr. Cabot Brown and Mr. Thomas Lynch, and each of the members satisfies the independence requirements of Rule 5605(a)(2) of the NASDAQ Stock Market, Marketplace Rules and the independence requirements of Rule 10A-3(b)(1) under the Exchange Act. Mr. Lynch serves as chair of this committee. Under NASDAQ Stock Market, Marketplace Rules, there are heightened independence standards for members of the Remuneration Committee, including a prohibition against the receipt of any compensation from us other than standard director compensation. All of our compensation committee members meet this heightened standard.

 

Our Remuneration Committee assists our board of directors in reviewing and approving the compensation structure of our directors and executive officers, including all forms of compensation to be provided to our directors and executive officers. Members of the Remuneration Committee are prohibited from direct involvement in determining their own compensation, including participation in meetings about their individual compensation. It is a policy of the Remuneration Committee that no individual, including our chief executive officer and other executive directors, participates in discussions or decisions concerning his own Remuneration and such persons may not be present at any Remuneration Committee meeting during which their compensation is deliberated.

 

The Remuneration Committee is responsible for, among other things:

 

reviewing the compensation plans, policies and programs adopted by our management;
reviewing and approving the compensation package for our executive officers;
reviewing and approving corporate goals and objectives relevant to the compensation of our executive directors, including, our chief executive officer, evaluating the performance of those executive directors in light of those goals and objectives, and setting the compensation level of those executive directors, including, our chief executive officer, based on this evaluation; and
reviewing periodically and making recommendations to the board of directors regarding any long-term incentive compensation or equity plans, programs or similar arrangements, annual bonuses, employee pension and welfare benefit plans.

 

Nominations Committee

 

As permitted for foreign private issuers, we have elected to follow our home country’s practice in lieu of the NASDAQ Global Market requirement for U.S. listed companies to have a nominating committee comprised of independent directors. The members of the Nominations Committee comprise Dr. Geoffrey Guy, Mr. James Noble and Mr. Cabot Brown, with Mr. Noble and Mr. Brown being independent directors. Dr. Guy serves as Chair of the Nominations Committee and oversees the evaluation of the board’s performance. Dr. Guy’s performance as Chairman is reviewed by Mr. Noble, in his capacity as senior independent director, taking into account feedback from other members of the board of directors. The Nominations Committee meets at least twice a year and reviews the structure, size and composition of the board of directors, supervising the selection and appointment process of directors, making recommendations to the board of directors with regard to any changes and using an external search consultancy if considered appropriate. For new appointments, the Nominations Committee makes a final recommendation to the board of directors, and the board has the opportunity to meet the candidate prior to approving the appointment. Once appointed, the Nominations Committee oversees the induction of new directors and provides the appropriate training to the board during the course of the year in order to ensure that each member has the knowledge and skills necessary to operate effectively. The Nominations Committee is also responsible for annually evaluating the performance of the board, both on an individual basis and for the board as a whole, taking into account such factors as attendance record, contribution during board meetings and the amount of time that has been dedicated to board matters during the course of the year.

 

Code of Business Conduct and Ethics

 

Our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics is applicable to all of our employees, officers and directors and is available on our website at http://www.gwpharm.com. Our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics provides that our directors and officers are expected to avoid any action, position or interest that conflicts with the interests of our company or gives the appearance of a conflict. Our directors and officers have an obligation under our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics to advance our company’s interests when the opportunity to do so arises. We expect that any amendment to this code, or any waivers of its requirements, will be disclosed on our website. Information contained on, or that can be accessed through, our website is not incorporated by reference into this document, and you should not consider information on our website to be part of this document.

 

  108  

 

 

D. Employees.

 

The number of employees by function and geographic location as of the end of the period for our fiscal years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014 was as follows:

 

    2016     2015     2014  
By Function:                        
Research and development     268       207       165  
Manufacturing and operations     80       56       44  
Quality control and assurance     61       51       29  
Commercial     15       7       -  
Management and administrative     72       48       27  
Total     496       369       265  
                         
By Geography:                        
United Kingdom     425       342       263  
North America     71       27       2  
Total     496       369       265  

 

We have never had a work stoppage and none of our employees are covered by collective bargaining agreements or represented by a labor union. We believe our relationships with our employees around the world are good.

 

E. Share Ownership.

 

See Item 7, below.

 

Item 7 Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions.

 

A. Major Shareholders.

 

The following table and related footnotes set forth information with respect to the beneficial ownership of our ordinary shares, as of September 30, 2016, by:

 

each of our directors and executive officers; and

 

each person known to us to own beneficially more than 5% of our ordinary shares as of September 30, 2016.

 

Beneficial ownership is determined in accordance with the rules and regulations of the SEC. In computing the number of ordinary shares owned by a person and the percentage ownership of that person, we have included shares that the person has the right to acquire within 60 days, including through the exercise of any option, warrant or other right or the conversion of any other security. These ordinary shares, however, are not included in the computation of the percentage ownership of any other person. Ownership of our ordinary shares by the “principal shareholders” identified above has been determined by reference to our share register, which provides us with information regarding the registered holders of our ordinary shares but generally provides limited, or no, information regarding the ultimate beneficial owners of such ordinary shares. As a result, we may not be aware of each person or group of affiliated persons who beneficially owns more than 5% of our ordinary shares.

 

Unless otherwise indicated, the address for each of the shareholders in the table below is c/o GW Pharmaceuticals plc, Sovereign House, Vision Park, Chivers Way, Histon, Cambridge CB24 9BZ, United Kingdom.

 

  109  

 

 

   

Ordinary Shares Beneficially

Owned (2)

 
Name of Beneficial Owner (1)   Number     Percent  
Greater than 5% Shareholders                
Capital Research and Management Company (3)     45,340,848       15.0  
Prudential plc group of companies (4)     24,602,551       8.1  
Scopia Capital Management LP (5)     22,622,004       7.5  
Fidelity Management & Research Co. (6)     21,058,296       7.1  
Named Executive Officers and Directors                
Dr. Geoffrey Guy (7)     14,248,000       4.6  
Mr. Justin Gover (8)     -       *  
Mr. Thomas Lynch     -       *  
Mr. James Noble     -       *  
Mr. Adam George (9)     -       *  
Dr. Stephen Wright (10)     -       *  
Mr. Julian Gangolli     -       *  
Mr. Chris Tovey     -       *  
Mr. Cabot Brown     -       *  
All Named Executive Officers and Directors as a Group (9 persons)             *  

 

 

* Indicates beneficial ownership of less than one percent of our ordinary shares.

 

(1) The business addresses for the listed beneficial owners are as follows: Prudential plc group of companies—Laurence Pountney Hill, London, EC4R 0HH; Scopia Capital Management LP – 152 West 57 th Street, 33 rd Floor, New York, NY 10019; Fidelity Management & Research Co. – 245 Summer Street, , Boston, MA 02210

 

(2) Number of shares owned as shown both in this table and the accompanying footnotes and percentage ownership is based on 302,093,139 ordinary shares outstanding on September 30, 2016.

 

(3) Capital Research and Management Company, or CRMC, a U.S.–based investment management company, holds these shares in the form of ADSs. The Capital Group Companies, Inc. is the parent company of CRMC. The business address for CRMC is 333 South Hope Street, Los Angeles, CA 90071.

 

(4) Includes (i) 24,602,551 ordinary shares indirectly held by Prudential plc, (ii) 24,602,551 ordinary shares indirectly held by M&G Group Limited, a wholly owned subsidiary of Prudential plc, (iii) 24,602,551 ordinary shares indirectly held by M&G Limited, a wholly owned subsidiary of M&G Group Limited, (iv) 24,602,551 ordinary shares indirectly held by M&G Investment Management Limited, a wholly owned subsidiary of M&G Limited and (v) 24,602,551 ordinary shares held of record by M&G Securities Limited, a wholly owned subsidiary of M&G Limited.

 

(5) Scopia Capital Management LP , a U.S.-based investment management company, holds these shares in the form of ADSs.

 

(6) Fidelity Management & Research Co., or FMRC, a U.S.-based investment management company, holds these shares in the form of ADSs

 

(7) Includes 225,000 ordinary shares beneficially owned by Dr. Guy’s immediate family, 1,168,958 shares held by his personal pension plan and options to purchase 450,158 ordinary shares that have vested.

 

(8) Includes 2,143,314 ordinary shares beneficially owned by The Gover Family Investment LLP, of which Mr. Gover owns 99% and the remaining 1% is held by his spouse.

 

(9) Includes 21,696 shares held by his personal pension plan, 5,912 shares owned personally and options to purchase 407,106 ordinary shares that have vested.

 

(10) Includes 5,000 ordinary shares beneficially owned by Dr. Wright’s spouse, 915 shares owned personally and options to purchase 602,990 ordinary shares that have vested.

 

Our major shareholders do not have different voting rights. We are not aware of any arrangement that may, at a subsequent date, result in a change of control of our company.

 

  110  

 

 

Citibank, N.A. is the holder of record for our ADS program, whereby each ADS represents twelve ordinary shares. As of September 30, 2016, Citibank, N.A. held 226,162,356 ordinary shares representing 75% of our issued share capital held at that date. As of September 30, 2016, we had a further 473,317 ordinary shares held by 9 U.S. resident shareholders of record, representing less than one percent of total voting power. Certain of these ordinary shares and ADSs were held by brokers or other nominees. As a result, the number of holders of record or registered holders in the U.S. is not representative of the number of beneficial holders or of the residence of beneficial holders.

 

Due to the de-listing from the AIM market in the United Kingdom, there has been a significant increase in the number of shares held in ADS form by Citibank. As at December 5, 2016, 267,889,376 ordinary shares were held by Citibank, representing 89% of share capital.

 

B. Related Party Transactions.

 

During the three year period ended September 30, 2016, there has not been, nor is there currently proposed, any material transaction or series of similar material transactions to which we were or are a party in which any of our directors, members of our executive management board, associates, holders of more than 10% of any class of our voting securities, or any affiliates or member of the immediate families of any of the foregoing persons, had or will have a direct or indirect material interest, other than the compensation and shareholding arrangements we describe where required in the section of this Annual Report titled “Management.”

 

We have adopted a related person transaction policy which sets forth our procedures for the identification, review, consideration and approval or ratification of related person transactions. For purposes of our policy only, a related person transaction is a transaction, arrangement or relationship, or any series of similar transactions, arrangements or relationships, in which we and any related person are, were or will be participants. Transactions involving compensation for services provided to us as an employee or director are not covered by this policy. A related person is any employee, director or beneficial owner of more than 3% of any class of our voting securities, including any of their immediate family members and any entity owned or controlled by such persons.

 

Under the policy, if a transaction has been identified as a related person transaction, including any transaction that was not a related person transaction when originally consummated or any transaction that was not initially identified as a related person transaction prior to consummation, our management must present information regarding the related person transaction to our Audit Committee, or, if Audit Committee approval would be inappropriate, to another independent body of our board of directors, for review, consideration and approval or ratification. The presentation must include a description of, among other things, the material facts, the interests, direct and indirect, of the related persons, the benefits to us of the transaction and whether the transaction is on terms that are comparable to the terms available to or from, as the case may be, an unrelated third-party or to or from employees generally. Under the policy, we will collect information that we deem reasonably necessary from each director, executive officer and, to the extent feasible, significant shareholder to enable us to identify any existing or potential related person transactions and to effectuate the terms of the policy. In addition, under our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics, our employees and directors have an affirmative responsibility to disclose any transaction or relationship that reasonably could be expected to give rise to a conflict of interest.

 

C. Interests of Experts and Counsel.

 

Not Applicable.

 

Item 8 Financial Information.

 

A. Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information.

 

See “Item 18. Financial Statements.”

 

B. Significant Changes.

 

There have been no significant changes since September 30, 2016.

 

  111  

 

 

Item 9 The Offer and Listing.

 

A. Offer and Listing Details.

 

Price History of Stock

 

The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, the reported high and low closing sale prices of our ADSs on the NASDAQ Global Market in U.S. dollars.

 

    Price Per ADS  
    High     Low  
Annual (Year Ended September 30):                
2013 (May 1, 2013 through September 30, 2013)   $ 17.75     $ 8.51  
2014   $ 107.35     $ 17.01  
2015   $ 129.69     $ 61.55  
2016   $ 132.73     $ 36.64  
2017 (through December 2, 2016)   $ 134.02     $ 109.28  
Quarterly:                
First Quarter 2014   $ 41.54     $ 17.01  
Second Quarter 2014   $ 83.05     $ 38.06  
Third Quarter 2014   $ 107.29     $ 44.00  
Fourth Quarter 2014   $ 107.35     $ 80.70  
First Quarter 2015   $ 82.33     $ 61.55  
Second Quarter 2015   $ 100.48     $ 69.61  
Third Quarter 2015   $ 129.69     $ 90.58  
Fourth Quarter 2015   $ 129.01     $ 88.78  
First Quarter 2016   $ 92.27     $ 64.96  
Second Quarter 2016   $ 85.24     $ 36.64  
Third Quarter 2016   $ 94.19     $ 73.64  
Fourth Quarter 2016   $ 132.73     $ 80.65  
First Quarter 2017 (through December 2, 2016)   $ 134.02     $ 109.28  
Most Recent Six Months:                
June 2016   $ 94.19     $ 83.31  
July 2016   $ 97.10     $ 90.39  
August 2016   $ 96.11     $ 80.65  
September 2016   $ 132.73     $ 82.28  
October 2016   $ 133.45     $ 116.23  
November 2016   $ 134.02     $ 111.45
December 2016 (through December 2, 2016)   $ 112.32     $ 109.28  

 

On September 30, 2016, and December 5, 2016, the last reported sale prices of our ADSs on the NASDAQ Global Market were $132.73 per ADS and $112.32 per ADS, respectively.

  

  112  

 

 

The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, the reported high and low closing sale prices of our ordinary shares on the AIM in pounds sterling and U.S. dollars. U.S. dollar per ordinary share amounts have been translated into U.S. dollars at $1.00 = £0.7683 based on the certified foreign exchange rates published by Federal Reserve Bank of New York on September 30, 2016.

 

    Price Per Ordinary Share     Price Per Ordinary Share  
    High     Low     High     Low  
Annual (Year Ended September 30):                                
2011   £ 1.33     £ 0.83     $ 1.73     $ 1.08  
2012   £ 1.03     £ 0.66     $ 1.34     $ 0.86  
2013   £ 0.90     £ 0.40     $ 1.17     $ 0.52  
2014   £ 5.24     £ 0.85     $ 6.82     $ 1.11  
2015   £ 6.96     £ 3.20     $ 9.06     $ 4.17  
2016   £ 8.39     £ 2.12     $ 10.92     $ 2.76  
2017 (through December 2, 2016)   £ 8.90     £ 7.10     $ 11.58     $ 9.24  
Quarterly:                                
First Quarter 2014   £ 1.99     £ 0.85     $ 2.59     $ 1.11  
Second Quarter 2014   £ 4.11     £ 1.90     $ 5.35     $ 2.47  
Third Quarter 2014   £ 5.10     £ 2.19     $ 6.64     $ 2.85  
Fourth Quarter 2014   £ 5.24     £ 4.00     $ 6.82     $ 5.21  
First Quarter 2015   £ 4.30     £ 3.21     $ 5.60     $ 4.18  
Second Quarter 2015   £ 5.60     £ 3.69     $ 7.29     $ 4.80  
Third Quarter 2015   £ 6.96     £ 5.06     $ 9.06     $ 6.59  
Fourth Quarter 2015   £ 6.93     £ 4.90     $ 9.02     $ 6.38  
First Quarter 2016   £ 5.16     £ 3.69     $ 6.72     $ 4.80  
Second Quarter 2016   £ 5.10     £ 2.12     $ 6.64     $ 2.76  
Third Quarter 2016   £ 5.80     £ 4.29     $ 7.55     $ 5.58  
Fourth Quarter 2016   £ 8.39     £ 5.15     $ 10.92     $ 6.70  
First Quarter 2017 (through December 2, 2016)   £ 8.90     £ 7.10     $ 11.58     $ 9.24  
Most Recent Six Months:                                
June 2016   £ 5.80     £ 4.94     $ 7.55     $ 6.43  
July 2016   £ 6.23     £ 5.71     $ 8.11     $ 7.43  
August 2016   £ 6.11     £ 5.15     $ 7.95     $ 6.70  
September 2016   £ 8.39     £ 5.15     $ 10.92     $ 6.70  
October 2016   £ 8.88     £ 7.93     $ 11.56     $ 10.32  
November 2016   £ 8.90     £ 7.26     $ 11.58     $ 9.45  
December 2016 (through December 2, 2016)   £ 7.19     £ 7.10     $ 11.58     $ 9.24  

 

On September 30, 2016, and December 2, 2016, the last reported sale prices of our ordinary shares on AIM were £8.39 per share ($10.92 per share) and £7.10 per share ($9.24 per share), respectively.

 

B. Plan of Distribution.

 

Not Applicable.

 

C. Markets.

 

226,162,356 of our ordinary shares underlie ADSs listed on the NASDAQ Global Market under the symbol “GWPH.” The depositary for the ADSs holds twelve ordinary shares for every ADS. 75,930,783 of our ordinary shares are admitted to trading on the AIM outside the ADS facility. Our ordinary shares have been trading on the AIM under the symbol “GWP” since June 28, 2001. Trading on AIM ceased on December 5, 2016.

 

D. Selling Shareholders.

 

Not Applicable.

 

E. Dilution.

 

Not Applicable.

 

F. Expenses of the Issue.

 

Not Applicable.

 

Item 10 Additional Information.

 

A. Share Capital.

 

Not Applicable.

 

B. Memorandum and Articles of Association.

 

The information called for by this item has been reported previously in our Registration Statement on form F-3 (File No. 333-195747), filed with the SEC May 7, 2014 under the heading “Description of Share Capital” and is incorporated by reference into this Annual Report.

 

C. Material Contracts.

 

Except as otherwise disclosed in this Annual Report (including the exhibits thereto), we are not currently, and have not been in the last two years, party to any material contract, other than contracts entered into in the ordinary course of our business.

 

  113  

 

 

D. Exchange Controls.

 

There are no governmental laws, decrees, regulations or other legislation in the United Kingdom that may affect the import or export of capital, including the availability of cash and cash equivalents for use by us, or that may affect the remittance of dividends, interest, or other payments by us to non-resident holders of our ordinary shares or ADSs, other than withholding tax requirements. There is no limitation imposed by English law or our articles of association on the right of non-residents to hold or vote shares.

 

E. Taxation

 

U.S. Federal Income Taxation

 

The following discussion describes the material U.S. federal income tax consequences to U.S. Holders (as defined below) under present law of the ownership and disposition of the ADSs. This discussion is based on the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, in effect as of the date of this Annual Report on Form 20-F and on U.S. Treasury regulations in effect or, in some cases, proposed, as of the date of this Annual Report on Form 20-F, as well as judicial and administrative interpretations thereof available on or before such date. All of the foregoing authorities are subject to change, which change could apply retroactively and could affect the tax consequences described below.

 

This discussion applies only to U.S. Holders that hold the ADSs as capital assets for U.S. federal income tax purposes. It does not purport to be a comprehensive description of all tax considerations that may be relevant to a decision to purchase the ADSs by any particular investor. In particular, this discussion does not address tax considerations applicable to a U.S. Holder that may be subject to special tax rules, including, without limitation, a dealer in securities or currencies, a trader in securities that elects to use a mark-to-market method of accounting for securities holdings, banks, thrifts, or other financial institutions, an insurance company, a tax-exempt organization, a person that holds the ADSs as part of a hedge, straddle or conversion transaction for tax purposes, a person whose functional currency for tax purposes is not the U.S. dollar, certain former citizens or residents of the United States, a person subject to the U.S. alternative minimum tax, or a person that owns or is deemed to own 10% or more of the company’s voting stock. In addition, the discussion does not address tax consequences to an entity treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes that holds the ADSs, or a partner in such partnership. The U.S. federal income tax treatment of each partner of such partnership generally will depend upon the status of the partner and the activities of the partnership. Prospective purchasers that are partners in a partnership holding the ADSs should consult their own tax advisers.

 

YOU ARE URGED TO CONSULT YOUR TAX ADVISORS ABOUT THE APPLICATION OF THE U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX RULES TO YOUR PARTICULAR CIRCUMSTANCES AS WELL AS THE STATE, LOCAL, NON-U.S. AND OTHER TAX CONSEQUENCES OF THE PURCHASE, OWNERSHIP AND DISPOSITION OF THE ADSs.

 

The discussion below of the U.S. federal income tax consequences to “U.S. Holders” will apply to you if you are a beneficial owner of ADSs and you are, for U.S. federal income tax purposes,

 

an individual who is a citizen or resident of the United States;

 

a corporation (or other entity taxable as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes) organized under the laws of the United States, any state therein or the District of Columbia;

 

an estate whose income is subject to U.S. federal income taxation regardless of its source; or

 

a trust that (i) is subject to the primary supervision of a court within the United States and subject to the control of one or more U.S. persons for all substantial decisions or (ii) has a valid election in effect under applicable U.S. Treasury regulations to be treated as a U.S. person.

 

If you hold ADSs, you should be treated as the holder of the underlying ordinary shares represented by those ADSs for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

 

  114  

 

 

Taxation of Dividends and Other Distributions on the ADSs

 

Subject to the PFIC rules discussed below, the gross amount of cash distributions made by us to you with respect to the ADSs will generally be includable in your gross income as dividend income on the date of receipt by the depositary bank, but only to the extent that the distribution is paid out of our current or accumulated earnings and profits (as determined under U.S. federal income tax principles). To the extent, if any, that the amount of the distribution exceeds our current and accumulated earnings and profits, it will be treated first as a tax-free return of your tax basis in your ADSs, and to the extent the amount of the distribution exceeds your tax basis, the excess will be taxed as capital gain. We do not intend to calculate our earnings and profits under U.S. federal income tax principles. Therefore, a U.S. Holder should expect that a distribution will generally be treated as a dividend even if that distribution would otherwise be treated as a non-taxable return of capital or as capital gain under the rules described above. U.S. Holders should consult their own tax advisors regarding the tax consequences to them if we pay dividends in any non-U.S. currency. A dividend in respect of the ADSs will not be eligible for the dividends-received deduction allowed to corporations in respect of dividends received from other U.S. corporations.

 

With respect to non-corporate U.S. Holders, including individual U.S. Holders, dividends will generally be taxed at the preferential rate applicable to qualified dividend income, provided that (i) the ADSs are readily tradable on an established securities market in the United States, or we are eligible for the benefits of an approved qualifying income tax treaty with the United States that includes an exchange of information program, (ii) we are not a PFIC (as discussed below) for either our taxable year in which the dividend is paid or the preceding taxable year, (iii) certain holding period requirements are met and (iv) you are not under any obligation to make related payments with respect to positions in substantially similar or related property. You should consult your tax advisors regarding the availability of the preferential rate for dividends paid with respect to the ADSs.

 

Dividends generally will constitute income from sources outside the United States for U.S. foreign tax credit purposes. However, if 50% or more of our stock is treated as held by U.S. persons, we will be treated as a “U.S.-owned foreign corporation.” In that case, dividends may be treated for U.S. foreign tax credit purposes as income from sources outside the United States to the extent paid out of our non-U.S. source earnings and profits, and as income from sources within the United States to the extent paid out of our U.S. source earnings and profits. We cannot assure you that we will not be treated as a U.S.-owned foreign corporation. If the dividends are taxed as qualified dividend income (as discussed above), the amount of the dividend taken into account for purposes of calculating the U.S. foreign tax credit limitation will generally be limited to the gross amount of the dividend, multiplied by the preferential rate divided by the highest rate of tax normally applicable to dividends. The limitation on foreign taxes eligible for credit is calculated separately with respect to specific classes of income. For this purpose, dividends distributed by us with respect to the ADSs will generally constitute “passive category income.”

 

Taxation of Dispositions of ADSs

 

Subject to the PFIC rules discussed below, you will recognize taxable gain or loss on any sale, exchange or other taxable disposition of an ADS equal to the difference between the amount realized (in U.S. dollars) for the ADS and your tax basis (in U.S. dollars) in the ADS. The gain or loss will generally be capital gain or loss. If you are a non-corporate U.S. Holder, including an individual U.S. Holder, who has held the ADS for more than one year, you may be eligible for preferential tax rates. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to limitations. Any such gain or loss that you recognize will generally be treated as U.S. source income or loss for U.S. foreign tax credit purposes.

 

Medicare Tax

 

Certain U.S. Holders that are individuals, estates or trusts and whose income exceeds certain thresholds will be subject to an additional 3.8% Medicare tax on some or all of such U.S. Holder’s “net investment income.” Net investment income generally includes income from the ADSs unless such income is derived in the ordinary course of the conduct of a trade or business (other than a trade or business that consists of certain passive or trading activities). You should consult your tax advisors regarding the effect this Medicare tax may have, if any, on your acquisition, ownership or disposition of the ADSs.

 

  115  

 

 

Disposition of Foreign Currency

 

U.S. Holders are urged to consult their tax advisors regarding the tax consequences of receiving, converting or disposing of any non-U.S. currency received as dividends on the ADSs or on the sale or retirement of an ADS.

 

Passive Foreign Investment Company

 

Special U.S. tax rules apply to companies that are considered to be PFICs. We will be classified as a PFIC in a particular taxable year if either (i) 75% or more of our gross income for the taxable year is passive income; or (ii) on average at least 50% of the value of our assets produce passive income or are held for the production of passive income. Passive income for this purpose generally includes, among other things, certain dividends, interest, royalties, rents and gains from commodities and securities transactions and from the sale or exchange of property that gives rise to passive income. In making this determination, we will be treated as earning our proportionate share of any income and owning our proportionate share of any assets of any corporation in which we hold a 25% or greater interest (by value).

 

Based on our estimated gross income, the average value of our assets, including goodwill, and the nature of our active business, we do not believe that we were classified as a PFIC for U.S. federal income tax purposes for our taxable year ended September 30, 2016. Our status for any taxable year will depend on our assets and activities in each year, and because this is a factual determination made annually after the end of each taxable year, there can be no assurance that we will not be considered a PFIC for any future taxable year. The market value of our assets may be determined in large part by reference to the market price of the ADSs and our ordinary shares, which is likely to fluctuate (and may fluctuate considerably given that market prices of life sciences companies can be especially volatile). Furthermore, because the value of our gross assets is likely to be determined in large part by reference to our market capitalization and the value of our goodwill, a decline in the value of our shares could affect the determination of whether we are a PFIC. We do not intend to make a determination of our or any of our future subsidiaries’ PFIC status in the future.

 

A U.S. Holder may be able to mitigate some of the adverse U.S. federal income tax consequences described below with respect to owning the ADSs if we are classified as a PFIC for any taxable year, provided that such U.S. Holder is eligible to make, and validly makes a mark-to-market election, described below. In certain circumstances a U.S. Holder can make a qualified electing fund election, or QEF election, to mitigate some of the adverse tax consequences described with respect to an ownership interest in a PFIC by including in income its share of the PFIC’s income on a current basis. However, we do not currently intend to prepare or provide the information that would enable a U.S. Holder to make a qualified electing fund election.

 

In the event we are classified as a PFIC, in any year in which you hold the ADSs, and you do not make the election described in the following paragraphs, any gain recognized by you on a sale or other disposition (including a pledge) of the ADSs would be allocated ratably over your holding period for the ADSs. The amounts allocated to the taxable year of the sale or other disposition and to any year before we became a PFIC would be taxed as ordinary income. The amount allocated to each other taxable year would be subject to tax at the highest rate in effect for individuals or corporations, as appropriate, for that taxable year, and an interest charge would be imposed. Further, to the extent that any distribution received by you on your ADSs were to exceed 125% of the average of the annual distributions on the ADSs received during the preceding three years or your holding period, whichever is shorter, that distribution would be subject to taxation in the same manner as gain on the sale or other disposition of shares, described above. Classification as a PFIC may also have other adverse tax consequences, including, in the case of individuals, the denial of a step-up in the basis of your ADSs at death.

 

If we are a PFIC for any taxable year during which you holds the ADSs, then in lieu of being subject to the special tax regime and interest charge rules discussed above, you may make an election to include gain on the ADSs as ordinary income under a mark-to-market method, provided that such the ADSs are treated as “regularly traded” on a “qualified exchange.” In general, the ADSs will be treated as “regularly traded” for a given calendar year if more than a de minimis quantity of the ADSs are traded on a qualified exchange on at least 15 days during each calendar quarter of such calendar year. Although the U.S. Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) has not published any authority identifying specific exchanges that may constitute “qualified exchanges,” Treasury Regulations provide that a qualified exchange is (a) a U.S. securities exchange that is registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission, (b) the U.S. market system established pursuant to section 11A of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, or (c) a non-U.S. securities exchange that is regulated or supervised by a governmental authority of the country in which the market is located, provided that (i) such non-U.S. exchange has trading volume, listing, financial disclosure, surveillance and other requirements designed to prevent fraudulent and manipulative acts and practices, to remove impediments to and perfect the mechanism of a free and open, fair and orderly, market, and to protect investors; and the laws of the country in which such non-U.S. exchange is located and the rules of such non-U.S. exchange ensure that such requirements are actually enforced and (ii) the rules of such non-U.S. exchange effectively promote active trading of listed shares. No assurance can be given that the ADSs will meet the requirements to be treated as “regularly traded” for purposes of the mark-to-market election. In addition, because a mark-to-market election cannot be made for any lower-tier PFICs that we may own, you may continue to be subject to the special tax regime with respect to your indirect interest in any investments held by us that are treated as an equity interest in a PFIC for U.S. federal income tax purposes, including shares in any future subsidiary of ours that is treated as a PFIC.

 

  116  

 

 

If you make this mark-to-market election, you will be required in any year in which we are a PFIC to include as ordinary income the excess of the fair market value of your ADSs at year-end over your basis in those ADSs. In addition, the excess, if any, of your basis in the ADSs over the fair market value of your ADSs at year-end is deductible as an ordinary loss in an amount equal to the lesser of (i) the amount of the excess or (ii) the amount of the net mark-to-market gains that have been included in income in prior years. Any gain recognized upon the sale of the ADSs will be taxed as ordinary income in the year of sale. Amounts treated as ordinary income will not be eligible for the preferential tax rate applicable to qualified dividend income or long-term capital gains. Your adjusted tax basis in the ADSs will be increased by the amount of any income inclusion and decreased by the amount of any deductions under the mark-to-market rules. If you make a mark-to market election, it will be effective for the taxable year for which the election is made and all subsequent taxable years unless the ADSs are no longer regularly traded on a qualified exchange or the IRS consents to the revocation of the election.

 

The U.S. federal income tax rules relating to PFICs are complex. You are urged to consult your tax advisors with respect to the purchase, ownership and disposition of the ADSs, any elections available with respect to such ADSs and the U.S. Internal Revenue Service information reporting obligations with respect to the purchase, ownership and disposition of the ADSs.

 

Information Reporting and Backup Withholding

 

Distributions with respect to ADSs and proceeds from the sale, exchange or disposition of ADSs may be subject to information reporting to the U.S. Internal Revenue Service and possible U.S. backup withholding. Backup withholding will not apply, however, to a U.S. Holder who furnishes a correct taxpayer identification number and makes any other required certification or who is otherwise exempt from backup withholding. U.S. Holders who are required to establish their exempt status generally must provide such certification on U.S. Internal Revenue Service Form W-9. U.S. Holders should consult their tax advisors regarding the application of the U.S. information reporting and backup withholding rules.

  117  

 

 

Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Amounts withheld as backup withholding may be credited against your U.S. federal income tax liability, and you may obtain a refund of any excess amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules by filing the appropriate claim for refund with the U.S. Internal Revenue Service and furnishing any required information. If a U.S. Holder owns ADS during any year in which we are a PFIC, such U.S. Holder (including, potentially, indirect holders) generally must file a U.S. Internal Revenue Service Form 8621 with such holder’s federal income tax return for that year.

 

Specified Foreign Financial Assets

 

Tax reporting obligations are imposed on certain U.S. persons that own “specified foreign financial assets,” including securities issued by any foreign person, either directly or indirectly or through certain foreign financial institutions, if the aggregate value of all of those assets exceeds $50,000 on the last day of the taxable year (and in some circumstances, a higher threshold). This reporting requirement applies to individuals and certain U.S. entities. The ADSs may be treated as specified foreign financial assets, and investors may be subject to this information reporting regime. Significant penalties and an extended statute of limitations may apply to a U.S. Holder subject to this reporting requirement that fails to file information reports. Each prospective investor that is a U.S. person should consult its own tax advisor regarding this information reporting obligation.

 

United Kingdom Tax Considerations

 

The following is a general summary of certain U.K. tax considerations relating to the ownership and disposal of the ordinary shares or the ADSs and does not address all possible tax consequences relating to an investment in the ordinary shares or the ADSs. It is based on current U.K. tax law and generally published HM Revenue & Customs, (or “HMRC”), practice as at the date of this Annual Report on Form 20-F, both of which are subject to change, possibly with retrospective effect.

 

Save as provided otherwise, this summary applies only to persons who are resident (and, in the case of individuals, domiciled) in the United Kingdom for tax purposes and who are not resident for tax purposes in any other jurisdiction and do not have a permanent establishment or fixed base in any other jurisdiction with which the holding of the ordinary shares or ADSs is connected (“U.K. Holders”). Persons (a) who are not resident (or, if resident are not domiciled) in the United Kingdom for tax purposes, including those individuals and companies who trade in the United Kingdom through a branch, agency or permanent establishment in the United Kingdom to which the ordinary shares or the ADSs are attributable, or (b) who are resident or otherwise subject to tax in a jurisdiction outside the United Kingdom, are recommended to seek the advice of professional advisors in relation to their taxation obligations.

 

This summary is for general information only and is not intended to be, nor should it be considered to be, legal or tax advice to any particular investor. It does not address all of the tax considerations that may be relevant to specific investors in light of their particular circumstances or to investors subject to special treatment under U.K. tax law. In particular:

 

this summary only applies to the absolute beneficial owners of the ordinary shares or the ADSs and any dividends paid in respect of the ordinary shares represented by the ADSs where the dividends are regarded for U.K. tax purposes as that person’s own income (and not the income of some other person);

 

this summary: (a) only addresses the principal U.K. tax consequences for investors who hold the ordinary shares or ADSs as capital assets/investments, (b) does not address the tax consequences that may be relevant to certain special classes of investor such as dealers, brokers or traders in shares or securities and other persons who hold the ordinary shares or ADSs otherwise than as an investment, (c) does not address the tax consequences for holders that are financial institutions, insurance companies, collective investment schemes, pension schemes, charities or tax-exempt organizations, (d) assumes that the holder is not an officer or employee of the Company (or of any related company) and has not (and is not deemed to have) acquired the ordinary shares or ADSs by reason of an office or employment, and (e) assumes that the holder does not control or hold (and is not deemed to control or hold), either alone or together with one or more associated or connected persons, directly or indirectly (including through the holding of the ADSs), an interest of 10% or more in the issued share capital (or in any class thereof), voting power, rights to profits or capital of the Company, and is not otherwise connected with the Company.

 

This summary further assumes that a holder of ADSs will be treated as the beneficial owner of the underlying ordinary shares for U.K. tax purposes.

 

POTENTIAL INVESTORS IN THE ADSs SHOULD SATISFY THEMSELVES PRIOR TO INVESTING AS TO THE OVERALL TAX CONSEQUENCES, INCLUDING, SPECIFICALLY, THE CONSEQUENCES UNDER U.K. TAX LAW AND HMRC PRACTICE OF THE ACQUISITION, OWNERSHIP AND DISPOSAL OF THE ORDINARY SHARES OR ADSs, IN THEIR OWN PARTICULAR CIRCUMSTANCES BY CONSULTING THEIR OWN TAX ADVISERS.

 

  118  

 

 

Taxation of dividends

 

Withholding Tax

 

Dividend payments in respect of the ordinary shares represented by the ADSs may be made without withholding or deduction for or on account of U.K. tax.

 

Income Tax

 

Dividends received by individual U.K. Holders will be subject to U.K. income tax on the amount of the dividend paid.

 

An individual U.K. Holder will be exempt from U.K. income tax (by applying a nil rate of tax) on the first £5,000 of dividend income received by such individual U.K. Holder in a tax year, regardless of the amount of the individual’s other taxable income.

 

Dividend income in excess of the £5,000 allowance will be taxed at the rate of 7.5% to the extent that the dividend, when treated as the top slice of the relevant U.K. Holder’s income, does not exceed the basic rate income tax limit, at the rate of 32.5% to the extent that the dividend, when treated as the top slice of the relevant U.K. Holder’s income, exceeds the basic rate income tax limit but does not exceed the higher rate income tax limit, and at the rate of 38.1% to the extent that the dividend, when treated as the top slice of the relevant U.K. Holder’s income, exceeds the higher rate income tax limit.

 

An individual holder of ordinary shares or ADSs who is not a U.K. Holder will not be chargeable to U.K. income tax on dividends paid by the Company, unless such holder carries on (whether solely or in partnership) a trade, profession or vocation in the United Kingdom through a branch or agency in the United Kingdom to which the ordinary shares or ADSs are attributable. In these circumstances, such holder may, depending on his or her individual circumstances, be chargeable to U.K. income tax on dividends received from the Company.

 

Corporation Tax

 

A U.K. Holder within the charge to U.K. corporation tax may be entitled to exemption from U.K. corporation tax in respect of dividend payments. If the conditions for the exemption are not satisfied, or such U.K. Holder elects for an otherwise exempt dividend to be taxable, U.K. corporation tax will be chargeable on the gross amount of any dividends. If potential investors are in any doubt as to their position, they should consult their own professional advisers.

 

A corporate holder of ordinary shares or ADSs that is not a U.K. Holder will not be subject to U.K. corporation tax on dividends received from the Company, unless it carries on a trade in the United Kingdom through a permanent establishment to which the ordinary shares or ADSs are attributable. In these circumstances, such holder may, depending on its individual circumstances and if the exemption from U.K. corporation tax discussed above does not apply, be chargeable to U.K. corporation tax on dividends received from the Company.

 

  119  

 

 

Taxation of disposals

 

U.K. Holders

 

A disposal or deemed disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs by an individual U.K. Holder may, depending on his or her individual circumstances, give rise to a chargeable gain or to an allowable loss for the purpose of U.K. capital gains tax. The principal factors that will determine the capital gains tax position on a disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs are the extent to which the holder realizes any other capital gains in the tax year in which the disposal is made, the extent to which the holder has incurred capital losses in that or any earlier tax year and the level of the annual allowance of tax-free gains in that tax year (the “annual exemption”). The annual exemption for the 2016/2017 tax year is £11,100. If, after all allowable deductions, an individual U.K. Holder’s total taxable income (which, for the avoidance of doubt, includes any dividend income within the £5,000 nil rate band described above) for the year exceeds the basic rate income tax limit, a taxable capital gain accruing on a disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs will be taxed at 20%. If, after all allowable deductions, an individual U.K. Holder’s total taxable income for the year does not exceed the basic rate income tax limit, and assuming the individual does not have any other taxable capital gains in the tax year that would use up the remaining basic rate allowance, a taxable capital gain accruing on a disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs will be taxed at 10% on an amount that, when treated as the top slice of the relevant U.K. Holder’s income/gains, does not exceed the basic rate income tax and at 20% on the remainder.  

 

A disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs by a corporate U.K. Holder may give rise to a chargeable gain or an allowable loss for the purpose of U.K. corporation tax. Such a holder should be entitled to an indexation allowance, which applies to reduce capital gains to take account of inflation. The allowance may reduce a chargeable gain but will not create or increase an allowable loss.

 

Any gains or losses in respect of currency fluctuations over the period of holding the ADSs would also be brought into account on the disposal.

 

Non-U.K. Holders

 

An individual holder who is not a U.K. Holder will not be liable to U.K. capital gains tax on capital gains realized on the disposal of his or her ordinary shares or ADSs unless such holder carries on (whether solely or in partnership) a trade, profession or vocation in the United Kingdom through a branch or agency in the United Kingdom to which the ordinary shares or ADSs are attributable. In these circumstances, such holder may, depending on his or her individual circumstances, be chargeable to U.K. capital gains tax on chargeable gains arising from a disposal of his or her ordinary shares or ADSs.

 

A corporate holder of ordinary shares or ADSs that is not a U.K. Holder will not be liable for U.K. corporation tax on chargeable gains realized on the disposal of its ordinary shares or ADSs unless it carries on a trade in the United Kingdom through a permanent establishment to which the ordinary shares or ADSs are attributable. In these circumstances, a disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs by such holder may give rise to a chargeable gain or an allowable loss for the purposes of U.K. corporation tax.

 

Inheritance Tax

 

If for the purposes of the Taxes on Estates of Deceased Persons and on Gifts Treaty 1978 between the United States and the United Kingdom an individual holder of ordinary shares or ADSs is domiciled in the United States and is not a national of the United Kingdom, any ordinary shares or ADSs beneficially owned by that holder will not generally be subject to U.K. inheritance tax on that holder’s death or on a gift made by that holder during his/her lifetime, provided that any applicable United States federal gift or estate tax liability is paid, except where (i) the ordinary shares or ADSs are part of the business property of a U.K. permanent establishment or pertain to a U.K. fixed base used for the performance of independent personal services; or (ii) the ordinary shares or ADSs are comprised in a settlement unless, at the time the settlement was made, the settlor was domiciled in the United States and not a national of the U.K. (in which case no charge to U.K. inheritance tax should apply).

 

Stamp Duty and Stamp Duty Reserve Tax

 

Issue and Transfer of Ordinary Shares

 

No U.K. stamp duty is payable on the issue of the ordinary shares.

 

Based on current published HMRC practice and recent case law, there should be no U.K. stamp duty reserve tax ("SDRT") payable on the issue of ordinary shares to a depositary receipt system or a clearance service (for example DTC).

 

Transfers of ordinary shares to, or to a nominee or agent for, a person whose business is or includes issuing depositary receipts or to, or to a nominee or agent for, a person whose business is or includes the provision of clearance services, will generally be regarded by HMRC as subject to stamp duty or SDRT at 1.5% of the amount or value of the consideration or, in certain circumstances, the value of the ordinary shares transferred. In practice, this liability for stamp duty or SDRT is in general borne by such person depositing the relevant shares in the depositary receipt system or clearance service. Transfers of ordinary shares between depositary receipt systems and clearance services will generally be exempt from stamp duty and SDRT.

 

The transfer on sale of ordinary shares by a written instrument of transfer will generally be liable to U.K. stamp duty at the rate of 0.5% of the amount or value of the consideration for the transfer. The purchaser normally pays the stamp duty.

 

An agreement to transfer ordinary shares outside a depositary receipt system or a clearance service will generally give rise to a liability on the purchaser to SDRT at the rate of 0.5% of the amount or value of the consideration. Such SDRT is payable on the seventh day of the month following the month in which the charge arises, but where an instrument of transfer is executed and duly stamped before the expiry of a period of six years beginning with the date of that agreement, (i) any SDRT that has not been paid ceases to be payable, and (ii) any SDRT that has been paid may be recovered from HMRC, generally with interest.

   

  120  

 

 

Transfer of ADSs

 

Based on current HMRC published practice, no U.K. stamp duty should be payable on a written instrument transferring an ADS or on a written agreement to transfer an ADS, on the basis that an ADS is not regarded as “stock” or a “marketable security” for U.K. stamp duty purposes.

 

No SDRT will be payable on an agreement to transfer an ADS, as an ADS is not considered a “chargeable security” for the purposes of SDRT.

 

F. Dividends and Paying Agents.

 

Not Applicable.

 

G. Statement by Experts.

 

Not Applicable.

 

H. Documents on Display.

 

We are subject to the informational requirements of the Exchange Act. Accordingly, we are required to file reports and other information with the SEC, including annual reports on Form 20-F and reports on Form 6-K. You may inspect and copy reports and other information filed with the SEC at the Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549. Information on the operation of the Public Reference Room may be obtained by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. In addition, the SEC maintains an Internet website that contains reports and other information about issuers, like us, that file electronically with the SEC. The address of that website is www.sec.gov.

 

We also make available on our website, free of charge, our Annual Report and the text of our reports on Form 6-K, including any amendments to these reports, as well as certain other SEC filings, as soon as reasonably practicable after they are electronically filed with or furnished to the SEC. Our website address is “www.gwpharm.com.” The information contained on our website is not incorporated by reference in this Annual Report.

 

I. Subsidiary Information

 

Not Applicable.

 

Item 11 Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk.

 

Market risk arises from our exposure to fluctuation in interest rates and currency exchange rates. These risks are managed by maintaining an appropriate mix of cash deposits in various currencies, placed with a variety of financial institutions for varying periods according to expected liquidity requirements.

 

Interest Rate Risk

 

We are exposed to interest rate risk as we place surplus cash funds on deposit to earn interest income. We seek to ensure that we consistently earn commercially competitive interest rates by using the services of an independent broker to identify and secure the best commercially available interest rates from those banks that meet our stringent counterparty credit rating criteria. In doing so, we manage the term of cash deposits, up to 365 days, in order to maximize interest earnings while also ensuring that we maintain sufficient readily available cash in order to meet short-term liquidity needs.

 

At September 30, 2016, our cash and cash equivalents consisted of very short-term cash deposits with maturities of less than 90 days, in order to maximize the liquidity of our funds during a period of economic uncertainty and increased concern about counterparty credit risk.

 

We do not have any balance sheet exposure to assets or liabilities that would increase or decrease in fair value with changes to interest rates.

 

  121  

 

 

Currency Risk

 

Our functional currency is pounds sterling and the majority of our transactions are denominated in that currency. However, we receive revenue and incur expenses in other currencies and are exposed to the effects of exchange rates. We seek to minimize this exposure by passively maintaining other currency cash balances at levels appropriate to meet foreseeable expenses in these other currencies, converting surplus currency balances of these other currencies into pounds sterling as soon as they arise. We do not use forward exchange contracts to manage exchange rate exposure.

 

For additional information about our quantitative and qualitative risks, see Note 21 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

Item 12 Description of Securities Other than Equity Securities.

 

A. Debt Securities.

 

Not Applicable.

 

B. Warrants and Rights.

 

Not Applicable.

 

C. Other Securities.

 

Not Applicable.

 

D. American Depositary Shares.

 

Fees and Charges

 

The following table shows the fees and charges that a holder of our ADSs may have to pay, either directly or indirectly. The majority of these costs are set by the Depositary and are subject to change:

 

Service

 

Fees

Issuance of ADSs   Up to U.S. 5¢ per ADS issued
Cancellation of ADSs   Up to U.S. 5¢ per ADS canceled
Distribution of cash dividends or other cash distributions   Up to U.S. 5¢ per ADS held
Distribution of ADSs pursuant to stock dividends, free stock distributions or exercise of rights   Up to U.S. 5¢ per ADS held
Distribution of securities other than ADSs or rights to purchase additional ADSs   Up to U.S. 5¢ per ADS held
Depositary Services   Up to U.S. 5¢ per ADS held on the applicable record date(s) established by the depositary bank

 

ADS holders may also be responsible to pay certain fees and expenses incurred by the depositary bank and certain taxes and governmental charges such as:

 

Fees for the transfer and registration of ordinary shares charged by the registrar and transfer agent for the ordinary shares in England and Wales (i.e., upon deposit and withdrawal of ordinary shares).

 

Expenses incurred for converting foreign currency into U.S. dollars.

 

Expenses for cable, telex and fax transmissions and for delivery of securities.

 

Taxes and duties upon the transfer of securities (i.e., when ordinary shares are deposited or withdrawn from deposit).

 

Fees and expenses incurred in connection with the delivery or servicing of ordinary shares on deposit.

 

  122  

 

 

PART II

 

Item 13. Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies.

 

None

 

Item 14. Material Modifications To The Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds.

 

Not Applicable.

 

Item 15. Controls and Procedures.

 

A. Disclosure Controls and Procedures.

 

As required by Rule 13a-15 under the Exchange Act, management, including our chief executive officer and our chief financial officer, has evaluated the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures as of the end of the period covered by this report. Disclosure controls and procedures refer to controls and other procedures designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in the reports we file or submit under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the rules and forms of the SEC. Disclosure controls and procedures include, without limitation, controls and procedures designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by us in our reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to management, including our principal executive and principal financial officers, or persons performing similar functions, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding our required disclosure.

 

Based on the foregoing, our chief executive officer and our chief financial officer have concluded that, as of September 30, 2016, our disclosure controls and procedures in internal control over financial reporting were effective.

 

B. Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting.

 

Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Exchange Act. Our internal control over financial reporting is a process to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards, or IFRS, as endorsed by the European Union and as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board, or IASB. We have a program for the review of our internal control over financial reporting to ensure compliance with the requirements of the Exchange Act and Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. Our internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that:

 

pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of our assets;

 

provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with IFRS, as endorsed by the European Union and as issued by IASB;

 

provide reasonable assurance that our receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of our management and directors; and

 

provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of our assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

  123  

 

 

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect all misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

 

Our management, with the participation of our chief executive officer and our chief financial officer, assessed the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2016. In conducting its assessment of internal control over financial reporting, management based its evaluation on the Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the COSO as at September 30, 2016. Based on its evaluation, our management has concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective as at September 30, 2016.

 

The Group’s internal control over financial reporting at September 30, 2016 has been audited by Deloitte LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm who also audit the Group’s consolidated financial statements. Their audit report on internal control over financial reporting is included in Item 15C. Deloitte LLP has also audited the consolidated financial statements as at and for the year ended September 30, 2016 and their report expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements.

 

C. Attestation Report of the Registered Public Accounting Firm.

 

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of GW Pharmaceuticals plc

 

We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of GW Pharmaceuticals plc and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as at September 30, 2016, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

 

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on that risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

A company's internal control over financial reporting is a process designed by, or under the supervision of, the company's principal executive and principal financial officers, or persons performing similar functions, and effected by the company's board of directors, management, and other personnel to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company's internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company's assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

Because of the inherent limitations of internal control over financial reporting, including the possibility of collusion or improper management override of controls, material misstatements due to error or fraud may not be prevented or detected on a timely basis. Also, projections of any evaluation of the effectiveness of the internal control over financial reporting to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

 

  124  

 

 

In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2016, based on the criteria established in Internal Control— Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.

 

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated financial statements of the Company as of and for the year ended September 30, 2016 and our report dated December 5, 2016 expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements.

 

/s/ Deloitte LLP  
   
London, United Kingdom  
December 5, 2016  

  

D. Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting.

 

During fiscal 2016, we implemented changes in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Exchange Act) that materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Group’s internal control over financial reporting. As disclosed in our Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended September 30, 2015, we concluded that we did not have adequate internal controls over the accounting for the completeness and valuation of clinical trial accruals.

 

With the oversight of our management and the Audit Committee, we have implemented additional measures to remediate the underlying causes of the material weakness related to the accounting for the completeness and valuation of clinical trial accruals described above. Our remediation actions included:

 

redesigning our controls over the monitoring of clinical study expenditures to ensure the completeness and accuracy of the budgeted and actual clinical study costs related to each clinical trial. These controls over the clinical accrual calculation will comprise: (i) a detailed review of the initial budget for each trial including a comparison to underlying contracts and amendments, (ii) a review of actual costs incurred to date are allocated to the appropriate trial and are both accurate and complete and (iii) a revised assessment that the remaining costs to complete reflect the expected future expenditure
establishing a company-wide contract monitoring and management process to identify and monitor all contracts where payments are linked to progress based milestones. These potential contractual liabilities are then investigated on a monthly basis to ensure accurate accruals at each period end.

 

We believe the previously identified material weakness for over accounting for the completeness and valuation of clinical trial accruals has been remediated.

 

Item 16A. Audit Committee Financial Expert.

 

Our Audit Committee consists of James Noble, Cabot Brown and Thomas Lynch and is chaired by Mr. James Noble. Each of our Audit Committee members satisfies the independence requirements of Rule 5605(a)(2) of the NASDAQ Stock Market, Marketplace Rules, and the independence requirements of Rule 10A-3(b)(1) under the Exchange Act. Our board of directors has determined that Mr. Noble qualifies as an Audit Committee financial expert within the meaning of the applicable SEC rules.

 

  125  

 

 

Item 16B. Code of Ethics.

 

Our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics is applicable to all of our employees, officers and directors and is available on our website at http://www.gwpharm.com. Our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics provides that our directors and officers are expected to avoid any action, position or interest that conflicts with the interests of our company or gives the appearance of a conflict. Our directors and officers have an obligation under our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics to advance our company’s interests when the opportunity to do so arises. We expect that any amendment to this code, or any waivers of its requirements, will be disclosed on our website. Information contained on, or that can be accessed through, our website is not incorporated by reference into this document, and you should not consider information on our website to be part of this document.

 

Item 16C. Principal Accountant Fees and Services.

 

Our financial statements have been prepared in accordance with IFRS and are audited by Deloitte LLP, a firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board in the United States.

 

Deloitte LLP has served as our independent registered public accountant for each of the years ended September 30, 2016, September 30, 2015 and September 30, 2014 for which audited statements appear in this Annual Report.

 

The following table shows the aggregate fees for services rendered by Deloitte LLP to us, including some of our subsidiaries, in fiscal years ended September 30, 2016 and 2015.

 

   

2016

£000’s

   

2015

£000’s

 
Audit fees:                
– Audit of the Company’s annual accounts 1     400       400  
– Audit of the Company’s subsidiaries pursuant to legislation     50       50  
Total audit fees     450       450  
Other services                
– Audit-related assurance 2     75       53  
– Other assurance services 3     109       92  
Total non-audit fees     184       145  

 

1 For the years ended September 30, 2016 and 2015, the audit fees include amounts for the audit of the consolidated financial statements in accordance with the International Standards of Auditing, and standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board. For the year ended September 30, 2016 and 2015, audit fees also include amounts for the audit of the Group’s internal controls over financial reporting. An additional £40,000 was billed in respect of the 2015 audit during the year to September 30, 2016. An additional £156,000 was billed in respect of the 2014 audit during the year to September 30, 2015.

 

2 Audit related assurance fees relate to fees for the performance of interim reviews, and other procedures on our interim results.

 

3 Other assurance services represents assurance reporting on historical financial information included in the Company’s shelf registration and SEC registration statements in connection with following offerings on the NASDAQ Global Market.

 

Our Audit Committee reviews and pre-approves the scope and the cost of audit services related to us and permissible non-audit services performed by the independent auditors, other than those for de minimis services which are approved by the Audit Committee prior to the completion of the audit. All of the services related to our company provided by Deloitte LLP during the last fiscal year have been approved by the Audit Committee.

 

Item 16D. Exemptions From the Listing Standards For Audit Committees.

 

Not Applicable.

 

Item 16E. Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers.

 

Not Applicable.

 

Item 16F. Change in the Registrant’s Certifying Accountant.

 

Not Applicable.

 

  126  

 

 

Item 16G. Corporate Governance.

 

We rely on a provision in NASDAQ’s Listed Company Manual that allows us to follow English corporate law and the Companies Act 2006 with regard to certain aspects of corporate governance. This allows us to follow certain corporate governance practices that differ in significant respects from the corporate governance requirements applicable to U.S. companies listed on the NASDAQ Global Market.

 

For example, we are exempt from regulations that require a listed company to:

 

have a majority of the board of directors consist of independent directors;

 

require non-management directors to meet on a regular basis without management present;

 

promptly disclose any waivers of the code for directors or executive officers that should address certain specified items;

 

have an independent nominating committee;

 

solicit proxies and provide proxy statements for all shareholder meetings;

 

have a compensation committee charter specifying the items enumerated in NASDAQ Stock Market, Marketplace Rule 5605(d)(1) and a review and assessment of the adequacy of that charter on an annual basis; and

 

seek shareholder approval for the implementation of certain equity compensation plans and issuances of ordinary shares.

 

As a foreign private issuer, we are permitted to, and we will continue to, follow home country practice in lieu of the above requirements.

 

In accordance with our NASDAQ Global Market listing, our Audit Committee is required to comply with the provisions of Section 301 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, or the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, and Rule 10A-3 of the Exchange Act, both of which are also applicable to NASDAQ Global Market-listed U.S. companies. Because we are a foreign private issuer, however, our Audit Committee is not subject to additional NASDAQ Global Market requirements applicable to listed U.S. companies, including an affirmative determination that all members of the Audit Committee are “independent,” using more stringent criteria than those applicable to us as a foreign private issuer.

 

Item 16H. Mine Safety Disclosure.

 

Not Applicable.

 

  127  

 

 

PART III

 

Item 17 Financial Statements.

 

We have elected to provide financial statements pursuant to Item 18.

 

Item 18 Financial Statements.

 

The financial statements are filed as part of this Annual Report beginning on page F-1.

 

Item 19 Exhibits

 

Exhibit

Number

  Description of Exhibit  
     
1.1*   Memorandum & Articles of Association of GW Pharmaceuticals plc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
2.1*   Form of specimen certificate evidencing ordinary shares (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
2.2 (1) *   Form of Deposit Agreement among GW Pharmaceuticals plc, Citibank, N.A., as the depositary bank and all Holders and Beneficial Owners of ADSs issued thereunder (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
2.3 (1) *   Form of American Depositary Receipt (included in Exhibit 2.2) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.1†*   Licence and Distribution Agreement between Bayer AG Division Pharma and GW Pharma Limited., dated May 20, 2003 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.2†*   Amendment Number 1 to the Licence and Distribution Agreement, dated November 4, 2003 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.3*   Amendment Number 2 to the Licence and Distribution Agreement between GW Pharma Limited. and Bayer Healthcare AG Division Pharma, dated January 14, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.4†*   Amendment Number 3 to the Licence and Distribution Agreement between GW Pharma Limited. and Bayer Healthcare AG Division Pharma, dated March 1, 2005 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.5†*   Amendment Number 4 to the Licence and Distribution Agreement between GW Pharma Limited. and Bayer Healthcare AG Division Pharma, dated May 10, 2005 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.6*   Amendment Number 5 to the Licence and Distribution Agreement between GW Pharma Limited. and Bayer Schering Pharma AG (f/k/a Bayer AG, Bayer HealthCare, Division Pharma), dated March 10, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).

 

  128  

 

 

4.7†*   Supply Agreement between Bayer AG and GW Pharma Limited, dated May 20, 2003 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.8†*   Amendment Number 1 to the Supply Agreement between GW Pharma Limited. and Bayer Healthcare AG, dated November 4, 2003 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.9†*   Amendment Number 2 to the Supply Agreement between GW Pharma Limited. and Bayer Healthcare AG, dated May 10, 2005 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.9 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.10†*   Amendment Number 3 to the Supply Agreement between GW Pharma Limited. and Bayer Schering Pharma AG (f/k/a Bayer AG, Bayer HealthCare, Division Pharma), dated March 10, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.10 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.11†*   Product Commercialisation and Supply Consolidated Agreement between GW Pharma Limited and Almirall Prodesfarma, S.A., dated June 6, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.11 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.12†*   Amendment No. 1 to the Product Commercialisation and Supply Consolidated Agreement between GW Pharma Limited. and Laboratorios Almirall S.A., dated March 4, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.12 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.13†*   Amendment to the Product Commercialisation and Supply Consolidated Agreement, dated June 6, 2006 between GW Pharma Limited. and Almirall S.A., dated July 23, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.13 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.14†*   Supplementary Agreement to the Product Commercialisation and Supply Consolidated Agreement, dated June 6, 2006 between GW Pharma Limited. and Almirall S.A., dated November 17, 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.14 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.15†*   Amendment and Supplementary Agreement to the Product Commercialisation and Supply Consolidated Agreement, dated June 6, 2006 between GW Pharma Limited. and Almirall S.A., dated March 13, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.15 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.16†*   Research Collaboration and Licence Agreement between GW Pharma Limited. and GW Pharmaceuticals plc and Otsuka Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd., dated July 9, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.16 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.17†*   Amendment No. 1 to Research Collaboration and Licence Agreement, dated March 14, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.17 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.18†*   Amendment No. 2 to Research Collaboration and Licence Agreement, dated June 29, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.18 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).

 

  129  

 

 

4.19†*   Development and Licence Agreement between GW Pharma Limited. and GW Pharmaceuticals Plc and Otsuka Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd., dated February 14, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.19 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.20†*   Amendment No. 1 to Development and Licence Agreement, dated November 1, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.20 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.21†*   Letter amending Development and Licence Agreement, dated October 21, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.21 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.22†*   Distribution and Licence Agreement, dated April 8, 2011, by and between GW Pharma Limited. and Novartis Pharma AG (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.22 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.23†*   Manufacturing and Supply Agreement, dated November 9, 2011, by and between Novartis Pharma AG and GW Pharma Limited. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.23 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.24†*   Production Supply Agreement, dated March 7, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.24 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.25†*   Lease, dated July 6, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.26†*   Lease, dated October 9, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.26 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.27†*   Lease, dated April 6, 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.28†*   Lease, dated October 12, 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.28 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.29†*   Lease, dated January 6, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.29 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.30†*   Agreement for Lease, dated April 4, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.30 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.31*   Occupational Underlease, dated August 11, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.31 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.32*   Lease, dated May 24, 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.32 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).

 

  130  

 

 

4.33*   Tenancy Agreement, dated November 19, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.33 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.34*   Service Agreement by and between GW Pharma Limited, and Adam George, dated June 1, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.34 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.35†*   Service Agreement by and between GW Pharma Limited, and Chris Tovey, dated July 11, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.35 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.36*   Service Agreement by and between GW Research Limited and Dr. Geoffrey Guy, dated March 14, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.36 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.37*   Service Agreement by and between GW Research Limited and Justin Gover, dated February 26, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.37 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.38*   Service Agreement by and between GW Research Limited and Dr. Stephen Wright, dated January 18, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.38 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.39*   Letter of Appointment by and between GW Pharmaceuticals plc and James Noble, dated February 26, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.39 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.40*   Letter of Appointment by and between GW Pharmaceuticals plc and Thomas Lynch, dated February 26, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.40 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.41*   Service Agreement by and between Greenwich Biosciences Inc. (formerly GW Pharmaceuticals Inc.) and Cabot Brown, dated November 7, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.41 to our Annual Report (file no. 001-35892), filed with the SEC on November 25, 2013).
     
4.42*   Long Term Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to our Registration Statement on Form S-8 (file no. 333-204389), filed with the SEC on May 22, 2015).
     
4.43*   GW Pharmaceuticals All Employee Share Scheme (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.43 to our Registration Statement on Form F-1 (file no. 333-187356), as amended, initially filed with the SEC on March 19, 2013).
     
4.44*   GW Pharmaceuticals Approved Share Option Scheme 2001, as amended.
     
4.45*   GW Pharmaceuticals Unapproved Share Option Scheme 2001, as amended.
     
4.46†*   Lease, dated May 24, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.46 to our Annual Report (file no. 001-35892), as amended, originally filed with the SEC on November 25, 2013).
     
4.47†*   Lease, dated May 24, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.47 to our Annual Report (file no. 001-35892), as amended, originally filed with the SEC on November 25, 2013).
     
4.48†*   Lease, dated May 24, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.48 to our Annual Report (file no. 001-35892), as amended, originally filed with the SEC on November 25, 2013).

 

  131  

 

 

4.49*   Lease, dated August 1, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.49 to our Annual Report (file no. 001-35892), as amended, originally filed with the SEC on November 25, 2013).
     
4.50*   Lease, dated July 16, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.50 to our Annual Report (file no. 001-35892), as amended, originally filed with the SEC on November 25, 2013).
     
4.51*   Amendment to the Distribution and Licence Agreement, dated May 5, 2014 between Novartis Pharma AG and GW Pharma Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.4 to our Report on Form 6-K, filed with the SEC on May 7, 2014).
     
4.52*†   Amendment and Supplementary Agreement to the Product Commercialisation and Supply Consolidated Agreement dated June 6, 2006, between GW Pharma Limited and Almirall, S.A., dated September 30, 2014.
     
4.53*   Transfer of Contract, dated July 20, 2015 among GW Pharmaceuticals plc, GW Research Limited and Justin Gover.
     
4.54*   Offer Letter, dated July 17, 2015 between Greenwich Biosciences Inc. (formerly GW Pharmaceuticals Inc.) and Justin Gover.
     
4.55*   Offer Letter, dated May 5, 2015 between Greenwich Biosciences Inc. (formerly GW Pharmaceuticals Inc.) and Julian Gangolli.
     
4.56*   Discretionary Benefits Letter, dated May 5, 2015 between Greenwich Biosciences Inc. (formerly GW Pharmaceuticals Inc.) and Julian Gangolli.
     
4.57*   Service Agreement by and between GW Pharmaceuticals plc and Julian Gangolli, effective July 21, 2015.
     
4.58**††   Lease, dated May 27, 2016.
     
4.59**††   Amended and Restated Production and Supply Agreement, dated August 31, 2016, among GW Pharma Limited, GW Pharmaceuticals plc and British Sugar plc.
     
4.60**   Mutual Termination Agreement, dated November 24, 2016 between Novartis Pharma AG and GW Pharma Ltd.
     
4.61**   Letter of Appointment by and between GW Pharmaceuticals plc and Cabot Brown, effective January 1, 2016.
     
4.62**   Letter of Appointment by and between GW Pharmaceuticals plc and James Noble, effective February 1, 2016.
     
8.1**   List of Subsidiaries.
     
12.1**   Certificate of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Securities Exchange Act Rules 13a-14(a) and 15d-14(a) as adopted pursuant to §302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
     
12.2**   Certificate of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Securities Exchange Act Rules 13a-14(a) and 15d-14(a) as adopted pursuant to §302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
     
13.1**   Certificate of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. §1350, as adopted pursuant to §906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
     
13.2**   Certificate of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. §1350, as adopted pursuant to §906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
     
15.1**  

Consent of Deloitte LLP.

 

 

* Previously filed.

 

** Filed herewith.

 

Confidential treatment previously requested and granted as to portions of the exhibit. Confidential materials omitted and filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

 

†† Confidential treatment requested as to portions of the exhibit. Confidential materials omitted and filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

 

(1) Incorporated by reference to the Registration Statement on Form F-6 (File No. 333-187978), filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission with respect to ADSs representing ordinary shares.

 

  132  

 

 

Signature

 

The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this Annual Report on its behalf.

 

  GW PHARMACEUTICALS PLC
     
  By: /s/ Justin Gover
    Name: Justin Gover
    Title: Chief Executive Officer
Date: December 5, 2016      

 

  133  

 

 

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm F-2
   
Consolidated Income Statements for the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014 F-3
   
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss for the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014 F-4
   
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Equity for the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014 F-5
   
Consolidated Balance Sheets as at September 30, 2016 and 2015 F-6
   
Consolidated Cash Flow Statements for the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014 F-7
   
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements F-8

 

  F- 1  

 

 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of GW Pharmaceuticals plc

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of GW Pharmaceuticals plc and subsidiaries (the "Company") as at September 30, 2016 and 2015, and the related consolidated income statements, consolidated statements of comprehensive loss, consolidated statements of changes in equity, and consolidated cash flow statements for each of the three years in the period ended September 30, 2016. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

In our opinion, such consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of GW Pharmaceuticals plc and subsidiaries as at September 30, 2016 and 2015, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended September 30, 2016, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IASB”).

 

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the Company's internal control over financial reporting as at September 30, 2016, based on the criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated December 5, 2016 expressed an unqualified opinion on the Company's internal control over financial reporting.

 

/s/ DELOITTE LLP  
   
London, United Kingdom   
December 5, 2016  

 

  F- 2  

 

  

Consolidated Income Statements

For the year ended 30 September

 

    Notes    

2016

£000s

    2015
£000s
    2014
£000s
 
Revenue     3       10,315       28,540       30,045  
Cost of sales             (2,719 )     (2,618 )     (2,060 )
Research and development expenditure     4       (99,815 )     (76,785 )     (43,475 )
Sales, general and administrative expenses             (19,939 )     (12,569 )     (7,337 )
Net foreign exchange gain             25,551       6,202       3,188  
Operating loss             (86,607 )     (57,230 )     (19,639 )
Interest expense     9       (173 )     (75 )     (61 )
Other income     9       608       244       130  
Loss before tax     5       (86,172 )     (57,061 )     (19,570 )
Tax benefit     10       22,515       12,498       4,911  
Loss for the year             (63,657 )     (44,563 )     (14,659 )
                                 
Loss per share – basic     11       (23.5 )p     (18.1 )p     (7.0 )p
Loss per share – diluted     11       (23.5 )p     (18.1 )p     (7.0 )p

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated income statements.

 

All activities relate to continuing operations.

 

  F- 3  

 

 

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss

For the year ended 30 September

 

   

2016

£000s

    2015
£000s
    2014
£000s
 
Loss for the year     (63,657 )     (44,563 )     (14,659 )
Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss                        
Exchange differences on translation of foreign operations     349       (71 )     (2 )
Other comprehensive gain/(loss) for the year     349       (71 )     (2 )
Total comprehensive loss for the year     (63,308 )     (44,634 )     (14,661 )

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated statements of comprehensive loss.

 

  F- 4  

 

 

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity

For the year ended 30 September

 

Group   Share
Capital
£000s
    Share
Premium
Account
£000s
    Other
Reserves
£000s
    Accumulated
Deficit
£000s
    Total
Equity
£000s
 
At 1 October 2013     178       84,005       20,184       (68,965 )     35,402  
Issue of share capital     51       127,315                   127,366  
Expenses of new equity issue           (1,067 )                 (1,067 )
Exercise of share options     4       5,014                   5,018  
Exercise of warrants     4       5,284       (922 )     922       5,288  
Share-based payment transactions                       1,238       1,238  
Loss for the year                       (14,659 )     (14,659 )
Other comprehensive loss                 (2 )           (2 )
Balance at 30 September 2014     237       220,551       19,260       (81,464 )     158,584  
Issue of share capital     22       127,812                   127,834  
Expenses of new equity issue           (271 )                 (271 )
Exercise of share options     2       1,183                   1,185  
Share-based payment transactions                       2,488       2,488  
Loss for the year                       (44,563 )     (44,563 )
Deferred tax attributable to unrealised share option gains                       84       84  
Other comprehensive loss                 (71 )           (71 )
Balance at 30 September 2015     261       349,275       19,189       (123,455 )     245,270  
Issue of share capital (note 22)     39       206,512                   206,551  
Expenses of new equity issue           (472 )                 (472 )
Underwriters’ contribution towards expenses of new equity issue           472                   472  
Exercise of share options (note 22)     2       690                   692  
Share-based payment transactions                       8,152       8,152  
Loss for the year                       (63,657 )     (63,657 )
Deferred tax attributable to unrealised share option gains                       1,133       1,133  
Other comprehensive gain                 349             349  
Balance at 30 September 2016     302       556,477       19,538       (177,827 )     398,490  

 

  F- 5  

 

 

Consolidated Balance Sheets

As at 30 September

 

          Group  
    Notes     2016
£000s
    2015
£000s
 
Non-current assets                        
Intangible assets – goodwill     12       5,210       5,210  
Other intangible assets     13       629       245  
Property, plant and equipment     14       38,947       28,733  
Deferred tax asset     10       3,873       418  
              48,659       34,606  
Current assets                        
Inventories     15       4,248       4,756  
Taxation recoverable     10       21,322       12,641  
Trade receivables and other current assets     16       4,556       2,873  
Cash and cash equivalents     21       374,392       234,872  
              404,518       255,142  
Total assets             453,177       289,748  
Current liabilities                        
Trade and other payables     17       (31,170 )     (24,022 )
Current tax liabilities     10       (883 )     (366 )
Obligations under finance leases     19       (211 )     (111 )
Deferred revenue     20       (2,686 )     (3,269 )
              (34,950 )     (27,768 )
Non-current liabilities                        
Trade and other payables     17       (9,423 )     (8,445 )
Obligations under finance leases     19       (4,959 )     (1,540 )
Deferred revenue     20       (5,355 )     (6,725 )
Total liabilities             (54,687 )     (44,478 )
Net assets             398,490       245,270  
Equity                        
Share capital     22       302       261  
Share premium account             556,477       349,275  
Other reserves     24       19,538       19,189  
Accumulated (deficit)/profit             (177,827 )     (123,455 )
Total equity             398,490       245,270  

 

The financial statements of GW Pharmaceuticals plc, registered number 04160917, were authorised by the Board and approved for issue on 5 December 2016.

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated balance sheets.

 

  F- 6  

 

 

Consolidated Cash Flow Statements

For the year ended 30 September

 

    Group  
    2016
£000s
    2015
£000s
    2014
£000s
 
(Loss)/profit for the year     (63,657 )     (44,563 )     (14,659 )
Adjustments for:                        
Interest expense     173       75       61  
Other income     (608 )     (244 )     (130 )
Tax     (22,515 )     (12,498 )     (4,911 )
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment     3,605       2,250       1,398  
Impairment of property, plant and equipment           606        
Amortisation of intangible assets     62       52        
Net foreign exchange gains     (25,551 )     (6,282 )     (1,876 )
Increase/(decrease) in provision for inventories     72       33       (408 )
Decrease in deferred signature fees     (1,170 )     (1,250 )     (1,065 )
Share-based payment charge     8,152       2,478       1,238  
Loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment     1       1       2  
      (101,436 )     (59,342 )     (20,350 )
Decrease/(increase) in inventories     436       (12 )     292  
(Increase)/decrease in trade receivables and other current assets     (753 )     (1,010 )     (142 )
Increase/(decrease) in trade and other payables and deferred revenue     4,761       8,478       4,393  
Cash (used in) operations     (96,992 )     (51,886 )     (15,807 )
Income taxes paid     (883 )            
Research and development tax credits received     13,281       5,415       3,181  
Net cash (outflow) from operating activities     (84,594 )     (46,471 )     (12,626 )
Investing activities                        
Interest received     434       236       145  
Purchase of property, plant and equipment     (8,678 )     (17,915 )     (7,254 )
Purchase of intangible assets     (512 )     (114 )      
Proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment           2       14  
Net cash outflow from investing activities     (8,756 )     (17,791 )     (7,095 )
Financing activities                        
Proceeds on exercise of share options     540       1,185       5,018  
Proceeds of new equity issue     206,550       127,834       127,367  
Expenses of new equity issue     (319 )     (271 )     (1,067 )
Underwriters’ contribution towards expenses of new equity issue     472              
Proceeds of warrant exercise                 5,288  
Interest paid     (69 )     (74 )     (61 )
Proceeds from fit out funding                 7,822  
Repayments of fit out funding     (240 )            
Repayments of obligations under finance leases     (127 )     (255 )     (100 )
Net cash inflow from financing activities     206,807       128,419       144,267  
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes     26,063       6,224       1,876  
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents     139,520       70,381       126,422  
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the year     234,872       164,491       38,069  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of the year     374,392       234,872       164,491  

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated cash flow statements.

 

  F- 7  

 

 

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

1. General Information

GW Pharmaceuticals plc (the “Company”) and its subsidiaries (the “Group”) are primarily involved in the development of cannabinoid prescription medicines using botanical extracts derived from the Cannabis plant. The Group are developing a portfolio of cannabinoid medicines, of which the lead product is Epidiolex ® , an oral medicine for the treatment of refractory childhood epilepsies.

 

The Company is a public limited company, which has had American Depository Receipts (“ADRs”) registered with the US Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) and is listed on NASDAQ since 1 May 2013. Until 5 December 2016, the Company was also listed on the Alternative Investment Market (“AIM”), which is a sub-market of the London Stock Exchange. The Company is incorporated and domiciled in the United Kingdom. The address of the Company’s registered office and principal place of business is Sovereign House, Vision Park, Histon, Cambridgeshire.

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies

The principal Group accounting policies are summarised below.

 

Basis of Accounting

The financial statements have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as endorsed by the European Union and as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IASB”). The Group financial statements also comply with Article 4 of the European Union IAS regulation.

 

The financial statements have been prepared under the historical cost convention, except for the revaluation of financial instruments. Historical cost is generally based on the fair value of the consideration given in exchange for the assets and received for the liabilities. The principal accounting policies are set out below.

 

Going Concern

At 30 September 2016 the Group had cash and cash equivalents of £374.4 million (2015: £234.9 million). The Directors have considered the financial position of the Group, its cash position and forecast cash flows for the 12-month period from the date of this report when considering going concern. They have also considered the Group's key risks and uncertainties affecting the likely development of the business. In the light of this review, the Directors have a reasonable expectation that the Company and the Group have adequate resources to continue in operational existence for at least a 12-month period from the date of this report. Accordingly, they continue to adopt the going concern basis in preparing these financial statements.

 

Basis of Consolidation

The consolidated financial statements incorporate the financial statements of the Company and entities controlled by the Company (its subsidiaries) made up to 30 September each year. Subsidiaries are all entities over which the Group has the power to govern the financial and operating policies of the entity concerned, generally accompanying a shareholding of more than one half of the voting rights.

 

The results of subsidiaries acquired or disposed of during the year are included in the consolidated income statement from the effective date of acquisition or up to the effective date of disposal, as appropriate. Where necessary, adjustments are made to the financial statements of subsidiaries to bring the accounting policies used into line with those used by the Group. All intra-Group transactions, balances, income and expenses are eliminated on consolidation. Acquisitions are accounted for under the acquisition method.

 

In future business combinations, if a non-controlling interest in a subsidiary arises, such non-controlling interest will be identified separately from the Group’s equity therein. The interests of non-controlling shareholders that are present ownership interests entitling their holders to a proportionate share of net assets upon liquidation may initially be measured at fair value or at the non-controlling interests’ proportionate share of the fair value of the acquiree’s identifiable net assets. The choice of measurement is made on an acquisition-by-acquisition basis. Other non-controlling interests are initially measured at fair value. Subsequent to acquisition, the carrying amount of non-controlling interests is the amount of those interests at initial recognition plus the non-controlling interests’ share of subsequent changes in equity. Total comprehensive income is attributed to non-controlling interests even if this results in the non-controlling interests having a deficit balance.

 

Changes in the Group’s interests in subsidiaries that do not result in a loss of control are accounted for as equity transactions. The carrying amount of the Group’s interests and the non-controlling interests are adjusted to reflect the changes in their relative interests in the subsidiaries. Any difference between the amount by which the non-controlling interests are adjusted and the fair value of the consideration paid or received is recognised directly in equity and attributed to the owners of the Company.

 

When the Group loses control of a subsidiary, the profit or loss on disposal is calculated as the difference between (i) the aggregate of the fair value of the consideration received and the fair value of any retained interest and (ii) the previous carrying amount of the assets (including goodwill), less liabilities of the subsidiary and any non-controlling interests. Amounts previously recognised in other comprehensive income in relation to the subsidiary are accounted for (i.e. reclassified to profit or loss or transferred directly to accumulated deficit) in the same manner as would be required if the relevant assets or liabilities are disposed of. The fair value of any investment retained in the former subsidiary at the date when control is lost is regarded as the fair value on initial recognition for subsequent accounting under IAS 39 Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement or, when applicable, the costs on initial recognition of an investment in an associate or jointly controlled entity.

 

No income statement is presented for GW Pharmaceuticals plc as permitted by Section 408 of the Companies Act 2006. The Company’s profit for the financial year was £30,480,000 (2015: £8,046,000; 2014: £4,267,000).

 

  F- 8  

 

 

Intangible Assets – Goodwill

Goodwill arising in a business combination is recognised as an asset at the date that control is acquired. Goodwill is measured as the excess of the sum of consideration transferred, the amount of any non-controlling interest in the acquiree and the fair value of the acquirer’s previously held equity interest (if any) in the entity over the net of the acquisition date amounts of the identifiable assets and liabilities assumed.

 

Goodwill is not amortised but is tested for impairment at least annually. For the purpose of impairment testing, goodwill is allocated to each of the Group’s cash-generating units expected to benefit from the synergies of the combination. Cash-generating units to which goodwill has been allocated are tested for impairment annually, or more frequently when there is an indication that the unit may be impaired. If the recoverable amount of the cash-generating unit is less than the carrying amount of the unit, the impairment loss is allocated first to reduce the carrying amount of any goodwill allocated to the unit and then to the other assets of the unit pro rata on the basis of the carrying amount of each asset in the unit. An impairment loss recognised for goodwill is not reversed in a subsequent period.

 

On disposal of a subsidiary, the attributable amount of goodwill is included in the determination of the profit or loss on disposal.

 

Intangible Assets – Other

Other intangible assets are stated at cost less provisions for amortisation and impairments. Licences, patents, know-how, software and marketing rights separately acquired or acquired as part of a business combination are amortised over their estimated useful lives using the straight-line basis from the time they are available for use. The estimated useful lives for determining the amortisation take into account patent lives and related product application, but do not exceed their lifetime. Asset lives are reviewed annually and adjusted where necessary. Contingent milestone payments are recognised at the point that the contingent event becomes certain. Any subsequent development costs incurred by the Group and associated with acquired licences, patents, know-how or marketing rights are written off to the income statement when incurred, unless the criteria for recognition of an internally generated intangible asset are met, usually when a regulatory filing has been made in a major market and approval is considered highly probable.

 

Revenue

Revenue is measured at the fair value of the consideration received or receivable and represents amounts receivable for goods and services provided in the normal course of business net of value added tax and other sales-related taxes. The Group recognises revenue when the amount can be reliably measured; when it is probable that future economic benefits will flow to the Group; and when specific criteria have been met for each of the Group’s activities, as described below.

 

The Group’s revenue arises from product sales, licensing fees, collaboration fees, technical access fees, development and approval milestone fees, research and development fees and royalties. Agreements with commercial partners generally include non-refundable up-front licence and collaboration fees, milestone payments, the receipt of which is dependent upon the achievement of certain clinical, regulatory or commercial milestones, as well as royalties on product sales of licenced products, if and when such product sales occur, and revenue from the supply of products. For these agreements, total arrangement consideration is attributed to separately identifiable components on a reliable basis that reasonably reflects the selling prices that might be expected to be achieved in stand-alone transactions. The then allocated consideration is recognised as revenue in accordance with the principles described below.

 

The percentage of completion method is used for a number of revenue streams of the Group. For each of the three years ended 30 September 2016, there were no discrete events or adjustments which caused the Group to revise its previous estimates of completion associated with those revenue arrangements accounted for under the percentage of completion method.

 

Product Sales

Revenue from the sale of products is recognised when the Group has transferred to the buyer the significant risks and rewards of ownership of the goods, the Group no longer has effective control over the goods sold, the amount of revenue and costs associated with the transaction can be measured reliably, and it is probable that the Group will receive future economic benefits associated with the transaction. Product sales have no rights of return other than where products are damaged or defective.

 

The Group maintains a rebate provision for expected reimbursements to our commercial partners in circumstances in which actual net revenue per vial differs from expected net revenue per vial as a consequence of, as an example, ongoing pricing negotiations with local health authorities. The amount of our rebate provision is based on, amongst other things, monthly unit sales and in-market sales data received from commercial partners and represents management’s best estimate of the rebate expected to be required to settle the present obligation at the end of the reporting period. Provisions for rebates are established in the same period that the related sales are recorded.

 

Licensing Fees

Licensing fees received in connection with product out-licensing agreements, even where such fees are non-refundable, are deferred and recognised over the period of the licence term.

 

Collaboration Fees

Collaboration fees are deferred and recognised as services rendered based on the percentage of completion method.

 

  F- 9  

 

 

Technical Access Fees

Technical access fees represent amounts charged to licensing partners to provide access to, and to commercially exploit, data that the Group possesses or which can be expected to result from Group research programmes that are in progress. Non-refundable technical access fees that involve the delivery of data that the Group possesses and that permit the licensing partner to use the data freely and where the Group has no remaining obligations to perform are recognised as revenue upon delivery of the data. Non-refundable technical access fees relating to data where the research programme is ongoing are recognised based on the percentage of completion method.

 

Development and Approval Milestone Fees

Development and approval milestone fees are recognised as revenue based on the percentage of completion method on the assumption that all stages will be completed successfully, but with cumulative revenue recognised limited to non-refundable amounts already received or reasonably certain to be received.

 

Research and Development Fees

Revenue from partner-funded contract research and development agreements is recognised as research and development services are rendered. Where services are in-progress at period end, the Group recognises revenues proportionately, in line with the percentage of completion of the service. Where such in-progress services include the conduct of clinical trials, the Group recognises revenue in line with the stage of completion of each trial so that revenues are recognised in line with the expenditures.

 

Royalties

Royalty revenue is recognised on an accrual basis in accordance with the substance of the relevant agreement, provided that it is probable that the economic benefits will flow to the Group and the amount of revenue can be measured reliably.

 

Research and Development

Expenditure on research and development activities is recognised as an expense in the period in which it is incurred prior to achieving regulatory approval.

 

An internally generated intangible asset arising from the Group’s development activities is recognised only if the following conditions can be demonstrated:

 

· the technical feasibility of completing the intangible asset so that it will be available for use or sale;
· the intention to complete the intangible asset and use or sell it;
· the ability to use or sell the intangible asset;
· how the intangible asset will generate probable future economic benefits;
· the availability of adequate technical, financial and other resources to complete the development and to use or sell the intangible asset; and
· the ability to measure reliably the expenditure attributable to the intangible asset during its development.

 

The Group has determined that regulatory approval is the earliest point at which the probable threshold can be achieved. All research and development expenditure incurred prior to achieving regulatory approval is therefore expensed as incurred.

 

Government Grants

Government grants are not recognised until there is reasonable assurance that the Group will comply with the conditions attaching to them and that the grants will be received. Government grants for research programmes are recognised as revenue over the periods necessary to match them with the related costs incurred, and in the consolidated income statement are deducted from the related costs. Government grants related to property, plant and equipment are treated as deferred income and released to the consolidated income statement over the expected useful lives of the assets concerned.

 

Borrowing Costs

Borrowing costs directly attributable to the acquisition, construction or production of qualifying assets, which are assets that necessarily take a substantial period of time to get ready for their intended use or sale, are added to the cost of those assets, until such time as the assets are substantially ready for their intended use or sale. All other borrowing costs are recognised in the income statement using the effective interest method.

 

Property, Plant and Equipment

Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost, net of accumulated depreciation and any recognised impairment loss. Depreciation is provided so as to write off the cost of assets, less their estimated residual values, over their useful lives using the straight-line method, as follows:

 

Leasehold buildings 20 years or term of lease if shorter
Plant, machinery and lab equipment 3 to 10 years
Office and IT equipment 3 to 5 years
Leasehold improvements 4 to 15 years or term of the lease if shorter

 

Assets under finance leases are depreciated over their expected useful lives on the same basis as owned assets or, where shorter, over the term of the relevant lease.

 

No depreciation is provided on assets under the course of construction. Cost includes professional fees and, for qualifying assets, borrowing costs capitalised in accordance with the Group’s accounting policy. Depreciation on these assets commences when the assets are available for use.

 

The gain or loss arising on disposal or scrappage of an asset is determined as the difference between the sales proceeds and the carrying amount of the asset and is recognised in operating profit.

 

  F- 10  

 

 

Inventories

Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Cost is calculated using the weighted average cost method. Cost includes materials, direct labour, depreciation of manufacturing assets and an attributable proportion of manufacturing overheads based on normal levels of activity. Net realisable value is the estimated selling price, less all estimated costs of completion and costs to be incurred in marketing, selling and distribution.

 

If net realisable value is lower than the carrying amount, a write down provision is recognised for the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds its net realisable value.

 

Inventories manufactured prior to regulatory approval are capitalised as an asset but provided for until there is a high probability of regulatory approval of the product. At the point when a high probability of regulatory approval is obtained, the provision is adjusted appropriately to increase the carrying value to expected net realisable value, which may not exceed original cost.

 

Adjustments to the provision for inventories manufactured prior to regulatory approval are recorded as a component of research and development expenditure. Adjustments to the provision against commercial product related inventories manufactured following achievement of regulatory approval are recorded as a component of cost of goods.

 

Taxation

The tax expense represents the sum of the tax currently payable or recoverable and deferred tax. Current and deferred taxes are recognised in profit or loss, except when they relate to items that are recognised in other comprehensive income or directly in equity, in which case, the current and deferred tax are also recognised in other comprehensive income or directly in equity, respectively. Where current or deferred tax arises from the initial accounting for a business combination, the tax effect is included in the accounting for the business combination.

 

The tax payable or recoverable is based on taxable profit for the year. Taxable profit differs from profit before tax as reported in the consolidated income statement because it excludes items of income or expense that are taxable or deductible in other years and it further excludes items that are never taxable or deductible. The Group’s liability for current tax is calculated using tax rates and laws that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the balance sheet date.

 

Deferred tax is the tax expected to be payable or recoverable on differences between carrying amounts of assets and liabilities in the financial statements and the corresponding tax bases used in the computation of taxable profit, and is accounted for using the balance sheet liability method. Deferred tax liabilities are generally recognised for all taxable temporary differences and deferred tax assets are recognised only to the extent that it is probable that taxable profits will be available against which deductible temporary differences can be utilised. Such assets and liabilities are not recognised if the temporary difference arises from the initial recognition of goodwill or from the initial recognition (other than in a business combination) of assets and liabilities in a transaction that affects neither the taxable profit nor the accounting profit.

 

Deferred tax liabilities are recognised for taxable temporary differences arising on investments in subsidiaries and associates, and interests in joint ventures, except where the Group is able to control the reversal of the temporary difference and it is probable that the temporary difference will not reverse in the foreseeable future.

 

The carrying amount of deferred tax assets is reviewed at each balance sheet date and reduced to the extent that it is no longer probable that sufficient future taxable profits will be available to allow all or part of the asset to be recovered.

 

Deferred tax is calculated at the tax rates that are expected to apply in the period when the liability is settled or the asset is realised based on tax laws and rates that have been enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date. Deferred tax is charged or credited in the consolidated income statement, except when it relates to items charged or credited in other comprehensive income, in which case the deferred tax is also dealt with in other comprehensive income.

 

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to set off current tax assets against current tax liabilities and when they relate to income taxes levied by the same taxation authority and the Group intends to settle its current tax assets and liabilities on a net basis.

 

(Loss)/Earnings per Share

Basic earnings or loss per share represents the profit or loss for the year, divided by the weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue during the year, excluding the weighted average number of ordinary shares held in the GW Pharmaceuticals All Employee Share Scheme (the “ESOP”) during the year to satisfy employee share awards.

 

Diluted earnings or loss per share represents the profit or loss for the year, divided by the weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue during the year, excluding the weighted average number of shares held in the ESOP during the year to satisfy employee share awards, plus the weighted average number of dilutive shares resulting from share options or warrants where the inclusion of these would not be anti-dilutive.

 

  F- 11  

 

 

Retirement Benefit Costs

The Group does not operate any pension plans, but makes contributions to personal pension arrangements of its Executive Directors and employees. The amounts charged to the consolidated income statement in respect of pension costs are the contributions payable in the year. Differences between contributions payable in the year and contributions paid are shown as either accruals or prepayments in the consolidated balance sheet.

 

Foreign Currency

The individual financial statements of each Group company are presented in the currency of the primary economic environment in which it operates (its functional currency). For the purpose of the consolidated financial statements, the results and financial position of each Group company are expressed in Pounds Sterling.

 

In preparing the financial statements of the individual companies, transactions in currencies other than the entity’s functional currency (foreign currencies) are recorded at the rate of exchange at the date of the transaction. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies at the balance sheet date are retranslated at the rates of exchange prevailing at that date. Non-monetary items carried at fair value that are denominated in foreign currencies are translated at the rates prevailing at the date when the fair value was determined. Non-monetary items that are measured in terms of historical cost in a foreign currency are not retranslated.

 

For the purpose of presenting consolidated financial statements, the assets and liabilities of the Group’s foreign operations are translated at exchange rates prevailing on the balance sheet date. Income and expense items are translated at the average exchange rate for the period, unless exchange rates fluctuate significantly during the period, in which case the exchange rates at the date of transactions are used. Exchange differences arising, if any, are recognised in other comprehensive income and accumulated in equity.

 

Share-based payments

The Group operates a number of equity-settled share-based compensation plans under which the Company receives services from employees as consideration for equity instruments (options) of the Company. The fair value of the employee services received in exchange for the grant of the awards is recognised as an expense. The total amount to be expensed is determined by reference to the fair value of the options granted (excluding the effect of any non-market-based performance and service vesting conditions) at the date of grant.

 

The fair value determined at the grant date of the equity-settled share-based payments is expensed on a straight-line basis over the vesting period, based on the Group’s estimate of shares that will eventually vest. At each balance sheet date, the Group revises its estimate of the number of equity instruments expected to vest as a result of the effect of non-market-based performance and service vesting conditions. The impact of the revision of the original estimates, if any, is recognised in profit or loss such that the cumulative expense reflects the revised estimate, with a corresponding adjustment to equity reserves.

 

Equity-settled share-based payment transactions with parties other than employees are measured at the fair value of the goods or services received, except where that fair value cannot be estimated reliably, in which case they are measured at the fair value of the equity instruments granted, measured at the date of grant.

 

Leases

Leases are classified as finance leases whenever the terms of the lease transfer substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership to the lessee. All other leases are classified as operating leases.

 

Rentals under operating leases are charged on a straight-line basis over the term of the relevant lease except where another more systematic basis is more representative of the time pattern in which economic benefits from the lease are consumed. Contingent rentals arising under operating leases are recognised as an expense in the period in which they are incurred.

 

In the event that lease incentives are received to enter into operating leases, such incentives are recognised as a liability. The aggregate benefit of incentives is recognised as a reduction of rental expense on a straight-line basis, except where another systematic basis is more representative of the time pattern in which economic benefits from the leased asset are consumed.

 

Assets held under finance leases are recognised as assets of the Group at their fair value or, if lower, the present value of the minimum lease payments, each determined at the inception of the lease. The corresponding liability to the lessor is included in the balance sheet as a finance lease obligation. Lease payments are apportioned between finance charges and reduction of the finance lease obligation so as to achieve a constant rate of interest on the remaining balance of the liability. Finance expenses are recognised immediately in profit or loss, unless they are directly attributable to qualifying assets, in which case they are capitalised in accordance with the Group’s general policy on borrowing costs. Contingent rentals are recognised as an expense in the periods in which they are incurred.

 

Financial Instruments

Financial assets and liabilities are recognised in the Group’s balance sheet when the Group becomes party to the contractual provisions of the instrument.

 

All financial assets are recognised and derecognised on a trade date where the purchase or sale of a financial asset is under a contract whose terms require delivery of the financial asset within the timeframe established by the market concerned, and are initially measured at fair value, plus transaction costs, except for those financial assets classified as at fair value through profit or loss, which are initially measured at fair value.

 

Financial assets are classified into the following specified categories: financial assets “at fair value through profit or loss”, “held-to-maturity” investments, “available-for-sale” financial assets and “loans and receivables”. The classification depends on the nature and purpose of the financial assets and is determined at the time of initial recognition.

 

For each reporting period covered herein, the Group’s financial assets were restricted to “loans and receivables”.

 

  F- 12  

 

  

Loans and Receivables

Trade receivables that have fixed or determinable payments that are not quoted in an active market are classified as “loans and receivables”. Loans and receivables are measured at amortised cost, less any impairment. Interest income is recognised by applying the effective interest rate, except for short-term receivables when the recognition of interest would be immaterial.

 

Trade receivables are assessed for indicators of impairment at each balance sheet date. Trade receivables are impaired where there is objective evidence that, as a result of one or more events that occurred after initial recognition, the estimated future cash flows of the receivables have been affected. Appropriate allowances for estimated irrecoverable amounts are recognised in the consolidated income statement. The allowance recognised is measured as the difference between the asset’s carrying amount and the present value of estimated future cash flows discounted at the effective interest rate computed at initial recognition.

 

Cash and Cash Equivalents

Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash in hand and on-call deposits held with banks and other short-term highly liquid investments with a maturity of three months or less.

 

Financial Liabilities

Financial liabilities are classified as either financial liabilities “at fair value through profit and loss” or “other financial liabilities”. For each reporting period covered herein, the Group’s financial liabilities were restricted to “other financial liabilities”.

 

Other Financial Liabilities

Trade payables are initially recognised at fair value and then held at amortised cost which equates to nominal value. Long-term payables are discounted where the effect is material.

 

All borrowings are initially recorded at the amount of proceeds received, net of transaction costs. Borrowings are subsequently carried at amortised cost, using the effective interest method. The difference between the proceeds, net of transaction costs, and the amount due on redemption is recognised as a charge to the income statement over the period of the relevant borrowing.

 

The effective interest method is a method of calculating the amortised cost of a financial liability and of allocating interest expense over the relevant period. The effective interest rate is the rate that exactly discounts estimated future cash payments through the expected life of the financial liability or, where appropriate, a shorter period, to the net carrying amount on initial recognition.

 

Critical Judgements in Applying the Group’s Accounting Policies

In the application of the Group’s accounting policies, which are described above, the Board of Directors are required to make judgements, estimates and assumptions about the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. The estimates and associated assumptions are based on historical experience and other factors that are considered to be relevant. Actual results may differ from these estimates.

 

The estimates and assumptions are reviewed on an ongoing basis. Revisions to accounting estimates are recognised in the period in which the estimate is revised if the revision affects only that period, or in the period of the revisions and future periods if the revision affects both current and future periods.

 

The following are the critical judgements, apart from those involving estimations (which are dealt with separately below), that the Directors have made in the process of applying the Group’s accounting policies and that have the most significant effect on the amounts recognised in the financial statements.

 

Recognition of Clinical Trials Expenditure

The Group recognises expenditure incurred in carrying out clinical trials during the course of conduct of each clinical trial in line with the state of completion of each trial. This involves the calculation of clinical trial accruals at each period end to account for expenditure which has been incurred. This requires estimation of the expected full cost to complete the trial and also estimation of the current stage of trial completion.

 

Clinical trials usually take place over extended time periods and typically involve a set-up phase, a recruitment phase and a completion phase which ends upon the receipt of a final report containing full statistical analysis of trial results. Accruals are prepared separately for each in-process clinical trial and take into consideration the stage of completion of each trial including the number of patients that have entered the trial, the number of patients that have completed treatment and whether the final report has been received. In all cases, the full cost of each trial is expensed by the time the final report has been received.

 

Revenue Recognition

The Group recognises revenue from product sales, licensing fees, collaboration fees, technical access fees, development and approval milestone fees, research and development fees and royalties. Agreements with commercial partners generally include a non-refundable up-front fee, milestone payments, the receipt of which is dependent upon the achievement of certain clinical, regulatory or commercial milestones, as well as royalties on product sales of licenced products, if and when such product sales occur. For these agreements, the Group is required to apply judgement in the allocation of total agreement consideration to the separately identifiable components on a reliable basis that reasonably reflects the selling prices that might be expected to be achieved in stand-alone transactions.

 

  F- 13  

 

 

Product revenue received is based on a contractually agreed percentage of our commercial partner’s in-market net sales revenue. The commercial partner’s in-market net sales revenue is the price per vial charged to end customers, less set defined deductible overheads incurred in distributing the product. In developing estimates, the Group uses monthly unit sales and in-market sales data received from commercial partners during the course of the year. For certain markets, where negotiations are ongoing with local reimbursement authorities, an estimated in-market sales price is used, which requires the application of judgement in assessing whether an estimated in-market sales price is reliably measurable. In the Group’s assessment, the Group considers, inter alia, identical products sold in similar markets and whether the agreed prices for those identical products support the estimated in-market sales price. In the event that the Group considers there to be significant uncertainty with regard to the in-market sales price to be charged by the commercial partner as a result of, as an example, ongoing pricing negotiations with local health authorities, such that it is not possible to reliably measure the amount of revenue that will flow to the Group, the Group would not recognise revenue until that uncertainty has been resolved.

 

The Group applies the percentage of completion revenue recognition method to certain classes of revenue. The application of this approach requires the judgement of the Group with regard to the total costs incurred and total estimated costs expected to be incurred over the length of the agreement.

 

Key Sources of Estimation Uncertainty

The key assumptions concerning the future, and other key sources of estimation uncertainty at the balance sheet date, that have a significant risk of causing a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within the next financial year, are discussed below.

 

Deferred Taxation

At the balance sheet date, the Group has accumulated tax losses of £102.8 million (2015: £74.0 million) and other temporary differences of £33.9 million (2015: £20.7 million) available to offset against future profits. If the value of these losses and other temporary differences were recognised within the Group’s balance sheet at the balance sheet date, the Group would be carrying an additional deferred tax asset of £23.2 million (2015: £18.9 million). However, as explained in the tax accounting policy note, the Group’s policy is to recognise deferred tax assets only to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profits, feasible tax-planning strategies, and deferred tax liabilities will be available against which the brought-forward trading losses can be utilised. Estimation of the level of future taxable profits is therefore required in order to determine the appropriate carrying value of the deferred tax asset at each balance sheet date. As such, a deferred tax asset of £3.9 million has been recognised at 30 September 2016 (2015: £0.4 million) in respect of temporary timings differences relating to the Group’s US subsidiary that are expected to be fully recoverable.

 

Research and Development and Orphan Tax Credits

The Group’s research and development tax credit claim is complex and requires management to interpret and apply UK and US research and development and orphan credit tax legislation to the Group’s specific circumstances and requires the use of certain assumptions in estimating the portion of current year research costs that are eligible for the claim.

 

Adoption of New and Revised Standards

In the current year the following revised standards have been adopted in these financial statements. Adoption has not had a significant impact on the amounts reported in these financial statements but may impact the accounting for future transactions.

 

Amendments to IAS 19: Defined Benefit Plans: Employee Contributions (Nov 2013)

Annual Improvements to IFRSs 2011–2013 Cycle (Dec 2013)

Annual Improvements to IFRSs 2010–2012 Cycle (Dec 2013)

 

At the date of authorisation of these financial statements, the following Standards and Interpretations which have not been applied in these financial statements were issued by the IASB but not yet effective:

 

IFRS 9 Financial Instruments (Jul 2014)

IFRS 14 Regulatory Deferral Accounts (Jan 2014)

IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with Customers (May 2014)

IFRS 16 Leases (January 2016)

Annual Improvements to IFRSs 2012–2014 Cycle (Sep 2014)

Amendments to IFRS 2: Classification and Measurement of Share-Based Payment Transactions (June 2016)

Amendments to IFRS 4: Applying IFRS 9 Financial Instruments with IFRS 4 Insurance Contracts (September 2016)

Amendments to IFRS 10, IFRS 12 and IAS 28: Investment Entities – Applying the Consolidation Exception (Dec 2014)

Amendments to IFRS 10 and IAS 28: Sale or Contribution of Assets between an Investor and its Associate or Joint Venture (Sep 2014)

Amendments to IFRS 11: Accounting for Acquisitions of Interests in Joint Operations (May 2014)

Clarifications to IFRS 15: Revenue from Contracts with Customers (April 2016)

Amendments to IAS 1: Disclosure Initiative (Dec 2014)

Amendments to IAS 7: Disclosure Initiative (January 2016)

Amendments to IAS 12: Recognition of Deferred Tax Assets for Unrealised Losses (January 2016)

Amendments to IAS 16 and IAS 38: Clarification of Acceptable Methods of Depreciation and Amortisation (May 2014)

Amendments to IAS 16 and IAS 41: Bearer Plants (Jun 2014)

Amendments to IAS 27: Equity Method in Separate Financial Statements (Aug 2014)

 

IFRS 15: establishes comprehensive guidelines for determining when to recognise revenue and how much revenue to recognise. The core principle in that framework is that a company should recognise revenue to depict the transfer of promised goods or services to the customer in an amount that reflects the consideration to which the company expects to be entitled in exchange for those goods or services. The standard is effective for reporting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2018. The Group continues to assess the impact of IFRS 15 on the results of the Group, and expects to finalise this assessment following final endorsement by the EU, which occurred on 31 October 2016. The impact is expected to be limited to historic revenue-generative partner agreements.

 

  F- 14  

 

 

IFRS 16: Leases will replace IAS 17 for accounting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2019. In so doing it will eliminate the distinction between classification of leases as finance or operating leases. The adoption of IFRS 16 is not expected to have a significant impact on the Group’s net results or net assets, although the full impact will be subject to further assessment following the conclusion of the ongoing consultations.

 

The Directors do not expect that the adoption of the remaining Standards and Interpretations in future periods will have a material impact on the financial statements of the Group.

 

3. Segmental Information

Information reported to the Company’s Board of Directors, the chief operating decision maker for the Group, for the purposes of resource allocation and assessment of segment performance is focused on the stage of product development. The Group’s reportable segments are as follows:

 

· Commercial: The Commercial segment distributes and sells the Group’s commercial products. Currently Sativex is promoted through strategic collaborations with major pharmaceutical companies for the currently approved indication of spasticity due to multiple sclerosis (“MS”). The Commercial segment will include revenues from the direct marketing of other future approved commercial products. The Group has licensing agreements for the commercialisation of Sativex ® with Almirall S.A. in Europe (excluding the United Kingdom) and Mexico, Otsuka Pharmaceutical Co. Ltd. (“Otsuka”) in the US, Novartis Pharma AG in Australia, New Zealand, Asia (excluding Japan, China and Hong Kong), the Middle East and Africa, Bayer HealthCare AG in the United Kingdom and Canada, Neopharm Group in Israel and Ipsen Biopharm Ltd. in Latin America (excluding Mexico and the Islands of the Caribbean). Commercial segment revenues include product sales, royalties, licence, collaboration and technical access fees, and development and approval milestone fees.
· Sativex ® Research and Development: The Sativex Research and Development ("Sativex R&D") segment seeks to maximise the potential of Sativex through the development of new indications. Sativex has shown promising efficacy in Phase 2 trials in other indications such as neuropathic pain, but these areas are not currently the subject of full development programmes. Sativex Research and Development segment revenues consist of research and development fees charged to Sativex licensees.
· Pipeline Research and Development: The Pipeline Research and Development (“Pipeline R&D”) segment seeks to develop cannabinoid medications other than Sativex across a range of therapeutic areas using our proprietary cannabinoid technology platform. The Group’s product pipeline includes Epidiolex®, in development as a treatment for Dravet syndrome, Lennox-Gastaut syndrome, Tuberous Sclerosis and Infantile Spasm, as well as other product candidates in Phase 1 and 2 clinical development for glioma, adult epilepsy and schizophrenia. Pipeline R&D segment revenues consist of research and development fees charged to Otsuka under the terms of our pipeline research collaboration agreement.

 

The accounting policies of the reportable segments are consistent with the Group’s accounting policies described in note 2. Segment result represents the result of each segment without allocation of share-based payment expenses, and before sales, general and administrative expenses, interest expense, interest income and tax. No measures of segment assets and segment liabilities are reported to the Group’s Board of Directors in order to assess performance and allocate resources. There is no intersegment activity and all revenue is generated from external customers.

 

  F- 15  

 

 

Segment Results

For the Year Ended 30 September 2016

    Commercial
£000s
    Sativex R&D
£000s
    Pipeline R&D
£000s
    Total
Reportable
Segments
£000s
   

Unallocated

Costs 1

£000s

   

Consolidated

£000s

 
Revenue:                                                
Product sales     5,208                   5,208             5,208  
Research and development fees           3,500       337       3,837             3,837  
Licence, collaboration and technical access fees     1,172                   1,172             1,172  
Development and approval milestones     98                   98             98  
Total revenue     6,478       3,500       337       10,315             10,315  
Cost of sales     (2,719 )                 (2,719 )           (2,719 )
Research and development expenditure           (4,125 )     (91,571 )     (95,696 )     (4,119 )     (99,815 )
Segmental result     3,759       (625 )     (91,234 )     (88,100 )     (4,119 )     (92,219 )
Sales, general and administrative expenses                                             (19,939 )
Net foreign exchange gain                                             25,551  
Operating loss                                             (86,607 )
Interest expense                                             (173 )
Other income                                             608  
Loss before tax                                             (86,172 )
Tax benefit                                             22,515  
Loss for the year                                             (63,657 )

 

1 Unallocated costs represent the portion of share-based payment expenditures which is included in research and development expenditure, but which is not allocated to segments. The remaining share-based payment expenditure is included within sales, general and administrative expenses, which is similarly excluded from segmental result.

 

  F- 16  

 

 

Segment Results

For the Year Ended 30 September 2015

    Commercial
£000s
    Sativex R&D
£000s
    Pipeline R&D
£000s
    Total
Reportable
Segments
£000s
   

Unallocated

Costs 1

£000s

   

Consolidated

£000s

 
Revenue:                                                
Product sales     4,255                   4,255             4,255  
Research and development fees           22,275       535       22,810             22,810  
Licence, collaboration and technical access fees     1,287                   1,287             1,287  
Development and approval milestones     188                   188             188  
Total revenue     5,730       22,275       535       28,540             28,540  
Cost of sales     (2,618 )                 (2,618 )           (2,618 )
Research and development expenditure           (26,398 )     (48,862 )     (75,260 )     (1,525 )     (76,785 )
Segmental result     3,112       (4,123 )     (48,327 )     (49,338 )     (1,525 )     (50,863 )
Sales, general and administrative expenses                                             (12,569 )
Net foreign exchange gain                                             6,202  
Operating loss                                             (57,230 )
Interest expense                                             (75 )
Other income                                             244  
Loss before tax                                             (57,061 )
Tax benefit                                             12,498  
Loss for the year                                             (44,563 )

 

1 Unallocated costs represent the portion of share-based payment expenditures which is included in research and development expenditure, but which is not allocated to segments. The remaining share-based payment expenditure is included within sales, general and administrative expenses, which is similarly excluded from segmental result.

 

  F- 17  

 

 

Segment Results

For the Year Ended 30 September 2014

   

Commercial 1

£000s

    Sativex R&D
£000s
    Pipeline R&D
£000s
    Total
Reportable
Segments
£000s
   

Unallocated

Costs 2

£000s

    Consolidated
£000s
 
Revenue:                                                
Product sales     4,382                   4,382             4,382  
Research and development fees           23,618       667       24,285             24,285  
Licence, collaboration and technical access fees     1,378                   1,378             1,378  
Total revenue     5,760       23,618       667       30,045             30,045  
Cost of sales     (2,060 )                 (2,060 )           (2,060 )
Research and development credit/(expenditure)     847       (26,444 )     (17,103 )     (42,700 )     (775 )     (43,475 )
Segmental result     4,547       (2,826 )     (16,436 )     (14,715 )     (775 )     (15,490 )
Sales, general and administrative expenses                                             (7,337 )
Net foreign exchange gain                                             3,188  
Operating loss                                             (19,639 )
Interest expense                                             (61 )
Other income                                             130  
Loss before tax                                             (19,570 )
Tax benefit                                             4,911  
Loss for the year                                             (14,659 )

 

1 The research and development credit in the commercial segment is the element of the inventory provision movement that relates to commercial inventory.
2 Unallocated costs represent the portion of share-based payment expenditures which is included in research and development expenditure, but which is not allocated to segments. The remaining share-based payment expenditure is included within sales, general and administrative expenses, which is similarly excluded from segmental result.

 

Segment Results

Revenues from the Group’s largest customer are included within the above segments as follows:

    Commercial
£000s
    Sativex
R&D
£000s
    Pipeline
R&D
£000s
    Total
£000s
 
Year ended 30 September 2016     4,310                   4,310  
Year ended 30 September 2015     3,385                   3,385  
Year ended 30 September 2014     3,494                   3,494  

 

Revenues from the Group’s second largest customer, the only other customer where revenues account for more than 10% of the Group’s revenues, are included within the above segments as follows:

    Commercial
£000s
    Sativex
R&D
£000s
    Pipeline
R&D
£000s
    Total
£000s
 
Year ended 30 September 2016     280       3,500       337       4,117  
Year ended 30 September 2015     280       22,275       535       23,090  
Year ended 30 September 2014     280       23,618       667       24,565  

 

Geographical Analysis of Revenue by Destination of Customer:

   

2016

£000s

    2015
£000s
    2014
£000s
 
UK     1,082       1,158       1,099  
Europe (excluding UK)     4,435       3,592       3,864  
United States     3,780       22,555       23,904  
Canada     680       700       518  
Asia/Other     338       535       660  
      10,315       28,540       30,045  

 

  F- 18  

 

 

4. Research and Development Expenditure

   

2016

£000s

    2015
£000s
    2014
£000s
 
GW-funded research and development     95,978       53,975       19,190  
Development partner-funded research and development     3,837       22,810       24,285  
      99,815       76,785       43,475  

 

GW-funded research and development expenditure consists of costs associated with the Group’s research activities. These costs include costs of conducting pre-clinical studies or clinical trials, payroll costs associated with employing a team of research and development staff, share-based payment expenses, property costs associated with leasing laboratory and office space to accommodate research teams, costs of growing botanical raw material, costs of consumables used in the conduct of in-house research programmes, payments for research work conducted by sub-contractors by a network of academic collaborative research scientists, costs associated with safety studies and costs associated with the development of further Epidiolex, Sativex or other pipeline product data.

 

Development partner-funded research and development expenditures include the costs of employing staff to work on joint research and development plans, plus the costs of sub-contracted pre-clinical studies and sponsorships of academic scientists who collaborate with the Group. These expenditures are charged to the Group’s commercial partners, principally Otsuka. The Group is the primary obligor for these activities and under the terms of the Sativex development agreements, the Group uses both its internal resources and third-party contractors to provide contract research and development services to its commercial partners.

 

5. Loss Before Tax

Loss before tax is stated after charging/(crediting):

   

2016

£000s

    2015
£000s
    2014
£000s
 
Operating lease rentals – land and buildings     2,341       1,473       1,301  
Operating lease rentals – equipment     20              
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment     3,605       2,250       1,398  
Impairment of property, plant and equipment           606        
Amortisation of intangible assets     62       52        
Increase/(decrease) provision for inventories     72       33       (408 )
Foreign exchange gain     (25,551 )     (6,202 )     (3,188 )
Staff costs (see note 7)     40,463       23,083       17,725  

 

  F- 19  

 

  

6. Auditor’s Remuneration

 

    2016     2015     2014  
    £000s     £000s     £000s  
The auditor for the years ended 30 September 2016, 2015 and 2014 was Deloitte LLP                        
Audit fees:                  
– Audit of the Group’s annual accounts 1     400       400       243  
– Audit of the Company and subsidiaries pursuant to legislation     50       50       41  
Total audit fees     450       450       284  
Other services                        
– Audit-related assurance 2     75       53       46  
– Other assurance services 3     109       92       193  
Total non-audit fees     184       145       239  

 

1 For the years ended 30 September 2016, 2015 and 2014, audit fees include amounts for the audit of the consolidated financial statements in accordance with the International Standards of Auditing, and standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). For the years ended 30 September 2016, 2015 and 2014, audit fees also include amounts for the audit of the Group’s internal controls over financial reporting.
2 Audit-related assurance fees relate to fees for the performance of interim reviews, and other procedures on interim results.
3 Other assurance services represents assurance reporting on historical financial information included in the Company’s initial, shelf and follow-on US registration statements.

 

An additional £40,000 was billed in respect of the 2015 audit during the year ended 30 September 2016.

 

An additional £156,000 was billed in respect of the 2014 audit during the year ended 30 September 2015.

 

The Audit Committee’s policy is to pre-approve all audit, audit-related and other services performed by the auditor. All such services were pre-approved during the years ended 30 September 2016, 2015 and 2014 under the Audit Committee’s policy.

 

7. Staff Costs

 

The average number of Group employees (including Executive Directors) for the year ended 30 September was:

 

 

    2016     2015     2014  
    Number     Number     Number  
Research and development     391       288       202  
Management and administration     53       34       21  
      444       322       223  

  

  2016     2015     2014  
    £000s     £000s     £000s  
Group aggregate remuneration comprised:                        
Wages and salaries     25,823       17,092       11,470  
Social security costs     5,132       2,748       4,484  
Other pension costs   1,356     765     533  
Share-based payment     8,152       2,478       1,238  
      40,463       23,083       17,725  

 

Included in social security costs are local tax obligations on unrealised share option gains.

 

  F- 20  

 

 

8. Directors’ Remuneration

 

Directors’ remuneration and other benefits for the year ended 30 September were as follows:

 

    2016     2015     2014  
    £000s     £000s     £000s  
Emoluments     2,523       2,395       2,688  
Money purchase contributions to Directors’ pension arrangements   215     211     203  
Gain on exercise of share options     6,453       7,910       5,526  
      9,191       10,516       8,417  

 

During 2016, six Directors were members of defined contribution pension schemes (2015 and 2014: five).

  

9. Other income and expense

 

    2016     2015     2014  
    £000s     £000s     £000s  
Interest income – bank interest   435     244     130  
Other income     173              
Interest expense – finance lease interest     (173 )     (75 )     (61 )

 

Other income relates to an “Above the line” credit associated with the UK large company R&D tax scheme. This represents an amount that is expected to be claimable from UK tax authorities in relation to qualifying expenditure incurred in the year ended 30 September 2016.

 

10. Tax

 

a) Analysis of Tax Credit for the Year

 

    2016     2015     2014  
    £000s     £000s     £000s  
Current year research and development tax credit     (21,150 )     (12,641 )     (5,251 )
Current period tax (credit)/charge     1,175       366        
Adjustment in respect of prior year tax credit     (546 )     (165 )     (278 )
Deferred tax credit     (2,037 )     (335 )     (829 )
Movements on deferred tax assets   43     277     1,447  
Tax benefit     (22,515 )     (12,498 )     (4,911 )

 

Tax credits relate to UK research and development tax credits claimed under the Finance Act 2000. The current period tax charge relates to US taxation on the taxable profit for the Group’s US subsidiary.

 

The Group recognises in full the estimated benefit for qualifying current year UK research and development expenditures and resulting tax credits. Any difference in the credit ultimately received is recorded as an adjustment in respect of prior year.

 

The Group recognises the likely recoverable estimated benefit for qualifying current year US research and development expenditures and resulting tax credits. Any difference in the credit ultimately received is recorded as an adjustment in respect of prior year.

 

At 30 September 2016 the Group had tax losses available for carry forward of approximately £102.8 million (2015: £74.0 million). Of such carried-forward losses, the Group has recognised a deferred tax asset of £1.8 million (2015: £1.9 million) up to the level of deferred tax liabilities arising in the same jurisdiction and additionally an asset supportable by taxable income projections of £nil (2015: £nil). The Group has also recognised a deferred tax asset of £3.9 million (2015: £0.4 million) in respect of taxable temporary timing differences relating to timing differences in another jurisdiction supportable by taxable income projections. In addition, the Group has not recognised deferred tax assets relating to other temporary differences of £33.9 million (2015: £20.7 million). These deferred tax assets have not been recognised as the Group’s management considers that there is insufficient future taxable income, taxable temporary differences and feasible tax-planning strategies to utilise all of the cumulative losses and therefore it is probable that the deferred tax assets will not be realised in full. If future income differs from current projections, this could significantly impact the tax charge or benefit in future periods.

 

In addition to the amount charged to the income statement and other comprehensive income, the following amounts relating to tax have been recognised directly in equity:

 

    2016     2015     2014  
    £000s     £000s     £000s  
Change in estimate of excess tax deductions related to share-based payments   1,133     84      
Total income tax recognised directly in equity     1,133       84        

 

  F- 21  

 

 

b) Factors Affecting the Tax Benefit for the Year

 

The tax benefit for the year can be reconciled to the tax benefit on the Group’s loss for the year at the standard UK corporation tax rate as follows:

 

    2016     2015     2014  
    £000s     £000s     £000s  
Loss before tax   (86,172 )   (57,061 )   (19,570 )
Tax credit on Group loss before tax at the standard UK corporation tax rate of 20.0% (2015: 20.5%; 2014: 22.0%)     (17,234 )     (11,698 )     (4,305 )
Effects of:                        
Expenses not deductible in determining taxable profit     588       233       1,070  
Impact of employee share acquisition relief     (1,842 )     (2,519 )     (1,053 )
Income not taxable in determining taxable profit                 (1 )
Current year UK research and development tax credit     (21,150 )     (12,641 )     (5,251 )
Current year US tax credits     (1,766 )            
R&D enhanced tax relief and surrender of losses     12,679       7,756       3,875  
Effect of unrecognised losses and temporary differences     6,634       6,536       1,861  
Overseas profits taxed at different rates     122              
Recognition of previously unrecognised deferred tax asset                 (829 )
Adjustment in respect of prior year tax credit     (546 )     (165 )     (278 )
Tax     (22,515 )     (12,498 )     (4,911 )

 

The following are the major deferred tax liabilities and assets recognised by the Group and movements thereon during the current and prior reporting periods:

 

    Accelerated
Tax
    Tax     Share-Based
Payment and
       
    Depreciation     Losses     Other Compensation     Total  
    £000s     £000s     £000s     £000s  
At 1 October 2013     (740 )     1,635             895  
(Charged)/credited to profit or loss   135     (753 )       (618 )
At 1 October 2014     (605 )     882             277  
Credited/(charged) to profit or loss     (1,290 )     1,002       345       57  
Credited/(charged) to equity                 84       84  
At 1 October 2015     (1,895 )     1,884       429       418  
Credited/(charged) to profit or loss     (23 )     (48 )     2,072       2,001  
Credited/(charged) to equity                 1,454       1,454  
At 30 September 2016     (1,918 )     1,836       3,955       3,873  

 

Deferred tax assets and liabilities have been offset where the Group has a legally enforceable right to do so, and intends to settle on a net basis. The taxing authority permits the Group to make or receive a single net payment for all UK subsidiaries. The Group’s US subsidiary operates in a different jurisdiction with no legally enforceable right to offset against UK tax charges or credits.

 

On 6 September 2016, the UK Government substantively enacted a reduction in the main rate of corporation tax from 20% to 19% with effect from 1 April 2017. The main rate of corporation tax will be reduced by a further 2% to 17% with effect from 1 April 2020. The enacted UK tax rate until 1 April 2015 was 21%.

 

  F- 22  

 

 

11. Loss Per Share

 

The calculations of loss per share are based on the following data:

 

    2016     2015     2014  
    £000s     £000s     £000s  
Loss for the year – basic and diluted     (63,657 )   (44,563 )   (14,659 )

 

    Number of Shares  
    2016     2015     2014  
    Million     Million     Million  
Weighted average number of ordinary shares   270.4     246.4     210.4  
Less ESOP trust ordinary shares 1                  
Weighted average number of ordinary shares for purposes of basic earnings per share     270.4       246.4       210.4  
Effect of potentially dilutive shares arising from share options 2                  
Weighted average number of ordinary shares for purposes of diluted earnings per share     270.4       246.4       210.4  
Loss per share – basic     (23.5 )p     (18.1 )p     (7.0 )p
Loss per share – diluted     (23.5 )p     (18.1 )p     (7.0 )p

 

1 As at 30 September 2016, 33,054 ordinary shares were held in the ESOP trust (2015: 33,054 and 2014: 34,706). The effect is less than 0.1 million shares, and consequently these have not been presented above.
2 The Group incurred a loss in each of the financial years above. As a result, the inclusion of potentially dilutive share options in the diluted loss per share calculation would have an anti-dilutive effect on the loss per share for the period. The impact of 7.1 million share options have therefore been excluded from the diluted loss per share calculation for the year ended 30 September 2016 (30 September 2015: 7.8 million; 30 September 2014: 9.5 million).

 

12. Intangible Assets – Goodwill

 

    2016     2015  
Group   £000s     £000s  
Cost – as at 1 October   5,210     5,210  
Net book value – as at 30 September     5,210       5,210  

 

Goodwill arose upon the acquisition of GW Research Limited (formerly G-Pharm Limited) by GW Pharma Limited in 2001. For impairment testing purposes, all goodwill has been allocated to the Commercial segment as a separate cash-generating unit. Goodwill has an indefinite useful life and is tested annually for impairment or more frequently if there are indications of impairment.

 

The Company has determined the recoverable amount of the Commercial segment based on a value-in-use calculation. This calculation uses pre-tax cash flow projections based on financial budgets approved by management covering a two-year period. Cash flows beyond the two-year period are based upon detailed internal and external third party analysis of the Company’s product opportunity, of which Epidiolex is a significant contributor, or are extrapolated using the estimated growth rates stated below. The projections include assumptions about the timing and likelihood of product launches and pricing policy.

 

Management has determined the following assumptions to be the key assumptions in the calculation of value-in-use for the Commercial segment:

 

Growth rate – sales volume in each period is the main driver for revenue and costs. The same growth rates have been used in financial budgets and are consistent with in-market run rates and internal commercial forecasts based on a 10-year period.

 

Long-term growth rate – A 0% growth rate has been applied after 10 years (2015: 0% after ten years). This approach has been adopted by management as it is representative of the long development and product lifecycle in the pharmaceutical sector. In future periods, depending on the performance of the Commercial segment, it may be necessary to revise the terminal growth rate.

 

Discount rate – a 12.6% (2015: 14.3% and 2014: 13.2%) pre-tax rate has been used. This is considered appropriate for the purpose of impairment reviews as it reflects the current market assessment of the time value of money and the risks specific to the cash-generating unit.

 

Any reasonably possible change in the key assumptions on which value-in-use is based would not cause the carrying amount to exceed the recoverable amount of the Commercial segment.

 

  F- 23  

 

 

13. Other Intangible Assets

 

    Intangible                    
    Assets Under                    
    the Course of                    
    Construction     Software     Licences     Total  
Group   £000s     £000s     £000s     £000s  
Cost                        
At 1 October 2014                        
Additions     55       76       59       190  
Reclassifications from property, plant and equipment (note 14)     11       144             155  
At 1 October 2015     66       220       59       345  
Additions     387       35       24       446  
Transfers of completed assets     (38 )     38              
At 30 September 2016     415       293       83       791  
Accumulated amortisation                                
At 1 October 2014                        
Charge for the year           48       4       52  
Reclassifications           48             48  
At 1 October 2015           96       4       100  
Charge for the year           57       5       62  
At 30 September 2016           153       9       162  
Net book value                                
At 30 September 2016     415       140       74       629  
At 30 September 2015     66       124       55       245  

 

Included in additions are £nil of other intangible assets which are unpaid at the balance sheet date and are included in trade and other payables (2015: £0.1 million).

 

  F- 24  

 

 

14. Property, Plant and Equipment

 

Group   Assets Under
the Course of 
Construction 
£000s
    Leasehold 
Buildings
£000s
    Plant, 
Machinery and 
Lab Equipment 
£000s
    Office and IT 
Equipment 
£000s
    Leasehold 
Improvements 
£000s
    Total 
£000s
 
Cost                                                
At 1 October 2014   6,490         4,655     1,478     4,657     17,280  
Additions     12,374             3,056       2,054       2,574       20,058  
Reclassifications to other intangible assets (note 13)     (11 )                 (144 )           (155 )
Transfers of completed assets     (1,570 )           570             1,000        
Disposals                 (366 )     (41 )     (67 )     (474 )
At 1 October 2015     17,283             7,915       3,347       8,164       36,709  
Additions     7,698       3,603       1,754       273       473       13,801  
Reclassifications                 1,463       (1,463 )            
Transfers of completed assets     (3,623 )           1,809       29       1,785        
Disposals                 (112 )     (789 )     (122 )     (1,023 )
Exchange differences                       20       1       21  
At 30 September 2016     21,358       3,603       12,829       1,417       10,301       49,508  
Accumulated depreciation and impairment                                                
At 1 October 2014                 3,384       918       1,339       5,641  
Disposals                 (365 )     (41 )     (67 )     (473 )
Charge for the year                 746       510       994       2,250  
Impairment of assets     606                               606  
Reclassifications                       (48 )           (48 )
At 1 October 2015     606             3,765       1,339       2,266       7,976  
Disposals                 (112 )     (788 )     (122 )     (1,022 )
Charge for the year           63       1,654       338       1,550       3,605  
Reclassifications                 216       (216 )            
Exchange differences                       1       1       2  
At 30 September 2016     606       63       5,523       674       3,695       10,561  
Net book value                                                
At 30 September 2016     20,752       3,540       7,306       743       6,606       38,947  
At 30 September 2015     16,677             4,150       2,008       5,898       28,733  

 

The impairment loss for the year ended 30 September 2015 on assets under the course of construction arose in connection with a change in use of manufacturing assets whereby the recoverable value of the assets did not exceed their carrying value.

 

The net book value of property, plant and equipment at 30 September 2016 includes £4.9 million in respect of assets held under finance leases (2015: £1.5 million). In addition, assets under the course of construction include £1.6 million of capitalised interest (2015: £1.0 million). Included in additions is £3.2 million of property, plant and equipment which is unpaid and is included in trade and other payables (2015: £1.4 million).

 

  F- 25  

 

 

15. Inventories

 

    2016     2015  
    £000s     £000s  
Raw materials   252     317  
Work in progress     3,226       3,686  
Finished goods     770       753  
Total inventories, net of provision     4,248       4,756  

 

Inventories with a carrying value of £2.2 million are considered to be recoverable after more than one year from the balance sheet date, but within the Group’s normal operating cycle (2015: £2.7 million).

 

The provision for inventories relates to inventories expected to be utilised in the Group’s R&D activities. The movement in the provision for inventories is as follows:

 

    2016     2015  
    £000s     £000s  
Opening balance as at 1 October     66       351  
Write down of inventories     129       98  
Write off of inventories included in the provision     (20 )   (318 )
Reversal of write down of inventories     (57 )     (65 )
Closing balance as at 30 September     118       66  

 

The reversal of write down is as a result of an increased level of production, reducing the level of work in progress expected to expire before use. Write off of inventories previously provided for does not impact cash flow.

 

16. Trade and Other Receivables

 

    Group  
    2016     2015  
    £000s     £000s  
Amounts falling due within one year                
Trade receivables   778     373  
Prepayments and accrued income     2,637       1,544  
Other receivables     1,141       956  
      4,556       2,873  

 

Trade receivables disclosed above are classified as loans and receivables and are therefore measured at amortised cost.

 

Trade receivables at 30 September 2016 represent 27 days of sales (2015: 5 days). The average trade receivable days during the year ended 30 September 2016 was 19 days (2015: 22 days). The credit period extended to customers is 30 to 60 days.

 

The trade receivables balance at 30 September 2016 consisted of balances due from four customers (2015: four customers) with the largest single customer representing 70% (2015: 46%) of the total amount due. The Group’s customers consist of a small number of large pharmaceutical companies, where the risk attributable to each customer is considered to be low. The Group seeks to mitigate credit risk by seeking payments in advance from pharmaceutical partners for expenditure to be incurred on their behalf.

 

No interest is charged on trade receivables. No impairment losses were recognised during the year ended 30 September 2016 (2015: £nil).

 

The Directors consider that the carrying value of trade receivables approximates to their fair value due to the short maturity thereof.

 

  F- 26  

 

 

17. Trade and Other Payables

 

    Group  
    2016     2015  
    £000s     £000s  
Amounts falling due within one year                
Other creditors and accruals   15,899     10,714  
Clinical trial accruals     9,503       8,374  
Trade payables     3,433       3,795  
Fit out funding (see note 18)     845       348  
Other taxation and social security     1,490       791  
      31,170       24,022  
Amounts falling due after one year                
Other creditors and accruals     1,081       -  
Fit out funding (see note 18)     8,342       8,445  
      9,423       8,445  
      40,593       32,467  

 

Trade payables principally comprise amounts outstanding for trade purchases and ongoing costs.

 

Trade payables at 30 September 2016 represent the equivalent of 14 days’ purchases (2015: 17 days).

 

The average credit period taken for trade purchases during the year ended 30 September 2016 was 14 days (2015: 17 days).

 

For most suppliers, no interest is charged on invoices that are paid within a pre-agreed trade credit period. The Group has procedures in place to ensure that invoices are paid within agreed credit terms so as to ensure that interest charges by suppliers are minimised.

 

The Directors consider that the carrying value of trade payables approximates to their fair value due to the short maturity thereof.

 

Non-current other creditors and accruals relates entirely to the expected employer’s payroll taxes payable on employee share options vesting more than one year after the financial year end.

 

18. Fit out funding

 

On 19 November 2013 the Group entered into an agreement with its landlord to receive fit out funding of £7.8 million to fund the expansion and upgrades to manufacturing facilities. The funds were received in tranches, with the final amount received on 1 July 2014. The repayment of the borrowing takes the form of quarterly rental payments over a period of 15 years which commenced on 27 May 2016 when the Group entered into the associated lease of the building. As at 30 September 2016 associated interest of £1.6 million has been incurred (30 September 2015: £1.0 million). The total liability at 30 September 2016 is £9.2 million (30 September 2015: £8.8 million). The Group has estimated that £0.9 million of the total liability will be due within one year and the remaining £8.3 million is due after one year.

 

The liability in respect of the funding was initially recognised at the amount of proceeds received, net of transaction costs, and has been subsequently carried at amortised cost using the effective interest method and a rate of 7.0% (30 September 2015: 7.2%).

 

  F- 27  

 

 

The following table details the Group’s remaining contractual maturity for its borrowings and the related interest payments. The tables are based on the undiscounted cash flows of financial liabilities based on the earliest date on which the Group could be required to pay. The table includes cash flows for both interest, based on the rate applicable as at 30 September 2016, and principal amounts:

 

Forward projection of cash flows as at 30 September 2016   <1 year
£000s
    1-2 years
£000s
    2-3 years
£000s
    3-4 years
£000s
    4-5 years
£000s
    5+ years
£000s
    Total
£000s
 
Principal     845       389       417       446       479       6,611       9,187  
Interest   603     576     548     519     486     2,480     5,212  
Total     1,448       965       965       965       965       9,091       14,399  

 

Forward projection of cash flows as at 30 September 2015   <1 year
£000s
    1-2 years
£000s
    2-3 years
£000s
    3-4 years
£000s
    4-5 years
£000s
    5+ years
£000s
    Total
£000s
 
Principal   348     369     397     426     456     7,011     9,007  
Interest     516       596       568       539       509       2,740       5,468  
Total     864       965       965       965       965       9,751       14,475  

 

19. Obligations Under Finance Leases

 

    Minimum Lease Payments  
    2016     2015  
Group   £000s     £000s  
Amounts payable under finance leases:                
Within one year     571       176  
In the second to fifth years inclusive   2,223     703  
After five years     6,511       1,206  
      9,305       2,085  
Less: future finance charges     (4,135 )     (434 )
Present value of lease obligations     5,170       1,651  

 

    Present Value of Lease
Payments
 
    2016     2015  
    £000s     £000s  
Amounts payable under finance leases:                
Amounts due for settlement within 12 months   211     111  
Amounts due for settlement after 12 months     4,959       1,540  
      5,170       1,651  

 

It is the Group’s policy to lease certain of its property, plant and equipment under finance leases. The weighted average lease term remaining is 17.1 years (2015: 12.1 years). For the year ended 30 September 2016, the average effective borrowing rate was 7.5% (2015: 4.0%). Interest rates are fixed at the contract date. All leases to date have been on a fixed repayment basis and no arrangements have been entered into for contingent rental payments.

 

All lease obligations are denominated in Pounds Sterling.

 

The carrying value of the Group’s lease obligations as at 30 September 2016 approximates to their fair value.

 

The Group’s obligations under finance leases are generally secured by the lessors’ rights over the leased assets.

 

  F- 28  

 

 

20. Deferred Revenue

 

    Group  
    2016     2015  
    £000s     £000s  
Amounts falling due within one year                
Deferred licence, collaboration and technical access fee income 1   1,451     1,260  
Advance research and development fees 2     1,236       2,009  
      2,687       3,269  
Amounts falling due after one year                
Deferred licence, collaboration and technical access fee income 1     5,355       6,725  

 

1 Deferred revenue primarily relates to up-front licence fees received in 2005 of £12.0 million from Almirall S.A. (deferred revenue balance as at 30 September 2016: £3.5 million; 30 September 2015: £4.3 million) and collaboration and technical access fees from other Sativex licencees. Amounts deferred under each agreement will be recognised in revenue as disclosed in note 2.
2 Advance payments received represent payments for research and development activities to be recognised as revenue in future periods as the services are rendered.

 

21. Financial Instruments

 

The Group manages its capital to ensure that entities in the Group will be able to continue operating as a going concern while maximising shareholder returns. The Group’s overall strategy remains unchanged from 2015.

 

Group senior management are responsible for monitoring and managing the financial risks relating to the operations of the Group, which include credit risk, market risks arising from interest rate risk and currency risk, and liquidity risk. The Board of Directors and the Audit Committee review and approve the internal policies for managing each of these risks, as summarised below. The Group is not subject to any externally imposed capital requirements.

 

The Group’s financial instruments, as at 30 September, are summarised below:

 

Categories of Financial Instruments

 

    2016     2015  
    £000s     £000s  
Financial assets – loans and receivables                
Cash and cash equivalents     374,392       234,872  
Trade receivables – at amortised cost     778       373  
Other receivables     385       248  
Total financial assets     375,555       235,493  
Financial liabilities – amortised cost                
Other creditors and accruals     12,401       10,426  
Clinical trial accruals     9,503       8,374  
Trade payables     3,433       3,795  
Fit out funding     9,187       8,793  
Obligations under finance leases     5,170       1,651  
Total financial liabilities     39,694       33,039  

 

All financial assets and financial liabilities, other than the non-current element of £5.0 million in respect of the obligations under finance leases (2015: £1.5 million) and £8.3 million (2015: £8.4 million) of fit out funding received from the Group’s landlord, are current in nature. In all instances, the Directors consider that the carrying value of financial assets and financial liabilities approximates to their fair value.

 

It is, and has been throughout the period under review, the Group’s policy that no speculative trading in financial instruments shall be undertaken.

 

Credit Risk

 

Credit risk refers to the risk that a counterparty will default on its contractual obligations resulting in financial loss to the Group. The Group has a policy of only dealing with creditworthy counterparties, principally involving the major UK clearing banks and their wholly owned subsidiaries, when placing cash on deposit. In addition the Group operates a treasury policy that dictates the maximum cash balance that may be placed on deposit with any single institution or group. This policy is reviewed and approved by the Audit Committee and the Board of Directors.

 

  F- 29  

 

 

Trade receivables represent amounts due from customers for the sale of commercial product and research funding from development partners, consisting primarily of a small number of major pharmaceutical companies where the credit risk is considered to be low. The Group seeks to minimise credit risk by offering only 30 days credit to new commercial customers and by requesting payment in advance from its development partners for the majority of its research activities.

 

At the balance sheet date the maximum credit risk attributable to any individual counterparty was £244.0 million (2015: £113.2 million) which is held by HSBC Holdings plc.

 

The carrying amount of the financial assets recorded in the financial statements represents the Group’s maximum exposure to credit risk as no collateral or other credit enhancements are held.

 

Market Risk

 

The Group’s activities expose it primarily to financial risks of changes in interest rates and foreign currency exchange rates. These risks are managed by maintaining an appropriate mix of cash deposits in various currencies, placed with a variety of financial institutions for varying periods according to the Group’s expected liquidity requirements. There has been no material change to the Group’s exposure to market risks or the manner in which it manages and measures risk.

 

i) Interest Rate Risk

 

The Group is exposed to interest rate risk as it places surplus cash funds on deposit to earn interest income. The Group seeks to ensure that it secures the best commercially available interest rates from those banks that meet the Group’s stringent counterparty credit rating criteria. In doing so, the Group manages the term of cash deposits, up to a maximum of 90 days, in order to maximise interest earnings while also ensuring that it maintains sufficient readily available cash in order to meet short-term liquidity needs.

 

Interest income of £0.4 million (2015: £0.2 million; 2014: £0.1 million) during the year ended 30 September 2016 was earned from deposits with a weighted average interest rate of 0.36% (2015: 0.24%; 2014: 0.54%). Therefore, a 100 basis point increase in interest rates would have increased interest income, and reduced the loss for the year, by £1.2 million (2015: reduced loss by £1.0 million; 2014: reduced loss by £0.5 million).

 

The Group does not have any balance sheet exposure to assets or liabilities which would increase or decrease in fair value with changes to interest rates.

 

ii) Currency Risk

 

The functional currency of the Company, and each of its subsidiaries apart from Greenwich Biosciences, Inc. (formerly GW Pharmaceuticals Inc.), is Pounds Sterling and the majority of transactions in the Group are denominated in that currency. The functional currency of Greenwich Biosciences, Inc. is US Dollars ($). The Group receives revenues and incurs expenditures in foreign currencies and is exposed to the risks of foreign exchange rate movements, with the impact recognised in the consolidated income statement. The Group seeks to minimise this exposure by passively maintaining foreign currency cash balances at levels appropriate to meet foreseeable foreign currency expenditures, converting surplus foreign currency balances into Pounds as soon as they arise. The Group does not use derivative contracts to manage exchange rate exposure.

 

The table below shows analysis of the Pounds Sterling equivalent of year-end cash and cash equivalent balances by currency:

 

    2016     2015  
    £000s     £000s  
Cash at bank and in hand:                
Pounds Sterling     73,277       18,756  
Euro     1,582       2,070  
US Dollar     169,738       98,417  
Canadian Dollar     448       804  
Total     245,045       120,047  
Short-term deposits (less than 30 days):                
Pounds Sterling     31,564       31,516  
US Dollar     97,783       83,309  
Total cash and cash equivalents     374,392       234,872  

 

  F- 30  

 

 

The table below shows those transactional exposures that give rise to net currency gains and losses recognised in the consolidated income statement. Such exposures comprise the net monetary assets and monetary liabilities of the Group that are not denominated in the functional currency of the relevant Group entity. As at 30 September these exposures were as follows:

 

Net Foreign Currency Assets/(Liabilities)

 

    2016     2015  
    £000s     £000s  
US Dollar     263,094       177,797  
Euro     1,665       768  
Canadian Dollar     649       953  
Other   (38 )   (55 )
      265,370       179,463  

 

Foreign Currency Sensitivity Analysis

 

The most significant currencies in which the Group transacts, other than Pounds Sterling, are the US Dollar, the Euro and the Canadian Dollar. The Group also trades in other currencies in small amounts as necessary. The Group’s sensitivity to foreign currency has increased during the current period primarily due to the issuance of 38.6 million new shares on NASDAQ (see note 22).

 

The following table details the Group’s sensitivity to a 10% change in the year-end rate, which the Group feels is the maximum likely change in rate based upon recent currency movements, in the key foreign currency exchange rates against Pounds Sterling:

 

Year Ended 30 September 2016  

Euro

£000s

   

US Dollar

£000s

   

Can Dollar

£000s

   

Other

£000s

 
Loss before tax     167       26,309       65       (4 )
Equity     167       26,309       65       (4 )

 

Year Ended 30 September 2015   Euro
£000s
    US Dollar
£000s
    Can Dollar
£000s
    Other
£000s
 
Loss before tax   77     17,780     95     (6 )
Equity     77       17,780       95       (6 )

 

Year Ended 30 September 2014   Euro
£000s
    US Dollar
£000s
    Can Dollar
£000s
    Other
£000s
 
Loss before tax   141     10,095     31     (3 )
Equity     141       10,095       31       (3 )

 

In management’s opinion, the sensitivity analysis is unrepresentative of the inherent foreign exchange risk as the year-end exposure does not reflect the exposure during the year.

 

Liquidity Risk

 

Responsibility for liquidity risk management rests with the Board of Directors, which has built a liquidity risk management framework to enable the monitoring and management of short, medium and long-term cash requirements of the business.

 

The Board of Directors actively monitors Group cash flows and regularly reviews projections of future cash requirements to ensure that appropriate levels of liquidity are maintained. The Group manages its short-term liquidity primarily by planning the maturity dates of cash deposits in order to time the availability of funds as liabilities fall due for payment. The Group does not maintain any borrowing facilities.

 

Cash deposits, classified as cash and cash equivalents on the balance sheet, comprise deposits placed on money markets for periods of up to three months and on call. The weighted average time for which the rate was fixed was 32 days (2015: 32 days).

 

All of the Group’s financial liabilities at each balance sheet date have maturity dates of less than 12 months from the balance sheet date, other than the £5.0 million in respect of the obligations under finance leases (2015: £1.5 million) and £8.3 million (2015: £8.4 million) of fit out funding received from the Group’s landlord. The obligations under finance leases will be repaid over a weighted average 17.1 year term (2015: 12.1 year term) and the fit out funding received is being repaid over a 15-year finance term of which repayments commenced during the year. There have been no material changes to the Group’s exposure to liquidity risks or the manner in which it manages and measures liquidity risk.

 

  F- 31  

 

 

22. Share Capital

 

As at 30 September 2016 the share capital of the Company’s allotted, called-up and fully paid amounts were as follows:

 

    2016     2015  
    £000s     £000s  
Allotted, called-up and fully paid     302       261  

 

Changes to the number of ordinary shares in issue have been as follows:

 

    Number of
Shares
    Total Nominal
Value
£000s
    Total Share
Premium
£000s
    Total
Consideration
£000s
 
As at 1 October 2014   236,646,895     237     220,551     220,788  
Issue of new shares (net of issuance costs)     22,093,601       22       127,541       127,563  
Exercise of share options     2,439,677       2       1,183       1,185  
As at 1 October 2015     261,180,173       261       349,275       349,536  
Issue of new shares (net of issuance costs)     38,640,000       39       206,512       206,551  
Exercise of share options     2,272,966       2       690       692  
As at 30 September 2016     302,093,139       302       556,477       556,779  

 

In July 2016, the Group completed an equity financing, issuing 38,640,000 ordinary shares in the form of American Depositary Shares (“ADSs”) listed on the NASDAQ Global market, raising net proceeds after expenses of $273.1 million (£206.6 million). This took the form of 3,220,000 ADSs at a price to the public of $90.00 per ADS. Each ADS represents 12 ordinary shares of 0.1p each in the capital of the Company.

 

In May 2015, the Group completed an equity financing, issuing 22,080,000 ordinary shares in the form of American Depositary Shares (“ADSs”) listed on the NASDAQ Global market, raising net proceeds after expenses of $193.3 million (£127.5 million). This took the form of 1,840,000 ADSs at a price to the public of $112.00 per ADS. Each ADS represents 12 ordinary shares of 0.1p each in the capital of the Company.

 

The Company has one class of ordinary shares which carry no right to fixed income.

 

23. Share-based Payments

 

Equity-settled Share Option Schemes

 

The Company operates various equity-settled share option schemes for employees of the Group. All options granted under these schemes are exercisable at the share price on the date of the grant, with the exception of certain options issued under the GW Pharmaceuticals Long Term Incentive Plan (“LTIP”) which are issued with an exercise price equivalent to the par value of the shares under option. The vesting period for all options granted range between one and four years from the date of grant and options lapse after six months to seven years from the vesting date. Options generally also lapse if the employee leaves the Group before the options vest. However, at the discretion of the Remuneration Committee, under the “Good Leaver” provisions of the various share option scheme rules, employees may be allowed to retain some or all of the share options upon ceasing employment by the Group. Vested options usually need to be exercised within six months of leaving.

 

In the year ended 30 September 2016, two employees designated as “Good Leavers” were permitted to retain options over 4,807 shares upon ceasing employment. Also during the year ended 30 September 2016, 90,000 non-director LTIP share options were replaced and accounted for as a modification of terms per the provisions of IFRS 2 Share Based Payment . This led to the recognition of an incremental fair value charge of £0.4 million, calculated using the Black-Scholes share option pricing model, which arises due to increases in the underlying share price since the initial options were granted.

 

LTIP awards granted to employees (excluding Executive Directors) are subject to service and non-market-based performance conditions which must be achieved before the options vest and become exercisable. LTIP awards granted to Executive Directors are subject to service and performance conditions which are determined by the Remuneration Committee. These are usually a mixture of market-based and non-market-based performance conditions which are intended to link executive compensation to the key value drivers for the business whilst aligning the interests of the Executive Directors with those of shareholders and employees. In the event that the performance conditions (non-market and market) are not achieved within the required vesting period, the options lapse.

 

2013 Awards

 

In the year ended 30 September 2013, all awards granted were LTIP awards.

 

The 2013 LTIP awards are subject to performance conditions whereby 100% of the awards vest on the third anniversary of the date of the grant if the ADS price has increased by 75% or more during the three-year vesting period ended 24 September 2016. 25% of the awards vests if 25% growth is achieved, with a straight-line basis of calculation being used to calculate the number of options vesting between these two extremes. No options vest if the share price growth is below 25% over the three-year vesting period.

 

The 2013 LTIP awards are subject to a service condition whereby the awards vest on the third anniversary of the date of the grant if the holders remain in employment, subject to the performance conditions above.

 

  F- 32  

 

 

2014 Awards

 

In the year ended 30 September 2014, all awards granted were LTIP awards.

 

The 2014 LTIP awards are subject to a service condition whereby 100% of the awards vest on the third anniversary of the date of the grant if the holders remain in employment.

 

2015 Awards

 

In the year ended 30 September 2015, all awards granted were LTIP awards.

 

The 2015 LTIP awards are subject to performance conditions, whereby:

· 25% of the awards are in the form of market-priced options, whereby the options have an exercise price equivalent to the market price at market close on the day prior to grant ($127.26 per ADS, equivalent to 671p per ordinary share). These options become exercisable on the third anniversary of the date of grant. Future gains upon exercise of these options will be linked to the extent of share price growth over the vesting period.
· 50% of the awards are in the form of performance stock options, whereby the options will vest upon the third anniversary of the date of grant subject to certain corporate performance conditions having been achieved. In this case, vesting of half of the performance stock options will occur upon receipt from FDA of their confirmation of acceptance of an Epidiolex NDA filing and half will vest upon FDA grant of Epidiolex regulatory approval.
· 25% of the awards are in the form of restricted stock options whereby these options are subject to a four-year service condition and vesting period. 25% of the options will vest on each anniversary of the date of grant over the next four years.

 

2016 Awards

 

In the year ended 30 September 2016, all awards granted were LTIP awards.

 

The 2016 LTIP awards are subject to performance conditions, whereby:

· 25% of the awards are in the form of market-priced options, whereby the options have an exercise price equivalent to the market price at market close on the day prior to grant ($44.64 per ADS, equivalent to 257p per ordinary share). These options become exercisable on the third anniversary of the date of grant. Future gains upon exercise of these options will be linked to the extent of share price growth over the vesting period.
· 50% of the awards are in the form of performance stock options, whereby the options will vest upon the third anniversary of the date of grant subject to certain corporate performance conditions having been achieved. In this case, vesting of half of the performance stock options will occur upon receipt from FDA of their confirmation of acceptance of an Epidiolex NDA filing and half will vest upon FDA grant of Epidiolex regulatory approval.
· 25% of the awards are in the form of restricted stock options whereby these options are subject to a four-year service condition and vesting period. 25% of the options will vest on each anniversary of the date of grant over the next four years.

 

The number of outstanding options under each scheme can be summarised as follows:

 

    30 Sept 2016     30 Sept 2015  
    Number of     Number of  
    Share Options     Share Options  
Employee share option schemes     107,542       770,936  
Employee LTIP awards 10,525,630     7,660,564  
Options outstanding     10,633,172       8,431,500  

 

  F- 33  

 

 

The movement in share options in each scheme during the year can be summarised as follows:

 

    Employee Options     Employee LTIP     Consultant Options     Total Options  
    Number of
Share
Options
    Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
£
    Number of
Share
Options
    Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
£
    Number of
Share
Options
    Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
£
    Number of
Share
Options
    Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
£
 
Outstanding at 1 October 2014     1,868,699       0.98       7,471,320       0.001       104,806       1.27       9,444,825       0.21  
Granted during the year                 2,009,231       1.09                   2,009,231       1.09  
Exercised during the year     (1,097,763 )     0.96       (1,237,108 )     0.001       (104,806 )     1.27       (2,439,677 )     0.49  
Lapsed during the year                 (582,879 )     0.001                   (582,879 )     0.001  
Outstanding at 1 October 2015   770,936     1.02     7,660,564     0.29             8,431,500     0.35  
Granted during the year                 4,767,106       0.60                   4,767,106       0.60  
Exercised during the year     (663,394 )     1.04       (1,609,572 )     0.001                   (2,272,966 )     0.305  
Lapsed during the year                 (292,468 )     0.001                   (292,468 )     0.001  
Outstanding at 30 September 2016     107,542       0.868       10,525,630       0.482                   10,633,172       0.61  

 

Share options outstanding at 30 September 2016 can be summarised as follows:

 

    Employee Options     Employee LTIP     Consultant Options     Total Options  
    Number of
Share
Options
    Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life/Years
    Number of
Share
Options
    Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life/Years
    Number of
Share
Options
    Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life/Years
    Number of
Share
Options
    Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life/Years
 
£0.00–£0.50     4,000       1.97       9,182,071       6.26                   9,186,071       6.25  
£0.51–£1.00     103,542       0.59                               103,542       0.59  
£1.00+                 1,343,559       7.24                   1,343,559       7.24  
Outstanding at 30 September 2016   107,542     0.64     10,525,630     6.38             10,633,172     6.32  
Exercisable at 30 September 2016     107,542       0.64       3,057,821       6.12                   3,165,363       5.93  

 

Share options outstanding at 30 September 2015 can be summarised as follows:

 

    Employee Options     Employee LTIP     Consultant Options     Total Options  
    Number of
Share
Options
    Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life/Years
    Number of
Share
Options
    Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life/Years
    Number of
Share
Options
    Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life/Years
    Number of
Share
Options
    Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life/Years
 
£0.00–£0.50     4,000       2.97       7,333,940       6.95                   7,337,940       6.95  
£0.51–£1.00     547,812       1.52                               547,812       1.52  
£1.01–£1.50     219,124       0.36                               219,124       0.36  
£1.51+                 326,624       9.74                   326,624       9.74  
Outstanding at 30 September 2015   770,936     1.20     7,660,564     7.07             8,431,500     6.53  
Exercisable at 30 September 2015     770,936       1.20       2,207,875       4.98                   2,978,811       4.00  

 

Charges for share-based payments have been allocated to the research and development expenditure and Sales, general and administrative expenses in the consolidated income statements as follows:

 

   

2016

£000s

  2015
£000s
    2014
£000s
 
Research and development expenditure     4,119       1,525       775  
Sales, general and administrative expenses   4,033     953     463  
      8,152       2,478       1,238  

 

  F- 34  

 

 

In the year ended 30 September 2016, options were granted on 29 December 2015, 15 January 2016, 15 February 2016, 18 March 2016, 14 April 2016, 12 May 2016, 9 June 2016 and 26 August 2016. The aggregate of the estimated fair values of the options granted on those dates is £12.7 million and the weighted average fair value of the awards made during 2016 was £2.66 per option.

 

In the year ended 30 September 2015, options were granted on 24 December 2014, 9 January 2015, 25 February 2015, 20 March 2015, 9 April 2015, 6 May 2015, 24 June 2015 and 22 September 2015. The aggregate of the estimated fair values of the options granted on those dates is £10.6 million and the weighted average fair value of the awards made during 2015 was £5.30 per option.

 

Fair values were calculated using the Black-Scholes share option pricing model for grants with non-market-based performance conditions. The Monte Carlo share option pricing model has been used for grants with market-based performance conditions. The following weighted average assumptions were used in calculating these fair values:

 

    2016     2015     2014  
Weighted average share price     298 p     579 p     303 p
Weighted average exercise price     60 p     109 p     0.1 p
Expected volatility     58 %     59 %     58 %
Expected life     3.3 years       3.6 years       5.0 years  
Risk-free rate     1.09 %     1.32 %     0.5 %
Expected dividend yield     Nil       Nil       Nil  

 

Expected volatility was determined by calculating the historical volatility of the Group’s share price over previous years. The expected life used in the model has been adjusted, based on management’s best estimate, for the effects of non-transferability, exercise restrictions, performance conditions and behavioural considerations.

 

24. Other Reserves

 

Other reserves of £19.5 million (30 September 2015: £19.2 million) relate to a £19.3 million merger reserve (30 September 2015: £19.3 million) and a £0.2 million credit relating to exchange difference on translation of foreign operations (30 September 2015: debit £0.1 million). The merger reserve was created as a result of the acquisition by the Company of the entire issued share capital of GW Pharma Limited in 2001. This acquisition was effected by a share-for-share exchange which was merger accounted under UK Generally Accepted Accounting Practice (“UK GAAP”), in accordance with the merger relief provisions of Section 131 of the Companies Act 1985 (as amended) relating to the accounting for business combinations involving the issue of shares at a premium. In preparing consolidated financial statements, the amount by which the fair value of the shares issued exceeded their nominal value was recorded in a merger reserve on consolidation, rather than in a share premium account. The merger reserve was retained upon transition to IFRSs, as allowed under UK law. This reserve is not considered to be distributable.

 

ESOP Reserve

 

The Group’s “ESOP” is an Inland Revenue-approved all employee share scheme constituted under a trust deed. The trust holds shares in the Company for the benefit of and as an incentive for the employees of the Group. The trustee of the ESOP is GWP Trustee Company Limited, a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company. Costs incurred by the trust are expensed in the Group’s financial statements as incurred. Distributions from the trust are made in accordance with the scheme rules and on the recommendation of the Board of Directors of the Company.

 

Shares held in trust represent issued and fully paid up 0.1p ordinary shares and remain eligible to receive dividends. The shares held by the ESOP were originally acquired in 2000 for nil consideration by way of a gift from a shareholder and hence the balance on the ESOP reserve is nil (2015: nil).

 

As at 30 September the ESOP held the following shares:

 

   

2016

Number

    2015
Number
 
Unconditionally vested in employees     90,043       115,352  
Shares available for future distribution to employees   33,054     33,054  
Total     123,097       148,406  

 

The valuation methodology used to compute the share-based payment charge related to the ESOP is based on fair value at the grant date, which is determined by the application of a Black-Scholes share option pricing model. The assumptions underlying the Black-Scholes model for the ESOP shares are as detailed in note 23 relating to the LTIP awards. The exercise price for shares granted under the ESOP is nil, and the vesting conditions include employment by the Group over a three-year vesting period from the date of grant. The share-based payment charge for shares granted under the ESOP plan amounted to £nil in the year ended 30 September 2016 (2015: £nil).

 

As at 30 September 2016 the number and market value of shares held by the trust which have not yet unconditionally vested in employees is 33,054 (2015: 33,054) and £0.3 million (2015: £0.2 million) respectively.

 

  F- 35  

 

 

25. Financial Commitments

 

The Group had capital commitments for property, plant and equipment contracted but not provided for at 30 September 2016 of £5.1 million (2015: £0.7 million). Included within the commitment for the year ended 30 September 2016 is £4.0 million of property, plant and equipment associated with the commercial growing agreement explained further below.

 

At the balance sheet date the Group had outstanding commitments for future minimum lease payments under non-cancellable operating leases, which fall due as follows:

 

    Group  
   

2016

£000s

    2015
£000s
 
Within one year   2,723     1,642  
Between two and five years     8,117       4,600  
After five years     2,198       1,982  
      13,038       8,224  

 

The minimum lease payments payable under operating leases recognised as an expense in the year were £2.4 million (2015: £1.5 million).

 

Operating lease payments represent rentals payable by the Group for certain of its leased properties. Manufacturing and laboratory facilities are subject to 5 to 15-year leases, some of which have a lease break three years prior to the conclusion of the lease at the Group’s option. Office properties are subject to 1 to 10-year leases.

 

During the year ended 30 September 2016, the Group signed a commercial growing agreement with an external supplier to produce plant material for use in the Epidiolex development programmes and commercial release. This agreement commences during the second quarter of the year ended 30 September 2017 and includes multiple fee-elements designed to incentivise cost efficient, reliable production volumes of raw materials for use in research, development and commercial activities.

 

As part of the accounting treatment for this agreement a component operating lease has been identified under the requirements of IFRIC 4 Determining Whether an Arrangement Contains a Lease . Rental payments commence during the second quarter of the year ended 30 September 2017 and continue over a five-year non-cancellable period. Future minimum lease payments associated with this operating lease are included in the table shown above.

 

Other gross payments associated with this agreement, excluding operating lease rentals and capital commitments outlined above, fall due as follows

 

    Group  
   

2016

£000s

    2015
£000s
 
Within one year     6,755        
Between two and five years     36,667        
After five years   2,248      
      45,670        

 

26. Contingent Liabilities

 

As at 30 September 2016 certain fees associated with capital expenditure have been estimated. The final fees payable are to be agreed and paid once agreement is reached, which is expected during the second quarter of the year ending 30 September 2017. The Group estimates that there is a possible contingent liability for incremental fees of up to £0.4 million of capital expenditure.

 

27. Related Party Transactions

 

Remuneration of Key Management Personnel

 

The remuneration of the Directors, who are the key management personnel of the Group, is set out below in aggregate for each of the categories specified in IAS 24 Related party disclosures .

 

   

2016

£000s

    2015
£000s
    2014
£000s
 
Short-term employee benefits     2,523       2,395       2,688  
Post-employment benefits   215     211     203  
Share-based payments     4,556       1,164       666  
      7,294       3,770       3,557  

 

  F- 36  

 

 

Other Related Party Transactions

 

Group

 

The Group purchased various regulatory support services from Icon Clinical Research Limited and Icon Clinical Research (UK) Limited, which are part of Icon plc. Tom Lynch, a non-executive Director of the Group, acted as Chairman for Icon plc up to 29 March 2016. These services were at a cost of £2,044 (2015: £12,762; 2014: £12,166). As at 30 September 2016 there was £nil due in relation to these amounts (2015: £nil; 2014: £2,799).

 

The Group paid £138 (2015: £263; 2014: £3,441) under a consultancy agreement for medical writing services to Kathryn Wright, wife of the Group’s Chief Medical Officer Stephen Wright. As at 30 September 2016 there was no amount due to Kathryn Wright (2015 and 2014: £nil).

 

The Group paid £47 (2015 and 2014: £nil) to Adaptimmune Ltd in relation to travel expenses incurred by James Noble, a non-executive Director of the Group, who also acts as Chief Executive Officer for Adaptimmune Ltd. As at 30 September 2016 there was no amount due to Adaptimmune Ltd (2015 and 2014: £nil).

 

All fees outlined above were paid on an arms-length basis and were carried out in accordance with the Group’s policy regarding related party transactions.

 

As part of the consideration of the vesting of the September 2013 LTIP award, the Remuneration Committee has agreed to indemnify Justin Gover for the incremental US taxation that he is likely to suffer on the gain arising from these LTIP options as a result of having relocated to the US at the Company’s request during the vesting period for this award. As at 30 September 2016 this liability is estimated as $1.2 million, and is expected to payable when the option gain is crystallised by sale of the resulting shares, expected in late 2016/early 2017.

 

  F- 37  

 

Exhibit 4.58

 

***Certain portions of this exhibit have been omitted based on a request for confidential treatment pursuant to Rule 24b-2 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. The omitted portions have been filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

 

DATED 27 May 2016

 

( 1 )     AG KENT B.V.

( 2 )     GW PHARMA LIMITED

( 3 )     GW PHARMACEUTICALS PLC

 

ORIGINAL / COUNTERPART

 

LEASE

 

***

***

 

REFERENCE

 

SA/381631.00003

 

 

Reed Smith LLP

The Broadgate Tower

20 Primrose Street

London EC2A 2RS

Phone - +44 (0) 20 3116 3000

Fax - +44 (0) 20 3116 3999

DX1066 City / DX18 London

reedsmith.com

Reed Smith

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

CONTENTS

 

CLAUSE

 

1 INTERPRETATION 3
     
2 DEMISE AND RENT 7
     
3 TENANTS’ COVENANTS 8
     
4 LANDLORD’S COVENANTS 29
     
5 PROVISOS 33
     
6 RENT REVIEW 39
     
7 TENANT’S OPTION TO DETERMINE 43
     
8 ACCIDENTAL HAPPENINGS OR INJURIES 43
     
9 NOTICES 44
     
10 VAT 44
     
11 SURETY’S COVENANTS 44
     
12 LANDLORD AND TENANT (COVENANTS) ACT 1995 44
     
13 ADDRESS FOR RENT DEMANDS 45
     
14 LANDLORD AND TENANT ACT 1954 45
     
15 DELIVERY AS A DEED 45
     
16 RIGHTS OF THIRD PARTIES 45
     
17 GOVERNING LAW 45

 

SCHEDULE  
   
SCHEDULE 1 46
   
           RIGHTS GRANTED 46
   
SCHEDULE 2 47
   
   RIGHTS RESERVED 47
   
SCHEDULE 3 49
   
   DOCUMENTS TO BE OBSERVED 49
   
SCHEDULE 4 50
   
   SERVICE CHARGE 50
   
    PART A 50
   
   PART B 50
   
SCHEDULE 5 51
   
      INDEX-LINKED REVIEW OF SERVICE CHARGE 51

 

 

 

 

SCHEDULE 6 55
   
COVENANTS BY THE SURETY 55
   
SCHEDULE 7 57
   
    AUTHORISED GUARANTEE AGREEMENT 57
   
SCHEDULE 8 59
   
     THE REGULATIONS 59
   
SCHEDULE 9 60
   
    UTILITIES CHARGE 60
   
ANNEXURE 1 64
   
   RENT REVIEW SPECIFICATION 64
   
ANNEXURE 2 68
   
   REINSTATEMENT SPECIFICATION 68

 

  CONTENTS PAGE 2  

 

 

LAND REGISTRY PRESCRIBED CLAUSES

 

LR1 Date of lease 27 May 2016
   
LR2 Title number(s) LR2.1 Landlord’s title number(s)
   
  ***
   
  LR2.2 Other title numbers
   
  None
   
LR3 Parties to this lease Landlord
   
  AG KENT B.V. (Dutch Company Number 64764192) whose registered office is at Prinsengracht 919, 1017 KD Amsterdam, The Netherlands
   
  Tenant
   
  GW Pharma Limited a company registered in England and Wales (registered number 03704998) whose registered office is at Sovereign House, Vision Park, Chivers Way, Histon, Cambridge CB24 9BZ
   
  Other parties
   
  Surety
   
  G W Pharmaceuticals plc a company registered in England and Wales (registered number 4160917) whose registered office is at Sovereign House, Vision Park, Chivers Way, Histon, Cambridge CB24 9BZ
   
LR4 Property In the case of a conflict between this clause and the remainder of this lease then, for the purposes of registration, this clause shall prevail.
   
  The Premises as defined in clause 1.1
   
LR5 Prescribed statements etc LR5.1 Not applicable
   
  LR5.2 Not applicable
   
LR6 Term for which the Property is leased The Term is as follows -
   
  20 years from and including the Term Commencement Date

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  PAGE 1  

 

 

  Date
   
LR7 Premium None
   
LR8 Prohibitions or restrictions on disposing of this lease The lease contains a provision that prohibits or restricts dispositions
   
LR9 Rights of acquisition etc LR9.1 Tenant’s contractual rights to renew this lease, to acquire the reversion or another lease of the Property, or to acquire an interest in other land
   
  None
   
  LR9.2 Tenant’s covenant to (or offer to) surrender this lease
   
  None
   
  LR9.3 Landlord’s contractual rights to acquire this lease
   
  None
   
LR10 Restrictive covenants given in this lease by the Landlord in respect of land other than the Property None
   
LR11 Easements LR11.1 Easements granted by this lease for the benefit of the Property
   
  The rights and matters set out in Schedule 1
   
  LR11.2 Easements granted or reserved by this lease over the Property for the benefit of other property
   
  The rights and matters set out in Schedule 2
   
LR12 Estate rentcharge burdening the Property None
   
LR13 Application for standard form of restriction None
   
LR14 Declaration of trust where there is more than one person comprising the Tenant Not applicable

 

  PAGE 2  

 

 

LEASE is made on the date set out in clause LR1

 

BETWEEN:

 

(1) the Landlord as set out in clause LR3;

 

(2) the Tenant as set out in clause LR3; and

 

(3) the Surety as set out in clause LR3.

 

1 INTERPRETATION

 

1.1 In this Lease -

 

Access Roads ’ means the roads footpaths and accessways within the Science Park not adopted from time to time and the road connecting the Science Park to Broadoak Road;

 

adjoining or neighbouring premises ’ includes any part or parts of the Science Park other than the Premises;

 

Authorised Guarantee Agreement ’ means an agreement between the Landlord and the Tenant entered into by the Tenant as covenantor in the circumstances set out in clause 3.18 and containing the provisions set out in Schedule 7;

 

Break Date ’ means 15th anniversary of Term Commencement Date;

 

Break Payment ’ means such sum as is equivalent to one year’s worth of the Principal Rent at the rate payable immediately prior to the Break Date (ignoring any suspension or censer of such rent);

 

Centre Common Parts ’ means any entrances, passageways, Access Roads, Conducting Media, car parking, hardstanding, verges, landscaping and other parts of the Science Park available or intended to be available for use and/or enjoyment by two or more of the Landlord’s tenants of the Science Park in common (but for the avoidance of doubt including all car parking areas whether or not the subject of exclusive parking rights);

 

  PAGE 3  

 

 

Conducting Media ’ means tanks, pipes, cables, wires, meters, drains, sewers, gutters and other things of a similar nature for the passage of electricity, gas, water, soil and other services;

 

Environmental Audit’ means an audit of the Tenant’s activities on the Premises to be commissioned by the Landlord from time to time but not more than once per year;

 

EPC ’ means energy performance certificate and recommendation report, as defined in the Energy Performance of Buildings (Certificates and Inspections) (England and Wales) Regulations 2007 as amended or updated from time to time;

 

Existing EPC ’ means a copy of the EPC for the Premises reference no ***

 

;

 

Fit Out Rent ’ means the sum of £*** per annum;

 

Gateway Tenant ’ means an individual, partnership or company whose prime activity either is within the areas of Science or High Technology or is the provision of support directly related to the scientific community as would maintain an appropriate mix of tenants for a science park;

 

Group Company ’ means a company which is in the same group of companies (within the meaning of section 42 Landlord and Tenant Act 1954) as the Tenant;

 

High Technology ’ means research, development, design, distribution, manufacturing or service activities utilising, employing or manufacturing product or processes which apply research, pharmaceuticals, bio-technology, electronics, robotics, informatics or other such scientific disciplines as the Landlord (in conjunction with the local planning authority) determines to be representative of the field of high technology;

 

Insurance Rent ’ means the rent reserved by clause 2.4;

 

Insured Risks ’ means (to the extent insurance for such risks remains available in the London insurance market) fire, lightning, aircraft, explosion, riot, malicious persons, earthquake, storm, flood, burst pipes, impact, theft, subsidence, sprinkler leakage, terrorism and such other risks or perils (if any) as the Landlord or any superior landlord (acting reasonably) may from time to time deem it prudent to insure against;

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  PAGE 4  

 

 

Landlord ’ includes the person or persons for the time being entitled to the reversion immediately expectant on the Term;

 

Permitted Part ’ has the meaning given to that expression in clause 3.19;

 

Planning Acts ’ means and includes the ‘planning Acts’ as defined in section 117 Planning and Compulsory Purchase Act 2004 together with that Act and all other legislation from time to time imposing controls on the development or use of land;

 

Planning Agreement ’ means a Section 106 Agreement dated 15 February 2010 between Sittingbourne (No. 1) Limited and Sittingbourne (No. 2) Limited (1) and Lillian Joyce Attwood, Kevin Dennis Attwood, Michael Christopher Attwood and Attwood Farms Limited (2) Swale Borough Council (3) Kent County Council (4);

 

Premises ’ means the premises (shown edged red on the plan annexed hereto but excluding the car park edged in blue) known as ***                                         as well as any landlord’s fixtures and fittings from time to time in the Premises and each and every part of the Premises (but (if applicable) excluding the outer half, severed vertically, of any wall dividing the Premises from any adjoining or neighbouring premises);

 

Principal Rent ’ means the principal rent reserved by this Lease at the rate from time to time payable under clause 2.1 and clause 6;

 

Regulations ’ means the regulations set out in Schedule 8;

 

Reinstatement Specification ’ means the Premises Specification annexed to this Lease as Annexure 2;

 

Rent Review Specification ’ means the Premises’ base build specification annexed to this Lease as Annexure 1;

 

 

*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  PAGE 5  

 

 

Science ’ means dependence upon the application of scientific or technological skills or knowledge in the production of new goods or services for competitive advantage;

 

Science Park ’ means ***                                        and any other land from time to time owned by the Landlord which is adjoining or neighbouring;

 

Service Charge ’ means the Service Charge as defined in and calculated pursuant to Schedule 4;

 

Tenant ’ includes the successors in title and assigns of the Tenant;

 

Term ’ means the term set out in Clause LR6 together with any continuation by statute or implication of law;

 

Term Commencement Date ’ means the date of this Lease;

 

Uninsured Risk ’ means an Insured Risk against which insurance is not or ceases to be obtainable for such risk on normal commercial terms in the London insurance market at reasonable commercial rates generally available in the London insurance market for a property of this type, size and location; and

 

VAT ’ means Value Added Tax and any other tax of a similar nature.

 

1.2 In this Lease unless there be something in the context inconsistent therewith -

 

(a) words importing the masculine gender shall include the feminine gender and vice versa and words importing the singular shall include the plural and vice versa and words importing persons and all references to persons shall include companies, corporations and firms and vice versa;

 

(b) if at any time two or more persons are included in the expression the `Landlord’, the ‘Tenant’ or the ‘Surety’ then covenants contained in this Lease or implied by or on the part of the Landlord, the Tenant or the Surety as the case may be shall be deemed to be and shall be construed as covenants entered into by and binding on such persons jointly and severally;

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

  

  PAGE 6  

 

 

(c) wherever the consent or approval of the Landlord is required it may be given subject to the Tenant obtaining any necessary further consent or approval under any headlease and nothing in this Lease implies that such further consent or approval under any headlease will not be unreasonably withheld;

 

(d) where the Tenant is placed under a restriction by this Lease it includes an obligation not to permit or allow the restriction to be infringed;

 

(e) references to ‘lease’ shall include ‘underlease’ and vice versa.

 

2 DEMISE AND RENT

 

The Landlord at the request of the Surety demises unto the Tenant ALL THOSE the Premises TOGETHER with the particular rights set out in Schedule 1 BUT EXCEPT AND RESERVED AND SUBJECT to the particular rights and matters set out in Schedule 2 AND SUBJECT ALSO to the matters contained or referred to in the documents brief particulars of which are set out in Schedule 3 TO HOLD the Premises unto the Tenant (together with but except and reserved and subject as above) for the Term YIELDING AND PAYING to the Landlord during the Term and so in proportion for any time less than a year without any deductions whatsoever the following rents namely -

 

2.1 from and including the Term Commencement Date until and including 26 May 2017 the yearly rent of £*** per annum and from and including 27 May 2017 for the remainder of the Term the yearly rent of £*** per annum or such higher yearly rent as may become payable pursuant to review under clause 6, such sums payable by equal quarterly payments in advance on the four usual quarter days in each year of which the first payment (being the due proportion for the period commencing on and including the Term Commencement Date and ending on and including the day before the first quarter day after the Term Commencement Date) shall be paid on or before the date of this Lease;

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  PAGE 7  

 

 

2.2 from and including the Term Commencement Date until and including 26 May 2031 by equal quarterly payments in advance on the four usual quarter days in each year, the Fit Out Rent, of which the first payment (being the due proportion for the period commencing on and including the Term Commencement Date and ending on and including the day before the first quarter day after the Term Commencement Date) shall be paid on or before the date of this Lease;

 

2.3 throughout the Term sums equal to a just proportion fairly attributable to the Premises of the total amounts which the Landlord shall from time to time expend by way of premium and incidental costs (including the cost of periodic valuations and any premium payable under any headlease and the whole of any increase in any premium from time to time as a result of or arising out of the manner or the purposes in or for which the Premises are kept used and occupied) in effecting and maintaining the several insurances referred to in clause 4.1 (together with any insurance effected by the Landlord against public liability risks in respect of the Science Park) each such sum to be paid within 14 days following written demand the first such payment in respect of amounts already so expended by the Landlord (being the due proportion commencing on and including the Term Commencement Date to the next renewal date or dates for such insurances) to be paid on or before the date of this Lease and in the event of any dispute as to any such sum the same shall be determined by the Landlord’s surveyor (acting as an independent expert and not as an arbitrator) whose determination shall in the absence of manifest error be final and binding on the parties;

 

2.4 throughout the Term sums equal to the Service Charge at the times and in the manner specified in Schedule 4; and

 

2.5 VAT on the rents reserved by this Lease payable at the time such rents are payable.

 

3 TENANTS’ COVENANTS

 

The Tenant to the intent that the obligations created shall continue throughout the whole of the Term COVENANTS with the Landlord as follows –

 

  PAGE 8  

 

 

3.1 PAY RENT

 

(a) To pay the Principal Rent, the Fit-Out Rent, the Insurance Rent and the Service Charge at the times and in the manner required by clause 2 without deduction or set off and to pay the Principal Rent, the Fit-Out Rent and the Fixed Charge (as defined in Schedule 5) by bankers standing order or similar form of bank transfer if so required by the Landlord.

 

(b) To pay all rents and other sums as they fall due under this Lease whether or not such rents or other sums relate to a period before the Term became vested in the Tenant (provided such rents or other sums do not relate to any period prior to the commencement of the Term).

 

3.2 PAY OUTGOINGS

 

(a) To pay and keep the Landlord fully indemnified from and against all liability for all general and other rates of whatever nature or kind and all taxes, charges, duties, levies, assessments, impositions and outgoings whatever (whether parliamentary, parochial, local or of any other description) which are now or may become rated taxed charged levied assessed or imposed upon the Premises or the owner, landlord, tenant or occupier of the Premises and whether or not required to be paid by the Tenant himself but ‘taxes’ does not include value added tax or taxes imposed on the Landlord in respect of the yearly rent reserved by this Lease or in respect of a disposal of the interest in immediate reversion to this Lease.

 

(b) Where not supplied directly by the relevant utility company to the Tenant to pay to the Landlord the cost (which may for the avoidance of doubt and without limitation include reasonable provision for management by the Landlord’s own staff) incurred by the Landlord in or incidental to arranging for the supply of services pursuant to clause 4.4 consumed at the Premises, such payment to be made in accordance with the provisions of Schedule 9 (which provisions are hereby incorporated).

 

  PAGE 9  

 

 

SAVE THAT whilst the Tenant is GW Pharma Limited or a Group Company of GW Pharma Limited or of GW Pharmaceuticals plc Schedule 9 shall not apply and the Tenant shall pay such cost within 14 days of written demand (and where not separately metered such cost shall be a due proportion determined by the Landlord (acting reasonably) of such costs payable or incurred by the Landlord in respect of the Premises together with other premises).

 

3.3 REPAIR AND DECORATE

 

(a) (Damage by the Insured Risks always excepted unless the policy or policies of insurance effected by the Landlord against them shall be rendered void or payment of the insurance moneys be refused in whole or in part by reason of or arising out of any act, omission, neglect or default by the Tenant or any subtenant or other person under the control of the Tenant or any subtenant) to keep the Premises in good and substantial repair and in good decorative and clean condition with the glass cleaned both inside and (unless the cost of the same is being met by the Tenant as part of the Service Charge) outside at least once a month.

 

(b) (Without prejudice to the generality of the above obligations of the Tenant) in a good and workmanlike manner whenever necessary and also in the last three months of the Term (however and whenever it may terminate) to decorate the Premises and in the case of decoration in the last three months of the Term the Landlord shall have the right to insist on a particular colour scheme being used.

 

3.4 OBSERVE LEGISLATION

 

(a) To observe and perform all requirements of any Act of Parliament, local Act or bylaw and notices issued under such legislation or by any public, local or other competent authority (together referred to in this clause 3.4 as ‘ Acts ’) (whether or not required of the Tenant himself) in any way affecting the Premises or any thing in or any activity carried on by persons resorting to or working or employed at the Premises or the use and occupation of the Premises within the time prescribed by law or the notice requiring the same (or if no time is so prescribed then within a reasonable time) to the reasonable satisfaction of the Landlord and to indemnify and keep the Landlord fully indemnified against all such requirements and all actions, proceedings, costs, claims, demands, expenses and liability whatever arising out of or in connection with non-observance or non-performance of such requirements.

 

  PAGE 10  

 

 

(b) At its own expense to obtain from the appropriate authorities all licences consents and permissions as may be required for the carrying out by the Tenant of any operations on or for the use of any part of the Premises.

 

(c) Not to do anything in the Premises or cause them to be used or occupied in such a way that the Landlord or any tenant or occupier of the Science Park is disabled from complying with any Acts in respect of the whole or any part of the Science Park or may under any Acts incur or have imposed upon it or become liable to pay any penalty damages compensation costs charges or expenses.

 

(d) In particular but without prejudice to the generality of the foregoing to comply with all the lawful requirements from time to time of the following bodies or their successors -

 

(i) Health and Safety Executive;

 

(ii) Environment Agency;

 

(iii) Home Office;

 

(iv) Department of Health;

 

(v) ***                   

 

(vi) HM Revenue and Customs;

 

(vii) Department for Environment Food and Rural Affairs; and

 

(viii) Health Protection Agency.

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

  

  PAGE 11  

 

 

3.5 YIELD UP

 

Quietly to surrender and yield up the Premises to the Landlord (or as the Landlord may direct) at the end or sooner determination of the Term in the state and condition evidenced in the Reinstatement Specification and the Tenant agrees at the end or sooner determination of the Term -

 

(a) to hand over to the Landlord all keys relating to the Premises; and

 

(b) to provide the Landlord with details of the utility companies providing utilities to the Premises and with sufficient details of the Tenant’s accounts with such utility companies (so far as relating to the Premises) to enable the Landlord to contact the utility companies in relation to such accounts.

 

3.6 ENTRY BY LANDLORD

 

(a) To permit the Landlord and others authorised by the Landlord after at least three days’ prior notice (except in an emergency when no notice need be given) to enter upon the Premises to view and inspect the Premises and ascertain how the Premises are being used and occupied and their state and condition and to take schedules of all landlord’s fixtures and fittings and to estimate the current value of the Premises for insurance, mortgage or other purposes and to carry out an Environmental Audit.

 

(b) Whenever on any such inspection anything is found which constitutes a breach, non-performance or non-observance of the covenants on the part of the Tenant contained in this Lease and of which the Landlord gives notice to the Tenant to commence to remedy and make good the same within one month of the date of such notice (or immediately in the case of any breach, non-performance or non-observance of clause 3.26 or in respect of any other matter which the Landlord reasonably deems as requiring immediate remedial action) and thereafter proceed diligently with the requisite works but if the Tenant shall fail so to do to permit the Landlord if it so desires (although the Landlord shall be under no obligation so to do) without prejudice to the Landlord’s right of re-entry or any other right or remedy of the Landlord to enter upon the Premises with contractors, workmen and others and all necessary equipment, tools and materials and to execute or complete such works and to pay to the Landlord on written demand either during or on completion of such works as the Landlord may require the costs and expenses incurred by the Landlord together with all solicitors’, surveyors’ and other professional fees and expenses incurred by the Landlord in relation to such works.

 

  PAGE 12  

 

 

3.7 WORKS TO ADJOINING OR NEIGHBOURING PREMISES

 

To permit the Landlord and others authorised by the Landlord and their respective agents and contractors to enter upon the Premises with workmen and others and all necessary equipment, tools and materials after at least three days’ prior written notice (except in an emergency when no prior written notice need be given) in order to carry out repairs, alterations, additions or any other works to or of any adjoining or neighbouring premises which cannot reasonably be carried out without entry on to the Premises PROVIDED ALWAYS that the persons so entering shall -

 

(a) be accompanied at all times by a representative of the Tenant (provided such a representative is made available for such purpose);

 

(b) cause as little inconvenience and disruption as possible to the Tenant and the other occupiers of the Premises; and

 

(c) with the minimum of delay and make good all damage thereby caused to the Premises to the reasonable satisfaction of the Tenant.

 

3.8 COSTS OF DEFAULT

 

To pay all proper costs, charges and expenses (including solicitors’ costs and bailiffs’, architects’ and surveyors’ fees) reasonably payable by the Landlord for the purposes of and incidental to the preparation, service and enforcement (whether by proceedings or otherwise) of -

 

  PAGE 13  

 

 

(a) any notice under section 146 or 147 Law of Property Act 1925 requiring the Tenant to remedy a breach of any of the Tenant’s obligations hereunder notwithstanding forfeiture for any such breach shall be avoided otherwise than by relief granted by the Court;

 

(b) any notice to repair or schedule of dilapidations accrued at or prior to the end or sooner determination of the Term whether served during or within three months after the end of the Term;

 

(c) the payment of any arrears in the rents reserved by this Lease;

 

and in default of payment all such sums shall be recoverable as rent in arrears.

 

3.9 USER

 

(a) Not to use the Premises otherwise than for any use within Class B1 of the Town and Country Planning (Use Classes) Order 1987 (as in force at the date of the agreement for lease pursuant to which this Lease was entered into) (but not as diplomatic offices or as a betting office or bookmaker’s office) and not in any other manner or for any other purpose or for any immoral or unlawful purpose or for any sale by auction and the Tenant acknowledges that nothing in this Lease constitutes a warranty that the above use complies or will continue to comply with the Planning Acts and the Tenant shall not be entitled to any relief or compensation whatsoever from the Landlord in that respect.

 

(b) Not to keep any animal on or about the Premises nor to conduct allow or permit to be conducted anywhere on or about the Premises any research or experiments of any kind on or involving animals of whatever kind whether live or dead.

 

(c) Not to carry out (nor to allow or permit to be carried out) on or from the Premises research into or involving any of the following -

 

(i) genetic modification within the meaning of Directive 2001/18/EC;

 

  PAGE 14  

 

 

(ii) human embryology within the meaning of the Human Fertilisation and Embryology Act 1990 (as amended); and/or

 

(iii) cloning, being (for the purposes of this clause) any process, including techniques of embryo splitting, designed to create a human being (or animal) with the same nuclear genetic information as another living or deceased human being (or animal as the case may be).

 

(d) Not to overload any floor of the Premises or any lift in or serving the Premises and not to pass anything of a harmful nature through the Conducting Media in or serving the Premises (whether exclusively or jointly with other premises) or do anything at the Premises which shall be or may become a nuisance (whether indictable or not) or which shall cause any damage or disturbance to the Landlord or the owners, tenants or occupiers from time to time of any adjoining or neighbouring premises.

 

3.10 ALTERATIONS

 

(a) (Without prejudice to sub clause (b) of this clause) not to carry out any alterations, additions or other works to the Premises (whether structural or non-structural) without the prior written consent of the Landlord having been obtained (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed and provided that — without prejudice to the generality of the foregoing — it shall be reasonable for the Landlord to withhold consent in any circumstances where a proposed alteration or addition to any of the Conducting Media or the systems for the supply of heating, air-conditioning (if any), lighting, electric power or water installed within or upon the Premises would or might have a material adverse impact upon the Existing EPC rating (and it is agreed that a downgrade in the Existing EPC rating shall constitute a material adverse impact).

 

(b) Not to carry out any alterations, additions or other works to the Premises before all necessary approvals, consents, licences, permits or permissions of any competent authority, body or person have been obtained and such alterations, additions or works shall be carried out strictly in accordance with their terms and conditions.

 

  PAGE 15  

 

 

(c) To permit the Landlord and others authorised by the Landlord to enter upon the Premises at reasonable hours during the daytime for the purpose of seeing that all alterations, additions or other works are being or have been carried out in all respects in conformity with this clause and immediately upon being required to do so to remove any alteration, addition or other works of or to the Premises which do not so conform or in respect of which any such approvals, consents, licences, permits or permissions of the competent authority, body or person have been withdrawn or have lapsed and thereupon to make good all damage caused to the Premises and restore and reinstate all affected parts of the Premises to the reasonable satisfaction of the Landlord.

 

(d) If any alterations or additions are made to the Premises, within 30 days following completion of such works to give written notice to the Landlord and at the same time (or at such later date as is reasonable) to provide to the Landlord a copy of the as-built drawings for such works.

 

(e) To pay as additional rent any sums which the Landlord may properly expend by way of additional premiums for the insurance of the Premises by reason of any alterations or additions made to the Premises by the Tenant.

 

3.11 SIGNAGE

 

No fascia, sign, name plate, bill, notice, placard, advertisement or similar device shall be affixed to or displayed in or on any part of the Premises so as to be visible from the exterior other than those indicating the name of any occupier for the time being and his business and which have (with their size and positioning) been previously approved by the Landlord in writing (such approval not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed).

 

  PAGE 16  

 

 

3.12 AERIALS, ETC

 

No television or wireless or other form of mast or aerial nor any flagpole shall be affixed to any part of the exterior of the Premises other than those which have (with their positioning) been previously approved by the Landlord in writing (such approval not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed).

 

3.13 PLANNING ACTS

 

(a) Without prejudice to the generality of clause 3.4 fully to observe and perform all the requirements of the Planning Acts in respect of the Premises or their use and all the requirements of any approval, consent, licence, permit or permission granted under the Planning Acts which remain lawfully enforceable and affect the Premises and to indemnify and keep the Landlord fully indemnified from and against all actions, proceedings, costs, claims, demands, expenses and liability whatsoever arising out of or in connection with any non-observance or non-performance of this covenant.

 

(b) No application shall be made for any approval, consent, licence, permit, permission, certificate or determination under the Planning Acts in respect of the Premises without the prior written consent of the Landlord (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed).

 

(c) Unless the Landlord shall otherwise direct in writing to carry out to the reasonable satisfaction of the Landlord during the Term (however and whenever it may terminate) all works to the Premises which as a condition of any such approval, consent, licence, permit or permission obtained by or on behalf of the Tenant or any subtenant are required to be carried out at the Premises by a date after the Term (however and whenever it may terminate).

 

(d) The Tenant shall not be liable for any costs arising in relation to compliance with or the failure to comply with the Planning Agreement by any person.

 

  PAGE 17  

 

 

3.14 STATUTORY NOTICES

 

To give the Landlord a copy of every notice of whatsoever nature affecting or likely to affect the Premises made given or issued by or on behalf of the local planning authority or any other authority, body or person having lawful jurisdiction within seven days of its receipt by the Tenant or any subtenant and to produce the original to the Landlord on written request and to take all reasonable and necessary steps to comply with every such notice And if so required in writing by or on behalf of the Landlord to make or join with the Landlord and any other persons for the time being interested in the Premises or any lawful adjoining or neighbouring premises in making such objections or representations against or in respect of any such notice as the Landlord may reasonably and properly require provided that such objections or representations are not adverse to the legitimate business interests of the Tenant.

 

3.15 INSURER’S REQUIREMENTS

 

(a) (Save with the prior written consent of the Landlord) nothing of a noxious, dangerous, explosive or inflammable nature shall be stored, placed or kept or remain on the Premises nor (subject and to the extent that the Tenant has received appropriate details and notification from the Landlord of such insurances) shall any other thing be done in or about the Premises by the Tenant or any subtenant which does or may invalidate or render void or voidable or cause any increased premium to be payable for any policy of insurance maintained by the Landlord in respect of the Premises or any adjoining or neighbouring premises.

 

(b) To repay to the Landlord upon written demand as part of the Insurance Rent an amount equal to any such increased premium referred to in sub clause (a) of this clause as may become so payable.

 

(c) If the Premises or any other premises shall be destroyed or damaged as a result of any matter referred to in sub clause (a) of this clause or as a result of any act, omission, neglect or default by or on the part of the Tenant or any subtenant or any person under the control of the Tenant or any subtenant as a result of which any policy of insurance maintained by the Landlord is rendered void or payment of the insurance money is refused in whole or in part, to pay to the Landlord within 21 days of written demand the amount so refused or which would (other than for the policy having been rendered void as aforesaid) have been payable.

 

  PAGE 18  

 

 

3.16 TO LET BOARD

 

To permit the Landlord during the period of six months immediately preceding the end or sooner determination of the Term (and at any time during the Term in the event of any proposed disposal by the Landlord of its interest in the Premises or in any of the events set out in clause 5.2) to affix and retain on any part of the Premises (but not so as materially to interfere with any trade or business carried on at the Premises or with reasonable access of light and air to the Premises) notices and boards relating to any proposed disposal by the Landlord of its interest in the Premises for reletting or otherwise dealing with the same and to permit all persons with written authority from the Landlord or the Landlord’s agents to inspect and view the Premises at reasonable times of the day by previous appointment.

 

3.17 PROHIBITED ALIENATION

 

(a) The Tenant shall not assign, transfer, mortgage or charge any part (as opposed to the whole) of the Premises nor, save as permitted by Clauses 3.17(b), 3.18, and 3.19, assign, transfer, part with or share possession or occupation of the whole of the Premises or underlet, part with or share possession of any part of the Premises.

 

(b) Nothing in clause 3.17(a) shall restrict the right of the Tenant to allow any Group Company to occupy or share the occupation of the Premises from time to time which the Tenant shall be entitled to do without the consent of the Landlord PROVIDED THAT -

 

(i) no relationship of landlord and tenant shall be created or deemed to exist between the Tenant and the Group Company;

 

  PAGE 19  

 

 

(ii) the Group Company shall not be permitted to have exclusive occupation of the whole or any part or parts of the Premises; and

 

(iii) the relevant company shall vacate the Premises forthwith upon ceasing to be a Group Company.

 

3.18 ASSIGNMENT

 

(a) Not to assign the whole of the Premises without the prior written consent of the Landlord (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed) provided that the Landlord shall be entitled -

 

(i) to withhold its consent in the circumstances set out in sub clause (c);

 

(ii) to impose all or any of the matters set out in sub clause (d) as a condition of its consent.

 

(b) The provisos to sub clause (a) shall operate without prejudice to the right of the Landlord to withhold such consent on any other ground or grounds where such withholding of consent on such other ground or grounds would be reasonable or to impose any further condition or conditions upon the grant of consent where the imposition of such condition or conditions would be reasonable.

 

(c) The circumstances referred to in sub clause (a)(i) are as follows -

 

(i) where the assignee is a Group Company unless in the reasonable opinion of the Landlord the assignee (when assessed together with any proposed guarantor for the assignee) is of at least equivalent financial standing to the Tenant; and

 

(ii) where in the reasonable opinion of the Landlord the assignee is not a Gateway Tenant.

 

  PAGE 20  

 

 

(d) The conditions referred to in sub clause (a)(ii) are as follows -

 

(i) the execution and delivery by the Tenant to the Landlord prior to the assignment in question of a deed of guarantee (being an Authorised Guarantee Agreement);

 

(ii) the payment to the Landlord of all rents which have fallen due under the Lease prior to the date of assignment;

 

(iii) the giving of any requisite consent of any superior landlord or mortgagee and the fulfilment of any lawful condition of such consent; and

 

(iv) if reasonably required by the Landlord either -

 

(1) the execution and delivery to the Landlord prior to the assignment of a rent deposit deed in such form as the Landlord shall reasonably require together with the payment to the Landlord by way of cleared funds of the amount of the rent deposit (being a reasonable sum) specified in the rent deposit deed; or

 

(2) the execution and delivery to the Landlord of a deed of guarantee entered into by a third party guarantor reasonably acceptable to the Landlord incorporating the provisions of Schedule 6.

 

3.19 SUBLETTING

 

(a) Not to sublet the whole of the Premises (and not to sublet a Permitted Part, meaning a complete floor or floors of the Premises) Provided for the avoidance of doubt that there shall be no more than two underleases of Permitted Parts in existence at any one time (not including the Tenant’s own occupation of the Premises) except in accordance with the provisions of sub clauses (b), (c), (d), (e) and (f) of this clause 3.19.

 

(b) Not to sublet the Premises or agree to sublet the Premises (or a Permitted Part) at less than the open market rent then reasonably obtainable for the whole or the Permitted Part (as the case may be) of the Premises with vacant possession without fine or premium being taken (but this shall not preclude the payment of any fine or premium or concessions or incentives which are standard in the market at the time of the subletting) nor to do so without provision for upwards only review of such rent as at each Review Date (as defined in clause 6.1(a)) which shall occur during the term of the relevant underlease in a similar manner (mutatis mutandis) as provided in clause 6 and every permitted underlease (whether mediate or immediate) of the whole or any Permitted Part of the Premises shall (so far as applicable) contain covenants by the subtenant in the same form as those contained in clauses 3.17, 3.18 and 3.19.

 

  PAGE 21  

 

 

(c) Before or at the same time as any subletting of the whole of the Premises or of a Permitted Part of the Premises shall be effected the proposed subtenant shall enter into direct covenants with the Landlord in such form as the Landlord shall reasonably require to observe and perform all the covenants and agreements on the part of the Tenant and the stipulations and conditions contained in this Lease (other than the payment of the Principal Rent, the Fit-Out Rent, the Insurance Rent and the Service Charge) during the term of the underlease.

 

(d) Any underlease shall contain a valid and effective agreement to exclude the provisions of sections 24-28 (inclusive) of the Landlord and Tenant Act 1954 in relation to such underlease.

 

(e) The Tenant shall not sublet the Premises or agree to sublet the Premises otherwise than to a subtenant who in the reasonable opinion of the Landlord is a Gateway Tenant.

 

(f) Subject and without prejudice to the other provisions of this clause there shall be no subletting of the whole of the Premises or of a Permitted Part of the Premises without the prior written consent of the Landlord (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed).

 

(g) Notwithstanding the remainder of clauses 3.17, 3.18 and 3.19, the Tenant shall be entitled to share occupation of the whole or part of the Premises with any Group Company on terms which do not create any relationship of landlord and tenant provided that -

 

  PAGE 22  

 

 

(i) the Tenant shall give notice to the Landlord within 28 days of the commencement or termination of such arrangement; and

 

(ii) any such arrangement shall terminate on the Tenant and any such member of the group ceasing to be Group Companies.

 

3.20 REGISTRATION OF DEALINGS

 

Within 21 days of every assignment or transfer (whether by deed, will or otherwise) and every mortgage or charge and every permitted subletting of the Premises or a Permitted Part and upon every other disposition or transmission or devolution of the Premises (including all Orders of Court, Probates and Letters of Administration) notice shall be given to the Landlord’s solicitors with the date and short particulars of the dealing and the names and addresses of every party and at the same time the deed, document or instrument creating or evidencing the dealing shall be produced to the Landlord’s solicitors for registration (with a certified copy for retention by the Landlord) and such solicitors’ reasonable fee of not less than £*** for such registration shall be paid by the Tenant.

 

3.21 ENCROACHMENTS

 

(a) Not to effect, authorise or permit any encroachment upon or acquisition of any right, easement, quasi-right, quasi-easement or privilege adversely affecting the Premises or any closing or obstruction of the access of light or air to any windows or openings of the Premises nor to give any acknowledgement to any third party that the enjoyment of access of light or air is by the consent of such third party or give any consideration to any third party or enter into any agreement with any third party for the purpose of inducing or binding such third party to abstain from obstructing the access of light or air.

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  PAGE 23  

 

 

(b) If any such encroachment or acquisition or closing or obstruction shall be threatened or attempted to give notice of the dealing to the Landlord as soon as the same comes to the knowledge of the Tenant or of any subtenant and upon request by the Landlord to take immediate steps (in conjunction with the Landlord and other interested persons if the Landlord shall so require) and to adopt all such lawful means and do all such lawful things as the Landlord may reasonably deem appropriate for preventing any such encroachment or acquisition.

 

3.22 COSTS OF APPLICATIONS

 

To pay all reasonable and proper costs and expenses (including surveyors’ fees and solicitors’ charges and all disbursements) reasonably and properly incurred or payable by the Landlord in respect of every application to the Landlord for any consent or approval hereunder whether or not such consent or approval is granted or refused or the application for same is withdrawn save where a consent is withheld unlawfully or unlawful conditions are imposed.

 

3.23 OBSERVE DOCUMENTS

 

By way of indemnity only to observe and perform the agreements, covenants and stipulations contained or referred to in the documents brief particulars of which are set out in Schedule 3 in so far as the same are still subsisting, relate to the Premises and are capable of being enforced against the Premises or the owner, landlord, tenant or occupier of the Premises and to keep the Landlord throughout the Term fully indemnified against all actions, proceedings, costs, claims, demands, expenses and liability in any way incurred by or made against the Landlord arising as a result of a breach by the Tenant of this covenant.

 

3.24 ENERGY PERFORMANCE CERTIFICATE

 

(a) Not to obtain an EPC for the Premises without the consent of the Landlord (not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed where an EPC is required by statute).

 

  PAGE 24  

 

 

(b) Where supplied directly to the Tenant by the relevant utility company rather than by the Landlord, to provide to the Landlord within a reasonable period following written request any such information to the extent that the same is in the possession of the Tenant as may be reasonably required to enable the Landlord to measure or assess energy consumed at the Premises.

 

(c) It shall be reasonable for the Landlord to withhold consent pursuant to clause 3.24(a) if -

 

(i) the Existing EPC remains valid; or

 

(ii) the Landlord provides to the Tenant a valid EPC for the Premises; or

 

(iii) the Landlord agrees to obtain an EPC for the Premises.

 

(d) If the Tenant requests (and the Landlord provides) any information in order to allow an energy assessor to prepare an EPC then the Tenant shall on demand pay to the Landlord the Landlord’s costs and expenses incurred in providing such information.

 

3.25 KEYHOLDER

 

To ensure that at all times the Landlord has written notice of the name home address and home telephone number of at least two keyholders of the Premises.

 

3.26 ENVIRONMENTAL LIABILITY

 

(a) In this clause -

 

(i) Environmental Claim ’ means any formal written notice given by any person or body including without limitation any relevant enforcing or regulatory authority alleging liability or potential liability including (without limitation) investigatory costs remedial costs administrative costs fines damages and penalties arising out of or based on or resulting from either regulatory civil or criminal action relating to either the presence or release migration or escape into the environment of any Hazardous Materials and forming the basis of any infringement of any Environmental Laws;

 

  PAGE 25  

 

 

(ii) Environmental Laws ’ means all legal requirements relating to the pollution or protection of the environment (as defined in Section 1(2) of the Environmental Protection Act 1990) or harm to human health or the environment including without limitation those relating to Environmental Matters or otherwise relating to the manufacture processing distribution use treatment storage keeping disposal transport or handling of Hazardous Materials or of goods containing Hazardous Materials;

 

(iii) Environmental Matters ’ means waste (as defined in Section 75 of the Environmental Protection Act 1990), contaminated land, discharges and emissions of Hazardous Materials into any environmental medium, noise and vibration, heat light and radiation, dangerous hazardous or toxic substances and materials, nuisance (including statutory nuisance) and health and safety;

 

(iv) Hazardous Materials ’ means all chemicals pollutants contaminants waste petroleum petroleum products pesticides dangerous or noxious or hazardous or toxic or carcinogenic or radioactive or explosive or combustible or inflammable substances and materials (in each case whether in the form of a solid liquid, gas or vapour, and whether alone or in combination) which are in each case causing or in a condition capable of causing harm or damage to the environment or to the health and safety of persons;

 

(v) Pre-existing Environmental Matters ’ means the presence of any Hazardous Materials at the Premises or any Environmental Matters in existence at the Premises in either case prior to the first occupation of the Premises by the Tenant (except to the extent the condition of such Hazardous Materials or Environmental Matters has been made worse by the act or negligent omission of the Tenant).

 

  PAGE 26  

 

 

(b) Save in relation to Pre-existing Environmental Matters, not to discharge or permit or suffer to be discharged any Hazardous Materials from the Premises to any adjoining or neighbouring property and not to cause contamination or pollution at, on, in or under the Premises.

 

(c) As soon as is reasonably practicable to notify the Landlord in writing of the following and to supply to the Landlord such further information relating to such matters as the Landlord may reasonably (save for information which has the benefit of legal privilege) require -

 

(i) the presence at the Premises of any Hazardous Materials in any condition or any occurrence on the Premises that either results or could result in the breach of the terms of this Lease relating to Environmental Matters or that might form the basis of an Environmental Claim in respect of the Premises or any other property;

 

(ii) any pending or threatened Environmental Claim in respect of the Premises.

 

(d) If the Landlord acting reasonably shall believe that the terms of this Lease relating to Environmental Matters have been breached or that Hazardous Materials (other than petrol in the petrol tanks of vehicles at the Premises in accordance with the provisions of this Lease or usual waste or any Hazardous Materials used in the ordinary course of the Tenant’s business which have been notified to and approved by the Landlord acting reasonably) have been brought on to the Premises then the Landlord may cause an independent environmental consultant chosen by the Landlord to make an inspection of the Premises (including making such tests and taking such samples as the consultant considers necessary or desirable) on such terms as the Landlord shall reasonably determine Provided that if such inspection reveals that the terms of this Lease have been so breached the Tenant shall pay to the Landlord on demand the costs and expenses of such inspection.

 

  PAGE 27  

 

 

(e) Whenever required by the Landlord and save in relation to Pre-existing Environmental Matters, the Tenant shall at the Landlord’s option either -

 

(i) carry out at the Tenant’s expense such remedial works as the Landlord shall reasonably require to ensure that the Premises comply with all Environmental Laws insofar as any act default or omission of the Tenant has caused or is causing a breach of such laws; or

 

(ii) grant the Landlord uninterrupted access to carry out such remedial works and reimburse the Landlord on demand all costs and expenses of and associated with such remedial works.

 

(f) Save in relation to Pre-existing Environmental Matters, to keep the Landlord indemnified from and against all expenses, costs, claims, demands, losses, liabilities, damages, fines and penalties which the Landlord may suffer or incur as a consequence of Environmental Claims arising out of any act default or omission of the Tenant and against all expenses, costs, claims, demands, losses, liabilities, damages, fines and penalties in respect of or arising from damage to or pollution of the environment or damage to property or harm to human health caused or permitted by the Tenant at the Premises and against all expenses, costs, claims, demands, losses, liabilities, damages, fines and penalties arising from the Tenant’s breach of its covenants given in this clause 3.26.

 

(g) To comply with the Regulations and all such further reasonable regulations and directions as the Landlord may from time to time make and provide to the Tenant in writing. Insofar as there is any inconsistency between the terms of such regulations or directions and this Lease, the terms of this Lease shall prevail.

 

(h) The Tenant hereby acknowledges and covenants that its obligations and all its liabilities in relation to all Environmental Claims and environmental matters arising during the subsistence of this Lease shall continue despite expiry or sooner determination of this Lease.

 

  PAGE 28  

 

 

4 LANDLORD’S COVENANTS

 

The Landlord COVENANTS with the Tenant as follows -

 

4.1 INSURE

 

(a) To insure and (unless such insurance shall become void by reason of any act, omission, neglect or default by or on the part of the Tenant or any subtenant or other person under the control of the Tenant or any subtenant) to keep insured (and pay all premiums for insuring) the Science Park including the Premises (whether or not with other premises) with a reputable insurance office in the United Kingdom against loss or damage by the Insured Risks for the full reinstatement cost together with insurance against -

 

(i) architects’, surveyors’ and other professional advisers’ fees at the usual scales current for the time being and the cost of demolition and site clearance consequent upon rebuilding or reinstatement; and

 

(ii) three years’ loss of the Principal Rent, the Fit-Out Rent and the Service Charge or loss of the Principal Rent, the Fit-Out Rent and the Service Charge for such longer period as the Landlord shall in its absolute discretion (acting reasonably) deem necessary for the rebuilding or reinstatement of the Premises taking into account any likely increases in such rents during such period

 

subject to such exclusions, conditions, limitations and uninsured excesses as the insurer may reasonably apply, provided that the Landlord shall use reasonable endeavours to ensure that any such exclusions, conditions, limitations and uninsured excesses are no more onerous than would be applied as standard in the London insurance market to a policy at normal commercial rates for a property of this location, size and type.

 

  PAGE 29  

 

 

(b) If the Premises (or those parts of the Centre Common Parts that provide access to the Premises) shall at any time or times be destroyed or damaged by any of the Insured Risks -

 

(i) to apply all such moneys (except moneys received in respect of loss or damage of or to such adjoining or neighbouring premises or any fixtures and fittings liability to third parties or loss of rent) as the Landlord may receive under or by virtue of such insurance in rebuilding or reinstating the Premises or such parts as may have been damaged or destroyed or the means of access to the same (as the case may be) as expeditiously as possible (subject always to the Landlord being able to obtain all such approvals, consents, licences, permits and permissions from any superior landlord or other competent authorities (which the Landlord shall use reasonable endeavours to obtain) and all such materials and labour as may be necessary for such rebuilding and reinstatement); and

 

(ii) (save to the extent payment of the insurance moneys shall be refused in whole or in part by reason of any act, omission, neglect or default by or on the part of the Tenant or any subtenant or other person under the control of the Tenant or any subtenant and the Tenant fails to pay such monies to the Landlord in accordance with clause 3.15(c)) to pay any shortfall out of its own moneys.

 

(c) To cause a note of the Tenant’s interest (either generally or specifically) to be endorsed on the insurance policy or policies and to produce to the Tenant within a reasonable time following demand (but not more than once in every year) a copy of the Landlord’s insurance policy or policies required to be effected by the Landlord in respect of the Science Park (including the Premises) pursuant to this clause 4.1 and reasonable evidence of the payment of the insurance premium for the same.

 

  PAGE 30  

 

 

4.2 QUIET ENJOYMENT

 

That the Tenant paying the Principal Rent, the Fit-Out Rent (if applicable) the Insurance Rent, the Service Charge and all other moneys which may become payable hereunder by the Tenant and observing and performing the several covenants and agreements on the Tenant’s part and the conditions and stipulations contained in this Lease shall and may peaceably hold and enjoy the Premises during the Term in accordance with the provisions of this Lease without any lawful interruption by the Landlord or any person lawfully claiming under or in trust for the Landlord or by title paramount.

 

4.3 PROVIDE SERVICES

 

(Unless prevented by strikes, lockouts, unavailability of materials or labour or by any other matter outside the control of the Landlord and so long as the Tenant shall pay the Service Charge) to use its best endeavours to carry out the works and to provide the services referred to in Schedule 4 Part B, and provided that the Landlord shall not be liable to the Tenant for any loss, damage or inconvenience which may be caused because of -

 

(a) temporary interruption of such services during periods of inspection, maintenance, repair and renewal so long as such periods are kept as short as reasonably practicable and the Landlord shall use all reasonable endeavours to prevent or mitigate the effect of such interruption and to restore the services as soon as possible; or

 

(b) the breakdown, failure, stoppage, leaking, bursting or defect of any Conducting Media provided the Landlord uses its best endeavours to remedy such matters (so far as they are within its control) as soon as reasonably practicable.

 

4.4 PROVISION OF POWER WATER ETC

 

(a) Until such time (if any) as the Landlord shall arrange for the provision of all or any of the following services directly from the relevant utility company the Landlord shall subject to the Tenant paying the outgoings referred to in clause 3.2(b) use all reasonable endeavours to procure the supply of the following services to the Premises -

 

  PAGE 31  

 

 

(i) electricity;

 

(ii) heated water;

 

(iii) mains raw water;

 

(iv) sewerage;

 

(v) medium temperature hot water for heating.

 

(b) The Landlord may upon written notice to the Tenant of not less than five working days suspend for such reasonable period as may be necessary for repair replacement modernisation (including works to supply any service to the Premises directly from the relevant utility company) any of the services referred to in clause 4.4(a) and in any event the Landlord shall be under no liability in respect of any failure in the performance or observance of any such obligation Provided that if such suspension exceeds 24 continuous hours the landlord shall at its own cost provide a means of supplying equivalent temporary services.

 

(c) All liability on the part of the Landlord pursuant to this clause shall cease in respect of any service which the Landlord shall, acting reasonably and in the interest of good estate management (but without any obligation so to do), make arrangements to have supplied directly to the Premises by the relevant utility company.

 

  PAGE 32  

 

 

5 PROVISOS

 

PROVIDED ALWAYS AND IT IS AGREED as follows -

 

5.1 INTEREST ON LATE PAYMENTS

 

(a) Whenever the whole or any part of the Principal Rent, the Fit-Out Rent, the Insurance Rent or the Service Charge (whether formally or legally demanded or not) or any other moneys which may become payable hereunder by the Tenant to the Landlord shall remain unpaid after becoming due and payable then the amount or the balance for the time being unpaid shall (without prejudice to the Landlord’s right of re-entry or any other right or remedy of the Landlord) as from the due date for payment and until the same is duly paid bear and carry interest thereon (as well after as before any judgment) at the rate of four per cent per annum above the base rate for the time being of Barclays Bank PLC or (in the event of such rate ceasing to be published) at such equivalent rate as the Landlord shall notify to the Tenant in writing.

 

(b) In the event of there being any breach by the Tenant of the covenants on its part contained in this Lease and the Landlord having notified the Tenant in writing that by reason of such breach the Principal Rent, the Fit-Out Rent, the Insurance Rent or the Service Charge will not be accepted for the time being then the amount or the balance for the time being outstanding shall (but without prejudice as mentioned above) as from the date of the notice served by the Landlord in respect of such breach or (if later) from the due date for payment until the date on which payment is tendered by the Tenant following the remedying of such breach bear and carry interest thereon (as well after as before any judgment) at the above rate;

 

and the Tenant accordingly COVENANTS with the Landlord that in every such case the Tenant will pay such interest thereon to the Landlord in addition to the Principal Rent, the Fit-Out Rent, the Insurance Rent, Service Charge and other moneys (as well after as before any judgment) at the above rate and in default of payment such interest shall be recoverable as rent in arrears.

 

5.2 RE-ENTRY

 

Without prejudice to any other provisions contained in this Lease, if -

 

(a) any of the rents reserved by this Lease are unpaid for 21 days after becoming payable (whether formally demanded or not);

 

  PAGE 33  

 

 

(b) the Tenant is in breach of any of its obligations in this Lease;

 

(c) the Tenant (being a company) enters into liquidation whether compulsory or voluntary (other than for the purpose of reconstruction or amalgamation not involving a realisation of assets) or a resolution is passed or a petition is presented for such liquidation;

 

(d) an administrator is appointed in respect of the Tenant pursuant to the Insolvency Act 1986 or the Insolvent Partnerships Order or application is made for such administration or notice is given under paragraph 15 or 26 of Schedule B1 to the Insolvency Act 1986 (as amended);

 

(e) a receiver is appointed in respect of the Tenant or any assets of the Tenant;

 

(f) (where the Tenant comprises or includes one or more individuals) a bankruptcy order is made against any such individual or a petition is presented for such bankruptcy order;

 

(g) the Tenant becomes insolvent or unable to pay its debts within the meaning of section 123 Insolvency Act 1986 or makes a proposal for or enters into any composition with its or his creditors or makes a proposal for or enters into a voluntary arrangement (within the meaning of section 1 or section 253 Insolvency Act 1986);

 

(h) distress, sequestration or execution is levied on the Tenant’s goods;

 

(i) any of the above events occurs in relation to the Surety (excluding for this purpose any person whose liability at the time of such event derives from an Authorised Guarantee Agreement); or

 

(j) any event analogous to any of the above events occurs in any jurisdiction other than England and Wales

 

then the Landlord may at any time re-enter the Premises or any part of the Premises in the name of the whole and immediately this Lease shall terminate absolutely but without prejudice to any rights of the Landlord in respect of any breach of any of the obligations on the Tenant’s part in this Lease.

 

  PAGE 34  

 

 

5.3 RENT CESSER

 

If the Premises or any part of them or any access roads within the Science Park shall at any time or times be destroyed or damaged by any of the Insured Risks so as to render the Premises unfit for occupation and use and/or inaccessible then and in every such case (save to the extent provided in clause 4.1(b)(ii)) the Principal Rent, the Fit-Out Rent, and the Service Charge or a fair and just proportion according to the nature and extent of the damage sustained (as agreed between the Landlord and the Tenant in writing within one month of such destruction or damage) shall be suspended and cease to be payable for a period of three years (or for such other period as the Landlord shall have insured under clause 4.1(a)) from the date of such damage or destruction or (if earlier) until the Premises (or access roads within the Science Park, as the case may be) have been rebuilt or reinstated so that the Premises are again fit for occupation and use and accessible and failing such agreement or in case any dispute shall arise as to the amount of such suspension and/or such period the same shall be determined by an independent surveyor who shall -

 

(a) be a chartered surveyor with at least ten years’ experience in the assessment of rent for premises of a similar nature in the locality of the Premises;

 

(b) be appointed by the President or Vice President for the time being of the Royal Institution of Chartered Surveyors on the application of whichever of the Landlord and the Tenant shall first so apply;

 

(c) act as an expert and not as an arbitrator;

 

(d) on his appointment serve written notice on the Landlord and the Tenant;

 

(e) consider any written representations by or on behalf of the Landlord or the Tenant concerning such matter which are received by him within 28 days of such service but otherwise have an unfettered discretion to determine such matter;

 

  PAGE 35  

 

 

(f) serve notice of such determination on the Landlord and the Tenant as soon as he has made it;

 

(g) be paid his proper fee and expenses in connection with such determination by the Landlord and the Tenant in equal shares or any such shares as he may determine;

 

and any such determination shall be final and binding on the parties PROVIDED that if and whenever any person so appointed shall die, be adjudged bankrupt or become of unsound mind or if both the Landlord and the Tenant shall serve upon such person written notice that in their opinion he has unreasonably delayed making such determination such person shall ipso facto be discharged and be entitled only to his reasonable expenses prior to such discharge and another such independent surveyor shall be appointed to act in his place.

 

5.4 REINSTATEMENT PREVENTED

 

If the Premises or any part of them or any access roads within the Science Park are destroyed or damaged by any of the Insured Risks and the Landlord has not completed reinstatement of the Premises or the relevant access roads (so that the Premises are fit again for occupation and use and accessible) within two years and nine months after the date of such damage or destruction then (unless payment of the insurance moneys was refused in whole or in part by reason of any act, omission, neglect or default by or on the part of the Tenant or any subtenant or other person under the control of the Tenant or any subtenant and the Tenant failed to pay such monies to the Landlord in accordance with clause 3.15(c)) at any time thereafter this Lease may be terminated by either the Landlord or the Tenant giving to the other not less than three months’ notice and upon the expiry of such notice the Term shall end but if by the expiry of such notice the Premises (or the access roads) have been reinstated so that at that date the Premises are again fit for occupation and use and accessible the notice will be void and this Lease will continue in full force and effect, and if this Lease is terminated pursuant to this clause the Landlord will be entitled to retain the whole of the insurance moneys for its absolute use and benefit.

 

  PAGE 36  

 

 

5.5 REINSTATEMENT FOLLOWING DAMAGE BY AN UNINSURED RISK

 

For the purpose of this clause 5.5 and clauses 5.6 and 5.7 below -

 

(a) these provisions shall apply from the date on which any Insured Risk becomes an Uninsured Risk but only in relation to the Uninsured Risk;

 

(b) references to an Insured Risk becoming an Uninsured Risk shall, without limitation, include the application by insurers of an exclusion, condition or limitation to an Insured Risk to the extent to which such risk thereby is or becomes an Uninsured Risk but -

 

(i) an Insured Risk shall not become an Uninsured Risk due to the Landlord’s failure to comply with the provisions of clause 4.1; and

 

(ii) an Insured Risk shall not become an Uninsured Risk owing to the act or default of the Tenant or any person deriving title under the Tenant or their respective agents, employees, licensees or contractors;

 

(c) the Landlord shall notify the Tenant in writing as soon as reasonably practicable after an Insured Risk becomes an Uninsured Risk.

 

5.6 SUSPENSION OF RENT FOLLOWING DAMAGE BY AN UNINSURED RISK

 

If, during the Term, the Premises or any part of them or any access roads within the Science Park shall be damaged or destroyed by an Uninsured Risk so as to make the Premises or any part of them unfit for occupation or use or inaccessible -

 

(a) then the provisions of clause 5.3 (except for the words ‘for a period of three years (or for such other period as the Landlord shall have insured under clause 4.1(a)) from the date of such damage or destruction or (if earlier)’) shall apply as if there had been damage or destruction by an Insured Risk;

 

(b) the Landlord may serve notice on the Tenant within six months of the date of damage or destruction (time being of the essence) confirming that it will reinstate the Premises (or the access roads as the case may be) (‘ a Reinstatement Notice ’); and

 

  PAGE 37  

 

 

(c) if the Landlord serves a Reinstatement Notice in accordance with clause 5.6(b) then clause 4.1(b) and clause 5.4 shall apply as if there had been damage or destruction by an Insured Risk (but as though the period of two years and nine months mentioned in clause 5.4 were deemed to be a period of three years).

 

5.7 REINSTATEMENT NOT PURSUED FOLLOWING DAMAGE BY AN UNINSURED RISK

 

If the Landlord does not serve a Reinstatement Notice following damage or destruction by an Uninsured Risk, then at any time after the date six months after the date on which such damage or destruction occurred (time being of the essence) or, if the Landlord serves notice at any time stating that it does not wish to reinstate such damage or destruction, then at any time after service of such notice either party may by service of a written notice on the other terminate this Lease with immediate effect (unless in the meantime at the date of service of such notice the Premises or the access roads within the Science Park have been reinstated so that the Premises are again fit for occupation and use and accessible) but without prejudice to the rights of either party against the other in respect of any antecedent breach of this Lease.

 

5.8 STATUTORY COMPENSATION

 

The Tenant shall not be entitled on quitting the Premises to any compensation under section 37 Landlord and Tenant Act 1954 (as amended).

 

5.9 DATA PROTECTION ACT 1998

 

For the purposes of the Data Protection Act 1998 or otherwise the Tenant and the Surety acknowledge that information relating to this tenancy will be held on computer and other filing systems by the Landlord or the Landlord’s managing agent (if any) for the purposes of general administration and/or enforcement of this Lease and agree to such information being used for such purposes and being disclosed to third parties so far only as is necessary in connection with -

 

  PAGE 38  

 

 

(a) the management of the Landlord’s interest in the Science Park;

 

(b) the insurance and/or the maintenance of the Premises;

 

(c) checking the credit-worthiness of the Tenant and the Surety; or

 

(d) the disposal or sub-letting of the Premises or the Science Park,

 

or is necessary to conform with recognised industry practice in the management and letting of property.

 

5.10 EXCLUSION OF LIABILITY

 

The Landlord shall not be liable to observe or perform any obligation on its part contained in this Lease after it has ceased to be entitled to the reversion immediately expectant upon the Term (and, without prejudice to any right of the Tenant in respect of any antecedent breach by the Landlord of any of the obligations on the Landlord’s part prior to that date, the Tenant releases the Landlord from all liability in respect of any future breach or non-observance of any such obligation occurring after it has disposed of such reversion).

 

6 RENT REVIEW

 

THIS CLAUSE 6 SHALL APPLY TO THE PRINCIPAL RENT ONLY AND IT IS ALSO AGREED AND DECLARED as follows -

 

6.1 In this clause -

 

(a) the ‘ Review Date ’ means and includes 27 May 2021, 27 May 2026 and 27 May 2031;

 

  PAGE 39  

 

 

(b) the ‘ Market Rent ’ means the yearly rent exclusive of all outgoings at which the Premises might reasonably be expected to be let as a whole as between a willing landlord and a willing tenant in the open market with vacant possession for a term of fifteen years commencing on the relevant Review Date without payment of any fine or premium upon the terms and subject to covenants, agreements, stipulations and conditions similar to those contained in this Lease (except as to the Term and the amount of the Principal Rent but including similar provisions for review of the Principal Rent) but upon the assumption that -

 

(i) the Tenant has complied with all of the covenants on the part of the Tenant contained in this Lease;

 

(ii) the Premises have been finished at the Landlord’s cost to a specification equivalent to the Rent Review Specification and are accordingly ready to receive the willing tenant’s fitting out works and that the willing tenant has had the benefit of such rental concessions (including any rent free or reduced rent period) as are usual in the market to compensate it for the time and inconvenience of it having to fit out the Premises (but no other rent free periods or incentives);

 

(iii) the Premises may be used for any use permitted by this Lease and by any licence or consent granted by the Landlord prior to the relevant Review Date at the request of the Tenant or any permitted undertenant or any predecessor in title of them or either of them respectively;

 

(iv) in case the Premises have been destroyed or damaged they have been fully restored;

 

(v) all Value Added Tax payable by the Tenant under the provisions of this Lease is recoverable by the Tenant in full; and

 

(vi) the Premises comply with all requirements of all Acts (as defined in clause 3.4);

 

and disregarding (if appropriate, and without prejudice to the assumptions at paragraphs (ii) and (vi) above) -

 

  PAGE 40  

 

 

(1) any effect on the rent of the fact that the Tenant or any permitted undertenant or their respective predecessors in title or any other permitted occupier has been or is in occupation of the whole or any part of the Premises;

 

(2) any goodwill attached to the Premises by reason of the carrying on at the Premises of the business of the Tenant or any permitted undertenant or other permitted occupier;

 

(3) any permitted improvement to the Premises carried out by and at the expense of the Tenant or any permitted undertenant or any predecessor in title of them or either of them respectively (otherwise than in pursuance of an obligation to the Landlord save where the obligation arises pursuant to clauses 3.4 or 3.13(a)) and being such an improvement completed after the date of this Lease but not more than 21 years before the relevant Review Date;

 

(4) the Tenant’s Works, as defined in the Agreement for Lease dated 19 November 2013 between (1) the Landlord (2) the Tenant and (3) the Surety;

 

(5) any works of demolition, construction, alteration or addition carried out or being carried out on the Premises by the Tenant or any undertenant or other permitted occupier or their respective predecessors in title (otherwise than by and at the instance of the Landlord or in pursuance of an obligation to the Landlord save where the obligation arises pursuant to clauses 3.4 or 3.13(a)) which diminish the rental value of the Premises at the relevant Review Date;

 

(6) the obligation to pay, and all references to, the Fit-Out Rent; and

 

(7) the Tenant’s option to determine this Lease in accordance with clause 7.

 

  PAGE 41  

 

 

6.2 As at each Review Date there shall be a review of the Principal Rent and the Landlord and the Tenant shall seek to agree the Market Rent but failing written agreement between the parties the Landlord or the Tenant may at any time not more than two months prior to the relevant Review Date refer the determination of the Market Rent to an independent surveyor (being such a person as is mentioned in clause 5.3(a) and who shall be appointed as mentioned in clause 5.3(b)) acting as an arbitrator (in which case the Arbitration Act 1996 shall apply) or (if the Landlord and the Tenant shall so agree) such independent surveyor shall act as an expert and not as an arbitrator.

 

6.3 If the determination of the Market Rent shall be referred to an expert in accordance with the previous clause then clause 5.3(d), 5.3(e), 5.3(f) and 5.3(g) shall also apply and such expert shall give notice in writing of his decision within two months of his appointment or within such extended period as the parties may agree.

 

6.4 The Principal Rent payable hereunder as from each Review Date (the ‘ Reviewed Rent ’) until the subsequent Review Date or the end or sooner determination of the Term (as the case may be) shall be the greater of the Principal Rent payable hereunder immediately prior to the relevant Review Date (the ‘ Current Rent ’) and the Market Rent agreed or determined in accordance with clause 6.2.

 

6.5 If the Reviewed Rent shall not be ascertained by the Review Date then until it has been ascertained the Tenant shall continue to pay on account Principal Rent at the rate of the Current Rent until the quarter day after it has been ascertained on which quarter day the Tenant shall pay the Landlord an additional sum equal to the excess (if any) of Principal Rent at the rate of the Reviewed Rent over Principal Rent at the rate of the Current Rent for the period from the Review Date to such quarter day plus interest on such additional sum from the date on which each instalment would have been due during such period if the Reviewed Rent had then been ascertained such interest being chargeable at the base rate for the time being of Barclays Bank PLC or (in the event of such rate ceasing to be published) at such equivalent rate as the Landlord shall notify to the Tenant in writing.

 

6.6 A Memorandum of the Market Rent shall be entered into between the parties in such terms as the Landlord shall reasonably require.

 

  PAGE 42  

 

 

7 TENANT’S OPTION TO DETERMINE

 

7.1 The Tenant may terminate this Lease on the Break Date by giving to the Landlord not less than 12 months’ written notice provided that on the Break Date -

 

(a) there are no arrears of Principal Rent or Fit Out Rent (or any VAT which may be chargeable in respect of either of those rents) due under the Lease up to and including the Break Date (but excluding any period falling after the Break Date);

 

(b) occupation of the Premises is given up and no underleases of the Premises (or any part of the Premises) remain subsisting; and

 

(c) (or before the Break Date) the Tenant has paid to the Landlord in cleared funds (and over and above any other sums due under this Lease) the Break Payment.

 

7.2 If any of the conditions referred to in clause 7.1(a) or (b) or (c) above are not satisfied on the Break Date the Tenant’s notice served pursuant to clause 7.1 shall be deemed to be of no effect and this Lease shall continue as before, provided that the Landlord may waive all or any of such conditions by giving notice to the Tenant at any time.

 

7.3 The ending of this Lease shall not affect either party’s rights in respect of any earlier breach of any provision of this Lease.

 

7.4 Within 20 days of the Break Date the Landlord shall repay to the Tenant all sums paid in advance by the Tenant to the Landlord pursuant to this Lease which relate to the period after (but excluding) the Break Date.

 

8 ACCIDENTAL HAPPENINGS OR INJURIES

 

8.1 The Landlord shall not be responsible to the Tenant or the Tenant’s licensees servants agents tradesmen or other persons in the Premises or any part thereof or calling upon the Tenant or upon the Science Park for any accidental happening or injury suffered to or loss of any chattel or property (save where the same are due to the act, default or negligence of the Landlord or the Landlord’s employees servants agents tradesmen or those under the control of the Landlord) sustained on the Premises the Science Park or any part thereof.

 

  PAGE 43  

 

 

8.2 The Landlord shall not be liable to the Tenant or any other person claiming through the Tenant for any loss or damage whatsoever which may be caused by stoppage interruption or defect of any plant or machinery in or service to the Premises or the Science Park or any neighbouring premises provided that the Landlord shall use all reasonable endeavours to prevent or mitigate the effect of such stoppage, interruption or defect and to remedy such matters as soon as possible.

 

9 NOTICES

 

This Lease shall incorporate the provisions as to notices contained in section 196 Law of Property Act 1925 as amended by the Recorded Delivery Service Act 1962 and every notice required to be given hereunder shall be in writing.

 

10 VAT

 

10.1 All rents and other sums payable by the Tenant hereunder which are for the time being subject to VAT shall be considered to be tax exclusive sums and the VAT at the appropriate rate for the time being shall be payable by the Tenant in addition.

 

10.2 The Tenant shall indemnify and keep indemnified the Landlord against any VAT paid or payable by the Landlord in respect of any costs, fees, disbursements, expenses or other sums which the Landlord is entitled to recover under the terms of this Lease.

 

11 SURETY’S COVENANTS

 

The Surety covenants with the Landlord in the terms of Schedule 6.

 

12 LANDLORD AND TENANT (COVENANTS) ACT 1995

 

This Lease is a new tenancy within the meaning of section 1 Landlord and Tenant (Covenants) Act 1995.

 

  PAGE 44  

 

 

13 ADDRESS FOR RENT DEMANDS

 

Whilst GW Pharma Limited is the Tenant all rent demands should be sent to c/o GW Pharmaceuticals plc, Building 114, Porton Down Science Park, Porton, Wiltshire SP4 OJQ unless it notifies the Landlord of another address.

 

14 LANDLORD AND TENANT ACT 1954

 

The parties agree that, in the event of a renewal of this Lease pursuant to the Landlord & Tenant Act 1954, any renewal lease shall not reserve the Fit Out Rent as rents payable by the Tenant.

 

15 DELIVERY AS A DEED

 

This document shall be treated as having been executed as a deed only upon being dated.

 

16 RIGHTS OF THIRD PARTIES

 

No person other than a contracting party may enforce any provision of this Lease by virtue of the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999.

 

17 GOVERNING LAW

 

17.1 This deed shall be governed by and construed in accordance with English law.

 

17.2 Each party irrevocably submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of the English courts to settle any dispute which may arise under or in connection with this deed or the legal relationships established by this deed.

 

In witness of the above the parties have executed this deed the day and year first before written

 

  PAGE 45  

 

 

SCHEDULE 1

 

RIGHTS GRANTED

 

1 The right in common with all others having similar rights from time to time -

 

1.1 of passage to and from the Premises with or without vehicles over the Access Roads subject to the Landlord’s right in its absolute discretion to alter, stop up or divert the Access Roads or any part or parts of them at any time during the Term provided that -

 

(a) any expenses in altering, stopping up or diverting the Access Roads are borne by the Landlord; and

 

(b) the Landlord leaves available for use by the Tenant reasonable means of access to the Premises;

 

1.2 of full, free and uninterrupted passage and running of water, soil, gas, electricity and all other services from and to the Premises through the Conducting Media which are now in, upon, over or under other parts of the Science Park.

 

2 The exclusive right to use 42 car parking spaces edged blue on the plan attached hereto but -

 

2.1 only for parking private motor cars (duly insured and taxed for use on the public highway) belonging to the Tenant or any undertenant or their respective invitees or others authorised by them (but for the avoidance of doubt the Tenant shall not be entitled to demand any consideration in money or money’s worth from any third party for the use of such spaces); and

 

2.2 if at any time acting reasonably and in the interests of good and proper estate management the Landlord desires to re-designate all or any of the said parking spaces, the Landlord shall have full right and liberty so to do on giving to the Tenant prior written notice of such re-designation, but at its own expense and subject to the Landlord making available for use by the Tenant always at least the same number of parking spaces as are edged blue on the aforementioned plan.
  PAGE 46  

 

 

SCHEDULE 2

 

RIGHTS RESERVED

 

1 The full, free and uninterrupted passage and running of water, soil, gas, electricity and all other services for the benefit of the Landlord and the owners, tenants or occupiers for the time being of the adjoining or neighbouring premises through the Conducting Media which are now or may at any time hereafter be in, upon, over or under the Premises.

 

2 The right at all reasonable times to enter such parts of the Premises as may be necessary after three working days’ prior notice (except in case of emergency) for the purposes of -

 

2.1 anything connected with the provision of the services referred to in clauses 4.3 and 4.4;

 

2.2 carrying out an assessment or survey of the Premises for the purposes of obtaining an EPC;

 

2.3 connecting, laying, inspecting, cleansing, maintaining, repairing, replacing, amending, altering, relaying or renewing the Conducting Media; and/or

 

2.4 erecting, constructing or laying in, under, over or across such reasonable parts of the Premises (as shall be agreed with the Tenant (whose agreement shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed) any Conducting Media, poles, structures, fixtures or other works for the drainage of or for the supply of water, gas, electricity, telephone, heating, steam and other services to any adjoining or neighbouring premises;

 

subject to performing such tasks as quickly as reasonably practicable.

 

3 The right to erect scaffolding (and the right to enter in order to erect such scaffolding) for the purpose of inspecting repairing or cleaning the Premises or any buildings now or after the date of this Lease on adjoining or neighbouring premises notwithstanding that such scaffolding may temporarily restrict the access of light and air to the Premises.

 

  PAGE 47  

 

 

4 The right to enter after three working days’ prior notice (except in case of emergency) upon the Premises for the purpose of carrying out any necessary repairs, alterations or improvements to any adjoining or neighbouring premises

 

5 The Landlord must make good in a reasonable manner to the Tenant’s reasonable satisfaction all damage occasioned to the Premises in the exercise of the rights referred to in paragraphs 2, 3 and 4 above but the Landlord will not be liable to pay compensation for any inconvenience caused to the Tenant.

 

6 All rights of light and air which the Premises enjoy over any other property.

 

7 The right to deal with, modify or vary all covenants of which the Premises enjoy the benefit provided that in so doing the Tenant’s use of the Premises shall not be materially adversely affected.

 

8 All rights of entry in clause 3 of this Lease.

 

9 The right to erect any new buildings of any height on adjoining or neighbouring premises in such manner as it shall think fit notwithstanding the fact that the same may obstruct affect or interfere with the amenity of or access to the Premises or the passage of light and air to the Premises.

 

  PAGE 48  

 

 

SCHEDULE 3

 

DOCUMENTS TO BE OBSERVED

 

1 All those documents and matters referred to in the Property and Charges Registers of the Landlord’s freehold title of the Science Park as registered at the Land Registry under title number ***       as at 3 December 2012 at 09-36-05 (save for any financial charges) in so far as the same relate to the Premises.

 

2 Wayleaves granted to The South Eastern Electricity Board variously -

 

2.1 dated 26 January 1967 between Shell Research Limited (1) and The South Eastern Electricity Board (2); and

 

2.2 dated 15 February 1989 between Shell Research Limited (1) and The South Eastern Electricity Board (2).

 

3 Wayleave agreement dated 21 May 2010 between Sittingbourne (No. 1) Limited and Sittingbourne (No. 2) Limited (1) and British Telecommunications plc (2).

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  PAGE 49  

 

 

SCHEDULE 4

 

SERVICE CHARGE

 

PART A

 

1 The service charge referred to in this Schedule (the ‘ Service Charge ’) shall be the Fixed Charge as defined in Schedule 5.

 

2 The Tenant shall pay the Fixed Charge by equal quarterly payments in advance on the usual quarter days and so in proportion for any broken period.

 

3 Notwithstanding the other provisions of this Part of this Schedule the first payment of the Fixed Charge for the period from the Term Commencement Date to the next quarter day hereafter shall be paid on or before the date of this Lease.

 

4 The Landlord shall not be concerned in the administration and collection of or accounting for the Service Charge on an assignment of this Lease and accordingly the Landlord shall -

 

4.1 not be required to make any apportionment relative to the assignment; and

 

4.2 be entitled to deal exclusively with the Tenant in whom this Lease is for the time being vested (and for this purpose in disregard of any assignment which has not been registered in accordance with clause 3.20).

 

PART B

 

1 Maintaining, repairing, cleansing, decorating and renewing (and landscaping as deemed appropriate by the Landlord in its discretion) the Centre Common Parts.

 

2 Providing security at the Science Park to include (if and as deemed necessary by the Landlord in its discretion acting reasonably) 24 hour manned presence CCTV surveillance security fencing and gates or other equivalent perimeter security measures.

 

  PAGE 50  

 

 

SCHEDULE 5

 

INDEX-LINKED REVIEW OF SERVICE CHARGE

 

1 In this Schedule the following expressions shall have the meanings set opposite them -

 

Fixed Charge from and including the Term Commencement Date to and including 24 December 2016 the Initial Charge and from and including 25 December 2016 as determined in accordance with paragraph 2 of this Schedule 5 on an annual basis;
   
Review Date the 25th day of December 2016 and every anniversary of that date and the date which is one day before the date on which the Term would expire by effluxion of time (disregarding any statutory continuation thereof);
   
Initial Charge £***  per annum;
   
Index the Index of Retail Prices (All Items) published by H M Government or any equivalent index stated by H M Government to be the official successor to the Index of Retail Prices (All Items)
   
  PROVIDED that if the method of computation and/or the reference base of the Index shall materially change after the date of this Lease then the figure deemed to be shown in the Index for the purposes of this Lease after such change shall be the figure which would have been shown in the Index if the method of computation and/or reference base current at the date of this Lease had been retained, and any official reconciliation between such differing methods of computation or reference bases shall be binding on the parties to this Lease;

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  PAGE 51  

 

 

Relevant Fraction a fraction of which the numerator is the figure of the Index published in the four weeks preceding the relevant Review Date and the denominator is the figure of the Index published in April 2016;
   
Expert an independent chartered accountant (acting as an expert) being a partner in or a director of a leading firm or company of chartered accountants to be nominated in default of agreement by the Landlord and the Tenant by the President for the time being of the Institution of Chartered Accountants in England and Wales on the application of the Landlord or the Tenant made not more than one month before the relevant Review Date.

 

2 From and including each Review Date the Fixed Charge shall be whichever is the higher of -

 

(a) the Fixed Charge which was payable immediately before the relevant Review Date (the ‘ Old Charge ’); and

 

(b) the figure calculated by multiplying the Initial Charge by the Relevant Fraction (the ‘ Revised Charge ’).

 

3 If the Landlord and the Tenant shall fall to agree upon the Revised Charge, then either of them may not more than one month before the relevant Review Date require the Revised Charge to be determined by the Expert.

 

  PAGE 52  

 

 

4 The Expert shall on being appointed invite the Landlord and the Tenant to submit to him within such time limits as he shall consider appropriate (but not being less than 21 days) representations and cross representations as to the calculation of the Revised Charge, supported if they so wish by a statement of reasons and/or schedule of calculations. The Expert shall consider such matters submitted to him but shall not be fettered thereby and shall determine the Revised Charge in accordance with his own knowledge, judgment and opinion having regard to such matters as he may consider appropriate. The Expert’s decision shall (save as to any question of law) be final and binding on all matters referred to him under this Lease.

 

5 If after the date of this Lease it becomes impossible (because of any change in the methods used to calculate the Index, or for any other reason) to calculate the Revised Charge, then the Expert shall have full power to determine what the increase in the Index would have been had it continued on the same basis as is assumed to be available for the operation of this rent review or (if that determination shall also be impossible) shall determine a reasonable charge having regard to the purposes and intent of this Schedule.

 

6 If the Expert shall die or be unable or unwilling to accept his appointment or to carry out his functions then either the Landlord or the Tenant may apply for a replacement to be appointed in his stead, and this procedure may be repeated as often as necessary.

 

7 If at any Review Date there is any statutory restriction upon the review or increase of the Fixed Charge or the Landlord’s right to recover it, then at any time after the lifting, removal or modification of such restriction and prior to the next following Review Date the Landlord may give the Tenant not less than one month’s notice requiring an additional review to take place on a quarter day to be specified in such notice which quarter day shall thereupon be treated for the purposes of this Lease as a Review Date.

 

8 The costs of the Expert and the parties’ costs of the reference to him shall lie in his award but, in the absence of such award, the Landlord and Tenant shall each bear their own costs and one half of the Expert’s costs. One party may pay the costs required to be borne by another party if they remain unpaid for more than 14 days after they become due, and then recover these and any incidental expenses incurred from that other party on demand.

 

9 Time is not of the essence in relation to any matter contained in this Schedule.

 

  PAGE 53  

 

 

10 If the Revised Charge has not been ascertained by the relevant Review Date, then the Old Charge shall be payable until such time as the Revised Charge has been ascertained.

 

11 Once the Revised Charge has been ascertained, the Tenant shall on demand pay the Landlord a sum equal to the amount (if any) by which the Revised Charge exceeds the Old Charge for the period from the relevant Review Date until the next quarter day following the date of such demand together with interest on each quarterly shortfall calculated on a daily basis from the date upon which each instalment of the shortfall would have been payable if the Revised Charge had then been ascertained at the base rate of Barclays Bank plc until seven days after the date of such demand, and thereafter together with interest calculated on a daily basis at the rate referred to in clause 5.1(a).

 

12 The Landlord and the Tenant may at any time settle the Revised Charge in more than one amount and agree to reserve such amounts increasing in steps until the next Review Date or, if none, until the termination of the Term, or as they may otherwise agree.

 

13 The parties will procure that a memorandum of the Revised Charge signed by the Landlord and Tenant shall be endorsed on or annexed to this Lease and its counterpart.

 

  PAGE 54  

 

 

SCHEDULE 6

 

COVENANTS BY THE SURETY

 

1 The Surety (if any) in consideration of the grant of this Lease (or the agreement to the assignment of this Lease as appropriate) COVENANTS AND GUARANTEES with and to the Landlord that -

 

1.1 The Tenant shall punctually pay the rents and perform and observe the covenants and other terms of this Lease.

 

1.2 If the Tenant shall make any default in payment of the rents or in performing or observing any of the covenants or other terms of this Lease the Surety will pay the rents and perform or observe the covenants or terms in respect of which the Tenant shall be in default and make good to the Landlord on demand and indemnify the Landlord against all losses, damages, costs and expenses arising or incurred by the Landlord as a result of such non-payment, non-performance or non-observance notwithstanding -

 

(a) any time or indulgence granted by the Landlord to the Tenant or any neglect or forbearance of the Landlord in enforcing the payment of the rents or the observance or performance of the covenants or other terms of this Lease;

 

(b) that the terms of this Lease may have been varied by agreement between the parties;

 

(c) any other act or thing (apart from an express release by deed) by which but for this provision the Surety would have been released.

 

1.3 These provisions are to take effect immediately on the grant (or the assignment as appropriate) of the Lease to the Tenant and are to remain in force so long and to the extent that the Tenant is not released by law from liability for any of the covenants and other terms of this Lease.

 

  PAGE 55  

 

 

2 The Surety FURTHER COVENANTS with the Landlord that if this Lease is disclaimed or forfeited prior to any lawful assignment by the Tenant of this Lease the Landlord may within six months after the disclaimer or forfeiture by notice in writing require the Surety to accept a new lease of the Premises for a term equivalent to the residue which if there had been no disclaimer or forfeiture would have remained of the Term at the same rent and subject to similar covenants and conditions as are payable under and applicable to the tenancy immediately before the date of such disclaimer or forfeiture (such new lease and the rights and liabilities under it to take effect as from the date of such disclaimer or forfeiture) and in such case the Surety shall pay the Landlord’s costs incurred by the Landlord in connection with such new lease and the Surety shall accept such new lease accordingly and will execute and deliver to the Landlord a counterpart of it.

 

3 If this Lease is disclaimed or forfeited and for any reason the Landlord does not require the Surety to accept a new lease of the Premises in accordance with paragraph 2 the Surety shall pay to the Landlord on demand an amount equal to the difference between any money received by the Landlord for the use or occupation of the Premises (less any expenditure incurred by the Landlord in connection with the Premises) and the rents which would have been payable under the Lease but for such disclaimer or forfeiture in both cases for the period commencing with the date of such disclaimer or forfeiture and ending on whichever is the earlier of the following dates -

 

(a) the date six months after such disclaimer or forfeiture; and

 

(b) the date (if any) upon which the Premises are relet.

 

4 The Surety FURTHER COVENANTS and guarantees the obligations of the Tenant under any Authorised Guarantee Agreement entered into by the Tenant pursuant to the terms of this Lease.

 

5 It is hereby agreed that if any payment is made under the terms of this guarantee and the Surety is thereupon subrogated to all the Landlord’s rights of recovery in relation thereto then the Surety shall not exercise any such rights against the Tenant.

 

6 For the purposes of these provisions references to the Tenant are to the Tenant in relation to whom the Surety’s covenant is given but not any lawful assignee of such Tenant.

 

  PAGE 56  

 

 

SCHEDULE 7

 

AUTHORISED GUARANTEE AGREEMENT

 

1 The Tenant in consideration of the agreement to the assignment of the Lease COVENANTS AND GUARANTEES with and to the Landlord that -

 

1.1 The Assignee shall punctually pay the rents and perform and observe the covenants and other terms of the Lease.

 

1.2 If the Assignee shall make any default in payment of the rents or in performing or observing any of the covenants or other terms of the Lease the Tenant will pay the rents and perform and observe the covenants or terms in respect of which the Assignee shall be in default and make good to the Landlord on demand and indemnify the Landlord against all losses, damages, costs and expenses arising or incurred by the Landlord as a result of such non-payment, non-performance or nonobservance notwithstanding -

 

(a) any time or indulgence granted by the Landlord to the Assignee or any neglect or forbearance of the Landlord in enforcing the payment of the rents or the observance or performance of the covenants or other terms of the Lease;

 

(b) that the terms of the Lease may have been varied by agreement between the parties (but subject always to section 18 Landlord and Tenant (Covenants) Act 1995);

 

(c) any other act or thing (apart from an express release by deed) by which but for this provision the Tenant would have been released.

 

2 The Tenant FURTHER COVENANTS with the Landlord that if the Lease is disclaimed prior to any lawful assignment by the Assignee of the Lease the Landlord may within six months after the disclaimer require the Tenant to accept a new lease of the Premises for a term equivalent to the residue which if there had been no disclaimer would have remained of the Term at the same rent and subject to similar covenants and conditions as are payable under and applicable to the tenancy immediately before the date of such disclaimer (such new lease and the rights and liabilities under it to take effect as from the date of such disclaimer) and in such case the Tenant shall pay the Landlord’s costs incurred by the Landlord in connection with such new lease and the Tenant shall accept such new lease accordingly and will execute and deliver to the Landlord a counterpart of it.

 

  PAGE 57  

 

 

3 If the Lease is disclaimed and for any reason the Landlord does not require the Tenant to accept a new lease of the Premises in accordance with paragraph 2 the Tenant shall pay to the Landlord on demand an amount equal to the difference between any money received by the Landlord for the use or occupation of the Premises (less any expenditure incurred by the Landlord in connection with the Premises) and the rents which would have been payable under the Lease but for such disclaimer in both cases for the period commencing with the date of such disclaimer and ending on whichever is the earlier of the following dates -

 

(a) the date six months after such disclaimer;

 

(b) the end or sooner determination of the Term.

 

4 Notwithstanding any of the above provisions the Tenant -

 

(a) shall not be required to guarantee in any way the liability for the covenants and other terms of the Lease of any person other than the Assignee; and

 

(b) shall not be subject to any liability, restriction or other requirement (of whatever nature) in relation to any time after the Assignee is by law released from the covenants and other terms of the Lease.

 

5 It is hereby agreed that if any payment is made under the terms of this guarantee and the Tenant is thereupon subrogated to all the Landlord’s right of recovery in relation thereto then the Tenant shall not exercise any such rights against the Assignee.

 

6 No person other than a contracting party may enforce any provision of this Deed by virtue of the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999.

 

7 Words and expressions used in this Deed shall have the same meaning as in the Lease.

 

  PAGE 58  

 

 

SCHEDULE 8

 

THE REGULATIONS

 

1 Not to store rubbish or waste of any description outside the Premises save in any area so designated by the Landlord from time to time.

 

2 Not to allow empty containers or rubbish of any description to accumulate upon the Premises or the Centre Common Parts nor to discharge into the Conducting Media or onto any wall or parking area or forecourt of the Science Park any deleterious matter or substance including chemicals radioactive material diesel fuel or oil which might be or become a source of danger or injury to the Conducting Media or any other property or person.

 

3 Not to use any container for rubbish or refuse other than such type and so constructed as to prevent any leakage or spillage therefrom and to keep the same in the area (if any) provided for the purpose and to prevent such rubbish or refuse causing a nuisance or annoyance to the Landlord or the owners or occupiers of neighbouring premises.

 

4 Not to use any part of the Premises in such manner as to subject it to any excessive strain or interference and not to install machinery on the Premises which shall be unduly noisy or cause vibration.

 

5 Not to do anything on the Premises which might reasonably be expected to produce directly or indirectly corrosive fumes or vapours or moisture or humidity in excess of that which the Premises were designed to bear and are otherwise reasonable.

 

6 Not to load or unload any vehicle unless the vehicle shall be in a loading area provided from time to time for that purpose and not to obstruct or damage any access ways roads or landscaped areas in the Science Park or leading to the Premises.

 

7 In the event of a spill or deposit on the Premises of any Hazardous Materials to inform the Landlord of this and permit him to enter and inspect the Premises.

 

8 To observe the speed limits and traffic signs on the Access Roads.

 

  PAGE 59  

 

 

SCHEDULE 9

 

UTILITIES CHARGE

 

1 In this Schedule, the following meanings shall apply -

 

1.1 Estimated Utilities Charge ’ means the Landlord’s reasonable and proper estimate of the Utilities Charge for the forthcoming Utilities Charge Period.

 

1.2 Utilities Charge ’ means the cost referred to in clause 3.2, calculated in accordance with this Schedule;

 

1.3 Utilities Charge Period ’ means each period of 12 months commencing on the Term Commencement Date falling wholly or partly within the Term (but only to the extent falling within the Term) provided that the Landlord may vary the Utilities Charge Period at its sole discretion at any time during the Term;

 

1.4 End Date ’ means the date on which the Term expires or (if earlier) on which the Term is determined;

 

1.5 Final Utilities Charge Period ’ means the Utilities Charge Period which ends on the End Date;

 

1.6 First Utilities Charge Period ’ means the Utilities Charge Period which begins when the Term commences;

 

1.7 Meters ’ means the measuring equipment (if any) installed in the Building for the purposes of measuring the supply of services to the Premises.

 

2 Subject to paragraph 8, the Landlord will, prior to each Utilities Charge Period (or on or prior to the commencement of the Term, in the case of the First Utilities Charge Period), submit to the Tenant a statement setting out the Estimated Utilities Charge for the forthcoming Utilities Charge Period.

 

  PAGE 60  

 

 

3 The Tenant will pay the Estimated Utilities Charge to the Landlord by equal quarterly payments in advance on the usual quarter days, the first payment (being the due proportion for the period commencing on and including the Term Commencement Date and ending on the day before the next quarter day hereafter) to be paid on or before the date of this Lease.

 

4 At the end of each Utilities Charge Period the Landlord shall procure that readings are taken and recorded from the Meters and the readings taken and recorded shall (subject to manifest error) be accepted by the Landlord and the Tenant. Should Meters not be installed the Landlord’s surveyor shall calculate (the Landlord’s surveyor’s determination to be conclusive) a just proportion fairly attributable to the Premises of the actual cost to the Landlord of supplying the relevant services to the Science Park during the relevant Utilities Charge Period and such proportion shall be the Utilities Charge for the relevant Utilities Charge Period.

 

5 Upon having taken the readings or made the calculations in accordance with paragraph 4, the Landlord shall deliver to the Tenant a statement setting out in respect of the previous Utilities Charge Period -

 

5.1 the Estimated Utilities Charge received from the Tenant;

 

5.2 the Utilities Charge; and

 

5.3 the difference (if any) between the sums referred to in paragraphs 5.1 and 5.2.

 

6 If in respect of a Utilities Charge Period the Utilities Charge is more or less than the Estimated Utilities Charge received from the Tenant then any sum payable to or by the Landlord by way of adjustment (with the intent that the Tenant shall have paid the whole of the Utilities Charge to the Landlord in respect of the relevant Utilities Charge Period) will become due and shall be paid by the Tenant (within 14 days of delivery of the statement referred to in paragraph 5) or credited to the Tenant for the succeeding Utilities Charge Period (or paid to the Tenant in the case of the Final Utilities Charge Period) as the case may require.

 

  PAGE 61  

 

 

7 The Tenant shall be liable only for the Utilities Charge up to and including the End Date but the provisions of this schedule shall otherwise continue to apply after the End Date.

 

8 The Landlord may, on prior written notice to the Tenant, vary the means by which the Utilities Charge is charged to the Tenant provided that such variation is fair, proper and in the interests of good estate management.

 

9.1 Within one month after delivery to the Tenant of the statement referred to in paragraph 5 (time being of the essence) the Tenant may request the Landlord to provide (and the Landlord will promptly provide) to the Tenant all vouchers and invoices which the Tenant shall reasonably need in order to satisfy itself as to the accuracy of the Utilities Charge in accordance with this Schedule.

 

9.2 Within two months after delivery of the statement referred to in paragraph 5 (time being of the essence) the Tenant may challenge it on the ground that it contains errors or is otherwise incorrectly drawn by giving to the Landlord notice to that effect but only if it has first made full payment of any amount due from the Tenant under paragraph 6 and if so -

 

(a) both parties must endeavour to resolve the relevant issue; but if they cannot do so;

 

(b) the issue in dispute may be referred by either party to the determination of an independent surveyor being such a person as is mentioned in clause 5.3(a) and who shall be appointed as mentioned in clause 5.3(b) and clauses 5.3(c), 5.3(d), 5.3(e), 5.3(f) and 5.3(g) shall also apply and the independent surveyor’s determination shall be final and binding on the parties Provided that if and whenever any person so appointed shall die, be adjudged bankrupt or become of unsound mind or if both the Landlord and the Tenant shall serve upon such person written notice that in their opinion he has unreasonably delayed making such determination such person shall ipso facto be discharged and be entitled only to his reasonable expenses prior to such discharge and another such independent surveyor shall be appointed to act in his place;

 

  PAGE 62  

 

 

(c) any adjustments to the statement required to be made in consequence of the determination of the independent surveyor shall be made and any sum payable to or by the Landlord shall immediately be paid (with interest in respect of the period during which the relevant amount has been underpaid, such interest to be at the base rate for the time being of Barclays Bank PLC or, in the event of such rate ceasing to be published, at such equivalent rate as the Landlord shall notify to the Tenant) or allowed as appropriate;

 

but if not the Tenant’s right of challenge to that statement shall lapse.

 

10 The Landlord shall not be concerned in the administration and collection of or accounting for the Utilities Charge on an assignment of this Lease and accordingly the Landlord shall -

 

10.1 not be required to make any apportionment relative to the assignment and

 

10.2 be entitled to deal exclusively with the Tenant in whom this Lease is for the time being vested (and for this purpose in disregard of any assignment which has not been registered in accordance with clause 3.20).

 

11 The statement referred to in paragraph 5 shall for the purposes of this Schedule be deemed to have been delivered to the Tenant on the next working day after it is posted by first class post to the address referred to in clause 13 or to such other address as may have been notified by the Tenant to the Landlord as the address to which rent demands should be sent.

 

  PAGE 63  

 

 

ANNEXURE 1

 

RENT REVIEW SPECIFICATION

 

  PAGE 64  

 

 

RENT REVIEW SPECIFICATION FOR TECHNOLOGY UNIT 2 - G.Pharm MANUFACTURING FACILITY AT KENT SCIENCE PARK

 

Introduction.

 

The works comprise the first phase of a proposed Production Facility situated in ***      within ***           and consists of a 1109 m2 steel framed building (8.565 m to eaves and 10.060 to ridge) with insulated cladding to walls and roof and a mezzanine floor of 765m2, together with car park, service area, stores and compounds, barriers and fencing to form a secure facility.

 

The basic build prior to tenant fitting out comprises an open plan portal frame building with insulated wall and roof cladding with a small area of first floor, served by an internal staircase and mezzanine plant rooms with an enclosed escape stair. Concrete ground slab and first floor suspended slabs have been designed for the following imposed loads, 40 kN/m2 Ground floor and 7.5 kN/m2 First Floor and are to have power floated finish to receive tenant finishes. Finish to the internal face of the external walls will be the pre-finished inner face of the external wall cladding. Inner lining by tenant.

 

The general specification is as follows:-

 

Foundations to comprise reinforced concrete pad foundations to column bases with concrete edge beam to support cavity brickwork to dpc level. Oversite reinforced concrete slab, laid on hard-core with insulation under, slab to include recesses, plinths, and movement joints and to have power float finish.

 

Structural steel frame 8.585m to eaves and 10.060m to ridge complete with cladding rails I purlins to accept wall cladding and roof sheeting. Structural steel frame to form mezzanine floor (frame designed to facilitate easy removal on expiry of lease) Mezzanine floor comprising 150mm reinforced concrete slab on Kingspan Multideck permanent formwork, with concrete upstands to perimeter. Steel trimmers within external wall structure to enable formation of roller shutter openings at some future date. Steelwork to include lifting beam.

 

Steelwork to receive intumescent spray painted fire protection.

 

Roof cladding to be Kingspan KS1000 RW 100mm thick composite panel complete with Plastisol Highline eaves/ gutter detail and rainwater pipes. Provision of two canopies.

 

Roof works to include mansafe system and Kingspan polycristaline PV panels.

 

Flat roof areas to fire escape stair and canopies to be single membrane high performance roofing on plywood decking insulated as required.

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  PAGE 65  

 

 

Precast concrete and steel staircases to form access stair to first floor and escape stair complete with handrails to detail (total 7 No. stairs / maintenance access) all with handrails l balustrades.

 

External walls to be cavity wall to dpc level comprising block inner leaf and facing brick outer skin with cavity insulation. Wail cladding above this level to be Kingspan K5900 MR composite panels complete with flashings, trims etc and non-standard colour feature panels around entrance. Provision for removable panels, fire barriers and fire stopping.

 

Aluminium louvres to match cladding as described.

 

Windows Double glazed colour coated aluminium windows complete with ironmongery as required.

 

Curtain walking complete with main double entrance doors Personnel / fire escape doors to be aluminium in metal frames with solid infill panels.

 

Power operated roller shutter door and double doors to DAP plant compound.

 

Form DAP compound adjacent to DAP room.

 

Externally .

 

Drainage. Roof surface water to discharge through externally fixed rainwater pipes via drainage system to soakaways. Car park run off and surface water drainage from yard and service area to discharge to soakaways via interceptors. Solvent stores and fuel tanks to be fully bunded.

 

Foul drainage to connect via foul sewer within Shimmin Road and then into existing foul drainage installation.

 

Provide underground ducts, draw pits and access chambers for incoming services, CCTV installation, data.

 

Incoming services water, electricity will be suitably terminated within the building for extension by the tenant.

 

Medium temperature hot water via the sitewide MTHW will be terminated at the site boundary for extension by the tenant.

 

Form tarmac finished car park complete with pcc kerbs, edgings and Line markings including cycle store and disabled parking area.

 

Construct reinforced concrete access controlled service area including bin store, plant compound solvent stores and waste collection area. Service access to be tarmac finish.

 

  PAGE 66  

 

 

Excavate for and form reinforced concrete foundation to sprinkler tank and pump housing. Maintenance access to tank / pump house to be grasscrete paving.

 

Precast concrete footpaths around building, complete with edgings and bollards where required. Top soil and seeding to remaining areas.

 

Fencing to perimeter of site comprising weldmesh fencing with GRP palisade fencing to rear boundary. Palisade fencing complete with gates to chiller compound, timber fencing to bin store, alt complete with gates where required.

 

Excavate for and form concrete foundations for walls, barriers, gates and plant plinths as required. Construct brick boundary wall to Shimmin Road elevation and provide automatic power operated barrier to service access and swing barrier to service area.

 

  PAGE 67  

 

 

ANNEXURE 2

 

REINSTATEMENT SPECIFICATION

 

  PAGE 68  

 

 

REINSTATEMENT SPECIFICATION FOR RETURNING TECHNOLOGY UNIT 2 - G - PHARM MANUFACTURING FACILITY TO SHELL CONDITION AT EXPIRATION OF LEASE

 

Introduction

 

The purpose of this specification is to describe those works necessary to return the Production Facility to a shell condition to enable the Landlord to sub-divide and re-let the unit following the expiration of the OW Pharmaceutical lease.

 

Internally

 

Removal of all tenant fixtures, fittings and loose furniture.

 

Termination of all process pipework and services and removal of same together with all process equipment.

 

Removal of all gas lines, solvent tines and tanks or containers Disconnect and remove all refrigerant lines, chillers and associated plant.

 

Removal of all Air conditioning plant and pipework both internally and externally from the building.

 

Isolate and strip out all electrical installations, lighting and power back to main distribution board including stand by generator and UPS installations.

 

Remove all data outlets, data cableling and IT server room equipment.

 

Remove internal lining to external wall including column casings, pipework and pipework supports within void.

 

Reinstate wall lining to follow line of internal face of external wall including column casings.

 

Dismantle and remove cold rooms, secure rooms and vault and reinstate floor and walls.

 

Demolish all internal walls and partitions including internal doors, viewing panels and make good structure where removed.

 

Take down all suspended ceilings, walk on ceilings and supports.

 

Demolish reinforced concrete mezzanine floor and supporting steelwork including removal of staircases.

 

Take up floor finishings to ground floor area including skirting area, cut out drainage, plant supports and plinths and reinstate floor surface to power float finish.

 

  PAGE 69  

 

 

Remove all secondary steelwork acting as plant / pipework support and make good intumescent fire protection as required.

 

Externally

 

Remove all tanks, plant, stacks, vents and pipework externally to building including supports, plinths and bunds and make good ail surfaces.

 

Remove canopies, tenant signage and make good cladding.

 

Remove DAP extension, infill removable panel and make good.

 

Remove chiller compound, solvent stores and bin store.

 

Remove louvres, vents and pipework penetrating through wall or roof and replace roof / wall cladding to match existing.

 

Take out redundant windows/ external doors, curtain walling and non-standard colour wall cladding and infill with new cladding sections to match existing.

 

Dismantle sprinkler tank and pump house, and remove from site, Break out foundations, disconnect water supply, cap off below ground and reinstate ground.

 

  PAGE 70  

 

 

 

Signed as a deed on behalf of )
AG Kent B.V. a company incorporated )
in the Netherlands, by Jean-Baptiste Garcia )
and Robert Tieskens, being persons who )
in accordance with the laws of that )
territory, are acting under the authority )
of the company )

 

Authorised Signatory /s/ J. B. Garcia  
     
Authorised Signatory Illegible  

 

Signed as a deed on behalf of )
AG Kent B.V. a company incorporated )
in the Netherlands, by Eurostrat )
Netherlands Manager, L.L.C. )
being persons who )
in accordance with the laws of that )
territory, are acting under the authority )
of the company )

 

Authorised Signatory Illegible  
     
Authorised Signatory    

 

  PAGE 71  

 

 

Executed as a deed by )  
GW Pharma Limited ) /s/ Adam George
acting by )  

 

Director

 

Witness

 

Signature of Witness /s/ Neil Tween  

 

Name Neil Tween  

 

Address 1 Saberton Close,  

 

Waterbeach, CB25 9QW  

 

Occupation Chartered Accountant  

 

Executed as a deed by )  
GW Pharmaceuticals plc ) /s/ Adam George
acting by )  

 

Director

 

Witness

 

Signature of Witness /s/ Neil Tween  

 

Name Neil Tween  

 

Address 1 Saberton Close,  

 

Waterbeach, CB25 9QW  

 

Occupation Chartered Accountant  

 

  PAGE 72  

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

Exhibit 4.59

   

***Certain portions of this exhibit have been omitted based on a request for confidential treatment pursuant to Rule 24b-2 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. The omitted portions have been filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

 

Dated 31 st August 2016

 

 

GW PHARMA LIMITED

 

GW PHARMACEUTICALS PLC

 

- and -

 

BRITISH SUGAR PLC

 

 

 

amended and restated Production AND SUPPLY Agreement

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

    Page
     
1. DEFINITIONS AND INTERPRETATION 1
     
2. AMENDMENT AND RESTATEMENT 7
     
3. CONDITION PRECEDENT 7
     
4. PROJECT MANAGEMENT 8
     
5. GLASSHOUSE CONVERSION AND USE OF THE Facility 10
     
6. APPOINTMENT 11
     
7. KNOW-HOW TRANSFER/SUPPLY OF PLANTS 11
     
8. PRODUCTION, DELIVERY AND ACCEPTANCE 12
     
9. INSPECTIONS AND AUDITS 14
     
10. INFORMATION SHARING 15
     
11. DOCUMENTATION, RECORDS AND PERMITS 15
     
12. FURTHER RIGHTS, OBLIGATIONS AND RESPONSIBILITIES 15
     
13. CONSIDERATION 17
     
14. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY 21
     
15. CONFIDENTIALITY 21
     
16. WARRANTIES AND LIABILITY 23
     
17 INSURANCE 24
     
18. TERM AND TERMINATION 24
     
19. FINANCIAL SECURITY 27
     
20. RIGHTS SHORT OF TERMINATION 28
     
21. INDEMNITY 28
     
22. MISCELLANEOUS 29
     
23. PARENT COMPANY GUARANTEE 31
     
SCHEDULES  
   
Schedule 1 – Operating Costs and Budget for Costs for 2017  
   
Schedule 2 – Project Management and Glasshouse Conversion Project Planning  
   
Schedule 3 – British Sugar Depreciation Costs  
   
Schedule 4 – Efficiency Savings Example  
   
Schedule 5 – Terms of reference for Expert Determination  
   
Schedule 6 –Worked Examples of Financial terms  
   
Schedule 7 – Administrative Information  

 

  - i -  

 

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

(continued)

 

  Page
   
Schedule 8 - Anti-Bribery and Sanctions Rules  
   
Schedule 9 - Map of Site, Facility and Growth Rooms  
   
Schedule 10 – Financial consequences of termination  

 

  - ii -  

 

 

THIS PRODUCTION AND SUPPLY AGREEMENT , is entered into on the        day of         2016

 

between:

 

(1) GW PHARMA LIMITED , a company incorporated in accordance with the laws of England (Company No. 03704998) whose registered office is at Sovereign House, Vision Park, Histon, Cambridge CB24 9BZ, UK ( “GW” );

 

(2) GW PHARMACEUTICALS PLC, a company incorporated in accordance with the laws of England (Company No. 04160917) whose registered office is at Sovereign House, Vision Park, Histon, Cambridge CB24 9BZ, UK ( “GW Pharmaceuticals” ); and

 

(3) BRITISH SUGAR PLC , a company incorporated in accordance with the laws of England (Company No. 315158) whose registered office is at Weston Centre, 10 Grosvenor Street, London, W1K 4QQ ( “British Sugar” ).

 

WHEREAS

 

(A) GW is developing medicinal products based on the properties of cannabis and owns or otherwise controls certain patent rights, know-how and plant variety rights covering or otherwise relating to such products.

 

(B) British Sugar has the facilities and expertise necessary, in conjunction with GW Know How (as defined herein), to grow, process and supply cannabis in dried form to GW for use in medicinal products and owns certain Know How (as defined herein) of its own covering or otherwise relating to general horticultural processes and techniques.

 

(C) The Parties entered into a production and supply agreement dated 10 August 2016 (“the Original Agreement”) under which (i) GW agreed to fund the conversion of the current 45 acre British Sugar glasshouse facility to be able to grow, harvest, dry and pellet the cannabis crop and (ii) GW appointed British Sugar as a third party supplier to GW of Botanical Raw Material (as defined herein) and British Sugar accepted the appointment on the terms of the Original Agreement.

 

(D) The Parties have now decided to terminate the Original Agreement and enter into this Agreement which is based on the provisions of Original Agreement but amended to reflect some agreed changes to the commercial terms and to remove matters that have now been superseded.

 

(E) GW understands that British Sugar will have to terminate its current contract with Thanet Earth Marketing Ltd so as to be able to offer the facilities. The Parties understand that their obligations under this Agreement are conditional on termination of that contract.

 

(F) GW Pharmaceuticals is a party to the Agreement for the purpose of giving the parent company guarantee in Clause 23 only.

 

IT IS THEREFORE AGREED AS FOLLOWS:

 

1. DEFINITIONS AND INTERPRETATION

 

1.1 The following terms as used in this Agreement shall have the meanings set forth in this Clause.

 

“Affiliate” – with respect to a Person, any company, partnership or other business entity that controls, is controlled by or is under common control with, such Person. For the purposes of this definition only, “control” refers to any of the following (i) the possession, directly or indirectly, of the power to direct the management or policies of an entity, whether through ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise; (ii) ownership of fifty per cent (50%) or more of the voting securities entitled to vote for the election of directors in the case of a corporation, or of fifty per cent (50%) or more of the equity interest in the case of any other type of legal entity; (iii) status as a general partner in any partnership, or any other arrangement whereby a Person controls or has the right to control the Board of Directors or equivalent governing body of a corporation or other entity.

 

  1  

 

 

“Agreement” - this contract between GW and British Sugar for the supply of BRM as set out in this document and the Schedules hereto.

 

Anti-Bribery and Sanctions Rules ” – the anti-bribery and sanctions rules set out in Schedule 8.

 

“Area Charge” - £***      million as such sum is increased under Clause 13.1.4.

 

“Batch” - the BRM resulting from Harvesting Production Plants of a single Chemovar grown from Cuttings taken and propagated in the same week, later transferred to the Flowering Zone (as defined in the Technical Agreement) in the same week, treated in all practical terms identically and Harvested on the same day.

 

“Batch Records” - all records held by British Sugar, which relate directly to the Production of a Batch.

 

“Botanical Raw Material” or “BRM” - the dried aerial parts of a Production Plant after it has been stripped from the stem, in baled and pelleted form, but before it has been processed further. References in this Agreement which pertain to the on-sale or supply by GW shall be construed to include any product containing BRM.

 

“British Sugar Improvements” - any and all Improvements to the British Sugar Know How developed by British Sugar whilst performing its obligations under this Agreement, including improvements to methods, techniques or standard operating procedures generally available to or used by horticultural growers or producers.

 

“British Sugar Improvements to GW Know How” - any and all Improvements to the GW Know How or GW Improvements developed in respect of Cannabis sativa L. growing and harvesting by British Sugar whilst performing its obligations under this Agreement.

 

“British Sugar Know How” – any and all Know How owned or controlled by British Sugar at the Effective Date which is used by British Sugar in Producing. For clarity, British Sugar Know How does not include any of GW Know How or GW Improvements licensed to it under Clause 14.1.

 

“BRM Specifications” - the specifications set out in the Technical Agreement (as such specifications may be amended from time to time by agreement) being the specifications for pre-milled BRM, as Produced in accordance with the Growing Protocol.

 

“Business Day” – 9.00am to 5.30pm UK time on a day other than a Saturday, Sunday or other day on which commercial banks in London, UK, are authorised or required by Law to close.

 

Budget for Costs ” – is defined in Clause 13.1.2.

 

“Certificate of Release” – a certificate of release approved by the appropriate personnel of British Sugar and supplied to GW with the Batch to which it relates, and which states that at the time of release (i) the Batch has been Produced in all material respects in accordance with the BRM Specifications, GACP and the Technical Agreement, and (ii) that in the reasonable opinion of British Sugar the Batch is acceptable for collection by GW.

 

“Chemovar” – the chemovar of Cannabis sativa L. which has been genetically and chemically characterised by GW and which produces a specified cannabinoid as the dominant cannabinoid.

 

“Competent Authority” - any national or local agency, authority, commission, department, inspectorate, minister, ministry, official, parliament, public or statutory Person (whether autonomous or not) or other instrumentality of the European Community or government of any country having jurisdiction over either any of the activities contemplated by this Agreement or over the Parties.

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  2  

 

 

“Confidential Information” - the following, subject to the exceptions set forth in Clause 15.1: (i) the terms and conditions of this Agreement, for which each Party will be considered a Disclosing Party and a Receiving Party; (ii) Know How within GW Know How or GW Improvements for which GW will be considered the Disclosing Party and British Sugar the Receiving Party; (iii) Know How within British Sugar Know How, British Sugar Improvements or British Sugar Improvements to GW Know How, for which British Sugar will be considered the Disclosing Party and GW the Receiving Party, and (iv) any other non-public information, whether or not patentable, disclosed or provided by one Party to the other Party in connection with this Agreement, including information regarding such Party’s strategy, business plans, objectives, research, technology, products, business affairs or finances and any other information of the type that is customarily considered to be confidential information by parties engaged in activities that are substantially similar to the activities being engaged in by the Parties under this Agreement, for which the Party making such disclosure will be considered the Disclosing Party and the Party receiving such disclosure will be considered the Receiving Party.

 

“Conversion Budget” – the budget of operating and capital costs forecast to be incurred by British Sugar in performing the Conversion Plan, as approved by the Parties pursuant to Clause 4.3.3.

 

“Conversion Plan” - plan of activities to be undertaken by British Sugar to convert the Facility so that it can Produce BRM, including the specification to which the conversion and related activities are to be undertaken, and the timetable within which such activities are to be completed, approved by the Parties pursuant to Clause 4.3.3.

 

“Crop Change Payment” - the aggregate amount payable by GW to compensate British Sugar for changing the crop grown at the Facility from a tomato crop to a cannabis crop, as set out in Clause 13.1.1.

 

“Cuttings” - a piece of sectioned plant material taken from a Mother Plant, which when potted up, can be grown to form a new Production Plant.

 

“Effective Date” – is defined in Clause 3.4.

 

“Equipment” - all moveable equipment and machinery required for Production.

 

“Facility” – the 45 acre area glasshouse owned by British Sugar set aside for growing Plants labelled “Facility” on the map attached at Schedule 9.

 

Fees ” – the Crop Change Payment, depreciation costs, the Area Charge, the Productivity Fee and the On Budget Fee, together with the unreimbursed costs relating to the Conversion Plan which are reimbursable under Clause 5.3.

 

“Force Majeure” - in relation to either Party, any event or circumstance which is beyond the reasonable control of that Party which event or circumstance that Party could not reasonably be expected to have taken into account at the Effective Date and which results in or causes the failure of that Party to perform any or all of its obligations under this Agreement, including acts of God, lightning, fire, storm, flood, earthquake, accumulation of snow or ice, lack of water arising from weather or environmental problems, strike, lockout or other industrial or student disturbance, act of the public enemy, war declared or undeclared, threat of war, terrorist act, blockade, revolution, riot, insurrection, civil commotion, public demonstration, sabotage, act of vandalism, prevention from or hindrance in obtaining in any way materials, energy or other supplies, explosion, fault or failure of plant or machinery (which could not have been prevented by good industry practice), or legal requirement governing either Party, provided that:

 

(i) lack of funds shall not be interpreted as a cause beyond the reasonable control of the affected Party;

 

(ii) loss or destruction of Plants due to infection or infestation of a Facility by an organism (whether prokaryotic or eukaryotic) which could have been prevented had such Facility been managed in accordance with good industry practice, shall not be interpreted as a cause beyond the reasonable control of the affected Party;

 

  3  

 

 

(iii) the amendment or coming into force of any legal provision adversely affecting GW in relation to this Agreement including any Economic Sanctions Law (as defined in Schedule 8) shall not be interpreted as a cause beyond the reasonable control of GW; and

 

(iv) the failure to obtain or retain all approvals necessary for GW to exercise its rights under this Agreement, (including the right to purchase or sell BRM) or the existence or imposition of any Law which restricts, prohibits or otherwise affects GW’s ability to commercialise or sell BRM, shall not be interpreted as a cause beyond the reasonable control of GW.

 

“Good Agricultural and Collection Practices” or “GACP” – (i) Red Tractor Assurance for Farms, Fresh Produce Scheme - Fresh Produce Standards, (ii) Red Tractor Assurance for Farms, Fresh Produce Scheme – Crop Specific Protocol for Sprouting Seeds and Leaves, (iii) the EUREPGAP regulatory standards and the principles and guidelines for Good Agricultural and Collection Practice (GACP), in each case ((i), (ii) and (iii)) in effect from time to time, or such alternative standards as GW may designate from time to time.

 

“Growing Plan” – a plan detailing the timings and volumes for Production in a given calendar year.

 

“Growing Protocol” - the protocol for the Production of the BRM set out in Appendix A to the Technical Agreement, as such protocol may be amended from time to time by agreement.

 

“Growth Rooms” – the growth rooms that are being installed on the Site, which provide agricultural seed pelleting and priming services to British Sugar, its growers and third party seed producers, which are labelled “Growth Rooms” on the map attached at Schedule 9.

 

“GW Improvements” – any and all Improvements to GW Know How developed or made by GW, including Improvements to the Growing Protocol, the Plants, the BRM or Production made by GW.

 

“GW Know How” – any and all Know How owned or controlled by GW at the Effective Date or at any time during the Term (including the Growing Protocol), which is necessary for Production. For clarity, GW Know How does not include British Sugar Know How, British Sugar Improvements, or British Sugar Improvements to GW Know How.

 

“Harvest” , “Harvested” or “Harvesting” – the activity of cutting down a particular crop of Production Plants ready for drying to Produce BRM, which activity will be performed in all material respects in accordance with the Technical Agreement.

 

“Harvest Date” - the date calculated in accordance with the Technical Agreement on which a particular crop of Production Plants is to be Harvested.

 

“Improvements” - improvements, modifications or adaptations to Know How.

 

“Insolvency Event” – in relation to either Party, means any one of the following:

 

(i) a notice shall have been issued to convene a meeting for the purpose of passing a resolution to wind up that Party, or such a resolution shall have been passed other than a resolution for the solvent reconstruction or reorganisation of that Party; or

 

(ii) a resolution shall have been passed by that Party’s directors to seek a winding up or a petition for a winding up shall have been presented against that Party which, in the case of a petition presented against a Party, shall not have been appealed within seven (7) days of having been lodged or such an order shall have been made and shall have been dismissed within thirty (30) days thereafter; or

 

(iii) a receiver, administrative receiver, receiver and manager, interim receiver, custodian, sequestrator or similar officer is appointed in respect of that Party or an encumbrancer takes steps to enforce or enforces its security which shall not have been dismissed by a court of competent jurisdiction within thirty (30) days thereafter; or

 

  4  

 

 

(iv) a resolution shall have been passed by that Party or that Party’s directors to make an application for an administration order or to appoint an administrator, or (ii) an application for an administration order shall have been made to the court or a notice of appointment of an administrator shall have been filed at the court in respect of that Party, which in the case of such an application made to the court or notice filed with the court, shall not have been appealed within seven (7) days of having been made or filed or such an order or appointment shall have been dismissed within thirty (30) days thereafter; or

 

(v) a proposal for a voluntary arrangement shall have been made in relation to that Party under Part I Insolvency Act 1986; or

 

(vi) a step or event shall have been taken or have arisen outside the United Kingdom which is similar or analogous to any of the steps or events listed at (i) to (v) above; or

 

(vii) that Party takes any step (including starting negotiations) with a view to readjustment, rescheduling or deferral of any part of that Party’s indebtedness, or proposes or makes any general assignment, composition or arrangement with or for the benefit of all or some of that Party’s creditors or makes or suspends or threatens to suspend making payments to all or some of that Party’s creditors or the Party submits to any type of voluntary arrangement; or

 

(viii) where that Party is resident in the United Kingdom it is deemed to be unable to pay its debts within the meaning of Section 123 Insolvency Act 1986.

 

“Know How” – the technical and other information which is not in the public domain, including information comprising or relating to concepts, discoveries, data, designs, formulae, ideas, inventions, methods, models, assays, research plans, procedures, designs for experiments and tests and results of experimentation and testing (including results of research or development), processes (including plant generation and growing processes, specifications, methods and techniques), laboratory records, chemical, pharmacological, toxicological, clinical, analytical and quality control data, trial data, case report forms, data analyses, reports, manufacturing data or summaries and information contained in submissions to and information from ethical committees and regulatory authorities. Know How includes documents containing Know How, including but not limited to any rights including trade secrets, copyright, database or design rights protecting such Know How. The fact that an item is known to the public shall not be taken to preclude the possibility that a compilation including the item, or a development relating to the item, is not known to the public.

 

“Law” – all laws, statutes, rules, regulations, ordinances, guidelines and other pronouncements of any Competent Authority having the effect of law.

 

“Marketing Authorisation” – the approval granted by a Competent Authority permitting a Person to market a medicinal product in a country.

 

“Mother Plants” – the mother cannabis plants grown and maintained solely for the intention of producing further generations of Cuttings.

 

“On Budget Fee” - is defined in Clause 13.1.6.

 

“Operating Costs” – is defined in Schedule 1.

 

“Packing Date” – the date on which a Batch of BRM is packaged and labelled ready for delivery.

 

“Partner” – a Person with whom GW enters into a collaboration or licence in relation to the commercialisation of a drug product for which BRM is a starting material.

 

“Party” or “Parties” – GW or British Sugar.

 

“Person” - an individual, sole proprietorship, partnership, limited partnership, limited liability partnership, corporation, limited liability company, business trust, joint stock company, trust, incorporated association, joint venture or similar entity or organisation, including a government or political subdivision, department or agency of a government.

 

  5  

 

 

“Plant” – a cannabis plant of the Chemovar, irrespective of whether it is a Mother Plant, Production Plant or Cutting.

 

“Production” – all activities relating to purchasing, planting, propagation, cultivation, maintenance, Harvesting, drying, pelleting, packing, QC, Release, storage, shipment and supply of the BRM specified in the Technical Agreement and removal, reprocessing or recycling of the bi-products from Harvesting, and “ Produce ” and “ Producing ” shall be interpreted accordingly.

 

“Production Plant” – a Plant grown solely for the purpose of flowering to produce BRM.

 

“Productivity Fee” - is defined in Clause 13.1.5.

 

“Regulatory Approval” – any manufacturing or other licence required by British Sugar to grow the Plants, Produce BRM, store, supply and dispose of the Plants and any by-products, being any licence or authorisation to Produce BRM as granted by the relevant Competent Authorities equivalent to and including the “Home Office Licence to Produce, Supply and Possess”.

 

“Release” – the mechanism by which each Batch is deemed to conform in all material respects with the BRM Specifications (including in accordance with GACP). Release is demonstrated by issue of a Certificate of Release.

 

“Site” – the area marked on the map attached at Schedule 9 as the “Site”, including the Facility and the Growth Rooms.

 

“Settlement Agreement” – ***

 

.

 

“Supplier Non-Conformity/Reject Note” – a certificate (as more fully defined in the Technical Agreement) issued by GW, which (i) when issued by GW pursuant to Clause 8.6.1 formally indicates to British Sugar an incidence of non-conformance of a Batch (or part thereof) in any material respect with the BRM Specifications, or (ii) when issued by GW pursuant to Clause 8.6.2 formally indicates to British Sugar an incidence of non-conformance of a Batch (or part thereof) in any material respect with the BRM Specifications (which was not apparent on a reasonable inspection), where GW reasonably believes that the non-conformity has arisen from a failure on the part of British Sugar to meet its obligations under the Technical Agreement in any material respect.

 

“Technical Agreement” – the technical agreement between the Parties dated on or about the Effective Date which specifies the respective responsibilities of the Parties relating to the cultivation and control of BRM as may be amended from time to time by the Parties in writing.

 

“Term” – is defined in Clause 18.1.

 

***                                                                                                                                                                            .

 

“Type 1 Conversion Costs” – (i) costs identified as such in the preliminary budget of conversion costs set out in Schedule 2, and (ii) the costs of any item required for the conversion project that is not identified in the preliminary budget in Schedule 2 but is of a similar nature to those items labelled as being Type 1 Conversion Costs in the preliminary budget of conversion costs, such as additional Equipment.

 

“Type 2 Conversion Costs” – (i) costs identified as such in the preliminary budget of conversion costs set out in Schedule 2, and (ii) the costs of any item required for the conversion project that is not identified in the preliminary budget in Schedule 2 but is of a similar nature to those items labelled as being Type 2 Conversion Costs in the preliminary budget of conversion costs, such as costs relating to the supply of utilities to the Facility.

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  6  

 

 

1.2 In this Agreement, unless the context otherwise requires:

 

1.2.1 unless otherwise stated, a reference to a Clause or Schedule is a reference to a clause of, or schedule to, this Agreement;

 

1.2.2 clause headings are for ease of reference only and do not affect the construction of this Agreement;

 

1.2.3 references in this Agreement to any statute or statutory provision shall include any statute or statutory provision which amends, extends, consolidates or replaces the same (whether before or after the Effective Date) or which has been amended, extended, consolidated or replaced by the same and shall include any order, regulation, instrument or other subordinate legislation made under the relevant statute or statutory provision;

 

1.2.4 words in the singular shall include the plural and vice versa and references to the masculine gender shall include the feminine gender and vice versa;

 

1.2.5 the words “include”, “including” or “in particular” are to be construed without limitation to the generality of the preceding words;

 

1.2.6 any reference to “writing” includes a reference to any communication effected by facsimile transmission or similar means, but not e-mail;

 

1.2.7 the word “or” has the inclusive meaning represented by the phrase “and/or”; and

 

1.2.8 any covenant by a Party not to do an act or thing shall be deemed to include an obligation not to permit or suffer such act or thing to be done by another Person.

 

1.3 If there is any inconsistency between Clauses 1 to 23 (inclusive) of this Agreement and any Schedule, such Clauses shall prevail. If any provisions of the Technical Agreement are in direct conflict with the terms of Clauses 1 to 23 (inclusive) of this Agreement, so that the provisions of both documents cannot be given effect, the terms of this Agreement shall govern the specific issue unless it is a quality-related issue, in which case the provisions of the Technical Agreement shall govern the issue.

 

2. AMENDMENT AND RESTATEMENT

 

2.1 This Agreement restates and amends the Original Agreement with effect from the date of this Agreement and replaces and supersedes the Original Agreement in its entirety.

 

3. Condition precedent

 

3.1 The coming into force and effect of this Agreement is conditional on British Sugar entering into the Settlement Agreement.

 

3.2 British Sugar shall use reasonable endeavours to achieve satisfaction of the condition under Clause 3.1 by 15 September 2016, but shall, for the avoidance of doubt, not be obliged in any circumstances to enter into the Settlement Agreement where the terms are unacceptable to British Sugar.

 

3.3 British Sugar shall give written notice to GW of the satisfaction of the condition under Clause 3.1 within one (1) Business Day of the condition being satisfied.

 

3.4 The “ Effective Date ” shall be the first Business Day following the date of the written notice issued under Clause 3.3.

 

3.5 Pending satisfaction of the condition under Clause 3.1 the Parties shall engage in planning activities with respect to the activities needed to convert the Facility to be able to be Produce BRM and the fully costed budget therefor, as further specified in Clause 4 and Schedule 2, at their own cost. However, no conversion activities can or should be initiated prior to the Effective Date.

 

  7  

 

 

3.6 If the condition has not been satisfied by 15 September 2016 the Parties shall meet in good faith to discuss (i) whether to persist with efforts to satisfy the condition under Clause 3.1 in 2016 or whether British Sugar will proceed with its tomato growing business in 2016/2017, and (ii) the consequences for conditional obligations in the Agreement and the time for their eventual completion if the Condition is not satisfied by 15 September 2016. In the event that the condition precedent is not satisfied and the Parties decide not to proceed with the Agreement, each Party shall pay its own costs and expenses.

 

3.7 Clauses 1, 2, 3, 15, 22.4, 22.5, 22.6, 22.7, 22.8, 22.9, 22.10, 22.11, 22.12 and 22.13 of this Agreement shall come into effect on the date of this Agreement. All other provisions of this Agreement shall come into effect on the Effective Date.

 

4. Project Management

 

4.1 British Sugar and GW each appoints the individual identified as such in Schedule 2 as its project manager. Each project manager shall have authority to represent its appointer on all day to day matters relating to the conversion of the Facility to be suitable for Production, the Production of BRM, or otherwise arising under this Agreement. In particular the respective Parties’ project managers will be responsible for:

 

4.1.1 co-ordinating all Conversion Plan-related activities, including overseeing the performance thereof;

 

4.1.2 seeking to resolve any issues arising under the Agreement. The Parties’ respective project managers shall use all reasonable endeavours to resolve issues arising under this Agreement, but shall refer all problems which are outside their ordinary authority to resolve to the Parties; and

 

4.1.3 day to day liaison between the Parties.

 

Each Party may replace its project manager at any time by notice to the other Party. Each of British Sugar and GW agrees that it will endeavour to ensure continuity of its project manager, but the Parties accept that project managers may need to be changed for operational, employment, and availability reasons. Where a Party’s project manager is to be replaced, that Party shall make reasonable efforts to ensure that a replacement is appointed as soon as practicable, and that there is a reasonable handover period and that any adverse effects of the change of its project manager are minimised.

 

4.2 Whilst any activities are on-going under the Conversion Plan or Growing Plan:

 

4.2.1 the British Sugar project manager shall send his counterpart at GW an email, no less frequently than once every week, summarising activities initiated, completed or continuing to be performed at British Sugar under the Conversion Plan or Growing Plan, including details of progress with such on-going activity, anticipated completion date and, if required, an explanation of why such completion date is different to that scheduled in the relevant plan or a previous week’s update. At the request of the GW project manager following receipt of such an email, the project managers shall convene by telephone to discuss the content of a weekly update email and any issues arising therefrom; and

 

  8  

 

 

4.2.2 the project managers shall meet in person or by teleconference no less frequently than once each calendar month to (i) review and discuss progress with implementing the Conversion Plan, (ii) discuss changes to the current BRM Specifications and the Production process and the implementation of any improvements thereto, and (iii) review the operation of this Agreement. Dates of meetings shall be agreed by the project managers not less than twenty one (21) days beforehand. The first meeting of the project managers will take place as soon as practicable after the Effective Date, but in no event later than fifteen (15) days after the Effective Date. In addition, special meetings of the project managers may be called by either project manager upon written request.

 

4.3 The Parties shall meet:

 

4.3.1 by no later than 30 September in each calendar year during the Term to review the terms of the Agreement and its operation over the previous 12 months and to discuss ways in which Production, and each Party’s performance or the terms of the Agreement may be improved. This review and discussion shall cover the following matters:

 

(a) A discussion in good faith of the actual Operating Costs incurred in the current calendar year and the Budget for Costs and depreciation costs for the coming calendar year, as further specified in Clause 13.1.2 and 13.1.3.

 

(b) A discussion in good faith of the charging methodology to be used in the subsequent calendar year, both Parties accepting that the desired goal is to operate a charging mechanism that rewards British Sugar for the volume of BRM produced in that calendar year and in future years the CBD content of the BRM may be recognised in the charging methodology .

 

(c) A discussion in good faith of the Growing Plan for the coming calendar year and the target yield of BRM for the coming calendar year.

 

(d) A discussion in good faith of British Sugar proposed continuous improvement plan for the following year.

 

(e) A discussion in good faith as to the period of time required by GW to analyse a Batch under Clause 8.6.2.

 

(f) A discussion in good faith as to operational concerns and how these can be addressed.

 

(g) A discussion in good faith of the development of the Epidiolex market, GW’s short to medium term forecasts for total BRM volume and potential glasshouse expansion opportunities.

 

Any agreement reached on an amendment to the Agreement at such a meeting shall be reduced to writing and signed by an authorised representative of each Party in accordance with Clause 22.7.

 

4.3.2 by no later than 31 January in each calendar year during the Term to:

 

(a) Review (i) amounts invoiced and paid, (ii) total volume of BRM Produced and delivered, (iii) total volume of BRM meeting the BRM Specifications Produced and delivered, during the prior calendar year, (iv) Operating Costs incurred and paid, and (v) Budget for Costs set in the prior September pursuant to Clause 4.3.1.

 

(b) Determine the On Budget Fee for the prior calendar year in accordance with the provisions of Clause 13.1.6 .

 

  9  

 

 

(c) Reconcile the amounts actually invoiced and paid in the prior calendar year against the amounts due under the terms of the Agreement for the Production of BRM in the prior calendar year, specifically taking into account the Conversion Costs, Budget for Costs, Productivity Fee, On Budget Fee, and the volume of BRM rejected for not meeting the BRM Specifications.

 

Thereafter British Sugar shall issue an invoice or credit note, as applicable for any variance between the amounts invoiced and paid for BRM Produced and delivered in the prior calendar year and the amounts properly due for BRM Produced and delivered in the prior calendar year.

 

4.3.3 with the Project Managers promptly after the Conversion Plan and Conversion Budget have been prepared pursuant to the Facility conversion project planning process set out in Schedule 2, so that the Project Managers can present their proposed Conversion Plan and Conversion Budget for discussion and approval. The provisional budget for the conversion activities is as set out in Schedule 2. This provisional budget is based on the Parties’ current estimations of the capital costs required to convert the Facility and reflects the Parties’ objective of converting, as cost effectively as reasonably practicable, the Facility into a building capable of Producing BRM. The Parties shall discuss the proposed Conversion Plan and Conversion Budget in good faith. If the Conversion Budget presented exceeds £***        the Project Managers will explain (i) the steps they have taken to order and prioritise activities and spend under the budget to ensure the essential conversion activities are performed and paid for first, so as to make the Facility operational before the £***         threshold is exceeded, (ii) why the initial estimates were inaccurate, and (iii) the steps taken across the Conversion Plan and Conversion Budget to mitigate the cost increases. Neither Party will unreasonably withhold its agreement to the Conversion Plan. Neither Party will unreasonably withhold its agreement to the Conversion Budget if the Conversion Budget does not exceed £***        . If the Conversion Budget exceeds £***        , neither Party will unreasonably withhold its agreement to the Conversion Budget, but the following principles shall apply: (i) GW shall be responsible for any costs incurred in performing the approved Conversion Plan (a) up to the £***        cap, and (b) above the £***        cap to extent the additional cost is attributable to an increase in Type 1 Conversion Costs, and (ii) British Sugar shall be responsibility for any costs incurred in performing the approved Conversion Plan above the £***         cap to the extent the additional cost is attributable to an increase in Type 2 Conversion Costs.

 

5. GLASSHOUSE CONVERSION AND USE OF THE Facility

 

5.1 The Parties have agreed that British Sugar is to convert the Facility to be able to be Produce BRM. The Parties shall constitute a Facility conversion project planning team as specified in Schedule 2 to appraise and define the scope of the conversion work, the specifications to which the conversion work is to be performed, to obtain quotes for the conversion work to be undertaken, to prepare the draft Conversion Plan and draft Conversion Budget and, once the Conversion Plan and Conversion Budget have been approved under Clause 4.3.3, oversee the execution of the Conversion Plan. The factors to be considered by the Facility conversion project planning team when devising their draft Conversion Plan and draft Conversion Budget, including the agreed assumptions as to the timing of when capital and operational costs associated with the conversion of the Facility would be reimbursed, are set out in Schedule 2.

 

5.2 Once the Conversion Plan and Conversion Budget have been agreed under Clause 4.3.3, British Sugar undertakes to perform the Conversion Plan with all reasonable skill, care and attention and in accordance with any and all Laws, using reasonable endeavours to complete such works in accordance with the timetable set out in the Conversion Plan.

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  10  

 

 

5.3 GW shall fund British Sugar’s performing of the Conversion Plan subject to the following terms. GW shall reimburse British Sugar its actual direct costs of the Conversion Plan so long as British Sugar is carrying out the Conversion Plan in a prudent economic manner, consistent with the requirements of the Conversion Plan and having regard to the nature of the works and the dates and periods specified in Conversion Plan. GW will reimburse any costs overrun incurred by British Sugar in performing agreed activities under the Conversion Plan (a) to the extent they do not take the total cost of the conversion above £***        , and (b) if they do take the total cost of the conversion above £***         , to the extent to extent the additional cost is attributable to an increase in Type 1 Conversion Costs, and in each case subject to British Sugar informing GW of the same in advance of invoicing them. Without prejudice to the foregoing if, for some reason British Sugar requires a change to the Conversion Budget, such as to cover additional activities or additional Equipment or fixtures not captured in the Conversion Plan, British Sugar shall present GW with evidence for the requested change and the Parties, working through the Project Managers, shall discuss and implement such changes in good faith including by making a change to the Conversion Plan if required. GW will not unreasonably withhold its consent to a requested change to the Conversion Plan or Conversion Budget requested under this Clause 5.3, but the principles specified in Clause 4.3.3 shall apply with respect to the allocation of responsibility for the additional costs. British Sugar shall invoice and GW shall pay for allowable costs under this Clause in accordance with the terms of Clauses 13.4 to 13.13.

 

5.4 During the Term British Sugar may use the Site, with the exception of the Facility (which will be exclusively used for the Production of BRM during the Term), for any purposes required by the Associated British Foods plc corporate group, including the Growth Rooms, provided that any such use of the Site by British Sugar does not adversely impact the Production of BRM at the Facility .

 

6. appointment

 

6.1 GW hereby appoints British Sugar as an external supplier of BRM for the Term on a non-exclusive basis. BRM shall only be Produced at and supplied from the Facility. During the Term British Sugar shall not grow Cannabis sativa varieties for any Person except an Affiliate of GW. GW undertakes to purchase from British Sugar 100% of BRM produced by British Sugar as set out in Schedule 6.

 

7. KNOW-HOW TRANSFER/SUPPLY OF PLANTS

 

7.1 On the Effective Date GW shall, to the extent it has not already done so, give full disclosure to British Sugar of, and permit British Sugar to use for the purpose of performing its obligations under this Agreement, all GW Know How. In addition GW shall promptly (i) provide to British Sugar such technical advice and guidance from GW employees and or representatives (as appropriate) as British Sugar may reasonably request and at times to be agreed by the Parties for the purpose of understanding GW Know How disclosed to British Sugar; and (ii) supply or shall arrange the supply to British Sugar of the quantities of Plants required to establish the Facility to Produce BRM at a time to be agreed; and (iii) disclose to British Sugar GW Improvements necessary or useful to Produce BRM in accordance with the Growing Protocol.

 

7.2 Subject to Clause 7.3 below, once British Sugar is in possession of Plants, it will not without the prior consent of GW: (i) use the Plants for any purpose other than Production at the Facility; (ii) supply the Plants to any other Person; (iii) use the Plants in human subjects; (iv) chemically or biologically modify the Plants; (v) use the Plants to support the development of any commercial product containing the Plants; (vi) use or license any Plants to support the development of any commercial product; or (vii) disseminate, publish or disclose to any Person any information, data, report, summary or the like concerning, using or based on the results produced in carrying out Production, the Plants or any of its activities hereunder.

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  11  

 

 

7.3 British Sugar may deal with any by-products arising from the Production of BRM and any Plants that cannot be used in the Production of BRM, including the right to utilise these by-products and Plants and/or supply them to any other Person. All revenues generated from dealing with such by-products (if any) shall be set off against the Operating Costs payable to British Sugar for the calendar year in which they are collected.

 

7.4 If British Sugar at any time believes GW to be in default of its obligations under Clause 7.1 giving rise to circumstances which excuse British Sugar’s performance under this Agreement, British Sugar shall give prompt written notice of this fault to GW giving reason for this belief (each such notice containing details of such facts). Should British Sugar fail to give prompt notice of such circumstances following it becoming aware of the same British Sugar shall not be entitled to rely on any such default by GW to excuse British Sugar’s performance.

 

8. PRODUCTION, DELIVERY AND ACCEPTANCE

 

8.1 British Sugar shall take and pot up Cuttings in accordance with the Growing Plan and shall cultivate each crop of Production Plants in all material respects in accordance with the Growing Protocol. Upon each Harvest Date British Sugar shall Harvest that crop of Production Plants and thereafter shall complete the Production of each Batch.

 

8.2 British Sugar shall notify GW in writing of each Packing Date within five (5) Business Days of it occurring and provided that the foregoing notification was duly given GW shall arrange for its carrier to accept delivery of each Batch within one (1) week from receipt of such notification. The actual delivery dates shall be mutually agreed between the Parties.

 

8.3 Prior to delivery of any Batch, British Sugar will supply the Responsible Person (as defined in the Technical Agreement) at GW with all pre-despatch documents specified in the Technical Agreement, including the Certificate of Release. Each Batch of BRM shall be delivered to GW’s designated carrier on an ex-works basis (EXW, Incoterms 2010) in its entirety (except for agreed samples) and shall be accompanied by all documentation necessary to comply with the Regulatory Approvals. Upon arrival at GW’s (or its nominee’s) premises, each Party will complete all post-despatch documents in accordance with the requirements of the Technical Agreement. Title and risk of damage and loss in a Batch shall pass to GW upon delivery of such Batch to GW’s designated carrier, and GW shall be responsible for all costs of shipping, taxes, insurance, warehousing and other similar or related costs after delivery.

 

8.4 When performing Production British Sugar shall comply in all material respects with the Technical Agreement.

 

8.5 British Sugar shall package, label and store the BRM appropriately for delivery to GW in all material respects in accordance with the requirements of the Technical Agreement, and the reasonable instructions of GW. British Sugar shall ensure that appropriate storage conditions are met until delivery.

 

8.6 Acceptance:

 

8.6.1 GW or GW’s representative shall examine each Batch and the documentation delivered with each Batch pursuant to Clause 8.5 as soon as practicable following arrival at GW’s or its nominee’s premises. Within ten (10) days of delivery of each Batch GW shall send British Sugar a Supplier Non-Conformity/Reject Note containing details of any failure of the Batch or part of the Batch to meet the BRM Specifications that are apparent on reasonable inspection. If British Sugar has not received a Supplier Non-Conformity/Reject Note within twelve (12) days of delivery the Batch shall be deemed to have been delivered complete and undamaged and (in respect of any defect apparent on reasonable inspection) in compliance with the BRM Specifications. In the event that GW gives British Sugar a Supplier Non-Conformity/Reject Note in relation to any Batch GW shall make promptly available such material to British Sugar for inspection by British Sugar. If following such inspection by British Sugar (which shall take place within thirty (30) days of such BRM being made available to British Sugar) it is agreed by British Sugar that the Batch or part of the Batch is not in compliance with the BRM Specifications GW will deduct the volume of rejected BRM from the annual accepted quantity used in the financial calculations under this Agreement. British Sugar may test each Batch in advance of delivery at British Sugar’s own cost and expense to ensure they will meet the requirements of the BRM Specifications.

 

  12  

 

 

8.6.2 Thereafter, if within three (3) months of the delivery date for a Batch (or such shorter period as is agreed by the Parties under Clause 4.3.1(e)): (i) the results of GW’s analysis of a Batch shows a non-conformance to the BRM Specifications (which was not apparent on a reasonable inspection) and GW has reasonable cause to believe that this has arisen from a failure on the part of British Sugar to meet its obligations in any material respect under the Technical Agreement (such belief to be supported by documented evidence including a copy of the results of the laboratory analysis of the Batch (or part thereof) in question showing the non-conformance to the BRM Specifications) then GW shall give British Sugar a Supplier Non-Conformity/Reject Note within twenty five (25) days of receipt of such analysis and shall at British Sugar’s expense make available such material to British Sugar for further testing. If following such further testing by British Sugar and following investigation by British Sugar of all available site records in relation to the Batch (which shall take place within thirty (30) days of such BRM being made available to British Sugar) it is agreed by British Sugar that the Batch or part of the Batch was not Produced in accordance with the BRM Specifications GW will deduct the volume of the rejected BRM from the annual accepted quantity used to calculate the Productivity Fee. For clarity so long as the results of GW’s analysis of a Batch are received by GW within three (3) months of delivery of the relevant Batch (unless otherwise agreed by the Parties under Clause 4.3.1(e)) and the Supplier Non-Conformity/Reject Note is served on British Sugar within twenty five (25) days after GW’s receipt of the results of such analysis such Supplier Non-Conformity/Reject Note shall be valid even if delivered after three (3) months of the delivery date so long as the other relevant requirements of this Clause 8.6.2 have been complied with.

 

8.6.3 If after British Sugar has carried out the inspection envisaged in Clause 8.6.1 above or the further testing envisaged in Clause 8.6.2 above British Sugar disagrees with GW’s view that on delivery the Batch or part of the Batch failed to conform in all material respects to the BRM Specifications, and therefore there is a dispute between the Parties relating thereto, then either: (i) British Sugar shall promptly send a sample of the Batch in question to an independent testing laboratory to be appointed by agreement between GW and British Sugar (such agreement to be reached expeditiously), or (ii) where appropriate, the Parties shall appoint an independent expert (“ Expert ”) to investigate compliance with the BRM Specifications. If the Parties elect to send the sample to an independent laboratory, the costs of such independent testing laboratory shall be borne equally between GW and British Sugar. The decision of such independent testing laboratory shall be in writing and, save for manifest error on the face of decision, shall be binding on both GW and British Sugar. If the Parties elect to resolve the issue by Expert determination, the Expert shall be engaged on the terms set out in Schedule 5.

 

8.6.4 Any Batch that, as a result of the procedures set out in Clauses 8.6.1 to 8.6.3 is found to have been Produced other than in compliance with the BRM Specifications shall be destroyed with associated costs to be included within Operating Costs.

 

  13  

 

 

8.6.5 If GW fails to notify British Sugar of its return of a Batch within the time limits set out in Clauses 8.6.1 to 8.6.2 the Batch shall be deemed accepted and within the BRM Specifications. GW shall not be entitled to return the BRM concerned and British Sugar shall have no liability for any defect in such Batch and GW shall not be entitled to deduct the volume of the rejected BRM from the annual accepted quantity used in the financial calculations of this Agreement.

 

8.6.6 Should any Batch fail to meet any other internal GW specifications, the Parties shall, without imposing any liability or additional obligations on British Sugar, meet to discuss the same and any changes to the Growing Protocol that may be recommended.

 

8.6.7 Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement (including the remaining provisions of this Clause 8 and Clause 16) GW expressly recognises and agrees the following:-

 

(a) British Sugar has to date grown wholly different horticultural products at the Facility;

 

(b) the Parties have entered into this Agreement primarily because of the size of the Facility and that, while GW recognises that British Sugar has substantial expertise in large scale horticultural production, British Sugar does not have or profess to have high levels of expertise in Production or in BRM; and

 

(c) inevitably there will be a “learning curve” in terms of British Sugar’s performance under this Agreement and accordingly

 

British Sugar does not accept any absolute obligation as to outcome, timing or performance in respect of its obligations to Produce BRM under this Agreement and all such obligations under this Agreement assumed by British Sugar shall be read as if subject only to British Sugar using reasonable endeavours to Produce BRM that meets the BRM Specifications in the agreed volumes. However, if British Sugar is experiencing difficulties in Producing BRM despite using its reasonable endeavours, British Sugar shall notify GW of the difficulties it is experiencing and ask GW for technical advice and guidance under Clause 7.1 to overcome these difficulties.

 

9. INSPECTIONS AND AUDITS

 

9.1 GW shall, at its own expense, have the right from time to time to assign a reasonable number of its employees or representatives (including employees or representatives of a Partner) to be present at the Facility to inspect, discuss and review all activities being undertaken by or on behalf of British Sugar in relation to Production and to inspect all documents and records created by British Sugar in relation to Production, including the Batch Records. Such employees and representatives shall, while at the Premises observe and comply with British Sugar’s safety and other customary regulations and policies. Where the employees or representatives of GW do not comply with such regulations and policies British Sugar shall have the right to remove them from the Premises. Where British Sugar imposes conditions on entry of the employees or representatives of GW to the Facility, GW shall ensure that these are complied with by such employees and representatives.

 

9.2 British Sugar will allow representatives of any Competent Authority to inspect the relevant parts of the Facility where Production is carried out and to inspect all documents and records created by British Sugar in relation to Production, including the Batch Records, including to verify compliance with GACP and other practices or Laws and will promptly notify GW of the scheduling of any such inspection. British Sugar acknowledges that representatives of any Competent Authority may appear at the Facility without prior notice, and British Sugar will notify the GW project manager of this visit by telephone and use reasonable endeavours to facilitate such unannounced visits in accordance with its standard procedures.

 

  14  

 

 

9.3 British Sugar shall notify GW within three (3) Business Days after it has been notified of any inquiry, notification, or inspection activity by any Competent Authority relating to BRM, as detailed in the Technical Agreement. British Sugar shall provide a reasonable description to GW of any such inquiries, notifications or inspections promptly (but in no event later than ten (10) days after such inquiry, notification, or inspection).

 

10. INFORMATION SHARING

 

10.1 British Sugar shall inform GW of all reportable incidences in accordance with the terms of the Technical Agreement in writing, as soon as possible from the time it becomes reportable and in any event within the time period specified in the Technical Agreement.

 

10.2 Each Party shall keep the other Party informed, commencing within two (2) Business Days of notification of any action by, or notification or other information which it receives (directly or indirectly) from any Competent Authority, which (i) raises material concerns regarding the safety or efficacy of the BRM, or (ii) which indicates or suggests a potential material liability for either Party to third parties arising in connection with the BRM (including in the case of GW, BRM supplied to it by third parties to the extent GW can share such information with British Sugar without breaching any obligations of confidence it owes the third party). GW shall notify British Sugar promptly in the event a drug product containing a drug substance derived from BRM is withdrawn or recalled due to a Marketing Authorisation for such drug product being withdrawn, suspended or revoked.

 

11. DOCUMENTATION, RECORDS AND PERMITS

 

11.1 GW shall at its expense do all such things as are necessary to enable British Sugar promptly to obtain all Regulatory Approvals. British Sugar shall provide reasonable assistance but shall rely entirely on GW’s expertise in obtaining such Regulatory Approvals. Subject to obtaining all assistance reasonably necessary from GW (which GW hereby agrees to provide), British Sugar shall take all steps reasonably necessary to maintain Regulatory Approvals, the costs of which will form part of the Operating Costs, (provided that maintenance of the Regulatory Approvals does not extend to changes made to Regulatory Approvals which impose materially more onerous obligations on British Sugar or which have a material adverse effect on British Sugar, except to the extent the imposition of such obligations or effects arise from British Sugar’s own misconduct). In the event that a Regulatory Approval is withdrawn, both Parties shall take all reasonable steps to achieve its reinstatement (to the extent a reinstatement is possible) and Clauses 20.2, 20.3 and 20.4 shall apply.

 

11.2 British Sugar shall prepare and maintain the Batch Records and all other documentation relating to Production in all material respects in accordance with the terms of the Technical Agreement.

 

11.3 British Sugar shall safely store and archive all records relating to BRM Production in accordance with the requirements of the Technical Agreement. In the event GW wishes the Batch Records to be retained by British Sugar beyond the time period set out in the Technical Agreement, British Sugar may charge GW a standard annual storage fee for the retention of such Batch Records at a price to be agreed in advance by both Parties.

 

12. FURTHER RIGHTS, OBLIGATIONS AND RESPONSIBILITIES

 

The following rights, obligations and responsibilities shall also apply:

 

12.1 British Sugar shall be responsible for maintaining Equipment and infrastructure at the Facility following completion of the Conversion Plan. If any Equipment or other assets are to be supplied by GW, purchased by British Sugar for and on behalf of GW, or if GW is to otherwise reimburse British Sugar its costs for purchasing any Equipment or other assets, GW shall own all right, title and interest in and to any and all such Equipment and other assets, including the right to claim capital allowances thereon, shall make such Equipment and assets available to British Sugar for the sole purpose of Producing, such Equipment and assets shall be clearly marked as “owned by GW Pharma Limited” and British Sugar shall keep a written log of all Equipment and other assets owned by GW that is used at the Facility, including details of serial or registration numbers and ensure such Equipment and other assets are readily identifiable.

 

  15  

 

 

12.2 During the Term, British Sugar shall (i) maintain all Equipment in good working condition (subject to fair wear and tear), and (ii) maintain the environment and access at each of the Facility in a manner appropriate for Production.

 

12.3 On termination or expiry of the Agreement, GW shall have the right to remove from the Facility the Equipment and other assets that are owned by it, and GW shall remove such Equipment and other assets that it wishes to retain within 30 days of the effective date of termination or expiry. If there are items of Equipment and other assets at the Facility that GW does not wish to retain ownership of, British Sugar shall have the right to purchase such assets and Equipment at a price to be agreed. If the Parties cannot agree a price for such assets and Equipment, or British Sugar does not wish to purchase any such asset or item of Equipment, GW will remove such item(s) from the Facility at its own cost.

 

12.4 British Sugar shall comply with all applicable environmental, health and safety Laws in performing its obligations under this Agreement and warrants that it provides a safe and healthy workplace, presenting no immediate hazards to its employees and that it provides access to clean water, food, and emergency healthcare to its employees in the event of accidents or incidents. To the extent required by Law, GW shall be entitled to monitor and audit the compliance by British Sugar with the obligations set out in this Clause. British Sugar shall provide to GW all information regarding environmental, health and safety matters as GW may reasonably request from time to time at no cost.

 

12.5 GW shall comply with all applicable environmental, health, safety and other Laws in exercising its rights pursuant to this Agreement including in connection with the commercialisation of BRM and warrants that it shall at all times provide a safe and healthy workplace, which present no immediate hazards to its employees and that it provides access to clean water, food, and emergency healthcare to its employees in the event of accidents or incidents.

 

12.6 Each of the Parties shall comply with, and shall not engage directly or indirectly in any activities that could subject either Party to any liability under the Modern Slavery Act 2015 or any equivalent measures in any other relevant country or jurisdiction.

 

12.7 Each Party shall fully comply with the Anti-Bribery and Sanctions Rules.

 

12.8 Each calendar year during the Term, British Sugar shall prepare a continuous improvement plan in relation to Production. The continuous improvement plan shall include detailed plans to reduce the cost of Production and increase yields. The first continuous improvement plan shall be prepared as soon as possible after the Effective Date and shall be reviewed in line with the arrangements detailed in Clause 4.3.1. Each continuous improvement plan shall be subject to discussions between British Sugar and GW and shall be implemented only with GW’s prior written consent. GW shall have the right to propose to British Sugar improvements to the Production process at any time. British Sugar shall evaluate and discuss any such proposed improvements with GW. If the Parties agree that the proposed improvement shall be implemented, British Sugar shall amend the then applicable continuous improvement plan to take account of the proposed improvement. To the extent a continuous improvement plan includes changes to the Growing Protocol, or requires a change to the Growing Protocol in order for the improvement to be implemented, the provisions of Clause 12.10 shall apply .

 

  16  

 

 

12.9 Both Parties shall, at all times during the Term, comply with the terms of this Agreement and the Technical Agreement.

 

12.10 Either Party may suggest amendments to the BRM Specifications (including the Growing Protocol) at any time in accordance with Change Control (as defined in accordance with the requirements of the Technical Agreement) procedure set out in the Technical Agreement. The Parties shall discuss such proposed changes in good faith, including (i) whether British Sugar can implement the requested change or amendment to the BRM Specifications (including the Growing Protocol), and (ii) if British Sugar can implement the requested change or amendment to the BRM Specifications (including the Growing Protocol), the consequences of such change on the Budget for Costs and the time it will take British Sugar to implement the change. British Sugar will not unreasonably withhold or delay its consent to change or amendment to the BRM Specifications (including the Growing Protocol), but no change shall be effective unless agreed in writing by both Parties.

 

12.11 A list of key personnel for both GW and British Sugar, together with specimens of their signatures is presented in Appendix G of the Technical Agreement. Both Parties shall keep each other informed in writing as to changes in such key personnel from time to time.

 

13. CONSIDERATION

 

13.1 In consideration of British Sugar supplying GW with BRM on the terms set out herein GW shall compensate British Sugar, on a cost per kilogram basis (whereby the cost per kilogram is determined by taking into account the following calculated amounts, divided by the number of kilograms of BRM Produced in each calendar year) as follows:

 

13.1.1 GW shall pay the “ Crop Change Payment ”. This charge shall be £***        . GW shall pay this amount in five equal instalments payable over the first 5 years of the Term (the first payment being made on 31 December 2016 and thereafter on each anniversary of that date). In the event that this Agreement terminates for any reason, any amount of the Crop Change Payment that remains unpaid shall become immediately due and payable.

 

13.1.2 the Operating Costs properly incurred in the performance of its obligations under this Agreement. British Sugar’s agreed budget for Costs (“ Budget for Costs ”) for the year ending 31 December 2017 is detailed in Schedule 1. On or before 30 September 2017 and 15 September in each subsequent calendar year during the Term, British Sugar shall submit to GW its draft Budget for Costs for the coming calendar year. The Parties shall discuss the Budget for Costs for the upcoming calendar year at their meeting held pursuant to Clause 4.3.1. The Budget for Costs shall be agreed by 31 October thereafter. In the event of a failure to agree the Budget for Costs in any year, the Parties shall adopt the most recently approved Budget for Costs for a calendar year in which the Growing Plan required British Sugar to Produce 213 tonnes of BRM. Further, if the Budget for Costs that cannot be agreed relates to a Growing Plan that requires British Sugar to Produce more than 213 tonnes of BRM, the Parties shall adopt the most recently approved Budget for Costs for a calendar year in which the Growing Plan required British Sugar to Produce 213 tonnes of BRM and the associated Growing Plan. If, for some reason, British Sugar requires a change to the Budget for Costs for a specific calendar year, British Sugar shall present GW with evidence for the requested change and the Parties shall discuss the changes to the Budget for Costs in good faith. Any change to a Budget for Costs will only be binding on GW when a revised Budget for Costs is signed by both Parties; for the avoidance of doubt any authorised change to the Budget for Costs for a calendar year or other overspend of Operating Costs otherwise authorised will qualify as within budget for the purpose of calculating the On Budget Fee for the calendar year in question. Any increase in Operating Costs during a calendar year due to a change in the unit price of gas or electricity charged to British Sugar or a change in labour costs due to changes in minimum wage) shall not be treated as an overspend (and shall, therefore, be treated as approved and within the Budget for Costs). Where GW has requested an increase in Production part way through a calendar year, the Parties shall agree a revised Budget for Costs for the balance of such calendar year before British Sugar starts implementing the scale up in Production.

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  17  

 

 

13.1.3 the current depreciation costs of the assets related to the business conducted at the Facility, prior to the date of this Agreement (not to exceed £***        per annum for 2017, as indicated in Schedule 3, but the assets and associated depreciation costs for 2017 are to be confirmed and agreed within 20 Business Days following the Effective Date). The depreciation costs shall be reviewed and amended annually to reflect the incremental depreciation charged associated with capital expenditure funded by British Sugar at the same time as, and on the same terms as, the budgeting process for Operating Costs is conducted under Clauses 4.3.1 and 13.1.2. The depreciation costs for the year will be paid in 12 equal instalments payable on the last day of each calendar month.

 

13.1.4 an annual charge (irrespective of actual acreage used) for utilising the Facility (the “ Area Charge ”). During the period starting 1 January 2017 and ending 31 December 2017, the Area Charge shall be £***        per annum. Thereafter the Area Charge shall be increased on 31 December of each calendar year (commencing on 31 December 2017) by the lesser of (i) the change in RPI over the 12 months prior to the date from which the change in Area Charge will apply, and (ii) ***    per cent (***%). The Area Charge shall be paid in 12 equal instalments payable on the last day of each calendar month. For the avoidance of doubt, payment of the Area Charge does not give GW the benefit of any lease, licence or other proprietary interest in the Facility.

 

13.1.5 a fee of £***        per kilogram for each kilogram of BRM Produced and delivered in a calendar year which meets the BRM Specifications (“ Productivity Fee ”). The Productivity Fee shall (irrespective of the actual output from British Sugar of BRM) be guaranteed for the period ending 31 December 2017 at £***        in the aggregate for all BRM Produced and delivered in calendar year 2017, to be invoiced in twelve (12) equal monthly instalments of £***      . Thereafter, the Productivity Fee will be linked to the actual number of kilograms of BRM meeting the BRM Specifications delivered to GW in each calendar year.

 

13.1.6 a fee of £*** per kilogram (the “ On Budget Fee ”), for each kilogram of BRM Produced and delivered in a calendar year that meets the BRM Specifications, in the circumstances where British Sugar keeps its Operating Costs for a calendar year within the Budget for Costs set for that calendar year pursuant to Clauses 4.3.1 and 13.1.2. In the event British Sugar exceeds the Budget for Costs set for a calendar year pursuant to Clauses 4.3.1 and 13.1.2, the total On Budget Fee for such calendar year will be reduced by one pound for every pound of overspend on Operating Costs against the agreed Budget for Costs, as illustrated in the worked example set out in Schedule 6. The On Budget Fee shall be guaranteed for the period ending 31 December 2017 at £*** in the aggregate for all BRM Produced and delivered in calendar year 2017, to be invoiced on 31 December 2017. Thereafter, the On Budget Fee will be linked to the actual number of kilograms of BRM meeting the BRM Specifications delivered to GW in each calendar year, as set out above.

 

13.2 For the avoidance of doubt, and notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, if British Sugar fails (for any reason save where British Sugar has failed to use reasonable endeavours to Produce in accordance with this Agreement) to Produce BRM in accordance with the BRM Specification (including where it fails to produce all or some of the quantities of BRM ordered) the sole consequence shall be that British Sugar shall not, in respect of such undelivered or not compliant BRM, receive the full Productivity Fee or On Budget Fee.

 

13.3 GW and British Sugar shall work in collaboration to drive for efficiency savings. Once efficiencies are such that British Sugar supplies GW with BRM meeting the BRM Specifications in a calendar year at an aggregate cost per kilogram, taking into account all payments made in such calendar year pursuant to Clause 13.1, are at or below £***/kg of BRM Produced and delivered, any resulting savings shall be shared *** . See Schedule 4 for illustration.

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  18  

 

 

13.4 British Sugar shall supply to GW within thirty (30) days of the end of each calendar month after the Effective Date an itemised and adequately documented summary of its actual monthly Operating Costs for that month and a monthly invoice for the sums due in accordance with Clauses 13.1.2, 13.1.3 and 13.1.4. All sums due pursuant to Clause 13.1.5 shall be invoiced on the last day of each calendar month based upon the number of kilograms of BRM delivered in the month. All sums due pursuant to Clause 13.1.1 shall be invoiced on the last day of each calendar year, with the first invoice to be submitted on 31 December 2016 and the final invoice to be submitted 31 December 2020. Starting in 2018, all sums due pursuant to Clause 13.1.6 shall be invoiced within thirty (30) days of the end of the calendar year to which they relate, once all cost and yield data for that calendar year have been mutually agreed pursuant to Clause 4.3.2. Costs of Facility conversion incurred pursuant to, and in accordance with, Clause 5.3 shall be invoiced separately as incurred. British Sugar shall not invoice GW for an Operating Cost that is not in the Budget for Costs without the prior consent of GW (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed). GW shall make each payment due within thirty (30) days of the date of each invoice therefor.

 

13.5 British Sugar shall keep full, true and accurate records and books of account containing all particulars that may be necessary for the purpose of calculating all sums payable by GW under this Agreement for a minimum period of six (6) years. Upon timely requests by GW, GW shall have the right to inspect such records and books of account to ensure that British Sugar has invoiced GW only for the sums properly payable by it under this Agreement.

 

13.6 Should GW’s inspection pursuant to Clause 13.5 reasonably lead GW to believe that it has not been invoiced only for the sums properly payable by it under this Agreement, upon timely request by GW, GW shall have the right to instruct an independent, internationally recognised, accounting firm to perform an audit, conducted so far as appropriate in accordance with standard UK accounting practice, as is reasonably necessary to enable such accounting firm to report to GW that GW has been invoiced for the sums properly payable by it under this Agreement on the following basis:

 

13.6.1 such firm of accountants shall be given access to and shall be permitted to examine and copy such books and records upon twenty (20) Business Days’ notice having been given by GW and at all reasonable times on Business Days for the purpose of certifying to GW that the Operating Costs, depreciation costs and other payment calculated and invoiced by British Sugar during any calendar year were calculated correctly in accordance with this Agreement (and if such certification cannot be given specifying the reasons why which will enable the Parties to recalculate the relevant sums);

 

13.6.2 prior to any such examination taking place, such firm of accountants shall undertake to British Sugar that they shall keep all information and data contained in such books and records, strictly confidential and shall not disclose such information or copies of such books and records to any third person including GW, but shall only use the same for the purpose of the reviews or calculations which they need to perform in order to issue the certificate to GW which this Clause 13.6 envisages;

 

13.6.3 any such access examination and certification shall occur no more frequently than once per calendar year; and

 

13.6.4 British Sugar shall make available personnel to answer queries on all books and records required for the purpose of that certification.

 

  19  

 

 

13.7 If the certification is in disagreement with the invoices submitted by British Sugar, British Sugar shall notify GW within ten (10) days of receipt by British Sugar of the certification whether or not British Sugar agrees within the certification. If British Sugar notifies its agreement with the certification within the ten (10) day period or fails to give any notification within that period, the sums calculated by the certification shall be used for purposes of calculating any monies owed and any monies owed by British Sugar to GW shall be paid by British Sugar. The cost of the accountant shall be the responsibility of British Sugar if the recalculation shows that British Sugar’s invoices for the year in question supplied to GW to be inaccurate by more than twenty thousand pounds sterling (£20,000) and the responsibility of GW otherwise. If British Sugar notifies its disagreement with the certification, either Party may refer the items in dispute to a partner of at least 10 years qualified experience at an independent, internationally recognized, public accounting firm agreed by the Parties in writing for final and binding resolution, or failing agreement on the identity of the public accounting firm within fifteen (15) days starting on the day after receipt of the notification of disagreement, an independent, internationally recognised, public accounting firm appointed on the application of either Party by the President for the time being of the Institute of Chartered Accountants of England and Wales. Such person appointed shall act on the following basis:

 

13.7.1 such person shall act as an expert and not as an arbitrator;

 

13.7.2 such person’s terms of reference shall be to determine the matters in dispute within 20 days of his appointment;

 

13.7.3 the Parties shall each provide such person with all information relating to the items in dispute which such person reasonably requires and such person shall be entitled (to the extent he considers appropriate) to base his determination on such information;

 

13.7.4 the decision of such person is, in the absence of fraud or manifest error, final and binding on the Parties; and

 

13.7.5 such person’s costs shall be paid by British Sugar or GW as such person may determine.

 

13.8 All payments to be made under the terms of the Agreement are expressed to be exclusive of value added tax howsoever arising and GW shall pay to British Sugar, in addition to the invoiced amount, all value added tax for which British Sugar is liable to account in relation to any supply made or deemed to be made for value added tax purposes on receipt of a tax invoice or invoices therefore from British Sugar.

 

13.9 British Sugar will submit detailed invoices monthly in arrears, such invoices to be submitted in pdf form to the e-mail or postal address below:

 

e-mail: invoices@gwpharm.com

post:       Accounts Department

GW Pharmaceuticals,

Kingsgate House,

Andover,

Hants,

SP10 4DU,

UK

 

13.10 All payments under this Agreement shall be made free and clear and without any set off, deduction or deferment in respect of any disputes or claims whatsoever unless required by law of any Competent Authority or unless GW has a valid court order requiring an amount equal to such deduction to be paid by British Sugar to GW.

 

13.11 Payments shall be made by electronic wire transfer of immediately available funds directly to the account of British Sugar designated by British Sugar in writing from time to time.

 

  20  

 

 

13.12 If GW fails to make any payment to British Sugar hereunder on the due date for payment and the payment is either (i) not in dispute between the Parties, or (ii) the payment is disputed by GW and GW has given British Sugar notice of the disputed amount it is withholding and an explanation as to why that amount is disputed and the dispute has not been resolved, without prejudice to any other right or remedy available to British Sugar, British Sugar shall be entitled to charge GW interest (both before and after judgment) on the amount unpaid at the annual rate of twelve month LIBOR plus four per cent (4%) calculated on a daily basis until payment in full is made without prejudice to British Sugar’s right to receive payment on the due date.

 

13.13 All payment obligations of GW under this Agreement shall be subject to Clause 18.8.

 

14. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY

 

14.1 GW grants to British Sugar, as a producer on behalf of GW, a royalty-free, non-exclusive right and licence to use GW Know How, together with any GW Improvements (subject to Clause 14.6), solely for the purpose of performing British Sugar’s obligations under this Agreement during the Term. British Sugar shall otherwise obtain no right title or interest in or to GW Know How or GW Improvements as a result of this Agreement.

 

14.2 Title to and property in GW Know How and GW Improvements shall remain with GW.

 

14.3 Title to and property in all British Sugar Know How, British Sugar Improvements and the British Sugar Improvements to GW Know How shall remain with British Sugar.

 

14.4 No British Sugar Know How or British Sugar Improvements shall be employed by GW (including in its Production activities) unless this has been separately agreed in writing by British Sugar.

 

14.5 British Sugar grants to GW a royalty-free, non-exclusive right and licence to use British Sugar Improvements to GW Know How, solely for the purpose of growing (or having grown for it) Cannabis sativa L . plants and producing botanical raw materials therefrom. British Sugar undertakes not to use itself, or grant a third party a licence to use, British Sugar Improvements to GW Know How for the purpose of growing Cannabis sativa L . plants and producing botanical raw materials therefrom for a period of five (5) years following the expiry or termination of the Agreement.

 

14.6 No GW Improvements shall be employed by British Sugar in its Production activities unless this has been previously agreed in writing by GW, other than as contemplated by clause 7.1.

 

15. CONFIDENTIALITY

 

15.1 Except to the extent expressly authorised by this Agreement including in Clauses 15.2 and 15.3 or otherwise agreed in writing, each Party in possession of Confidential Information (“ Receiving Party ”) of the other Party (“ Disclosing Party ”) shall maintain such Confidential Information as confidential and use it only for the purposes of this Agreement in accordance with this Clause 15. The term of maintaining confidentiality of all such information and the limitations on use shall be for a period equal to the longer of (i) five (5) years after the date of expiration or termination of this Agreement; or (ii) for so long as the exceptions set out below in the next subsequent paragraph do not apply to the relevant Confidential Information. Each Party shall guard such Confidential Information using the same degree of care as it normally uses to guard its own confidential, proprietary information of like importance, but in any event no less than reasonable care.

 

Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Receiving Party shall be relieved of the confidentiality and limited use obligations of this Agreement to the extent that the Receiving Party establishes by written evidence that:

 

  21  

 

 

15.1.1 the Confidential Information was previously known to the Receiving Party from sources other than the Disclosing Party at the time of disclosure and other than under an obligation of confidentiality;

 

15.1.2 the Confidential Information was generally available to the public or otherwise part of the public domain at the time of its disclosure; or

 

15.1.3 the Confidential Information became generally available to the public or otherwise part of the public domain after its disclosure to the Receiving Party other than through any act or omission of the Receiving Party in breach of this Agreement; or

 

15.1.4 the Confidential Information is acquired in good faith in the future by the Receiving Party from a third party who has a lawful right to disclose such information and who is not under an obligation of confidence to the Disclosing Party with respect to such information; or

 

15.1.5 the Confidential Information is subsequently developed by or on behalf of the Receiving Party without use of the Disclosing Party’s Confidential Information.

 

15.2 Notwithstanding the above obligations of confidentiality and non-use a Receiving Party may:

 

15.2.1 disclose Confidential Information to a Competent Authority as reasonably necessary to obtain regulatory approval in a particular jurisdiction to the extent consistent with the licenses granted under terms of this Agreement;

 

15.2.2 disclose Confidential Information: (i) to the extent such disclosure is reasonably necessary to comply with the order of a court; or (ii) to the extent such disclosure is required to comply with an applicable Law, including to the extent such disclosure is required in publicly filed financial statements or other public statements under stock exchange rules (e.g., the rules of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission, NASDAQ, NYSE, UKLA or any other stock exchange on which securities issued by either Party or any Affiliate of such Party may be listed); provided, to the extent possible bearing in mind such Law, such Party shall provide the other Party with a copy of the proposed text of such statements or disclosure five (5) Business Days in advance of the date on which the disclosure is to be made to review and provide comments, unless a shorter review time is agreed;

 

15.2.3 disclose Confidential Information to such Receiving Party’s employees, Affiliates, distributors, licensees, Partners, agents, consultants, clinical investigators, collaborators or contractors as such Receiving Party reasonably determines is necessary to receive the benefits of the licences to it under this Agreement or to perform its obligations pursuant to this Agreement; provided, however, any such Persons must be obligated to substantially the same extent as set forth in Clause 15.1 to hold in confidence and not make use of such Confidential Information for any purpose other than those permitted by this Agreement.

 

15.2.4 disclose Confidential Information: (i) to its actual or potential investment bankers and to lenders for the purpose of obtaining financing for its business; (ii) to potential investors in connection with an offering or placement of securities for purposes of obtaining financing for its business; and (iii) to bona fide potential acquirer or merger partner for the purposes of evaluating entering into a merger or acquisition, provided, however, any such Persons must be obligated to substantially the same extent as set forth in Clause 15.1 to hold in confidence and not make use of such Confidential Information for any purpose other than those permitted by this Agreement;

 

15.2.5 nothing in this Clause 15 restricts either Party from using or disclosing any of its own Confidential Information for any purpose whatsoever.

 

  22  

 

 

15.3 Save as permitted in Clause 15.2.2, neither Party shall make any public announcement or statement to the public containing Confidential Information without the prior consent of the other. All such public announcements or statements shall not be made without the prior review and consent of appropriate individual designated for the purpose by the other Party.

 

16. WARRANTIES AND LIABILITY

 

16.1 British Sugar warrants to GW that:

 

16.1.1 neither it nor any of its officers or employees: (i) has been convicted of any offence involving slavery or human trafficking; and (ii) having made reasonable enquiries, so far as it is aware, has been or is the subject of any investigation, inquiry or enforcement proceedings by any governmental, administrative or regulatory body regarding any offence or alleged offence of or in connection with slavery and human trafficking;

 

16.1.2 it will perform its obligations hereunder with reasonable skill and care;

 

16.1.3 each Batch shall be delivered free of encumbrances and liens; and

 

16.1.4 it will endeavour to ensure that the BRM shall, at the time of delivery, meet the BRM Specifications in all material respects.

 

16.2 GW warrants to British Sugar that:

 

16.2.1 neither it nor any of its officers or employees: (i) has been convicted of any offence involving slavery or human trafficking; and (ii) having made reasonable enquiries, so far as it is aware, has been or is the subject of any investigation, inquiry or enforcement proceedings by any governmental, administrative or regulatory body regarding any offence or alleged offence of or in connection with slavery and human trafficking;

 

16.2.2 it holds all necessary rights and licenses to GW Know How to allow British Sugar to Produce BRM;

 

16.2.3 the GW Know How will enable British Sugar (using reasonable care and skill) to Produce BRM in accordance with the BRM Specifications;

 

16.2.4 the Equipment and other assets it supplies (i) will meet the specifications agreed therefor under the Conversion Plan at the time of installation and will, if properly maintained, operated in a suitable environment and in a proper manner by trained competent staff in accordance with its operating instructions, continue to meet such specification, and (ii) will be of satisfactory quality;

 

16.2.5 the Equipment and other assets it identifies for use in Production in the Conversion Plan and that is to be purchased by British Sugar will, if such Equipment or other assets meet the specifications agreed therefor under the Conversion Plan at the time of delivery, is properly installed and maintained, operated in a suitable environment and in a proper manner by trained competent staff in accordance with its operating instructions, be of satisfactory quality and sufficient to allow British Sugar to Produce BRM that meets the BRM Specifications; and

 

16.2.6 no claim or litigation has been brought or threatened by any Person alleging that the disclosing, copying, making, licensing, using or exploiting of GW Know How violates, infringes or otherwise conflicts or interferes with any intellectual property or proprietary right of any other Person.

 

  23  

 

 

16.3 Except as and to the extent specifically provided in this Clause 16 or in any other provision of this Agreement, British Sugar and GW make no representations or warranties of any kind, express or implied, with respect to the subject matter of this Agreement, and each Party specifically disclaims and waives all other representations, warranties and conditions, including all implied conditions of merchantability and fitness for a particular purpose. British Sugar and GW warranties are made only to British Sugar and GW, respectively, and do not extend to any third party.

 

16.4 Subject to Clause 16.5 and Clause 16.6 and except in the case of fraudulent misrepresentation, neither Party shall be liable to the other in contract, tort (including negligence) breach of statutory duty, misrepresentation or otherwise for any loss, damage, costs or expenses of any nature whatsoever incurred or suffered by the other or its Affiliates:

 

16.4.1 of a direct nature where the same is a loss of profits, business or goodwill; or

 

16.4.2 of an indirect or consequential nature.

 

Provided that (for the avoidance of doubt) nothing herein shall excuse GW from liability in respect of any amount payable by it to British Sugar under this Agreement.

 

16.5 Each Party accepts liability for death or personal injury resulting from its negligence.

 

16.6 The maximum liability a Party shall have under this Agreement shall not exceed £5 million whether in contract, tort or otherwise and howsoever arising provided that this limitation shall not apply (i) to any payment obligations under this Agreement including payment arising on termination (all of which shall not be taken into account so as to limit the amount recoverable as regards any other claim or liability) and (ii) to liability under any indemnity.

 

17. INSURANCE

 

17.1 British Sugar shall in respect of its activities envisaged in this Agreement maintain during any period in which British Sugar is Producing for GW and for a period of twelve (12) months thereafter, commercial general liability insurance with a combined single limit for bodily injury of not less than £5 million per occurrence and property damage in an amount that is not less than the full reinstatement value of the Facility, and shall provide GW with proof of its policies of insurance in that regard once every calendar year.

 

17.2 GW shall in respect of its activities envisaged in this Agreement maintain during any period in which British Sugar is Producing for GW and for a period of twelve (12) months thereafter, commercial general liability insurance with a combined single limit for bodily injury and property damage of not less than £5 million per occurrence, and shall upon request provide British Sugar with a copy of its policies of insurance in that regard, along with any amendments and revisions thereto .

 

18. TERM AND TERMINATION

 

Term

 

18.1 Unless terminated earlier in accordance with Clauses 18.2, 18.3, or 22.3 this Agreement shall come into force on the Effective Date and shall continue until the end of the calendar year following the ***    anniversary of the Effective Date (the “ Initial Term ”). On or about the ***    (***) anniversary of the Effective Date the Parties shall meet to discuss whether the Agreement should continue beyond the Initial Term. Where no agreement to extend the term is reached the Agreement shall automatically terminate at the end of the Initial Term. Where agreement to extend the term is reached the Agreement shall (unless the parties select another period) continue for a further period of ***    (***) years after the expiry of the Initial Term (“ Renewal Term ). The procedure in respect of extending the term set out above may be repeated thereafter to renew the Agreement for additional Renewal Terms. For clarity, the Initial Term and the Renewal Term(s) together, being the “ Term ”. The Parties obligations following expiry of the Agreement shall be subject to the terms set out in Schedule 10 and the further detail in Clauses 18.4 to 18.8.

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

  

  24  

 

 

Termination Events

 

18.2 British Sugar may terminate the Agreement as follows:

 

18.2.1 upon written notice to GW, with immediate effect, in the event GW commits a material breach of the Agreement which (in the case of a breach capable of remedy) is not remedied within ninety (90) days of the receipt by GW of notice identifying the breach and requiring its remedy.

 

18.2.2 upon written notice to GW, with immediate effect, in the event GW suffers an Insolvency Event.

 

18.2.3 at any time after the third anniversary of the Effective Date by giving not less than twenty four (24) months’ notice of termination of this Agreement in writing to GW, provided such notice shall only take effect at the end of a calendar year. By way of example, if British Sugar served notice under this Clause 18.2.3 in the middle of the fourth year of this Agreement, termination would be effective at the end of calendar year six.

 

18.2.4 upon written notice to GW, with immediate effect, if any Competent Authority (including the Home Office):

 

(a) fails to grant such Regulatory Approval by 31 December 2017;

 

(b) withdraws any Regulatory Approval which British Sugar requires for Production at the Facility for a reason outside of British Sugar’s control and such Regulatory Approval is not or cannot be re-awarded within one year of the withdrawal.

 

During the period set out at (b) above, this Agreement shall be treated as suspended and Clause 20.2 shall apply.

 

18.3 This Agreement may be terminated by GW as follows:

 

18.3.1 upon written notice to British Sugar, with immediate effect, if British Sugar commits a material breach of the Agreement which (in the case of a breach capable of remedy) is not remedied within ninety (90) days of the receipt by British Sugar of a notice identifying the breach and requiring its remedy.

 

18.3.2 upon written notice to British Sugar, with immediate effect, in the event British Sugar suffers an Insolvency Event.

 

18.3.3 at any time after the ***    anniversary of the Effective Date by giving not less than ***    (***) months’ notice of termination of this Agreement in writing to British Sugar, provided such notice shall only take effect at the end of a calendar year. By way of example, if GW served notice under this Clause 18.3.3 in the middle of the ***    year of this Agreement, termination would be effective at the end of calendar year ***.

 

18.3.4 upon written notice to British Sugar, with immediate effect, if any Competent Authority (including the Home Office):

 

(a) fails to grant such Regulatory Approval by 31 December 2017;

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  25  

 

 

(b) withdraws any Regulatory Approval which British Sugar requires for Production at the Facility because of a failure by British Sugar to meet its obligations under the Regulatory Approval and such Regulatory Approval is not or cannot be re-awarded within one year of the withdrawal; or

 

(c) withdraws any Regulatory Approval which British Sugar requires for Production at the Facility for a reason outside of British Sugar’s control and such Regulatory Approval is not or cannot be re-awarded within one year of the withdrawal.

 

During the one year period set out at (b) and (c) above, this Agreement shall be treated as suspended and Clause 20.2 shall apply.

 

18.3.5 upon written notice to British Sugar, with immediate effect, in the event a drug product containing a drug substance derived from BRM is withdrawn or recalled due to a Marketing Authorisation for such drug product being withdrawn, suspended or revoked.

 

Consequences of Termination

 

18.4 Upon the expiration or termination of the Agreement for whatever reason:

 

18.4.1 British Sugar shall cease using and promptly return to GW all GW Know GW Improvements and shall disclose to GW all British Sugar Improvements to GW Know How not previously disclosed to GW;

 

18.4.2 British Sugar shall allow GW access to the Facility in order for GW to remove its Equipment and other assets from the Facility;

 

18.4.3 British Sugar shall, at GW’s direction, either return to GW all Plants (including Cuttings) in its possession or destroy such Plants and Cuttings;

 

18.4.4 British Sugar will promptly send a close-out report to GW stating the amounts of BRM in its possession and, upon payment therefor, shall deliver to GW all such amounts of BRM to GW as specified in Clause 8;

 

18.4.5 at GW’s request, British Sugar shall deliver up the Batch Records;

 

18.4.6 the provisions of Clause 12.3 shall apply; and

 

18.4.7 the licence granted to GW under Clause 14.5 of this Agreement shall continue notwithstanding any expiry or termination of this Agreement and shall be without limit of period.

 

18.5 In the event that British Sugar or GW (as the case may be) terminates this Agreement pursuant to Clause 18.2.3 or 18.3.3, promptly following receipt of a notice to terminate given pursuant to such Clause, British Sugar and GW shall meet as soon as practicably possible and in any event within ten (10) Business Days thereof to discuss the strategy for the orderly wind-down of the Facility by the termination date and determine when British Sugar will cease Producing BRM during the notice period. In the event British Sugar is to wind down BRM Production prior to expiry of the notice period, upon completion of the wind-down activities British Sugar will be free to grow another crop in the Facility. GW shall have the final decision on whether Production is to continue for the duration of any notice period or cease at an earlier date. In the event a Party terminates this Agreement pursuant to Clause 18.2.3 or 18.3.3 and it is agreed or determined by GW that British Sugar is to wind down BRM Production prior to expiry of the notice period, GW shall pay a termination fee covering the remaining period of the notice period following completion of the wind down activities (the “ Run Off Period ”) as specified in Schedule 10, but excluding Operating Costs incurred after the wind down period (which for the purpose of calculating the Operating Costs payable will not exceed 16 weeks) and subject to the following: British Sugar shall use its reasonable endeavours to generate an income from one or more crops grown in the Facility during the Run Off Period. Should British Sugar grow another crop in the Facility during the Run Off Period, the profit contribution (revenue less direct operating overheads funded by British Sugar) earned from these activities shall be set off against the termination fee payable under this Clause 18.5.

 

  26  

 

 

18.6 In the event that this Agreement is terminated by either Party pursuant to Clause 22.3 due to Force Majeure, British Sugar pursuant to Clause 18.2.1, 18.2.2 or 18.2.4(b), or by GW pursuant to Clauses 18.3.1, 18.3.2, 18.3.4(b) or 18.3.4(c), then (in any such case) British Sugar shall organise an orderly wind down and closure of the Facility in a timely fashion, and save in the event of termination pursuant to Clause 17.3.1. GW shall pay to British Sugar all its direct costs incurred in winding down and closure of the Facility in accordance with the strategy agreed between the Parties (acting reasonably) in relation thereto.

 

18.7 Termination of the Agreement for whatever reason shall not affect the accrued rights or remedies of either British Sugar or GW arising under or out of this Agreement and all provisions which are expressed or intended to survive the Agreement shall remain in full force and effect. In order to protect GW’s Confidential Information, British Sugar shall not produce or supply a dried cannabis plant preparation for any Person except an Affiliate of GW for a period of ***    (***) years following the termination or expiration of this Agreement. The provisions of Clauses 1, 8.6, 11.3, 12.3, 13.5 to 13.13 (inclusive), 14.2, 14.3 14.5, 15, 16.3 to 16.6 (inclusive), 17, 18.4 to 18.8 (inclusive) 21, 22.5, 22.6, 22.8, 22.10, 22.13, 23 and Schedule 10 shall survive termination of this Agreement.

 

18.8 The Parties recognise that British Sugar has entered into this Agreement on the basis of certain assurances in respect of financial returns. Termination of this Agreement prior to the expiry of the Initial Term will be subject to the financial terms set out in Schedule 10. Accordingly, on termination for any reason (except for where termination is caused by a breach by British Sugar, insolvency of British Sugar, Regulatory Approval being removed in circumstances where British Sugar is at fault, or by either Party under Clause 22.3 due to British Sugar being affected by Force Majeure, and as otherwise specified in Clause 18.8.1 below), British Sugar shall be paid the Fees (on the basis of *** tonnes of BRM being deemed to be Produced in accordance with the BRM Specifications and on budget) as if the Agreement had continued until either (i) the first 31 December following the ***    anniversary of the Effective Date, or (ii) the first 31 December to occur not less than ***        (***) months following the effective date of termination or notice (as applicable), whichever is the later.

 

18.8.1 If the Agreement is terminated under Clause 18.2.3 or 18.3.3, GW shall only be obliged to pay the Fees and other amounts specified in, and subject to the terms of, Clause 18.5.

 

19. FINANCIAL SECURITY

 

19.1 GW agrees that in the event that GW’s balance of cash in its bank accounts falls below £*** million, GW will place a sum equivalent to the termination fee due under Clause 18.5 in an escrow account outside of GW’s control, for British Sugar to call upon in the event of being underpaid by GW for any reason. Should GW’s cash balance return above the £*** million threshold, GW shall remove the funds from escrow, however neither GW nor any administrator appointed to GW shall be able to unilaterally withdraw funds from the escrow account. GW agrees to enter into such escrow agreement as British Sugar may reasonably request to give effect to this Clause 18.

 

19.2 The Parties shall review GW’s cash balance once a calendar quarter. For so long as GW’s cash balance is below £*** million, British Sugar shall have the right to request of GW, no more frequently than once per month, an update on its cash balance.

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  27  

 

 

20. Rights short of termination

 

20.1 GW may at any time during the term of this Agreement on giving British Sugar *** (***) weeks’ written notice require British Sugar to suspend Production of BRM for any reason, such reason to be specified in the notice, and the expected duration of the suspension. The date on which such suspension becomes effective shall be the “ Suspension Date ”.

 

20.2 In the event that any Competent Authority (including the Home Office) withdraws any Regulatory Approval that British Sugar requires for Production at the Facility on the basis that it will be or can be re-awarded or the one year period under either Clause 18.2.4(b), 18.3.4(b) or 18.3.4(c) applies, then the Parties shall follow the suspension procedure set out below.

 

20.3 Upon receipt of a notice pursuant to Clause 20.1 or if Clause 20.2 applies, British Sugar and GW shall meet as soon as practicably possible and in any event within ten (10) Business Days thereof to discuss and agree the strategy for (i) the orderly wind-down of the Facility by the Suspension Date; and (ii) the maintenance of the Facility in a state from which BRM Production may be re-initiated in a reasonable period of time bearing in mind the reason for the suspension, and thereafter British Sugar shall implement such strategy in a timely fashion including so that BRM Production has ceased by the Suspension Date. As part of this discussion the Parties shall discuss and agree the period of notice British Sugar will require in order to reinitiate BRM Production at the Facility. During a period of Production suspension, the following financial principles shall apply:

 

20.3.1 If the suspension of Production is necessitated by a reason connected specifically to an identified issue with the Facility or Production at the Facility, including loss or suspension of a Regulatory Approval because of a failure by British Sugar to meet its obligations under the Regulatory Approval, the cost of remedying the circumstances leading to the suspension will be borne by British Sugar. GW will continue to pay the payments due under Clauses 13.1.1, 13.1.2 (subject to the following sentence), 13.1.3, and 13.1.4. British Sugar shall not be entitled to any Productivity Fee or On Budget Fee during the period of the suspension, British Sugar shall take all reasonable steps to minimise its Operating Costs, but GW shall not otherwise be relieved of its payment obligations hereunder.

 

20.3.2 If the suspension of Production is necessitated by a reason not connected specifically to an identified issue with the Facility or Production at the Facility, the cost of remedying the circumstances leading to the suspension will be borne by GW, GW will continue to pay the payments due under Clauses 13.1.1, 13.1.2 (subject to the following sentence), 13.1.3, and13.1.4, British Sugar shall be entitled to receive a Productivity Fee and On Budget Fee for the period of suspension equal to the amount it would have received should it have Produced and delivered BRM during the period of the suspension (and its output of BRM was *** tonnes for each calendar year during the suspension period), British Sugar shall take all reasonable steps to minimise its Operating Costs, but GW shall not otherwise be relieved of its payment obligations hereunder.

 

20.4 Notwithstanding the foregoing, so as to enable British Sugar to keep its employees and Know How British Sugar shall be permitted to grow other crops during any period of suspension under Clause 20.3.2 that is reasonably expected to last longer than three (3) months and shall be entitled to notice of three (3) months prior to such suspension being lifted. Should British Sugar grow another crop in the Facility during this suspension period, the profit contribution (revenue less direct operating overheads funded by British Sugar) earned from these activities shall be set off against the suspension fees payable under this Clause 20.

 

21. Indemnity

 

21.1 GW shall indemnify and hold British Sugar harmless from and against any and all costs, claims, demands, damages, losses, expenses and liabilities suffered or incurred by British Sugar arising out of third party claims, suits or demands based on alleged or actual bodily injury or death resulting from the use of BRM.

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  28  

 

 

21.2 The above indemnity shall not apply if the claim relates to contaminants negligently introduced by British Sugar in Production.

 

21.3 The indemnity shall further be subject to British Sugar :

 

21.3.1 promptly notifying GW in writing with details of the claim and providing GW with access to all documents and information reasonably required to enable it to defend the claim;

 

21.3.2 allowing GW to have the conduct of the defence or settlement of the claim (provided that British Sugar may elect to choose counsel independent from that representing GW at its own cost and expense on a non-controlling basis);

 

21.3.3 giving GW all reasonable assistance (at GW’s reasonable expense) in dealing with the claim; and

 

21.3.4 not making any payment or incurring any expenses in connection with the claim, or making any admissions or doing anything that may compromise or prejudice the defence of any such claim without the prior written consent of GW.

 

22. Miscellaneous

 

22.1 British Sugar acknowledges that GW addresses and resolves ethical and compliance-related issues arising in connection with its activities as set forth in the GW Code of Conduct and Business Ethics and requires its business partners to adhere to similar standards. To maintain such ethical and compliance standards also with respect to the activities under this Agreement British Sugar agrees to perform its activities under this Agreement in accordance with the GW Code of Conduct for Business Partners that can be found at http://ir.gwpharm.com/governance.cfm.

 

22.2 GW acknowledges that British Sugar addresses and resolves ethical and compliance-related issues arising in connection with its activities as set forth in the Associated British Foods plc Supplier Code of Conduct(as amended from time to time) and requires its business partners to adhere to similar standards. To maintain such ethical and compliance standards also with respect to the activities under or in connection with this Agreement or BRM generally GW agrees to perform its activities under this Agreement and otherwise in connection with BRM in accordance with the Associated British Foods plc Supplier Code of Conduct that can be found at http://www.abf.co.uk/responsibility/our_policies .

 

22.3 A Party shall be excused performance (save in respect of a payment obligation) if and to the extent it is subject to Force Majeure. A Party so affected shall promptly notify the other Party and give full details of the Force Majeure and its likely duration. If a Party suffers an event of Force Majeure for longer than twelve (12) months either Party may terminate the Agreement on three (3) months’ written notice. If British Sugar is affected by a Force Majeure event GW’s payment obligations in respect of the period of the Force Majeure event (excluding payment of the Crop Change Payment) are suspended for the duration of such Force Majeure event. The Parties’ financial obligations following termination shall be subject to the terms set out in Clauses 18.6, 18.8 and Schedule 10.

 

22.4 Nothing in this Agreement shall create, evidence, or imply any agency, partnership, or joint venture between the Parties. Neither Party shall act or describe itself as the agent of the other, nor shall it make or represent that it has authority to make any commitments on the other’s behalf.

 

  29  

 

 

22.5 Any notice or other communication required or permitted to be given by either Party under this Agreement shall be effective when delivered, if delivered by hand or by electronic facsimile, or five (5) Business Days after mailing if mailed by registered or certified mail (postage prepaid and return receipt requested), or two (2) Business Days after deposit with a courier if sent by an internationally recognised courier, and shall be addressed to each Party at the addresses set out in Schedule 7 or such other address as may be designated by notice pursuant to this Clause 22.5.

 

22.6 This Agreement together with the Technical Agreement constitutes the whole agreement between the Parties and supersedes any previous agreement between the Parties relating to its subject matter. Each Party acknowledges that in entering into this Agreement, it does not rely on any representation, warranty or other provision, except as expressly provided for under this Agreement.

 

22.7 No variation of this Agreement shall be effective unless it is in writing and signed by, or on behalf of, the Parties.

 

22.8 Neither this Agreement, nor any obligations or rights hereunder, shall be assignable or transferable (whether by contract, operation of law or otherwise) or subcontracted by either Party without the prior written consent of the other Party. Should a Party give consent to the other Party subcontracting any of its obligations under this Agreement, the latter Party shall implement due diligence procedures to ensure that there is no slavery or human trafficking utilised by its proposed sub-contractor.

 

22.9 This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts, each of which, when executed, shall be an original, and all the counterparts together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

 

22.10 A Person who is not a Party to this Agreement shall not have any rights under the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999 to enforce any term of this Agreement but this does not affect any right or remedy of a Third Party which exists, or is available, apart from under that Act. .

 

22.11 No failure or delay by a Party to exercise any right or remedy provided under this Agreement or by law shall constitute a waiver of that or any other right or remedy, nor shall it preclude or restrict the further exercise of that or any other right or remedy. No single or partial exercise of such right or remedy shall preclude or restrict the further exercise of that or any other right or remedy.

 

22.12 If any provision or part-provision of this Agreement shall be held to be illegal, void, invalid or unenforceable under the law of any jurisdiction:

 

22.12.1 that provision or part-provision shall, to the extent required, be deemed to be deleted, and the validity and enforceability of the other provisions of this Agreement shall not be affected; and

 

22.12.2 the legality, validity and enforceability of the whole of this Agreement in any other jurisdiction shall not be affected.

 

22.13 This Agreement and any dispute or claim arising out of or in connection with it or its subject matter or formation (including non-contractual disputes or claims) shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the law of England and Wales. The Parties irrevocably agree that the courts of England and Wales shall have exclusive jurisdiction to settle any dispute or claim that arises out of or in connection with this Agreement or its subject matter or formation (including non-contractual disputes or claims).

 

  30  

 

 

23. parent company guarantee

 

23.1 In consideration of British Sugar supplying or continuing to supply BRM to GW, GW Pharmaceuticals hereby unconditionally and irrevocably guarantees to British Sugar the performance of all the financial obligations of GW under this Agreement, including the due and prompt payment by GW of any amounts payable under this Agreement and any damages or other financial compensation for breach of this Agreement by GW (the “ Payment Obligations ”). In case of the failure of GW to promptly pay any amounts or to make whole British Sugar for any of its payment obligations under this Agreement, GW Pharmaceuticals hereby agrees to cause the payment of such amounts to be made promptly when and as such amounts become due and payable as if it were the principal obligor. GW Pharmaceuticals hereby agrees that its obligations hereunder will be absolute and unconditional, irrespective of, and will be unaffected by, the validity, regularity or enforceability of the obligations of GW under this Agreement, the absence of any action to enforce the same, the dissolution, the insolvency or bankruptcy of GW, any amendment, novation, extension or waiver of this Agreement or any other document or security in connection with this Agreement or any other circumstance which might otherwise constitute a legal or equitable discharge or defence of a guarantor or surety. GW Pharmaceuticals hereby waives the benefits of diligence, presentment, demand of payment, any requirement that British Sugar protect, secure, perfect or insure any security interest in or other lien on any property subject thereto or exhaust any right or take any action against GW or any collateral, filing of claims with a court in the event of dissolution, insolvency or bankruptcy of GW, any right to require a proceeding first against GW and covenants that its obligations hereunder are continuing and will not be discharged except by complete payment of the amounts due by GW under this Agreement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, unless GW has been legally dissolved, British Sugar agrees to give GW notice of any claim under this Agreement prior to making any demand under this Clause 23 in respect of the Payment Obligations. In the event that any payment to British Sugar in respect of any amounts due by GW under this Agreement is rescinded or must otherwise be returned for any reason whatsoever, GW Pharmaceuticals will remain liable for such amounts to the extent provided herein as if such amounts had not been paid. GW Pharmaceutical’s liability under this Clause 23 will not be affected by anything which would not have released or reduced such liability had the liability been incurred by GW Pharmaceuticals as a principal debtor instead of as a guarantor. The aggregate amount to be paid under this Clause 23 by GW Pharmaceuticals shall be net of any prior payment to British Sugar by GW in respect of such Payment Obligations.

 

23.2 GW Pharmaceuticals agrees, as an additional and independent obligation, that if any of the Payment Obligations are not, for any reason, recoverable from GW Pharmaceuticals under any guarantee contained in Clause 23.1 GW Pharmaceuticals will be liable to British Sugar as principal debtor for the same amount as it would have been liable for had those Payment Obligations been recoverable under that guarantee.

 

[EXECUTION PAGE TO FOLLOW]

 

  31  

 

 

This Agreement has been entered into on the date at the beginning of this Agreement.

 

Signed for and on behalf of GW PHARMA LIMITED   /s/ James Ryan   /s/ Chris Tovey
    Signature   Signature
         
    James Ryan   Chris Tovey
    Name   Name
         
Signed for and on behalf of GW PHARMACEUTICALS PLC   /s/ James Ryan   /s/ Chris Tovey
    Signature   Signature
         
    James Ryan   Chris Tovey
    Name   Name
       
Signed for and on behalf of BRITISH SUGAR PLC   /s/ Paul Kenward    
    Signature    
         
    Paul Kenward    
    Name (print)    

 

  32  

 

 

SCHEDULE 1
Operating Costs

 

“Operating Costs” - the direct costs incurred by British Sugar exclusively in relation to the actual Production of a Batch, established on a regular, standard basis in accordance with UK generally accepted accounting practices consistently applied by British Sugar. Operating Costs shall be calculated according to the principles of “open book” and include the following elements: (i) actual costs to British Sugar of materials used for Production of the Batch; and (ii) direct labour cost of production employees (including wages, labour and related payroll taxes and benefits) incurred or spent in the Production of the Batch and all other costs not specifically excluded below. It is agreed by both Parties that the following costs will be treated as variable costs in the budget:

 

· costs of gas (to dry the BRM), electricity supplied to the Facility, potable water, gas for supplementary boiler firing, and waste disposal are expected to vary during a financial year based on the unit cost charged to British Sugar for budgeted use.

 

· in addition operational labour costs for non-salaried staff may also vary as a result of changes in the National Living Wage. Where a change in minimum wage is introduced, the labour costs will be adjusted to reflect this change (changes in headcount will be addressed under the agreed protocol for budget variances in Clause 13.1.2).

 

The Operating Cost budget will be adjusted at the end of each calendar year to reflect the true cost of these variable budget items prior to reconciliation of On Budget Fees.

 

Operating Costs include those direct costs associated with Producing Batches of BRM and agreed in the Budget for Costs, and include asset insurance.

 

Operating Costs do not include depreciation (as this is recharged as a separate element of the cost per kilogram revenues per annum), costs of insurance that British Sugar may choose to take out against loss of profit/business interruption, the cost of the heat provided by the factory (except where British Sugar intentionally requests supplementary boiler firing to boost the availability of heat in periods of exceptional demand), salaries for British Sugar staff who are not directly involved in Growing operations or indirect overheads allocated from other British Sugar departments or other group companies, management bonuses linked to profitability of the Agreement or costs of discontinuing service arrangements with existing staff who are not required for this Agreement, equity based incentives for staff, or any write off/depreciation for British Sugar’s tomato growing specific assets. Operating Costs do not include capital costs incurred by British Sugar, which shall be capitalised and depreciated.

 

  33  

 

 

2017 Budget for Costs

 

GW shall assume the Operating Costs of the Facility on 1 January 2017, unless mutually agreed in writing.

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  34  

 

 

SCHEDULE 2
Project Management and Facility Conversion Project Planning

 

Project managers:

 

For GW – ***

 

For British Sugar – ***

 

Facility Conversion Project Planning Team and Process

 

The Project managers for both Parties shall meet within 10 days of the Effective Date to agree the plan for the Project Management and Facility Conversion Project Planning.  This discussion shall cover process, personnel and governance for the projects relating to preparing the facility to grow GW’s crop.

 

GW acknowledges that the project management approach taken will be in accordance with British Sugar’s ‘Capital Projects Framework’ dated October 2014, which is attached to the Agreement at the end of this Schedule.  This process shall be followed in accordance with Clause 4 of this agreement.

 

Capital Projects Framework

 

Inserted by hand

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  35  

 

 

Conversion Budget as of 5 th August 2016

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  36  

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

 

 

  

Schedule 3
British Sugar current depreciation costs

 

Year     2017       2018       2019       2020       2021       2022       2023       2024       2025       2026  
Depreciation charge (£)     ***       ***       ***       ***       ***       ***       ***       ***       ***       ***  

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  37  

 

 

SCHEDULE 4
Efficiency savings example

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  38  

 

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  39  

 

 

SCHEDULE 5
Terms of Reference for Expert Determination

 

1. Any matter or dispute to be determined by an expert under this Agreement (“ Expert ”) shall be referred to a person suitably qualified to determine that particular matter or dispute who shall be nominated jointly by the Parties or, failing agreement between the Parties within twenty (20) Business Days of a written request by either Party to the other seeking to initiate the Expert’s decision procedure, either Party may request the President for the time being of the Association of the British Pharmaceutical Industry or any successor body to it to nominate the Expert.

 

2. The Parties shall with fourteen (14) days of the appointment of the Expert meet with him/her in order to agree a program for oral written and oral submissions.

 

3. In all cases the terms of appointment of the Expert by whomsoever appointed shall include:

 

3.1 a commitment by the Parties to share equally the Expert’s fee;

 

3.2 a requirement on the Expert to act fairly as between the Parties and according to the principles of natural justice;

 

3.3 a requirement on the Expert to hold professional indemnity insurance both then and for three years following the date of his/her determination;

 

3.4 a commitment by the Parties to supply to the expert the submissions the subject of paragraph 2 and all such assistance, documents and information as he/she may require for the purpose of his or her determination.

 

3.5 a commitment by the Parties that all negotiations connected with the dispute shall be conducted in confidence and without prejudice to the rights of the Parties in any future proceedings.

 

4. The Expert shall give a written decision which shall contain a factual analysis, his/her conclusions and the reasons for his conclusions.

 

5. The Expert’s decision shall be final and binding on the Parties (save in the case of negligence or manifest error).

 

6. The Parties expressly acknowledge and agree that they do not intend the reference to the Expert to constitute an arbitration within the scope of any arbitration legislation, the Expert’s decision is not a quasi judicial procedure and the Parties shall have no right of appeal against the Expert’s decision provided always that this shall not be construed as waiving any rights the Parties might have against the Expert for breaching his/her terms of appointment or otherwise being negligent.

 

  40  

 

 

SCHEDULE 6

 

Worked Examples of Financial Terms

 

BRM Demand

 

Both parties recognise that in growing a crop, the delivered yields can be estimated, but are almost never accurate. In order to deliver a targeted weight of BRM, it is likely that British Sugar will plan to grow slightly more than the desired amount of BRM to ensure that any challenges in producing the desired weight still allow the targeted weight to be delivered. In adopting this model, it is likely that the final weight of material produced will exceed the target weight to some extent. Both parties agree that BRM that meets the BRM Specifications should be utilised by GW, whilst recognising that significant over delivery may not be desirable in all circumstances and may have an impact on demand for subsequent years.

 

Four scenarios can be envisaged for BRM demand by GW:

 

1. Supply a targeted production of *** tonnes of BRM

 

2. Supply as much BRM as possible

 

3. Supply a targeted production in excess of *** tonnes of BRM

 

4. Supply less than *** tonnes of BRM

 

1. GW requests *** tonnes of BRM

 

British Sugar will seek to deliver no less than *** tonnes, the only penalty for not delivering up to *** tonnes is a failure for British Sugar to recover the targeted total Productivity Fee and On Budget Fee. GW will accept delivery of all additional BRM in excess of *** tonnes, but will only pay Productivity and On Budget fees for a maximum of ***% of the demand volume (i.e. *** tonnes in total). Any BRM delivered in excess of *** tonnes will be considered to have been Produced in the subsequent calendar year in all respects i.e. the volume will be considered to be part of the subsequent calendar year’s Production, Productivity Fees will be paid as if the BRM was delivered as part of the first shipment of the subsequent calendar year and the volume will count towards the On Budget Fees for the entire subsequent calendar year.

 

However, where British Sugar has over-Produced in one calendar year British Sugar will modify the Growing Plan for the subsequent calendar year to take into account the excess material already produced when growing to achieve the targeted demand volume. In addition the Growing Plan for the subsequent year will take account of improved yields that have led to excess production in the first instance i.e. British Sugar should not be routinely producing significantly in excess of the demanded volume.

 

By way of example

 

    Example 1   Example 2
Targeted tonnage (Year X)   *** tonnes   *** tonnes
Actual production (Year X)   *** tonnes   *** tonnes
Tonnage on which Productivity Fee and On Budget Fee is payable   *** tonnes   *** tonnes
Carry over to Year X+1 production tonnage   *** tonnes   *** tonnes
Productivity Fee payable   ***     kg*£***/kg=
£***
  ***    kg*£***/kg=
£***
On Budget Fee payable
(assuming budget achieved)
  ***    kg*£***/kg=
£***
  ***    kg*£***/kg=
£***   

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  41  

 

 

2. GW requests as much BRM as possible

 

British Sugar will seek to deliver as much BRM as is viable within the existing Operating Budget. There will be no limit on the BRM accepted by GW for which the Productivity Fee and On Budget Fee will be paid.

 

Where British Sugar or GW believe that additional BRM could be Produced as a result of additional Operating Budget spend then British Sugar and GW will discuss the changes to the Operating Budget and expected BRM Production. Changes must be agreed in writing by both Parties. This is likely to be most pertinent when there is a desire to change production requirements within the season (i.e. outside of the annual budgeting and growing plan cycle).

 

3. GW requests in excess of *** tonnes of BRM

 

British Sugar will seek to deliver the targeted weight (it is expected that the target will be derived from a combination of previously delivered yield and high probability continuous improvement projects). GW will take additional BRM in excess of the targeted weight up to a maximum of ***% (although as the yield target is likely to be challenging it should be anticipated that the delivered weight is more likely to be close to the target weight).

 

In the event that British Sugar produces in excess of ***%, any further BRM that meets the BRM Specifications will be accepted by GW. However this additional material will count towards the subsequent year’s target production and will be invoiced as part of the first delivery of BRM in the subsequent year’s deliveries.

 

By way of example

 

    Example 1   Example 2
Targeted tonnage (Year X)   *** tonnes   *** tonnes
Actual production (Year X)   *** tonnes   *** tonnes
Tonnage on which Productivity and On Budget Fee is payable   *** tonnes   *** tonnes
Carry over to Year X+1 production tonnage   *** tonnes   *** tonnes

 

4. GW requests less than *** tonnes of BRM

 

British Sugar will seek to deliver no less than the desired tonnage. GW will pay the Productivity Fee due for no less than *** tonnes of BRM and the On Budget Fee for no less than *** tonnes as if the budget was achieved by British Sugar.

 

Where British Sugar produces more than the desired tonnage, GW will take all additional BRM in excess of the desired tonnage but will be accounted for in one of two ways at GW’s discretion:

 

a)       All taken as part of the current year’s Production, with Productivity Fee and On Budget Fee paid as if the Budget for Costs had been achieved for the greater of *** tonnes or the actual weight delivered.

 

b)       All BRM taken by GW, but all weight up to ***% of the target Production taken as part of the current year’s Production with Productivity Fee and On Budget Fee paid as if the Budget for Costs had been achieved for the greater of *** tonnes or the weight delivered. All weight in excess of ***% will count towards the subsequent year’s Production and will be invoiced as part of the first delivery of BRM in the subsequent year’s deliveries. British Sugar will modify the Growing Plan for the subsequent year to take into account the excess material already produced when growing to achieve the targeted Production.

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  42  

 

 

    Example 1  

Example 2
Option b

  Example 3  

Example 4
Option a

 

Example 4
Option b

Targeted tonnage (Year X)   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes
Actual production (Year X)   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes
Tonnage on which Productivity and On Budget fee is payable   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes
Carry over to Year X+1 production tonnage   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes
Productivity fee payable  

*** kg*

£***/kg

=£***

 

*** kg*

£***/kg

=£***

 

*** kg*

£***/kg=
£***

 

*** kg*

£***/kg=
£***

 

*** kg*

£***/kg=
£***

On Budget fee payable  

*** kg*

£***/kg

=£***

 

*** kg*

£***/kg

=£***

 

***kg*

£***/kg=
£***

 

***kg*

£***/kg=
£***

 

***kg*

£***/kg=
£***

 

Example of On Budget Fee calculation

Budget
performance
  Under budget   Over budget
Yield   Under   Target   Over   Under   Target   Over    
Operating costs
(budget)
  £ ***   £ ***   £ ***   £ ***   £ ***   £ ***   £ ***
Operating costs
(actual*)
  £ ***   £ ***   £ ***   £ ***   £ ***   £ ***   £ ***
Operating cost delta   £ ***
underspend
  £ ***
underspend
  £ ***
underspend
  £ ***
overspend
  £ ***
overspend
  £ ***
overspend
  £ ***   overspend
BRM tonnage   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes   *** tonnes
On Budget Fee
(Nominal)
  £ *** * *** =
£ ***
  £ *** * *** =
£ ***
  £ *** * *** =
£ ***
  £ *** * *** =
£ ***
  £ *** * *** =
£ ***
  £ *** * *** =
£ ***
  £ *** * *** =
£ ***
On Budget Fee payable   £ ***    -    £ ***    = £ ***   £ ***    - £ ***
= £ ***
  £ ***    - £ ***
***
  £ ***    -
£ *** =
£ ***
  £ *** -
£ *** =
£ ***
  £ *** -
£ *** =
£ ***
  £ *** *** +
£ ***
***

 

*Changes to Operating Costs must be agreed by GW in accordance with Clause 13.1.2

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  43  

 

 

SCHEDULE 7
Administrative Information

 

1. GW Research Limited

 

1.1 Sovereign House
Vision Park
Histon
Cambridge CB24 9BZ

 

Tel: + 44 (0)1223 266800

 

Fax: + 44 (0)1223 235667

 

Attention: Company Secretary

 

2. British Sugar

 

2.1 Weston Centre
10 Grosvenor Street
London W1K 4QY

 

Tel: +44 (0)207 3996500

 

Fax: +44 (0)207 3996580

 

Attention: Company Secretary.

 

  44  

 

 

SCHEDULE 8

 

ANTI-BRIBERY AND SANCTIONS RULES

 

Each Party warrants to the other that in connection with any matter arising under or pursuant to any contract it shall not make or offer, directly or indirectly, any payment, gift or other advantage to a public official with the intention of influencing them and obtaining or retaining an advantage in the conduct of business

 

In addition, each Party:

 

(a) shall comply with all applicable laws, regulations, codes and sanctions relating to anti-bribery and anti-corruption including but not limited to the Bribery Act 2010 (all of the aforesaid being “ Relevant Requirements ”);

 

(b) shall have and shall maintain in place throughout the term of this Agreement its own policies and procedures, including but not limited to adequate procedures under the Bribery Act 2010, to ensure compliance with the Relevant Requirements, and will enforce them where appropriate;

 

(c) shall provide such supporting evidence of compliance with the undertaking in (b) above as the other Party may reasonably request;

 

(d) warrants that neither it nor, to its knowledge, its officers, employees, nor any person involved by or for it in the performance of any contract, is a Sanctioned Person; and

 

(e) shall comply with Economic Sanctions Law in all respects related to the performance of this Agreement, and shall not have any dealings or transactions with any Sanctioned Person if such dealings or transactions would cause the other Party to be in violation, or to be subject to a risk of punitive measures being imposed pursuant to, any Economic Sanctions Law (including in respect of any further sale of BRM or drug product containing a drug substance derived from BRM if such dealings or transactions would cause the other Party to be in violation, or to be subject to a risk of punitive measures being imposed pursuant to, any Economic Sanctions Law);

 

For the purposes of this Agreement:

 

Sanctioned Person ” means any person, organisation or vessel

 

(i) designated on the United Nations Consolidated Lists, the Consolidated List of Financial Sanctions Targets maintained by the UK HM Treasury, the Office of Foreign Assets Control list of Specially Designated Nationals and Blocked Persons, the US Government's Denied Persons List, Entities List, Debarred Parties List and Terrorism Exclusion List or an any list of targeted persons issued under the Economic Sanctions Law of any other country (including the European Union);

 

(ii) that is, or is part of, a government of a Sanctioned Territory;

 

(iii) owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by, or acting on behalf of, any of the foregoing; or

 

(iv) incorporated within, located within or operating from a Sanctioned Territory and performing an activity subject to any Economic Sanctions Law; or

 

(v) otherwise targeted under any Economic Sanctions Law.

 

Economic Sanctions Law ” means any laws, regulations, or other binding measures of the European Union, any EU member state, the United Kingdom, the United Nations, the United States of America or any other jurisdiction applicable to the Parties which relates to economic or trade sanctions, export controls, non-proliferation, anti-terrorism or similar restrictions.

 

  45  

 

 

Sanctioned Territory ” means any country or other territory subject to a general export, import, financial or investment embargo under Economic Sanctions Law from time to time, including without limitation Iran, Myanmar, Sudan, Syria, North Korea and Russia/Ukraine.

 

  46  

 

  

SCHEDULE 9

 

MAP OF SITE, FACILITY AND GROWTH ROOMS

 

***

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  47  

 

 

SCHEDULE 10

 

FINANCIAL CONSEQUENCES OF TERMINATION

 

Termination
clause(s) &
description
  Production
continues /
ceases
  Productivity
Fee payable
by GW
  On Budget Fee
payable by GW
  Area Charge
&
depreciation
costs payable
by GW
  Operating
Costs payable
by GW
  Other
amounts
payable 1 by
GW
  Other
Mutual Rights                            
Clause 3.6 -Failure to  satisfy the condition precedent and the Parties decide not to proceed with the Agreement   N/A   Nil   Nil   Nil   Nil   Nil   Each Party shall pay its own costs and expenses and each Party acknowledges that such costs and expenses were incurred entirely at its own risk.
                             
Clause 18.1 -Natural expiry of the contract   Production continues until the expiry of the Initial Term or Renewal Term (as applicable)   Payable as set out in Clause 13.1.5 for the BRM Produced until the expiry of the Initial Term or Renewal Term (as applicable)   Payable as set out in Clause 13.1.6 for the BRM Produced until the expiry of the Initial Term or Renewal Term (as applicable)   Payable as set out in Clauses 13.1.4 and 13.1.3 respectively until the expiry of the Initial Term or Renewal Term (as applicable)  

Payable as set out in Clause 13.1.2 until the expiry of the Initial Term or Renewal Term (as applicable)

 

 

GW shall pay any other amounts due and payable under the Agreement

 

 

N/A

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1 These may include the other Fees, such as the Crop Change Payment and the unreimbursed costs relating to the Conversion Plan which are reimbursable under Clause 5.3.

 

  48  

 

 

 

Termination
clause(s) &
description
  Production
continues /
ceases
  Productivity
Fee payable
by GW
  On Budget Fee
payable by GW
  Area Charge
&
depreciation
costs payable
by GW
  Operating
Costs payable
by GW
  Other
amounts
payable 1 by
GW
  Other

Clause 22.3 - Force Majeure

prevents British Sugar growing at the site

  To the extent possible, British Sugar shall wind down the Facility in accordance with Clause 18.6.   Payable as set out in Clause 13.1.5 for the BRM Produced until Force Majeure is invoked.   Payable as set out in Clause 13.1.6 for the BRM Produced until Force Majeure is invoked   Payable as set out in Clauses 13.1.4 and 13.1.3 respectively until Force Majeure is invoked   Payable as set out in Clause 13.1.2 until Force Majeure is invoked   GW shall pay any other financial obligations it assumed under this Agreement which would have been payable had the Agreement continued, including any outstanding Crop Change Payment due under Clause 13.1.1 or any unreimbursed costs relating to the Conversion Plan which are reimbursable under Clause 5.3.    

 

  49  

 

 

 

Termination
clause(s) &
description
  Production
continues /
ceases
  Productivity
Fee payable
by GW
  On Budget Fee
payable by GW
  Area Charge
&
depreciation
costs payable
by GW
  Operating
Costs payable
by GW
  Other
amounts
payable 1 by
GW
  Other
Clause 22.3 - Force Majeure event affects GW   British Sugar shall wind down the Facility in accordance with Clause 18.6.  

Payable as if the Agreement continued until (i) the first 31 December following the ***

anniversary of the Effective Date or (ii) the first 31 December to occur not less than *** ( *** ) months following the effective date of termination, whichever is the later.

 

It shall be assumed for these purposes that British Sugar had properly performed its obligations and that the output of BRM Produced was *** tonnes.

 

 

Payable as if the Agreement continued until (i) the first 31 December following the *** anniversary of the Effective Date or (ii) the first 31 December to occur not less than twenty four (24) months following the effective date of termination, whichever is the later.

 

It shall be assumed for these purposes that British Sugar had properly performed its obligations and that the output of BRM Produced was *** tonnes.

 

 

Payable as if the Agreement continued until (i) the first 31 December following the ***

anniversary of the Effective Date or (ii) the first 31 December to occur not less than *** ( *** ) months following the effective date of termination, whichever is the later.

 

 

  Payable during the period in which British Sugar winds down the Facility.  

GW shall pay any other financial obligations it assumed under this Agreement which would have been payable had the Agreement continued, including any outstanding Crop Change Payment due under Clause 13.1.1 or any unreimbursed costs relating to the Conversion Plan which are reimbursable under Clause 5.3.

 

  British Sugar shall take steps to mitigate its losses and shall use reasonable endeavours to generate an income from one or more crops grown in the Facility during the period between termination and the relevant date to which GW is to pay Fees. Should British Sugar grow another crop in the Facility during this post-termination period, the profit contribution (revenue less direct operating overheads funded by British Sugar) earned from these activities shall be set off against the Fees payable (hereafter “ Mitigation on Termination ”).

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  50  

 

 

 

Termination
clause(s) &
description
  Production
continues /
ceases
  Productivity
Fee payable
by GW
  On Budget Fee
payable by GW
  Area Charge
&
depreciation
costs payable
by GW
  Operating
Costs payable
by GW
  Other
amounts
payable 1 by
GW
  Other
Termination by British Sugar                            
18.2.1 -  Material breach by GW   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.
                             
18.2.2 - Insolvency of GW   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.
                             
18.2.3 - After Year 3 without cause – GW elect to continue growing   Grow until expiry of the notice period.  

Payable until (i) the first 31 December following the ***

anniversary of the Effective Date or (ii) the first 31 December to occur not less than *** ( *** ) months following the effective date of the notice, whichever is the later, for a minimum of *** tonnes of BRM that meets the BRM Specification.

 

Payable until (i) the first 31 December following the ***

anniversary of the Effective Date or (ii) the first 31 December to occur not less than *** ( *** ) months following the effective date of the notice, whichever is the later.

 

It shall be assumed for these purposes that British Sugar had properly performed its obligations and that the output of BRM Produced was *** tonnes on budget.

 

Payable until (i) the first 31 December following the ***

anniversary of the Effective Date or (ii) the first 31 December to occur not less than *** ( *** ) months following the effective date of the notice, whichever is the later.

 

 

Payable during the period of Production.

 

  GW shall not be relieved of any other financial obligations it assumed under this Agreement which would have been payable had the Agreement continued, including any outstanding Crop Change Payment due under Clause 13.1.1 or any unreimbursed costs relating to the Conversion Plan which are reimbursable under Clause 5.3.    

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  51  

 

 

 

Termination
clause(s) &
description
  Production
continues /
ceases
  Productivity
Fee payable
by GW
  On Budget Fee
payable by GW
  Area Charge
&
depreciation
costs payable
by GW
  Operating
Costs payable
by GW
  Other
amounts
payable 1 by
GW
  Other
                             
18.2.3 - After Year 3 without cause, GW elect to cease production   Wind down as agreed with GW   Due immediately - all Productivity Fees payable up to (i) the first 31 December following the ***   anniversary of the Effective Date or (ii) the first 31 December to occur not less than ***                ( *** ) months following the effective date of the notice, whichever is the later, for a minimum of *** tonnes of BRM that meets the BRM Specification.  

Due immediately - all On Budget Fees Payable until (i) the first 31 December following the *** anniversary of the Effective Date or (ii) the first 31 December to occur not less than *** ( *** ) months following the effective date of the notice, whichever is the later.

 

It shall be assumed for these purposes that British Sugar had properly performed its obligations and that the output of BRM Produced was *** tonnes on budget.

  Due immediately all Depreciation and Area Charges payable until (i) the first 31 December following the fifth anniversary of the Effective Date or (ii) the first 31 December to occur not less than ***                    ( *** ) months following the effective date of the notice, whichever is the later.  

Payable during the period of Production and during the wind down period (provided that the wind down period for the purpose of calculating the Operating Costs payable will not exceed 16 weeks).

 

  GW shall not be relieved of any other financial obligations it assumed under this Agreement which would have been payable had the Agreement continued, including any outstanding Crop Change Payment due under Clause 13.1.1 or any unreimbursed costs relating to the Conversion Plan which are reimbursable under Clause 5.3.   Mitigation on Termination shall apply.

 

 

 

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  52  

 

 

 

Termination
clause(s) &
description
  Production
continues /
ceases
  Productivity
Fee payable
by GW
  On Budget Fee
payable by GW
  Area Charge
&
depreciation
costs payable
by GW
  Operating
Costs payable
by GW
  Other
amounts
payable 1 by
GW
  Other
                             
18.2.4(a) - No Regulatory Approval obtained by longstop date   N/A  

Payable until the first 31 December following the ***

anniversary of the Effective Date.

 

It shall be assumed for these purposes that British Sugar had properly performed its obligations and that the output of BRM Produced was *** tonnes.

 

Payable until the first 31 December following the *** anniversary of the Effective Date.

 

It shall be assumed for these purposes that British Sugar had properly performed its obligations and that the output of BRM Produced was *** tonnes on budget.

 

Payable until (i) the first 31 December following the ***

anniversary of the Effective Date or (ii) the first 31 December to occur not less than *** ( *** ) months following the longstop date, whichever is the later.

  Payable until the effective date of termination.   GW shall not be relieved of any other financial obligations it assumed under this Agreement which would have been payable had the Agreement continued for the specified period, including any outstanding Crop Change Payment due under Clause 13.1.1 or any unreimbursed costs relating to the Conversion Plan which are reimbursable under Clause 5.3.   Mitigation on Termination shall apply.
                             

18.2.4(b) - Approval to grow removed (British Sugar not at fault)

 

  As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.

 

 
*** Portions of this page have been omitted pursuant to a request for Confidential Treatment and filed separately with the Commission.

 

  53  

 

 

 

Termination
clause(s) &
description
  Production
continues /
ceases
  Productivity
Fee payable
by GW
  On Budget Fee
payable by GW
  Area Charge
&
depreciation
costs payable
by GW
  Operating
Costs payable
by GW
  Other
amounts
payable 1 by

GW
  Other
Termination by GW

18.3.1 - Material breach by British Sugar

 

 

   British Sugar shall wind down the Facility in accordance with clause 18.6.   Payable for BRM that meets the BRM Specification which is Produced and available for collection up to the effective date of termination, provided that it can still be used and sold.   Payable for BRM which is Produced and available for collection up to the effective date of termination.   Payable until the effective date of termination.   Payable until the effective date of termination.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if British Sugar affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if British Sugar affected by Force Majeure.
                             
18.3.2 - Insolvency of British Sugar   As set out above in relation to 18.3.1.    As set out above in relation to 18.3.1.    As set out above in relation to 18.3.1.    As set out above in relation to 18.3.1.   As set out above in relation to 18.3.1.    As set out above in relation to 18.3.1.    As set out above in relation to 18.3.1.
                             
18.3.3 - After Year 3 without cause   As set out in relation to 18.2.3 above.   As set out in relation to 18.2.3 above.   As set out in relation to 18.2.3 above.   As set out in relation to 18.2.3 above.   As set out in relation to 18.2.3 above.   As set out in relation to 18.2.3 above.   As set out in relation to 18.2.3 above.
                             
18.3.4(a) - No Regulatory Approval obtained by longstop date   As set out above in relation to 18.2.4(a).   As set out above in relation to 18.2.4(a).   As set out above in relation to 18.2.4(a).   As set out above in relation to 18.2.4(a).   As set out above in relation to 18.2.4(a).   As set out above in relation to 18.2.4(a).   As set out above in relation to 18.2.4(a).

 

  54  

 

 

 

Termination
clause(s) &
description
  Production
continues /
ceases
  Productivity
Fee payable
by GW
  On Budget Fee
payable by GW
  Area Charge
&
depreciation
costs payable
by GW
  Operating
Costs payable
by GW
  Other
amounts
payable 1 by
GW
  Other
                             
18.3.4(b) – Regulatory Approval removed (British Sugar at fault)    As set out above in relation to 18.3.1.    As set out above in relation to 18.3.1.    As set out above in relation to 18.3.1.    As set out above in relation to 18.3.1.    As set out above in relation to 18.3.1.    As set out above in relation to 18.3.1.    As set out above in relation to 18.3.1.
                             
18.3.4(c) –Regulatory Approval removed (British Sugar not at fault)   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.
                             

18.3.5 – Marketing Authorisation is withdrawn

 

  As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.   As set out in relation to 22.3 above as if GW affected by Force Majeure.

 

  55  

 

Exhibit 4.60

 

MUTUAL TERMINATION AGREEMENT

 

This Mutual Termination Agreement (together with all Exhibits hereto, this “ Termination Agreement ”) is entered into as of 24 November 2016 (the “ Termination Effective Date ”) by and between Novartis Pharma AG, a company incorporated under the laws of Switzerland, with a place of business at Lichtstrasse 35, CH-4056 Basel, Switzerland (hereinafter referred to as “Novartis” ), and GW Pharma Ltd, a company incorporated under the laws of England and Wales (Company No. 03704998), having its registered address at Sovereign House, Vision Park, Chivers Way, Histon, Cambridge CB24 9BZ, UK (hereinafter referred to as “GW” ). Novartis and GW, may hereinafter be referred to individually as a “Party” and collectively as the “Parties”.

 

WHEREAS , Novartis and GW are parties to that certain Distribution and License Agreement, dated 8 April 2011, as amended on 1 February 2014 and 19 January 2015 (collectively and as so amended, the “Agreement” ); and

 

WHEREAS , Novartis and GW wish to terminate the Agreement, and to confirm and define their respective future mutual rights and obligations with respect thereto, in each case, on the terms and conditions set forth herein.

 

NOW THEREFORE , in consideration of the mutual promises and covenants hereinafter set forth, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and adequacy of which is hereby acknowledged, and intending to be legally bound hereby, the Parties agree as follows:

 

1. DEFINITIONS

 

Unless otherwise defined herein, capitalized words used in this Termination Agreement shall have the meaning attributed to them in the Agreement.

 

2. MUTUAL TERMINATION OF THE AGREEMENT

 

Notwithstanding any provision of the Agreement to the contrary, the Parties agree that on the Termination Effective Date, the Agreement (including any and all related amendments, modifications and ancillary agreements, including the Manufacturing and Supply Agreement, dated 9 November 2011, by and between GW and Novartis), is hereby mutually terminated by the Parties and of no further legal force or effect, except as otherwise expressly provided for herein (including Section 3.11 hereof). Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Parties agree that the Pharmacovigilance Agreement, dated 28 February 2012, by between GW and Novartis (the “ Pharmacoviligance Agreement ”) shall not terminate on the Termination Effective Date and shall instead continue in effect solely in accordance with the terms of Section 3.6 of this Termination Agreement.

 

 

 

 

3. EFFECTS OF TERMINATION AND TRANSITION SERVICES.

 

3.1 Effect of Termination on the Licenses and Other Grants Relevant to Section 2 of the Agreement.

 

a) The Parties hereby agree that any licenses and other rights granted by GW to Novartis under the GW Technology pursuant to the Agreement shall terminate and/or be transitioned to GW in accordance with the following:

 

i. For those countries in the Territory (i) in which no Regulatory Filings for Product have been submitted to the Regulatory Authority of that country prior to the Termination Effective Date or (ii) in which the Regulatory Filings have been rejected by the Regulatory Authority prior to the Termination Effective Date (collectively, the “ No Approval Countries ”): Any licenses and other rights to use the GW Technology granted by GW to Novartis under the Agreement with respect to such country will terminate and revert to GW effective upon the Termination Effective Date;

 

ii. For those countries in the Territory in which Novartis has submitted a Regulatory Filing for Product to the Regulatory Authority of that country prior to the Termination Effective Date, but in which a Regulatory Approval has not been obtained before the Termination Effective Date (collectively, the “ Pending Approval Countries ”): Any licenses and other rights to use the GW Technology granted by GW to Novartis under the Agreement with respect to such country will terminate and revert to GW effective upon the Termination Effective Date except that such licenses and rights shall continue following the Termination Effective Date solely to the extent necessary for Novartis to perform and discharge its obligations under this Termination Agreement. Upon the discharge of such obligations such residual rights under GW Technology will terminate and revert to GW; and

 

iii. For those countries in the Territory in which a Regulatory Approval has been obtained by Novartis as of the Termination Effective Date, specifically, Australia, Malaysia, New Zealand, Kuwait, and the United Arab Emirates (collectively, the “ Approved Countries ”): Any licenses and other rights to use the GW Technology granted by GW to Novartis under the Agreement with respect to such country will continue after the Termination Effective Date and shall terminate and revert to GW effective upon the date of completion of the transfer from Novartis of the Regulatory Approval for such country to GW or to its Third Party designee.

 

b) Novartis hereby confirms that it has not granted to any Third Parties any sublicenses under the GW Technology.

 

3.2 Effect of Termination on the Obligations relating to Development and Product Information Relevant to Section 4 of the Agreement.

 

From and after the Termination Effective Date, GW will be solely responsible, at its own cost and expense, for all Development of the Product for the Territory.

 

  2  

 

 

3.3 Effect of Termination on the Regulatory Affairs and Activities Relevant to Section 6.1 of the Agreement.

 

a) The Parties hereby agree that Novartis’ rights and responsibilities with respect to regulatory affairs and activities related to the Product in the Territory shall terminate and/or be transitioned to GW in accordance with the following:

 

i. For each of the Approved Countries : Novartis will continue to maintain the Regulatory Filings for each Approved Country until 31 January 2017. On or before 31 January 2017, Novartis will file the CDS-update(s), CMC-variation(s) and Regulatory Approval transfer submission(s) for the transfer of the Regulatory Approval(s) in each such Approved Country to GW or its designated Third Party in accordance with applicable local Law. GW will (or will cause its future local distribution-partner to), at GW’s own cost and expense, execute, acknowledge and deliver any and all documents and take any action as may be reasonably necessary to complete each Regulatory Approval transfer. By way of exception, in Malaysia, Novartis will only be required to file the Regulatory Approval transfer submission (and the Parties have agreed that Novartis is not obliged to file any CDS-updates or CMC-variations for Malaysia), but will do so on or before 31 January 2017. For each Approved Country, from and after 31 January 2017 any subsequent new CDS-update(s) and CMC variation(s) will be filed directly by GW once the Regulatory Approval transfer has been completed.

 

ii. For each of the Pending Approval Countries : From and after the Termination Effective Date, Novartis will transfer all Regulatory Filings to GW, except that Novartis shall have no such obligation if GW expressly requests that Novartis withdraw the Regulatory Filings in a specific country. GW hereby expressly requests that Novartis withdraw the Regulatory Filings in South Africa and Egypt. By way of exception, in Saudi Arabia, Novartis will continue to be responsible for all interactions with the Regulatory Authority with respect to the Regulatory Approvals, including any discussions related to the Pricing and/or Reimbursement Approval for the Product, until the Regulatory Approval in Saudi Arabia has been granted or rejected; following the grant or rejection of these Regulatory Approvals, Novartis will (A) file the Regulatory Approval transfer submission for the transfer of these Regulatory Approvals to GW or its Third Party designee and (B) transfer all Regulatory Filings for Saudi Arabia to GW. The foregoing obligations with respect to Saudi Arabia will continue beyond 31 January 2017 until they have been completed. The Parties agree that if, after submission of the pricing documents by Novartis, a significant amount of regulatory work will continue to be required in order to obtain Regulatory Approvals in the Pending Approval Countries, then the Parties will discuss in good faith how this work can be outsourced to a Third Party and the sharing of the associated costs by the Parties; and

 

iii. For the each of the No Approval Countries : From and after the Termination Effective Date, GW will be solely responsible for all interactions with the Regulatory Authorities with respect to all Regulatory Filings and Regulatory Approvals.

 

  3  

 

 

b) For the avoidance of the doubt, any regulatory activities performed by Novartis pursuant to the above Section 3.3(a) (collectively, the “ Regulatory Services ”) shall be performed free of charge to GW and Novartis agrees to bear all costs and expenses incurred in connection with all Regulatory Services performed on or before 31 January 2017 (even if the invoice for such services is not raised or received until after 31 January 2017) or, in the case of Saudi Arabia (and subject to the final sentence of Section 3.3(a)ii , until the Regulatory Services are completed. It is agreed and understood by and between the Parties that Novartis will not be liable for, and GW hereby expressly waives, releases and discharges Novartis from, any claims in contract, tort, negligence, breach of statutory duty or otherwise for any special, indirect, incidental, punitive or consequential damages or for any economic loss or loss of profits actually or allegedly suffered by GW arising out of or in connection with any Regulatory Service.

 

c) Notwithstanding the above, except with respect to Saudi Arabia from and after 1 January 2017, GW will be solely responsible, at its own cost and expense, for all Regulatory Filings and Regulatory Approvals for all Product in the Territory (including all interactions with Regulatory Authorities in the Territory with respect to Regulatory Approvals, including filing and maintaining any required Regulatory Approvals, seeking necessary permits and/or scheduling or re-scheduling in controlled substance listings or de-scheduling of the Product from controlled substances listings in the Territory).

 

d) Each of Novartis and GW will (and GW will cause each of its Third Party designee(s) to) use its best efforts in order to ensure a smooth transition of the regulatory affairs and activities relating to the Product in the Territory in accordance with this Section 3.4 on or before 31 January 2017.

 

e) On or before 31 January 2017, Novartis shall provide GW with copies of all filings and correspondence submitted to, or received from, any Regulatory Authority to the extent they relate to all relevant Product(s) in the Territory and are still available at Novartis. Novartis will forward to GW any correspondence received from any Regulatory Authority in the Territory after 31 January 2017 to the extent they relate to the Product and are still available at Novartis.

 

f) Notwithstanding the foregoing, Novartis will file an application for the certification of the reimbursement price for the Product in Kuwait with the Ministry of Health in Kuwait on or before 31 January 2017.

 

g) Notwithstanding the foregoing, Novartis will ensure that Novartis’ registered distributors for Product in Kuwait and United Arab Emirates will deliver, at GW’s request, a letter of no objection (in a form reasonably acceptable to GW and the applicable Regulatory Authority) consenting to its replacement of Novartis` distributor as the registered distributor of Product in such country.

 

h) Notwithstanding the foregoing, Novartis will give Novartis’ registered distributors for Product in United Arab Emirates notice of termination of its appointment as the registered distributor of Product in such country (in a form reasonably acceptable to GW and the applicable Regulatory Authority).

 

  4  

 

 

3.4 Effect of Termination on the Commercialization Activities Relevant to Sections 6.2 and 11.2 of the Agreement.

 

a) From and after the Termination Effective Date and except as expressly set forth in Section 3.3 of this Termination Agreement, GW will be solely responsible, at its own cost and expense, for all aspects of Commercialization of the Product in the Territory, including planning and implementation, distribution, booking of sales, pricing, reimbursement, regulatory, manufacturing, phase IV studies, marketing and sales activities.

 

b) Novartis hereby confirms that there are no clinical data generated by Novartis as part of any Phase IV clinical study conducted by it in accordance with the Agreement and that no Phase IV clinical studies of any Product sponsored by Novartis are on-going as of the Termination Effective Date.

 

c) Effective from and after the Termination Effective Date, Novartis hereby grants to GW an exclusive, perpetual, irrevocable, fully paid-up, sublicensable license under the copyright and trade dress rights in the marketing, advertising and promotional materials used by Novartis and its Affiliates to Commercialize the Product in the Territory, to make and have made Regulatory Filings, import, have imported, use, have used, Commercialize and have Commercialized any Product in the Territory. Expressly excluded from the foregoing license is the right for GW to use the Novartis Marks.

 

3.5 Effect of Termination on the Trademark Rights and Licenses Relevant to Sections 6.3 and 11.2 of the Agreement.

 

a) The Parties hereby agree that any licenses and other rights granted by GW to Novartis pursuant to the Agreement to use the GW Trademark shall terminate in accordance with the following:

 

i. In all countries in the Territory other than the Approved Countries : All rights granted to Novartis pursuant to the Agreement to use the GW Trademark in such countries shall cease immediately upon the Termination Effective Date; and

 

ii. In each of the Approved Countries : All rights granted to Novartis pursuant to the Agreement to use the GW Trademark in such countries shall cease upon completion of Novartis’ obligations under this Termination Agreement to transfer to GW, or to its Third Party designee, all of Novartis’ rights in the Regulatory Approvals and Regulatory Filings.

 

b) As soon as practicable following the Termination Effective Date, Novartis will transfer to GW any registrations for domain names owned or Controlled by Novartis or its Affiliates which correspond to or include any GW Trademark for Product.

 

c) For the sake of clarity, Novartis exclusively owns and will, after the Termination Effective Date, continue to exclusively own all rights in and to the Novartis Marks.

 

  5  

 

 

3.6 Effect of Termination on the Pharmacovigilance Activities Relevant to Section 6.5 of the Agreement.

 

a) Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the amendment to the Pharmacovigilance Agreement referenced in Section 3.6(b) hereof , from and after the Termination Effective Date, GW will be solely responsible, at its own cost and expense, for all pharmacovigilance activities related to or with respect to the Product in the Territory.

 

b) The Parties hereby agree that on or before 31 January 2017, the Parties will enter into an amendment to the Pharmacovigilance Agreement setting forth the terms and conditions for a detailed transitional plan pursuant to which all pharmacovigilance activities will be transitioned from Novartis to GW.

 

c) Novartis will use its best efforts to assist GW in its performance of its pharmacovigilance obligations during the transitional phase in accordance with the detailed transitional plan referenced in Section 3.6(b) , above.

 

3.7 Effect of Termination on the Patents and Resulting Intellectual Property Relevant to Sections 2 and 8 of the Agreement.

 

a) For the sake of clarity, both Parties will retain all title, rights, interest, and ownership in their respective Intellectual Property.

 

b) Each Party hereby confirms that no Resulting Intellectual Property was generated, developed or created by either Party and that neither Party owns any Resulting Intellectual Property.

 

3.8 Effect of Termination on the Sales in New Zealand to Individual Patients.

 

a) From and after the Termination Effective Date but only until the NZ Transfer Date (as defined below), Novartis will continue to supply to individual patients in New Zealand the amounts of Product sufficient to cover their medical needs, who, as of the Termination Effective Date, receive Product from Novartis in all material respects in accordance with the current practices and procedures for such supply already established (i.e., using Bayer UK packs that are converted locally into saleable packs for the New Zealand market) (the “ NZ Supply ”) solely until both (i) the Regulatory Approval for New Zealand has been transferred to GW and (ii) GW has established new mechanisms to distribute and supply Product in New Zealand which have been approved by the Ministry of Health (the date that both (i) and (ii) are achieved, the “ NZ Transfer Date ”).

 

b) From and after the NZ Transfer Date:

 

i. GW will be exclusively solely responsible, at its own cost and expense, for any and all supply of Product in New Zealand;

 

ii. Upon receipt by Novartis of reimbursement by GW of the Price originally paid by Novartis to GW for any unexpired and saleable inventory of Product in Novartis’ warehouse as of the NZ Transfer Date , Novartis will transfer such inventory to GW or its Third Party designee as soon as practicable following the NZ Transfer Date;

 

  6  

 

 

iii. Novartis will transfer to GW all pending supply requests and purchase orders related to the Product received by Novartis.

 

c) Each Party shall use commercially reasonable efforts to ensure that such NZ Supply patients continue to have access to the Product until the NZ Transfer Date and to ensure that the transfer will happen as soon as possible after the Termination Effective Date. In the event that GW or its Third Party designee are unable to achieve prong (ii) of the definition of “ NZ Transfer Date ” within 180 days of the Termination Effective Date, the Parties will discuss in good faith the terms and conditions upon which Novartis can continue to supply Product to individual patients in order to provide such NZ Supply patients with access to the Product.

 

3.9 Effect of Termination on the Financial Provisions Relevant to Section 7 of the Agreement.

 

a) The Parties agree that any payment made by Novartis to GW relating to, arising out of, or in connection with the Agreement (including the upfront payment paid pursuant to Section 7.1 of the Agreement) prior to the Termination Effective Date will not be refunded to Novartis.

 

b) The Parties agree that upon the Termination Effective Date any obligation of Novartis to make royalty payments to GW pursuant to Section 7.3 of the Agreement will immediately cease and that no Milestone Payments, as per Section 7.2 of the Agreement, are or will be due.

 

c) GW hereby confirms that it has not acquired and will not acquire licenses to any Relevant Third Party Rights for which Novartis would need to pay fifty percent (50%) of the milestone payments, royalties and/or other license fees.

 

3.10 Mutual Release.

 

a) Except as expressly set forth in this Termination Agreement (including Section 3.11 hereof), effective as of the Termination Effective Date, each of GW and Novartis hereby irrevocably releases and discharges the other from all its obligations and liabilities under or in connection with the Agreement (including any and all related amendments, modifications and ancillary agreements other than the Pharmacovigilance Agreement).

 

  7  

 

 

b) Each of the Parties, for itself and on behalf of its predecessors, successors, assigns, and Affiliates, and its past, present and future directors, officers, agents, employees and representatives (the “ Releasors ”), hereby affirms that the Releasors do not know of any claims by any Third Party for which the Releasors would seek indemnification or any type of monetary recovery or injunctive relief from the other Party, its respective predecessors, successors, assigns, and Affiliates, and each of their past, present and future directors, officers, agents, employees and representatives (the “ Released Parties ”). The Releasors hereby completely and forever remise, release and discharge the Released Parties of any and all claims by the Releasors for any and all actions, causes of action, suits, debts, dues, sums of money, accounts, covenants, set offs, defenses, rights, obligations, liabilities, controversies, damages, executions, claims and demands whatsoever, in law or in equity, in tort or contract, whether known or unknown, whether liquidated or unliquidated, whether contingent or fixed, against the Released Parties (or any of them), that Releasors (or any of them) have or have ever had before the Termination Effective Date, or may ever claim to have or have had before the Termination Effective Date, for, upon, or by reason of any matter, cause or thing whatsoever, relating to, arising out of, or in connection with the Agreement (including any and all related amendments, modifications and ancillary agreements). For the avoidance of doubt, this release does not apply to the rights and obligations set forth in this Termination Agreement.

 

3.11 Survivals.

 

Notwithstanding anything herein or in the Agreement to the contrary, the only provisions of the Agreement that shall survive its termination are as follows: Section 1 of the Agreement (Definitions and Interpretation); and Section 9 of the Agreement (Confidentiality).

 

4. GENERAL PROVISIONS

 

4.1 Assignment . Neither Party may assign this Termination Agreement nor its rights and obligations under this Termination Agreement without the other Party’s prior written consent, except that Novartis may, without GW’s consent, (a) assign its rights and obligations under this Termination Agreement or any part hereof to one or more of its Affiliates; or (b) assign this Termination Agreement in its entirety to a successor to all or substantially all of its business or assets to which this Termination Agreement relates. Any permitted assignee will assume all obligations of its assignor under this Termination Agreement (or related to the assigned portion in case of a partial assignment). Any attempted assignment in contravention of the foregoing will be void. Subject to the terms of this Termination Agreement, this Termination Agreement will be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the Parties and their respective successors and permitted assigns.

 

4.2 Severability . Should one or more of the provisions of this Termination Agreement become void or unenforceable as a matter of law, then this Termination Agreement will be construed as if such provision were not contained herein and the remainder of this Termination Agreement will remain in full force and effect. The Parties will use their best efforts to substitute for the invalid or unenforceable provision a valid and enforceable provision which conforms as nearly as possible with the original intent of the Parties.

 

4.3 Written Form Clause. This Termination Agreement, together with its Exhibits, sets forth the entire agreement and understanding of the Parties as to the subject matter hereof and supersedes all proposals, oral or written, and all other prior communications between the Parties with respect to the Termination Agreement. No provision of this Termination Agreement may be amended or modified other than by a written document signed by authorized representatives of each Party. In the event of any conflict between a substantive provision of this Termination Agreement and the Agreement, the substantive provisions of this Termination Agreement will prevail.

 

  8  

 

 

4.4 Language, Applicable Law and Jurisdiction. This Termination Agreement was negotiated, written and executed in the English language, which will be the only official version and will override any translated version to the extent of any conflict. Any translation into any other language will only be an unofficial working-translation and will be irrelevant for interpreting this Termination Agreement. This Termination Agreement shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the laws which govern the Agreement, which provisions (Section 14.3 of the Agreement) are expressly incorporated herein by reference mutadis mutandis . The Parties submit to the jurisdiction and dispute resolution provisions as set forth in the Agreement, which provisions (Sections 14.3 and 14.4 of the Agreement) are expressly incorporated herein by reference mutadis mutandis .

 

4.5 Waivers and Amendments . The failure of any Party to assert a right hereunder or to insist upon compliance with any term or condition of this Termination Agreement will not constitute a waiver of that right or excuse a similar subsequent failure to perform any such term or condition by the other Party. No waiver will be effective unless it has been given in writing and signed by the Party giving such waiver. No provision of this Termination Agreement may be amended or modified other than by a written document signed by authorized representatives of each Party.

 

4.6 Notices. All notices, consents, waivers, and other communications under this Termination Agreement must be in writing and will be deemed to have been duly given when: (a) delivered by hand (with written confirmation of receipt); or (b) sent by facsimile (with provision for assurance of receipt in a manner typical with respect to communications of that type); or (c) when received by the addressee, if sent by an internationally recognized overnight delivery service, in each case to the appropriate addresses set forth below (or to such other addresses as a Party may designate by written notice):

 

If to GW:

 

GW Pharma Limited

Sovereign House,

Histon,

Cambridge,

CB24 9BZ

United Kingdom

Attention: Company Secretary

Fax number: +44 1223 235667

 

If to Novartis:

 

Novartis Pharma AG P.O. Box CH - 4002 Basel Switzerland Attn: Head, Business Development and Licensing Fax: +41-61-324-2511

 

with a copy to:

 

Novartis Pharma AG P.O. Box CH - 4002 Basel Switzerland Attn: Head, Legal Department Fax: +41-61-324-7399.

 

  9  

 

 

4.7 Further Assurances . Parties hereby covenant and agree without the necessity of any further consideration, to execute, acknowledge and deliver any and all such other documents and take any such other action as may be reasonably necessary to carry out the intent and purposes of this Termination Agreement.

 

4.8 Compliance with Law . Each Party will perform its obligations under this Termination Agreement in accordance with all applicable Laws. No Party will, or will be required to, undertake any activity under or in connection with this Termination Agreement which violates, or which it believes, in good faith, may violate, any applicable Law.

 

4.9 No Third Party Beneficiary Rights . The provisions of this Termination Agreement are for the sole benefit of the Parties and their successors and permitted assigns, and they will not be construed as conferring any rights to any Third Party (including any third party beneficiary rights).

 

4.10 Expenses In Concluding This Mutual Termination . Except as otherwise expressly provided in this Termination Agreement, each Party will pay the fees and expenses of its respective lawyers and other advisors and all other expenses and costs incurred by such Party incidental to the negotiation, preparation, execution and delivery of this Termination Agreement.

 

4.11 Interpretation . In this Termination Agreement, unless otherwise specified:

 

a) “includes” and “including” mean, respectively, “includes, without limitation” and “including, without limitation”;

 

b) a Party includes its permitted assignees and/or the respective successors in title to substantially the whole of its undertaking;

 

c) a statute or statutory instrument or any of their provisions is to be construed as a reference to that statute or statutory instrument or such provision as the same may have been or may from time to time hereafter be amended or re-enacted;

 

d) words denoting the singular will include the plural and vice versa and words denoting any gender will include all genders;

 

e) the Exhibits and other attachments form part of the operative provisions of this Agreement and references to this Termination Agreement will, unless the context otherwise requires, include references to the Exhibits and attachments;

 

f) the headings in this Termination Agreement are for information only and will not be considered in the interpretation of this Termination Agreement;

 

g) general words will not be given a restrictive interpretation by reason of their being preceded or followed by words indicating a particular class of acts, matters or things; and

 

  10  

 

 

h) the Parties agree that the terms and conditions of this Termination Agreement are the result of negotiations between the Parties and that this Termination Agreement will not be construed in favor of or against any Party by reason of the extent to which any Party participated in the preparation of this Termination Agreement.

 

4.12 Force Majeure. In the event that either Party is prevented from performing its obligations under this Termination Agreement as a result of any contingency beyond its reasonable control that could not have been avoided by due care being taken by such non-performing Party (“ Force Majeure ”), including any actions of governmental authorities or agencies, war, hostilities between nations, civil commotions, riots, national industry strikes, lockouts, sabotage, shortages in supplies, energy shortages, fire, floods and acts of nature such as typhoons, hurricanes, earthquakes, or tsunamis, the Party so affected will not be responsible to the other Party for any delay or failure of performance of its obligations hereunder, for so long as Force Majeure prevents such performance. In the event of Force Majeure, the Party immediately affected thereby will give prompt written notice to the other Party specifying the Force Majeure event complained of, and will use commercially reasonable efforts to resume performance of its obligations. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if such a Force Majeure induced delay or failure of performance continues for a period beyond 31 January 2017, either Party may terminate any remaining obligations under this Termination Agreement upon written notice to the other Party.

 

4.13 Authority to Enter this Mutual Termination. Each Party hereby covenants and represents to the other Party that it has full right and authority to enter into this Termination Agreement without the consent or approval of any Third Party.

 

4.14 Counterparts. This Termination Agreement may be executed in two or more counterparts, by manual, facsimile, pdf or electronic signature, each of which will be deemed an original, but all of which together will constitute one and the same instrument.

 

4.15 Cumulative Remedies . No remedy referred to in this Termination Agreement is intended to be exclusive, but each will be cumulative and in addition to any other remedy referred to in this Termination Agreement or otherwise available under Law.

 

[ Signature Page Follows ]

 

  11  

 

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties intending to be bound have caused this Termination Agreement to be executed by their duly authorized representatives.

 

NOVARTIS PHARMA  AG   GW PHARMA LTD
         
By: /s/ Stefan lbing   By: /s/ James Ryan
         
Name: Stefan lbing   Name: James Ryan
         
Title: Authorised Signatory   Title: Head of Legal Affairs
         
Date: 25/11/2016   Date: 28-11-2016
         
By: /s/ Britt Henderson      
         
Name: Britt Henderson      
         
Title: CFO Amal Pharma      
         
Date: 28-11-2016      

 

Signature Page to Termination Agreement

 

Exhibit 4.61

 

 

 

1 January 2016

 

Mr Cabot Brown

 

Dear Cabot

 

GW Pharmaceuticals plc (the "Company")

 

I am writing to record the amended terms of your appointment as a non-executive Director of, GW Pharmaceuticals plc (" GW "). These amended terms will take effect on 1 January 2016 and will continue until terminated by either party giving to the other not less than 3 months' prior written notice or as provided for in paragraph 1 below.

 

The terms of appointment replace the previous terms of you appointment by GW Pharmaceuticals Inc. dated 7 November 2013. Your employment by GW Pharmaceuticals Inc. ended on 31 December 2015.

 

1. Appointment

 

(a) Your appointment as a non-executive Director of GW is subject to the Articles of Association of GW. Your appointment as a Director will be subject to the usual rules requiring your appointment and re-appointment to be approved by shareholders. Your appointment as a non-executive Director will automatically terminate without any entitlement to compensation if you:

 

(i) are removed from office by a resolution of the shareholders;

 

(ii) are not re-elected to office; or

 

(iii) cease to be a director by reason of your vacating office pursuant to any provision of the Company's Articles of Association.

 

(b) The Company may terminate your appointment with immediate effect if you:

 

(i) commit any act, whether or not in the course of your duties for the Company, which tends to bring you or the Company or Group into disrepute;

 

 

 

 

(ii) commit a material breach of your obligations under this letter;

 

(iii) commit any serious or repeated breach or non-observance of your obligations to the Company (which include an obligation not to breach your duties to the Company, whether statutory, fiduciary or common law);

 

(iv) are declared bankrupt or have made an arrangement with, or for the benefit of, your creditors;

 

(v) are convicted of any arrestable criminal offence (other than an offence under road traffic legislation in the UK or elsewhere for which a fine or non-custodial penalty is imposed); or

 

(vi) are unavailable to perform your duties under your appointment for 6 months consecutively or in aggregate in any period of one year.

 

(c) During any period of notice in accordance with this agreement, the Company may at its absolute discretion ask you not to attend any Board or General meetings or to perform any other services on its behalf.

 

(d) Non-executive directors on the GW Board are typically expected to serve two three-year terms but you may be invited by the Company to serve for an additional period on the Board. Any term renewal is subject to Board review and GW AGM re-election. Notwithstanding any mutual expectation, there is no right to re-nomination by the Board, either annually or after any three-year period.

 

(e) Upon the ending of your appointment for any reason, you will resign at the request of the Company, without any claim for compensation (other than for accrued and unpaid fees due under this letter), from all directorships and other offices held by you in the Company and any other member of the Group and from all trusteeships held by you of any pension scheme or other trusts established by any member of the Group. Should you fail to do so, you irrevocably appoint any member of the Board as your attorney in your name and on your behalf to sign any documents and take such other steps as are necessary to give effect to those resignations.

 

2. Time commitment

 

(a) You will be expected to devote such time, in the UK, as is necessary for the proper performance of your duties, and you should be prepared to spend at least 12 days per annum attending meetings representing the Company business interests. You are expected to attend GW Board Meetings and GW General Meetings of the shareholders of GW as and when they are held. In connection with attendance at the meetings, you will exercise such functions that are specifically delegated to you from time to time by the Board.

 

 

 

 

(b) You will be required to sit on the Remuneration Committee, the Nomination Committee and the Audit Committee of the GW Board.

 

(c) We expect this role to involve attendance at six GW Board meetings, the GW Annual General Meeting, GW Audit committee meetings with auditors and occasional attendance, as required, and meetings with other advisers and shareholders. Unless urgent and unavoidable circumstances prevent you from doing so, it is expected that you will attend these meetings, to be held in the UK.

 

(d) Additional time may be required, on an ad-hoc basis, to attend meetings to deal with certain GW Board and sub-committee matters as they arise. The nature of the role makes it impossible to be specific about the maximum time commitment, and there is always the possibility of additional time commitment in respect of preparation time and ad hoc matters which may arise from time to time, and particularly when the Company is undergoing a period of increased activity. At certain times, it may be necessary to convene additional GW Board, committee or shareholder meetings.

 

(e) In accepting this role you are deemed to undertake that you have sufficient time available to commit to the proper performance of this role. Prior to acceptance of the role you will be required to provide to the Company Secretary details of your other Board appointments and significant commitments with a broad indication of the time involved and will be required to update the Company Secretary from time to time of any changes to these commitments.

 

3. Remuneration and expenses

 

(a) Your fees will be $70,000 per annum, and will be subject to any deduction required by law. This will be paid monthly in arrears. You are not eligible for any other benefits.

 

(b) This fee will be reviewed from time to time by the GW Board. It is our current practice to review these fees at the end of each calendar year although such review does not imply nor guarantee any increase.

 

(c) You will not be entitled to participate in any Group pension scheme

 

 

 

 

(d) You will be reimbursed for all reasonable out-of-pocket expenses properly incurred by you on Company business, including costs associated with you attending UK Board, Committee and General Meetings. Reimbursement would include the reasonable cost of obtaining legal advice, if circumstances should arise where it was necessary for you to seek such advice separately, about your responsibilities as a non-executive director of the Company although you should initially raise any such concerns with the Chairman of the Company. This advice should be obtained, and reimbursement will only be made, in accordance with any formal procedure for directors to take independent professional advice adopted from time to time by the Company and a copy of the current version will be supplied to you. Claims for reimbursement should be accompanied by evidence of expenditure.

 

4. Insurance

 

The Company will, at its expense, provide you with director's and officer's liability insurance, subject to the provisions governing such insurance and on such terms as the Board may from time to time decide (including but not limited to terms relating to the level of cover, deductibles, caps, exclusions and aggregate limits) and subject to the obtaining of insurance at reasonable rates of premium. No undertaking is given regarding the continuation of this insurance, other than that you will be covered for as long as it remains in place for the directors of the Company.

 

5. Duties

 

(a) You will be expected to perform your duties, whether statutory, fiduciary or common-law, faithfully, efficiently and diligently to a standard commensurate with both the functions of your role and your knowledge, skills and experience.

 

(a) You will exercise your powers in your role as a non-executive director having regard to relevant obligations under prevailing law and regulation, including the Companies Act 2006. You are also required to comply with the requirements of Nasdaq. You will be advised by the Company Secretary where these differ from requirements in the UK.

 

(b) You will have particular regard to the general duties of directors as set out in Part 10, Chapter 2 of the Companies Act 2006, including the duty to promote the success of the company:

 

" A director of a company must act in the way he considers, in good faith, would be most likely to promote the success of the company for the benefit of its members as a whole, and in doing so have regard (amongst other matters) to -

 

(a) the likely consequences of any decision in the long term,

 

(b) the interests of the company's employees,

 

(c) the need to foster the company's business relationships with suppliers, customers and others,

 

 

 

 

(d) the impact of the company's operations on the community and the environment,

 

(e) the desirability of the company maintaining a reputation for high standards of business conduct, and

 

(f) the need to act fairly as between members of the company. "

 

(c) In your role as non-executive director you will be required to:

 

· constructively challenge and help develop proposals on strategy;

 

· scrutinise the performance of management in meeting agreed goals and objectives and monitor the reporting of performance;

 

· satisfy yourself on the integrity of financial information and that financial controls and systems of risk management are robust and defensible;

 

· determine appropriate levels of remuneration of executive directors and have a prime role in appointing and, where necessary, removing executive directors, and in succession planning;

 

· devote time to developing and refreshing your knowledge and skills;

 

· uphold high standards of integrity and probity and support me and the other directors in instilling the appropriate culture, values and behaviours in the boardroom and beyond;

 

· insist on receiving high-quality information sufficiently in advance of board meetings; and

 

· take into account the views of shareholders and other stakeholders where appropriate.

 

(d) You will be required to exercise relevant powers under, and abide by, GW’s articles of association.

 

(e) You will be required to exercise your powers as a director in accordance with GW’s policies and procedures.

 

(f) You will disclose any direct or indirect interest which you may have in any matter being considered at a board meeting or committee meeting and, save as permitted under the articles of association, you will not vote on any resolution of the Board, or of one of its committees, on any matter where you have any direct or indirect interest.

 

 

 

 

(g) You will immediately report to the Chairman your own wrongdoing or the wrongdoing or proposed wrongdoing of any employee or director of which you become aware.

 

(h) Unless specifically authorised to do so by the Board, you will not enter into any legal or other commitment or contract on behalf of the Company.

 

6. Outside interests

 

During your appointment you may not, without the prior approval of the Board, accept a directorship of a company or provide your services to anyone who is a competitor of the Group. The Board's agreement will not be given if such appointment or involvement would conflict with or is likely to interfere with this appointment. It is the parties understanding that the definition of a competitor shall be restricted to a project, business or activity, directly or indirectly, involving cannabinoid research. Please let the Company Secretary have a list of your current commitments for our records and keep him updated in that respect.

 

7. Confidentiality

 

You should not, during your appointment (except in the proper performance of your duties and then only to those who need to know such information) or after it has ceased (except as required by law), disclose to any person, company or other organisation or use otherwise than for the benefit of the Group any confidential information or trade secrets concerning its business. This includes but is not limited to:

 

(a) corporate and marketing strategy, acquisition and investment proposals, business development and plans, maturing business opportunities, sales reports and research results;

 

(b) business contacts, lists of customers and suppliers and details of contracts with customers and suppliers and their current or future requirements;

 

(c) budgets, financial plans and management accounts, trading statements and other financial reports and information;

 

(d) unpublished price sensitive information about the Group; and

 

(e) any document marked "confidential" and any information which by its nature is commercially sensitive.

 

 

 

 

8. Compliance

 

(a) You are expected to comply with the Company's articles of association, the City Code on Takeovers and Mergers, applicable stock exchange rules and regulations and the Company's relevant internal codes. In particular during your appointment you will comply, and will procure, so far as you are able, that your spouse or Civil Partner and dependent children (if any) or any trust in which you or your spouse or Civil Partner may be concerned or interested as trustee or beneficiary, comply with any code of conduct relating to securities transactions by directors and specified employees adopted by the Company from time to time.

 

(b) You will promptly give the Company such information as the Company or any member of the Group may require to enable it to comply with its legal and regulatory obligations whether to any securities or investment exchange or regulatory or governmental body to which any member of the Group is, from time to time, subject or howsoever arising.

 

9. Return of Company property

 

When your appointment ends, you should, unless otherwise agreed in writing, immediately return all documents and other property belonging to any member of the Group and which may be in your possession or under your control. No copies (including electronic copies) should be retained by you or by anyone on your behalf.

 

10. Data protection

 

By signing this letter you consent to the Company holding and processing information about you for legal, personnel, administrative and management purposes and in particular to the processing of any sensitive personal data (as defined in the Data Protection Act 1998) including, as and when appropriate:

 

(i) information about your physical or mental health or condition in order to monitor sick leave and take decisions as to your fitness to perform your duties;

 

(ii) information about you that may be relevant to ensuring equality of opportunity and treatment in line with the Company’s equal opportunities policy and in compliance with equal opportunities legislation; and

 

(iii) information relating to any criminal proceedings in which you have been involved, for insurance purposes and in order to comply with legal requirements and obligations to third parties.

 

You consent to the transfer of such personal information to any member of the Group (or a company appointed by them for such purposes), whether or not outside the European Economic Area, for administration purposes and other purposes in connection with your appointment, where it is necessary or desirable for the Company to do so.

 

 

 

 

11. Non-compete

 

In consideration for the fees payable to you under this letter, you agree you will not (except with prior written consent of the GW Board) directly or indirectly do or attempt to, for the period of 12 months immediately after the termination of your office, to any material extent, undertake, carry on or be employed, engaged or interested in any capacity in the supply or proposed supply of Competitive Services within the Territory. For the purposes of this paragraph, "Competitive Services" means any business connected to the marketing, sales or distribution, or development or proposed development of pharmaceuticals from cannabinoids which is competitive with the Company's or GW, or GW Pharma's businesses; and "Territory" means England, Wales, Scotland and/or Northern Ireland and any other country, or, in the United States, any state, which the Company or any member of the Group is operating or planning to operate a competitive business at the end of your appointment.

 

12. Rights of third parties

 

The Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999 shall not apply to this letter. No person other than you and the Company shall have any rights under this letter and the terms of this letter shall not be enforceable by any person other than you and the Company.

 

13. Miscellaneous

 

(a) For the purpose of this letter:

 

the " Board " shall mean the board of directors of the Company as constituted from time to time;

 

" Civil Partner " means a civil partner as defined by the Civil Partnership Act 2004; and

 

the " Group " means any of the following from time to time: the Company, its subsidiaries and subsidiary undertakings and any holding company or parent undertaking of the Company and all other subsidiaries and subsidiary undertakings of any holding company or parent undertaking of the Company, where "holding company", "parent undertaking", "subsidiary" and "subsidiary undertaking" have the meanings given to them in the Companies Act 2006.

 

(b) This letter will be construed in accordance with English law and you and the Company irrevocably submit to the exclusive jurisdiction of the English Courts to settle any dispute which may arise in connection with this letter.

 

(c) This letter constitutes the entire terms and conditions of your appointment. No variation or addition to this letter and no waiver of any provision of it will be valid unless in writing and signed by or on behalf of both parties.

 

 

 

 

I would ask you to countersign the enclosed copy of this letter to confirm the basis of your appointment with the Company and to show acceptance of the terms of this letter by executing it as a deed.

 

I look forward to continuing to work with you to the general benefit of our shareholders.

 

Yours sincerely

 

/s/ Adam George

 

Adam George

 

For and on behalf of the Board of Directors of GW Pharmaceuticals plc

 

Signed as a Deed by:

 

     /s/ Cabot Brown Date      2/4/16

 

in the presence of :

 

Witness: /s/ Adam George  
     
Name: Adam George  
     
Address: c/o 1 Cavendish Place, London  
     
Occupation:   Chief Financial Officer  

 

 

 

Exhibit 4.62

 

 

 

1 February 2016

 

Mr James Noble

 

Dear James

 

GW Pharmaceuticals plc (the "Company")

 

I am writing to record the amended terms of your appointment as a non-executive Director of, GW Pharmaceuticals plc (" GW "). These amended terms will take effect on 1 February 2016 and will continue until terminated by either party giving to the other not less than 3 months' prior written notice or as provided for in paragraph 1 below.

 

The terms of appointment replace the previous terms of you appointment by GW Pharmaceuticals plc. dated 19 January 2007.

 

1. Appointment

 

(a) Your appointment as a non-executive Director of GW is subject to the Articles of Association of GW. You will continue to act as Senior Independent Director and will continue to participate in the Remuneration Committee, Nominations Committee and will act as Chairman of the Audit Committee.

 

(b) Your appointment as a Director will be subject to the usual rules requiring your appointment and re-appointment to be approved by shareholders. Your appointment as a non-executive Director will automatically terminate without any entitlement to compensation if you:

 

(i) are removed from office by a resolution of the shareholders;

 

(ii) are not re-elected to office; or

 

(iii) cease to be a director by reason of your vacating office pursuant to any provision of the Company's Articles of Association.

 

(c) The Company may terminate your appointment with immediate effect if you:

 

 

 

 

(i) commit any act, whether or not in the course of your duties for the Company, which tends to bring you or the Company or Group into disrepute;

 

(ii) commit a material breach of your obligations under this letter;

 

(iii) commit any serious or repeated breach or non-observance of your obligations to the Company (which include an obligation not to breach your duties to the Company, whether statutory, fiduciary or common law);

 

(iv) are declared bankrupt or have made an arrangement with, or for the benefit of, your creditors;

 

(v) are convicted of any arrestable criminal offence (other than an offence under road traffic legislation in the UK or elsewhere for which a fine or non-custodial penalty is imposed); or

 

(vi) are unavailable to perform your duties under your appointment for 6 months consecutively or in aggregate in any period of one year.

 

(d) During any period of notice in accordance with this agreement, the Company may at its absolute discretion ask you not to attend any Board or General meetings or to perform any other services on its behalf.

 

(e) Non-executive directors on the GW Board are typically expected to serve two three-year terms but you may be invited by the Company to serve for an additional period on the Board. Any term renewal is subject to Board review and GW AGM re-election. Notwithstanding any mutual expectation, there is no right to re-nomination by the Board, either annually or after any three-year period.

 

(f) Upon the ending of your appointment for any reason, you will resign at the request of the Company, without any claim for compensation (other than for accrued and unpaid fees due under this letter), from all directorships and other offices held by you in the Company and any other member of the Group and from all trusteeships held by you of any pension scheme or other trusts established by any member of the Group. Should you fail to do so, you irrevocably appoint any member of the Board as your attorney in your name and on your behalf to sign any documents and take such other steps as are necessary to give effect to those resignations.

 

2. Time commitment

 

(a) You will be expected to devote such time, in the UK, as is necessary for the proper performance of your duties, and you should be prepared to spend at least 12 days per annum attending meetings representing the Company business interests. You are expected to attend GW Board Meetings and GW General Meetings of the shareholders of GW as and when they are held. In connection with attendance at the meetings, you will exercise such functions that are specifically delegated to you from time to time by the Board.

 

 

 

 

(b) You will be required to sit on the Remuneration Committee, the Nomination Committee and the Audit Committee of the GW Board.

 

(c) We expect this role to involve attendance at six GW Board meetings, the GW Annual General Meeting, GW Audit committee meetings with auditors and occasional attendance, as required, and meetings with other advisers and shareholders. Unless urgent and unavoidable circumstances prevent you from doing so, it is expected that you will attend these meetings, to be held in the UK.

 

(d) Additional time may be required, on an ad-hoc basis, to attend meetings to deal with certain GW Board and sub-committee matters as they arise. The nature of the role makes it impossible to be specific about the maximum time commitment, and there is always the possibility of additional time commitment in respect of preparation time and ad hoc matters which may arise from time to time, and particularly when the Company is undergoing a period of increased activity. At certain times, it may be necessary to convene additional GW Board, committee or shareholder meetings.

 

(e) In accepting this role you are deemed to undertake that you have sufficient time available to commit to the proper performance of this role. Prior to acceptance of the role you will be required to provide to the Company Secretary details of your other Board appointments and significant commitments with a broad indication of the time involved and will be required to update the Company Secretary from time to time of any changes to these commitments.

 

3. Remuneration and expenses

 

(a) Your fees will be £63,000 per annum, and will be subject to any deduction required by law. This will be paid monthly in arrears. You are not eligible for any other benefits.

 

(b) This fee will be reviewed from time to time by the GW Board. It is our current practice to review these fees at the end of each calendar year although such review does not imply nor guarantee any increase.

 

(c) You will not be entitled to participate in any Group pension scheme

 

 

 

 

(d) You will be reimbursed for all reasonable out-of-pocket expenses properly incurred by you on Company business, including costs associated with you attending UK Board, Committee and General Meetings. Reimbursement would include the reasonable cost of obtaining legal advice, if circumstances should arise where it was necessary for you to seek such advice separately, about your responsibilities as a non-executive director of the Company although you should initially raise any such concerns with the Chairman of the Company. This advice should be obtained, and reimbursement will only be made, in accordance with any formal procedure for directors to take independent professional advice adopted from time to time by the Company and a copy of the current version will be supplied to you. Claims for reimbursement should be accompanied by evidence of expenditure.

 

4. Insurance

 

The Company will, at its expense, provide you with director's and officer's liability insurance, subject to the provisions governing such insurance and on such terms as the Board may from time to time decide (including but not limited to terms relating to the level of cover, deductibles, caps, exclusions and aggregate limits) and subject to the obtaining of insurance at reasonable rates of premium. No undertaking is given regarding the continuation of this insurance, other than that you will be covered for as long as it remains in place for the directors of the Company.

 

5. Duties

 

(a) You will be expected to perform your duties, whether statutory, fiduciary or common-law, faithfully, efficiently and diligently to a standard commensurate with both the functions of your role and your knowledge, skills and experience.

 

(a) You will exercise your powers in your role as a non-executive director having regard to relevant obligations under prevailing law and regulation, including the Companies Act 2006. You are also required to comply with the requirements of Nasdaq. You will be advised by the Company Secretary where these differ from requirements in the UK.

 

(b) You will have particular regard to the general duties of directors as set out in Part 10, Chapter 2 of the Companies Act 2006, including the duty to promote the success of the company:

 

" A director of a company must act in the way he considers, in good faith, would be most likely to promote the success of the company for the benefit of its members as a whole, and in doing so have regard (amongst other matters) to -

 

(a) the likely consequences of any decision in the long term,

 

 

 

 

(b) the interests of the company's employees,

 

(c) the need to foster the company's business relationships with suppliers, customers and others,

 

(d) the impact of the company's operations on the community and the environment,

 

(e) the desirability of the company maintaining a reputation for high standards of business conduct, and

 

(f) the need to act fairly as between members of the company. "

 

(c) In your role as non-executive director you will be required to:

 

· constructively challenge and help develop proposals on strategy;

 

· scrutinise the performance of management in meeting agreed goals and objectives and monitor the reporting of performance;

 

· satisfy yourself on the integrity of financial information and that financial controls and systems of risk management are robust and defensible;

 

· determine appropriate levels of remuneration of executive directors and have a prime role in appointing and, where necessary, removing executive directors, and in succession planning;

 

· devote time to developing and refreshing your knowledge and skills;

 

· uphold high standards of integrity and probity and support me and the other directors in instilling the appropriate culture, values and behaviours in the boardroom and beyond;

 

· insist on receiving high-quality information sufficiently in advance of board meetings; and

 

· take into account the views of shareholders and other stakeholders where appropriate.

 

(d) You will be required to exercise relevant powers under, and abide by, GW’s articles of association.

 

(e) You will be required to exercise your powers as a director in accordance with GW’s policies and procedures.

 

 

 

 

(f) You will disclose any direct or indirect interest which you may have in any matter being considered at a board meeting or committee meeting and, save as permitted under the articles of association, you will not vote on any resolution of the Board, or of one of its committees, on any matter where you have any direct or indirect interest.

 

(g) You will immediately report to the Chairman your own wrongdoing or the wrongdoing or proposed wrongdoing of any employee or director of which you become aware.

 

(h) Unless specifically authorised to do so by the Board, you will not enter into any legal or other commitment or contract on behalf of the Company.

 

6. Outside interests

 

During your appointment you may not, without the prior approval of the Board, accept a directorship of a company or provide your services to anyone who is a competitor of the Group. The Board's agreement will not be given if such appointment or involvement would conflict with or is likely to interfere with this appointment. It is the parties understanding that the definition of a competitor shall be restricted to a project, business or activity, directly or indirectly, involving cannabinoid research. Please let the Company Secretary have a list of your current commitments for our records and keep him updated in that respect.

 

7. Confidentiality

 

You should not, during your appointment (except in the proper performance of your duties and then only to those who need to know such information) or after it has ceased (except as required by law), disclose to any person, company or other organisation or use otherwise than for the benefit of the Group any confidential information or trade secrets concerning its business. This includes but is not limited to:

 

(a) corporate and marketing strategy, acquisition and investment proposals, business development and plans, maturing business opportunities, sales reports and research results;

 

(b) business contacts, lists of customers and suppliers and details of contracts with customers and suppliers and their current or future requirements;

 

(c) budgets, financial plans and management accounts, trading statements and other financial reports and information;

 

(d) unpublished price sensitive information about the Group; and

 

(e) any document marked "confidential" and any information which by its nature is commercially sensitive.

 

 

 

 

8. Compliance

 

(a) You are expected to comply with the Company's articles of association, the City Code on Takeovers and Mergers, applicable stock exchange rules and regulations and the Company's relevant internal codes. In particular during your appointment you will comply, and will procure, so far as you are able, that your spouse or Civil Partner and dependent children (if any) or any trust in which you or your spouse or Civil Partner may be concerned or interested as trustee or beneficiary, comply with any code of conduct relating to securities transactions by directors and specified employees adopted by the Company from time to time.

 

(b) You will promptly give the Company such information as the Company or any member of the Group may require to enable it to comply with its legal and regulatory obligations whether to any securities or investment exchange or regulatory or governmental body to which any member of the Group is, from time to time, subject or howsoever arising.

 

9. Return of Company property

 

When your appointment ends, you should, unless otherwise agreed in writing, immediately return all documents and other property belonging to any member of the Group and which may be in your possession or under your control. No copies (including electronic copies) should be retained by you or by anyone on your behalf.

 

10. Data protection

 

By signing this letter you consent to the Company holding and processing information about you for legal, personnel, administrative and management purposes and in particular to the processing of any sensitive personal data (as defined in the Data Protection Act 1998) including, as and when appropriate:

 

(i) information about your physical or mental health or condition in order to monitor sick leave and take decisions as to your fitness to perform your duties;

 

(ii) information about you that may be relevant to ensuring equality of opportunity and treatment in line with the Company’s equal opportunities policy and in compliance with equal opportunities legislation; and

 

(iii) information relating to any criminal proceedings in which you have been involved, for insurance purposes and in order to comply with legal requirements and obligations to third parties.

 

You consent to the transfer of such personal information to any member of the Group (or a company appointed by them for such purposes), whether or not outside the European Economic Area, for administration purposes and other purposes in connection with your appointment, where it is necessary or desirable for the Company to do so.

 

 

 

 

11. Non-compete

 

In consideration for the fees payable to you under this letter, you agree you will not (except with prior written consent of the GW Board) directly or indirectly do or attempt to, for the period of 12 months immediately after the termination of your office, to any material extent, undertake, carry on or be employed, engaged or interested in any capacity in the supply or proposed supply of Competitive Services within the Territory. For the purposes of this paragraph, "Competitive Services" means any business connected to the marketing, sales or distribution, or development or proposed development of pharmaceuticals from cannabinoids which is competitive with the Company's or GW, or GW Pharma's businesses; and "Territory" means England, Wales, Scotland and/or Northern Ireland and any other country, or, in the United States, any state, which the Company or any member of the Group is operating or planning to operate a competitive business at the end of your appointment.

 

12. Rights of third parties

 

The Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999 shall not apply to this letter. No person other than you and the Company shall have any rights under this letter and the terms of this letter shall not be enforceable by any person other than you and the Company.

 

13. Miscellaneous

 

(a) For the purpose of this letter:

 

the " Board " shall mean the board of directors of the Company as constituted from time to time;

 

" Civil Partner " means a civil partner as defined by the Civil Partnership Act 2004; and

 

the " Group " means any of the following from time to time: the Company, its subsidiaries and subsidiary undertakings and any holding company or parent undertaking of the Company and all other subsidiaries and subsidiary undertakings of any holding company or parent undertaking of the Company, where "holding company", "parent undertaking", "subsidiary" and "subsidiary undertaking" have the meanings given to them in the Companies Act 2006.

 

(b) This letter will be construed in accordance with English law and you and the Company irrevocably submit to the exclusive jurisdiction of the English Courts to settle any dispute which may arise in connection with this letter.

 

(c) This letter constitutes the entire terms and conditions of your appointment. No variation or addition to this letter and no waiver of any provision of it will be valid unless in writing and signed by or on behalf of both parties.

 

 

 

 

I would ask you to countersign the enclosed copy of this letter to confirm the basis of your appointment with the Company and to show acceptance of the terms of this letter by executing it as a deed.

 

I look forward to continuing to work with you to the general benefit of our shareholders.

 

Yours sincerely

 
Adam George

 

For and on behalf of the Board of Directors of GW Pharmaceuticals plc

 

Signed as a Deed by: James Noble

 

/s/ James Noble Date   5-2-16

 

in the presence of :

 

Witness: /s/ H. R. Boardman  
     
Name: Hilary Boardman  
     
Address: The Old Post Office, High Street, Childrey OX 12 9UE  
     
Occupation:  Snr Executive Assistant  

 

 

 

 

 

Exhibit 8.1

 

Subsidiaries of Registrant

 

Name of undertaking   Country of
registration
  Activity   %
holding
 
GW Pharma Limited   England and Wales   Research and Development     100  
GW Research Limited   England and Wales   Research and Development     100  
Greenwich Biosciences Inc.   United States   Pharmaceutical development services     100  
GWP Trustee Company Limited   England and Wales   Employee Share Ownership     100  
Cannabinoid Research Institute Limited   England and Wales   Dormant     100  
Guernsey Pharmaceuticals Limited   Guernsey   Dormant     100  
G-Pharm Limited   England and Wales   Dormant     100  

 

 

 

 

 

Exhibit 12.1

 

Section 302 Certificate

 

Form of Certification Required by Rule 13a-14(a) or 15d-14(a) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 as Adopted Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

 

I, Justin Gover, certify that:

 

  1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of GW Pharmaceuticals plc;

 

  2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

 

  3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the company as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

 

  4. The company’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the company and have:

 

  a. designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the company, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 

  b. designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

 

  c. evaluated the effectiveness of the company’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

  d. disclosed in this report any change in the company’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the company’s internal control over financial reporting; and

 

  5. The company’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the company’s auditors and the audit committee of the company’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

 

  a. all significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the company’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

 

  b. any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the company’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

Date: December 5, 2016

 

  /s/ Justin Gover
  Justin Gover
  Chief Executive Officer

  

 

 

 

Exhibit 12.2

 

Section 302 Certificate

 

Form of Certification Required by Rule 13a-14(a) or 15d-14(a) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

 

I, Adam George, certify that:

 

  1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of GW Pharmaceuticals plc;

 

  2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

 

  3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the company as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

 

  4. The company’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the company and have:

 

  a. designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the company, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 

  b. designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

 

  c. evaluated the effectiveness of the company’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

  d. disclosed in this report any change in the company’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the company’s internal control over financial reporting; and

 

  5. The company’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the company’s auditors and the audit committee of the company’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

 

  a. all significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the company’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

 

  b. any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the company’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

Date: December 5, 2016

 

  /s/ Adam George
  Adam George
  Chief Financial Officer

  

 

 

 

Exhibit 13.1

 

Section 906 Certificate

 

Certification Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (Subsections (a) and (b) of Section 1350, Chapter 63 of Title 18, United States Code)

 

Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (subsections (a) and (b) of Section 1350, Chapter 63 of Title 18, United States Code), I, Justin Gover, Chief Executive Officer of GW Pharmaceuticals plc, a public limited company incorporated under English law (the “company”), hereby certify, to my knowledge, that:

 

  1. The Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended September 30, 2016 (the “Form 20-F”) of the company fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and

 

  2. The information contained in the Form 20-F fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the company.

 

Date: December 5, 2016

 

  /s/ Justin Gover
  Justin Gover
  Chief Executive Officer

 

 

 

 

Exhibit 13.2

 

Section 906 Certificate

 

Certification Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (Subsections (a) and (b) of Section 1350, Chapter 63 of Title 18, United States Code)

 

Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (subsections (a) and (b) of Section 1350, Chapter 63 of Title 18, United States Code), I, Adam George, Chief Financial Officer of GW Pharmaceuticals plc, a public limited company incorporated under English law (the “company”), hereby certify, to my knowledge, that:

 

  1. The Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended September 30, 2016 (the “Form 20-F”) of the company fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and

 

  2. The information contained in the Form 20-F fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the company.

 

Date: December 5, 2016

 

  /s/ Adam George
  Adam George
  Chief Financial Officer

 

 

 

 

 

Exhibit 15.1

 

CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of GW Pharmaceuticals plc

 

We consent to the incorporation by reference in Registration Statement No. 333-195747 on Form F-3 and Registration Statement No. 333-204389 on Form S-8 of our reports dated December 5, 2016, relating to the consolidated financial statements of GW Pharmaceuticals plc, and the effectiveness of GW Pharmaceuticals plc’s internal control over financial reporting, appearing in this Annual Report on Form 20-F of GW Pharmaceuticals plc for the year ended September 30, 2016.

 

/s/ Deloitte LLP

 

London, United Kingdom

December 5, 2016